rclone

rclone(1) rclone(1)

Rclone syncs your files to cloud storage

    About rclone

    What can rclone do for you?

    What features does rclone have?

    What providers does rclone support?

    Download (https://rclone.org/downloads/)

    Install (https://rclone.org/install/)

    Donate. (https://rclone.org/donate/)

About rclone

   Rclone is a command-line program to manage files on cloud storage.  It is a feature-rich alternative to cloud vendors' web storage interfaces.  Over 40 cloud
   storage products support rclone including S3 object stores, business & consumer file storage services, as well as standard transfer protocols.

   Rclone has powerful cloud equivalents to the unix commands rsync, cp, mv, mount, ls, ncdu, tree, rm, and cat.  Rclone's familiar syntax includes shell  pipe
   line support, and --dry-run protection.  It is used at the command line, in scripts or via its API.

   Users call rclone "The Swiss army knife of cloud storage", and "Technology indistinguishable from magic".

   Rclone  really  looks  after your data.  It preserves timestamps and verifies checksums at all times.  Transfers over limited bandwidth; intermittent connec
   tions, or subject to quota can be restarted, from the last good file transferred.  You can check (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_check/) the integrity of
   your  files.   Where  possible, rclone employs server-side transfers to minimise local bandwidth use and transfers from one provider to another without using
   local disk.

   Virtual backends wrap local and cloud file systems to apply  encryption  (https://rclone.org/crypt/),  compression  (https://rclone.org/compress/),  chunking
   (https://rclone.org/chunker/), hashing (https://rclone.org/hasher/) and joining (https://rclone.org/union/).

   Rclone  mounts  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/)  any  local, cloud or virtual filesystem as a disk on Windows, macOS, linux and FreeBSD, and also
   serves    these    over    SFTP    (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/),    HTTP     (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_http/),     WebDAV
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_webdav/),     FTP     (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_ftp/)     and     DLNA     (https://rclone.org/com
   mands/rclone_serve_dlna/).

   Rclone is mature, open-source software originally inspired by rsync and written in Go (https://golang.org).  The friendly support community is familiar  with
   varied  use  cases.   Official  Ubuntu,  Debian,  Fedora,  Brew  and  Chocolatey  repos.  include rclone.  For the latest version downloading from rclone.org
   (https://rclone.org/downloads/) is recommended.

   Rclone is widely used on Linux, Windows and Mac.  Third-party developers create innovative backup, restore, GUI and  business  process  solutions  using  the
   rclone command line or API.

   Rclone does the heavy lifting of communicating with cloud storage.

What can rclone do for you?

   Rclone helps you:

    Backup (and encrypt) files to cloud storage

    Restore (and decrypt) files from cloud storage

    Mirror cloud data to other cloud services or locally

    Migrate data to the cloud, or between cloud storage vendors

    Mount multiple, encrypted, cached or diverse cloud storage as a disk

    Analyse and account for data held on cloud storage using lsf (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsf/), ljson (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsjson/),
     size (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/), ncdu (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ncdu/)

    Union (https://rclone.org/union/) file systems together to present multiple local and/or cloud file systems as one

Features

    Transfers

      MD5, SHA1 hashes are checked at all times for file integrity

      Timestamps are preserved on files

      Operations can be restarted at any time

      Can be to and from network, e.g.  two different cloud providers

      Can use multi-threaded downloads to local disk

    Copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) new or changed files to cloud storage

    Sync (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sync/) (one way) to make a directory identical

    Move (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_move/) files to cloud storage deleting the local after verification

    Check (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_check/) hashes and for missing/extra files

    Mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) your cloud storage as a network disk

    Serve   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)   local   or   remote   files   over    HTTP    (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_http/)/WebDav
     (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_webdav/)/FTP             (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_ftp/)/SFTP            (https://rclone.org/com
     mands/rclone_serve_sftp/)/DLNA (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_dlna/)

    Experimental Web based GUI (https://rclone.org/gui/)

Supported providers

   (There are many others, built on standard protocols such as WebDAV or S3, that work out of the box.)

    1Fichier

    Akamai Netstorage

    Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) Object Storage System (OSS)

    Amazon Drive

    Amazon S3

    Backblaze B2

    Box

    Ceph

    China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

    Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS)

    Citrix ShareFile

    Cloudflare R2

    DigitalOcean Spaces

    Digi Storage

    Dreamhost

    Dropbox

    Enterprise File Fabric

    FTP

    Google Cloud Storage

    Google Drive

    Google Photos

    HDFS

    Hetzner Storage Box

    HiDrive

    HTTP

    Internet Archive

    Jottacloud

    IBM COS S3

    IDrive e2

    IONOS Cloud

    Koofr

    Liara Object Storage

    Mail.ru Cloud

    Memset Memstore

    Mega

    Memory

    Microsoft Azure Blob Storage

    Microsoft OneDrive

    Minio

    Nextcloud

    OVH

    OpenDrive

    OpenStack Swift

    Oracle Cloud Storage Swift

    Oracle Object Storage

    ownCloud

    pCloud

    premiumize.me

    put.io

    QingStor

    Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo)

    Rackspace Cloud Files

    rsync.net

    Scaleway

    Seafile

    Seagate Lyve Cloud

    SeaweedFS

    SFTP

    Sia

    SMB / CIFS

    StackPath

    Storj

    SugarSync

    Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)

    Uptobox

    Wasabi

    WebDAV

    Yandex Disk

    Zoho WorkDrive

    The local filesystem

Virtual providers

   These backends adapt or modify other storage providers:

    Alias: Rename existing remotes

    Cache: Cache remotes (DEPRECATED)

    Chunker: Split large files

    Combine: Combine multiple remotes into a directory tree

    Compress: Compress files

    Crypt: Encrypt files

    Hasher: Hash files

    Union: Join multiple remotes to work together

Links

    Home page (https://rclone.org/)

    GitHub project page for source and bug tracker (https://github.com/rclone/rclone)

    Rclone Forum (https://forum.rclone.org)

    Downloads (https://rclone.org/downloads/)

Install

   Rclone is a Go program and comes as a single binary file.

Quickstart

    Download (https://rclone.org/downloads/) the relevant binary.

    Extract the rclone executable, rclone.exe on Windows, from the archive.

    Run rclone config to setup.  See rclone config docs (https://rclone.org/docs/) for more details.

    Optionally configure automatic execution.

   See below for some expanded Linux / macOS / Windows instructions.

   See the usage (https://rclone.org/docs/) docs for how to use rclone, or run rclone -h.

   Already installed rclone can be easily updated to the latest version using the rclone selfupdate (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_selfupdate/) command.

Script installation

   To install rclone on Linux/macOS/BSD systems, run:

          sudo -v ; curl https://rclone.org/install.sh | sudo bash

   For beta installation, run:

          sudo -v ; curl https://rclone.org/install.sh | sudo bash -s beta

   Note that this script checks the version of rclone installed first and won't re-download if not needed.

Linux installation Precompiled binary

   Fetch and unpack

          curl -O https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-linux-amd64.zip
          unzip rclone-current-linux-amd64.zip
          cd rclone-*-linux-amd64

   Copy binary file

          sudo cp rclone /usr/bin/
          sudo chown root:root /usr/bin/rclone
          sudo chmod 755 /usr/bin/rclone

   Install manpage

          sudo mkdir -p /usr/local/share/man/man1
          sudo cp rclone.1 /usr/local/share/man/man1/
          sudo mandb

   Run rclone config to setup.  See rclone config docs (https://rclone.org/docs/) for more details.

          rclone config

macOS installation Installation with brew

          brew install rclone

   NOTE: This version of rclone will not support mount any more (see #5373 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/5373)).  If mounting is wanted on macOS, ei‐
   ther install a precompiled binary or enable the relevant option when installing from source.

   Note that this is a third party installer not controlled by the rclone developers so it may be out of date.  Its current version is as below.

   [IMAGE: Homebrew package (https://repology.org/badge/version-for-repo/homebrew/rclone.svg)] (https://repology.org/project/rclone/versions)

Precompiled binary, using curl

   To avoid problems with macOS gatekeeper enforcing the binary to be signed and notarized it is enough to download with curl.

   Download the latest version of rclone.

          cd && curl -O https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-osx-amd64.zip

   Unzip the download and cd to the extracted folder.

          unzip -a rclone-current-osx-amd64.zip && cd rclone-*-osx-amd64

   Move rclone to your $PATH.  You will be prompted for your password.

          sudo mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
          sudo mv rclone /usr/local/bin/

   (the mkdir command is safe to run, even if the directory already exists).

   Remove the leftover files.

          cd .. && rm -rf rclone-*-osx-amd64 rclone-current-osx-amd64.zip

   Run rclone config to setup.  See rclone config docs (https://rclone.org/docs/) for more details.

          rclone config

Precompiled binary, using a web browser

   When downloading a binary with a web browser, the browser will set the macOS gatekeeper quarantine attribute.  Starting from Catalina, when attempting to run
   rclone, a pop-up will appear saying:

          "rclone" cannot be opened because the developer cannot be verified.
          macOS cannot verify that this app is free from malware.

   The simplest fix is to run

          xattr -d com.apple.quarantine rclone

Windows installation Precompiled binary

   Fetch the correct binary for your processor type by clicking on these links.  If not sure, use the first link.

    Intel/AMD - 64 Bit (https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-windows-amd64.zip)

    Intel/AMD - 32 Bit (https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-windows-386.zip)

    ARM - 64 Bit (https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-windows-arm64.zip)

   Open this file in the Explorer and extract rclone.exe.  Rclone is a portable executable so you can place it wherever is convenient.

   Open a CMD window (or powershell) and run the binary.  Note that rclone does not launch a GUI by default, it runs in the CMD Window.

    Run rclone.exe config to setup.  See rclone config docs (https://rclone.org/docs/) for more details.

    Optionally configure automatic execution.

   If you are planning to use the rclone mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) feature then you will need to install the third party utility  WinFsp
   (https://winfsp.dev/) also.

Windows package manager (Winget)

   Winget (https://learn.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/package-manager/) comes pre-installed with the latest versions of Windows.  If not, update the App Install
   er (https://www.microsoft.com/p/app-installer/9nblggh4nns1) package from the Microsoft store.

          winget install Rclone.Rclone

Chocolatey package manager

   Make sure you have Choco (https://chocolatey.org/) installed

          choco search rclone
          choco install rclone

   This will install rclone on your Windows machine.  If you are planning to use rclone mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) then

          choco install winfsp

   will install that too.

   Note that this is a third party installer not controlled by the rclone developers so it may be out of date.  Its current version is as below.

   [IMAGE: Chocolatey package (https://repology.org/badge/version-for-repo/chocolatey/rclone.svg)] (https://repology.org/project/rclone/versions)

Scoop package manager

   Make sure you have Scoop (https://scoop.sh/) installed

          scoop install rclone

   Note that this is a third party installer not controlled by the rclone developers so it may be out of date.  Its current version is as below.

   [IMAGE: Scoop package (https://repology.org/badge/version-for-repo/scoop/rclone.svg)] (https://repology.org/project/rclone/versions)

Package manager installation

   Many Linux, Windows, macOS and other OS distributions package and distribute rclone.

   The distributed versions of rclone are often quite out of date and for this reason we recommend one of the other installation methods if possible.

   You can get an idea of how up to date or not your OS distribution's package is here.

   [IMAGE: Packaging status (https://repology.org/badge/vertical-allrepos/rclone.svg?columns=3)] (https://repology.org/project/rclone/versions)

Docker installation

   The rclone developers maintain a docker image for rclone (https://hub.docker.com/r/rclone/rclone).

   These images are built as part of the release process based on a minimal Alpine Linux.

   The :latest tag will always point to the latest stable release.  You can use the :beta tag to get the latest build from master.  You  can  also  use  version
   tags, e.g.  :1.49.1, :1.49 or :1.

          $ docker pull rclone/rclone:latest
          latest: Pulling from rclone/rclone
          Digest: sha256:0e0ced72671989bb837fea8e88578b3fc48371aa45d209663683e24cfdaa0e11
          ...
          $ docker run --rm rclone/rclone:latest version
          rclone v1.49.1
          - os/arch: linux/amd64
          - go version: go1.12.9

   There are a few command line options to consider when starting an rclone Docker container from the rclone image.

    You  need  to  mount  the host rclone config dir at /config/rclone into the Docker container.  Due to the fact that rclone updates tokens inside its config
     file, and that the update process involves a file rename, you need to mount the whole host rclone config dir, not just the single host rclone config file.

    You need to mount a host data dir at /data into the Docker container.

    By default, the rclone binary inside a Docker container runs with UID=0 (root).  As a result, all files created in a run will have UID=0.  If  your  config
     and data files reside on the host with a non-root UID:GID, you need to pass these on the container start command line.

    If you want to access the RC interface (either via the API or the Web UI), it is required to set the --rc-addr to :5572 in order to connect to it from out
     side the container.  An explanation about why this is necessary is present  here  (https://web.archive.org/web/20200808071950/https://pythonspeed.com/arti
     cles/docker-connection-refused/).

      NOTE:  Users  running  this  container with the docker network set to host should probably set it to listen to localhost only, with 127.0.0.1:5572 as the
       value for --rc-addr

    It is possible to use rclone mount inside a userspace Docker container, and expose the resulting fuse mount to the host.  The exact docker run  options  to
     do that might vary slightly between hosts.  See, e.g.  the discussion in this thread (https://github.com/moby/moby/issues/9448).

     You also need to mount the host /etc/passwd and /etc/group for fuse to work inside the container.

   Here are some commands tested on an Ubuntu 18.04.3 host:

          # config on host at ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf
          # data on host at ~/data

          # make sure the config is ok by listing the remotes
          docker run --rm \
              --volume ~/.config/rclone:/config/rclone \
              --volume ~/data:/data:shared \
              --user $(id -u):$(id -g) \
              rclone/rclone \
              listremotes

          # perform mount inside Docker container, expose result to host
          mkdir -p ~/data/mount
          docker run --rm \
              --volume ~/.config/rclone:/config/rclone \
              --volume ~/data:/data:shared \
              --user $(id -u):$(id -g) \
              --volume /etc/passwd:/etc/passwd:ro --volume /etc/group:/etc/group:ro \
              --device /dev/fuse --cap-add SYS_ADMIN --security-opt apparmor:unconfined \
              rclone/rclone \
              mount dropbox:Photos /data/mount &
          ls ~/data/mount
          kill %1

Source installation

   Make  sure  you  have  git and Go (https://golang.org/) installed.  Go version 1.17 or newer is required, latest release is recommended.  You can get it from
   your package manager, or download it from golang.org/dl (https://golang.org/dl/).  Then you can run the following:

          git clone https://github.com/rclone/rclone.git
          cd rclone
          go build

   This will check out the rclone source in subfolder rclone, which you can later modify and send pull requests with.  Then it will build the rclone  executable
   in the same folder.  As an initial check you can now run ./rclone version (.\rclone version on Windows).

   Note that on macOS and Windows the mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) command will not be available unless you specify an additional build tag
   cmount.

          go build -tags cmount

   This assumes you have a GCC compatible C compiler (GCC or Clang) in your PATH, as it uses cgo (https://pkg.go.dev/cmd/cgo).   But  on  Windows,  the  cgofuse
   (https://github.com/winfsp/cgofuse)  library that the cmount implementation is based on, also supports building without cgo (https://github.com/golang/go/wi
   ki/WindowsDLLs), i.e.  by setting environment variable CGO_ENABLED to value 0 (static linking).  This is how the official Windows release of rclone is  being
   built,  starting  with  version 1.59.  It is still possible to build with cgo on Windows as well, by using the MinGW port of GCC, e.g.  by installing it in a
   MSYS2 (https://www.msys2.org) distribution (make sure you install it in the classic mingw64 subsystem, the ucrt64 version is not compatible).

   Additionally, on Windows, you must install the third party utility WinFsp (https://winfsp.dev/), with the "Developer" feature  selected.   If  building  with
   cgo, you must also set environment variable CPATH pointing to the fuse include directory within the WinFsp installation (normally C:\Program Files (x86)\Win
   Fsp\inc\fuse).

   You may also add arguments -ldflags -s (with or without -tags cmount), to omit symbol table and debug information, making the executable  file  smaller,  and
   -trimpath to remove references to local file system paths.  This is how the official rclone releases are built.

          go build -trimpath -ldflags -s -tags cmount

   Instead of executing the go build command directly, you can run it via the Makefile.  It changes the version number suffix from "-DEV" to "-beta" and appends
   commit details.  It also copies the resulting rclone executable into your GOPATH bin folder ($(go env GOPATH)/bin, which corresponds  to  ~/go/bin/rclone  by
   default).

          make

   To include mount command on macOS and Windows with Makefile build:

          make GOTAGS=cmount

   There  are  other make targets that can be used for more advanced builds, such as cross-compiling for all supported os/architectures, embedding icon and ver
   sion info resources into windows executable, and packaging results into release artifacts.  See Makefile  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/Make
   file) and cross-compile.go (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/bin/cross-compile.go) for details.

   Another  alternative  is  to download the source, build and install rclone in one operation, as a regular Go package.  The source will be stored it in the Go
   module cache, and the resulting executable will be in your GOPATH bin folder ($(go env GOPATH)/bin, which corresponds to ~/go/bin/rclone by default).

   With Go version 1.17 or newer:

          go install github.com/rclone/rclone@latest

   With Go versions older than 1.17 (do not use the -u flag, it causes Go to try to update the dependencies that rclone uses and sometimes these don't work with
   the current version):

          go get github.com/rclone/rclone

Ansible installation

   This can be done with Stefan Weichinger's ansible role (https://github.com/stefangweichinger/ansible-rclone).

   Instructions

   1. git clone https://github.com/stefangweichinger/ansible-rclone.git into your local roles-directory

   2. add the role to the hosts you want rclone installed to:

          - hosts: rclone-hosts
            roles:
                - rclone

Portable installation

   As  mentioned  above  (https://rclone.org/install/#quickstart), rclone is single executable (rclone, or rclone.exe on Windows) that you can download as a zip
   archive and extract into a location of your choosing.  When executing different commands, it may create files in different locations, such as a configuration
   file  and  various temporary files.  By default the locations for these are according to your operating system, e.g.  configuration file in your user profile
   directory and temporary files in the standard temporary directory, but you can customize all of them, e.g.  to make a completely self-contained, portable in
   stallation.

   Run the config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) command to see the locations that rclone will use.

   To  override  them set the corresponding options (as command-line arguments, or as environment variables (https://rclone.org/docs/#environment-variables)): -
   --config (https://rclone.org/docs/#config-config-file) - --cache-dir (https://rclone.org/docs/#cache-dir-dir)  -  --temp-dir  (https://rclone.org/docs/#temp-
   dir-dir)

Autostart

   After  installing and configuring rclone, as described above, you are ready to use rclone as an interactive command line utility.  If your goal is to perform
   periodic operations, such as a regular sync (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sync/), you will probably want to configure your rclone command in your oper
   ating system's scheduler.  If you need to expose service-like features, such as remote control (https://rclone.org/rc/), GUI (https://rclone.org/gui/), serve
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) or mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/), you will often want an rclone command always running in the
   background,  and  configuring  it to run in a service infrastructure may be a better option.  Below are some alternatives on how to achieve this on different
   operating systems.

   NOTE: Before setting up autorun it is highly recommended that you have tested your command manually from a Command Prompt first.

Autostart on Windows

   The most relevant alternatives for autostart on Windows are: - Run at user log on using the Startup folder - Run at user log on,  at  system  startup  or  at
   schedule using Task Scheduler - Run at system startup using Windows service

Running in background

   Rclone  is  a console application, so if not starting from an existing Command Prompt, e.g.  when starting rclone.exe from a shortcut, it will open a Command
   Prompt window.  When configuring rclone to run from task scheduler and windows service you are able to set it to run hidden in background.  From rclone  ver
   sion  1.54  you  can  also make it run hidden from anywhere by adding option --no-console (it may still flash briefly when the program starts).  Since rclone
   normally writes information and any error messages to the console, you must redirect this to a file to be able to see  it.   Rclone  has  a  built-in  option
   --log-file for that.

   Example command to run a sync in background:

          c:\rclone\rclone.exe sync c:\files remote:/files --no-console --log-file c:\rclone\logs\sync_files.txt

User account

   As  mentioned  in  the  mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) documentation, mounted drives created as Administrator are not visible to other ac
   counts, not even the account that was elevated as Administrator.  By running the mount command as the built-in SYSTEM user account, it will create drives ac
   cessible for everyone on the system.  Both scheduled task and Windows service can be used to achieve this.

   NOTE:  Remember  that  when rclone runs as the SYSTEM user, the user profile that it sees will not be yours.  This means that if you normally run rclone with
   configuration file in the default location, to be able to use the same configuration when running as the system user you must explicitly tell rclone where to
   find  it  with  the  --config  (https://rclone.org/docs/#config-config-file)  option,  or else it will look in the system users profile path (C:\Windows\Sys‐
   tem32\config\systemprofile).  To test your command manually from a Command Prompt, you can run it with the PsExec (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/sysinter
   nals/downloads/psexec) utility from Microsoft's Sysinternals suite, which takes option -s to execute commands as the SYSTEM user.

Start from Startup folder

   To  quickly  execute  an  rclone  command you can simply create a standard Windows Explorer shortcut for the complete rclone command you want to run.  If you
   store this shortcut in the special "Startup" start-menu folder, Windows will automatically run it at login.  To open this folder in Windows  Explorer,  enter
   path  %APPDATA%\Microsoft\Windows\Start  Menu\Programs\Startup,  or  C:\ProgramData\Microsoft\Windows\Start  Menu\Programs\StartUp if you want the command to
   start for every user that logs in.

   This is the easiest approach to autostarting of rclone, but it offers no functionality to set it to run as different user, or to set conditions or actions on
   certain events.  Setting up a scheduled task as described below will often give you better results.

Start from Task Scheduler

   Task Scheduler is an administrative tool built into Windows, and it can be used to configure rclone to be started automatically in a highly configurable way,
   e.g.  periodically on a schedule, on user log on, or at system startup.  It can run be configured to run as the current user, or for  a  mount  command  that
   needs  to  be  available  to all users it can run as the SYSTEM user.  For technical information, see https://docs.microsoft.com/windows/win32/taskschd/task-
   scheduler-start-page.

Run as service

   For running rclone at system startup, you can create a Windows service that executes your rclone command, as an alternative to scheduled task  configured  to
   run at startup.

Mount command built-in service integration

   For  mount  commands, rclone has a built-in Windows service integration via the third-party WinFsp library it uses.  Registering as a regular Windows service
   easy, as you just have to execute the built-in PowerShell command New-Service (requires administrative privileges).

   Example of a PowerShell command that creates a Windows service for mounting some remote:/files as drive letter X:, for all users (service will be running  as
   the local system account):

          New-Service -Name Rclone -BinaryPathName 'c:\rclone\rclone.exe mount remote:/files X: --config c:\rclone\config\rclone.conf --log-file c:\rclone\logs\mount.txt'

   The  WinFsp  service  infrastructure (https://github.com/billziss-gh/winfsp/wiki/WinFsp-Service-Architecture) supports incorporating services for file system
   implementations, such as rclone, into its own launcher service, as kind of "child services".  This has the additional advantage that  it  also  implements  a
   network  provider  that integrates into Windows standard methods for managing network drives.  This is currently not officially supported by Rclone, but with
   WinFsp version 2019.3 B2 / v1.5B2 or later it should be possible through path rewriting as described here (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3340).

Third-party service integration

   To Windows service running any rclone command, the excellent third-party utility NSSM (http://nssm.cc), the "Non-Sucking Service Manager", can be  used.   It
   includes  some advanced features such as adjusting process priority, defining process environment variables, redirect to file anything written to stdout, and
   customized response to different exit codes, with a GUI to configure everything from (although it can also be used from command line ).

   There are also several other alternatives.  To mention one more, WinSW (https://github.com/winsw/winsw), "Windows Service Wrapper", is  worth  checking  out.
   It  requires  .NET  Framework,  but it is preinstalled on newer versions of Windows, and it also provides alternative standalone distributions which includes
   necessary runtime (.NET 5).  WinSW is a command-line only utility, where you have to manually create an XML file with service configuration.  This may  be  a
   drawback  for some, but it can also be an advantage as it is easy to back up and re-use the configuration settings, without having go through manual steps in
   a GUI.  One thing to note is that by default it does not restart the service on error, one have to explicit enable this in the configuration  file  (via  the
   "onfailure" parameter).

Autostart on Linux Start as a service

   To  always  run rclone in background, relevant for mount commands etc, you can use systemd to set up rclone as a system or user service.  Running as a system
   service ensures that it is run at startup even if the user it is running as has no active session.  Running rclone as a user service  ensures  that  it  only
   starts after the configured user has logged into the system.

Run periodically from cron

   To run a periodic command, such as a copy/sync, you can set up a cron job.

Usage

   Rclone is a command line program to manage files on cloud storage.  After download (https://rclone.org/downloads/) and install, continue here to learn how to
   use it: Initial configuration, what the basic syntax looks like, describes the various subcommands, the various options, and more.

Configure

   First, you'll need to configure rclone.  As the object storage systems have quite complicated authentication these are kept  in  a  config  file.   (See  the
   --config entry for how to find the config file and choose its location.)

   The easiest way to make the config is to run rclone with the config option:

          rclone config

   See the following for detailed instructions for

    1Fichier (https://rclone.org/fichier/)

    Akamai Netstorage (https://rclone.org/netstorage/)

    Alias (https://rclone.org/alias/)

    Amazon Drive (https://rclone.org/amazonclouddrive/)

    Amazon S3 (https://rclone.org/s3/)

    Backblaze B2 (https://rclone.org/b2/)

    Box (https://rclone.org/box/)

    Chunker (https://rclone.org/chunker/) - transparently splits large files for other remotes

    Citrix ShareFile (https://rclone.org/sharefile/)

    Compress (https://rclone.org/compress/)

    Combine (https://rclone.org/combine/)

    Crypt (https://rclone.org/crypt/) - to encrypt other remotes

    DigitalOcean Spaces (https://rclone.org/s3/#digitalocean-spaces)

    Digi Storage (https://rclone.org/koofr/#digi-storage)

    Dropbox (https://rclone.org/dropbox/)

    Enterprise File Fabric (https://rclone.org/filefabric/)

    FTP (https://rclone.org/ftp/)

    Google Cloud Storage (https://rclone.org/googlecloudstorage/)

    Google Drive (https://rclone.org/drive/)

    Google Photos (https://rclone.org/googlephotos/)

    Hasher (https://rclone.org/hasher/) - to handle checksums for other remotes

    HDFS (https://rclone.org/hdfs/)

    HiDrive (https://rclone.org/hidrive/)

    HTTP (https://rclone.org/http/)

    Internet Archive (https://rclone.org/internetarchive/)

    Jottacloud (https://rclone.org/jottacloud/)

    Koofr (https://rclone.org/koofr/)

    Mail.ru Cloud (https://rclone.org/mailru/)

    Mega (https://rclone.org/mega/)

    Memory (https://rclone.org/memory/)

    Microsoft Azure Blob Storage (https://rclone.org/azureblob/)

    Microsoft OneDrive (https://rclone.org/onedrive/)

    OpenStack Swift / Rackspace Cloudfiles / Memset Memstore (https://rclone.org/swift/)

    OpenDrive (https://rclone.org/opendrive/)

    Oracle Object Storage (https://rclone.org/oracleobjectstorage/)

    Pcloud (https://rclone.org/pcloud/)

    premiumize.me (https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/)

    put.io (https://rclone.org/putio/)

    QingStor (https://rclone.org/qingstor/)

    Seafile (https://rclone.org/seafile/)

    SFTP (https://rclone.org/sftp/)

    Sia (https://rclone.org/sia/)

    SMB (https://rclone.org/smb/)

    Storj (https://rclone.org/storj/)

    SugarSync (https://rclone.org/sugarsync/)

    Union (https://rclone.org/union/)

    Uptobox (https://rclone.org/uptobox/)

    WebDAV (https://rclone.org/webdav/)

    Yandex Disk (https://rclone.org/yandex/)

    Zoho WorkDrive (https://rclone.org/zoho/)

    The local filesystem (https://rclone.org/local/)

Basic syntax

   Rclone syncs a directory tree from one storage system to another.

   Its syntax is like this

          Syntax: [options] subcommand <parameters> <parameters...>

   Source  and  destination  paths are specified by the name you gave the storage system in the config file then the sub path, e.g.  "drive:myfolder" to look at
   "myfolder" in Google drive.

   You can define as many storage paths as you like in the config file.

   Please use the --interactive/-i flag while learning rclone to avoid accidental data loss.

Subcommands

   rclone uses a system of subcommands.  For example

          rclone ls remote:path # lists a remote
          rclone copy /local/path remote:path # copies /local/path to the remote
          rclone sync --interactive /local/path remote:path # syncs /local/path to the remote

rclone config

   Enter an interactive configuration session.

Synopsis

   Enter an interactive configuration session where you can setup new remotes and manage existing ones.  You may also set or remove a password to  protect  your
   configuration.

          rclone config [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for config

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

    rclone config create (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/) - Create a new remote with name, type and options.

    rclone config delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_delete/) - Delete an existing remote.

    rclone config disconnect (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_disconnect/) - Disconnects user from remote

    rclone config dump (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_dump/) - Dump the config file as JSON.

    rclone config file (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_file/) - Show path of configuration file in use.

    rclone config password (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_password/) - Update password in an existing remote.

    rclone config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) - Show paths used for configuration, cache, temp etc.

    rclone config providers (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_providers/) - List in JSON format all the providers and options.

    rclone config reconnect (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_reconnect/) - Re-authenticates user with remote.

    rclone config show (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_show/) - Print (decrypted) config file, or the config for a single remote.

    rclone config touch (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_touch/) - Ensure configuration file exists.

    rclone config update (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_update/) - Update options in an existing remote.

    rclone config userinfo (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_userinfo/) - Prints info about logged in user of remote.

rclone copy

   Copy files from source to dest, skipping identical files.

Synopsis

   Copy  the  source to the destination.  Does not transfer files that are identical on source and destination, testing by size and modification time or MD5SUM.
   Doesn't delete files from the destination.  If you want to also delete files from destination, to make it match source, use the sync (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_sync/) command instead.

   Note  that  it  is  always  the contents of the directory that is synced, not the directory itself.  So when source:path is a directory, it's the contents of
   source:path that are copied, not the directory name and contents.

   To copy single files, use the copyto (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copyto/) command instead.

   If dest:path doesn't exist, it is created and the source:path contents go there.

   For example

          rclone copy source:sourcepath dest:destpath

   Let's say there are two files in sourcepath

          sourcepath/one.txt
          sourcepath/two.txt

   This copies them to

          destpath/one.txt
          destpath/two.txt

   Not to

          destpath/sourcepath/one.txt
          destpath/sourcepath/two.txt

   If you are familiar with rsync, rclone always works as if you had written a trailing / - meaning "copy the contents of this directory".  This applies to  all
   commands and whether you are talking about the source or destination.

   See  the  --no-traverse  (https://rclone.org/docs/#no-traverse) option for controlling whether rclone lists the destination directory or not.  Supplying this
   option when copying a small number of files into a large destination can speed transfers up greatly.

   For example, if you have many files in /path/to/src but only a few of them change every day, you can copy all the files which have changed recently very  ef
   ficiently like this:

          rclone copy --max-age 24h --no-traverse /path/to/src remote:

   Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

   Note: Use the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag to test without copying anything.

          rclone copy source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

                --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after copy
            -h, --help                    help for copy

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone sync

   Make source and dest identical, modifying destination only.

Synopsis

   Sync  the source to the destination, changing the destination only.  Doesn't transfer files that are identical on source and destination, testing by size and
   modification time or MD5SUM.  Destination is updated to match source, including deleting files if necessary (except duplicate objects, see  below).   If  you
   don't want to delete files from destination, use the copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command instead.

   Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

          rclone sync -i SOURCE remote:DESTINATION

   Note  that  files in the destination won't be deleted if there were any errors at any point.  Duplicate objects (files with the same name, on those providers
   that support it) are also not yet handled.

   It is always the contents of the directory that is synced, not the directory itself.  So when source:path is a directory, it's the  contents  of  source:path
   that are copied, not the directory name and contents.  See extended explanation in the copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command if unsure.

   If dest:path doesn't exist, it is created and the source:path contents go there.

   It  is  not  possible  to  sync  overlapping remotes.  However, you may exclude the destination from the sync with a filter rule or by putting an exclude-if-
   present file inside the destination directory and sync to a destination that is inside the source directory.

   Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics

   Note: Use the rclone dedupe command to deal with  "Duplicate  object/directory  found  in  source/destination  -  ignoring"  errors.   See  this  forum  post
   (https://forum.rclone.org/t/sync-not-clearing-duplicates/14372) for more info.

          rclone sync source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

                --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after sync
            -h, --help                    help for sync

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone move

   Move files from source to dest.

Synopsis

   Moves  the  contents  of  the source directory to the destination directory.  Rclone will error if the source and destination overlap and the remote does not
   support a server-side directory move operation.

   To move single files, use the moveto (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_moveto/) command instead.

   If no filters are in use and if possible this will server-side move source:path into dest:path.  After this source:path will no longer exist.

   Otherwise for each file in source:path selected by the filters (if any) this will move it into dest:path.  If possible a server-side move will be used,  oth
   erwise it will copy it (server-side if possible) into dest:path then delete the original (if no errors on copy) in source:path.

   If you want to delete empty source directories after move, use the --delete-empty-src-dirs flag.

   See  the  --no-traverse  (https://rclone.org/docs/#no-traverse) option for controlling whether rclone lists the destination directory or not.  Supplying this
   option when moving a small number of files into a large destination can speed transfers up greatly.

   Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

   Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

          rclone move source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

                --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after move
                --delete-empty-src-dirs   Delete empty source dirs after move
            -h, --help                    help for move

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone delete

   Remove the files in path.

Synopsis

   Remove the files in path.  Unlike purge (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) it obeys include/exclude filters so can be  used  to  selectively  delete
   files.

   rclone  delete  only  deletes  files  but  leaves  the  directory  structure  alone.  If you want to delete a directory and all of its contents use the purge
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command.

   If you supply the --rmdirs flag, it will remove all empty directories along with it.  You can also use the separate  command  rmdir  (https://rclone.org/com
   mands/rclone_rmdir/) or rmdirs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/) to delete empty directories only.

   For example, to delete all files bigger than 100 MiB, you may first want to check what would be deleted (use either):

          rclone --min-size 100M lsl remote:path
          rclone --dry-run --min-size 100M delete remote:path

   Then proceed with the actual delete:

          rclone --min-size 100M delete remote:path

   That reads "delete everything with a minimum size of 100 MiB", hence delete all files bigger than 100 MiB.

   Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

          rclone delete remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help     help for delete
                --rmdirs   rmdirs removes empty directories but leaves root intact

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone purge

   Remove the path and all of its contents.

Synopsis

   Remove  the  path  and  all  of  its  contents.   Note  that  this  does  not  obey  include/exclude  filters  -  everything will be removed.  Use the delete
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/) command if you want to  selectively  delete  files.   To  delete  empty  directories  only,  use  command  rmdir
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/) or rmdirs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/).

   Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

          rclone purge remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for purge

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone mkdir

   Make the path if it doesn't already exist.

          rclone mkdir remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for mkdir

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rmdir

   Remove the empty directory at path.

Synopsis

   This  removes  empty  directory  given  by  path.   Will  not remove the path if it has any objects in it, not even empty subdirectories.  Use command rmdirs
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/) (or delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/) with option --rmdirs) to do that.

   To delete a path and any objects in it, use purge (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command.

          rclone rmdir remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for rmdir

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone check

   Checks the files in the source and destination match.

Synopsis

   Checks the files in the source and destination match.  It compares sizes and hashes (MD5 or SHA1) and logs a report of files that don't  match.   It  doesn't
   alter the source or destination.

   For  the crypt (https://rclone.org/crypt/) remote there is a dedicated command, cryptcheck (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cryptcheck/), that are able to
   check the checksums of the crypted files.

   If you supply the --size-only flag, it will only compare the sizes not the hashes as well.  Use this for a quick check.

   If you supply the --download flag, it will download the data from both remotes and check them against each other on the fly.  This can be useful for  remotes
   that don't support hashes or if you really want to check all the data.

   If you supply the --checkfile HASH flag with a valid hash name, the source:path must point to a text file in the SUM format.

   If  you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in the source match the files in the destination, not the other way around.  This means that
   extra files in the destination that are not in the source will not be detected.

   The --differ, --missing-on-dst, --missing-on-src, --match and --error flags write paths, one per line, to the file name (or stdout  if  it  is  -)  supplied.
   What  they  write is described in the help below.  For example --differ will write all paths which are present on both the source and destination but differ
   ent.

   The --combined flag will write a file (or stdout) which contains all file paths with a symbol and then a space and then the path to tell you what happened to
   it.  These are reminiscent of diff files.

    = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical

    - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination

    + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source

    * path means path was present in source and destination but different.

    ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.

     rclone check source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

            -C, --checkfile string        Treat source:path as a SUM file with hashes of given type
                --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
                --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
                --download                Check by downloading rather than with hash
                --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
            -h, --help                    help for check
                --match string            Report all matching files to this file
                --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
                --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
                --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone ls

   List the objects in the path with size and path.

Synopsis

   Lists the objects in the source path to standard output in a human readable format with size and path.  Recurses by default.

   Eg

          $ rclone ls swift:bucket
              60295 bevajer5jef
              90613 canole
              94467 diwogej7
              37600 fubuwic

   Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

   There are several related list commands

    ls to list size and path of objects only

    lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

    lsd to list directories only

    lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

    lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

   ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

   Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

   The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

   Listing  a  nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g.  s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based re
   motes).

          rclone ls remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for ls

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsd

   List all directories/containers/buckets in the path.

Synopsis

   Lists the directories in the source path to standard output.  Does not recurse by default.  Use the -R flag to recurse.

   This command lists the total size of the directory (if known, -1 if not), the modification time (if known, the current time if not), the number of objects in
   the directory (if known, -1 if not) and the name of the directory, Eg

          $ rclone lsd swift:
                494000 2018-04-26 08:43:20     10000 10000files
                    65 2018-04-26 08:43:20         1 1File

   Or

          $ rclone lsd drive:test
                    -1 2016-10-17 17:41:53        -1 1000files
                    -1 2017-01-03 14:40:54        -1 2500files
                    -1 2017-07-08 14:39:28        -1 4000files

   If you just want the directory names use rclone lsf --dirs-only.

   Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

   There are several related list commands

    ls to list size and path of objects only

    lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

    lsd to list directories only

    lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

    lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

   ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

   Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

   The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

   Listing  a  nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g.  s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based re
   motes).

          rclone lsd remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help        help for lsd
            -R, --recursive   Recurse into the listing

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsl

   List the objects in path with modification time, size and path.

Synopsis

   Lists the objects in the source path to standard output in a human readable format with modification time, size and path.  Recurses by default.

   Eg

          $ rclone lsl swift:bucket
              60295 2016-06-25 18:55:41.062626927 bevajer5jef
              90613 2016-06-25 18:55:43.302607074 canole
              94467 2016-06-25 18:55:43.046609333 diwogej7
              37600 2016-06-25 18:55:40.814629136 fubuwic

   Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

   There are several related list commands

    ls to list size and path of objects only

    lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

    lsd to list directories only

    lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

    lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

   ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

   Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

   The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

   Listing a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g.  s3, swift, or gcs - the  bucket-based  re
   motes).

          rclone lsl remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for lsl

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone md5sum

   Produces an md5sum file for all the objects in the path.

Synopsis

   Produces an md5sum file for all the objects in the path.  This is in the same format as the standard md5sum tool produces.

   By  default,  the hash is requested from the remote.  If MD5 is not supported by the remote, no hash will be returned.  With the download flag, the file will
   be downloaded from the remote and hashed locally enabling MD5 for any remote.

   For other algorithms, see the hashsum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_hashsum/) command.  Running rclone md5sum  remote:path  is  equivalent  to  running
   rclone hashsum MD5 remote:path.

   This command can also hash data received on standard input (stdin), by not passing a remote:path, or by passing a hyphen as remote:path when there is data to
   read (if not, the hyphen will be treated literally, as a relative path).

          rclone md5sum remote:path [flags]

Options

                --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
            -C, --checkfile string     Validate hashes against a given SUM file instead of printing them
                --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
            -h, --help                 help for md5sum
                --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone sha1sum

   Produces an sha1sum file for all the objects in the path.

Synopsis

   Produces an sha1sum file for all the objects in the path.  This is in the same format as the standard sha1sum tool produces.

   By default, the hash is requested from the remote.  If SHA-1 is not supported by the remote, no hash will be returned.  With the download flag, the file will
   be downloaded from the remote and hashed locally enabling SHA-1 for any remote.

   For  other  algorithms,  see  the hashsum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_hashsum/) command.  Running rclone sha1sum remote:path is equivalent to running
   rclone hashsum SHA1 remote:path.

   This command can also hash data received on standard input (stdin), by not passing a remote:path, or by passing a hyphen as remote:path when there is data to
   read (if not, the hyphen will be treated literally, as a relative path).

   This command can also hash data received on STDIN, if not passing a remote:path.

          rclone sha1sum remote:path [flags]

Options

                --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
            -C, --checkfile string     Validate hashes against a given SUM file instead of printing them
                --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
            -h, --help                 help for sha1sum
                --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone size

   Prints the total size and number of objects in remote:path.

Synopsis

   Counts objects in the path and calculates the total size.  Prints the result to standard output.

   By  default the output is in human-readable format, but shows values in both human-readable format as well as the raw numbers (global option --human-readable
   is not considered).  Use option --json to format output as JSON instead.

   Recurses by default, use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

   Some  backends  do  not  always  provide  file  sizes,  see  for   example   Google   Photos   (https://rclone.org/googlephotos/#size)   and   Google   Drive
   (https://rclone.org/drive/#limitations-of-google-docs).  Rclone will then show a notice in the log indicating how many such files were encountered, and count
   them in as empty files in the output of the size command.

          rclone size remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for size
                --json   Format output as JSON

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone version

   Show the version number.

Synopsis

   Show the rclone version number, the go version, the build target OS and architecture, the runtime OS and kernel version and bitness, build tags and the  type
   of executable (static or dynamic).

   For example:

          $ rclone version
          rclone v1.55.0
          - os/version: ubuntu 18.04 (64 bit)
          - os/kernel: 4.15.0-136-generic (x86_64)
          - os/type: linux
          - os/arch: amd64
          - go/version: go1.16
          - go/linking: static
          - go/tags: none

   Note: before rclone version 1.55 the os/type and os/arch lines were merged, and the "go/version" line was tagged as "go version".

   If you supply the --check flag, then it will do an online check to compare your version with the latest release and the latest beta.

          $ rclone version --check
          yours:  1.42.0.6
          latest: 1.42          (released 2018-06-16)
          beta:   1.42.0.5      (released 2018-06-17)

   Or

          $ rclone version --check
          yours:  1.41
          latest: 1.42          (released 2018-06-16)
            upgrade: https://downloads.rclone.org/v1.42
          beta:   1.42.0.5      (released 2018-06-17)
            upgrade: https://beta.rclone.org/v1.42-005-g56e1e820

          rclone version [flags]

Options

                --check   Check for new version
            -h, --help    help for version

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cleanup

   Clean up the remote if possible.

Synopsis

   Clean up the remote if possible.  Empty the trash or delete old file versions.  Not supported by all remotes.

          rclone cleanup remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for cleanup

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone dedupe

   Interactively find duplicate filenames and delete/rename them.

Synopsis

   By  default dedupe interactively finds files with duplicate names and offers to delete all but one or rename them to be different.  This is known as deduping
   by name.

   Deduping by name is only useful with a small group of backends (e.g.  Google Drive, Opendrive) that can have duplicate file names.  It can be run on wrapping
   backends (e.g.  crypt) if they wrap a backend which supports duplicate file names.

   However  if --by-hash is passed in then dedupe will find files with duplicate hashes instead which will work on any backend which supports at least one hash.
   This can be used to find files with duplicate content.  This is known as deduping by hash.

   If deduping by name, first rclone will merge directories with the same name.  It will do this iteratively until all the identically  named  directories  have
   been merged.

   Next,  if  deduping by name, for every group of duplicate file names / hashes, it will delete all but one identical file it finds without confirmation.  This
   means that for most duplicated files the dedupe command will not be interactive.

   dedupe considers files to be identical if they have the same file path and the same hash.  If the backend does  not  support  hashes  (e.g.   crypt  wrapping
   Google  Drive)  then they will never be found to be identical.  If you use the --size-only flag then files will be considered identical if they have the same
   size (any hash will be ignored).  This can be useful on crypt backends which do not support hashes.

   Next rclone will resolve the remaining duplicates.  Exactly which action is taken depends on the dedupe mode.  By default, rclone  will  interactively  query
   the user for each one.

   Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

   Here is an example run.

   Before - with duplicates

          $ rclone lsl drive:dupes
            6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000 one.txt
            6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:11.775000000 one.txt
             564374 2016-03-05 16:23:06.731000000 one.txt
            6048320 2016-03-05 16:18:26.092000000 one.txt
            6048320 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000 two.txt
            1744073 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000 two.txt
             564374 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000 two.txt

   Now the dedupe session

          $ rclone dedupe drive:dupes
          2016/03/05 16:24:37 Google drive root 'dupes': Looking for duplicates using interactive mode.
          one.txt: Found 4 files with duplicate names
          one.txt: Deleting 2/3 identical duplicates (MD5 "1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36")
          one.txt: 2 duplicates remain
            1:      6048320 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000, MD5 1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36
            2:       564374 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:23:06.731000000, MD5 7594e7dc9fc28f727c42ee3e0749de81
          s) Skip and do nothing
          k) Keep just one (choose which in next step)
          r) Rename all to be different (by changing file.jpg to file-1.jpg)
          s/k/r> k
          Enter the number of the file to keep> 1
          one.txt: Deleted 1 extra copies
          two.txt: Found 3 files with duplicate names
          two.txt: 3 duplicates remain
            1:       564374 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000, MD5 7594e7dc9fc28f727c42ee3e0749de81
            2:      6048320 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000, MD5 1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36
            3:      1744073 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000, MD5 851957f7fb6f0bc4ce76be966d336802
          s) Skip and do nothing
          k) Keep just one (choose which in next step)
          r) Rename all to be different (by changing file.jpg to file-1.jpg)
          s/k/r> r
          two-1.txt: renamed from: two.txt
          two-2.txt: renamed from: two.txt
          two-3.txt: renamed from: two.txt

   The result being

          $ rclone lsl drive:dupes
            6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000 one.txt
             564374 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000 two-1.txt
            6048320 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000 two-2.txt
            1744073 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000 two-3.txt

   Dedupe can be run non interactively using the --dedupe-mode flag or by using an extra parameter with the same value

    --dedupe-mode interactive - interactive as above.

    --dedupe-mode skip - removes identical files then skips anything left.

    --dedupe-mode first - removes identical files then keeps the first one.

    --dedupe-mode newest - removes identical files then keeps the newest one.

    --dedupe-mode oldest - removes identical files then keeps the oldest one.

    --dedupe-mode largest - removes identical files then keeps the largest one.

    --dedupe-mode smallest - removes identical files then keeps the smallest one.

    --dedupe-mode rename - removes identical files then renames the rest to be different.

    --dedupe-mode list - lists duplicate dirs and files only and changes nothing.

   For example, to rename all the identically named photos in your Google Photos directory, do

          rclone dedupe --dedupe-mode rename "drive:Google Photos"

   Or

          rclone dedupe rename "drive:Google Photos"

          rclone dedupe [mode] remote:path [flags]

Options

                --by-hash              Find identical hashes rather than names
                --dedupe-mode string   Dedupe mode interactive|skip|first|newest|oldest|largest|smallest|rename (default "interactive")
            -h, --help                 help for dedupe

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone about

   Get quota information from the remote.

Synopsis

   rclone about prints quota information about a remote to standard output.  The output is typically used, free, quota and trash contents.

   E.g.  Typical output from rclone about remote: is:

          Total:   17 GiB
          Used:    7.444 GiB
          Free:    1.315 GiB
          Trashed: 100.000 MiB
          Other:   8.241 GiB

   Where the fields are:

    Total: Total size available.

    Used: Total size used.

    Free: Total space available to this user.

    Trashed: Total space used by trash.

    Other: Total amount in other storage (e.g.  Gmail, Google Photos).

    Objects: Total number of objects in the storage.

   All sizes are in number of bytes.

   Applying a --full flag to the command prints the bytes in full, e.g.

          Total:   18253611008
          Used:    7993453766
          Free:    1411001220
          Trashed: 104857602
          Other:   8849156022

   A --json flag generates conveniently machine-readable output, e.g.

          {
              "total": 18253611008,
              "used": 7993453766,
              "trashed": 104857602,
              "other": 8849156022,
              "free": 1411001220
          }

   Not all backends print all fields.  Information is not included if it is not provided by a backend.  Where the value is unlimited it is omitted.

   Some backends does not support the rclone about command at all, see complete list in documentation (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features).

          rclone about remote: [flags]

Options

                --full   Full numbers instead of human-readable
            -h, --help   help for about
                --json   Format output as JSON

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone authorize

   Remote authorization.

Synopsis

   Remote authorization.  Used to authorize a remote or headless rclone from a machine with a browser - use as instructed by rclone config.

   Use the --auth-no-open-browser to prevent rclone to open auth link in default browser automatically.

          rclone authorize [flags]

Options

                --auth-no-open-browser   Do not automatically open auth link in default browser
            -h, --help                   help for authorize

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone backend

   Run a backend-specific command.

Synopsis

   This  runs a backend-specific command.  The commands themselves (except for "help" and "features") are defined by the backends and you should see the backend
   docs for definitions.

   You can discover what commands a backend implements by using

          rclone backend help remote:
          rclone backend help <backendname>

   You can also discover information about the backend using (see operations/fsinfo (https://rclone.org/rc/#operations-fsinfo) in the remote  control  docs  for
   more info).

          rclone backend features remote:

   Pass options to the backend command with -o.  This should be key=value or key, e.g.:

          rclone backend stats remote:path stats -o format=json -o long

   Pass arguments to the backend by placing them on the end of the line

          rclone backend cleanup remote:path file1 file2 file3

   Note to run these commands on a running backend then see backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command) in the rc docs.

          rclone backend <command> remote:path [opts] <args> [flags]

Options

            -h, --help                 help for backend
                --json                 Always output in JSON format
            -o, --option stringArray   Option in the form name=value or name

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone bisync

   Perform bidirectional synchronization between two paths.

Synopsis

   Perform bidirectional synchronization between two paths.

   Bisync (https://rclone.org/bisync/) provides a bidirectional cloud sync solution in rclone.  It retains the Path1 and Path2 filesystem listings from the pri
   or run.  On each successive run it will: - list files on Path1 and Path2, and check for changes on each side.  Changes include New, Newer, Older, and Deleted
   files.  - Propagate changes on Path1 to Path2, and vice-versa.

   See full bisync description (https://rclone.org/bisync/) for details.

          rclone bisync remote1:path1 remote2:path2 [flags]

Options

                --check-access            Ensure expected RCLONE_TEST files are found on both Path1 and Path2 filesystems, else abort.
                --check-filename string   Filename for --check-access (default: RCLONE_TEST)
                --check-sync string       Controls comparison of final listings: true|false|only (default: true) (default "true")
                --filters-file string     Read filtering patterns from a file
                --force                   Bypass --max-delete safety check and run the sync. Consider using with --verbose
            -h, --help                    help for bisync
                --localtime               Use local time in listings (default: UTC)
                --no-cleanup              Retain working files (useful for troubleshooting and testing).
                --remove-empty-dirs       Remove empty directories at the final cleanup step.
            -1, --resync                  Performs the resync run. Path1 files may overwrite Path2 versions. Consider using --verbose or --dry-run first.
                --workdir string          Use custom working dir - useful for testing. (default: $HOME/.cache/rclone/bisync)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cat

   Concatenates any files and sends them to stdout.

Synopsis

   rclone cat sends any files to standard output.

   You can use it like this to output a single file

          rclone cat remote:path/to/file

   Or like this to output any file in dir or its subdirectories.

          rclone cat remote:path/to/dir

   Or like this to output any .txt files in dir or its subdirectories.

          rclone --include "*.txt" cat remote:path/to/dir

   Use the --head flag to print characters only at the start, --tail for the end and --offset and --count to print a section in the middle.  Note that if offset
   is negative it will count from the end, so --offset -1 --count 1 is equivalent to --tail 1.

          rclone cat remote:path [flags]

Options

                --count int    Only print N characters (default -1)
                --discard      Discard the output instead of printing
                --head int     Only print the first N characters
            -h, --help         help for cat
                --offset int   Start printing at offset N (or from end if -ve)
                --tail int     Only print the last N characters

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone checksum

   Checks the files in the source against a SUM file.

Synopsis

   Checks that hashsums of source files match the SUM file.  It compares hashes (MD5, SHA1, etc) and logs a report of files which don't match.  It doesn't alter
   the file system.

   If  you  supply  the  --download flag, it will download the data from remote and calculate the contents hash on the fly.  This can be useful for remotes that
   don't support hashes or if you really want to check all the data.

   Note that hash values in the SUM file are treated as case insensitive.

   If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in the source match the files in the destination, not the other way around.  This means  that
   extra files in the destination that are not in the source will not be detected.

   The  --differ,  --missing-on-dst,  --missing-on-src,  --match  and --error flags write paths, one per line, to the file name (or stdout if it is -) supplied.
   What they write is described in the help below.  For example --differ will write all paths which are present on both the source and destination  but  differ
   ent.

   The --combined flag will write a file (or stdout) which contains all file paths with a symbol and then a space and then the path to tell you what happened to
   it.  These are reminiscent of diff files.

    = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical

    - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination

    + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source

    * path means path was present in source and destination but different.

    ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.

     rclone checksum <hash> sumfile src:path [flags]

Options

                --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
                --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
                --download                Check by hashing the contents
                --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
            -h, --help                    help for checksum
                --match string            Report all matching files to this file
                --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
                --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
                --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone completion

   Generate the autocompletion script for the specified shell

Synopsis

   Generate the autocompletion script for rclone for the specified shell.  See each sub-command's help for details on how to use the generated script.

Options

            -h, --help   help for completion

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

    rclone completion bash (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_bash/) - Generate the autocompletion script for bash

    rclone completion fish (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_fish/) - Generate the autocompletion script for fish

    rclone completion powershell (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_powershell/) - Generate the autocompletion script for powershell

    rclone completion zsh (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_zsh/) - Generate the autocompletion script for zsh

rclone completion bash

   Generate the autocompletion script for bash

Synopsis

   Generate the autocompletion script for the bash shell.

   This script depends on the 'bash-completion' package.  If it is not installed already, you can install it via your OS's package manager.

   To load completions in your current shell session:

          source <(rclone completion bash)

   To load completions for every new session, execute once:

Linux:

          rclone completion bash > /etc/bash_completion.d/rclone

macOS:

          rclone completion bash > $(brew --prefix)/etc/bash_completion.d/rclone

   You will need to start a new shell for this setup to take effect.

          rclone completion bash

Options

            -h, --help              help for bash
                --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone completion (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/) - Generate the autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone completion fish

   Generate the autocompletion script for fish

Synopsis

   Generate the autocompletion script for the fish shell.

   To load completions in your current shell session:

          rclone completion fish | source

   To load completions for every new session, execute once:

          rclone completion fish > ~/.config/fish/completions/rclone.fish

   You will need to start a new shell for this setup to take effect.

          rclone completion fish [flags]

Options

            -h, --help              help for fish
                --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone completion (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/) - Generate the autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone completion powershell

   Generate the autocompletion script for powershell

Synopsis

   Generate the autocompletion script for powershell.

   To load completions in your current shell session:

          rclone completion powershell | Out-String | Invoke-Expression

   To load completions for every new session, add the output of the above command to your powershell profile.

          rclone completion powershell [flags]

Options

            -h, --help              help for powershell
                --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone completion (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/) - Generate the autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone completion zsh

   Generate the autocompletion script for zsh

Synopsis

   Generate the autocompletion script for the zsh shell.

   If shell completion is not already enabled in your environment you will need to enable it.  You can execute the following once:

          echo "autoload -U compinit; compinit" >> ~/.zshrc

   To load completions in your current shell session:

          source <(rclone completion zsh); compdef _rclone rclone

   To load completions for every new session, execute once:

Linux:

          rclone completion zsh > "${fpath[1]}/_rclone"

macOS:

          rclone completion zsh > $(brew --prefix)/share/zsh/site-functions/_rclone

   You will need to start a new shell for this setup to take effect.

          rclone completion zsh [flags]

Options

            -h, --help              help for zsh
                --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone completion (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/) - Generate the autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone config create

   Create a new remote with name, type and options.

Synopsis

   Create a new remote of name with type and options.  The options should be passed in pairs of key value or as key=value.

   For example, to make a swift remote of name myremote using auto config you would do:

          rclone config create myremote swift env_auth true
          rclone config create myremote swift env_auth=true

   So for example if you wanted to configure a Google Drive remote but using remote authorization you would do this:

          rclone config create mydrive drive config_is_local=false

   Note that if the config process would normally ask a question the default is taken (unless --non-interactive is used).  Each time that  happens  rclone  will
   print or DEBUG a message saying how to affect the value taken.

   If  any  of the parameters passed is a password field, then rclone will automatically obscure them if they aren't already obscured before putting them in the
   config file.

   NB If the password parameter is 22 characters or longer and consists only of base64 characters then rclone can get confused about whether the password is al‐
   ready  obscured  or not and put unobscured passwords into the config file.  If you want to be 100% certain that the passwords get obscured then use the --ob‐
   scure flag, or if you are 100% certain you are already passing obscured passwords then use --no-obscure.  You can  also  set  obscured  passwords  using  the
   rclone config password command.

   The  flag  --non-interactive  is  for use by applications that wish to configure rclone themselves, rather than using rclone's text based configuration ques
   tions.  If this flag is set, and rclone needs to ask the user a question, a JSON blob will be returned with the question in it.

   This will look something like (some irrelevant detail removed):

          {
              "State": "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,,",
              "Option": {
                  "Name": "config_is_local",
                  "Help": "Use auto config?\n * Say Y if not sure\n * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine\n",
                  "Default": true,
                  "Examples": [
                      {
                          "Value": "true",
                          "Help": "Yes"
                      },
                      {
                          "Value": "false",
                          "Help": "No"
                      }
                  ],
                  "Required": false,
                  "IsPassword": false,
                  "Type": "bool",
                  "Exclusive": true,
              },
              "Error": "",
          }

   The format of Option is the same as returned by rclone config providers.  The question should be asked to the user and returned to rclone as the --result op
   tion along with the --state parameter.

   The keys of Option are used as follows:

    Name - name of variable - show to user

    Help - help text.  Hard wrapped at 80 chars.  Any URLs should be clicky.

    Default - default value - return this if the user just wants the default.

    Examples - the user should be able to choose one of these

    Required - the value should be non-empty

    IsPassword - the value is a password and should be edited as such

    Type - type of value, eg bool, string, int and others

    Exclusive - if set no free-form entry allowed only the Examples

    Irrelevant keys Provider, ShortOpt, Hide, NoPrefix, Advanced

   If Error is set then it should be shown to the user at the same time as the question.

          rclone config update name --continue --state "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,," --result "true"

   Note  that when using --continue all passwords should be passed in the clear (not obscured).  Any default config values should be passed in with each invoca
   tion of --continue.

   At the end of the non interactive process, rclone will return a result with State as empty string.

   If --all is passed then rclone will ask all the config questions, not just the post config questions.  Any parameters are used as defaults for  questions  as
   usual.

   Note that bin/config.py in the rclone source implements this protocol as a readable demonstration.

          rclone config create name type [key value]* [flags]

Options

                --all               Ask the full set of config questions
                --continue          Continue the configuration process with an answer
            -h, --help              help for create
                --no-obscure        Force any passwords not to be obscured
                --non-interactive   Don't interact with user and return questions
                --obscure           Force any passwords to be obscured
                --result string     Result - use with --continue
                --state string      State - use with --continue

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config delete

   Delete an existing remote.

          rclone config delete name [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for delete

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config disconnect

   Disconnects user from remote

Synopsis

   This disconnects the remote: passed in to the cloud storage system.

   This normally means revoking the oauth token.

   To reconnect use "rclone config reconnect".

          rclone config disconnect remote: [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for disconnect

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config dump

   Dump the config file as JSON.

          rclone config dump [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for dump

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config edit

   Enter an interactive configuration session.

Synopsis

   Enter  an  interactive configuration session where you can setup new remotes and manage existing ones.  You may also set or remove a password to protect your
   configuration.

          rclone config edit [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for edit

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config file

   Show path of configuration file in use.

          rclone config file [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for file

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config password

   Update password in an existing remote.

Synopsis

   Update an existing remote's password.  The password should be passed in pairs of key password or as key=password.  The password should be passed in in  clear
   (unobscured).

   For example, to set password of a remote of name myremote you would do:

          rclone config password myremote fieldname mypassword
          rclone config password myremote fieldname=mypassword

   This command is obsolete now that "config update" and "config create" both support obscuring passwords directly.

          rclone config password name [key value]+ [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for password

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config paths

   Show paths used for configuration, cache, temp etc.

          rclone config paths [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for paths

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config providers

   List in JSON format all the providers and options.

          rclone config providers [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for providers

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config reconnect

   Re-authenticates user with remote.

Synopsis

   This reconnects remote: passed in to the cloud storage system.

   To disconnect the remote use "rclone config disconnect".

   This normally means going through the interactive oauth flow again.

          rclone config reconnect remote: [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for reconnect

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config show

   Print (decrypted) config file, or the config for a single remote.

          rclone config show [<remote>] [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for show

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config touch

   Ensure configuration file exists.

          rclone config touch [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for touch

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config update

   Update options in an existing remote.

Synopsis

   Update an existing remote's options.  The options should be passed in pairs of key value or as key=value.

   For example, to update the env_auth field of a remote of name myremote you would do:

          rclone config update myremote env_auth true
          rclone config update myremote env_auth=true

   If the remote uses OAuth the token will be updated, if you don't require this add an extra parameter thus:

          rclone config update myremote env_auth=true config_refresh_token=false

   Note  that  if  the config process would normally ask a question the default is taken (unless --non-interactive is used).  Each time that happens rclone will
   print or DEBUG a message saying how to affect the value taken.

   If any of the parameters passed is a password field, then rclone will automatically obscure them if they aren't already obscured before putting them  in  the
   config file.

   NB If the password parameter is 22 characters or longer and consists only of base64 characters then rclone can get confused about whether the password is al‐
   ready obscured or not and put unobscured passwords into the config file.  If you want to be 100% certain that the passwords get obscured then use  the  --ob‐
   scure  flag,  or  if  you  are  100% certain you are already passing obscured passwords then use --no-obscure.  You can also set obscured passwords using the
   rclone config password command.

   The flag --non-interactive is for use by applications that wish to configure rclone themselves, rather than using rclone's  text  based  configuration  ques
   tions.  If this flag is set, and rclone needs to ask the user a question, a JSON blob will be returned with the question in it.

   This will look something like (some irrelevant detail removed):

          {
              "State": "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,,",
              "Option": {
                  "Name": "config_is_local",
                  "Help": "Use auto config?\n * Say Y if not sure\n * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine\n",
                  "Default": true,
                  "Examples": [
                      {
                          "Value": "true",
                          "Help": "Yes"
                      },
                      {
                          "Value": "false",
                          "Help": "No"
                      }
                  ],
                  "Required": false,
                  "IsPassword": false,
                  "Type": "bool",
                  "Exclusive": true,
              },
              "Error": "",
          }

   The format of Option is the same as returned by rclone config providers.  The question should be asked to the user and returned to rclone as the --result op
   tion along with the --state parameter.

   The keys of Option are used as follows:

    Name - name of variable - show to user

    Help - help text.  Hard wrapped at 80 chars.  Any URLs should be clicky.

    Default - default value - return this if the user just wants the default.

    Examples - the user should be able to choose one of these

    Required - the value should be non-empty

    IsPassword - the value is a password and should be edited as such

    Type - type of value, eg bool, string, int and others

    Exclusive - if set no free-form entry allowed only the Examples

    Irrelevant keys Provider, ShortOpt, Hide, NoPrefix, Advanced

   If Error is set then it should be shown to the user at the same time as the question.

          rclone config update name --continue --state "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,," --result "true"

   Note that when using --continue all passwords should be passed in the clear (not obscured).  Any default config values should be passed in with each  invoca
   tion of --continue.

   At the end of the non interactive process, rclone will return a result with State as empty string.

   If  --all  is passed then rclone will ask all the config questions, not just the post config questions.  Any parameters are used as defaults for questions as
   usual.

   Note that bin/config.py in the rclone source implements this protocol as a readable demonstration.

          rclone config update name [key value]+ [flags]

Options

                --all               Ask the full set of config questions
                --continue          Continue the configuration process with an answer
            -h, --help              help for update
                --no-obscure        Force any passwords not to be obscured
                --non-interactive   Don't interact with user and return questions
                --obscure           Force any passwords to be obscured
                --result string     Result - use with --continue
                --state string      State - use with --continue

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone config userinfo

   Prints info about logged in user of remote.

Synopsis

   This prints the details of the person logged in to the cloud storage system.

          rclone config userinfo remote: [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for userinfo
                --json   Format output as JSON

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) - Enter an interactive configuration session.

rclone copyto

   Copy files from source to dest, skipping identical files.

Synopsis

   If source:path is a file or directory then it copies it to a file or directory named dest:path.

   This can be used to upload single files  to  other  than  their  current  name.   If  the  source  is  a  directory  then  it  acts  exactly  like  the  copy
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command.

   So

          rclone copyto src dst

   where src and dst are rclone paths, either remote:path or /path/to/local or C:.

   This will:

          if src is file
              copy it to dst, overwriting an existing file if it exists
          if src is directory
              copy it to dst, overwriting existing files if they exist
              see copy command for full details

   This  doesn't  transfer  files that are identical on src and dst, testing by size and modification time or MD5SUM.  It doesn't delete files from the destina
   tion.

   Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics

          rclone copyto source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for copyto

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone copyurl

   Copy url content to dest.

Synopsis

   Download a URL's content and copy it to the destination without saving it in temporary storage.

   Setting --auto-filename will attempt to automatically determine the filename from the URL (after any redirections) and used in the  destination  path.   With
   --auto-filename-header  in  addition, if a specific filename is set in HTTP headers, it will be used instead of the name from the URL.  With --print-filename
   in addition, the resulting file name will be printed.

   Setting --no-clobber will prevent overwriting file on the destination if there is one with the same name.

   Setting --stdout or making the output file name - will cause the output to be written to standard output.

          rclone copyurl https://example.com dest:path [flags]

Options

            -a, --auto-filename     Get the file name from the URL and use it for destination file path
                --header-filename   Get the file name from the Content-Disposition header
            -h, --help              help for copyurl
                --no-clobber        Prevent overwriting file with same name
            -p, --print-filename    Print the resulting name from --auto-filename
                --stdout            Write the output to stdout rather than a file

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cryptcheck

   Cryptcheck checks the integrity of a crypted remote.

Synopsis

   rclone  cryptcheck  checks  a  remote  against  a  crypted  (https://rclone.org/crypt/)  remote.   This  is  the   equivalent   of   running   rclone   check
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_check/), but able to check the checksums of the crypted remote.

   For it to work the underlying remote of the cryptedremote must support some kind of checksum.

   It  works  by  reading the nonce from each file on the cryptedremote: and using that to encrypt each file on the remote:.  It then checks the checksum of the
   underlying file on the cryptedremote: against the checksum of the file it has just encrypted.

   Use it like this

          rclone cryptcheck /path/to/files encryptedremote:path

   You can use it like this also, but that will involve downloading all the files in remote:path.

          rclone cryptcheck remote:path encryptedremote:path

   After it has run it will log the status of the encryptedremote:.

   If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in the source match the files in the destination, not the other way around.  This means  that
   extra files in the destination that are not in the source will not be detected.

   The  --differ,  --missing-on-dst,  --missing-on-src,  --match  and --error flags write paths, one per line, to the file name (or stdout if it is -) supplied.
   What they write is described in the help below.  For example --differ will write all paths which are present on both the source and destination  but  differ
   ent.

   The --combined flag will write a file (or stdout) which contains all file paths with a symbol and then a space and then the path to tell you what happened to
   it.  These are reminiscent of diff files.

    = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical

    - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination

    + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source

    * path means path was present in source and destination but different.

    ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.

     rclone cryptcheck remote:path cryptedremote:path [flags]

Options

                --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
                --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
                --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
            -h, --help                    help for cryptcheck
                --match string            Report all matching files to this file
                --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
                --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
                --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cryptdecode

   Cryptdecode returns unencrypted file names.

Synopsis

   rclone cryptdecode returns unencrypted file names when provided with a list of encrypted file names.  List limit is 10 items.

   If you supply the --reverse flag, it will return encrypted file names.

   use it like this

          rclone cryptdecode encryptedremote: encryptedfilename1 encryptedfilename2

          rclone cryptdecode --reverse encryptedremote: filename1 filename2

   Another way to accomplish this is by using the rclone backend encode (or decode) command.  See the documentation  on  the  crypt  (https://rclone.org/crypt/)
   overlay for more info.

          rclone cryptdecode encryptedremote: encryptedfilename [flags]

Options

            -h, --help      help for cryptdecode
                --reverse   Reverse cryptdecode, encrypts filenames

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone deletefile

   Remove a single file from remote.

Synopsis

   Remove  a single file from remote.  Unlike delete it cannot be used to remove a directory and it doesn't obey include/exclude filters - if the specified file
   exists, it will always be removed.

          rclone deletefile remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for deletefile

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone genautocomplete

   Output completion script for a given shell.

Synopsis

   Generates a shell completion script for rclone.  Run with --help to list the supported shells.

Options

            -h, --help   help for genautocomplete

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

    rclone genautocomplete bash (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete_bash/) - Output bash completion script for rclone.

    rclone genautocomplete fish (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete_fish/) - Output fish completion script for rclone.

    rclone genautocomplete zsh (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete_zsh/) - Output zsh completion script for rclone.

rclone genautocomplete bash

   Output bash completion script for rclone.

Synopsis

   Generates a bash shell autocompletion script for rclone.

   This writes to /etc/bash_completion.d/rclone by default so will probably need to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

          sudo rclone genautocomplete bash

   Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source them directly

          . /etc/bash_completion

   If you supply a command line argument the script will be written there.

   If output_file is "-", then the output will be written to stdout.

          rclone genautocomplete bash [output_file] [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for bash

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone genautocomplete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete/) - Output completion script for a given shell.

rclone genautocomplete fish

   Output fish completion script for rclone.

Synopsis

   Generates a fish autocompletion script for rclone.

   This writes to /etc/fish/completions/rclone.fish by default so will probably need to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

          sudo rclone genautocomplete fish

   Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source them directly

          . /etc/fish/completions/rclone.fish

   If you supply a command line argument the script will be written there.

   If output_file is "-", then the output will be written to stdout.

          rclone genautocomplete fish [output_file] [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for fish

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone genautocomplete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete/) - Output completion script for a given shell.

rclone genautocomplete zsh

   Output zsh completion script for rclone.

Synopsis

   Generates a zsh autocompletion script for rclone.

   This writes to /usr/share/zsh/vendor-completions/_rclone by default so will probably need to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

          sudo rclone genautocomplete zsh

   Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source them directly

          autoload -U compinit && compinit

   If you supply a command line argument the script will be written there.

   If output_file is "-", then the output will be written to stdout.

          rclone genautocomplete zsh [output_file] [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for zsh

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone genautocomplete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete/) - Output completion script for a given shell.

rclone gendocs

   Output markdown docs for rclone to the directory supplied.

Synopsis

   This produces markdown docs for the rclone commands to the directory supplied.  These are in a format suitable for hugo to render into  the  rclone.org  web
   site.

          rclone gendocs output_directory [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for gendocs

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone hashsum

   Produces a hashsum file for all the objects in the path.

Synopsis

   Produces a hash file for all the objects in the path using the hash named.  The output is in the same format as the standard md5sum/sha1sum tool.

   By  default,  the hash is requested from the remote.  If the hash is not supported by the remote, no hash will be returned.  With the download flag, the file
   will be downloaded from the remote and hashed locally enabling any hash for any remote.

   For the MD5 and SHA1 algorithms there are also dedicated commands, md5sum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_md5sum/) and  sha1sum  (https://rclone.org/com
   mands/rclone_sha1sum/).

   This command can also hash data received on standard input (stdin), by not passing a remote:path, or by passing a hyphen as remote:path when there is data to
   read (if not, the hyphen will be treated literally, as a relative path).

   Run without a hash to see the list of all supported hashes, e.g.

          $ rclone hashsum
          Supported hashes are:
            * md5
            * sha1
            * whirlpool
            * crc32
            * sha256
            * dropbox
            * hidrive
            * mailru
            * quickxor

   Then

          $ rclone hashsum MD5 remote:path

   Note that hash names are case insensitive and values are output in lower case.

          rclone hashsum <hash> remote:path [flags]

Options

                --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
            -C, --checkfile string     Validate hashes against a given SUM file instead of printing them
                --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
            -h, --help                 help for hashsum
                --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone link

   Generate public link to file/folder.

Synopsis

   rclone link will create, retrieve or remove a public link to the given file or folder.

          rclone link remote:path/to/file
          rclone link remote:path/to/folder/
          rclone link --unlink remote:path/to/folder/
          rclone link --expire 1d remote:path/to/file

   If you supply the --expire flag, it will set the expiration time otherwise it will use the default (100 years).  Note not all backends support  the  --expire
   flag - if the backend doesn't support it then the link returned won't expire.

   Use  the --unlink flag to remove existing public links to the file or folder.  Note not all backends support "--unlink" flag - those that don't will just ig
   nore it.

   If successful, the last line of the output will contain the link.  Exact capabilities depend on the remote, but the link will always by  default  be  created
   with the least constraints  e.g.  no expiry, no password protection, accessible without account.

          rclone link remote:path [flags]

Options

                --expire Duration   The amount of time that the link will be valid (default off)
            -h, --help              help for link
                --unlink            Remove existing public link to file/folder

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone listremotes

   List all the remotes in the config file.

Synopsis

   rclone listremotes lists all the available remotes from the config file.

   When used with the --long flag it lists the types too.

          rclone listremotes [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for listremotes
                --long   Show the type as well as names

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsf

   List directories and objects in remote:path formatted for parsing.

Synopsis

   List  the contents of the source path (directories and objects) to standard output in a form which is easy to parse by scripts.  By default this will just be
   the names of the objects and directories, one per line.  The directories will have a / suffix.

   Eg

          $ rclone lsf swift:bucket
          bevajer5jef
          canole
          diwogej7
          ferejej3gux/
          fubuwic

   Use the --format option to control what gets listed.  By default this is just the path, but you can use these parameters to control the output:

          p - path
          s - size
          t - modification time
          h - hash
          i - ID of object
          o - Original ID of underlying object
          m - MimeType of object if known
          e - encrypted name
          T - tier of storage if known, e.g. "Hot" or "Cool"
          M - Metadata of object in JSON blob format, eg {"key":"value"}

   So if you wanted the path, size and modification time, you would use --format "pst", or maybe --format "tsp" to put the path last.

   Eg

          $ rclone lsf  --format "tsp" swift:bucket
          2016-06-25 18:55:41;60295;bevajer5jef
          2016-06-25 18:55:43;90613;canole
          2016-06-25 18:55:43;94467;diwogej7
          2018-04-26 08:50:45;0;ferejej3gux/
          2016-06-25 18:55:40;37600;fubuwic

   If you specify "h" in the format you will get the MD5 hash by default, use the --hash flag to change which hash you want.  Note that this can be returned  as
   an empty string if it isn't available on the object (and for directories), "ERROR" if there was an error reading it from the object and "UNSUPPORTED" if that
   object does not support that hash type.

   For example, to emulate the md5sum command you can use

          rclone lsf -R --hash MD5 --format hp --separator "  " --files-only .

   Eg

          $ rclone lsf -R --hash MD5 --format hp --separator "  " --files-only swift:bucket
          7908e352297f0f530b84a756f188baa3  bevajer5jef
          cd65ac234e6fea5925974a51cdd865cc  canole
          03b5341b4f234b9d984d03ad076bae91  diwogej7
          8fd37c3810dd660778137ac3a66cc06d  fubuwic
          99713e14a4c4ff553acaf1930fad985b  gixacuh7ku

   (Though "rclone md5sum ." is an easier way of typing this.)

   By default the separator is ";" this can be changed with the --separator flag.  Note that separators aren't escaped in the path so putting it last is a  good
   strategy.

   Eg

          $ rclone lsf  --separator "," --format "tshp" swift:bucket
          2016-06-25 18:55:41,60295,7908e352297f0f530b84a756f188baa3,bevajer5jef
          2016-06-25 18:55:43,90613,cd65ac234e6fea5925974a51cdd865cc,canole
          2016-06-25 18:55:43,94467,03b5341b4f234b9d984d03ad076bae91,diwogej7
          2018-04-26 08:52:53,0,,ferejej3gux/
          2016-06-25 18:55:40,37600,8fd37c3810dd660778137ac3a66cc06d,fubuwic

   You can output in CSV standard format.  This will escape things in " if they contain ,

   Eg

          $ rclone lsf --csv --files-only --format ps remote:path
          test.log,22355
          test.sh,449
          "this file contains a comma, in the file name.txt",6

   Note that the --absolute parameter is useful for making lists of files to pass to an rclone copy with the --files-from-raw flag.

   For example, to find all the files modified within one day and copy those only (without traversing the whole directory structure):

          rclone lsf --absolute --files-only --max-age 1d /path/to/local > new_files
          rclone copy --files-from-raw new_files /path/to/local remote:path

   Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

   There are several related list commands

    ls to list size and path of objects only

    lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

    lsd to list directories only

    lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

    lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

   ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

   Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

   The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

   Listing  a  nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g.  s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based re
   motes).

          rclone lsf remote:path [flags]

Options

                --absolute           Put a leading / in front of path names
                --csv                Output in CSV format
            -d, --dir-slash          Append a slash to directory names (default true)
                --dirs-only          Only list directories
                --files-only         Only list files
            -F, --format string      Output format - see  help for details (default "p")
                --hash h             Use this hash when h is used in the format MD5|SHA-1|DropboxHash (default "md5")
            -h, --help               help for lsf
            -R, --recursive          Recurse into the listing
            -s, --separator string   Separator for the items in the format (default ";")

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsjson

   List directories and objects in the path in JSON format.

Synopsis

   List directories and objects in the path in JSON format.

   The output is an array of Items, where each Item looks like this

          {
            "Hashes" : {
               "SHA-1" : "f572d396fae9206628714fb2ce00f72e94f2258f",
               "MD5" : "b1946ac92492d2347c6235b4d2611184",
               "DropboxHash" : "ecb65bb98f9d905b70458986c39fcbad7715e5f2fcc3b1f07767d7c83e2438cc"
            },
            "ID": "y2djkhiujf83u33",
            "OrigID": "UYOJVTUW00Q1RzTDA",
            "IsBucket" : false,
            "IsDir" : false,
            "MimeType" : "application/octet-stream",
            "ModTime" : "2017-05-31T16:15:57.034468261+01:00",
            "Name" : "file.txt",
            "Encrypted" : "v0qpsdq8anpci8n929v3uu9338",
            "EncryptedPath" : "kja9098349023498/v0qpsdq8anpci8n929v3uu9338",
            "Path" : "full/path/goes/here/file.txt",
            "Size" : 6,
            "Tier" : "hot",
          }

   If --hash is not specified the Hashes property won't be emitted.  The types of hash can be specified with the --hash-type parameter (which may be  repeated).
   If --hash-type is set then it implies --hash.

   If  --no-modtime  is  specified  then ModTime will be blank.  This can speed things up on remotes where reading the ModTime takes an extra request (e.g.  s3,
   swift).

   If --no-mimetype is specified then MimeType will be blank.  This can speed things up on remotes where reading the MimeType takes an extra request (e.g.   s3,
   swift).

   If --encrypted is not specified the Encrypted won't be emitted.

   If --dirs-only is not specified files in addition to directories are returned

   If --files-only is not specified directories in addition to the files will be returned.

   If --metadata is set then an additional Metadata key will be returned.  This will have metadata in rclone standard format as a JSON object.

   if  --stat  is set then a single JSON blob will be returned about the item pointed to.  This will return an error if the item isn't found.  However on bucket
   based backends (like s3, gcs, b2, azureblob etc) if the item isn't found it will return an empty directory as it isn't possible  to  tell  empty  directories
   from missing directories there.

   The  Path  field will only show folders below the remote path being listed.  If "remote:path" contains the file "subfolder/file.txt", the Path for "file.txt"
   will be "subfolder/file.txt", not "remote:path/subfolder/file.txt".  When used without --recursive the Path will always be the same as Name.

   If the directory is a bucket in a bucket-based backend, then "IsBucket" will be set to true.  This key won't be present unless it is "true".

   The time is in RFC3339 format with up to nanosecond precision.  The number of decimal digits in the seconds will depend on the precision that the remote  can
   hold the times, so if times are accurate to the nearest millisecond (e.g.  Google Drive) then 3 digits will always be shown ("2017-05-31T16:15:57.034+01:00")
   whereas if the times are accurate to the nearest second (Dropbox, Box, WebDav, etc.)  no digits will be shown ("2017-05-31T16:15:57+01:00").

   The whole output can be processed as a JSON blob, or alternatively it can be processed line by line as each item is written one to a line.

   Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

   There are several related list commands

    ls to list size and path of objects only

    lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

    lsd to list directories only

    lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

    lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

   ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

   Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

   The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

   Listing a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g.  s3, swift, or gcs - the  bucket-based  re
   motes).

          rclone lsjson remote:path [flags]

Options

                --dirs-only               Show only directories in the listing
                --encrypted               Show the encrypted names
                --files-only              Show only files in the listing
                --hash                    Include hashes in the output (may take longer)
                --hash-type stringArray   Show only this hash type (may be repeated)
            -h, --help                    help for lsjson
                --no-mimetype             Don't read the mime type (can speed things up)
                --no-modtime              Don't read the modification time (can speed things up)
                --original                Show the ID of the underlying Object
            -R, --recursive               Recurse into the listing
                --stat                    Just return the info for the pointed to file

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone mount

   Mount the remote as file system on a mountpoint.

Synopsis

   rclone mount allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any of Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with FUSE.

   First set up your remote using rclone config.  Check it works with rclone ls etc.

   On Linux and macOS, you can run mount in either foreground or background (aka daemon) mode.  Mount runs in foreground mode by default.  Use the --daemon flag
   to force background mode.  On Windows you can run mount in foreground only, the flag is ignored.

   In background mode rclone acts as a generic Unix mount program: the main program starts, spawns background rclone process to setup and  maintain  the  mount,
   waits until success or timeout and exits with appropriate code (killing the child process if it fails).

   On Linux/macOS/FreeBSD start the mount like this, where /path/to/local/mount is an empty existing directory:

          rclone mount remote:path/to/files /path/to/local/mount

   On  Windows  you  can  start a mount in different ways.  See below for details.  If foreground mount is used interactively from a console window, rclone will
   serve the mount and occupy the console so another window should be used to work with the mount until rclone is interrupted e.g.  by pressing Ctrl-C.

   The following examples will mount to an automatically assigned drive, to specific drive letter X:, to path C:\path\parent\mount (where  parent  directory  or
   drive  must  exist,  and  mount  must  not  exist,  and  is not supported when mounting as a network drive), and the last example will mount as network share
   \\cloud\remote and map it to an automatically assigned drive:

          rclone mount remote:path/to/files *
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files C:\path\parent\mount
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files \\cloud\remote

   When the program ends while in foreground mode, either via Ctrl+C or receiving a SIGINT or SIGTERM signal, the mount should be automatically stopped.

   When running in background mode the user will have to stop the mount manually:

          # Linux
          fusermount -u /path/to/local/mount
          # OS X
          umount /path/to/local/mount

   The umount operation can fail, for example when the mountpoint is busy.  When that happens, it is the user's responsibility to stop the mount manually.

   The size of the mounted file system will  be  set  according  to  information  retrieved  from  the  remote,  the  same  as  returned  by  the  rclone  about
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/) command.  Remotes with unlimited storage may report the used size only, then an additional 1 PiB of free space is
   assumed.  If the remote does not support (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features) the about feature at all, then 1 PiB is set as both the  total  and
   the free size.

Installing on Windows

   To run rclone mount on Windows, you will need to download and install WinFsp (http://www.secfs.net/winfsp/).

   WinFsp  (https://github.com/winfsp/winfsp)  is an open-source Windows File System Proxy which makes it easy to write user space file systems for Windows.  It
   provides a FUSE emulation layer which rclone uses combination with cgofuse (https://github.com/winfsp/cgofuse).  Both of these packages are  by  Bill  Zissi
   mopoulos who was very helpful during the implementation of rclone mount for Windows.

Mounting modes on windows

   Unlike  other  operating systems, Microsoft Windows provides a different filesystem type for network and fixed drives.  It optimises access on the assumption
   fixed disk drives are fast and reliable, while network drives have relatively high latency and less reliability.  Some settings can  also  be  differentiated
   between  the  two  types,  for example that Windows Explorer should just display icons and not create preview thumbnails for image and video files on network
   drives.

   In most cases, rclone will mount the remote as a normal, fixed disk drive by default.  However, you can also choose to mount it as a  remote  network  drive,
   often  described  as a network share.  If you mount an rclone remote using the default, fixed drive mode and experience unexpected program errors, freezes or
   other issues, consider mounting as a network drive instead.

   When mounting as a fixed disk drive you can either mount to an unused drive letter, or to a path representing a nonexistent subdirectory of an existing  par
   ent  directory  or  drive.   Using  the special value * will tell rclone to automatically assign the next available drive letter, starting with Z: and moving
   backward.  Examples:

          rclone mount remote:path/to/files *
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files C:\path\parent\mount
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:

   Option --volname can be used to set a custom volume name for the mounted file system.  The default is to use the remote name and path.

   To mount as network drive, you can add option --network-mode to your mount command.  Mounting to a directory path is not supported in this mode, it is a lim
   itation Windows imposes on junctions, so the remote must always be mounted to a drive letter.

          rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --network-mode

   A  volume  name  specified  with  --volname will be used to create the network share path.  A complete UNC path, such as \\cloud\remote, optionally with path
   \\cloud\remote\madeup\path, will be used as is.  Any other string will be used as the share part, after a default prefix \\server\.  If  no  volume  name  is
   specified  then  \\server\share will be used.  You must make sure the volume name is unique when you are mounting more than one drive, or else the mount com
   mand will fail.  The share name will treated as the volume label for the mapped drive, shown in Windows Explorer etc, while the complete \\server\share  will
   be reported as the remote UNC path by net use etc, just like a normal network drive mapping.

   If  you specify a full network share UNC path with --volname, this will implicitly set the --network-mode option, so the following two examples have same re
   sult:

          rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --network-mode
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --volname \\server\share

   You may also specify the network share UNC path as the mountpoint itself.  Then rclone will automatically assign a drive letter, same as with * and use  that
   as  mountpoint,  and instead use the UNC path specified as the volume name, as if it were specified with the --volname option.  This will also implicitly set
   the --network-mode option.  This means the following two examples have same result:

          rclone mount remote:path/to/files \\cloud\remote
          rclone mount remote:path/to/files * --volname \\cloud\remote

   There is yet another way to enable network mode, and to set the share path, and that is to pass the  "native"  libfuse/WinFsp  option  directly:  --fuse-flag
   --VolumePrefix=\server\share.  Note that the path must be with just a single backslash prefix in this case.

   Note: In previous versions of rclone this was the only supported method.

   Read more about drive mapping (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Drive_mapping)

   See also Limitations section below.

Windows filesystem permissions

   The  FUSE  emulation  layer on Windows must convert between the POSIX-based permission model used in FUSE, and the permission model used in Windows, based on
   access-control lists (ACL).

   The mounted filesystem will normally get three entries in its access-control list (ACL), representing permissions for the  POSIX  permission  scopes:  Owner,
   group  and  others.  By default, the owner and group will be taken from the current user, and the built-in group "Everyone" will be used to represent others.
   The user/group can be customized with FUSE options "UserName" and "GroupName", e.g.  -o UserName=user123 -o GroupName="Authenticated Users".  The permissions
   on   each   entry   will   be   set   according   to   options   --dir-perms   and  --file-perms,  which  takes  a  value  in  traditional  numeric  notation
   (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/File-system_permissions#Numeric_notation).

   The default permissions corresponds to --file-perms 0666 --dir-perms 0777, i.e.  read and write permissions to everyone.  This means you will not be able  to
   start  any  programs from the mount.  To be able to do that you must add execute permissions, e.g.  --file-perms 0777 --dir-perms 0777 to add it to everyone.
   If the program needs to write files, chances are you will have to enable VFS File Caching as well (see also limitations).

   Note that the mapping of permissions is not always trivial, and the result you see in Windows Explorer may not be exactly like you  expected.   For  example,
   when  setting  a  value that includes write access, this will be mapped to individual permissions "write attributes", "write data" and "append data", but not
   "write extended attributes".  Windows will then show this as basic permission "Special" instead of "Write", because "Write" includes the "write extended  at‐
   tributes" permission.

   If  you  set  POSIX  permissions  for only allowing access to the owner, using --file-perms 0600 --dir-perms 0700, the user group and the built-in "Everyone"
   group will still be given some special permissions, such as "read attributes" and "read permissions", in Windows.  This is done  for  compatibility  reasons,
   e.g.   to  allow users without additional permissions to be able to read basic metadata about files like in UNIX.  One case that may arise is that other pro
   grams (incorrectly) interprets this as the file being accessible by everyone.  For example an SSH client may warn about "unprotected private key file".

   WinFsp 2021 (version 1.9) introduces a new FUSE option "FileSecurity", that allows the  complete  specification  of  file  security  descriptors  using  SDDL
   (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/win32/secauthz/security-descriptor-string-format).  With this you can work around issues such as the mentioned "un‐
   protected private key file" by specifying -o FileSecurity="D:P(A;;FA;;;OW)", for file all access (FA) to the owner (OW).

Windows caveats

   Drives created as Administrator are not visible to other accounts, not even an account that was elevated to Administrator with the User Account Control (UAC)
   feature.  A result of this is that if you mount to a drive letter from a Command Prompt run as Administrator, and then try to access the same drive from Win
   dows Explorer (which does not run as Administrator), you will not be able to see the mounted drive.

   If you don't need to access the drive from applications running with administrative privileges, the easiest way around this is to  always  create  the  mount
   from a non-elevated command prompt.

   To make mapped drives available to the user account that created them regardless if elevated or not, there is a special Windows setting called linked connec‐
   tions  (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/troubleshoot/windows-client/networking/mapped-drives-not-available-from-elevated-command#detail-to-configure-the-en‐
   ablelinkedconnections-registry-entry) that can be enabled.

   It  is also possible to make a drive mount available to everyone on the system, by running the process creating it as the built-in SYSTEM account.  There are
   several ways to do this: One is to use the command-line utility  PsExec  (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/sysinternals/downloads/psexec),  from  Microsoft's
   Sysinternals  suite,  which has option -s to start processes as the SYSTEM account.  Another alternative is to run the mount command from a Windows Scheduled
   Task,  or  a  Windows  Service,  configured  to  run  as  the  SYSTEM  account.   A  third  alternative  is  to  use   the   WinFsp.Launcher   infrastructure
   (https://github.com/winfsp/winfsp/wiki/WinFsp-Service-Architecture)).   Note that when running rclone as another user, it will not use the configuration file
   from your profile unless you tell it to with the --config (https://rclone.org/docs/#config-config-file) option.   Read  more  in  the  install  documentation
   (https://rclone.org/install/).

   Note that mapping to a directory path, instead of a drive letter, does not suffer from the same limitations.

Limitations

   Without the use of --vfs-cache-mode this can only write files sequentially, it can only seek when reading.  This means that many applications won't work with
   their files on an rclone mount without --vfs-cache-mode writes or --vfs-cache-mode full.  See the VFS File Caching section for more info.

   The bucket-based remotes (e.g.  Swift, S3, Google Compute Storage, B2) do not support the concept of empty directories, so empty directories will have a ten
   dency to disappear once they fall out of the directory cache.

   When  rclone  mount  is  invoked  on Unix with --daemon flag, the main rclone program will wait for the background mount to become ready or until the timeout
   specified by the --daemon-wait flag.  On Linux it can check mount status using ProcFS so the flag in fact sets maximum time to wait, while the real wait  can
   be less.  On macOS / BSD the time to wait is constant and the check is performed only at the end.  We advise you to set wait time on macOS reasonably.

   Only supported on Linux, FreeBSD, OS X and Windows at the moment.

rclone mount vs rclone sync/copy

   File  systems  expect  things  to be 100% reliable, whereas cloud storage systems are a long way from 100% reliable.  The rclone sync/copy commands cope with
   this with lots of retries.  However rclone mount can't use retries in the same way without making local copies of the uploads.  Look at the VFS File  Caching
   for solutions to make mount more reliable.

Attribute caching

   You can use the flag --attr-timeout to set the time the kernel caches the attributes (size, modification time, etc.)  for directory entries.

   The default is 1s which caches files just long enough to avoid too many callbacks to rclone from the kernel.

   In  theory  0s should be the correct value for filesystems which can change outside the control of the kernel.  However this causes quite a few problems such
   as   rclone   using   too   much   memory   (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2157),   rclone   not    serving    files    to    samba    (https://fo
   rum.rclone.org/t/rclone-1-39-vs-1-40-mount-issue/5112)   and   excessive  time  listing  directories  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2095#issuecom‐
   ment-371141147).

   The kernel can cache the info about a file for the time given by --attr-timeout.  You may see corruption if the remote file changes length during  this  win
   dow.   It  will  show up as either a truncated file or a file with garbage on the end.  With --attr-timeout 1s this is very unlikely but not impossible.  The
   higher you set --attr-timeout the more likely it is.  The default setting of "1s" is the lowest setting which mitigates the problems above.

   If you set it higher (10s or 1m say) then the kernel will call back to rclone less often making it more efficient, however there is more chance of  the  cor
   ruption issue above.

   If files don't change on the remote outside of the control of rclone then there is no chance of corruption.

   This is the same as setting the attr_timeout option in mount.fuse.

Filters

   Note that all the rclone filters can be used to select a subset of the files to be visible in the mount.

systemd

   When  running  rclone  mount as a systemd service, it is possible to use Type=notify.  In this case the service will enter the started state after the mount
   point has been successfully set up.  Units having the rclone mount service specified as a requirement will see all files  and  folders  immediately  in  this
   mode.

   Note  that  systemd  runs  mount  units  without any environment variables including PATH or HOME.  This means that tilde (~) expansion will not work and you
   should provide --config and --cache-dir explicitly as absolute paths via rclone arguments.  Since mounting requires the fusermount program, rclone  will  use
   the fallback PATH of /bin:/usr/bin in this scenario.  Please ensure that fusermount is present on this PATH.

Rclone as Unix mount helper

   The  core  Unix  program  /bin/mount  normally  takes  the  -t FSTYPE argument then runs the /sbin/mount.FSTYPE helper program passing it mount options as -o
   key=val,... or --opt=....  Automount (classic or systemd) behaves in a similar way.

   rclone by default expects GNU-style flags --key val.  To run it as a mount helper you should symlink  rclone  binary  to  /sbin/mount.rclone  and  optionally
   /usr/bin/rclonefs, e.g.  ln -s /usr/bin/rclone /sbin/mount.rclone.  rclone will detect it and translate command-line arguments appropriately.

   Now you can run classic mounts like this:

          mount sftp1:subdir /mnt/data -t rclone -o vfs_cache_mode=writes,sftp_key_file=/path/to/pem

   or create systemd mount units:

          # /etc/systemd/system/mnt-data.mount
          [Unit]
          After=network-online.target
          [Mount]
          Type=rclone
          What=sftp1:subdir
          Where=/mnt/data
          Options=rw,allow_other,args2env,vfs-cache-mode=writes,config=/etc/rclone.conf,cache-dir=/var/rclone

   optionally accompanied by systemd automount unit

          # /etc/systemd/system/mnt-data.automount
          [Unit]
          After=network-online.target
          Before=remote-fs.target
          [Automount]
          Where=/mnt/data
          TimeoutIdleSec=600
          [Install]
          WantedBy=multi-user.target

   or add in /etc/fstab a line like

          sftp1:subdir /mnt/data rclone rw,noauto,nofail,_netdev,x-systemd.automount,args2env,vfs_cache_mode=writes,config=/etc/rclone.conf,cache_dir=/var/cache/rclone 0 0

   or use classic Automountd.  Remember to provide explicit config=...,cache-dir=... as a workaround for mount units being run without HOME.

   Rclone  in  the mount helper mode will split -o argument(s) by comma, replace _ by - and prepend -- to get the command-line flags.  Options containing commas
   or spaces can be wrapped in single or double quotes.  Any inner quotes inside outer quotes of the same type should be doubled.

   Mount option syntax includes a few extra options treated specially:

    env.NAME=VALUE will set an environment variable for the mount process.  This helps with Automountd and Systemd.mount which don't allow setting custom envi
     ronment for mount helpers.  Typically you will use env.HTTPS_PROXY=proxy.host:3128 or env.HOME=/root

    command=cmount can be used to run cmount or any other rclone command rather than the default mount.

    args2env  will  pass  mount  options to the mount helper running in background via environment variables instead of command line arguments.  This allows to
     hide secrets from such commands as ps or pgrep.

    vv... will be transformed into appropriate --verbose=N

    standard mount options like x-systemd.automount, _netdev, nosuid and alike are intended only for Automountd and ignored by rclone.

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS  layer  has  to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using  the  --dir-cache-time  flag,  you  can  control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the  directory  cache  ex
   pires  if  the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the polling inter
   val.

   You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance  is  running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These flags control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.   It  can  be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If  run  with  -vv  rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone  is  quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If  using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can  potentially
   cause  data  corruption  if  you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't need to worry about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write  will  be  a  lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So  if  an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their full size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas  the  --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift,  ftp  and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If  you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can  reduce  the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased number of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified,  and
   greater  than  --vfs-read-chunk-size,  the  chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If the value is "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so  on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In  particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come  in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to  create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The  --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument  refers  to  an  existing
   file  with  exactly  the  same  name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly the same name is not
   found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.   Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note  that  case  sensitivity  of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system presented by rclone (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone  runs:  "true"  on  Windows  and  macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

          rclone mount remote:path /path/to/mountpoint [flags]

Options

                --allow-non-empty                        Allow mounting over a non-empty directory (not supported on Windows)
                --allow-other                            Allow access to other users (not supported on Windows)
                --allow-root                             Allow access to root user (not supported on Windows)
                --async-read                             Use asynchronous reads (not supported on Windows) (default true)
                --attr-timeout duration                  Time for which file/directory attributes are cached (default 1s)
                --daemon                                 Run mount in background and exit parent process (as background output is suppressed, use --log-file with --log-format=pid,... to monitor) (not supported on Windows)
                --daemon-timeout duration                Time limit for rclone to respond to kernel (not supported on Windows)
                --daemon-wait duration                   Time to wait for ready mount from daemon (maximum time on Linux, constant sleep time on OSX/BSD) (not supported on Windows) (default 1m0s)
                --debug-fuse                             Debug the FUSE internals - needs -v
                --default-permissions                    Makes kernel enforce access control based on the file mode (not supported on Windows)
                --devname string                         Set the device name - default is remote:path
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --fuse-flag stringArray                  Flags or arguments to be passed direct to libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for mount
                --max-read-ahead SizeSuffix              The number of bytes that can be prefetched for sequential reads (not supported on Windows) (default 128Ki)
                --network-mode                           Mount as remote network drive, instead of fixed disk drive (supported on Windows only)
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --noappledouble                          Ignore Apple Double (._) and .DS_Store files (supported on OSX only) (default true)
                --noapplexattr                           Ignore all "com.apple.*" extended attributes (supported on OSX only)
            -o, --option stringArray                     Option for libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)
                --volname string                         Set the volume name (supported on Windows and OSX only)
                --write-back-cache                       Makes kernel buffer writes before sending them to rclone (without this, writethrough caching is used) (not supported on Windows)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone moveto

   Move file or directory from source to dest.

Synopsis

   If source:path is a file or directory then it moves it to a file or directory named dest:path.

   This can be used to rename files or upload single files to other than their existing name.  If the source is a directory then it acts exactly like  the  move
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_move/) command.

   So

          rclone moveto src dst

   where src and dst are rclone paths, either remote:path or /path/to/local or C:.

   This will:

          if src is file
              move it to dst, overwriting an existing file if it exists
          if src is directory
              move it to dst, overwriting existing files if they exist
              see move command for full details

   This doesn't transfer files that are identical on src and dst, testing by size and modification time or MD5SUM.  src will be deleted on successful transfer.

   Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

   Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

          rclone moveto source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for moveto

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone ncdu

   Explore a remote with a text based user interface.

Synopsis

   This  displays  a  text  based user interface allowing the navigation of a remote.  It is most useful for answering the question - "What is using all my disk
   space?".

   To make the user interface it first scans the entire remote given and builds an in memory representation.  rclone ncdu can be used during this scanning phase
   and you will see it building up the directory structure as it goes along.

   You can interact with the user interface using key presses, press '?' to toggle the help on and off.  The supported keys are:

           , or k,j to Move
           ,l to enter
           ,h to return
           c toggle counts
           g toggle graph
           a toggle average size in directory
           u toggle human-readable format
           n,s,C,A sort by name,size,count,average size
           d delete file/directory
           v select file/directory
           V enter visual select mode
           D delete selected files/directories
           Y display current path
           ^L refresh screen (fix screen corruption)
           ? to toggle help on and off
           q/ESC/^c to quit

   Listed  files/directories may be prefixed by a one-character flag, some of them combined with a description in brackets at end of line.  These flags have the
   following meaning:

          e means this is an empty directory, i.e. contains no files (but
            may contain empty subdirectories)
          ~ means this is a directory where some of the files (possibly in
            subdirectories) have unknown size, and therefore the directory
            size may be underestimated (and average size inaccurate, as it
            is average of the files with known sizes).
          . means an error occurred while reading a subdirectory, and
            therefore the directory size may be underestimated (and average
            size inaccurate)
          ! means an error occurred while reading this directory

   This an homage to the ncdu tool (https://dev.yorhel.nl/ncdu) but for rclone remotes.  It is missing lots of features at  the  moment  but  is  useful  as  it
   stands.

   Note that it might take some time to delete big files/directories.  The UI won't respond in the meantime since the deletion is done synchronously.

   For  a  non-interactive listing of the remote, see the tree (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_tree/) command.  To just get the total size of the remote you
   can also use the size (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/) command.

          rclone ncdu remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for ncdu

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone obscure

   Obscure password for use in the rclone config file.

Synopsis

   In the rclone config file, human-readable passwords are obscured.  Obscuring them is done by encrypting them and writing them out in base64.  This is  not  a
   secure  way of encrypting these passwords as rclone can decrypt them - it is to prevent "eyedropping" - namely someone seeing a password in the rclone config
   file by accident.

   Many equally important things (like access tokens) are not obscured in the config file.  However it is very hard to shoulder surf a 64 character hex token.

   This command can also accept a password through STDIN instead of an argument by passing a hyphen as an argument.  This will use the first line  of  STDIN  as
   the password not including the trailing newline.

          echo "secretpassword" | rclone obscure -

   If there is no data on STDIN to read, rclone obscure will default to obfuscating the hyphen itself.

   If you want to encrypt the config file then please use config file encryption - see rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) for more info.

          rclone obscure password [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for obscure

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rc

   Run a command against a running rclone.

Synopsis

   This  runs  a command against a running rclone.  Use the --url flag to specify an non default URL to connect on.  This can be either a ":port" which is taken
   to mean "http://localhost:port" or a "host:port" which is taken to mean "http://host:port"

   A username and password can be passed in with --user and --pass.

   Note that --rc-addr, --rc-user, --rc-pass will be read also for --url, --user, --pass.

   Arguments should be passed in as parameter=value.

   The result will be returned as a JSON object by default.

   The --json parameter can be used to pass in a JSON blob as an input instead of key=value arguments.  This is the only way of passing in more complicated val
   ues.

   The -o/--opt option can be used to set a key "opt" with key, value options in the form -o key=value or -o key.  It can be repeated as many times as required.
   This is useful for rc commands which take the "opt" parameter which by convention is a dictionary of strings.

          -o key=value -o key2

   Will place this in the "opt" value

          {"key":"value", "key2","")

   The -a/--arg option can be used to set strings in the "arg" value.  It can be repeated as many times as required.  This is useful for rc commands which  take
   the "arg" parameter which by convention is a list of strings.

          -a value -a value2

   Will place this in the "arg" value

          ["value", "value2"]

   Use  --loopback  to  connect  to  the rclone instance running rclone rc.  This is very useful for testing commands without having to run an rclone rc server,
   e.g.:

          rclone rc --loopback operations/about fs=/

   Use rclone rc to see a list of all possible commands.

          rclone rc commands parameter [flags]

Options

            -a, --arg stringArray   Argument placed in the "arg" array
            -h, --help              help for rc
                --json string       Input JSON - use instead of key=value args
                --loopback          If set connect to this rclone instance not via HTTP
                --no-output         If set, don't output the JSON result
            -o, --opt stringArray   Option in the form name=value or name placed in the "opt" array
                --pass string       Password to use to connect to rclone remote control
                --url string        URL to connect to rclone remote control (default "http://localhost:5572/")
                --user string       Username to use to rclone remote control

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rcat

   Copies standard input to file on remote.

Synopsis

   rclone rcat reads from standard input (stdin) and copies it to a single remote file.

          echo "hello world" | rclone rcat remote:path/to/file
          ffmpeg - | rclone rcat remote:path/to/file

   If the remote file already exists, it will be overwritten.

   rcat will try to upload small files in a single request, which is usually more efficient than the streaming/chunked upload endpoints, which use multiple  re
   quests.   Exact  behaviour depends on the remote.  What is considered a small file may be set through --streaming-upload-cutoff.  Uploading only starts after
   the cutoff is reached or if the file ends before that.  The data must fit into RAM.  The cutoff needs to be small enough to adhere the limits of your remote,
   please see there.  Generally speaking, setting this cutoff too high will decrease your performance.

   Use the --size flag to preallocate the file in advance at the remote end and actually stream it, even if remote backend doesn't support streaming.

   --size  should  be  the  exact size of the input stream in bytes.  If the size of the stream is different in length to the --size passed in then the transfer
   will likely fail.

   Note that the upload can also not be retried because the data is not kept around until the upload succeeds.  If you need to transfer a lot  of  data,  you're
   better off caching locally and then rclone move it to the destination.

          rclone rcat remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help       help for rcat
                --size int   File size hint to preallocate (default -1)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rcd

   Run rclone listening to remote control commands only.

Synopsis

   This runs rclone so that it only listens to remote control commands.

   This is useful if you are controlling rclone via the rc API.

   If  you pass in a path to a directory, rclone will serve that directory for GET requests on the URL passed in.  It will also open the URL in the browser when
   rclone is run.

   See the rc documentation (https://rclone.org/rc/) for more info on the rc flags.

          rclone rcd <path to files to serve>* [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for rcd

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rmdirs

   Remove empty directories under the path.

Synopsis

   This recursively removes any empty directories (including directories that only contain empty directories), that it finds under the path.  The root path  it
   self will also be removed if it is empty, unless you supply the --leave-root flag.

   Use command rmdir (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/) to delete just the empty directory given by path, not recurse.

   This  is  useful  for  tidying  up  remotes  that  rclone  has  left  a  lot  of  empty  directories  in.   For  example  the delete (https://rclone.org/com
   mands/rclone_delete/) command will delete files but leave the directory structure (unless used with option --rmdirs).

   To delete a path and any objects in it, use purge (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command.

          rclone rmdirs remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help         help for rmdirs
                --leave-root   Do not remove root directory if empty

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone selfupdate

   Update the rclone binary.

Synopsis

   This command downloads the latest release of rclone and replaces the currently running binary.  The download is verified with a hashsum and cryptographically
   signed signature.

   If  used  without flags (or with implied --stable flag), this command will install the latest stable release.  However, some issues may be fixed (or features
   added) only in the latest beta release.  In such cases you should run the command with the --beta flag, i.e.  rclone selfupdate --beta.  You can check in ad
   vance what version would be installed by adding the --check flag, then repeat the command without it when you are satisfied.

   Sometimes  the  rclone team may recommend you a concrete beta or stable rclone release to troubleshoot your issue or add a bleeding edge feature.  The --ver
   sion VER flag, if given, will update to the concrete version instead of the latest one.  If you omit micro version from VER (for example  1.53),  the  latest
   matching micro version will be used.

   Upon  successful  update rclone will print a message that contains a previous version number.  You will need it if you later decide to revert your update for
   some reason.  Then you'll have to note the previous version and run the following command: rclone selfupdate [--beta] OLDVER.  If the  old  version  contains
   only  dots and digits (for example v1.54.0) then it's a stable release so you won't need the --beta flag.  Beta releases have an additional information simi‐
   lar to v1.54.0-beta.5111.06f1c0c61.  (if you are a developer and use a locally built rclone, the version number will end with -DEV, you will have to  rebuild
   it as it obviously can't be distributed).

   If you previously installed rclone via a package manager, the package may include local documentation or configure services.  You may wish to update with the
   flag --package deb or --package rpm (whichever is correct for your OS) to update these too.  This command with the default --package zip will update only the
   rclone executable so the local manual may become inaccurate after it.

   The  rclone mount command (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) may or may not support extended FUSE options depending on the build and OS.  selfupdate
   will refuse to update if the capability would be discarded.

   Note: Windows forbids deletion of a currently running executable so this command will rename the old executable to 'rclone.old.exe' upon success.

   Please note that this command was not available before rclone version 1.55.  If it fails for you with the message unknown command "selfupdate" then you  will
   need to update manually following the install instructions located at https://rclone.org/install/

          rclone selfupdate [flags]

Options

                --beta             Install beta release
                --check            Check for latest release, do not download
            -h, --help             help for selfupdate
                --output string    Save the downloaded binary at a given path (default: replace running binary)
                --package string   Package format: zip|deb|rpm (default: zip)
                --stable           Install stable release (this is the default)
                --version string   Install the given rclone version (default: latest)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone serve

   Serve a remote over a protocol.

Synopsis

   Serve a remote over a given protocol.  Requires the use of a subcommand to specify the protocol, e.g.

          rclone serve http remote:

   Each subcommand has its own options which you can see in their help.

          rclone serve <protocol> [opts] <remote> [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for serve

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

    rclone serve dlna (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_dlna/) - Serve remote:path over DLNA

    rclone serve docker (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/) - Serve any remote on docker's volume plugin API.

   • rclone serve ftp (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_ftp/) - Serve remote:path over FTP.

   • rclone serve http (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_http/) - Serve the remote over HTTP.

   • rclone serve restic (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_restic/) - Serve the remote for restic's REST API.

    rclone serve sftp (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/) - Serve the remote over SFTP.

    rclone serve webdav (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_webdav/) - Serve remote:path over WebDAV.

rclone serve dlna

   Serve remote:path over DLNA

Synopsis

   Run  a DLNA media server for media stored in an rclone remote.  Many devices, such as the Xbox and PlayStation, can automatically discover this server in the
   LAN and play audio/video from it.  VLC is also supported.  Service discovery uses UDP multicast packets (SSDP) and will thus only work on LANs.

   Rclone will list all files present in the remote, without filtering based on media formats or file extensions.  Additionally, there is no  media  transcoding
   support.  This means that some players might show files that they are not able to play back correctly.

Server options

   Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should listen on, e.g.  --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all IPs.

   Use --name to choose the friendly server name, which is by default "rclone (hostname)".

   Use --log-trace in conjunction with -vv to enable additional debug logging of all UPNP traffic.

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud  storage  objects  have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS layer has to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not  refreshed  from  the  backend.   Changes  made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory cache ex
   pires if the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the  polling  inter
   val.

   You  can  send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These  flags  control  the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent  but  can  be  con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note  that  files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every  --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You  should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can potentially
   cause data corruption if you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't  need  to  worry  about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This  is  very  similar  to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their  full  size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When  reading  a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For  example  hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift, ftp and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less  accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can reduce the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased  number  of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and
   greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If  the  value  is  "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With  --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes  rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File  systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.   If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The  user  may  specify  a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing
   file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly  the  same  name  is  not
   found  but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.  Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system  presented  by  rclone  (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If  the  flag  is  not  provided  on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

          rclone serve dlna remote:path [flags]

Options

                --addr string                            The ip:port or :port to bind the DLNA http server to (default ":7879")
                --announce-interval duration             The interval between SSDP announcements (default 12m0s)
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for dlna
                --interface stringArray                  The interface to use for SSDP (repeat as necessary)
                --log-trace                              Enable trace logging of SOAP traffic
                --name string                            Name of DLNA server
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone serve docker

   Serve any remote on docker's volume plugin API.

Synopsis

   This  command implements the Docker volume plugin API allowing docker to use rclone as a data storage mechanism for various cloud providers.  rclone provides
   docker volume plugin based on it.

   To create a docker plugin, one must create a Unix or TCP socket that Docker will look for when you use the plugin and then it listens for commands from dock
   er daemon and runs the corresponding code when necessary.  Docker plugins can run as a managed plugin under control of the docker daemon or as an independent
   native service.  For testing, you can just run it directly from the command line, for example:

          sudo rclone serve docker --base-dir /tmp/rclone-volumes --socket-addr localhost:8787 -vv

   Running rclone serve docker will create the said socket, listening for commands from Docker to create the necessary Volumes.  Normally you need not give  the
   --socket-addr  flag.  The API will listen on the unix domain socket at /run/docker/plugins/rclone.sock.  In the example above rclone will create a TCP socket
   and a small file /etc/docker/plugins/rclone.spec containing the socket address.  We use sudo because both paths are writeable only by the root user.

   If you later decide to change listening socket, the docker daemon must be restarted to reconnect to /run/docker/plugins/rclone.sock or parse  new  /etc/dock
   er/plugins/rclone.spec.   Until  you restart, any volume related docker commands will timeout trying to access the old socket.  Running directly is supported
   on  Linux  only,  not  on  Windows  or  MacOS.   This  is  not  a  problem  with  managed  plugin  mode  described  in  details  in  the  full  documentation
   (https://rclone.org/docker).

   The  command will create volume mounts under the path given by --base-dir (by default /var/lib/docker-volumes/rclone available only to root) and maintain the
   JSON formatted file docker-plugin.state in the rclone cache directory with book-keeping records of created and mounted volumes.

   All mount and VFS options are submitted by the docker daemon via API, but you can also provide defaults on the command line as well as set path to the config
   file and cache directory or adjust logging verbosity.

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud  storage  objects  have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS layer has to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not  refreshed  from  the  backend.   Changes  made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory cache ex
   pires if the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the  polling  inter
   val.

   You  can  send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These  flags  control  the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent  but  can  be  con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note  that  files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every  --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You  should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can potentially
   cause data corruption if you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't  need  to  worry  about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This  is  very  similar  to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their  full  size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When  reading  a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For  example  hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift, ftp and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less  accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can reduce the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased  number  of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and
   greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If  the  value  is  "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With  --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes  rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File  systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.   If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The  user  may  specify  a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing
   file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly  the  same  name  is  not
   found  but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.  Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system  presented  by  rclone  (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If  the  flag  is  not  provided  on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

          rclone serve docker [flags]

Options

                --allow-non-empty                        Allow mounting over a non-empty directory (not supported on Windows)
                --allow-other                            Allow access to other users (not supported on Windows)
                --allow-root                             Allow access to root user (not supported on Windows)
                --async-read                             Use asynchronous reads (not supported on Windows) (default true)
                --attr-timeout duration                  Time for which file/directory attributes are cached (default 1s)
                --base-dir string                        Base directory for volumes (default "/var/lib/docker-volumes/rclone")
                --daemon                                 Run mount in background and exit parent process (as background output is suppressed, use --log-file with --log-format=pid,... to monitor) (not supported on Windows)
                --daemon-timeout duration                Time limit for rclone to respond to kernel (not supported on Windows)
                --daemon-wait duration                   Time to wait for ready mount from daemon (maximum time on Linux, constant sleep time on OSX/BSD) (not supported on Windows) (default 1m0s)
                --debug-fuse                             Debug the FUSE internals - needs -v
                --default-permissions                    Makes kernel enforce access control based on the file mode (not supported on Windows)
                --devname string                         Set the device name - default is remote:path
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --forget-state                           Skip restoring previous state
                --fuse-flag stringArray                  Flags or arguments to be passed direct to libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for docker
                --max-read-ahead SizeSuffix              The number of bytes that can be prefetched for sequential reads (not supported on Windows) (default 128Ki)
                --network-mode                           Mount as remote network drive, instead of fixed disk drive (supported on Windows only)
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --no-spec                                Do not write spec file
                --noappledouble                          Ignore Apple Double (._) and .DS_Store files (supported on OSX only) (default true)
                --noapplexattr                           Ignore all "com.apple.*" extended attributes (supported on OSX only)
            -o, --option stringArray                     Option for libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --socket-addr string                     Address <host:port> or absolute path (default: /run/docker/plugins/rclone.sock)
                --socket-gid int                         GID for unix socket (default: current process GID)
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)
                --volname string                         Set the volume name (supported on Windows and OSX only)
                --write-back-cache                       Makes kernel buffer writes before sending them to rclone (without this, writethrough caching is used) (not supported on Windows)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone serve ftp

   Serve remote:path over FTP.

Synopsis

   Run a basic FTP server to serve a remote over FTP protocol.  This can be viewed with a FTP client or you can make a remote of type FTP to read and write it.

Server options

   Use  --addr  to specify which IP address and port the server should listen on, e.g.  --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all IPs.  By default it
   only listens on localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

   If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

Authentication

   By default this will serve files without needing a login.

   You can set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS  layer  has  to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using  the  --dir-cache-time  flag,  you  can  control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the  directory  cache  ex
   pires  if  the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the polling inter
   val.

   You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance  is  running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These flags control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.   It  can  be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If  run  with  -vv  rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone  is  quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If  using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can  potentially
   cause  data  corruption  if  you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't need to worry about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write  will  be  a  lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So  if  an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their full size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas  the  --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift,  ftp  and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If  you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can  reduce  the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased number of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified,  and
   greater  than  --vfs-read-chunk-size,  the  chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If the value is "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so  on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In  particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come  in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to  create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The  --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument  refers  to  an  existing
   file  with  exactly  the  same  name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly the same name is not
   found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.   Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note  that  case  sensitivity  of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system presented by rclone (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone  runs:  "true"  on  Windows  and  macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

Auth Proxy

   If you supply the parameter --auth-proxy /path/to/program then rclone will use that program to generate backends on the fly which then are used to  authenti
   cate incoming requests.  This uses a simple JSON based protocol with input on STDIN and output on STDOUT.

   PLEASE NOTE: --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used together, if --auth-proxy is set the authorized keys option will be ignored.

   There is an example program bin/test_proxy.py (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/test_proxy.py) in the rclone source code.

   The  program's  job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn those into the config for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format.  This config will have any
   default parameters for the backend added, but it won't use configuration from environment variables or command line options - it is the job of the proxy pro
   gram to make a complete config.

   This config generated must have this extra parameter - _root - root to use for the backend

   And it may have this parameter - _obscure - comma separated strings for parameters to obscure

   If password authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

          {
              "user": "me",
              "pass": "mypassword"
          }

   If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

          {
              "user": "me",
              "public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
          }

   And as an example return this on STDOUT

          {
              "type": "sftp",
              "_root": "",
              "_obscure": "pass",
              "user": "me",
              "pass": "mypassword",
              "host": "sftp.example.com"
          }

   This  would mean that an SFTP backend would be created on the fly for the user and pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given.  Note that since
   _obscure is set to pass, rclone will obscure the pass parameter before creating the backend (which is required for sftp backends).

   The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example to make proxy to many different sftp backends, you could make  the  user  be  user@exam
   ple.com and then set the host to example.com in the output and the user to user.  For security you'd probably want to restrict the host to a limited list.

   Note  that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for configuration, don't use pass or public_key.  This also means that if a user's password or
   public-key is changed the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins) before it takes effect.

   This can be used to build general purpose proxies to any kind of backend that rclone supports.

          rclone serve ftp remote:path [flags]

Options

                --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:2121")
                --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth
                --cert string                            TLS PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for ftp
                --key string                             TLS PEM Private key
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --pass string                            Password for authentication (empty value allow every password)
                --passive-port string                    Passive port range to use (default "30000-32000")
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --public-ip string                       Public IP address to advertise for passive connections
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --user string                            User name for authentication (default "anonymous")
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone serve http

   Serve the remote over HTTP.

Synopsis

   Run a basic web server to serve a remote over HTTP.  This can be viewed in a web browser or you can make a remote of type http read from it.

   You can use the filter flags (e.g.  --include, --exclude) to control what is served.

   The server will log errors.  Use -v to see access logs.

   --bwlimit will be respected for file transfers.  Use --stats to control the stats printing.

Server options

   Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should listen on, eg --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all IPs.  By default it only
   listens on localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

   If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

   --server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to control the timeouts on the server.  Note that this is the total time for a transfer.

   --max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will accept in the HTTP header.

   --baseurl  controls  the  URL prefix that rclone serves from.  By default rclone will serve from the root.  If you used --baseurl "/rclone" then rclone would
   serve from a URL starting with "/rclone/".  This is useful if you wish to proxy rclone serve.  Rclone automatically  inserts  leading  and  trailing  "/"  on
   --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone", --baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated identically.

SSL/TLS

   By  default  this will serve over http.  If you want you can serve over https.  You will need to supply the --cert and --key flags.  If you wish to do client
   side certificate validation then you will need to supply --client-ca also.

   --cert should be a either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation of that with the CA certificate.  --key should be the  PEM  encoded  private  key  and
   --client-ca should be the PEM encoded client certificate authority certificate.

   --min-tls-version is minimum TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are "tls1.0", "tls1.1", "tls1.2" and "tls1.3" (default "tls1.0").

Template

   --template  allows a user to specify a custom markup template for HTTP and WebDAV serve functions.  The server exports the following markup to be used within
   the template to server pages:

   Parameter                             Description
   
   .Name                                 The full path of a file/directory.
   .Title                                Directory listing of .Name
   .Sort                                 The current  sort  used.   This  is
                                         changeable via ?sort= parameter
                                         Sort                       Options:
                                         namedirfirst,name,size,time    (de
                                         fault namedirfirst)
   .Order                                The current ordering used.  This is
                                         changeable via ?order= parameter
                                         Order  Options:  asc,desc  (default
                                         asc)
   .Query                                Currently unused.
   .Breadcrumb                           Allows for creating a relative nav
                                         igation
   -- .Link                              The relative to the  root  link  of
                                         the Text.
   -- .Text                              The Name of the directory.
   .Entries                              Information    about   a   specific
                                         file/directory.
   -- .URL                               The 'url' of an entry.
   -- .Leaf                              Currently same as 'URL' but intend
                                         ed to be 'just' the name.
   -- .IsDir                             Boolean for if an entry is a direc
                                         tory or not.
   -- .Size                              Size in Bytes of the entry.
   -- .ModTime                           The UTC timestamp of an entry.

Authentication

   By default this will serve files without needing a login.

   You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

   Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file.  This is in standard apache format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic  authentication.
   Bcrypt is recommended.

   To create an htpasswd file:

          touch htpasswd
          htpasswd -B htpasswd user
          htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

   The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

   Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

   Use --salt to change the password hashing salt from the default.

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud  storage  objects  have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS layer has to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not  refreshed  from  the  backend.   Changes  made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory cache ex
   pires if the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the  polling  inter
   val.

   You  can  send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These  flags  control  the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent  but  can  be  con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note  that  files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every  --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You  should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can potentially
   cause data corruption if you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't  need  to  worry  about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This  is  very  similar  to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their  full  size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When  reading  a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For  example  hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift, ftp and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less  accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can reduce the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased  number  of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and
   greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If  the  value  is  "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With  --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes  rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File  systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.   If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The  user  may  specify  a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing
   file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly  the  same  name  is  not
   found  but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.  Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system  presented  by  rclone  (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If  the  flag  is  not  provided  on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

          rclone serve http remote:path [flags]

Options

                --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "127.0.0.1:8080")
                --baseurl string                         Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                --cert string                            SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                --client-ca string                       Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for http
                --htpasswd string                        A htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                --key string                             SSL PEM Private key
                --max-header-bytes int                   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                --min-tls-version string                 Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --pass string                            Password for authentication
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --realm string                           Realm for authentication
                --salt string                            Password hashing salt (default "dlPL2MqE")
                --server-read-timeout duration           Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                --server-write-timeout duration          Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                --template string                        User-specified template
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --user string                            User name for authentication
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone serve restic

   Serve the remote for restic's REST API.

Synopsis

   Run  a  basic  web server to serve a remove over restic's REST backend API over HTTP.  This allows restic to use rclone as a data storage mechanism for cloud
   providers that restic does not support directly.

   Restic (https://restic.net/) is a command-line program for doing backups.

   The server will log errors.  Use -v to see access logs.

   --bwlimit will be respected for file transfers.  Use --stats to control the stats printing.

Setting up rclone for use by restic

   First set up a remote for your chosen cloud provider (https://rclone.org/docs/#configure).

   Once you have set up the remote, check it is working with, for example "rclone lsd remote:".  You may have called the remote something other than "remote:" -
   just substitute whatever you called it in the following instructions.

   Now start the rclone restic server

          rclone serve restic -v remote:backup

   Where you can replace "backup" in the above by whatever path in the remote you wish to use.

   By default this will serve on "localhost:8080" you can change this with use of the --addr flag.

   You might wish to start this server on boot.

   Adding  --cache-objects=false will cause rclone to stop caching objects returned from the List call.  Caching is normally desirable as it speeds up download
   ing objects, saves transactions and uses very little memory.

Setting up restic to use rclone

   Now you can follow the restic instructions (http://restic.readthedocs.io/en/latest/030_preparing_a_new_repo.html#rest-server) on setting up restic.

   Note that you will need restic 0.8.2 or later to interoperate with rclone.

   For the example above you will want to use "http://localhost:8080/" as the URL for the REST server.

   For example:

          $ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/
          $ export RESTIC_PASSWORD=yourpassword
          $ restic init
          created restic backend 8b1a4b56ae at rest:http://localhost:8080/

          Please note that knowledge of your password is required to access
          the repository. Losing your password means that your data is
          irrecoverably lost.
          $ restic backup /path/to/files/to/backup
          scan [/path/to/files/to/backup]
          scanned 189 directories, 312 files in 0:00
          [0:00] 100.00%  38.128 MiB / 38.128 MiB  501 / 501 items  0 errors  ETA 0:00
          duration: 0:00
          snapshot 45c8fdd8 saved

Multiple repositories

   Note that you can use the endpoint to host multiple repositories.  Do this by adding a directory name or path after the URL.  Note that these must  end  with
   /.  Eg

          $ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/user1repo/
          # backup user1 stuff
          $ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/user2repo/
          # backup user2 stuff

Private repositories

   The--private-repos flag can be used to limit users to repositories starting with a path of /<username>/.

Server options

   Use  --addr  to specify which IP address and port the server should listen on, e.g.  --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all IPs.  By default it
   only listens on localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

   If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

   --server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to control the timeouts on the server.  Note that this is the total time for a transfer.

   --max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will accept in the HTTP header.

   --baseurl controls the URL prefix that rclone serves from.  By default rclone will serve from the root.  If you used --baseurl "/rclone"  then  rclone  would
   serve  from  a  URL  starting  with  "/rclone/".  This is useful if you wish to proxy rclone serve.  Rclone automatically inserts leading and trailing "/" on
   --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone", --baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated identically.

   --template allows a user to specify a custom markup template for HTTP and WebDAV serve functions.  The server exports the following markup to be used  within
   the template to server pages:

   Parameter                             Description
   
   .Name                                 The full path of a file/directory.
   .Title                                Directory listing of .Name
   .Sort                                 The  current  sort  used.   This is
                                         changeable via ?sort= parameter
                                         Sort                       Options:
                                         namedirfirst,name,size,time    (de
                                         fault namedirfirst)
   .Order                                The current ordering used.  This is
                                         changeable via ?order= parameter
                                         Order  Options:  asc,desc  (default
                                         asc)
   .Query                                Currently unused.
   .Breadcrumb                           Allows for creating a relative nav
                                         igation
   -- .Link                              The  relative  to  the root link of
                                         the Text.
   -- .Text                              The Name of the directory.
   .Entries                              Information   about   a    specific
                                         file/directory.
   -- .URL                               The 'url' of an entry.
   -- .Leaf                              Currently same as 'URL' but intend
                                         ed to be 'just' the name.
   -- .IsDir                             Boolean for if an entry is a direc
                                         tory or not.
   -- .Size                              Size in Bytes of the entry.
   -- .ModTime                           The UTC timestamp of an entry.

Authentication

   By default this will serve files without needing a login.

   You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

   Use  --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file.  This is in standard apache format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic authentication.
   Bcrypt is recommended.

   To create an htpasswd file:

          touch htpasswd
          htpasswd -B htpasswd user
          htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

   The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

   Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

SSL/TLS

   By default this will serve over HTTP.  If you want you can serve over HTTPS.  You will need to supply the --cert and --key flags.  If you wish to  do  client
   side certificate validation then you will need to supply --client-ca also.

   --cert  should  be  either  a  PEM  encoded  certificate or a concatenation of that with the CA certificate.  --key should be the PEM encoded private key and
   --client-ca should be the PEM encoded client certificate authority certificate.

   --min-tls-version is minimum TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are "tls1.0", "tls1.1", "tls1.2" and "tls1.3" (default "tls1.0").

          rclone serve restic remote:path [flags]

Options

                --addr string                     IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:8080")
                --append-only                     Disallow deletion of repository data
                --baseurl string                  Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                --cache-objects                   Cache listed objects (default true)
                --cert string                     SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                --client-ca string                Client certificate authority to verify clients with
            -h, --help                            help for restic
                --htpasswd string                 htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                --key string                      SSL PEM Private key
                --max-header-bytes int            Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                --min-tls-version string          Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                --pass string                     Password for authentication
                --private-repos                   Users can only access their private repo
                --realm string                    Realm for authentication (default "rclone")
                --server-read-timeout duration    Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                --server-write-timeout duration   Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                --stdio                           Run an HTTP2 server on stdin/stdout
                --template string                 User-specified template
                --user string                     User name for authentication

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone serve sftp

   Serve the remote over SFTP.

Synopsis

   Run an SFTP server to serve a remote over SFTP.  This can be used with an SFTP client or you can make a remote of type sftp to use with it.

   You can use the filter flags (e.g.  --include, --exclude) to control what is served.

   The server will respond to a small number of shell commands, mainly md5sum, sha1sum and df, which enable it to provide support for checksums  and  the  about
   feature when accessed from an sftp remote.

   Note  that  this  server  uses  standard  32  KiB  packet payload size, which means you must not configure the client to expect anything else, e.g.  with the
   chunk_size (https://rclone.org/sftp/#sftp-chunk-size) option on an sftp remote.

   The server will log errors.  Use -v to see access logs.

   --bwlimit will be respected for file transfers.  Use --stats to control the stats printing.

   You must provide some means of authentication, either with --user/--pass, an authorized keys file (specify location with --authorized-keys - the  default  is
   the same as ssh), an --auth-proxy, or set the --no-auth flag for no authentication when logging in.

   If  you  don't  supply  a host --key then rclone will generate rsa, ecdsa and ed25519 variants, and cache them for later use in rclone's cache directory (see
   rclone help flags cache-dir) in the "serve-sftp" directory.

   By default the server binds to localhost:2022 - if you want it to be reachable externally then supply --addr :2022 for example.

   Note that the default of --vfs-cache-mode off is fine for the rclone sftp backend, but it may not be with other SFTP clients.

   If --stdio is specified, rclone will serve SFTP over stdio, which can be used with sshd via ~/.ssh/authorized_keys, for example:

          restrict,command="rclone serve sftp --stdio ./photos" ssh-rsa ...

   On the client you need to set --transfers 1 when using --stdio.  Otherwise multiple instances of the rclone server are started by OpenSSH which can  lead  to
   "corrupted  on  transfer"  errors.   This is the case because the client chooses indiscriminately which server to send commands to while the servers all have
   different views of the state of the filing system.

   The "restrict" in authorized_keys prevents SHA1SUMs and MD5SUMs from beeing used.  Omitting "restrict" and using --sftp-path-override to enable  checksumming
   is possible but less secure and you could use the SFTP server provided by OpenSSH in this case.

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud  storage  objects  have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS layer has to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not  refreshed  from  the  backend.   Changes  made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory cache ex
   pires if the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the  polling  inter
   val.

   You  can  send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These  flags  control  the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent  but  can  be  con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note  that  files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every  --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You  should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can potentially
   cause data corruption if you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't  need  to  worry  about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This  is  very  similar  to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their  full  size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When  reading  a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For  example  hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift, ftp and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less  accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can reduce the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased  number  of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and
   greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If  the  value  is  "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With  --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes  rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File  systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.   If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The  user  may  specify  a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing
   file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly  the  same  name  is  not
   found  but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.  Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system  presented  by  rclone  (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If  the  flag  is  not  provided  on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

Auth Proxy

   If  you supply the parameter --auth-proxy /path/to/program then rclone will use that program to generate backends on the fly which then are used to authenti
   cate incoming requests.  This uses a simple JSON based protocol with input on STDIN and output on STDOUT.

   PLEASE NOTE: --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used together, if --auth-proxy is set the authorized keys option will be ignored.

   There is an example program bin/test_proxy.py (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/test_proxy.py) in the rclone source code.

   The program's job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn those into the config for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format.  This config will  have  any
   default parameters for the backend added, but it won't use configuration from environment variables or command line options - it is the job of the proxy pro
   gram to make a complete config.

   This config generated must have this extra parameter - _root - root to use for the backend

   And it may have this parameter - _obscure - comma separated strings for parameters to obscure

   If password authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

          {
              "user": "me",
              "pass": "mypassword"
          }

   If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

          {
              "user": "me",
              "public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
          }

   And as an example return this on STDOUT

          {
              "type": "sftp",
              "_root": "",
              "_obscure": "pass",
              "user": "me",
              "pass": "mypassword",
              "host": "sftp.example.com"
          }

   This would mean that an SFTP backend would be created on the fly for the user and pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given.  Note that  since
   _obscure is set to pass, rclone will obscure the pass parameter before creating the backend (which is required for sftp backends).

   The  program  can  manipulate  the supplied user in any way, for example to make proxy to many different sftp backends, you could make the user be user@exam
   ple.com and then set the host to example.com in the output and the user to user.  For security you'd probably want to restrict the host to a limited list.

   Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for configuration, don't use pass or public_key.  This also means that if a user's password  or
   public-key is changed the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins) before it takes effect.

   This can be used to build general purpose proxies to any kind of backend that rclone supports.

          rclone serve sftp remote:path [flags]

Options

                --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:2022")
                --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth
                --authorized-keys string                 Authorized keys file (default "~/.ssh/authorized_keys")
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for sftp
                --key stringArray                        SSH private host key file (Can be multi-valued, leave blank to auto generate)
                --no-auth                                Allow connections with no authentication if set
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --pass string                            Password for authentication
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --stdio                                  Run an sftp server on stdin/stdout
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --user string                            User name for authentication
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone serve webdav

   Serve remote:path over WebDAV.

Synopsis

   Run  a  basic  WebDAV server to serve a remote over HTTP via the WebDAV protocol.  This can be viewed with a WebDAV client, through a web browser, or you can
   make a remote of type WebDAV to read and write it.

WebDAV options --etag-hash

   This controls the ETag header.  Without this flag the ETag will be based on the ModTime and Size of the object.

   If this flag is set to "auto" then rclone will choose the first supported hash on the backend or you can use a named hash such as "MD5" or "SHA-1".  Use  the
   hashsum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_hashsum/) command to see the full list.

Server options

   Use  --addr  to specify which IP address and port the server should listen on, e.g.  --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all IPs.  By default it
   only listens on localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

   If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

   --server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to control the timeouts on the server.  Note that this is the total time for a transfer.

   --max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will accept in the HTTP header.

   --baseurl controls the URL prefix that rclone serves from.  By default rclone will serve from the root.  If you used --baseurl "/rclone"  then  rclone  would
   serve  from  a  URL  starting  with  "/rclone/".  This is useful if you wish to proxy rclone serve.  Rclone automatically inserts leading and trailing "/" on
   --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone", --baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated identically.

   --template allows a user to specify a custom markup template for HTTP and WebDAV serve functions.  The server exports the following markup to be used  within
   the template to server pages:

   Parameter                             Description
   
   .Name                                 The full path of a file/directory.
   .Title                                Directory listing of .Name
   .Sort                                 The  current  sort  used.   This is
                                         changeable via ?sort= parameter
                                         Sort                       Options:
                                         namedirfirst,name,size,time    (de
                                         fault namedirfirst)
   .Order                                The current ordering used.  This is
                                         changeable via ?order= parameter
                                         Order  Options:  asc,desc  (default
                                         asc)
   .Query                                Currently unused.
   .Breadcrumb                           Allows for creating a relative nav
                                         igation
   -- .Link                              The  relative  to  the root link of
                                         the Text.
   -- .Text                              The Name of the directory.
   .Entries                              Information   about   a    specific
                                         file/directory.
   -- .URL                               The 'url' of an entry.
   -- .Leaf                              Currently same as 'URL' but intend
                                         ed to be 'just' the name.
   -- .IsDir                             Boolean for if an entry is a direc
                                         tory or not.
   -- .Size                              Size in Bytes of the entry.
   -- .ModTime                           The UTC timestamp of an entry.

Authentication

   By default this will serve files without needing a login.

   You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

   Use  --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file.  This is in standard apache format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic authentication.
   Bcrypt is recommended.

   To create an htpasswd file:

          touch htpasswd
          htpasswd -B htpasswd user
          htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

   The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

   Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

SSL/TLS

   By default this will serve over HTTP.  If you want you can serve over HTTPS.  You will need to supply the --cert and --key flags.  If you wish to  do  client
   side certificate validation then you will need to supply --client-ca also.

   --cert  should  be  either  a  PEM  encoded  certificate or a concatenation of that with the CA certificate.  --key should be the PEM encoded private key and
   --client-ca should be the PEM encoded client certificate authority certificate.

   --min-tls-version is minimum TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are "tls1.0", "tls1.1", "tls1.2" and "tls1.3" (default "tls1.0").

VFS - Virtual File System

   This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

   Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the VFS  layer  has  to
   deal with that.  Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

   The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

   Using  the  --dir-cache-time  flag,  you  can  control how long a directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made
   through the VFS will appear immediately or invalidate the cache.

          --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
          --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

   However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once the  directory  cache  ex
   pires  if  the backend configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes will be picked up within the polling inter
   val.

   You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance  is  running,
   you can reset the cache like this:

          kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Or individual files or directories:

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

   The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data in advance.

   Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be shared.

   This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buf
   fer is empty, only a small amount of memory will be used.

   The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

   These flags control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.   It  can  be
   disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

   For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously to a file.  See below for more details.

   Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need one or the other or both.

          --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
          --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
          --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
          --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
          --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
          --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

   If  run  with  -vv  rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be con‐
   trolled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate environment variable.

   The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

   Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone  is  quit
   or dies with files that haven't been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same flags.

   If  using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.  Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.
   Secondly because open files cannot be evicted from the cache.

   You should not run two copies of rclone using the same VFS cache with the same or overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.  This can  potentially
   cause  data  corruption  if  you do.  You can work around this by giving each rclone its own cache hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don't need to worry about
   this if the remotes in use don't overlap.

--vfs-cache-mode off

   In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

   This will mean some operations are not possible

    Files can't be opened for both read AND write

   • Files opened for write can't be seeked

    Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

    Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

    Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

    Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

    If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

   This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered to disk.  This means that files opened for write  will  be  a  lot
   more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

   These operations are not possible

    Files opened for write only can't be seeked

   • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

   • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

   • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

   In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations.

   If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

   In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

   In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

   So  if  an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the start of the file.  These files will appear to be their full size
   in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

   This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

   When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas  the  --vfs-read-ahead
   is buffered on disk.

   When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

   IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.  Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on a filesys
   tem which doesn't support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

Fingerprinting

   Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see if a local file copy has changed relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

    size

    modification time

    hash

   where available on an object.

   On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call per object, or extra work per object).

   For example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire file and hash it, and modtime is slow with the s3, swift,  ftp  and
   qinqstor backends because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

   If  you use the --vfs-fast-fingerprint flag then rclone will not include the slow operations in the fingerprint.  This makes the fingerprinting less accurate
   but much faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

   If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is recommended.

   Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

VFS Chunked Reading

   When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This
   can  reduce  the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks from the remote that are actually read, at the cost of an increased number of
   requests.

   These flags control the chunking:

          --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
          --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

   Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified,  and
   greater  than  --vfs-read-chunk-size,  the  chunk size for each open file will get doubled only until the specified value is reached.  If the value is "off",
   which is the default, the limit is disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

   With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so  on.
   When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be 0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

   Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or "off" disables chunked reading.

VFS Performance

   These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

   In  particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the modi
   fication time takes a transaction.

          --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
          --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
          --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
          --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

   Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come  in.
   These flags only come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

          --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
          --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
   modified files from the cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

          --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

   Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

   File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to  create
   the file is preserved and available for programs to query.  It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

   Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

   The  --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If
   the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

   The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what is stored on the remote.  If an argument  refers  to  an  existing
   file  with  exactly  the  same  name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file name with exactly the same name is not
   found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file is requested.   Case
   sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the underlying remote.

   Note  that  case  sensitivity  of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ from case sensitivity of a file system presented by rclone (the
   source).  The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

   If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends on the operating system where rclone  runs:  "true"  on  Windows  and  macOS,
   "false" otherwise.  If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

VFS Disk Options

   This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

          --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

Alternate report of used bytes

   Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then
   pass the flag --vfs-used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report this information, rclone will scan the whole re
   mote similar to rclone size and compute the total used space itself.

   WARNING. Contrary to rclone size, this flag ignores filters so that the result is accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls
   resulting in extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

Auth Proxy

   If you supply the parameter --auth-proxy /path/to/program then rclone will use that program to generate backends on the fly which then are used to  authenti
   cate incoming requests.  This uses a simple JSON based protocol with input on STDIN and output on STDOUT.

   PLEASE NOTE: --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used together, if --auth-proxy is set the authorized keys option will be ignored.

   There is an example program bin/test_proxy.py (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/test_proxy.py) in the rclone source code.

   The  program's  job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn those into the config for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format.  This config will have any
   default parameters for the backend added, but it won't use configuration from environment variables or command line options - it is the job of the proxy pro
   gram to make a complete config.

   This config generated must have this extra parameter - _root - root to use for the backend

   And it may have this parameter - _obscure - comma separated strings for parameters to obscure

   If password authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

          {
              "user": "me",
              "pass": "mypassword"
          }

   If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

          {
              "user": "me",
              "public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
          }

   And as an example return this on STDOUT

          {
              "type": "sftp",
              "_root": "",
              "_obscure": "pass",
              "user": "me",
              "pass": "mypassword",
              "host": "sftp.example.com"
          }

   This  would mean that an SFTP backend would be created on the fly for the user and pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given.  Note that since
   _obscure is set to pass, rclone will obscure the pass parameter before creating the backend (which is required for sftp backends).

   The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example to make proxy to many different sftp backends, you could make  the  user  be  user@exam
   ple.com and then set the host to example.com in the output and the user to user.  For security you'd probably want to restrict the host to a limited list.

   Note  that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for configuration, don't use pass or public_key.  This also means that if a user's password or
   public-key is changed the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins) before it takes effect.

   This can be used to build general purpose proxies to any kind of backend that rclone supports.

          rclone serve webdav remote:path [flags]

Options

                --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:8080")
                --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth
                --baseurl string                         Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                --cert string                            SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                --client-ca string                       Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                --disable-dir-list                       Disable HTML directory list on GET request for a directory
                --etag-hash string                       Which hash to use for the ETag, or auto or blank for off
                --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
            -h, --help                                   help for webdav
                --htpasswd string                        htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                --key string                             SSL PEM Private key
                --max-header-bytes int                   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                --min-tls-version string                 Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                --pass string                            Password for authentication
                --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                --realm string                           Realm for authentication (default "rclone")
                --server-read-timeout duration           Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                --server-write-timeout duration          Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                --template string                        User-specified template
                --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows)
                --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 18)
                --user string                            User name for authentication
                --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/) - Serve a remote over a protocol.

rclone settier

   Changes storage class/tier of objects in remote.

Synopsis

   rclone settier changes storage tier or class at remote if supported.  Few cloud storage services provides different storage classes on objects,  for  example
   AWS S3 and Glacier, Azure Blob storage - Hot, Cool and Archive, Google Cloud Storage, Regional Storage, Nearline, Coldline etc.

   Note  that,  certain  tier  changes  make objects not available to access immediately.  For example tiering to archive in azure blob storage makes objects in
   frozen state, user can restore by setting tier to Hot/Cool, similarly S3 to Glacier makes object inaccessible.true

   You can use it to tier single object

          rclone settier Cool remote:path/file

   Or use rclone filters to set tier on only specific files

          rclone --include "*.txt" settier Hot remote:path/dir

   Or just provide remote directory and all files in directory will be tiered

          rclone settier tier remote:path/dir

          rclone settier tier remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for settier

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone test

   Run a test command

Synopsis

   Rclone test is used to run test commands.

   Select which test comand you want with the subcommand, eg

          rclone test memory remote:

   Each subcommand has its own options which you can see in their help.

   NB Be careful running these commands, they may do strange things so reading their documentation first is recommended.

Options

            -h, --help   help for test

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

    rclone test changenotify (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_changenotify/) - Log any change notify requests for the remote passed in.

    rclone test histogram (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_histogram/) - Makes a histogram of file name characters.

    rclone test info (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_info/) - Discovers file name or other limitations for paths.

    rclone test makefile (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_makefile/) - Make files with random contents of the size given

    rclone test makefiles (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_makefiles/) - Make a random file hierarchy in a directory

    rclone test memory (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_memory/) - Load all the objects at remote:path into memory and report memory stats.

rclone test changenotify

   Log any change notify requests for the remote passed in.

          rclone test changenotify remote: [flags]

Options

            -h, --help                     help for changenotify
                --poll-interval duration   Time to wait between polling for changes (default 10s)

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test histogram

   Makes a histogram of file name characters.

Synopsis

   This command outputs JSON which shows the histogram of characters used in filenames in the remote:path specified.

   The data doesn't contain any identifying information but is useful for the rclone developers when developing filename compression.

          rclone test histogram [remote:path] [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for histogram

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test info

   Discovers file name or other limitations for paths.

Synopsis

   rclone info discovers what filenames and upload methods are possible to write to the paths passed in and how long they can be.  It can take  some  time.   It
   will write test files into the remote:path passed in.  It outputs a bit of go code for each one.

   NB this can create undeletable files and other hazards - use with care

          rclone test info [remote:path]+ [flags]

Options

                --all                    Run all tests
                --check-control          Check control characters
                --check-length           Check max filename length
                --check-normalization    Check UTF-8 Normalization
                --check-streaming        Check uploads with indeterminate file size
            -h, --help                   help for info
                --upload-wait duration   Wait after writing a file
                --write-json string      Write results to file

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test makefile

   Make files with random contents of the size given

          rclone test makefile <size> [<file>]+ [flags]

Options

                --ascii      Fill files with random ASCII printable bytes only
                --chargen    Fill files with a ASCII chargen pattern
            -h, --help       help for makefile
                --pattern    Fill files with a periodic pattern
                --seed int   Seed for the random number generator (0 for random) (default 1)
                --sparse     Make the files sparse (appear to be filled with ASCII 0x00)
                --zero       Fill files with ASCII 0x00

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test makefiles

   Make a random file hierarchy in a directory

          rclone test makefiles <dir> [flags]

Options

                --ascii                      Fill files with random ASCII printable bytes only
                --chargen                    Fill files with a ASCII chargen pattern
                --files int                  Number of files to create (default 1000)
                --files-per-directory int    Average number of files per directory (default 10)
            -h, --help                       help for makefiles
                --max-file-size SizeSuffix   Maximum size of files to create (default 100)
                --max-name-length int        Maximum size of file names (default 12)
                --min-file-size SizeSuffix   Minimum size of file to create
                --min-name-length int        Minimum size of file names (default 4)
                --pattern                    Fill files with a periodic pattern
                --seed int                   Seed for the random number generator (0 for random) (default 1)
                --sparse                     Make the files sparse (appear to be filled with ASCII 0x00)
                --zero                       Fill files with ASCII 0x00

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test memory

   Load all the objects at remote:path into memory and report memory stats.

          rclone test memory remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help   help for memory

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone touch

   Create new file or change file modification time.

Synopsis

   Set the modification time on file(s) as specified by remote:path to have the current time.

   If remote:path does not exist then a zero sized file will be created, unless --no-create or --recursive is provided.

   If  --recursive  is  used then recursively sets the modification time on all existing files that is found under the path.  Filters are supported, and you can
   test with the --dry-run or the --interactive flag.

   If --timestamp is used then sets the modification time to that time instead of the current time.  Times may be specified as one of:

    'YYMMDD' - e.g.  17.10.30

    'YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS' - e.g.  2006-01-02T15:04:05

    'YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS.SSS' - e.g.  2006-01-02T15:04:05.123456789

   Note that value of --timestamp is in UTC.  If you want local time then add the --localtime flag.

          rclone touch remote:path [flags]

Options

            -h, --help               help for touch
                --localtime          Use localtime for timestamp, not UTC
            -C, --no-create          Do not create the file if it does not exist (implied with --recursive)
            -R, --recursive          Recursively touch all files
            -t, --timestamp string   Use specified time instead of the current time of day

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone tree

   List the contents of the remote in a tree like fashion.

Synopsis

   rclone tree lists the contents of a remote in a similar way to the unix tree command.

   For example

          $ rclone tree remote:path
          /
           file1
           file2
           file3
           subdir
               file4
               file5

          1 directories, 5 files

   You can use any of the filtering options with the tree command (e.g.  --include and --exclude.  You can also use --fast-list.

   The tree command has many options for controlling the listing which are compatible with the tree command, for example you can include file sizes with --size.
   Note that not all of them have short options as they conflict with rclone's short options.

   For a more interactive navigation of the remote see the ncdu (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ncdu/) command.

          rclone tree remote:path [flags]

Options

            -a, --all             All files are listed (list . files too)
            -C, --color           Turn colorization on always
            -d, --dirs-only       List directories only
                --dirsfirst       List directories before files (-U disables)
                --full-path       Print the full path prefix for each file
            -h, --help            help for tree
                --level int       Descend only level directories deep
            -D, --modtime         Print the date of last modification.
                --noindent        Don't print indentation lines
                --noreport        Turn off file/directory count at end of tree listing
            -o, --output string   Output to file instead of stdout
            -p, --protections     Print the protections for each file.
            -Q, --quote           Quote filenames with double quotes.
            -s, --size            Print the size in bytes of each file.
                --sort string     Select sort: name,version,size,mtime,ctime
                --sort-ctime      Sort files by last status change time
            -t, --sort-modtime    Sort files by last modification time
            -r, --sort-reverse    Reverse the order of the sort
            -U, --unsorted        Leave files unsorted
                --version         Sort files alphanumerically by version

   See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

    rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

Copying single files

   rclone  normally  syncs or copies directories.  However, if the source remote points to a file, rclone will just copy that file.  The destination remote must
   point to a directory - rclone will give the error Failed to create file system for "remote:file": is a file not a directory if it isn't.

   For example, suppose you have a remote with a file in called test.jpg, then you could copy just that file like this

          rclone copy remote:test.jpg /tmp/download

   The file test.jpg will be placed inside /tmp/download.

   This is equivalent to specifying

          rclone copy --files-from /tmp/files remote: /tmp/download

   Where /tmp/files contains the single line

          test.jpg

   It is recommended to use copy when copying individual files, not sync.  They have pretty much the same effect but copy will use a lot less memory.

Syntax of remote paths

   The syntax of the paths passed to the rclone command are as follows.

/path/to/dir

   This refers to the local file system.

   On Windows \ may be used instead of / in local paths only, non local paths must use /.   See  local  filesystem  (https://rclone.org/local/#paths-on-windows)
   documentation for more about Windows-specific paths.

   These paths needn't start with a leading / - if they don't then they will be relative to the current directory.

remote:path/to/dir

   This refers to a directory path/to/dir on remote: as defined in the config file (configured with rclone config).

remote:/path/to/dir

   On  most  backends  this  is refers to the same directory as remote:path/to/dir and that format should be preferred.  On a very small number of remotes (FTP,
   SFTP, Dropbox for business) this will refer to a different directory.  On these, paths without a leading / will refer to your "home" directory and paths with
   a leading / will refer to the root.

:backend:path/to/dir

   This  is  an advanced form for creating remotes on the fly.  backend should be the name or prefix of a backend (the type in the config file) and all the con
   figuration for the backend should be provided on the command line (or in environment variables).

   Here are some examples:

          rclone lsd --http-url https://pub.rclone.org :http:

   To list all the directories in the root of https://pub.rclone.org/.

          rclone lsf --http-url https://example.com :http:path/to/dir

   To list files and directories in https://example.com/path/to/dir/

          rclone copy --http-url https://example.com :http:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

   To copy files and directories in https://example.com/path/to/dir to /tmp/dir.

          rclone copy --sftp-host example.com :sftp:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

   To copy files and directories from example.com in the relative directory path/to/dir to /tmp/dir using sftp.

Connection strings

   The above examples can also be written using a connection string syntax, so instead  of  providing  the  arguments  as  command  line  parameters  --http-url
   https://pub.rclone.org they are provided as part of the remote specification as a kind of connection string.

          rclone lsd ":http,url='https://pub.rclone.org':"
          rclone lsf ":http,url='https://example.com':path/to/dir"
          rclone copy ":http,url='https://example.com':path/to/dir" /tmp/dir
          rclone copy :sftp,host=example.com:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

   These  can  apply  to  modify  existing  remotes as well as create new remotes with the on the fly syntax.  This example is equivalent to adding the --drive-
   shared-with-me parameter to the remote gdrive:.

          rclone lsf "gdrive,shared_with_me:path/to/dir"

   The major advantage to using the connection string style syntax is that it only applies to the remote, not to all the remotes of that  type  of  the  command
   line.   A  common  confusion is this attempt to copy a file shared on google drive to the normal drive which does not work because the --drive-shared-with-me
   flag applies to both the source and the destination.

          rclone copy --drive-shared-with-me gdrive:shared-file.txt gdrive:

   However using the connection string syntax, this does work.

          rclone copy "gdrive,shared_with_me:shared-file.txt" gdrive:

   Note that the connection string only affects the options of the immediate backend.  If for example gdriveCrypt is a crypt based on gdrive, then the following
   command will not work as intended, because shared_with_me is ignored by the crypt backend:

          rclone copy "gdriveCrypt,shared_with_me:shared-file.txt" gdriveCrypt:

   The connection strings have the following syntax

          remote,parameter=value,parameter2=value2:path/to/dir
          :backend,parameter=value,parameter2=value2:path/to/dir

   If the parameter has a : or , then it must be placed in quotes " or ', so

          remote,parameter="colon:value",parameter2="comma,value":path/to/dir
          :backend,parameter='colon:value',parameter2='comma,value':path/to/dir

   If a quoted value needs to include that quote, then it should be doubled, so

          remote,parameter="with""quote",parameter2='with''quote':path/to/dir

   This will make parameter be with"quote and parameter2 be with'quote.

   If you leave off the =parameter then rclone will substitute =true which works very well with flags.  For example, to use s3 configured in the environment you
   could use:

          rclone lsd :s3,env_auth:

   Which is equivalent to

          rclone lsd :s3,env_auth=true:

   Note that on the command line you might need to surround these connection strings with " or ' to stop the shell interpreting any  special  characters  within
   them.

   If  you  are  a  shell  master  then you'll know which strings are OK and which aren't, but if you aren't sure then enclose them in " and use ' as the inside
   quote.  This syntax works on all OSes.

          rclone copy ":http,url='https://example.com':path/to/dir" /tmp/dir

   On Linux/macOS some characters are still interpreted inside " strings in the shell (notably \ and $ and ") so if your strings contain those you can swap  the
   roles of " and ' thus.  (This syntax does not work on Windows.)

          rclone copy ':http,url="https://example.com":path/to/dir' /tmp/dir

Connection strings, config and logging

   If  you  supply  extra  configuration to a backend by command line flag, environment variable or connection string then rclone will add a suffix based on the
   hash of the config to the name of the remote, eg

          rclone -vv lsf --s3-chunk-size 20M s3:

   Has the log message

          DEBUG : s3: detected overridden config - adding "{Srj1p}" suffix to name

   This is so rclone can tell the modified remote apart from the unmodified remote when caching the backends.

   This should only be noticeable in the logs.

   This means that on the fly backends such as

          rclone -vv lsf :s3,env_auth:

   Will get their own names

          DEBUG : :s3: detected overridden config - adding "{YTu53}" suffix to name

Valid remote names

   Remote names are case sensitive, and must adhere to the following rules: - May contain number, letter, _, -, ., +, @ and space.  - May not start  with  -  or
   space.  - May not end with space.

   Starting  with  rclone  version 1.61, any Unicode numbers and letters are allowed, while in older versions it was limited to plain ASCII (0-9, A-Z, a-z).  If
   you use the same rclone configuration from different shells, which may be configured with different character encoding, you must be cautious to  use  charac
   ters  that are possible to write in all of them.  This is mostly a problem on Windows, where the console traditionally uses a non-Unicode character set - de
   fined by the so-called "code page".

Quoting and the shell

   When you are typing commands to your computer you are using something called the command line shell.  This interprets various characters in  an  OS  specific
   way.

   Here are some gotchas which may help users unfamiliar with the shell rules

Linux / OSX

   If your names have spaces or shell metacharacters (e.g.  *, ?, $, ', ", etc.)  then you must quote them.  Use single quotes ' by default.

          rclone copy 'Important files?' remote:backup

   If you want to send a ' you will need to use ", e.g.

          rclone copy "O'Reilly Reviews" remote:backup

   The rules for quoting metacharacters are complicated and if you want the full details you'll have to consult the manual page for your shell.

Windows

   If your names have spaces in you need to put them in ", e.g.

          rclone copy "E:\folder name\folder name\folder name" remote:backup

   If you are using the root directory on its own then don't quote it (see #464 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/464) for why), e.g.

          rclone copy E:\ remote:backup

Copying files or directories with : in the names

   rclone  uses  : to mark a remote name.  This is, however, a valid filename component in non-Windows OSes.  The remote name parser will only search for a : up
   to the first / so if you need to act on a file or directory like this then use the full path starting with a /, or use ./ as a current directory prefix.

   So to sync a directory called sync:me to a remote called remote: use

          rclone sync --interactive ./sync:me remote:path

   or

          rclone sync --interactive /full/path/to/sync:me remote:path

Server Side Copy

   Most remotes (but not all - see the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)) support server-side copy.

   This means if you want to copy one folder to another then rclone won't download all the files and re-upload them; it will instruct the server to copy them in
   place.

   Eg

          rclone copy s3:oldbucket s3:newbucket

   Will copy the contents of oldbucket to newbucket without downloading and re-uploading.

   Remotes which don't support server-side copy will download and re-upload in this case.

   Server  side  copies  are  used  with  sync  and copy and will be identified in the log when using the -v flag.  The move command may also use them if remote
   doesn't support server-side move directly.  This is done by issuing a server-side copy then a delete which is much quicker than a download and re-upload.

   Server side copies will only be attempted if the remote names are the same.

   This can be used when scripting to make aged backups efficiently, e.g.

          rclone sync --interactive remote:current-backup remote:previous-backup
          rclone sync --interactive /path/to/files remote:current-backup

Metadata support

   Metadata is data about a file which isn't the contents of the file.  Normally rclone only preserves the modification time and the content (MIME)  type  where
   possible.

   Rclone supports preserving all the available metadata on files (not directories) when using the --metadata or -M flag.

   Exactly  what metadata is supported and what that support means depends on the backend.  Backends that support metadata have a metadata section in their docs
   and are listed in the features table (https://rclone.org/overview/#features) (Eg local (https://rclone.org/local/#metadata), s3)

   Rclone only supports a one-time sync of metadata.  This means that metadata will be synced from the source object to the destination  object  only  when  the
   source  object has changed and needs to be re-uploaded.  If the metadata subsequently changes on the source object without changing the object itself then it
   won't be synced to the destination object.  This is in line with the way rclone syncs Content-Type without the --metadata flag.

   Using --metadata when syncing from local to local will preserve file attributes such as file mode, owner, extended attributes (not Windows).

   Note that arbitrary metadata may be added to objects using the --metadata-set key=value flag when the object is first uploaded.  This flag can be repeated as
   many times as necessary.

Types of metadata

   Metadata is divided into two type.  System metadata and User metadata.

   Metadata  which  the  backend  uses itself is called system metadata.  For example on the local backend the system metadata uid will store the user ID of the
   file when used on a unix based platform.

   Arbitrary metadata is called user metadata and this can be set however is desired.

   When objects are copied from backend to backend, they will attempt to interpret system metadata if it is supplied.  Metadata may change from being user meta
   data  to system metadata as objects are copied between different backends.  For example copying an object from s3 sets the content-type metadata.  In a back
   end which understands this (like azureblob) this will become the Content-Type of the object.  In a backend which doesn't  understand  this  (like  the  local
   backend) this will become user metadata.  However should the local object be copied back to s3, the Content-Type will be set correctly.

Metadata framework

   Rclone implements a metadata framework which can read metadata from an object and write it to the object when (and only when) it is being uploaded.

   This metadata is stored as a dictionary with string keys and string values.

   There are some limits on the names of the keys (these may be clarified further in the future).

    must be lower case

    may be a-z 0-9 containing . - or _

    length is backend dependent

   Each backend can provide system metadata that it understands.  Some backends can also store arbitrary user metadata.

   Where  possible the key names are standardized, so, for example, it is possible to copy object metadata from s3 to azureblob for example and metadata will be
   translated appropriately.

   Some backends have limits on the size of the metadata and rclone will give errors on upload if they are exceeded.

Metadata preservation

   The goal of the implementation is to

   1. Preserve metadata if at all possible

   2. Interpret metadata if at all possible

   The consequences of 1 is that you can copy an S3 object to a local disk then back to S3 losslessly.  Likewise you can copy a local file with file  attributes
   and xattrs from local disk to s3 and back again losslessly.

   The consequence of 2 is that you can copy an S3 object with metadata to Azureblob (say) and have the metadata appear on the Azureblob object also.

Standard system metadata

   Here is a table of standard system metadata which, if appropriate, a backend may implement.

   key                                  description             example
   
   mode                                 File  type  and mode:   0100664
                                        octal, unix style
   uid                                  User  ID  of   owner:   500
                                        decimal number
   gid                                  Group  ID  of  owner:   500
                                        decimal number
   rdev                                 Device ID (if special   0
                                        file) => hexadecimal
   atime                                Time  of last access:   2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00
                                        RFC 3339
   mtime                                Time  of last modifi   2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00
                                        cation: RFC 3339
   btime                                Time of file creation   2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00
                                        (birth): RFC 3339
   cache-control                        Cache-Control header    no-cache
   content-disposition                  Content-Disposition     inline
                                        header
   content-encoding                     Content-Encoding        gzip
                                        header
   content-language                     Content-Language        en-US
                                        header
   content-type                         Content-Type header     text/plain

   The metadata keys mtime and content-type will take precedence if supplied in the metadata over reading the Content-Type or modification time  of  the  source
   object.

   Hashes are not included in system metadata as there is a well defined way of reading those already.

Options

   Rclone has a number of options to control its behaviour.

   Options  that take parameters can have the values passed in two ways, --option=value or --option value.  However boolean (true/false) options behave slightly
   differently to the other options in that --boolean sets the option to true and the absence of the flag sets it to false.  It  is  also  possible  to  specify
   --boolean=false or --boolean=true.  Note that --boolean false is not valid - this is parsed as --boolean and the false is parsed as an extra command line ar
   gument for rclone.

Time or duration options

   TIME or DURATION options can be specified as a duration string or a time string.

   A duration string is a possibly signed sequence of decimal numbers, each with optional fraction and a unit suffix, such as "300ms", "-1.5h" or "2h45m".   De
   fault units are seconds or the following abbreviations are valid:

    ms - Milliseconds

    s - Seconds

    m - Minutes

    h - Hours

    d - Days

    w - Weeks

    M - Months

    y - Years

   These can also be specified as an absolute time in the following formats:

    RFC3339 - e.g.  2006-01-02T15:04:05Z or 2006-01-02T15:04:05+07:00

    ISO8601 Date and time, local timezone - 2006-01-02T15:04:05

    ISO8601 Date and time, local timezone - 2006-01-02 15:04:05

    ISO8601 Date - 2006-01-02 (YYYY-MM-DD)

Size options

   Options  which  use SIZE use KiB (multiples of 1024 bytes) by default.  However, a suffix of B for Byte, K for KiB, M for MiB, G for GiB, T for TiB and P for
   PiB may be used.  These are the binary units, e.g.  1, 2**10, 2**20, 2**30 respectively.

--backup-dir=DIR

   When using sync, copy or move any files which would have been overwritten or deleted are moved in their original hierarchy into this directory.

   If --suffix is set, then the moved files will have the suffix added to them.  If there is a file with the same path (after the suffix has been added) in DIR,
   then it will be overwritten.

   The remote in use must support server-side move or copy and you must use the same remote as the destination of the sync.  The backup directory must not over
   lap the destination directory without it being excluded by a filter rule.

   For example

          rclone sync --interactive /path/to/local remote:current --backup-dir remote:old

   will sync /path/to/local to remote:current, but for any files which would have been updated or deleted will be stored in remote:old.

   If running rclone from a script you might want to use today's date as the directory name passed to --backup-dir to store the old files, or you might want  to
   pass --suffix with today's date.

   See --compare-dest and --copy-dest.

--bind string

   Local  address  to  bind  to  for  outgoing connections.  This can be an IPv4 address (1.2.3.4), an IPv6 address (1234::789A) or host name.  If the host name
   doesn't resolve or resolves to more than one IP address it will give an error.

--bwlimit=BANDWIDTH_SPEC

   This option controls the bandwidth limit.  For example

          --bwlimit 10M

   would mean limit the upload and download bandwidth to 10 MiB/s.  NB this is bytes per second not bits per second.  To use a single limit, specify the desired
   bandwidth in KiB/s, or use a suffix B|K|M|G|T|P.  The default is 0 which means to not limit bandwidth.

   The upload and download bandwidth can be specified separately, as --bwlimit UP:DOWN, so

          --bwlimit 10M:100k

   would  mean limit the upload bandwidth to 10 MiB/s and the download bandwidth to 100 KiB/s.  Either limit can be "off" meaning no limit, so to just limit the
   upload bandwidth you would use

          --bwlimit 10M:off

   this would limit the upload bandwidth to 10 MiB/s but the download bandwidth would be unlimited.

   When specified as above the bandwidth limits last for the duration of run of the rclone binary.

   It is also possible to specify a "timetable" of limits, which will cause certain limits to be applied at certain times.  To specify a timetable, format  your
   entries as WEEKDAY-HH:MM,BANDWIDTH WEEKDAY-HH:MM,BANDWIDTH... where: WEEKDAY is optional element.

    BANDWIDTH can be a single number, e.g.100k or a pair of numbers for upload:download, e.g.10M:1M.

    WEEKDAY can be written as the whole word or only using the first 3 characters.  It is optional.

    HH:MM is an hour from 00:00 to 23:59.

   An example of a typical timetable to avoid link saturation during daytime working hours could be:

   --bwlimit "08:00,512k 12:00,10M 13:00,512k 18:00,30M 23:00,off"

   In  this  example, the transfer bandwidth will be set to 512 KiB/s at 8am every day.  At noon, it will rise to 10 MiB/s, and drop back to 512 KiB/sec at 1pm.
   At 6pm, the bandwidth limit will be set to 30 MiB/s, and at 11pm it will be completely disabled (full speed).  Anything between 11pm and 8am will remain  un
   limited.

   An example of timetable with WEEKDAY could be:

   --bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512 Fri-23:59,10M Sat-10:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

   It  means  that, the transfer bandwidth will be set to 512 KiB/s on Monday.  It will rise to 10 MiB/s before the end of Friday.  At 10:00 on Saturday it will
   be set to 1 MiB/s.  From 20:00 on Sunday it will be unlimited.

   Timeslots without WEEKDAY are extended to the whole week.  So this example:

   --bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512 12:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

   Is equivalent to this:

   --bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512Mon-12:00,1M Tue-12:00,1M Wed-12:00,1M Thu-12:00,1M Fri-12:00,1M Sat-12:00,1M Sun-12:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

   Bandwidth limit apply to the data transfer for all backends.  For most backends the directory listing bandwidth is also included (exceptions  being  the  non
   HTTP backends, ftp, sftp and storj).

   Note  that  the  units  are  Byte/s,  not bit/s.  Typically connections are measured in bit/s - to convert divide by 8.  For example, let's say you have a 10
   Mbit/s connection and you wish rclone to use half of it - 5 Mbit/s.  This is 5/8 = 0.625 MiB/s so you would use a --bwlimit 0.625M parameter for rclone.

   On Unix systems (Linux, macOS, ...)  the bandwidth limiter can be toggled by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to rclone.  This allows to remove the limitations of  a
   long  running  rclone  transfer and to restore it back to the value specified with --bwlimit quickly when needed.  Assuming there is only one rclone instance
   running, you can toggle the limiter like this:

          kill -SIGUSR2 $(pidof rclone)

   If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use change the bwlimit dynamically:

          rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M

--bwlimit-file=BANDWIDTH_SPEC

   This option controls per file bandwidth limit.  For the options see the --bwlimit flag.

   For example use this to allow no transfers to be faster than 1 MiB/s

          --bwlimit-file 1M

   This can be used in conjunction with --bwlimit.

   Note that if a schedule is provided the file will use the schedule in effect at the start of the transfer.

--buffer-size=SIZE

   Use this sized buffer to speed up file transfers.  Each --transfer will use this much memory for buffering.

   When using mount or cmount each open file descriptor will use this much memory for buffering.  See the mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#file-
   buffering) documentation for more details.

   Set to 0 to disable the buffering for the minimum memory usage.

   Note that the memory allocation of the buffers is influenced by the --use-mmap flag.

--cache-dir=DIR

   Specify the directory rclone will use for caching, to override the default.

   Default  value is depending on operating system: - Windows %LocalAppData%\rclone, if LocalAppData is defined.  - macOS $HOME/Library/Caches/rclone if HOME is
   defined.  - Unix $XDG_CACHE_HOME/rclone if XDG_CACHE_HOME is defined, else $HOME/.cache/rclone if HOME is defined.  - Fallback (on all OS) to $TMPDIR/rclone,
   where TMPDIR is the value from --temp-dir.

   You can use the config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) command to see the current value.

   Cache  directory  is  heavily  used  by  the  VFS  File Caching (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#vfs-file-caching) mount feature, but also by serve
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/), GUI and other parts of rclone.

--check-first

   If this flag is set then in a sync, copy or move, rclone will do all the checks to see whether files need to be transferred before doing any  of  the  trans
   fers.  Normally rclone would start running transfers as soon as possible.

   This flag can be useful on IO limited systems where transfers interfere with checking.

   It can also be useful to ensure perfect ordering when using --order-by.

   If  both  --check-first and --order-by are set when doing rclone move then rclone will use the transfer thread to delete source files which don't need trans
   ferring.  This will enable perfect ordering of the transfers and deletes but will cause the transfer stats to have more items in than expected.

   Using this flag can use more memory as it effectively sets --max-backlog to infinite.  This means that all the info on the objects to  transfer  is  held  in
   memory before the transfers start.

--checkers=N

   Originally  controlling just the number of file checkers to run in parallel, e.g.  by rclone copy.  Now a fairly universal parallelism control used by rclone
   in several places.

   Note: checkers do the equality checking of files during a sync.  For some storage systems (e.g.  S3, Swift, Dropbox) this can take a  significant  amount  of
   time so they are run in parallel.

   The  default  is to run 8 checkers in parallel.  However, in case of slow-reacting backends you may need to lower (rather than increase) this default by set
   ting --checkers to 4 or less threads.  This is especially advised if you are experiencing backend server crashes during file checking phase (e.g.  on  subse
   quent  or top-up backups where little or no file copying is done and checking takes up most of the time).  Increase this setting only with utmost care, while
   monitoring your server health and file checking throughput.

-c, --checksum

   Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to see if they are equal.  If you set this flag then rclone will check  the  file  hash  and
   size to determine if files are equal.

   This is useful when the remote doesn't support setting modified time and a more accurate sync is desired than just checking the file size.

   This is very useful when transferring between remotes which store the same hash type on the object, e.g.  Drive and Swift.  For details of which remotes sup‐
   port which hash type see the table in the overview section (https://rclone.org/overview/).

   Eg rclone --checksum sync s3:/bucket swift:/bucket would run much quicker than without the --checksum flag.

   When using this flag, rclone won't update mtimes of remote files if they are incorrect as it would normally.

--color WHEN

   Specifiy when colors (and other ANSI codes) should be added to the output.

   AUTO (default) only allows ANSI codes when the output is a terminal

   NEVER never allow ANSI codes

   ALWAYS always add ANSI codes, regardless of the output format (terminal or file)

--compare-dest=DIR

   When using sync, copy or move DIR is checked in addition to the destination for files.  If a file identical to the source is found that file  is  NOT  copied
   from source.  This is useful to copy just files that have changed since the last backup.

   You must use the same remote as the destination of the sync.  The compare directory must not overlap the destination directory.

   See --copy-dest and --backup-dir.

--config=CONFIG_FILE

   Specify the location of the rclone configuration file, to override the default.  E.g.  rclone config --config="rclone.conf".

   The  exact default is a bit complex to describe, due to changes introduced through different versions of rclone while preserving backwards compatibility, but
   in most cases it is as simple as:

    %APPDATA%/rclone/rclone.conf on Windows

    ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf on other

   The complete logic is as follows: Rclone will look for an existing configuration file in any of the following locations, in priority order:

   1. rclone.conf (in program directory, where rclone executable is)

   2. %APPDATA%/rclone/rclone.conf (only on Windows)

   3. $XDG_CONFIG_HOME/rclone/rclone.conf (on all systems, including Windows)

   4. ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf (see below for explanation of ~ symbol)

   5. ~/.rclone.conf

   If no existing configuration file is found, then a new one will be created in the following location:

    On Windows: Location 2 listed above, except in the unlikely event that APPDATA is not defined, then location 4 is used instead.

    On Unix: Location 3 if XDG_CONFIG_HOME is defined, else location 4.

    Fallback to location 5 (on all OS), when the rclone directory cannot be created, but if also a home directory was not found then path .rclone.conf relative
     to current working directory will be used as a final resort.

   The ~ symbol in paths above represent the home directory of the current user on any OS, and the value is defined as following:

    On Windows: %HOME% if defined, else %USERPROFILE%, or else %HOMEDRIVE%\%HOMEPATH%.

    On  Unix:  $HOME if defined, else by looking up current user in OS-specific user database (e.g.  passwd file), or else use the result from shell command cd
     && pwd.

   If you run rclone config file you will see where the default location is for you.

   The fact that an existing file rclone.conf in the same directory as the rclone executable is always preferred, means that it is easy  to  run  in  "portable"
   mode by downloading rclone executable to a writable directory and then create an empty file rclone.conf in the same directory.

   If  the  location  is set to empty string "" or path to a file with name notfound, or the os null device represented by value NUL on Windows and /dev/null on
   Unix systems, then rclone will keep the config file in memory only.

   The file format is basic INI (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/INI_file#Format): Sections of text, led by a [section] header and followed by  key=value  entries
   on separate lines.  In rclone each remote is represented by its own section, where the section name defines the name of the remote.  Options are specified as
   the key=value entries, where the key is the option name without the --backend- prefix, in lowercase and with _ instead of -.  E.g.  option --mega-hard-delete
   corresponds   to   key  hard_delete.   Only  backend  options  can  be  specified.   A  special,  and  required,  key  type  identifies  the  storage  system
   (https://rclone.org/overview/), where the value is the internal lowercase name as returned by command rclone help backends.  Comments are indicated by ; or #
   at the beginning of a line.

   Example:

          [megaremote]
          type = mega
          user = you@example.com
          pass = PDPcQVVjVtzFY-GTdDFozqBhTdsPg3qH

   Note  that  passwords are in obscured (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/) form.  Also, many storage systems uses token-based authentication instead
   of passwords, and this requires additional steps.  It is easier, and safer, to use the interactive command rclone config instead of manually editing the con
   figuration file.

   The  configuration file will typically contain login information, and should therefore have restricted permissions so that only the current user can read it.
   Rclone tries to ensure this when it writes the file.  You may also choose to encrypt the file.

   When token-based authentication are used, the configuration file must be writable, because rclone needs to update the tokens inside it.

--contimeout=TIME

   Set the connection timeout.  This should be in go time format which looks like 5s for 5 seconds, 10m for 10 minutes, or 3h30m.

   The connection timeout is the amount of time rclone will wait for a connection to go through to a remote object storage system.  It is 1m by default.

--copy-dest=DIR

   When using sync, copy or move DIR is checked in addition to the destination for files.  If a file identical to the source is found that file  is  server-side
   copied from DIR to the destination.  This is useful for incremental backup.

   The  remote in use must support server-side copy and you must use the same remote as the destination of the sync.  The compare directory must not overlap the
   destination directory.

   See --compare-dest and --backup-dir.

--dedupe-mode MODE

   Mode to run dedupe command in.  One of interactive, skip, first, newest, oldest, rename.  The default is interactive.
   See the dedupe command for more information as to what these options mean.

--disable FEATURE,FEATURE,...

   This disables a comma separated list of optional features.  For example to disable server-side move and server-side copy use:

          --disable move,copy

   The features can be put in any case.

   To see a list of which features can be disabled use:

          --disable help

   See the overview features (https://rclone.org/overview/#features) and optional features (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features) to get  an  idea  of
   which feature does what.

   This flag can be useful for debugging and in exceptional circumstances (e.g.  Google Drive limiting the total volume of Server Side Copies to 100 GiB/day).

--disable-http2

   This  stops  rclone  from  trying  to  use  HTTP/2  if  available.   This  can  sometimes  speed  up  transfers  due  to a problem in the Go standard library
   (https://github.com/golang/go/issues/37373).

--dscp VALUE

   Specify a DSCP value or name to use in connections.  This could help QoS system to identify traffic class.  BE, EF, DF, LE, CSx and AFxx are allowed.

   See the description of differentiated services (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Differentiated_services) to get an idea of this field.  Setting this to 1  (LE)
   to   identify   the   flow   to   SCAVENGER   class   can   avoid   occupying   too   much   bandwidth   in   a  network  with  DiffServ  support  (RFC  8622
   (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc8622)).

   For example, if you configured QoS on router to handle LE properly.  Running:

          rclone copy --dscp LE from:/from to:/to

   would make the priority lower than usual internet flows.

   This option has no effect on Windows (see golang/go#42728 (https://github.com/golang/go/issues/42728)).

-n, --dry-run

   Do a trial run with no permanent changes.  Use this to see what rclone would do without actually doing it.  Useful when setting up  the  sync  command  which
   deletes files in the destination.

--expect-continue-timeout=TIME

   This  specifies  the  amount  of  time  to  wait for a server's first response headers after fully writing the request headers if the request has an "Expect:
   100-continue" header.  Not all backends support using this.

   Zero means no timeout and causes the body to be sent immediately, without waiting for the server to approve.  This time does not include the time to send the
   request header.

   The default is 1s.  Set to 0 to disable.

--error-on-no-transfer

   By default, rclone will exit with return code 0 if there were no errors.

   This  option  allows  rclone to return exit code 9 if no files were transferred between the source and destination.  This allows using rclone in scripts, and
   triggering follow-on actions if data was copied, or skipping if not.

   NB: Enabling this option turns a usually non-fatal error into a potentially fatal one - please check and adjust your scripts accordingly!

--fs-cache-expire-duration=TIME

   When using rclone via the API rclone caches created remotes for 5 minutes by default in the "fs cache".  This means that if you do repeated  actions  on  the
   same remote then rclone won't have to build it again from scratch, which makes it more efficient.

   This flag sets the time that the remotes are cached for.  If you set it to 0 (or negative) then rclone won't cache the remotes at all.

   Note  that  if  you  use  some flags, eg --backup-dir and if this is set to 0 rclone may build two remotes (one for the source or destination and one for the
   --backup-dir where it may have only built one before.

--fs-cache-expire-interval=TIME

   This controls how often rclone checks for cached remotes to expire.  See the --fs-cache-expire-duration documentation above for more info.   The  default  is
   60s, set to 0 to disable expiry.

--header

   Add an HTTP header for all transactions.  The flag can be repeated to add multiple headers.

   If you want to add headers only for uploads use --header-upload and if you want to add headers only for downloads use --header-download.

   This flag is supported for all HTTP based backends even those not supported by --header-upload and --header-download so may be used as a workaround for those
   with care.

          rclone ls remote:test --header "X-Rclone: Foo" --header "X-LetMeIn: Yes"

--header-download

   Add an HTTP header for all download transactions.  The flag can be repeated to add multiple headers.

          rclone sync --interactive s3:test/src ~/dst --header-download "X-Amz-Meta-Test: Foo" --header-download "X-Amz-Meta-Test2: Bar"

   See the GitHub issue here (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/59) for currently supported backends.

--header-upload

   Add an HTTP header for all upload transactions.  The flag can be repeated to add multiple headers.

          rclone sync --interactive ~/src s3:test/dst --header-upload "Content-Disposition: attachment; filename='cool.html'" --header-upload "X-Amz-Meta-Test: FooBar"

   See the GitHub issue here (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/59) for currently supported backends.

--human-readable

   Rclone commands output values for sizes (e.g.  number of bytes) and counts (e.g.  number of files) either as raw numbers, or in human-readable format.

   In human-readable format the values are scaled to larger units, indicated with a suffix shown after the value, and rounded to three decimals.  Rclone consis
   tently  uses  binary  units (powers of 2) for sizes and decimal units (powers of 10) for counts.  The unit prefix for size is according to IEC standard nota
   tion, e.g.  Ki for kibi.  Used with byte unit, 1 KiB means 1024 Byte.  In list type of output, only the unit prefix appended to the  value  (e.g.   9.762Ki),
   while in more textual output the full unit is shown (e.g.  9.762 KiB).  For counts the SI standard notation is used, e.g.  prefix k for kilo.  Used with file
   counts, 1k means 1000 files.

   The various list (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ls/) commands output raw numbers by default.  Option --human-readable will make them  output  values  in
   human-readable format instead (with the short unit prefix).

   The about (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/) command outputs human-readable by default, with a command-specific option --full to output the raw num
   bers instead.

   Command size (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/) outputs both human-readable and raw numbers in the same output.

   The tree (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_tree/) command also considers --human-readable, but it will not use the exact same notation as  the  other  com
   mands: It rounds to one decimal, and uses single letter suffix, e.g.  K instead of Ki.  The reason for this is that it relies on an external library.

   The  interactive  command  ncdu (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ncdu/) shows human-readable by default, and responds to key u for toggling human-readable
   format.

--ignore-case-sync

   Using this option will cause rclone to ignore the case of the files when synchronizing so files will not be copied/synced when the existing filenames are the
   same, even if the casing is different.

--ignore-checksum

   Normally rclone will check that the checksums of transferred files match, and give an error "corrupted on transfer" if they don't.

   You can use this option to skip that check.  You should only use it if you have had the "corrupted on transfer" error message and you are sure you might want
   to transfer potentially corrupted data.

--ignore-existing

   Using this option will make rclone unconditionally skip all files that exist on the destination, no matter the content of these files.

   While this isn't a generally recommended option, it can be useful in cases where your files change due to encryption.  However,  it  cannot  correct  partial
   transfers in case a transfer was interrupted.

   When  performing a move/moveto command, this flag will leave skipped files in the source location unchanged when a file with the same name exists on the des
   tination.

--ignore-size

   Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to see if they are equal.  If you set this flag then rclone will check only the modification
   time.  If --checksum is set then it only checks the checksum.

   It will also cause rclone to skip verifying the sizes are the same after transfer.

   This   can   be   useful   for   transferring   files   to   and   from   OneDrive   which  occasionally  misreports  the  size  of  image  files  (see  #399
   (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/399) for more info).

-I, --ignore-times

   Using this option will cause rclone to unconditionally upload all files regardless of the state of files on the destination.

   Normally rclone would skip any files that have the same modification time and are the same size (or have the same checksum if using --checksum).

--immutable

   Treat source and destination files as immutable and disallow modification.

   With this option set, files will be created and deleted as requested, but existing files will never be updated.  If an existing file does not  match  between
   the source and destination, rclone will give the error Source and destination exist but do not match: immutable file modified.

   Note that only commands which transfer files (e.g.  sync, copy, move) are affected by this behavior, and only modification is disallowed.  Files may still be
   deleted explicitly (e.g.  delete, purge) or implicitly (e.g.  sync, move).  Use copy --immutable if it is desired to avoid deletion as well as modification.

   This can be useful as an additional layer of protection for immutable or append-only data sets (notably backup archives), where modification implies  corrup
   tion and should not be propagated.

-i, --interactive

   This flag can be used to tell rclone that you wish a manual confirmation before destructive operations.

   It is recommended that you use this flag while learning rclone especially with rclone sync.

   For example

          $ rclone delete --interactive /tmp/dir
          rclone: delete "important-file.txt"?
          y) Yes, this is OK (default)
          n) No, skip this
          s) Skip all delete operations with no more questions
          !) Do all delete operations with no more questions
          q) Exit rclone now.
          y/n/s/!/q> n

   The options mean

    y: Yes, this operation should go ahead.  You can also press Return for this to happen.  You'll be asked every time unless you choose s or !.

   • n: No, do not do this operation.  You'll be asked every time unless you choose s or !.

    s: Skip all the following operations of this type with no more questions.  This takes effect until rclone exits.  If there are any different kind of opera
     tions you'll be prompted for them.

   • !: Do all the following operations with no more questions.  Useful if you've decided that you don't mind rclone doing that kind of operation.   This  takes
     effect until rclone exits .  If there are any different kind of operations you'll be prompted for them.

    q: Quit rclone now, just in case!

--leave-root

   During rmdirs it will not remove root directory, even if it's empty.

--log-file=FILE

   Log  all  of  rclone's  output  to FILE.  This is not active by default.  This can be useful for tracking down problems with syncs in combination with the -v
   flag.  See the Logging section for more info.

   If FILE exists then rclone will append to it.

   Note that if you are using the logrotate program to manage rclone's logs, then you should use the copytruncate option as rclone doesn't have a signal to  ro
   tate logs.

--log-format LIST

   Comma  separated  list  of  log  format  options.   Accepted options are date, time, microseconds, pid, longfile, shortfile, UTC.  Any other keywords will be
   silently ignored.  pid will tag log messages with process identifier which useful with rclone mount --daemon.  Other accepted options are explained in the go
   documentation (https://pkg.go.dev/log#pkg-constants).  The default log format is "date,time".

--log-level LEVEL

   This sets the log level for rclone.  The default log level is NOTICE.

   DEBUG is equivalent to -vv.  It outputs lots of debug info - useful for bug reports and really finding out what rclone is doing.

   INFO is equivalent to -v.  It outputs information about each transfer and prints stats once a minute by default.

   NOTICE is the default log level if no logging flags are supplied.  It outputs very little when things are working normally.  It outputs warnings and signifi
   cant events.

   ERROR is equivalent to -q.  It only outputs error messages.

--use-json-log

   This switches the log format to JSON for rclone.  The fields of json log are level, msg, source, time.

--low-level-retries NUMBER

   This controls the number of low level retries rclone does.

   A low level retry is used to retry a failing operation - typically one HTTP request.  This might be uploading a chunk of a big file for  example.   You  will
   see low level retries in the log with the -v flag.

   This  shouldn't need to be changed from the default in normal operations.  However, if you get a lot of low level retries you may wish to reduce the value so
   rclone moves on to a high level retry (see the --retries flag) quicker.

   Disable low level retries with --low-level-retries 1.

--max-backlog=N

   This is the maximum allowable backlog of files in a sync/copy/move queued for being checked or transferred.

   This can be set arbitrarily large.  It will only use memory when the queue is in use.  Note that it will use in the order of N KiB of memory when the backlog
   is in use.

   Setting this large allows rclone to calculate how many files are pending more accurately, give a more accurate estimated finish time and make --order-by work
   more accurately.

   Setting this small will make rclone more synchronous to the listings of the remote which may be desirable.

   Setting this to a negative number will make the backlog as large as possible.

--max-delete=N

   This tells rclone not to delete more than N files.  If that limit is exceeded then a fatal error will be generated and rclone  will  stop  the  operation  in
   progress.

--max-delete-size=SIZE

   Rclone will stop deleting files when the total size of deletions has reached the size specified.  It defaults to off.

   If that limit is exceeded then a fatal error will be generated and rclone will stop the operation in progress.

--max-depth=N

   This modifies the recursion depth for all the commands except purge.

   So  if  you  do  rclone  --max-depth 1 ls remote:path you will see only the files in the top level directory.  Using --max-depth 2 means you will see all the
   files in first two directory levels and so on.

   For historical reasons the lsd command defaults to using a --max-depth of 1 - you can override this with the command line flag.

   You can use this command to disable recursion (with --max-depth 1).

   Note that if you use this with sync and --delete-excluded the files not recursed through are considered excluded and will  be  deleted  on  the  destination.
   Test first with --dry-run if you are not sure what will happen.

--max-duration=TIME

   Rclone will stop scheduling new transfers when it has run for the duration specified.

   Defaults to off.

   When the limit is reached any existing transfers will complete.

   Rclone won't exit with an error if the transfer limit is reached.

--max-transfer=SIZE

   Rclone will stop transferring when it has reached the size specified.  Defaults to off.

   When the limit is reached all transfers will stop immediately.

   Rclone will exit with exit code 8 if the transfer limit is reached.

-M, --metadata

   Setting this flag enables rclone to copy the metadata from the source to the destination.  For local backends this is ownership, permissions, xattr etc.  See
   the #metadata for more info.

--metadata-set key=value

   Add metadata key = value when uploading.  This can be repeated as many times as required.  See the #metadata for more info.

--cutoff-mode=hard|soft|cautious

   This modifies the behavior of --max-transfer Defaults to --cutoff-mode=hard.

   Specifying --cutoff-mode=hard will stop transferring immediately when Rclone reaches the limit.

   Specifying --cutoff-mode=soft will stop starting new transfers when Rclone reaches the limit.

   Specifying --cutoff-mode=cautious will try to prevent Rclone from reaching the limit.

--modify-window=TIME

   When checking whether a file has been modified, this is the maximum allowed time difference that a file can have and still be considered equivalent.

   The default is 1ns unless this is overridden by a remote.  For example OS X only stores modification times to the nearest second so if you  are  reading  and
   writing to an OS X filing system this will be 1s by default.

   This command line flag allows you to override that computed default.

--multi-thread-cutoff=SIZE

   When downloading files to the local backend above this size, rclone will use multiple threads to download the file (default 250M).

   Rclone  preallocates  the file (using fallocate(FALLOC_FL_KEEP_SIZE) on unix or NTSetInformationFile on Windows both of which takes no time) then each thread
   writes directly into the file at the correct place.  This means that rclone won't create fragmented or sparse files and there won't be any assembly  time  at
   the end of the transfer.

   The number of threads used to download is controlled by --multi-thread-streams.

   Use -vv if you wish to see info about the threads.

   This  will work with the sync/copy/move commands and friends copyto/moveto.  Multi thread downloads will be used with rclone mount and rclone serve if --vfs-
   cache-mode is set to writes or above.

   NB that this only works for a local destination but will work with any source.

   NB that multi thread copies are disabled for local to local copies as they are faster without unless --multi-thread-streams is set explicitly.

   NB on Windows using multi-thread downloads will cause the resulting files to be sparse (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sparse_file).  Use --local-no-sparse to
   disable sparse files (which may cause long delays at the start of downloads) or disable multi-thread downloads with --multi-thread-streams 0

--multi-thread-streams=N

   When  using  multi thread downloads (see above --multi-thread-cutoff) this sets the maximum number of streams to use.  Set to 0 to disable multi thread down
   loads (Default 4).

   Exactly how many streams rclone uses for the download depends on the size of the file.  To calculate the number of download streams Rclone divides  the  size
   of the file by the --multi-thread-cutoff and rounds up, up to the maximum set with --multi-thread-streams.

   So if --multi-thread-cutoff 250M and --multi-thread-streams 4 are in effect (the defaults):

    0..250 MiB files will be downloaded with 1 stream

    250..500 MiB files will be downloaded with 2 streams

    500..750 MiB files will be downloaded with 3 streams

    750+ MiB files will be downloaded with 4 streams

--no-check-dest

   The --no-check-dest can be used with move or copy and it causes rclone not to check the destination at all when copying files.

   This means that:

    the destination is not listed minimising the API calls

    files are always transferred

    this can cause duplicates on remotes which allow it (e.g.  Google Drive)

    --retries 1 is recommended otherwise you'll transfer everything again on a retry

   This flag is useful to minimise the transactions if you know that none of the files are on the destination.

   This is a specialized flag which should be ignored by most users!

--no-gzip-encoding

   Don't  set Accept-Encoding: gzip.  This means that rclone won't ask the server for compressed files automatically.  Useful if you've set the server to return
   files with Content-Encoding: gzip but you uploaded compressed files.

   There is no need to set this in normal operation, and doing so will decrease the network transfer efficiency of rclone.

--no-traverse

   The --no-traverse flag controls whether the destination file system is traversed when using the copy or move commands.  --no-traverse is not compatible  with
   sync and will be ignored if you supply it with sync.

   If  you  are  only copying a small number of files (or are filtering most of the files) and/or have a large number of files on the destination then --no-tra
   verse will stop rclone listing the destination and save time.

   However, if you are copying a large number of files, especially if you are doing a copy where lots of the files under consideration haven't changed and won't
   need copying then you shouldn't use --no-traverse.

   See rclone copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) for an example of how to use it.

--no-unicode-normalization

   Don't normalize unicode characters in filenames during the sync routine.

   Sometimes,  an operating system will store filenames containing unicode parts in their decomposed form (particularly macOS).  Some cloud storage systems will
   then recompose the unicode, resulting in duplicate files if the data is ever copied back to a local filesystem.

   Using this flag will disable that functionality, treating each unicode character as unique.  For example, by default  and é will  be  normalized  into  the
   same character.  With --no-unicode-normalization they will be treated as unique characters.

--no-update-modtime

   When using this flag, rclone won't update modification times of remote files if they are incorrect as it would normally.

   This can be used if the remote is being synced with another tool also (e.g.  the Google Drive client).

--order-by string

   The --order-by flag controls the order in which files in the backlog are processed in rclone sync, rclone copy and rclone move.

   The order by string is constructed like this.  The first part describes what aspect is being measured:

    size - order by the size of the files

    name - order by the full path of the files

    modtime - order by the modification date of the files

   This can have a modifier appended with a comma:

    ascending or asc - order so that the smallest (or oldest) is processed first

    descending or desc - order so that the largest (or newest) is processed first

    mixed - order so that the smallest is processed first for some threads and the largest for others

   If  the  modifier  is mixed then it can have an optional percentage (which defaults to 50), e.g.  size,mixed,25 which means that 25% of the threads should be
   taking the smallest items and 75% the largest.  The threads which take the smallest first will always take the smallest first and likewise the largest  first
   threads.  The mixed mode can be useful to minimise the transfer time when you are transferring a mixture of large and small files - the large files are guar
   anteed upload threads and bandwidth and the small files will be processed continuously.

   If no modifier is supplied then the order is ascending.

   For example

    --order-by size,desc - send the largest files first

    --order-by modtime,ascending - send the oldest files first

    --order-by name - send the files with alphabetically by path first

   If the --order-by flag is not supplied or it is supplied with an empty string then the default ordering will be used which is as scanned.  With --checkers  1
   this is mostly alphabetical, however with the default --checkers 8 it is somewhat random.

Limitations

   The --order-by flag does not do a separate pass over the data.  This means that it may transfer some files out of the order specified if

    there are no files in the backlog or the source has not been fully scanned yet

    there are more than --max-backlog files in the backlog

   Rclone will do its best to transfer the best file it has so in practice this should not cause a problem.  Think of --order-by as being more of a best efforts
   flag rather than a perfect ordering.

   If you want perfect ordering then you will need to specify --check-first which will find all the files which need transferring first before transferring any.

--password-command SpaceSepList

   This flag supplies a program which should supply the config password when run.  This is an alternative to rclone prompting for the password  or  setting  the
   RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS variable.

   The  argument to this should be a command with a space separated list of arguments.  If one of the arguments has a space in then enclose it in ", if you want
   a literal " in an argument then enclose the argument in " and double the ".  See CSV encoding (https://godoc.org/encoding/csv) for more info.

   Eg

          --password-command echo hello
          --password-command echo "hello with space"
          --password-command echo "hello with ""quotes"" and space"

   See the Configuration Encryption for more info.

   See a Windows PowerShell example on the Wiki (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/wiki/Windows-Powershell-use-rclone-password-command-for-Config-file-password).

-P, --progress

   This flag makes rclone update the stats in a static block in the terminal providing a realtime overview of the transfer.

   Any log messages will scroll above the static block.  Log messages will push the static block down to the bottom of the terminal where it will stay.

   Normally this is updated every 500mS but this period can be overridden with the --stats flag.

   This can be used with the --stats-one-line flag for a simpler display.

   Note: On Windows until this bug (https://github.com/Azure/go-ansiterm/issues/26) is fixed all non-ASCII characters will be replaced with . when --progress is
   in use.

--progress-terminal-title

   This flag, when used with -P/--progress, will print the string ETA: %s to the terminal title.

-q, --quiet

   This flag will limit rclone's output to error messages only.

--refresh-times

   The --refresh-times flag can be used to update modification times of existing files when they are out of sync on backends which don't support hashes.

   This is useful if you uploaded files with the incorrect timestamps and you now wish to correct them.

   This flag is only useful for destinations which don't support hashes (e.g.  crypt).

   This can be used any of the sync commands sync, copy or move.

   To  use  this  flag  you  will  need  to be doing a modification time sync (so not using --size-only or --checksum).  The flag will have no effect when using
   --size-only or --checksum.

   If this flag is used when rclone comes to upload a file it will check to see if there is an existing file on the  destination.   If  this  file  matches  the
   source  with size (and checksum if available) but has a differing timestamp then instead of re-uploading it, rclone will update the timestamp on the destina
   tion file.  If the checksum does not match rclone will upload the new file.  If the checksum is absent (e.g.  on a crypt backend) then rclone will update the
   timestamp.

   Note that some remotes can't set the modification time without re-uploading the file so this flag is less useful on them.

   Normally  if you are doing a modification time sync rclone will update modification times without --refresh-times provided that the remote supports checksums
   and the checksums match on the file.  However if the checksums are absent then rclone will upload the file rather than setting the timestamp as this  is  the
   safe behaviour.

--retries int

   Retry the entire sync if it fails this many times it fails (default 3).

   Some remotes can be unreliable and a few retries help pick up the files which didn't get transferred because of errors.

   Disable retries with --retries 1.

--retries-sleep=TIME

   This sets the interval between each retry specified by --retries

   The default is 0.  Use 0 to disable.

--server-side-across-configs

   Allow server-side operations (e.g.  copy or move) to work across different configurations.

   This can be useful if you wish to do a server-side copy or move between two remotes which use the same backend but are configured differently.

   Note that this isn't enabled by default because it isn't easy for rclone to tell if it will work between any two configurations.

--size-only

   Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to see if they are equal.  If you set this flag then rclone will check only the size.

   This  can  be useful transferring files from Dropbox which have been modified by the desktop sync client which doesn't set checksums of modification times in
   the same way as rclone.

--stats=TIME

   Commands which transfer data (sync, copy, copyto, move, moveto) will print data transfer stats at regular intervals to show their progress.

   This sets the interval.

   The default is 1m.  Use 0 to disable.

   If you set the stats interval then all commands can show stats.  This can be useful when running other commands, check or mount for example.

   Stats are logged at INFO level by default which means they won't show at default log level NOTICE.  Use --stats-log-level NOTICE or -v  to  make  them  show.
   See the Logging section for more info on log levels.

   Note that on macOS you can send a SIGINFO (which is normally ctrl-T in the terminal) to make the stats print immediately.

--stats-file-name-length integer

   By  default,  the  --stats output will truncate file names and paths longer than 40 characters.  This is equivalent to providing --stats-file-name-length 40.
   Use --stats-file-name-length 0 to disable any truncation of file names printed by stats.

--stats-log-level string

   Log level to show --stats output at.  This can be DEBUG, INFO, NOTICE, or ERROR.  The default is INFO.  This means at the default level of logging  which  is
   NOTICE the stats won't show - if you want them to then use --stats-log-level NOTICE.  See the Logging section for more info on log levels.

--stats-one-line

   When this is specified, rclone condenses the stats into a single line showing the most important stats only.

--stats-one-line-date

   When this is specified, rclone enables the single-line stats and prepends the display with a date string.  The default is 2006/01/02 15:04:05 -

--stats-one-line-date-format

   When  this is specified, rclone enables the single-line stats and prepends the display with a user-supplied date string.  The date string MUST be enclosed in
   quotes.  Follow golang specs (https://golang.org/pkg/time/#Time.Format) for date formatting syntax.

--stats-unit=bits|bytes

   By default, data transfer rates will be printed in bytes per second.

   This option allows the data rate to be printed in bits per second.

   Data transfer volume will still be reported in bytes.

   The rate is reported as a binary unit, not SI unit.  So 1 Mbit/s equals 1,048,576 bit/s and not 1,000,000 bit/s.

   The default is bytes.

--suffix=SUFFIX

   When using sync, copy or move any files which would have been overwritten or deleted will have the suffix added to them.  If there is a file  with  the  same
   path (after the suffix has been added), then it will be overwritten.

   The remote in use must support server-side move or copy and you must use the same remote as the destination of the sync.

   This is for use with files to add the suffix in the current directory or with --backup-dir.  See --backup-dir for more info.

   For example

          rclone copy --interactive /path/to/local/file remote:current --suffix .bak

   will copy /path/to/local to remote:current, but for any files which would have been updated or deleted have .bak added.

   If  using  rclone  sync  with  --suffix  and without --backup-dir then it is recommended to put a filter rule in excluding the suffix otherwise the sync will
   delete the backup files.

          rclone sync --interactive /path/to/local/file remote:current --suffix .bak --exclude "*.bak"

--suffix-keep-extension

   When using --suffix, setting this causes rclone put the SUFFIX before the extension of the files that it backs up rather than after.

   So let's say we had --suffix -2019-01-01, without the flag file.txt would be backed up to file.txt-2019-01-01 and with the flag it  would  be  backed  up  to
   file-2019-01-01.txt.  This can be helpful to make sure the suffixed files can still be opened.

--syslog

   On capable OSes (not Windows or Plan9) send all log output to syslog.

   This can be useful for running rclone in a script or rclone mount.

--syslog-facility string

   If using --syslog this sets the syslog facility (e.g.  KERN, USER).  See man syslog for a list of possible facilities.  The default facility is DAEMON.

--temp-dir=DIR

   Specify the directory rclone will use for temporary files, to override the default.  Make sure the directory exists and have accessible permissions.

   By  default  the operating system's temp directory will be used: - On Unix systems, $TMPDIR if non-empty, else /tmp.  - On Windows, the first non-empty value
   from %TMP%, %TEMP%, %USERPROFILE%, or the Windows directory.

   When overriding the default with this option, the specified path will be set as value of environment variable TMPDIR on Unix systems and TMP and TEMP on Win
   dows.

   You can use the config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) command to see the current value.

--tpslimit float

   Limit transactions per second to this number.  Default is 0 which is used to mean unlimited transactions per second.

   A  transaction  is  roughly defined as an API call; its exact meaning will depend on the backend.  For HTTP based backends it is an HTTP PUT/GET/POST/etc and
   its response.  For FTP/SFTP it is a round trip transaction over TCP.

   For example, to limit rclone to 10 transactions per second use --tpslimit 10, or to 1 transaction every 2 seconds use --tpslimit 0.5.

   Use this when the number of transactions per second from rclone is causing a problem with the cloud storage provider (e.g.  getting you banned or rate limit
   ed).

   This can be very useful for rclone mount to control the behaviour of applications using it.

   This limit applies to all HTTP based backends and to the FTP and SFTP backends.  It does not apply to the local backend or the Storj backend.

   See also --tpslimit-burst.

--tpslimit-burst int

   Max burst of transactions for --tpslimit (default 1).

   Normally  --tpslimit will do exactly the number of transaction per second specified.  However if you supply --tps-burst then rclone can save up some transac
   tions from when it was idle giving a burst of up to the parameter supplied.

   For example if you provide --tpslimit-burst 10 then if rclone has been idle for more than 10*--tpslimit then it can do 10 transactions  very  quickly  before
   they are limited again.

   This may be used to increase performance of --tpslimit without changing the long term average number of transactions per second.

--track-renames

   By  default, rclone doesn't keep track of renamed files, so if you rename a file locally then sync it to a remote, rclone will delete the old file on the re‐
   mote and upload a new copy.

   An rclone sync with --track-renames runs like a normal sync, but keeps track of objects which exist in the destination but not in  the  source  (which  would
   normally be deleted), and which objects exist in the source but not the destination (which would normally be transferred).  These objects are then candidates
   for renaming.

   After the sync, rclone matches up the source only and destination only objects using the --track-renames-strategy specified and either renames  the  destina‐
   tion object or transfers the source and deletes the destination object.  --track-renames is stateless like all of rclone's syncs.

   To use this flag the destination must support server-side copy or server-side move, and to use a hash based --track-renames-strategy (the default) the source
   and the destination must have a compatible hash.

   If the destination does not support server-side copy or move, rclone will fall back to the default behaviour and log an error level message to the console.

   Encrypted destinations are not currently supported by --track-renames if --track-renames-strategy includes hash.

   Note that --track-renames is incompatible with --no-traverse and that it uses extra memory to keep track of all the rename candidates.

   Note also that --track-renames is incompatible with --delete-before and will select --delete-after instead of --delete-during.

--track-renames-strategy (hash,modtime,leaf,size)

   This option changes the file matching criteria for --track-renames.

   The matching is controlled by a comma separated selection of these tokens:

    modtime - the modification time of the file - not supported on all backends

    hash - the hash of the file contents - not supported on all backends

    leaf - the name of the file not including its directory name

    size - the size of the file (this is always enabled)

   The default option is hash.

   Using --track-renames-strategy modtime,leaf would match files based on modification time, the leaf of the file name and the size only.

   Using --track-renames-strategy modtime or leaf can enable --track-renames support for encrypted destinations.

   Note that the hash strategy is not supported with encrypted destinations.

--delete-(before,during,after)

   This option allows you to specify when files on your destination are deleted when you sync folders.

   Specifying the value --delete-before will delete all files present on the destination, but not on the source before starting the transfer of any new  or  up
   dated files.  This uses two passes through the file systems, one for the deletions and one for the copies.

   Specifying --delete-during will delete files while checking and uploading files.  This is the fastest option and uses the least memory.

   Specifying  --delete-after  (the default value) will delay deletion of files until all new/updated files have been successfully transferred.  The files to be
   deleted are collected in the copy pass then deleted after the copy pass has completed successfully.  The files to be deleted are held in memory so this  mode
   may use more memory.  This is the safest mode as it will only delete files if there have been no errors subsequent to that.  If there have been errors before
   the deletions start then you will get the message not deleting files as there were IO errors.

--fast-list

   When doing anything which involves a directory listing (e.g.  sync, copy, ls - in fact nearly every command), rclone normally lists a directory and processes
   it before using more directory lists to process any subdirectories.  This can be parallelised and works very quickly using the least amount of memory.

   However,  some remotes have a way of listing all files beneath a directory in one (or a small number) of transactions.  These tend to be the bucket-based re
   motes (e.g.  S3, B2, GCS, Swift).

   If you use the --fast-list flag then rclone will use this method for listing directories.  This will have the following consequences for the listing:

    It will use fewer transactions (important if you pay for them)

    It will use more memory.  Rclone has to load the whole listing into memory.

    It may be faster because it uses fewer transactions

    It may be slower because it can't be parallelized

   rclone should always give identical results with and without --fast-list.

   If you pay for transactions and can fit your entire sync listing into memory then --fast-list is recommended.  If you have a very big sync to do  then  don't
   use --fast-list otherwise you will run out of memory.

   If you use --fast-list on a remote which doesn't support it, then rclone will just ignore it.

--timeout=TIME

   This sets the IO idle timeout.  If a transfer has started but then becomes idle for this long it is considered broken and disconnected.

   The default is 5m.  Set to 0 to disable.

--transfers=N

   The  number  of  file  transfers to run in parallel.  It can sometimes be useful to set this to a smaller number if the remote is giving a lot of timeouts or
   bigger if you have lots of bandwidth and a fast remote.

   The default is to run 4 file transfers in parallel.

   Look at --multi-thread-streams if you would like to control single file transfers.

-u, --update

   This forces rclone to skip any files which exist on the destination and have a modified time that is newer than the source file.

   This can be useful in avoiding needless transfers when transferring to a remote which doesn't support modification times directly (or when using  --use-serv‐
   er-modtime to avoid extra API calls) as it is more accurate than a --size-only check and faster than using --checksum.  On such remotes (or when using --use-
   server-modtime) the time checked will be the uploaded time.

   If an existing destination file has a modification time older than the source file's, it will be updated if the sizes are different.  If the  sizes  are  the
   same, it will be updated if the checksum is different or not available.

   If  an  existing destination file has a modification time equal (within the computed modify window) to the source file's, it will be updated if the sizes are
   different.  The checksum will not be checked in this case unless the --checksum flag is provided.

   In all other cases the file will not be updated.

   Consider using the --modify-window flag to compensate for time skews between the source and the backend, for backends that do not support mod times, and  in
   stead  use  uploaded times.  However, if the backend does not support checksums, note that syncing or copying within the time skew window may still result in
   additional transfers for safety.

--use-mmap

   If this flag is set then rclone will use anonymous memory allocated by mmap on Unix based platforms and VirtualAlloc on  Windows  for  its  transfer  buffers
   (size  controlled  by  --buffer-size).   Memory  allocated like this does not go on the Go heap and can be returned to the OS immediately when it is finished
   with.

   If this flag is not set then rclone will allocate and free the buffers using the Go memory allocator which may use more memory as memory pages  are  returned
   less aggressively to the OS.

   It is possible this does not work well on all platforms so it is disabled by default; in the future it may be enabled by default.

--use-server-modtime

   Some  object-store backends (e.g, Swift, S3) do not preserve file modification times (modtime).  On these backends, rclone stores the original modtime as ad
   ditional metadata on the object.  By default it will make an API call to retrieve the metadata when the modtime is needed by an operation.

   Use this flag to disable the extra API call and rely instead on the server's modified time.  In cases such as a local to remote sync using --update,  knowing
   the  local  file  is newer than the time it was last uploaded to the remote is sufficient.  In those cases, this flag can speed up the process and reduce the
   number of API calls necessary.

   Using this flag on a sync operation without also using --update would cause all files modified at any time other than the last upload  time  to  be  uploaded
   again, which is probably not what you want.

-v, -vv, --verbose

   With -v rclone will tell you about each file that is transferred and a small number of significant events.

   With -vv rclone will become very verbose telling you about every file it considers and transfers.  Please send bug reports with a log with this setting.

   When setting verbosity as an environment variable, use RCLONE_VERBOSE=1 or RCLONE_VERBOSE=2 for -v and -vv respectively.

-V, --version

   Prints the version number

SSL/TLS options

   The  outgoing  SSL/TLS  connections rclone makes can be controlled with these options.  For example this can be very useful with the HTTP or WebDAV backends.
   Rclone HTTP servers have their own set of configuration for SSL/TLS which you can find in their documentation.

--ca-cert stringArray

   This loads the PEM encoded certificate authority certificates and uses it to verify the certificates of the servers rclone connects to.

   If you have generated certificates signed with a local CA then you will need this flag to connect to servers using those certificates.

--client-cert string

   This loads the PEM encoded client side certificate.

   This is used for mutual TLS authentication (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mutual_authentication).

   The --client-key flag is required too when using this.

--client-key string

   This loads the PEM encoded client side private key used for mutual TLS authentication.  Used in conjunction with --client-cert.

--no-check-certificate=true/false

   --no-check-certificate controls whether a client verifies the server's certificate chain and host name.  If --no-check-certificate is true, TLS  accepts  any
   certificate presented by the server and any host name in that certificate.  In this mode, TLS is susceptible to man-in-the-middle attacks.

   This option defaults to false.

   This should be used only for testing.

Configuration Encryption

   Your  configuration file contains information for logging in to your cloud services.  This means that you should keep your rclone.conf file in a secure loca
   tion.

   If you are in an environment where that isn't possible, you can add a password to your configuration.  This means that you will have to supply  the  password
   every time you start rclone.

   To add a password to your rclone configuration, execute rclone config.

          >rclone config
          Current remotes:

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/s/q>

   Go into s, Set configuration password:

          e/n/d/s/q> s
          Your configuration is not encrypted.
          If you add a password, you will protect your login information to cloud services.
          a) Add Password
          q) Quit to main menu
          a/q> a
          Enter NEW configuration password:
          password:
          Confirm NEW password:
          password:
          Password set
          Your configuration is encrypted.
          c) Change Password
          u) Unencrypt configuration
          q) Quit to main menu
          c/u/q>

   Your configuration is now encrypted, and every time you start rclone you will have to supply the password.  See below for details.  In the same menu, you can
   change the password or completely remove encryption from your configuration.

   There is no way to recover the configuration if you lose your password.

   rclone uses nacl secretbox (https://godoc.org/golang.org/x/crypto/nacl/secretbox) which in turn uses XSalsa20 and Poly1305 to encrypt and  authenticate  your
   configuration with secret-key cryptography.  The password is SHA-256 hashed, which produces the key for secretbox.  The hashed password is not stored.

   While this provides very good security, we do not recommend storing your encrypted rclone configuration in public if it contains sensitive information, maybe
   except if you use a very strong password.

   If it is safe in your environment, you can set the RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS environment variable to contain your password, in which case it will be  used  for  de‐
   crypting the configuration.

   You can set this for a session from a script.  For unix like systems save this to a file called set-rclone-password:

          #!/bin/echo Source this file don't run it

          read -s RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS
          export RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS

   Then  source  the file when you want to use it.  From the shell you would do source set-rclone-password.  It will then ask you for the password and set it in
   the environment variable.

   An alternate means of supplying the password is to provide a script which will retrieve the password and print on standard output.  This script should have a
   fully specified path name and not rely on any environment variables.  The script is supplied either via --password-command="..." command line argument or via
   the RCLONE_PASSWORD_COMMAND environment variable.

   One useful example of this is using the passwordstore application to retrieve the password:

          export RCLONE_PASSWORD_COMMAND="pass rclone/config"

   If the passwordstore password manager holds the password for the rclone configuration, using the script method means the password is primarily  protected  by
   the  passwordstore  system,  and is never embedded in the clear in scripts, nor available for examination using the standard commands available.  It is quite
   possible with long running rclone sessions for copies of passwords to be innocently captured in log files or terminal scroll buffers, etc.  Using the  script
   method of supplying the password enhances the security of the config password considerably.

   If  you are running rclone inside a script, unless you are using the --password-command method, you might want to disable password prompts.  To do that, pass
   the parameter --ask-password=false to rclone.  This will make rclone fail instead of asking for a password if  RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS  doesn't  contain  a  valid
   password, and --password-command has not been supplied.

   Whenever  running  commands  that  may be affected by options in a configuration file, rclone will look for an existing file according to the rules described
   above, and load any it finds.  If an encrypted file is found, this includes decrypting it, with the possible consequence of a password prompt.  When  execut
   ing  a  command  line that you know are not actually using anything from such a configuration file, you can avoid it being loaded by overriding the location,
   e.g.  with one of the documented special values for memory-only configuration.  Since only backend options can be stored in configuration files, this is nor
   mally unnecessary for commands that do not operate on backends, e.g.  genautocomplete.  However, it will be relevant for commands that do operate on backends
   in general, but are used without referencing a stored remote, e.g.  listing local filesystem paths, or connection strings: rclone --config="" ls .

Developer options

   These options are useful when developing or debugging rclone.  There are also some more remote specific options which aren't documented here which  are  used
   for testing.  These start with remote name e.g.  --drive-test-option - see the docs for the remote in question.

--cpuprofile=FILE

   Write CPU profile to file.  This can be analysed with go tool pprof.

--dump flag,flag,flag

   The --dump flag takes a comma separated list of flags to dump info about.

   Note that some headers including Accept-Encoding as shown may not be correct in the request and the response may not show Content-Encoding if the go standard
   libraries auto gzip encoding was in effect.  In this case the body of the request will be gunzipped before showing it.

   The available flags are:

--dump headers

   Dump HTTP headers with Authorization: lines removed.  May still contain sensitive info.  Can be very verbose.  Useful for debugging only.

   Use --dump auth if you do want the Authorization: headers.

--dump bodies

   Dump HTTP headers and bodies - may contain sensitive info.  Can be very verbose.  Useful for debugging only.

   Note that the bodies are buffered in memory so don't use this for enormous files.

--dump requests

   Like --dump bodies but dumps the request bodies and the response headers.  Useful for debugging download problems.

--dump responses

   Like --dump bodies but dumps the response bodies and the request headers.  Useful for debugging upload problems.

--dump auth

   Dump HTTP headers - will contain sensitive info such as Authorization: headers - use --dump headers to dump without Authorization: headers.  Can be very ver
   bose.  Useful for debugging only.

--dump filters

   Dump the filters to the output.  Useful to see exactly what include and exclude options are filtering on.

--dump goroutines

   This dumps a list of the running go-routines at the end of the command to standard output.

--dump openfiles

   This dumps a list of the open files at the end of the command.  It uses the lsof command to do that so you'll need that installed to use it.

--memprofile=FILE

   Write memory profile to file.  This can be analysed with go tool pprof.

Filtering

   For the filtering options

    --delete-excluded

    --filter

    --filter-from

    --exclude

    --exclude-from

    --exclude-if-present

    --include

    --include-from

    --files-from

    --files-from-raw

    --min-size

    --max-size

    --min-age

    --max-age

    --dump filters

    --metadata-include

    --metadata-include-from

    --metadata-exclude

    --metadata-exclude-from

    --metadata-filter

    --metadata-filter-from

   See the filtering section (https://rclone.org/filtering/).

Remote control

   For the remote control options and for instructions on how to remote control rclone

    --rc

    and anything starting with --rc-

   See the remote control section (https://rclone.org/rc/).

Logging

   rclone has 4 levels of logging, ERROR, NOTICE, INFO and DEBUG.

   By default, rclone logs to standard error.  This means you can redirect standard error and still see the normal output of rclone commands (e.g.  rclone ls).

   By default, rclone will produce Error and Notice level messages.

   If you use the -q flag, rclone will only produce Error messages.

   If you use the -v flag, rclone will produce Error, Notice and Info messages.

   If you use the -vv flag, rclone will produce Error, Notice, Info and Debug messages.

   You can also control the log levels with the --log-level flag.

   If you use the --log-file=FILE option, rclone will redirect Error, Info and Debug messages along with standard error to FILE.

   If you use the --syslog flag then rclone will log to syslog and the --syslog-facility control which facility it uses.

   Rclone prefixes all log messages with their level in capitals, e.g.  INFO which makes it easy to grep the log file for different kinds of information.

Exit Code

   If  any  errors  occur  during  the command execution, rclone will exit with a non-zero exit code.  This allows scripts to detect when rclone operations have
   failed.

   During the startup phase, rclone will exit immediately if an error is detected in the configuration.  There will always be a log message  immediately  before
   exiting.

   When  rclone is running it will accumulate errors as it goes along, and only exit with a non-zero exit code if (after retries) there were still failed trans
   fers.  For every error counted there will be a high priority log message (visible with -q) showing the message and which file caused  the  problem.   A  high
   priority  message  is  also shown when starting a retry so the user can see that any previous error messages may not be valid after the retry.  If rclone has
   done a retry it will log a high priority message if the retry was successful.

List of exit codes

    0 - success

    1 - Syntax or usage error

    2 - Error not otherwise categorised

    3 - Directory not found

    4 - File not found

    5 - Temporary error (one that more retries might fix) (Retry errors)

    6 - Less serious errors (like 461 errors from dropbox) (NoRetry errors)

    7 - Fatal error (one that more retries won't fix, like account suspended) (Fatal errors)

    8 - Transfer exceeded - limit set by --max-transfer reached

    9 - Operation successful, but no files transferred

Environment Variables

   Rclone can be configured entirely using environment variables.  These can be used to set defaults for options or config file entries.

Options

   Every option in rclone can have its default set by environment variable.

   To find the name of the environment variable, first, take the long option name, strip the leading --, change - to _, make upper case and prepend RCLONE_.

   For example, to always set --stats 5s, set the environment variable RCLONE_STATS=5s.  If you set stats on the command line this will override the environment
   variable setting.

   Or to always use the trash in drive --drive-use-trash, set RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH=true.

   Verbosity is slightly different, the environment variable equivalent of --verbose or -v is RCLONE_VERBOSE=1, or for -vv, RCLONE_VERBOSE=2.

   The same parser is used for the options and the environment variables so they take exactly the same form.

   The options set by environment variables can be seen with the -vv flag, e.g.  rclone version -vv.

Config file

   You can set defaults for values in the config file on an individual remote basis.  The names of the config items are documented in the page for each backend.

   To  find  the name of the environment variable, you need to set, take RCLONE_CONFIG_ + name of remote + _ + name of config file option and make it all upper
   case.

   For example, to configure an S3 remote named mys3: without a config file (using unix ways of setting environment variables):

          $ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_TYPE=s3
          $ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_ACCESS_KEY_ID=XXX
          $ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY=XXX
          $ rclone lsd mys3:
                    -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket
          $ rclone listremotes | grep mys3
          mys3:

   Note that if you want to create a remote using environment variables you must create the ..._TYPE variable as above.

   Note that the name of a remote created using environment variable is case insensitive, in contrast to regular remotes stored in  config  file  as  documented
   above.   You must write the name in uppercase in the environment variable, but as seen from example above it will be listed and can be accessed in lowercase,
   while you can also refer to the same remote in uppercase:

          $ rclone lsd mys3:
                    -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket
          $ rclone lsd MYS3:
                    -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket

   Note that you can only set the options of the immediate backend, so RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3CRYPT_ACCESS_KEY_ID has no effect, if myS3Crypt is a crypt remote based
   on an S3 remote.  However RCLONE_S3_ACCESS_KEY_ID will set the access key of all remotes using S3, including myS3Crypt.

   Note also that now rclone has connection strings, it is probably easier to use those instead which makes the above example

          rclone lsd :s3,access_key_id=XXX,secret_access_key=XXX:

Precedence

   The various different methods of backend configuration are read in this order and the first one with a value is used.

    Parameters in connection strings, e.g.  myRemote,skip_links:

    Flag values as supplied on the command line, e.g.  --skip-links

    Remote specific environment vars, e.g.  RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_SKIP_LINKS (see above).

    Backend-specific environment vars, e.g.  RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS.

    Backend generic environment vars, e.g.  RCLONE_SKIP_LINKS.

    Config file, e.g.  skip_links = true.

    Default values, e.g.  false - these can't be changed.

   So  if  both --skip-links is supplied on the command line and an environment variable RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS is set, the command line flag will take prefer‐
   ence.

   The backend configurations set by environment variables can be seen with the -vv flag, e.g.  rclone about myRemote: -vv.

   For non backend configuration the order is as follows:

   • Flag values as supplied on the command line, e.g.  --stats 5s.

   • Environment vars, e.g.  RCLONE_STATS=5s.

   • Default values, e.g.  1m - these can't be changed.

Other environment variables

    RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS set to contain your config file password (see Configuration Encryption section)

    HTTP_PROXY, HTTPS_PROXY and NO_PROXY (or the lowercase versions thereof).

      HTTPS_PROXY takes precedence over HTTP_PROXY for https requests.

      The environment values may be either a complete URL or a "host[:port]" for, in which case the "http" scheme is assumed.

    USER and LOGNAME values are used as fallbacks for current username.  The primary method for looking up username is OS-specific: Windows API on Windows, re
     al user ID in /etc/passwd on Unix systems.  In the documentation the current username is simply referred to as $USER.

    RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR - rclone sets this variable for use in config files and sub processes to point to the directory holding the config file.

   The options set by environment variables can be seen with the -vv and --log-level=DEBUG flags, e.g.  rclone version -vv.

Configuring rclone on a remote / headless machine

   Some of the configurations (those involving oauth2) require an Internet connected web browser.

   If  you  are trying to set rclone up on a remote or headless box with no browser available on it (e.g.  a NAS or a server in a datacenter) then you will need
   to use an alternative means of configuration.  There are two ways of doing it, described below.

Configuring using rclone authorize

   On the headless box run rclone config but answer N to the Use web browser  to automatically authenticate?  question.

          ...
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes (default)
          n) No
          y/n> n
          For this to work, you will need rclone available on a machine that has
          a web browser available.

          For more help and alternate methods see: https://rclone.org/remote_setup/

          Execute the following on the machine with the web browser (same rclone
          version recommended):

              rclone authorize "amazon cloud drive"

          Then paste the result below:
          result>

   Then on your main desktop machine

          rclone authorize "amazon cloud drive"
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          Paste the following into your remote machine --->
          SECRET_TOKEN
          <---End paste

   Then back to the headless box, paste in the code

          result> SECRET_TOKEN
          --------------------
          [acd12]
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          token = SECRET_TOKEN
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d>

Configuring by copying the config file

   Rclone stores all of its config in a single configuration file.  This can easily be copied to configure a remote rclone.

   So first configure rclone on your desktop machine with

          rclone config

   to set up the config file.

   Find the config file by running rclone config file, for example

          $ rclone config file
          Configuration file is stored at:
          /home/user/.rclone.conf

   Now transfer it to the remote box (scp, cut paste, ftp, sftp, etc.)  and place it in the correct place (use rclone config file on the remote box to find  out
   where).

Configuring using SSH Tunnel

   Linux and MacOS users can utilize SSH Tunnel to redirect the headless box port 53682 to local machine by using the following command:

          ssh -L localhost:53682:localhost:53682 username@remote_server

   Then on the headless box run rclone config and answer Y to the Use web  browser to automatically authenticate? question.

          ...
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes (default)
          n) No
          y/n> y

   Then copy and paste the auth url http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=xxxxxxxxxxxx to the browser on your local machine, complete the auth and it is done.

Filtering, includes and excludes

   Filter flags determine which files rclone sync, move, ls, lsl, md5sum, sha1sum, size, delete, check and similar commands apply to.

   They are specified in terms of path/file name patterns; path/file lists; file age and size, or presence of a file in a directory.  Bucket based remotes with
   out the concept of directory apply filters to object key, age and size in an analogous way.

   Rclone purge does not obey filters.

   To test filters without risk of damage to data, apply them to rclone ls, or with the --dry-run and -vv flags.

   Rclone filter patterns can only be used in filter command line options, not in the specification of a remote.

   E.g.  rclone copy "remote:dir*.jpg" /path/to/dir does not have a filter effect.  rclone copy remote:dir /path/to/dir --include "*.jpg" does.

   Important Avoid mixing any two of --include..., --exclude... or --filter... flags in an rclone command.  The results may not be what you expect.  Instead use
   a --filter... flag.

Patterns for matching path/file names Pattern syntax

   Here is a formal definition of the pattern syntax, examples are below.

   Rclone matching rules follow a glob style:

          *         matches any sequence of non-separator (/) characters
          **        matches any sequence of characters including / separators
          ?         matches any single non-separator (/) character
          [ [ ! ] { character-range } ]
                    character class (must be non-empty)
          { pattern-list }
                    pattern alternatives
          {{ regexp }}
                    regular expression to match
          c         matches character c (c != *, **, ?, \, [, {, })
          \c        matches reserved character c (c = *, **, ?, \, [, {, }) or character class

   character-range:

          c         matches character c (c != \, -, ])
          \c        matches reserved character c (c = \, -, ])
          lo - hi   matches character c for lo <= c <= hi

   pattern-list:

          pattern { , pattern }
                    comma-separated (without spaces) patterns

   character classes (see Go regular expression reference (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/)) include:

          Named character classes (e.g. [\d], [^\d], [\D], [^\D])
          Perl character classes (e.g. \s, \S, \w, \W)
          ASCII character classes (e.g. [[:alnum:]], [[:alpha:]], [[:punct:]], [[:xdigit:]])

   regexp for advanced users to insert a regular expression - see below for more info:

          Any re2 regular expression not containing `}}`

   If  the  filter  pattern starts with a / then it only matches at the top level of the directory tree, relative to the root of the remote (not necessarily the
   root of the drive).  If it does not start with / then it is matched starting at the end of the path/file name but it only matches a complete path  element  -
   it must match from a / separator or the beginning of the path/file.

          file.jpg   - matches "file.jpg"
                     - matches "directory/file.jpg"
                     - doesn't match "afile.jpg"
                     - doesn't match "directory/afile.jpg"
          /file.jpg  - matches "file.jpg" in the root directory of the remote
                     - doesn't match "afile.jpg"
                     - doesn't match "directory/file.jpg"

   The top level of the remote may not be the top level of the drive.

   E.g.  for a Microsoft Windows local directory structure

          F:
           bkp
           data
              excl
                 123.jpg
                 456.jpg
              incl
                 document.pdf

   To  copy the contents of folder data into folder bkp excluding the contents of subfolder exclthe following command treats F:\data and F:\bkp as top level for
   filtering.

   rclone copy F:\data\ F:\bkp\ --exclude=/excl/**

   Important Use / in path/file name patterns and not \ even if running on Microsoft Windows.

   Simple patterns are case sensitive unless the --ignore-case flag is used.

   Without --ignore-case (default)

          potato - matches "potato"
                 - doesn't match "POTATO"

   With --ignore-case

          potato - matches "potato"
                 - matches "POTATO"

Using regular expressions in filter patterns

   The syntax of filter patterns is glob style matching (like bash uses) to make things easy for users.  However this does not provide absolute control over the
   matching, so for advanced users rclone also provides a regular expression syntax.

   The  regular  expressions  used are as defined in the Go regular expression reference (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/).  Regular expressions should be
   enclosed in {{ }}.  They will match only the last path segment if the glob doesn't start with / or the whole path name if it does.  Note that rclone does not
   attempt  to parse the supplied regular expression, meaning that using any regular expression filter will prevent rclone from using directory filter rules, as
   it will instead check every path against the supplied regular expression(s).

   Here is how the {{regexp}} is transformed into an full regular expression to match the entire path:

          {{regexp}}  becomes (^|/)(regexp)$
          /{{regexp}} becomes ^(regexp)$

   Regexp syntax can be mixed with glob syntax, for example

          *.{{jpe?g}} to match file.jpg, file.jpeg but not file.png

   You can also use regexp flags - to set case insensitive, for example

          *.{{(?i)jpg}} to match file.jpg, file.JPG but not file.png

   Be careful with wildcards in regular expressions - you don't want them to match path separators normally.  To match any file name  starting  with  start  and
   ending with end write

          {{start[^/]*end\.jpg}}

   Not

          {{start.*end\.jpg}}

   Which will match a directory called start with a file called end.jpg in it as the .* will match / characters.

   Note  that you can use -vv --dump filters to show the filter patterns in regexp format - rclone implements the glob patters by transforming them into regular
   expressions.

Filter pattern examples

   Description           Pattern          Matches         Does not match
   
   Wildcard              *.jpg            /file.jpg       /file.png
                                          /dir/file.jpg   /dir/file.png
   Rooted                /*.jpg           /file.jpg       /file.png
                                          /file2.jpg      /dir/file.jpg
   Alternates            *.{jpg,png}      /file.jpg       /file.gif
                                          /dir/file.png   /dir/file.gif
   Path Wildcard         dir/**           /dir/anyfile    file.png
                                          /sub           /subdir/file.png
                                          dir/dir/sub
                                          subdir/any
                                          file
   Any Char              *.t?t            /file.txt       /file.qxt
                                          /dir/file.tzt   /dir/file.png
   Range                 *.[a-z]          /file.a         /file.0
                                          /dir/file.b     /dir/file.1
   Escape                *.\?\?\?         /file.???       /file.abc
                                          /dir/file.???   /dir/file.def
   Class                 *.\d\d\d         /file.012       /file.abc
                                          /dir/file.345   /dir/file.def
   Regexp                *.{{jpe?g}}      /file.jpeg      /file.png
                                          /dir/file.jpg   /dir/file.jpeeg
   Rooted Regexp         /{{.*\.jpe?g}}   /file.jpeg      /file.png
                                          /file.jpg       /dir/file.jpg

How filter rules are applied to files

   Rclone path/file name filters are made up of one or more of the following flags:

    --include

    --include-from

    --exclude

    --exclude-from

    --filter

    --filter-from

   There can be more than one instance of individual flags.

   Rclone internally uses a combined list of all the include and exclude rules.  The order in which rules are processed can influence the result of the filter.

   All flags of the same type are processed together in the order above, regardless of what order the different types of flags are included on the command line.

   Multiple instances of the same flag are processed from left to right according to their position in the command line.

   To mix up the order of processing includes and excludes use --filter... flags.

   Within --include-from, --exclude-from and --filter-from flags rules are processed from top to bottom of the referenced file.

   If there is an --include or --include-from flag specified, rclone implies a - ** rule which it adds to the bottom of the internal rule list.  Specifying a  +
   rule with a --filter... flag does not imply that rule.

   Each  path/file  name passed through rclone is matched against the combined filter list.  At first match to a rule the path/file name is included or excluded
   and no further filter rules are processed for that path/file.

   If rclone does not find a match, after testing against all rules (including the implied rule if appropriate), the path/file name is included.

   Any path/file included at that stage is processed by the rclone command.

   --files-from and --files-from-raw flags over-ride and cannot be combined with other filter options.

   To see the internal combined rule list, in regular expression form, for a command add the --dump filters flag.  Running an rclone command with --dump filters
   and  -vv  flags  lists the internal filter elements and shows how they are applied to each source path/file.  There is not currently a means provided to pass
   regular expression filter options into rclone directly though character class filter rules  contain  character  classes.   Go  regular  expression  reference
   (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/)

How filter rules are applied to directories

   Rclone  commands are applied to path/file names not directories.  The entire contents of a directory can be matched to a filter by the pattern directory/* or
   recursively by directory/**.

   Directory filter rules are defined with a closing / separator.

   E.g.  /directory/subdirectory/ is an rclone directory filter rule.

   Rclone commands can use directory filter rules to determine whether they recurse into subdirectories.  This potentially  optimises  access  to  a  remote  by
   avoiding listing unnecessary directories.  Whether optimisation is desirable depends on the specific filter rules and source remote content.

   If any regular expression filters are in use, then no directory recursion optimisation is possible, as rclone must check every path against the supplied reg
   ular expression(s).

   Directory recursion optimisation occurs if either:

    A source remote does not support the rclone ListR primitive.  local, sftp, Microsoft OneDrive and WebDAV do not support ListR.  Google Drive and most buck
     et type storage do.  Full list (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)

    On  other  remotes (those that support ListR), if the rclone command is not naturally recursive, and provided it is not run with the --fast-list flag.  ls,
     lsf -R and size are naturally recursive but sync, copy and move are not.

    Whenever the --disable ListR flag is applied to an rclone command.

   Rclone commands imply directory filter rules from path/file filter rules.  To view the directory filter rules rclone has implied for a  command  specify  the
   --dump filters flag.

   E.g.  for an include rule

          /a/*.jpg

   Rclone implies the directory include rule

          /a/

   Directory filter rules specified in an rclone command can limit the scope of an rclone command but path/file filters still have to be specified.

   E.g.   rclone ls remote: --include /directory/ will not match any files.  Because it is an --include option the --exclude ** rule is implied, and the /direc
   tory/ pattern serves only to optimise access to the remote by ignoring everything outside of that directory.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --filter-from filter-list.txt with a file filter-list.txt:

          - /dir1/
          - /dir2/
          + *.pdf
          - **

   All files in directories dir1 or dir2 or their subdirectories are completely excluded from the listing.  Only files of suffix pdf in the root of  remote:  or
   its subdirectories are listed.  The - ** rule prevents listing of any path/files not previously matched by the rules above.

   Option  exclude-if-present  creates  a directory exclude rule based on the presence of a file in a directory and takes precedence over other rclone directory
   filter rules.

   When using pattern list syntax, if a pattern item contains either / or **, then rclone will not able to imply a directory filter rule from this pattern list.

   E.g.  for an include rule

          {dir1/**,dir2/**}

   Rclone will match files below directories dir1 or dir2 only, but will not be able to use this filter to exclude a directory dir3 from being traversed.

   Directory recursion optimisation may affect performance, but normally not the result.  One exception to this is sync operations with  option  --create-empty-
   src-dirs, where any traversed empty directories will be created.  With the pattern list example {dir1/**,dir2/**} above, this would create an empty directory
   dir3 on destination (when it exists on source).  Changing the filter to {dir1,dir2}/**, or splitting it into two include rules  --include  dir1/**  --include
   dir2/**, will match the same files while also filtering directories, with the result that an empty directory dir3 will no longer be created.

--exclude - Exclude files matching pattern

   Excludes path/file names from an rclone command based on a single exclude rule.

   This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

   --exclude should not be used with --include, --include-from, --filter or --filter-from flags.

   --exclude has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --exclude *.bak excludes all .bak files from listing.

   E.g.  rclone size remote: "--exclude /dir/**" returns the total size of all files on remote: excluding those in root directory dir and sub directories.

   E.g.  on Microsoft Windows rclone ls remote: --exclude "*\[{JP,KR,HK}\]*" lists the files in remote: with [JP] or [KR] or [HK] in their name.  Quotes prevent
   the shell from interpreting the \ characters.\ characters escape the [ and ] so an rclone filter treats them literally rather than as a character-range.  The
   { and } define an rclone pattern list.  For other operating systems single quotes are required ie rclone ls remote: --exclude '*\[{JP,KR,HK}\]*'

--exclude-from - Read exclude patterns from file

   Excludes path/file names from an rclone command based on rules in a named file.  The file contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.

   For an example exclude-file.txt:

          # a sample exclude rule file
          *.bak
          file2.jpg

   rclone  ls  remote:  --exclude-from  exclude-file.txt  lists  the files on remote: except those named file2.jpg or with a suffix .bak.  That is equivalent to
   rclone ls remote: --exclude file2.jpg --exclude "*.bak".

   This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

   The --exclude-from flag is useful where multiple exclude filter rules are applied to an rclone command.

   --exclude-from should not be used with --include, --include-from, --filter or --filter-from flags.

   --exclude-from has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

   --exclude-from followed by - reads filter rules from standard input.

--include - Include files matching pattern

   Adds a single include rule based on path/file names to an rclone command.

   This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

   --include has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

   --include implies --exclude ** at the end of an rclone internal filter list.  Therefore if you mix --include and --include-from flags with  --exclude,  --ex
   clude-from,  --filter  or --filter-from, you must use include rules for all the files you want in the include statement.  For more flexibility use the --fil
   ter-from flag.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --include "*.{png,jpg}" lists the files on remote: with suffix .png and .jpg.  All other files are excluded.

   E.g.  multiple rclone copy commands can be combined with --include and a pattern-list.

          rclone copy /vol1/A remote:A
          rclone copy /vol1/B remote:B

   is equivalent to:

          rclone copy /vol1 remote: --include "{A,B}/**"

   E.g.  rclone ls remote:/wheat --include "??[^[:punct:]]*" lists the files remote: directory wheat (and subdirectories) whose third character is not  punctua
   tion.  This example uses an ASCII character class (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/).

--include-from - Read include patterns from file

   Adds path/file names to an rclone command based on rules in a named file.  The file contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.

   For an example include-file.txt:

          # a sample include rule file
          *.jpg
          file2.avi

   rclone  ls  remote:  --include-from  include-file.txt lists the files on remote: with name file2.avi or suffix .jpg.  That is equivalent to rclone ls remote:
   --include file2.avi --include "*.jpg".

   This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

   The --include-from flag is useful where multiple include filter rules are applied to an rclone command.

   --include-from implies --exclude ** at the end of an rclone internal filter list.  Therefore if you mix --include and --include-from  flags  with  --exclude,
   --exclude-from,  --filter  or  --filter-from,  you  must use include rules for all the files you want in the include statement.  For more flexibility use the
   --filter-from flag.

   --exclude-from has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

   --exclude-from followed by - reads filter rules from standard input.

--filter - Add a file-filtering rule

   Specifies path/file names to an rclone command, based on a single include or exclude rule, in + or - format.

   This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

   --filter + differs from --include.  In the case of --include rclone implies an --exclude * rule which it adds to  the  bottom  of  the  internal  rule  list.
   --filter...+ does not imply that rule.

   --filter has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

   --filter should not be used with --include, --include-from, --exclude or --exclude-from flags.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --filter "- *.bak" excludes all .bak files from a list of remote:.

--filter-from - Read filtering patterns from a file

   Adds path/file names to an rclone command based on rules in a named file.  The file contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.  Include rules start with +
   and exclude rules with -.  ! clears existing rules.  Rules are processed in the order they are defined.

   This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

   Arrange the order of filter rules with the most restrictive first and work down.

   E.g.  for filter-file.txt:

          # a sample filter rule file
          - secret*.jpg
          + *.jpg
          + *.png
          + file2.avi
          - /dir/Trash/**
          + /dir/**
          # exclude everything else
          - *

   rclone ls remote: --filter-from filter-file.txt lists the path/files on remote: including all jpg and png files, excluding any matching secret*.jpg  and  in
   cluding  file2.avi.   It  also includes everything in the directory dir at the root of remote, except remote:dir/Trash which it excludes.  Everything else is
   excluded.

   E.g.  for an alternative filter-file.txt:

          - secret*.jpg
          + *.jpg
          + *.png
          + file2.avi
          - *

   Files file1.jpg, file3.png and file2.avi are listed whilst secret17.jpg and files without the suffix .jpgor.png` are excluded.

   E.g.  for an alternative filter-file.txt:

          + *.jpg
          + *.gif
          !
          + 42.doc
          - *

   Only file 42.doc is listed.  Prior rules are cleared by the !.

--files-from - Read list of source-file names

   Adds path/files to an rclone command from a list in a named file.  Rclone processes the path/file names in the order of the list, and no others.

   Other filter flags (--include, --include-from, --exclude, --exclude-from, --filter and --filter-from) are ignored when --files-from is used.

   --files-from expects a list of files as its input.  Leading or trailing whitespace is stripped from the input lines.  Lines starting with # or ; are ignored.

   Rclone commands with a --files-from flag traverse the remote, treating the names in --files-from as a set of filters.

   If the --no-traverse and --files-from flags are used together an rclone command does not traverse the remote.  Instead it addresses each path/file  named  in
   the  file  individually.  For each path/file name, that requires typically 1 API call.  This can be efficient for a short --files-from list and a remote con
   taining many files.

   Rclone commands do not error if any names in the --files-from file are missing from the source remote.

   The --files-from flag can be repeated in a single rclone command to read path/file names from more than one file.  The files are  read  from  left  to  right
   along the command line.

   Paths  within  the  --files-from  file  are  interpreted  as  starting with the root specified in the rclone command.  Leading / separators are ignored.  See
   --files-from-raw if you need the input to be processed in a raw manner.

   E.g.  for a file files-from.txt:

          # comment
          file1.jpg
          subdir/file2.jpg

   rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt /home/me/pics remote:pics copies the following, if they exist, and only those files.

          /home/me/pics/file1.jpg         remote:pics/file1.jpg
          /home/me/pics/subdir/file2.jpg  remote:pics/subdir/file2.jpg

   E.g.  to copy the following files referenced by their absolute paths:

          /home/user1/42
          /home/user1/dir/ford
          /home/user2/prefect

   First find a common subdirectory - in this case /home and put the remaining files in files-from.txt with or without leading /, e.g.

          user1/42
          user1/dir/ford
          user2/prefect

   Then copy these to a remote:

          rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt /home remote:backup

   The three files are transferred as follows:

          /home/user1/42        remote:backup/user1/important
          /home/user1/dir/ford  remote:backup/user1/dir/file
          /home/user2/prefect   remote:backup/user2/stuff

   Alternatively if / is chosen as root files-from.txt will be:

          /home/user1/42
          /home/user1/dir/ford
          /home/user2/prefect

   The copy command will be:

          rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt / remote:backup

   Then there will be an extra home directory on the remote:

          /home/user1/42        remote:backup/home/user1/42
          /home/user1/dir/ford  remote:backup/home/user1/dir/ford
          /home/user2/prefect   remote:backup/home/user2/prefect

--files-from-raw - Read list of source-file names without any processing

   This flag is the same as --files-from except that input is read in a raw manner.  Lines with leading / trailing whitespace, and lines starting with  ;  or  #
   are read without any processing.  rclone lsf (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsf/) has a compatible format that can be used to export file lists from re
   motes for input to --files-from-raw.

--ignore-case - make searches case insensitive

   By default, rclone filter patterns are case sensitive.  The --ignore-case flag makes all of the filters patterns on the command line case insensitive.

   E.g.  --include "zaphod.txt" does not match a file Zaphod.txt.  With --ignore-case a match is made.

Quoting shell metacharacters

   Rclone commands with filter patterns containing shell metacharacters may not as work as expected in your shell and may require quoting.

   E.g.  linux, OSX (* metacharacter)

    --include \*.jpg

    --include '*.jpg'

    --include='*.jpg'

   Microsoft Windows expansion is done by the command, not shell, so --include *.jpg does not require quoting.

   If the rclone error Command .... needs .... arguments maximum: you provided .... non flag arguments: is encountered, the cause is commonly spaces within  the
   name of a remote or flag value.  The fix then is to quote values containing spaces.

Other filters --min-size - Don't transfer any file smaller than this

   Controls the minimum size file within the scope of an rclone command.  Default units are KiB but abbreviations K, M, G, T or P are valid.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --min-size 50k lists files on remote: of 50 KiB size or larger.

   See the size option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#size-option) for more info.

--max-size - Don't transfer any file larger than this

   Controls the maximum size file within the scope of an rclone command.  Default units are KiB but abbreviations K, M, G, T or P are valid.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --max-size 1G lists files on remote: of 1 GiB size or smaller.

   See the size option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#size-option) for more info.

--max-age - Don't transfer any file older than this

   Controls the maximum age of files within the scope of an rclone command.

   --max-age applies only to files and not to directories.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --max-age 2d lists files on remote: of 2 days old or less.

   See the time option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#time-option) for valid formats.

--min-age - Don't transfer any file younger than this

   Controls the minimum age of files within the scope of an rclone command.  (see --max-age for valid formats)

   --min-age applies only to files and not to directories.

   E.g.  rclone ls remote: --min-age 2d lists files on remote: of 2 days old or more.

   See the time option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#time-option) for valid formats.

Other flags --delete-excluded - Delete files on dest excluded from sync

   Important this flag is dangerous to your data - use with --dry-run and -v first.

   In conjunction with rclone sync, --delete-excluded deletes any files on the destination which are excluded from the command.

   E.g.  the scope of rclone sync --interactive A: B: can be restricted:

          rclone --min-size 50k --delete-excluded sync A: B:

   All files on B: which are less than 50 KiB are deleted because they are excluded from the rclone sync command.

--dump filters - dump the filters to the output

   Dumps the defined filters to standard output in regular expression format.

   Useful for debugging.

Exclude directory based on a file

   The  --exclude-if-present  flag  controls  whether a directory is within the scope of an rclone command based on the presence of a named file within it.  The
   flag can be repeated to check for multiple file names, presence of any of them will exclude the directory.

   This flag has a priority over other filter flags.

   E.g.  for the following directory structure:

          dir1/file1
          dir1/dir2/file2
          dir1/dir2/dir3/file3
          dir1/dir2/dir3/.ignore

   The command rclone ls --exclude-if-present .ignore dir1 does not list dir3, file3 or .ignore.

Metadata filters

   The metadata filters work in a very similar way to the normal file name filters, except they match metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata)  on  the  ob‐
   ject.

   The metadata should be specified as key=value patterns.  This may be wildcarded using the normal filter patterns or regular expressions.

   For example if you wished to list only local files with a mode of 100664 you could do that with:

          rclone lsf -M --files-only --metadata-include "mode=100664" .

   Or if you wished to show files with an atime, mtime or btime at a given date:

          rclone lsf -M --files-only --metadata-include "[abm]time=2022-12-16*" .

   Like file filtering, metadata filtering only applies to files not to directories.

   The filters can be applied using these flags.

    --metadata-include - Include metadatas matching pattern

    --metadata-include-from - Read metadata include patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)

    --metadata-exclude - Exclude metadatas matching pattern

    --metadata-exclude-from - Read metadata exclude patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)

    --metadata-filter - Add a metadata filtering rule

    --metadata-filter-from - Read metadata filtering patterns from a file (use - to read from stdin)

   Each  flag can be repeated.  See the section on how filter rules are applied for more details - these flags work in an identical way to the file name filter
   ing flags, but instead of file name patterns have metadata patterns.

Common pitfalls

   The most frequent filter support issues on the rclone forum (https://forum.rclone.org/) are:

    Not using paths relative to the root of the remote

    Not using / to match from the root of a remote

    Not using ** to match the contents of a directory

GUI (Experimental)

   Rclone can serve a web based GUI (graphical user interface).  This is somewhat experimental at the moment so things may be subject to change.

   Run this command in a terminal and rclone will download and then display the GUI in a web browser.

          rclone rcd --rc-web-gui

   This will produce logs like this and rclone needs to continue to run to serve the GUI:

          2019/08/25 11:40:14 NOTICE: A new release for gui is present at https://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/download/v0.0.6/currentbuild.zip
          2019/08/25 11:40:14 NOTICE: Downloading webgui binary. Please wait. [Size: 3813937, Path :  /home/USER/.cache/rclone/webgui/v0.0.6.zip]
          2019/08/25 11:40:16 NOTICE: Unzipping
          2019/08/25 11:40:16 NOTICE: Serving remote control on http://127.0.0.1:5572/

   This assumes you are running rclone locally on your machine.  It is possible to separate the rclone and the GUI - see below for details.

   If you wish to check for updates then you can add --rc-web-gui-update to the command line.

   If you find your GUI broken, you may force it to update by add --rc-web-gui-force-update.

   By default, rclone will open your browser.  Add --rc-web-gui-no-open-browser to disable this feature.

Using the GUI

   Once the GUI opens, you will be looking at the dashboard which has an overall overview.

   On the left hand side you will see a series of view buttons you can click on:

    Dashboard - main overview

    Configs - examine and create new configurations

    Explorer - view, download and upload files to the cloud storage systems

    Backend - view or alter the backend config

    Log out

   (More docs and walkthrough video to come!)

How it works

   When you run the rclone rcd --rc-web-gui this is what happens

    Rclone starts but only runs the remote control API ("rc").

    The API is bound to localhost with an auto-generated username and password.

    If the API bundle is missing then rclone will download it.

    rclone will start serving the files from the API bundle over the same port as the API

    rclone will open the browser with a login_token so it can log straight in.

Advanced use

   The rclone rcd may use any of the flags documented on the rc page (https://rclone.org/rc/#supported-parameters).

   The flag --rc-web-gui is shorthand for

    Download the web GUI if necessary

    Check we are using some authentication

    --rc-user gui

    --rc-pass <random password>

    --rc-serve

   These flags can be overridden as desired.

   See also the rclone rcd documentation (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rcd/).

Example: Running a public GUI

   For example the GUI could be served on a public port over SSL using an htpasswd file using the following flags:

    --rc-web-gui

    --rc-addr :443

    --rc-htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd

    --rc-cert /path/to/ssl.crt

    --rc-key /path/to/ssl.key

Example: Running a GUI behind a proxy

   If you want to run the GUI behind a proxy at /rclone you could use these flags:

    --rc-web-gui

    --rc-baseurl rclone

    --rc-htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd

   Or instead of htpasswd if you just want a single user and password:

    --rc-user me

    --rc-pass mypassword

Project

   The GUI is being developed in the: rclone/rclone-webui-react repository (https://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react).

   Bug reports and contributions are very welcome :-)

   If you have questions then please ask them on the rclone forum (https://forum.rclone.org/).

Remote controlling rclone with its API

   If rclone is run with the --rc flag then it starts an HTTP server which can be used to remote control rclone using its API.

   You can either use the rc command to access the API or use HTTP directly.

   If you just want to run a remote control then see the rcd (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rcd/) command.

Supported parameters --rc

   Flag to start the http server listen on remote requests

--rc-addr=IP

   IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to.  (default "localhost:5572")

--rc-cert=KEY

   SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)

--rc-client-ca=PATH

   Client certificate authority to verify clients with

--rc-htpasswd=PATH

   htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done

--rc-key=PATH

   SSL PEM Private key

--rc-max-header-bytes=VALUE

   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)

--rc-min-tls-version=VALUE

   The minimum TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are "tls1.0", "tls1.1", "tls1.2" and "tls1.3" (default "tls1.0").

--rc-user=VALUE

   User name for authentication.

--rc-pass=VALUE

   Password for authentication.

--rc-realm=VALUE

   Realm for authentication (default "rclone")

--rc-server-read-timeout=DURATION

   Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)

--rc-server-write-timeout=DURATION

   Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)

--rc-serve

   Enable the serving of remote objects via the HTTP interface.  This means objects will be accessible at http://127.0.0.1:5572/ by default, so you  can  browse
   to  http://127.0.0.1:5572/  or  http://127.0.0.1:5572/*  to  see  a  listing  of  the  remotes.   Objects  may  be  requested  from remotes using this syntax
   http://127.0.0.1:5572/[remote:path]/path/to/object

   Default Off.

--rc-files /path/to/directory

   Path to local files to serve on the HTTP server.

   If this is set then rclone will serve the files in that directory.  It will also open the root in the web browser if specified.   This  is  for  implementing
   browser based GUIs for rclone functions.

   If --rc-user or --rc-pass is set then the URL that is opened will have the authorization in the URL in the http://user:pass@localhost/ style.

   Default Off.

--rc-enable-metrics

   Enable OpenMetrics/Prometheus compatible endpoint at /metrics.

   Default Off.

--rc-web-gui

   Set this flag to serve the default web gui on the same port as rclone.

   Default Off.

--rc-allow-origin

   Set the allowed Access-Control-Allow-Origin for rc requests.

   Can be used with --rc-web-gui if the rclone is running on different IP than the web-gui.

   Default is IP address on which rc is running.

--rc-web-fetch-url

   Set the URL to fetch the rclone-web-gui files from.

   Default https://api.github.com/repos/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/latest.

--rc-web-gui-update

   Set this flag to check and update rclone-webui-react from the rc-web-fetch-url.

   Default Off.

--rc-web-gui-force-update

   Set this flag to force update rclone-webui-react from the rc-web-fetch-url.

   Default Off.

--rc-web-gui-no-open-browser

   Set this flag to disable opening browser automatically when using web-gui.

   Default Off.

--rc-job-expire-duration=DURATION

   Expire finished async jobs older than DURATION (default 60s).

--rc-job-expire-interval=DURATION

   Interval duration to check for expired async jobs (default 10s).

--rc-no-auth

   By  default rclone will require authorisation to have been set up on the rc interface in order to use any methods which access any rclone remotes.  Eg opera
   tions/list is denied as it involved creating a remote as is sync/copy.

   If this is set then no authorisation will be required on the server to use these methods.  The alternative is to use --rc-user and --rc-pass  and  use  these
   credentials in the request.

   Default Off.

--rc-baseurl

   Prefix for URLs.

   Default is root

--rc-template

   User-specified template.

Accessing the remote control via the rclone rc command

   Rclone itself implements the remote control protocol in its rclone rc command.

   You can use it like this

          $ rclone rc rc/noop param1=one param2=two
          {
              "param1": "one",
              "param2": "two"
          }

   Run rclone rc on its own to see the help for the installed remote control commands.

JSON input

   rclone rc also supports a --json flag which can be used to send more complicated input parameters.

          $ rclone rc --json '{ "p1": [1,"2",null,4], "p2": { "a":1, "b":2 } }' rc/noop
          {
              "p1": [
                  1,
                  "2",
                  null,
                  4
              ],
              "p2": {
                  "a": 1,
                  "b": 2
              }
          }

   If the parameter being passed is an object then it can be passed as a JSON string rather than using the --json flag which simplifies the command line.

          rclone rc operations/list fs=/tmp remote=test opt='{"showHash": true}'

   Rather than

          rclone rc operations/list --json '{"fs": "/tmp", "remote": "test", "opt": {"showHash": true}}'

Special parameters

   The rc interface supports some special parameters which apply to all commands.  These start with _ to show they are different.

Running asynchronous jobs with _async = true

   Each rc call is classified as a job and it is assigned its own id.  By default jobs are executed immediately as they are created or synchronously.

   If  _async  has  a  true  value  when  supplied  to an rc call then it will return immediately with a job id and the task will be run in the background.  The
   job/status call can be used to get information of the background job.  The job can be queried for up to 1 minute after it has finished.

   It is recommended that potentially long running jobs, e.g.  sync/sync, sync/copy, sync/move, operations/purge are run with the _async flag to avoid  any  po
   tential problems with the HTTP request and response timing out.

   Starting a job with the _async flag:

          $ rclone rc --json '{ "p1": [1,"2",null,4], "p2": { "a":1, "b":2 }, "_async": true }' rc/noop
          {
              "jobid": 2
          }

   Query the status to see if the job has finished.  For more information on the meaning of these return parameters see the job/status call.

          $ rclone rc --json '{ "jobid":2 }' job/status
          {
              "duration": 0.000124163,
              "endTime": "2018-10-27T11:38:07.911245881+01:00",
              "error": "",
              "finished": true,
              "id": 2,
              "output": {
                  "_async": true,
                  "p1": [
                      1,
                      "2",
                      null,
                      4
                  ],
                  "p2": {
                      "a": 1,
                      "b": 2
                  }
              },
              "startTime": "2018-10-27T11:38:07.911121728+01:00",
              "success": true
          }

   job/list can be used to show the running or recently completed jobs

          $ rclone rc job/list
          {
              "jobids": [
                  2
              ]
          }

Setting config flags with _config

   If you wish to set config (the equivalent of the global flags) for the duration of an rc call only then pass in the _config parameter.

   This should be in the same format as the config key returned by options/get.

   For example, if you wished to run a sync with the --checksum parameter, you would pass this parameter in your JSON blob.

          "_config":{"CheckSum": true}

   If using rclone rc this could be passed as

          rclone rc operations/sync ... _config='{"CheckSum": true}'

   Any config parameters you don't set will inherit the global defaults which were set with command line flags or environment variables.

   Note  that  it  is possible to set some values as strings or integers - see data types for more info.  Here is an example setting the equivalent of --buffer-
   size in string or integer format.

          "_config":{"BufferSize": "42M"}
          "_config":{"BufferSize": 44040192}

   If you wish to check the _config assignment has worked properly then calling options/local will show what the value got set to.

Setting filter flags with _filter

   If you wish to set filters for the duration of an rc call only then pass in the _filter parameter.

   This should be in the same format as the filter key returned by options/get.

   For example, if you wished to run a sync with these flags

          --max-size 1M --max-age 42s --include "a" --include "b"

   you would pass this parameter in your JSON blob.

          "_filter":{"MaxSize":"1M", "IncludeRule":["a","b"], "MaxAge":"42s"}

   If using rclone rc this could be passed as

          rclone rc ... _filter='{"MaxSize":"1M", "IncludeRule":["a","b"], "MaxAge":"42s"}'

   Any filter parameters you don't set will inherit the global defaults which were set with command line flags or environment variables.

   Note that it is possible to set some values as strings or integers - see data types for more info.  Here is an example setting the  equivalent  of  --buffer-
   size in string or integer format.

          "_filter":{"MinSize": "42M"}
          "_filter":{"MinSize": 44040192}

   If you wish to check the _filter assignment has worked properly then calling options/local will show what the value got set to.

Assigning operations to groups with _group = value

   Each  rc  call  has its own stats group for tracking its metrics.  By default grouping is done by the composite group name from prefix job/ and id of the job
   like so job/1.

   If _group has a value then stats for that request will be grouped under that value.  This allows caller to group stats under their own name.

   Stats for specific group can be accessed by passing group to core/stats:

          $ rclone rc --json '{ "group": "job/1" }' core/stats
          {
              "speed": 12345
              ...
          }

Data types

   When the API returns types, these will mostly be straight forward integer, string or boolean types.

   However some of the types returned by the options/get call and taken by the options/set calls as well as the vfsOpt, mountOpt and the _config parameters.

    Duration - these are returned as an integer duration in nanoseconds.  They may be set as an integer, or they may be set with time string, eg "5s".  See the
     options section (https://rclone.org/docs/#options) for more info.

    Size  -  these  are returned as an integer number of bytes.  They may be set as an integer or they may be set with a size suffix string, eg "10M".  See the
     options section (https://rclone.org/docs/#options) for more info.

    Enumerated type (such as CutoffMode, DumpFlags, LogLevel, VfsCacheMode - these will be returned as an integer and may be set as an integer but more  conve
     niently they can be set as a string, eg "HARD" for CutoffMode or DEBUG for LogLevel.

    BandwidthSpec - this will be set and returned as a string, eg "1M".

Specifying remotes to work on

   Remotes are specified with the fs=, srcFs=, dstFs= parameters depending on the command being used.

   The parameters can be a string as per the rest of rclone, eg s3:bucket/path or :sftp:/my/dir.  They can also be specified as JSON blobs.

   If  specifying  a JSON blob it should be a object mapping strings to strings.  These values will be used to configure the remote.  There are 3 special values
   which may be set:

    type - set to type to specify a remote called :type:

    _name - set to name to specify a remote called name:

    _root - sets the root of the remote - may be empty

   One of _name or type should normally be set.  If the local backend is desired then type should be set to local.  If _root isn't specified then it defaults to
   the root of the remote.

   For example this JSON is equivalent to remote:/tmp

          {
              "_name": "remote",
              "_path": "/tmp"
          }

   And this is equivalent to :sftp,host='example.com':/tmp

          {
              "type": "sftp",
              "host": "example.com",
              "_path": "/tmp"
          }

   And this is equivalent to /tmp/dir

          {
              type = "local",
              _ path = "/tmp/dir"
          }

Supported commands backend/command: Runs a backend command.

   This takes the following parameters:

    command - a string with the command name

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    arg - a list of arguments for the backend command

    opt - a map of string to string of options

   Returns:

    result - result from the backend command

   Example:

          rclone rc backend/command command=noop fs=. -o echo=yes -o blue -a path1 -a path2

   Returns

          {
              "result": {
                  "arg": [
                      "path1",
                      "path2"
                  ],
                  "name": "noop",
                  "opt": {
                      "blue": "",
                      "echo": "yes"
                  }
              }
          }

   Note that this is the direct equivalent of using this "backend" command:

          rclone backend noop . -o echo=yes -o blue path1 path2

   Note that arguments must be preceded by the "-a" flag

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more information.

   Authentication is required for this call.

cache/expire: Purge a remote from cache

   Purge  a  remote  from  the  cache  backend.  Supports either a directory or a file.  Params: - remote = path to remote (required) - withData = true/false to
   delete cached data (chunks) as well (optional)

   Eg

          rclone rc cache/expire remote=path/to/sub/folder/
          rclone rc cache/expire remote=/ withData=true

cache/fetch: Fetch file chunks

   Ensure the specified file chunks are cached on disk.

   The chunks= parameter specifies the file chunks to check.  It takes a comma separated list of array slice indices.  The slice indices are similar  to  Python
   slices: start[:end]

   start is the 0 based chunk number from the beginning of the file to fetch inclusive.  end is 0 based chunk number from the beginning of the file to fetch ex
   clusive.  Both values can be negative, in which case they count from the back of the file.  The value "-5:" represents the last 5 chunks of a file.

   Some valid examples are: ":5,-5:" -> the first and last five chunks "0,-2" -> the first and the second last chunk "0:10" -> the first ten chunks

   Any parameter with a key that starts with "file" can be used to specify files to fetch, e.g.

          rclone rc cache/fetch chunks=0 file=hello file2=home/goodbye

   File names will automatically be encrypted when the a crypt remote is used on top of the cache.

cache/stats: Get cache stats

   Show statistics for the cache remote.

config/create: create the config for a remote.

   This takes the following parameters:

    name - name of remote

    parameters - a map of { "key": "value" } pairs

    type - type of the new remote

    opt - a dictionary of options to control the configuration

      obscure - declare passwords are plain and need obscuring

      noObscure - declare passwords are already obscured and don't need obscuring

     • nonInteractive - don't interact with a user, return questions

      continue - continue the config process with an answer

      all - ask all the config questions not just the post config ones

      state - state to restart with - used with continue

      result - result to restart with - used with continue

   See the config create (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/delete: Delete a remote in the config file.

   Parameters:

    name - name of remote to delete

   See the config delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_delete/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/dump: Dumps the config file.

   Returns a JSON object: - key: value

   Where keys are remote names and values are the config parameters.

   See the config dump (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_dump/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/get: Get a remote in the config file.

   Parameters:

    name - name of remote to get

   See the config dump (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_dump/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/listremotes: Lists the remotes in the config file.

   Returns - remotes - array of remote names

   See the listremotes (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_listremotes/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/password: password the config for a remote.

   This takes the following parameters:

    name - name of remote

    parameters - a map of { "key": "value" } pairs

   See the config password (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_password/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/providers: Shows how providers are configured in the config file.

   Returns a JSON object: - providers - array of objects

   See the config providers (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_providers/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

config/update: update the config for a remote.

   This takes the following parameters:

    name - name of remote

    parameters - a map of { "key": "value" } pairs

    opt - a dictionary of options to control the configuration

      obscure - declare passwords are plain and need obscuring

      noObscure - declare passwords are already obscured and don't need obscuring

     • nonInteractive - don't interact with a user, return questions

      continue - continue the config process with an answer

      all - ask all the config questions not just the post config ones

      state - state to restart with - used with continue

      result - result to restart with - used with continue

   See the config update (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_update/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

core/bwlimit: Set the bandwidth limit.

   This sets the bandwidth limit to the string passed in.  This should be a single bandwidth limit entry or a pair of upload:download bandwidth.

   Eg

          rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=off
          {
              "bytesPerSecond": -1,
              "bytesPerSecondTx": -1,
              "bytesPerSecondRx": -1,
              "rate": "off"
          }
          rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M
          {
              "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
              "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
              "bytesPerSecondRx": 1048576,
              "rate": "1M"
          }
          rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M:100k
          {
              "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
              "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
              "bytesPerSecondRx": 131072,
              "rate": "1M"
          }

   If the rate parameter is not supplied then the bandwidth is queried

          rclone rc core/bwlimit
          {
              "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
              "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
              "bytesPerSecondRx": 1048576,
              "rate": "1M"
          }

   The format of the parameter is exactly the same as passed to --bwlimit except only one bandwidth may be specified.

   In either case "rate" is returned as a human-readable string, and "bytesPerSecond" is returned as a number.

core/command: Run a rclone terminal command over rc.

   This takes the following parameters:

    command - a string with the command name.

    arg - a list of arguments for the backend command.

    opt - a map of string to string of options.

    returnType - one of ("COMBINED_OUTPUT", "STREAM", "STREAM_ONLY_STDOUT", "STREAM_ONLY_STDERR").

      Defaults to "COMBINED_OUTPUT" if not set.

      The STREAM returnTypes will write the output to the body of the HTTP message.

      The COMBINED_OUTPUT will write the output to the "result" parameter.

   Returns:

    result - result from the backend command.

      Only set when using returnType "COMBINED_OUTPUT".

    error - set if rclone exits with an error code.

    returnType - one of ("COMBINED_OUTPUT", "STREAM", "STREAM_ONLY_STDOUT", "STREAM_ONLY_STDERR").

   Example:

          rclone rc core/command command=ls -a mydrive:/ -o max-depth=1
          rclone rc core/command -a ls -a mydrive:/ -o max-depth=1

   Returns:

          {
              "error": false,
              "result": "<Raw command line output>"
          }

          OR
          {
              "error": true,
              "result": "<Raw command line output>"
          }

   Authentication is required for this call.

core/gc: Runs a garbage collection.

   This tells the go runtime to do a garbage collection run.  It isn't necessary to call this normally, but it can be useful for debugging memory problems.

core/group-list: Returns list of stats.

   This returns list of stats groups currently in memory.

   Returns the following values:

          {
              "groups":  an array of group names:
                  [
                      "group1",
                      "group2",
                      ...
                  ]
          }

core/memstats: Returns the memory statistics

   This returns the memory statistics of the running program.  What the values mean are explained in the go docs: https://golang.org/pkg/runtime/#MemStats

   The most interesting values for most people are:

    HeapAlloc - this is the amount of memory rclone is actually using

    HeapSys - this is the amount of memory rclone has obtained from the OS

    Sys - this is the total amount of memory requested from the OS

      It is virtual memory so may include unused memory

core/obscure: Obscures a string passed in.

   Pass a clear string and rclone will obscure it for the config file: - clear - string

   Returns: - obscured - string

core/pid: Return PID of current process

   This returns PID of current process.  Useful for stopping rclone process.

core/quit: Terminates the app.

   (Optional) Pass an exit code to be used for terminating the app: - exitCode - int

core/stats: Returns stats about current transfers.

   This returns all available stats:

          rclone rc core/stats

   If group is not provided then summed up stats for all groups will be returned.

   Parameters

    group - name of the stats group (string)

   Returns the following values:

          {
              "bytes": total transferred bytes since the start of the group,
              "checks": number of files checked,
              "deletes" : number of files deleted,
              "elapsedTime": time in floating point seconds since rclone was started,
              "errors": number of errors,
              "eta": estimated time in seconds until the group completes,
              "fatalError": boolean whether there has been at least one fatal error,
              "lastError": last error string,
              "renames" : number of files renamed,
              "retryError": boolean showing whether there has been at least one non-NoRetryError,
              "speed": average speed in bytes per second since start of the group,
              "totalBytes": total number of bytes in the group,
              "totalChecks": total number of checks in the group,
              "totalTransfers": total number of transfers in the group,
              "transferTime" : total time spent on running jobs,
              "transfers": number of transferred files,
              "transferring": an array of currently active file transfers:
                  [
                      {
                          "bytes": total transferred bytes for this file,
                          "eta": estimated time in seconds until file transfer completion
                          "name": name of the file,
                          "percentage": progress of the file transfer in percent,
                          "speed": average speed over the whole transfer in bytes per second,
                          "speedAvg": current speed in bytes per second as an exponentially weighted moving average,
                          "size": size of the file in bytes
                      }
                  ],
              "checking": an array of names of currently active file checks
                  []
          }

   Values for "transferring", "checking" and "lastError" are only assigned if data is available.  The value for "eta" is null if an eta cannot be determined.

core/stats-delete: Delete stats group.

   This deletes entire stats group.

   Parameters

    group - name of the stats group (string)

core/stats-reset: Reset stats.

   This clears counters, errors and finished transfers for all stats or specific stats group if group is provided.

   Parameters

    group - name of the stats group (string)

core/transferred: Returns stats about completed transfers.

   This returns stats about completed transfers:

          rclone rc core/transferred

   If group is not provided then completed transfers for all groups will be returned.

   Note only the last 100 completed transfers are returned.

   Parameters

    group - name of the stats group (string)

   Returns the following values:

          {
              "transferred":  an array of completed transfers (including failed ones):
                  [
                      {
                          "name": name of the file,
                          "size": size of the file in bytes,
                          "bytes": total transferred bytes for this file,
                          "checked": if the transfer is only checked (skipped, deleted),
                          "timestamp": integer representing millisecond unix epoch,
                          "error": string description of the error (empty if successful),
                          "jobid": id of the job that this transfer belongs to
                      }
                  ]
          }

core/version: Shows the current version of rclone and the go runtime.

   This shows the current version of go and the go runtime:

    version - rclone version, e.g.  "v1.53.0"

    decomposed - version number as [major, minor, patch]

    isGit - boolean - true if this was compiled from the git version

    isBeta - boolean - true if this is a beta version

    os - OS in use as according to Go

    arch - cpu architecture in use according to Go

    goVersion - version of Go runtime in use

    linking - type of rclone executable (static or dynamic)

    goTags - space separated build tags or "none"

debug/set-block-profile-rate: Set runtime.SetBlockProfileRate for blocking profiling.

   SetBlockProfileRate controls the fraction of goroutine blocking events that are reported in the blocking profile.  The profiler aims to sample an average  of
   one blocking event per rate nanoseconds spent blocked.

   To include every blocking event in the profile, pass rate = 1.  To turn off profiling entirely, pass rate <= 0.

   After calling this you can use this to see the blocking profile:

          go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/block

   Parameters:

    rate - int

debug/set-mutex-profile-fraction: Set runtime.SetMutexProfileFraction for mutex profiling.

   SetMutexProfileFraction controls the fraction of mutex contention events that are reported in the mutex profile.  On average 1/rate events are reported.  The
   previous rate is returned.

   To turn off profiling entirely, pass rate 0.  To just read the current rate, pass rate < 0.  (For n>1 the details of sampling may change.)

   Once this is set you can look use this to profile the mutex contention:

          go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/mutex

   Parameters:

    rate - int

   Results:

    previousRate - int

fscache/clear: Clear the Fs cache.

   This clears the fs cache.  This is where remotes created from backends are cached for a short while to make repeated rc calls more efficient.

   If you change the parameters of a backend then you may want to call this to clear an existing remote out of the cache before re-creating it.

   Authentication is required for this call.

fscache/entries: Returns the number of entries in the fs cache.

   This returns the number of entries in the fs cache.

   Returns - entries - number of items in the cache

   Authentication is required for this call.

job/list: Lists the IDs of the running jobs

   Parameters: None.

   Results:

    jobids - array of integer job ids.

job/status: Reads the status of the job ID

   Parameters:

    jobid - id of the job (integer).

   Results:

    finished - boolean

    duration - time in seconds that the job ran for

    endTime - time the job finished (e.g.  "2018-10-26T18:50:20.528746884+01:00")

    error - error from the job or empty string for no error

    finished - boolean whether the job has finished or not

    id - as passed in above

    startTime - time the job started (e.g.  "2018-10-26T18:50:20.528336039+01:00")

    success - boolean - true for success false otherwise

    output - output of the job as would have been returned if called synchronously

    progress - output of the progress related to the underlying job

job/stop: Stop the running job

   Parameters:

    jobid - id of the job (integer).

job/stopgroup: Stop all running jobs in a group

   Parameters:

    group - name of the group (string).

mount/listmounts: Show current mount points

   This shows currently mounted points, which can be used for performing an unmount.

   This takes no parameters and returns

    mountPoints: list of current mount points

   Eg

          rclone rc mount/listmounts

   Authentication is required for this call.

mount/mount: Create a new mount point

   rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any of Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with FUSE.

   If no mountType is provided, the priority is given as follows: 1.  mount 2.cmount 3.mount2

   This takes the following parameters:

   • fs - a remote path to be mounted (required)

   • mountPoint: valid path on the local machine (required)

   • mountType: one of the values (mount, cmount, mount2) specifies the mount implementation to use

   • mountOpt: a JSON object with Mount options in.

   • vfsOpt: a JSON object with VFS options in.

   Example:

          rclone rc mount/mount fs=mydrive: mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint
          rclone rc mount/mount fs=mydrive: mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint mountType=mount
          rclone rc mount/mount fs=TestDrive: mountPoint=/mnt/tmp vfsOpt='{"CacheMode": 2}' mountOpt='{"AllowOther": true}'

   The vfsOpt are as described in options/get and can be seen in the the "vfs" section when running and the mountOpt can be seen in the "mount" section:

          rclone rc options/get

   Authentication is required for this call.

mount/types: Show all possible mount types

   This shows all possible mount types and returns them as a list.

   This takes no parameters and returns

    mountTypes: list of mount types

   The mount types are strings like "mount", "mount2", "cmount" and can be passed to mount/mount as the mountType parameter.

   Eg

          rclone rc mount/types

   Authentication is required for this call.

mount/unmount: Unmount selected active mount

   rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any of Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with FUSE.

   This takes the following parameters:

    mountPoint: valid path on the local machine where the mount was created (required)

   Example:

          rclone rc mount/unmount mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint

   Authentication is required for this call.

mount/unmountall: Unmount all active mounts

   rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any of Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with FUSE.

   This takes no parameters and returns error if unmount does not succeed.

   Eg

          rclone rc mount/unmountall

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/about: Return the space used on the remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

   The result is as returned from rclone about --json

   See the about (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/cleanup: Remove trashed files in the remote or path

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

   See the cleanup (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cleanup/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/copyfile: Copy a file from source remote to destination remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    srcFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:" for the source

    srcRemote - a path within that remote e.g.  "file.txt" for the source

    dstFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive2:" for the destination

    dstRemote - a path within that remote e.g.  "file2.txt" for the destination

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/copyurl: Copy the URL to the object

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

    url - string, URL to read from

    autoFilename - boolean, set to true to retrieve destination file name from url

   See the copyurl (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copyurl/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/delete: Remove files in the path

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

   See the delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/deletefile: Remove the single file pointed to

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

   See the deletefile (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_deletefile/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/fsinfo: Return information about the remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

   This returns info about the remote passed in;

          {
                  // optional features and whether they are available or not
                  "Features": {
                          "About": true,
                          "BucketBased": false,
                          "BucketBasedRootOK": false,
                          "CanHaveEmptyDirectories": true,
                          "CaseInsensitive": false,
                          "ChangeNotify": false,
                          "CleanUp": false,
                          "Command": true,
                          "Copy": false,
                          "DirCacheFlush": false,
                          "DirMove": true,
                          "Disconnect": false,
                          "DuplicateFiles": false,
                          "GetTier": false,
                          "IsLocal": true,
                          "ListR": false,
                          "MergeDirs": false,
                          "MetadataInfo": true,
                          "Move": true,
                          "OpenWriterAt": true,
                          "PublicLink": false,
                          "Purge": true,
                          "PutStream": true,
                          "PutUnchecked": false,
                          "ReadMetadata": true,
                          "ReadMimeType": false,
                          "ServerSideAcrossConfigs": false,
                          "SetTier": false,
                          "SetWrapper": false,
                          "Shutdown": false,
                          "SlowHash": true,
                          "SlowModTime": false,
                          "UnWrap": false,
                          "UserInfo": false,
                          "UserMetadata": true,
                          "WrapFs": false,
                          "WriteMetadata": true,
                          "WriteMimeType": false
                  },
                  // Names of hashes available
                  "Hashes": [
                          "md5",
                          "sha1",
                          "whirlpool",
                          "crc32",
                          "sha256",
                          "dropbox",
                          "mailru",
                          "quickxor"
                  ],
                  "Name": "local",        // Name as created
                  "Precision": 1,         // Precision of timestamps in ns
                  "Root": "/",            // Path as created
                  "String": "Local file system at /", // how the remote will appear in logs
                  // Information about the system metadata for this backend
                  "MetadataInfo": {
                          "System": {
                                  "atime": {
                                          "Help": "Time of last access",
                                          "Type": "RFC 3339",
                                          "Example": "2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00"
                                  },
                                  "btime": {
                                          "Help": "Time of file birth (creation)",
                                          "Type": "RFC 3339",
                                          "Example": "2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00"
                                  },
                                  "gid": {
                                          "Help": "Group ID of owner",
                                          "Type": "decimal number",
                                          "Example": "500"
                                  },
                                  "mode": {
                                          "Help": "File type and mode",
                                          "Type": "octal, unix style",
                                          "Example": "0100664"
                                  },
                                  "mtime": {
                                          "Help": "Time of last modification",
                                          "Type": "RFC 3339",
                                          "Example": "2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00"
                                  },
                                  "rdev": {
                                          "Help": "Device ID (if special file)",
                                          "Type": "hexadecimal",
                                          "Example": "1abc"
                                  },
                                  "uid": {
                                          "Help": "User ID of owner",
                                          "Type": "decimal number",
                                          "Example": "500"
                                  }
                          },
                          "Help": "Textual help string\n"
                  }
          }

   This command does not have a command line equivalent so use this instead:

          rclone rc --loopback operations/fsinfo fs=remote:

operations/list: List the given remote and path in JSON format

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

    opt - a dictionary of options to control the listing (optional)

      recurse - If set recurse directories

      noModTime - If set return modification time

      showEncrypted - If set show decrypted names

      showOrigIDs - If set show the IDs for each item if known

      showHash - If set return a dictionary of hashes

      noMimeType - If set don't show mime types

      dirsOnly - If set only show directories

      filesOnly - If set only show files

      metadata - If set return metadata of objects also

      hashTypes - array of strings of hash types to show if showHash set

   Returns:

    list

      This is an array of objects as described in the lsjson command

   See the lsjson (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsjson/) command for more information on the above and examples.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/mkdir: Make a destination directory or container

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

   See the mkdir (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mkdir/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/movefile: Move a file from source remote to destination remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    srcFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:" for the source

    srcRemote - a path within that remote e.g.  "file.txt" for the source

    dstFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive2:" for the destination

    dstRemote - a path within that remote e.g.  "file2.txt" for the destination

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/publiclink: Create or retrieve a public link to the given file or folder.

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

    unlink - boolean - if set removes the link rather than adding it (optional)

    expire - string - the expiry time of the link e.g.  "1d" (optional)

   Returns:

    url - URL of the resource

   See the link (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_link/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/purge: Remove a directory or container and all of its contents

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

   See the purge (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/rmdir: Remove an empty directory or container

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

   See the rmdir (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/rmdirs: Remove all the empty directories in the path

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

    leaveRoot - boolean, set to true not to delete the root

   See the rmdirs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/size: Count the number of bytes and files in remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:path/to/dir"

   Returns:

    count - number of files

    bytes - number of bytes in those files

   See the size (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/stat: Give information about the supplied file or directory

   This takes the following parameters

    fs - a remote name string eg "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote eg "dir"

    opt - a dictionary of options to control the listing (optional)

      see operations/list for the options

   The result is

    item - an object as described in the lsjson command.  Will be null if not found.

   Note that if you are only interested in files then it is much more efficient to set the filesOnly flag in the options.

   See the lsjson (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsjson/) command for more information on the above and examples.

   Authentication is required for this call.

operations/uploadfile: Upload file using multiform/form-data

   This takes the following parameters:

    fs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:"

    remote - a path within that remote e.g.  "dir"

    each part in body represents a file to be uploaded

   See the uploadfile (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_uploadfile/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

options/blocks: List all the option blocks

   Returns: - options - a list of the options block names

options/get: Get all the global options

   Returns an object where keys are option block names and values are an object with the current option values in.

   Note that these are the global options which are unaffected by use of the _config and _filter parameters.  If you wish to read the parameters set in  _config
   then use options/config and for _filter use options/filter.

   This shows the internal names of the option within rclone which should map to the external options very easily with a few exceptions.

options/local: Get the currently active config for this call

   Returns an object with the keys "config" and "filter".  The "config" key contains the local config and the "filter" key contains the local filters.

   Note that these are the local options specific to this rc call.  If _config was not supplied then they will be the global options.  Likewise with "_filter".

   This call is mostly useful for seeing if _config and _filter passing is working.

   This shows the internal names of the option within rclone which should map to the external options very easily with a few exceptions.

options/set: Set an option

   Parameters:

    option block name containing an object with

      key: value

   Repeated as often as required.

   Only  supply  the  options  you  wish to change.  If an option is unknown it will be silently ignored.  Not all options will have an effect when changed like
   this.

   For example:

   This sets DEBUG level logs (-vv) (these can be set by number or string)

          rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": "DEBUG"}}'
          rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": 8}}'

   And this sets INFO level logs (-v)

          rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": "INFO"}}'

   And this sets NOTICE level logs (normal without -v)

          rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": "NOTICE"}}'

pluginsctl/addPlugin: Add a plugin using url

   Used for adding a plugin to the webgui.

   This takes the following parameters:

    url - http url of the github repo where the plugin is hosted (http://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react).

   Example:

   rclone rc pluginsctl/addPlugin

   Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/getPluginsForType: Get plugins with type criteria

   This shows all possible plugins by a mime type.

   This takes the following parameters:

    type - supported mime type by a loaded plugin e.g.  (video/mp4, audio/mp3).

    pluginType - filter plugins based on their type e.g.  (DASHBOARD, FILE_HANDLER, TERMINAL).

   Returns:

    loadedPlugins - list of current production plugins.

    testPlugins - list of temporarily loaded development plugins, usually running on a different server.

   Example:

   rclone rc pluginsctl/getPluginsForType type=video/mp4

   Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/listPlugins: Get the list of currently loaded plugins

   This allows you to get the currently enabled plugins and their details.

   This takes no parameters and returns:

    loadedPlugins - list of current production plugins.

    testPlugins - list of temporarily loaded development plugins, usually running on a different server.

   E.g.

   rclone rc pluginsctl/listPlugins

   Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/listTestPlugins: Show currently loaded test plugins

   Allows listing of test plugins with the rclone.test set to true in package.json of the plugin.

   This takes no parameters and returns:

    loadedTestPlugins - list of currently available test plugins.

   E.g.

          rclone rc pluginsctl/listTestPlugins

   Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/removePlugin: Remove a loaded plugin

   This allows you to remove a plugin using it's name.

   This takes parameters:

    name - name of the plugin in the format author/plugin_name.

   E.g.

   rclone rc pluginsctl/removePlugin name=rclone/video-plugin

   Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/removeTestPlugin: Remove a test plugin

   This allows you to remove a plugin using it's name.

   This takes the following parameters:

    name - name of the plugin in the format author/plugin_name.

   Example:

          rclone rc pluginsctl/removeTestPlugin name=rclone/rclone-webui-react

   Authentication is required for this call.

rc/error: This returns an error

   This returns an error with the input as part of its error string.  Useful for testing error handling.

rc/list: List all the registered remote control commands

   This lists all the registered remote control commands as a JSON map in the commands response.

rc/noop: Echo the input to the output parameters

   This echoes the input parameters to the output parameters for testing purposes.  It can be used to check that rclone is still alive and to check that parame
   ter passing is working properly.

rc/noopauth: Echo the input to the output parameters requiring auth

   This echoes the input parameters to the output parameters for testing purposes.  It can be used to check that rclone is still alive and to check that parame
   ter passing is working properly.

   Authentication is required for this call.

sync/bisync: Perform bidirectional synchronization between two paths.

   This takes the following parameters

    path1 - a remote directory string e.g.  drive:path1

    path2 - a remote directory string e.g.  drive:path2

    dryRun - dry-run mode

    resync - performs the resync run

    checkAccess - abort if RCLONE_TEST files are not found on both filesystems

    checkFilename - file name for checkAccess (default: RCLONE_TEST)

    maxDelete - abort sync if percentage of deleted files is above this threshold (default: 50)

    force - maxDelete safety check and run the sync

    checkSync - true by default, false disables comparison of final listings, only will skip sync, only compare listings from the last run

    removeEmptyDirs - remove empty directories at the final cleanup step

    filtersFile - read filtering patterns from a file

    workdir - server directory for history files (default: /root/.cache/rclone/bisync)

    noCleanup - retain working files

   See bisync command help (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_bisync/) and full bisync description (https://rclone.org/bisync/) for more information.

   Authentication is required for this call.

sync/copy: copy a directory from source remote to destination remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    srcFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:src" for the source

    dstFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:dst" for the destination

    createEmptySrcDirs - create empty src directories on destination if set

   See the copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

sync/move: move a directory from source remote to destination remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    srcFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:src" for the source

    dstFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:dst" for the destination

    createEmptySrcDirs - create empty src directories on destination if set

    deleteEmptySrcDirs - delete empty src directories if set

   See the move (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_move/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

sync/sync: sync a directory from source remote to destination remote

   This takes the following parameters:

    srcFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:src" for the source

    dstFs - a remote name string e.g.  "drive:dst" for the destination

    createEmptySrcDirs - create empty src directories on destination if set

   See the sync (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sync/) command for more information on the above.

   Authentication is required for this call.

vfs/forget: Forget files or directories in the directory cache.

   This forgets the paths in the directory cache causing them to be re-read from the remote when needed.

   If no paths are passed in then it will forget all the paths in the directory cache.

          rclone rc vfs/forget

   Otherwise pass files or dirs in as file=path or dir=path.  Any parameter key starting with file will forget that file and any starting with dir  will  forget
   that dir, e.g.

          rclone rc vfs/forget file=hello file2=goodbye dir=home/junk

   This  command  takes  an "fs" parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If there is more
   than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter must be supplied.

vfs/list: List active VFSes.

   This lists the active VFSes.

   It returns a list under the key "vfses" where the values are the VFS names that could be passed to the other VFS commands in the "fs" parameter.

vfs/poll-interval: Get the status or update the value of the poll-interval option.

   Without any parameter given this returns the current status of the poll-interval setting.

   When the interval=duration parameter is set, the poll-interval value is updated and the polling function is notified.  Setting interval=0  disables  poll-in
   terval.

          rclone rc vfs/poll-interval interval=5m

   The  timeout=duration  parameter  can be used to specify a time to wait for the current poll function to apply the new value.  If timeout is less or equal 0,
   which is the default, wait indefinitely.

   The new poll-interval value will only be active when the timeout is not reached.

   If poll-interval is updated or disabled temporarily, some changes might not get picked up by the polling function, depending on the used remote.

   This command takes an "fs" parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If  there  is  more
   than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter must be supplied.

vfs/refresh: Refresh the directory cache.

   This reads the directories for the specified paths and freshens the directory cache.

   If no paths are passed in then it will refresh the root directory.

          rclone rc vfs/refresh

   Otherwise pass directories in as dir=path.  Any parameter key starting with dir will refresh that directory, e.g.

          rclone rc vfs/refresh dir=home/junk dir2=data/misc

   If the parameter recursive=true is given the whole directory tree will get refreshed.  This refresh will use --fast-list if enabled.

   This  command  takes  an "fs" parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If there is more
   than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter must be supplied.

vfs/stats: Stats for a VFS.

   This returns stats for the selected VFS.

          {
              // Status of the disk cache - only present if --vfs-cache-mode > off
              "diskCache": {
                  "bytesUsed": 0,
                  "erroredFiles": 0,
                  "files": 0,
                  "hashType": 1,
                  "outOfSpace": false,
                  "path": "/home/user/.cache/rclone/vfs/local/mnt/a",
                  "pathMeta": "/home/user/.cache/rclone/vfsMeta/local/mnt/a",
                  "uploadsInProgress": 0,
                  "uploadsQueued": 0
              },
              "fs": "/mnt/a",
              "inUse": 1,
              // Status of the in memory metadata cache
              "metadataCache": {
                  "dirs": 1,
                  "files": 0
              },
              // Options as returned by options/get
              "opt": {
                  "CacheMaxAge": 3600000000000,
                  // ...
                  "WriteWait": 1000000000
              }
          }

   This command takes an "fs" parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If  there  is  more
   than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter must be supplied.

Accessing the remote control via HTTP

   Rclone implements a simple HTTP based protocol.

   Each endpoint takes an JSON object and returns a JSON object or an error.  The JSON objects are essentially a map of string names to values.

   All calls must made using POST.

   The  input objects can be supplied using URL parameters, POST parameters or by supplying "Content-Type: application/json" and a JSON blob in the body.  There
   are examples of these below using curl.

   The response will be a JSON blob in the body of the response.  This is formatted to be reasonably human-readable.

Error returns

   If an error occurs then there will be an HTTP error status (e.g.  500) and the body of the response will contain a JSON encoded error object, e.g.

          {
              "error": "Expecting string value for key \"remote\" (was float64)",
              "input": {
                  "fs": "/tmp",
                  "remote": 3
              },
              "status": 400
              "path": "operations/rmdir",
          }

   The keys in the error response are - error - error string - input - the input parameters to the call - status - the HTTP status code - path - the path of the
   call

CORS

   The  sever  implements  basic CORS support and allows all origins for that.  The response to a preflight OPTIONS request will echo the requested "Access-Con‐
   trol-Request-Headers" back.

Using POST with URL parameters only

          curl -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?potato=1&sausage=2'

   Response

          {
              "potato": "1",
              "sausage": "2"
          }

   Here is what an error response looks like:

          curl -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/error?potato=1&sausage=2'

          {
              "error": "arbitrary error on input map[potato:1 sausage:2]",
              "input": {
                  "potato": "1",
                  "sausage": "2"
              }
          }

   Note that curl doesn't return errors to the shell unless you use the -f option

          $ curl -f -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/error?potato=1&sausage=2'
          curl: (22) The requested URL returned error: 400 Bad Request
          $ echo $?
          22

Using POST with a form

          curl --data "potato=1" --data "sausage=2" http://localhost:5572/rc/noop

   Response

          {
              "potato": "1",
              "sausage": "2"
          }

   Note that you can combine these with URL parameters too with the POST parameters taking precedence.

          curl --data "potato=1" --data "sausage=2" "http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?rutabaga=3&sausage=4"

   Response

          {
              "potato": "1",
              "rutabaga": "3",
              "sausage": "4"
          }

Using POST with a JSON blob

          curl -H "Content-Type: application/json" -X POST -d '{"potato":2,"sausage":1}' http://localhost:5572/rc/noop

   response

          {
              "password": "xyz",
              "username": "xyz"
          }

   This can be combined with URL parameters too if required.  The JSON blob takes precedence.

          curl -H "Content-Type: application/json" -X POST -d '{"potato":2,"sausage":1}' 'http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?rutabaga=3&potato=4'

          {
              "potato": 2,
              "rutabaga": "3",
              "sausage": 1
          }

Debugging rclone with pprof

   If you use the --rc flag this will also enable the use of the go profiling tools on the same port.

   To use these, first install go (https://golang.org/doc/install).

Debugging memory use

   To profile rclone's memory use you can run:

          go tool pprof -web http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap

   This should open a page in your browser showing what is using what memory.

   You can also use the -text flag to produce a textual summary

          $ go tool pprof -text http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap
          Showing nodes accounting for 1537.03kB, 100% of 1537.03kB total
                flat  flat%   sum%        cum   cum%
           1024.03kB 66.62% 66.62%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.addDecoderNode
               513kB 33.38%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.newBufioWriterSize
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/all.init
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/serve.init
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/serve/restic.init
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2.init
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.init
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.init.0
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  main.init
                   0     0%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.(*conn).readRequest
                   0     0%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.(*conn).serve
                   0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  runtime.main

Debugging go routine leaks

   Memory leaks are most often caused by go routine leaks keeping memory alive which should have been garbage collected.

   See all active go routines using

          curl http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1

   Or go to http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1 in your browser.

Other profiles to look at

   You can see a summary of profiles available at http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/

   Here is how to use some of them:

    Memory: go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap

    Go routines: curl http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1

    30-second CPU profile: go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/profile

    5-second execution trace: wget http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/trace?seconds=5

    Goroutine blocking profile

      Enable first with: rclone rc debug/set-block-profile-rate rate=1 (docs)

      go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/block

    Contended mutexes:

      Enable first with: rclone rc debug/set-mutex-profile-fraction rate=1 (docs)

      go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/mutex

   See the net/http/pprof docs (https://golang.org/pkg/net/http/pprof/) for more info on how to use the profiling and for a general overview see the  Go  team's
   blog post on profiling go programs (https://blog.golang.org/profiling-go-programs).

   The profiling hook is zero overhead unless it is used (https://stackoverflow.com/q/26545159/164234).

Overview of cloud storage systems

   Each cloud storage system is slightly different.  Rclone attempts to provide a unified interface to them, but some underlying differences show through.

Features

   Here is an overview of the major features of each cloud storage system.

   Name                     Hash       Mod     Case Insen    Duplicate     MIME     Meta
                                       Time     sitive         Files         Type     data
   
   1Fichier              Whirlpool       -          No            Yes         R         -
   Akamai Netstorage    MD5, SHA256     R/W         No            No          R         -
   Amazon Drive             MD5          -          Yes           No          R         -
   Amazon S3  (or  S3       MD5         R/W         No            No         R/W       RWU
   compatible)
   Backblaze B2             SHA1        R/W         No            No         R/W        -
   Box                      SHA1        R/W         Yes           No          -         -
   Citrix ShareFile         MD5         R/W         Yes           No          -         -
   Dropbox                DBHASH ¹       R          Yes           No          -         -
   Enterprise    File        -          R/W         Yes           No         R/W        -
   Fabric
   FTP                       -        R/W ¹        No            No          -         -
   Google Cloud Stor       MD5         R/W         No            No         R/W        -
   age
   Google Drive             MD5         R/W         No            Yes        R/W        -
   Google Photos             -           -          No            Yes         R         -
   HDFS                      -          R/W         No            No          -         -
   HiDrive               HiDrive ¹²     R/W         No            No          -         -
   HTTP                      -           R          No            No          R         -
   Internet Archive     MD5,  SHA1,   R/W ¹¹        No            No          -        RWU
                        CRC32
   Jottacloud               MD5         R/W         Yes           No          R         -
   Koofr                    MD5          -          Yes           No          -         -
   Mail.ru Cloud          Mailru       R/W         Yes           No          -         -
   Mega                      -           -          No            Yes         -         -
   Memory                   MD5         R/W         No            No          -         -
   Microsoft    Azure       MD5         R/W         No            No         R/W        -
   Blob Storage
   Microsoft OneDrive     QuickX       R/W         Yes           No          R         -
                          orHash 
   OpenDrive                MD5         R/W         Yes        Partial       -         -
   OpenStack Swift          MD5         R/W         No            No         R/W        -
   Oracle      Object       MD5         R/W         No            No         R/W        -
   Storage
   pCloud               MD5, SHA1       R          No            No          W         -
   premiumize.me             -           -          Yes           No          R         -
   put.io                  CRC-32       R/W         No            Yes         R         -
   QingStor                 MD5         -          No            No         R/W        -
   Seafile                   -           -          No            No          -         -
   SFTP                 MD5, SHA1 ²     R/W       Depends         No          -         -
   Sia                       -           -          No            No          -         -
   SMB                       -           -          Yes           No          -         -
   SugarSync                 -           -          No            No          -         -
   Storj                     -           R          No            No          -         -
   Uptobox                   -           -          No            Yes         -         -
   WebDAV               MD5, SHA1 ³     R        Depends         No          -         -
   Yandex Disk              MD5         R/W         No            No          R         -
   Zoho WorkDrive            -           -          No            No          -         -
   The local filesys       All         R/W       Depends         No          -        RWU
   tem

Notes

   ¹ Dropbox supports its own custom hash (https://www.dropbox.com/developers/reference/content-hash).  This is an SHA256 sum of all the 4 MiB block SHA256s.

   ² SFTP supports checksums if the same login has shell access and md5sum or sha1sum as well as echo are in the remote's PATH.

   ³ WebDAV supports hashes when used with Owncloud and Nextcloud only.

   ⁴ WebDAV supports modtimes when used with Owncloud and Nextcloud only.

   ⁵ QuickXorHash (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/onedrive/developer/code-snippets/quickxorhash) is Microsoft's own hash.

    Mail.ru uses its own modified SHA1 hash

    pCloud only supports SHA1 (not MD5) in its EU region

    Opendrive does not support creation of duplicate files using their web client interface or other stock clients, but the  underlying  storage  platform  has
   been determined to allow duplicate files, and it is possible to create them with rclone.  It may be that this is a mistake or an unsupported feature.

    QingStor does not support SetModTime for objects bigger than 5 GiB.

   ¹ FTP supports modtimes for the major FTP servers, and also others if they advertised required protocol extensions.  See this (https://rclone.org/ftp/#modi‐
   fied-time) for more details.

   ¹¹ Internet Archive requires option wait_archive to be set to a non-zero value for full modtime support.

   ¹² HiDrive supports its own custom hash (https://static.hidrive.com/dev/0001).  It combines SHA1 sums for each 4 KiB block hierarchically to  a  single  top-
   level sum.

Hash

   The cloud storage system supports various hash types of the objects.  The hashes are used when transferring data as an integrity check and can be specifical
   ly used with the --checksum flag in syncs and in the check command.

   To use the verify checksums when transferring between cloud storage systems they must support a common hash type.

ModTime

   Almost all cloud storage systems store some sort of timestamp on objects, but several of them not something that is appropriate to  use  for  syncing.   E.g.
   some backends will only write a timestamp that represent the time of the upload.  To be relevant for syncing it should be able to store the modification time
   of the source object.  If this is not the case, rclone will only check the file size by default, though can be configured to check the file  hash  (with  the
   --checksum flag).  Ideally it should also be possible to change the timestamp of an existing file without having to re-upload it.

   Storage  systems  with  a - in the ModTime column, means the modification read on objects is not the modification time of the file when uploaded.  It is most
   likely the time the file was uploaded, or possibly something else (like the time the picture was taken in Google Photos).

   Storage systems with a R (for read-only) in the ModTime column, means the it keeps modification times on objects, and updates them  when  uploading  objects,
   but  it  does not support changing only the modification time (SetModTime operation) without re-uploading, possibly not even without deleting existing first.
   Some operations in rclone, such as copy and sync commands, will automatically check for SetModTime support and re-upload if necessary to keep  the  modifica
   tion  times in sync.  Other commands will not work without SetModTime support, e.g.  touch command on an existing file will fail, and changes to modification
   time only on a files in a mount will be silently ignored.

   Storage systems with R/W (for read/write) in the ModTime column, means they do also support modtime-only operations.

Case Insensitive

   If a cloud storage systems is case sensitive then it is possible to have two files which differ only in case, e.g.  file.txt and FILE.txt.  If a cloud  stor
   age system is case insensitive then that isn't possible.

   This can cause problems when syncing between a case insensitive system and a case sensitive system.  The symptom of this is that no matter how many times you
   run the sync it never completes fully.

   The local filesystem and SFTP may or may not be case sensitive depending on OS.

   • Windows - usually case insensitive, though case is preserved

   • OSX - usually case insensitive, though it is possible to format case sensitive

   • Linux - usually case sensitive, but there are case insensitive file systems (e.g.  FAT formatted USB keys)

   Most of the time this doesn't cause any problems as people tend to avoid files whose name differs only by case even on case sensitive systems.

Duplicate files

   If a cloud storage system allows duplicate files then it can have two objects with the same name.

   This confuses rclone greatly when syncing - use the rclone dedupe command to rename or remove duplicates.

Restricted filenames

   Some cloud storage systems might have restrictions on the characters that are usable in file or directory names.  When rclone detects such a  name  during  a
   file  upload,  it  will  transparently replace the restricted characters with similar looking Unicode characters.  To handle the different sets of restricted
   characters for different backends, rclone uses something it calls encoding.

   This process is designed to avoid ambiguous file names as much as possible and allow to move files between many cloud storage systems transparently.

   The name shown by rclone to the user or during log output will only contain a minimal set of replaced characters to ensure correct formatting and not  neces
   sarily the actual name used on the cloud storage.

   This  transformation  is reversed when downloading a file or parsing rclone arguments.  For example, when uploading a file named my file?.txt to Onedrive, it
   will be displayed as my file?.txt on the console, but stored as my file.txt to Onedrive (the ?  gets replaced by the similar looking  character, the  so-
   called  "fullwidth  question  mark").   The  reverse  transformation  allows  to  read  a file unusual/name.txt from Google Drive, by passing the name unusu
   alname.txt on the command line (the / needs to be replaced by the similar looking  character).

Caveats

   The filename encoding system works well in most cases, at least where file names are written in English or similar languages.  You might not even notice  it:
   It just works.  In some cases it may lead to issues, though.  E.g.  when file names are written in Chinese, or Japanese, where it is always the Unicode full
   width variants of the punctuation marks that are used.

   On Windows, the characters :, * and ? are examples of restricted characters.  If these are used in filenames on a remote that supports it, Rclone will trans
   parently  convert  them  to  their  fullwidth Unicode variants ,  and  when downloading to Windows, and back again when uploading.  This way files with
   names that are not allowed on Windows can still be stored.

   However, if you have files on your Windows system originally with these same Unicode characters in their names, they will be included in the same  conversion
   process.   E.g.  if you create a file in your Windows filesystem with name Test1.jpg, where  is the Unicode fullwidth colon symbol, and use rclone to up
   load it to Google Drive, which supports regular : (halfwidth question mark), rclone will replace the fullwidth : with the halfwidth : and store the  file  as
   Test:1.jpg  in Google Drive.  Since both Windows and Google Drive allows the name Test1.jpg, it would probably be better if rclone just kept the name as is
   in this case.

   With the opposite situation; if you have a file named Test:1.jpg, in your Google Drive, e.g.  uploaded from a Linux system where : is valid  in  file  names.
   Then  later use rclone to copy this file to your Windows computer you will notice that on your local disk it gets renamed to Test1.jpg.  The original file
   name is not legal on Windows, due to the :, and rclone therefore renames it to make the copy possible.  That is all good.  However, this can also lead to  an
   issue:  If you already had a different file named Test1.jpg on Windows, and then use rclone to copy either way.  Rclone will then treat the file originally
   named Test:1.jpg on Google Drive and the file originally named Test1.jpg on Windows as the same file, and replace the contents from one with the other.

   Its virtually impossible to handle all cases like these correctly in all situations, but by customizing the encoding option, changing the set  of  characters
   that  rclone  should  convert,  you  should  be  able  to  create  a  configuration  that  works  well  for  your  specific  situation.  See also the example
   (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding-example-windows) below.

   (Windows was used as an example of a file system with many restricted characters, and Google drive a storage system with few.)

Default restricted characters

   The table below shows the characters that are replaced by default.

   When a replacement character is found in a filename, this character will be escaped with the  character to avoid ambiguous file names.  (e.g.  a file  named
   .txt would shown as .txt)

   Each cloud storage backend can use a different set of characters, which will be specified in the documentation for each backend.

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   SOH         0x01         
   STX         0x02         
   ETX         0x03         
   EOT         0x04         
   ENQ         0x05         
   ACK         0x06         
   BEL         0x07         
   BS          0x08         
   HT          0x09         
   LF          0x0A         
   VT          0x0B         
   FF          0x0C         
   CR          0x0D         
   SO          0x0E         
   SI          0x0F         

   DLE         0x10         
   DC1         0x11         
   DC2         0x12         
   DC3         0x13         
   DC4         0x14         
   NAK         0x15         
   SYN         0x16         
   ETB         0x17         
   CAN         0x18         
   EM          0x19         
   SUB         0x1A         
   ESC         0x1B         
   FS          0x1C         
   GS          0x1D         
   RS          0x1E         
   US          0x1F         
   /           0x2F        
   DEL         0x7F         

   The default encoding will also encode these file names as they are problematic with many cloud storage systems.

   File name   Replacement
   
   .               
   ..             

Invalid UTF-8 bytes

   Some backends only support a sequence of well formed UTF-8 bytes as file or directory names.

   In  this case all invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced with a quoted representation of the byte value to allow uploading a file to such a backend.  For exam
   ple, the invalid byte 0xFE will be encoded as FE.

   A common source of invalid UTF-8 bytes are local filesystems, that store names in a different encoding than UTF-8 or UTF-16,  like  latin1.   See  the  local
   filenames (https://rclone.org/local/#filenames) section for details.

Encoding option

   Most  backends  have  an  encoding option, specified as a flag --backend-encoding where backend is the name of the backend, or as a config parameter encoding
   (you'll need to select the Advanced config in rclone config to see it).

   This will have default value which encodes and decodes characters in such a way as to preserve the maximum number of characters (see above).

   However this can be incorrect in some scenarios, for example if you have a Windows file system with Unicode fullwidth characters *, ? or :, that you  want
   to remain as those characters on the remote rather than being translated to regular (halfwidth) *, ? and :.

   The  --backend-encoding  flags  allow you to change that.  You can disable the encoding completely with --backend-encoding None or set encoding = None in the
   config file.

   Encoding takes a comma separated list of encodings.  You can see the list of all possible values by passing an invalid value to this flag, e.g.   --local-en‐
   coding "help".  The command rclone help flags encoding will show you the defaults for the backends.

   Encoding                 Characters                 Encoded as
   ─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
   Asterisk                 *                          *
   BackQuote                `                          `
   BackSlash                \                          \
   Colon                    :                          :
   CrLf                     CR 0x0D, LF 0x0A           ␍, ␊
   Ctl                      All  control  characters   ␀␁␂␃␄␅␆␇␈␉␊␋␌␍␎␏␐␑␒␓␔␕␖␗␘␙␚␛␜␝␞␟
                            0x00-0x1F
   Del                      DEL 0x7F                   ␡
   Dollar                   $                          $
   Dot                      . or .. as entire string   ., ..
   DoubleQuote              "                          "
   Hash                     #                          #
   InvalidUtf8              An invalid UTF-8 charac‐   �
                            ter (e.g.  latin1)
   LeftCrLfHtVt             CR  0x0D,  LF  0x0A,  HT   ␍, ␊, ␉, ␋
                            0x09,  VT  0x0B  on  the
                            left of a string
   LeftPeriod               .  on  the  left  of   a   .
                            string
   LeftSpace                SPACE  on  the left of a   ␠
                            string
   LeftTilde                ~  on  the  left  of   a   ~
                            string
   LtGt                     <, >                       <, >
   None                     No characters are encod‐
                            ed
   Percent                  %                          %
   Pipe                     |                          |
   Question                 ?                          ?
   RightCrLfHtVt            CR  0x0D,  LF  0x0A,  HT   ␍, ␊, ␉, ␋
                            0x09,  VT  0x0B  on  the
                            right of a string
   RightPeriod              .  on  the  right  of  a   .
                            string
   RightSpace               SPACE  on the right of a   ␠
                            string
   Semicolon                ;                          ;
   SingleQuote              '                          
   Slash                    /                          
   SquareBracket            [, ]                       , 

Encoding example: FTP

   To take a specific example, the FTP backend's default encoding is

          --ftp-encoding "Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot"

   However, let's say the FTP server is running on Windows and can't have any of the invalid Windows characters in file names.  You are backing up Linux servers
   to this FTP server which do have those characters in file names.  So you would add the Windows set which are

          Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   to the existing ones, giving:

          Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot,Del,RightSpace

   This can be specified using the --ftp-encoding flag or using an encoding parameter in the config file.

Encoding example: Windows

   As a nother example, take a Windows system where there is a file with name Test1.jpg, where  is the Unicode fullwidth colon symbol.  When using rclone to
   copy this to a remote which supports :, the regular (halfwidth) colon (such as Google Drive), you will notice that the file gets renamed to Test:1.jpg.

   To avoid this you can change the set of characters rclone should convert for the local filesystem, using command-line  argument  --local-encoding.   Rclone's
   default behavior on Windows corresponds to

          --local-encoding "Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot"

   If you want to use fullwidth characters ,  and  in your filenames without rclone changing them when uploading to a remote, then set the same as the de
   fault value but without Colon,Question,Asterisk:

          --local-encoding "Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot"

   Alternatively, you can disable the conversion of any characters with --local-encoding None.

   Instead of using command-line argument --local-encoding, you  may  also  set  it  as  environment  variable  (https://rclone.org/docs/#environment-variables)
   RCLONE_LOCAL_ENCODING, or configure (https://rclone.org/docs/#configure) a remote of type local in your config, and set the encoding option there.

   The  risk by doing this is that if you have a filename with the regular (halfwidth) :, * and ? in your cloud storage, and you try to download it to your Win
   dows filesystem, this will fail.  These characters are not valid in filenames on Windows, and you have told rclone not to work around this by converting them
   to valid fullwidth variants.

MIME Type

   MIME types (also known as media types) classify types of documents using a simple text classification, e.g.  text/html or application/pdf.

   Some cloud storage systems support reading (R) the MIME type of objects and some support writing (W) the MIME type of objects.

   The MIME type can be important if you are serving files directly to HTTP from the storage system.

   If  you are copying from a remote which supports reading (R) to a remote which supports writing (W) then rclone will preserve the MIME types.  Otherwise they
   will be guessed from the extension, or the remote itself may assign the MIME type.

Metadata

   Backends may or may support reading or writing metadata.  They may support reading and writing system metadata (metadata intrinsic to  that  backend)  and/or
   user metadata (general purpose metadata).

   The levels of metadata support are

   Key                   Explanation
   
   R                     Read only System Metadata
   RW                    Read and write System Metadata
   RWU                   Read  and  write System Metadata and read and write
                         User Metadata

   See the metadata docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) for more info.

Optional Features

   All rclone remotes support a base command set.  Other features depend upon backend-specific capabilities.

   Name                Purge   Copy   Move   DirMove   CleanUp   ListR   StreamU   LinkShar   About   Empty
                                                                         pload      ing                 Dir
   
   1Fichier             No     Yes    Yes      No        No       No        No         Yes        No      Yes
   Akamai Netstorage    Yes     No     No      No        No       Yes       Yes         No        No      Yes
   Amazon Drive         Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No        No          No        No      Yes
   Amazon S3 (or  S3    No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes       Yes        Yes        No      No
   compatible)
   Backblaze B2         No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes       Yes        Yes        No      No
   Box                  Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes     Yes      No        Yes        Yes       Yes      Yes
   Citrix ShareFile     Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No        No      Yes
   Dropbox              Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes        Yes       Yes      Yes
   Enterprise   File    Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        No          No        No      Yes
   Fabric
   FTP                  No      No    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No        No      Yes
   Google      Cloud    Yes    Yes     No      No        No       Yes       Yes         No        No      No
   Storage
   Google Drive         Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      Yes       Yes        Yes       Yes      Yes
   Google Photos        No      No     No      No        No       No        No          No        No      No
   HDFS                 Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No       Yes      Yes
   HiDrive              Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No        No      Yes
   HTTP                 No      No     No      No        No       No        No          No        No      Yes
   Internet Archive     No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes       No         Yes       Yes      No
   Jottacloud           Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      Yes       No         Yes       Yes      Yes
   Koofr                Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes        Yes       Yes      Yes
   Mail.ru Cloud        Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        No         Yes       Yes      Yes
   Mega                 Yes     No    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        No         Yes       Yes      Yes
   Memory               No     Yes     No      No        No       Yes       Yes         No        No      No
   Microsoft   Azure    Yes    Yes     No      No        No       Yes       Yes         No        No      No
   Blob Storage
   Microsoft            Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        No         Yes       Yes      Yes
   OneDrive
   OpenDrive            Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        No          No        No      Yes
   OpenStack Swift     Yes    Yes     No      No        No       Yes       Yes         No       Yes      No
   Oracle     Object    No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes       Yes         No        No      No
   Storage
   pCloud               Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        No         Yes       Yes      Yes
   premiumize.me        Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No        No         Yes       Yes      Yes
   put.io               Yes     No    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        Yes         No       Yes      Yes
   QingStor             No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes       No          No        No      No
   Seafile              Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      Yes       Yes        Yes       Yes      Yes
   SFTP                 No      No    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No       Yes      Yes
   Sia                  No      No     No      No        No       No        Yes         No        No      Yes
   SMB                  No      No    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No        No      Yes
   SugarSync            Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes        Yes        No      Yes

   Storj               Yes    Yes    Yes      No        No       Yes       Yes        Yes        No      No
   Uptobox              No     Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        No          No        No      No
   WebDAV               Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No       Yes         No       Yes      Yes
   Yandex Disk          Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No        Yes        Yes       Yes      Yes
   Zoho WorkDrive       Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        No          No       Yes      Yes
   The         local    Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes         No       Yes      Yes
   filesystem

Purge

   This deletes a directory quicker than just deleting all the files in the directory.

    Note Swift implements this in order to delete directory markers but they don't actually have a quicker way of deleting files other than deleting them indi
   vidually.

    Storj implements this efficiently only for entire buckets.  If purging a directory inside a bucket, files are deleted individually.

    StreamUpload is not supported with Nextcloud

Copy

   Used when copying an object to and from the same remote.  This known as a server-side copy so you can copy a file without downloading  it  and  uploading  it
   again.  It is used if you use rclone copy or rclone move if the remote doesn't support Move directly.

   If the server doesn't support Copy directly then for copy operations the file is downloaded then re-uploaded.

Move

   Used  when  moving/renaming  an object on the same remote.  This is known as a server-side move of a file.  This is used in rclone move if the server doesn't
   support DirMove.

   If the server isn't capable of Move then rclone simulates it with Copy then delete.  If the server doesn't support Copy then rclone will  download  the  file
   and re-upload it.

DirMove

   This  is  used to implement rclone move to move a directory if possible.  If it isn't then it will use Move on each file (which falls back to Copy then down
   load and upload - see Move section).

CleanUp

   This is used for emptying the trash for a remote by rclone cleanup.

   If the server can't do CleanUp then rclone cleanup will return an error.

    Note that while Box implements this it has to delete every file individually so it will be slower than emptying the trash via the WebUI

ListR

   The remote supports a recursive list to list all the contents beneath a directory quickly.  This enables the --fast-list flag to work.  See the  rclone  docs
   (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more details.

StreamUpload

   Some  remotes allow files to be uploaded without knowing the file size in advance.  This allows certain operations to work without spooling the file to local
   disk first, e.g.  rclone rcat.

LinkSharing

   Sets the necessary permissions on a file or folder and prints a link that allows others to access them, even if they don't have an account on the  particular
   cloud provider.

About

   Rclone about prints quota information for a remote.  Typical output includes bytes used, free, quota and in trash.

   If a remote lacks about capability rclone about remote:returns an error.

   Backends without about capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount, or use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See rclone about command (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

EmptyDir

   The  remote supports empty directories.  See Limitations (https://rclone.org/bugs/#limitations) for details.  Most Object/Bucket-based remotes do not support
   this.

Global Flags

   This describes the global flags available to every rclone command split into two groups, non backend and backend flags.

Non Backend Flags

   These flags are available for every command.

                --ask-password                         Allow prompt for password for encrypted configuration (default true)
                --auto-confirm                         If enabled, do not request console confirmation
                --backup-dir string                    Make backups into hierarchy based in DIR
                --bind string                          Local address to bind to for outgoing connections, IPv4, IPv6 or name
                --buffer-size SizeSuffix               In memory buffer size when reading files for each --transfer (default 16Mi)
                --bwlimit BwTimetable                  Bandwidth limit in KiB/s, or use suffix B|K|M|G|T|P or a full timetable
                --bwlimit-file BwTimetable             Bandwidth limit per file in KiB/s, or use suffix B|K|M|G|T|P or a full timetable
                --ca-cert string                       CA certificate used to verify servers
                --cache-dir string                     Directory rclone will use for caching (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone")
                --check-first                          Do all the checks before starting transfers
                --checkers int                         Number of checkers to run in parallel (default 8)
            -c, --checksum                             Skip based on checksum (if available) & size, not mod-time & size
                --client-cert string                   Client SSL certificate (PEM) for mutual TLS auth
                --client-key string                    Client SSL private key (PEM) for mutual TLS auth
                --compare-dest stringArray             Include additional comma separated server-side paths during comparison
                --config string                        Config file (default "$HOME/.config/rclone/rclone.conf")
                --contimeout duration                  Connect timeout (default 1m0s)
                --copy-dest stringArray                Implies --compare-dest but also copies files from paths into destination
                --cpuprofile string                    Write cpu profile to file
                --cutoff-mode string                   Mode to stop transfers when reaching the max transfer limit HARD|SOFT|CAUTIOUS (default "HARD")
                --delete-after                         When synchronizing, delete files on destination after transferring (default)
                --delete-before                        When synchronizing, delete files on destination before transferring
                --delete-during                        When synchronizing, delete files during transfer
                --delete-excluded                      Delete files on dest excluded from sync
                --disable string                       Disable a comma separated list of features (use --disable help to see a list)
                --disable-http-keep-alives             Disable HTTP keep-alives and use each connection once.
                --disable-http2                        Disable HTTP/2 in the global transport
            -n, --dry-run                              Do a trial run with no permanent changes
                --dscp string                          Set DSCP value to connections, value or name, e.g. CS1, LE, DF, AF21
                --dump DumpFlags                       List of items to dump from: headers,bodies,requests,responses,auth,filters,goroutines,openfiles
                --dump-bodies                          Dump HTTP headers and bodies - may contain sensitive info
                --dump-headers                         Dump HTTP headers - may contain sensitive info
                --error-on-no-transfer                 Sets exit code 9 if no files are transferred, useful in scripts
                --exclude stringArray                  Exclude files matching pattern
                --exclude-from stringArray             Read exclude patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)
                --exclude-if-present stringArray       Exclude directories if filename is present
                --expect-continue-timeout duration     Timeout when using expect / 100-continue in HTTP (default 1s)
                --fast-list                            Use recursive list if available; uses more memory but fewer transactions
                --files-from stringArray               Read list of source-file names from file (use - to read from stdin)
                --files-from-raw stringArray           Read list of source-file names from file without any processing of lines (use - to read from stdin)
            -f, --filter stringArray                   Add a file-filtering rule
                --filter-from stringArray              Read filtering patterns from a file (use - to read from stdin)
                --fs-cache-expire-duration duration    Cache remotes for this long (0 to disable caching) (default 5m0s)
                --fs-cache-expire-interval duration    Interval to check for expired remotes (default 1m0s)
                --header stringArray                   Set HTTP header for all transactions
                --header-download stringArray          Set HTTP header for download transactions
                --header-upload stringArray            Set HTTP header for upload transactions
                --human-readable                       Print numbers in a human-readable format, sizes with suffix Ki|Mi|Gi|Ti|Pi
                --ignore-case                          Ignore case in filters (case insensitive)
                --ignore-case-sync                     Ignore case when synchronizing
                --ignore-checksum                      Skip post copy check of checksums
                --ignore-errors                        Delete even if there are I/O errors
                --ignore-existing                      Skip all files that exist on destination
                --ignore-size                          Ignore size when skipping use mod-time or checksum
            -I, --ignore-times                         Don't skip files that match size and time - transfer all files
                --immutable                            Do not modify files, fail if existing files have been modified
                --include stringArray                  Include files matching pattern
                --include-from stringArray             Read include patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)
            -i, --interactive                          Enable interactive mode
                --kv-lock-time duration                Maximum time to keep key-value database locked by process (default 1s)
                --log-file string                      Log everything to this file
                --log-format string                    Comma separated list of log format options (default "date,time")
                --log-level string                     Log level DEBUG|INFO|NOTICE|ERROR (default "NOTICE")
                --log-systemd                          Activate systemd integration for the logger
                --low-level-retries int                Number of low level retries to do (default 10)
                --max-age Duration                     Only transfer files younger than this in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d|w|M|y (default off)
                --max-backlog int                      Maximum number of objects in sync or check backlog (default 10000)
                --max-delete int                       When synchronizing, limit the number of deletes (default -1)
                --max-depth int                        If set limits the recursion depth to this (default -1)
                --max-duration duration                Maximum duration rclone will transfer data for
                --max-size SizeSuffix                  Only transfer files smaller than this in KiB or suffix B|K|M|G|T|P (default off)
                --max-stats-groups int                 Maximum number of stats groups to keep in memory, on max oldest is discarded (default 1000)
                --max-transfer SizeSuffix              Maximum size of data to transfer (default off)
                --memprofile string                    Write memory profile to file
            -M, --metadata                             If set, preserve metadata when copying objects
                --metadata-set stringArray             Add metadata key=value when uploading
                --min-age Duration                     Only transfer files older than this in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d|w|M|y (default off)
                --min-size SizeSuffix                  Only transfer files bigger than this in KiB or suffix B|K|M|G|T|P (default off)
                --modify-window duration               Max time diff to be considered the same (default 1ns)
                --multi-thread-cutoff SizeSuffix       Use multi-thread downloads for files above this size (default 250Mi)
                --multi-thread-streams int             Max number of streams to use for multi-thread downloads (default 4)
                --no-check-certificate                 Do not verify the server SSL certificate (insecure)
                --no-check-dest                        Don't check the destination, copy regardless
                --no-console                           Hide console window (supported on Windows only)
                --no-gzip-encoding                     Don't set Accept-Encoding: gzip
                --no-traverse                          Don't traverse destination file system on copy
                --no-unicode-normalization             Don't normalize unicode characters in filenames
                --no-update-modtime                    Don't update destination mod-time if files identical
                --order-by string                      Instructions on how to order the transfers, e.g. 'size,descending'
                --password-command SpaceSepList        Command for supplying password for encrypted configuration
            -P, --progress                             Show progress during transfer
                --progress-terminal-title              Show progress on the terminal title (requires -P/--progress)
            -q, --quiet                                Print as little stuff as possible
                --rc                                   Enable the remote control server
                --rc-addr string                       IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:5572")
                --rc-allow-origin string               Set the allowed origin for CORS
                --rc-baseurl string                    Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                --rc-cert string                       SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                --rc-client-ca string                  Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                --rc-enable-metrics                    Enable prometheus metrics on /metrics
                --rc-files string                      Path to local files to serve on the HTTP server
                --rc-htpasswd string                   htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                --rc-job-expire-duration duration      Expire finished async jobs older than this value (default 1m0s)
                --rc-job-expire-interval duration      Interval to check for expired async jobs (default 10s)
                --rc-key string                        SSL PEM Private key
                --rc-max-header-bytes int              Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                --rc-min-tls-version string            Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                --rc-no-auth                           Don't require auth for certain methods
                --rc-pass string                       Password for authentication
                --rc-realm string                      Realm for authentication (default "rclone")
                --rc-serve                             Enable the serving of remote objects
                --rc-server-read-timeout duration      Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                --rc-server-write-timeout duration     Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                --rc-template string                   User-specified template
                --rc-user string                       User name for authentication
                --rc-web-fetch-url string              URL to fetch the releases for webgui (default "https://api.github.com/repos/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/latest")
                --rc-web-gui                           Launch WebGUI on localhost
                --rc-web-gui-force-update              Force update to latest version of web gui
                --rc-web-gui-no-open-browser           Don't open the browser automatically
                --rc-web-gui-update                    Check and update to latest version of web gui
                --refresh-times                        Refresh the modtime of remote files
                --retries int                          Retry operations this many times if they fail (default 3)
                --retries-sleep duration               Interval between retrying operations if they fail, e.g. 500ms, 60s, 5m (0 to disable)
                --server-side-across-configs           Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different configs
                --size-only                            Skip based on size only, not mod-time or checksum
                --stats duration                       Interval between printing stats, e.g. 500ms, 60s, 5m (0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                --stats-file-name-length int           Max file name length in stats (0 for no limit) (default 45)
                --stats-log-level string               Log level to show --stats output DEBUG|INFO|NOTICE|ERROR (default "INFO")
                --stats-one-line                       Make the stats fit on one line
                --stats-one-line-date                  Enable --stats-one-line and add current date/time prefix
                --stats-one-line-date-format string    Enable --stats-one-line-date and use custom formatted date: Enclose date string in double quotes ("), see https://golang.org/pkg/time/#Time.Format
                --stats-unit string                    Show data rate in stats as either 'bits' or 'bytes' per second (default "bytes")
                --streaming-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload if file size is unknown, upload starts after reaching cutoff or when file ends (default 100Ki)
                --suffix string                        Suffix to add to changed files
                --suffix-keep-extension                Preserve the extension when using --suffix
                --syslog                               Use Syslog for logging
                --syslog-facility string               Facility for syslog, e.g. KERN,USER,... (default "DAEMON")
                --temp-dir string                      Directory rclone will use for temporary files (default "/tmp")
                --timeout duration                     IO idle timeout (default 5m0s)
                --tpslimit float                       Limit HTTP transactions per second to this
                --tpslimit-burst int                   Max burst of transactions for --tpslimit (default 1)
                --track-renames                        When synchronizing, track file renames and do a server-side move if possible
                --track-renames-strategy string        Strategies to use when synchronizing using track-renames hash|modtime|leaf (default "hash")
                --transfers int                        Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)
            -u, --update                               Skip files that are newer on the destination
                --use-cookies                          Enable session cookiejar
                --use-json-log                         Use json log format
                --use-mmap                             Use mmap allocator (see docs)
                --use-server-modtime                   Use server modified time instead of object metadata
                --user-agent string                    Set the user-agent to a specified string (default "rclone/v1.60.1")
            -v, --verbose count                        Print lots more stuff (repeat for more)

Backend Flags

   These flags are available for every command.  They control the backends and may be set in the config file.

                --acd-auth-url string                          Auth server URL
                --acd-client-id string                         OAuth Client Id
                --acd-client-secret string                     OAuth Client Secret
                --acd-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --acd-templink-threshold SizeSuffix            Files >= this size will be downloaded via their tempLink (default 9Gi)
                --acd-token string                             OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --acd-token-url string                         Token server url
                --acd-upload-wait-per-gb Duration              Additional time per GiB to wait after a failed complete upload to see if it appears (default 3m0s)
                --alias-remote string                          Remote or path to alias
                --azureblob-access-tier string                 Access tier of blob: hot, cool or archive
                --azureblob-account string                     Storage Account Name
                --azureblob-archive-tier-delete                Delete archive tier blobs before overwriting
                --azureblob-chunk-size SizeSuffix              Upload chunk size (default 4Mi)
                --azureblob-disable-checksum                   Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
                --azureblob-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8)
                --azureblob-endpoint string                    Endpoint for the service
                --azureblob-key string                         Storage Account Key
                --azureblob-list-chunk int                     Size of blob list (default 5000)
                --azureblob-memory-pool-flush-time Duration    How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed (default 1m0s)
                --azureblob-memory-pool-use-mmap               Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool
                --azureblob-msi-client-id string               Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any
                --azureblob-msi-mi-res-id string               Azure resource ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any
                --azureblob-msi-object-id string               Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any
                --azureblob-no-head-object                     If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects
                --azureblob-public-access string               Public access level of a container: blob or container
                --azureblob-sas-url string                     SAS URL for container level access only
                --azureblob-service-principal-file string      Path to file containing credentials for use with a service principal
                --azureblob-upload-concurrency int             Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 16)
                --azureblob-upload-cutoff string               Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (<= 256 MiB) (deprecated)
                --azureblob-use-emulator                       Uses local storage emulator if provided as 'true'
                --azureblob-use-msi                            Use a managed service identity to authenticate (only works in Azure)
                --b2-account string                            Account ID or Application Key ID
                --b2-chunk-size SizeSuffix                     Upload chunk size (default 96Mi)
                --b2-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                    Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4Gi)
                --b2-disable-checksum                          Disable checksums for large (> upload cutoff) files
                --b2-download-auth-duration Duration           Time before the authorization token will expire in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d (default 1w)
                --b2-download-url string                       Custom endpoint for downloads
                --b2-encoding MultiEncoder                     The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --b2-endpoint string                           Endpoint for the service
                --b2-hard-delete                               Permanently delete files on remote removal, otherwise hide files
                --b2-key string                                Application Key
                --b2-memory-pool-flush-time Duration           How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed (default 1m0s)
                --b2-memory-pool-use-mmap                      Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool
                --b2-test-mode string                          A flag string for X-Bz-Test-Mode header for debugging
                --b2-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                  Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                --b2-version-at Time                           Show file versions as they were at the specified time (default off)
                --b2-versions                                  Include old versions in directory listings
                --box-access-token string                      Box App Primary Access Token
                --box-auth-url string                          Auth server URL
                --box-box-config-file string                   Box App config.json location
                --box-box-sub-type string                       (default "user")
                --box-client-id string                         OAuth Client Id
                --box-client-secret string                     OAuth Client Secret
                --box-commit-retries int                       Max number of times to try committing a multipart file (default 100)
                --box-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --box-list-chunk int                           Size of listing chunk 1-1000 (default 1000)
                --box-owned-by string                          Only show items owned by the login (email address) passed in
                --box-root-folder-id string                    Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point
                --box-token string                             OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --box-token-url string                         Token server url
                --box-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                 Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (>= 50 MiB) (default 50Mi)
                --cache-chunk-clean-interval Duration          How often should the cache perform cleanups of the chunk storage (default 1m0s)
                --cache-chunk-no-memory                        Disable the in-memory cache for storing chunks during streaming
                --cache-chunk-path string                      Directory to cache chunk files (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend")
                --cache-chunk-size SizeSuffix                  The size of a chunk (partial file data) (default 5Mi)
                --cache-chunk-total-size SizeSuffix            The total size that the chunks can take up on the local disk (default 10Gi)
                --cache-db-path string                         Directory to store file structure metadata DB (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend")
                --cache-db-purge                               Clear all the cached data for this remote on start
                --cache-db-wait-time Duration                  How long to wait for the DB to be available - 0 is unlimited (default 1s)
                --cache-info-age Duration                      How long to cache file structure information (directory listings, file size, times, etc.) (default 6h0m0s)
                --cache-plex-insecure string                   Skip all certificate verification when connecting to the Plex server
                --cache-plex-password string                   The password of the Plex user (obscured)
                --cache-plex-url string                        The URL of the Plex server
                --cache-plex-username string                   The username of the Plex user
                --cache-read-retries int                       How many times to retry a read from a cache storage (default 10)
                --cache-remote string                          Remote to cache
                --cache-rps int                                Limits the number of requests per second to the source FS (-1 to disable) (default -1)
                --cache-tmp-upload-path string                 Directory to keep temporary files until they are uploaded
                --cache-tmp-wait-time Duration                 How long should files be stored in local cache before being uploaded (default 15s)
                --cache-workers int                            How many workers should run in parallel to download chunks (default 4)
                --cache-writes                                 Cache file data on writes through the FS
                --chunker-chunk-size SizeSuffix                Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks (default 2Gi)
                --chunker-fail-hard                            Choose how chunker should handle files with missing or invalid chunks
                --chunker-hash-type string                     Choose how chunker handles hash sums (default "md5")
                --chunker-remote string                        Remote to chunk/unchunk
                --combine-upstreams SpaceSepList               Upstreams for combining
                --compress-level int                           GZIP compression level (-2 to 9) (default -1)
                --compress-mode string                         Compression mode (default "gzip")
                --compress-ram-cache-limit SizeSuffix          Some remotes don't allow the upload of files with unknown size (default 20Mi)
                --compress-remote string                       Remote to compress
            -L, --copy-links                                   Follow symlinks and copy the pointed to item
                --crypt-directory-name-encryption              Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact (default true)
                --crypt-filename-encoding string               How to encode the encrypted filename to text string (default "base32")
                --crypt-filename-encryption string             How to encrypt the filenames (default "standard")
                --crypt-no-data-encryption                     Option to either encrypt file data or leave it unencrypted
                --crypt-password string                        Password or pass phrase for encryption (obscured)
                --crypt-password2 string                       Password or pass phrase for salt (obscured)
                --crypt-remote string                          Remote to encrypt/decrypt
                --crypt-server-side-across-configs             Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different crypt configs
                --crypt-show-mapping                           For all files listed show how the names encrypt
                --drive-acknowledge-abuse                      Set to allow files which return cannotDownloadAbusiveFile to be downloaded
                --drive-allow-import-name-change               Allow the filetype to change when uploading Google docs
                --drive-auth-owner-only                        Only consider files owned by the authenticated user
                --drive-auth-url string                        Auth server URL
                --drive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                  Upload chunk size (default 8Mi)
                --drive-client-id string                       Google Application Client Id
                --drive-client-secret string                   OAuth Client Secret
                --drive-copy-shortcut-content                  Server side copy contents of shortcuts instead of the shortcut
                --drive-disable-http2                          Disable drive using http2 (default true)
                --drive-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default InvalidUtf8)
                --drive-export-formats string                  Comma separated list of preferred formats for downloading Google docs (default "docx,xlsx,pptx,svg")
                --drive-formats string                         Deprecated: See export_formats
                --drive-impersonate string                     Impersonate this user when using a service account
                --drive-import-formats string                  Comma separated list of preferred formats for uploading Google docs
                --drive-keep-revision-forever                  Keep new head revision of each file forever
                --drive-list-chunk int                         Size of listing chunk 100-1000, 0 to disable (default 1000)
                --drive-pacer-burst int                        Number of API calls to allow without sleeping (default 100)
                --drive-pacer-min-sleep Duration               Minimum time to sleep between API calls (default 100ms)
                --drive-resource-key string                    Resource key for accessing a link-shared file
                --drive-root-folder-id string                  ID of the root folder
                --drive-scope string                           Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive
                --drive-server-side-across-configs             Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different drive configs
                --drive-service-account-credentials string     Service Account Credentials JSON blob
                --drive-service-account-file string            Service Account Credentials JSON file path
                --drive-shared-with-me                         Only show files that are shared with me
                --drive-size-as-quota                          Show sizes as storage quota usage, not actual size
                --drive-skip-checksum-gphotos                  Skip MD5 checksum on Google photos and videos only
                --drive-skip-dangling-shortcuts                If set skip dangling shortcut files
                --drive-skip-gdocs                             Skip google documents in all listings
                --drive-skip-shortcuts                         If set skip shortcut files
                --drive-starred-only                           Only show files that are starred
                --drive-stop-on-download-limit                 Make download limit errors be fatal
                --drive-stop-on-upload-limit                   Make upload limit errors be fatal
                --drive-team-drive string                      ID of the Shared Drive (Team Drive)
                --drive-token string                           OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --drive-token-url string                       Token server url
                --drive-trashed-only                           Only show files that are in the trash
                --drive-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix               Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 8Mi)
                --drive-use-created-date                       Use file created date instead of modified date
                --drive-use-shared-date                        Use date file was shared instead of modified date
                --drive-use-trash                              Send files to the trash instead of deleting permanently (default true)
                --drive-v2-download-min-size SizeSuffix        If Object's are greater, use drive v2 API to download (default off)
                --dropbox-auth-url string                      Auth server URL
                --dropbox-batch-commit-timeout Duration        Max time to wait for a batch to finish committing (default 10m0s)
                --dropbox-batch-mode string                    Upload file batching sync|async|off (default "sync")
                --dropbox-batch-size int                       Max number of files in upload batch
                --dropbox-batch-timeout Duration               Max time to allow an idle upload batch before uploading (default 0s)
                --dropbox-chunk-size SizeSuffix                Upload chunk size (< 150Mi) (default 48Mi)
                --dropbox-client-id string                     OAuth Client Id
                --dropbox-client-secret string                 OAuth Client Secret
                --dropbox-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --dropbox-impersonate string                   Impersonate this user when using a business account
                --dropbox-shared-files                         Instructs rclone to work on individual shared files
                --dropbox-shared-folders                       Instructs rclone to work on shared folders
                --dropbox-token string                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --dropbox-token-url string                     Token server url
                --fichier-api-key string                       Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl
                --fichier-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,SingleQuote,BackQuote,Dollar,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --fichier-file-password string                 If you want to download a shared file that is password protected, add this parameter (obscured)
                --fichier-folder-password string               If you want to list the files in a shared folder that is password protected, add this parameter (obscured)
                --fichier-shared-folder string                 If you want to download a shared folder, add this parameter
                --filefabric-encoding MultiEncoder             The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --filefabric-permanent-token string            Permanent Authentication Token
                --filefabric-root-folder-id string             ID of the root folder
                --filefabric-token string                      Session Token
                --filefabric-token-expiry string               Token expiry time
                --filefabric-url string                        URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to
                --filefabric-version string                    Version read from the file fabric
                --ftp-ask-password                             Allow asking for FTP password when needed
                --ftp-close-timeout Duration                   Maximum time to wait for a response to close (default 1m0s)
                --ftp-concurrency int                          Maximum number of FTP simultaneous connections, 0 for unlimited
                --ftp-disable-epsv                             Disable using EPSV even if server advertises support
                --ftp-disable-mlsd                             Disable using MLSD even if server advertises support
                --ftp-disable-tls13                            Disable TLS 1.3 (workaround for FTP servers with buggy TLS)
                --ftp-disable-utf8                             Disable using UTF-8 even if server advertises support
                --ftp-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot)
                --ftp-explicit-tls                             Use Explicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
                --ftp-force-list-hidden                        Use LIST -a to force listing of hidden files and folders. This will disable the use of MLSD
                --ftp-host string                              FTP host to connect to
                --ftp-idle-timeout Duration                    Max time before closing idle connections (default 1m0s)
                --ftp-no-check-certificate                     Do not verify the TLS certificate of the server
                --ftp-pass string                              FTP password (obscured)
                --ftp-port int                                 FTP port number (default 21)
                --ftp-shut-timeout Duration                    Maximum time to wait for data connection closing status (default 1m0s)
                --ftp-tls                                      Use Implicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
                --ftp-tls-cache-size int                       Size of TLS session cache for all control and data connections (default 32)
                --ftp-user string                              FTP username (default "$USER")
                --ftp-writing-mdtm                             Use MDTM to set modification time (VsFtpd quirk)
                --gcs-anonymous                                Access public buckets and objects without credentials
                --gcs-auth-url string                          Auth server URL
                --gcs-bucket-acl string                        Access Control List for new buckets
                --gcs-bucket-policy-only                       Access checks should use bucket-level IAM policies
                --gcs-client-id string                         OAuth Client Id
                --gcs-client-secret string                     OAuth Client Secret
                --gcs-decompress                               If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects
                --gcs-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --gcs-endpoint string                          Endpoint for the service
                --gcs-location string                          Location for the newly created buckets
                --gcs-no-check-bucket                          If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
                --gcs-object-acl string                        Access Control List for new objects
                --gcs-project-number string                    Project number
                --gcs-service-account-file string              Service Account Credentials JSON file path
                --gcs-storage-class string                     The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage
                --gcs-token string                             OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --gcs-token-url string                         Token server url
                --gphotos-auth-url string                      Auth server URL
                --gphotos-client-id string                     OAuth Client Id
                --gphotos-client-secret string                 OAuth Client Secret
                --gphotos-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --gphotos-include-archived                     Also view and download archived media
                --gphotos-read-only                            Set to make the Google Photos backend read only
                --gphotos-read-size                            Set to read the size of media items
                --gphotos-start-year int                       Year limits the photos to be downloaded to those which are uploaded after the given year (default 2000)
                --gphotos-token string                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --gphotos-token-url string                     Token server url
                --hasher-auto-size SizeSuffix                  Auto-update checksum for files smaller than this size (disabled by default)
                --hasher-hashes CommaSepList                   Comma separated list of supported checksum types (default md5,sha1)
                --hasher-max-age Duration                      Maximum time to keep checksums in cache (0 = no cache, off = cache forever) (default off)
                --hasher-remote string                         Remote to cache checksums for (e.g. myRemote:path)
                --hdfs-data-transfer-protection string         Kerberos data transfer protection: authentication|integrity|privacy
                --hdfs-encoding MultiEncoder                   The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Colon,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --hdfs-namenode string                         Hadoop name node and port
                --hdfs-service-principal-name string           Kerberos service principal name for the namenode
                --hdfs-username string                         Hadoop user name
                --hidrive-auth-url string                      Auth server URL
                --hidrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                Chunksize for chunked uploads (default 48Mi)
                --hidrive-client-id string                     OAuth Client Id
                --hidrive-client-secret string                 OAuth Client Secret
                --hidrive-disable-fetching-member-count        Do not fetch number of objects in directories unless it is absolutely necessary
                --hidrive-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Dot)
                --hidrive-endpoint string                      Endpoint for the service (default "https://api.hidrive.strato.com/2.1")
                --hidrive-root-prefix string                   The root/parent folder for all paths (default "/")
                --hidrive-scope-access string                  Access permissions that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive (default "rw")
                --hidrive-scope-role string                    User-level that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive (default "user")
                --hidrive-token string                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --hidrive-token-url string                     Token server url
                --hidrive-upload-concurrency int               Concurrency for chunked uploads (default 4)
                --hidrive-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix             Cutoff/Threshold for chunked uploads (default 96Mi)
                --http-headers CommaSepList                    Set HTTP headers for all transactions
                --http-no-head                                 Don't use HEAD requests
                --http-no-slash                                Set this if the site doesn't end directories with /
                --http-url string                              URL of HTTP host to connect to
                --internetarchive-access-key-id string         IAS3 Access Key
                --internetarchive-disable-checksum             Don't ask the server to test against MD5 checksum calculated by rclone (default true)
                --internetarchive-encoding MultiEncoder        The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,CrLf,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --internetarchive-endpoint string              IAS3 Endpoint (default "https://s3.us.archive.org")
                --internetarchive-front-endpoint string        Host of InternetArchive Frontend (default "https://archive.org")
                --internetarchive-secret-access-key string     IAS3 Secret Key (password)
                --internetarchive-wait-archive Duration        Timeout for waiting the server's processing tasks (specifically archive and book_op) to finish (default 0s)
                --jottacloud-encoding MultiEncoder             The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --jottacloud-hard-delete                       Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash
                --jottacloud-md5-memory-limit SizeSuffix       Files bigger than this will be cached on disk to calculate the MD5 if required (default 10Mi)
                --jottacloud-no-versions                       Avoid server side versioning by deleting files and recreating files instead of overwriting them
                --jottacloud-trashed-only                      Only show files that are in the trash
                --jottacloud-upload-resume-limit SizeSuffix    Files bigger than this can be resumed if the upload fail's (default 10Mi)
                --koofr-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --koofr-endpoint string                        The Koofr API endpoint to use
                --koofr-mountid string                         Mount ID of the mount to use
                --koofr-password string                        Your password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password) (obscured)
                --koofr-provider string                        Choose your storage provider
                --koofr-setmtime                               Does the backend support setting modification time (default true)
                --koofr-user string                            Your user name
            -l, --links                                        Translate symlinks to/from regular files with a '.rclonelink' extension
                --local-case-insensitive                       Force the filesystem to report itself as case insensitive
                --local-case-sensitive                         Force the filesystem to report itself as case sensitive
                --local-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Dot)
                --local-no-check-updated                       Don't check to see if the files change during upload
                --local-no-preallocate                         Disable preallocation of disk space for transferred files
                --local-no-set-modtime                         Disable setting modtime
                --local-no-sparse                              Disable sparse files for multi-thread downloads
                --local-nounc                                  Disable UNC (long path names) conversion on Windows
                --local-unicode-normalization                  Apply unicode NFC normalization to paths and filenames
                --local-zero-size-links                        Assume the Stat size of links is zero (and read them instead) (deprecated)
                --mailru-check-hash                            What should copy do if file checksum is mismatched or invalid (default true)
                --mailru-encoding MultiEncoder                 The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --mailru-pass string                           Password (obscured)
                --mailru-speedup-enable                        Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash (default true)
                --mailru-speedup-file-patterns string          Comma separated list of file name patterns eligible for speedup (put by hash) (default "*.mkv,*.avi,*.mp4,*.mp3,*.zip,*.gz,*.rar,*.pdf")
                --mailru-speedup-max-disk SizeSuffix           This option allows you to disable speedup (put by hash) for large files (default 3Gi)
                --mailru-speedup-max-memory SizeSuffix         Files larger than the size given below will always be hashed on disk (default 32Mi)
                --mailru-user string                           User name (usually email)
                --mega-debug                                   Output more debug from Mega
                --mega-encoding MultiEncoder                   The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --mega-hard-delete                             Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash
                --mega-pass string                             Password (obscured)
                --mega-user string                             User name
                --netstorage-account string                    Set the NetStorage account name
                --netstorage-host string                       Domain+path of NetStorage host to connect to
                --netstorage-protocol string                   Select between HTTP or HTTPS protocol (default "https")
                --netstorage-secret string                     Set the NetStorage account secret/G2O key for authentication (obscured)
            -x, --one-file-system                              Don't cross filesystem boundaries (unix/macOS only)
                --onedrive-access-scopes SpaceSepList          Set scopes to be requested by rclone (default Files.Read Files.ReadWrite Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All Sites.Read.All offline_access)
                --onedrive-auth-url string                     Auth server URL
                --onedrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix               Chunk size to upload files with - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes) (default 10Mi)
                --onedrive-client-id string                    OAuth Client Id
                --onedrive-client-secret string                OAuth Client Secret
                --onedrive-drive-id string                     The ID of the drive to use
                --onedrive-drive-type string                   The type of the drive (personal | business | documentLibrary)
                --onedrive-encoding MultiEncoder               The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --onedrive-expose-onenote-files                Set to make OneNote files show up in directory listings
                --onedrive-link-password string                Set the password for links created by the link command
                --onedrive-link-scope string                   Set the scope of the links created by the link command (default "anonymous")
                --onedrive-link-type string                    Set the type of the links created by the link command (default "view")
                --onedrive-list-chunk int                      Size of listing chunk (default 1000)
                --onedrive-no-versions                         Remove all versions on modifying operations
                --onedrive-region string                       Choose national cloud region for OneDrive (default "global")
                --onedrive-root-folder-id string               ID of the root folder
                --onedrive-server-side-across-configs          Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different onedrive configs
                --onedrive-token string                        OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --onedrive-token-url string                    Token server url
                --oos-chunk-size SizeSuffix                    Chunk size to use for uploading (default 5Mi)
                --oos-compartment string                       Object storage compartment OCID
                --oos-config-file string                       Path to OCI config file (default "~/.oci/config")
                --oos-config-profile string                    Profile name inside the oci config file (default "Default")
                --oos-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                   Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4.656Gi)
                --oos-copy-timeout Duration                    Timeout for copy (default 1m0s)
                --oos-disable-checksum                         Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
                --oos-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --oos-endpoint string                          Endpoint for Object storage API
                --oos-leave-parts-on-error                     If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery
                --oos-namespace string                         Object storage namespace
                --oos-no-check-bucket                          If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
                --oos-provider string                          Choose your Auth Provider (default "env_auth")
                --oos-region string                            Object storage Region
                --oos-upload-concurrency int                   Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 10)
                --oos-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                 Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                --opendrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix              Files will be uploaded in chunks this size (default 10Mi)
                --opendrive-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,LeftSpace,LeftCrLfHtVt,RightSpace,RightCrLfHtVt,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --opendrive-password string                    Password (obscured)
                --opendrive-username string                    Username
                --pcloud-auth-url string                       Auth server URL
                --pcloud-client-id string                      OAuth Client Id
                --pcloud-client-secret string                  OAuth Client Secret
                --pcloud-encoding MultiEncoder                 The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --pcloud-hostname string                       Hostname to connect to (default "api.pcloud.com")
                --pcloud-password string                       Your pcloud password (obscured)
                --pcloud-root-folder-id string                 Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point (default "d0")
                --pcloud-token string                          OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --pcloud-token-url string                      Token server url
                --pcloud-username string                       Your pcloud username
                --premiumizeme-encoding MultiEncoder           The encoding for the backend (default Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --putio-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --qingstor-access-key-id string                QingStor Access Key ID
                --qingstor-chunk-size SizeSuffix               Chunk size to use for uploading (default 4Mi)
                --qingstor-connection-retries int              Number of connection retries (default 3)
                --qingstor-encoding MultiEncoder               The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
                --qingstor-endpoint string                     Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API
                --qingstor-env-auth                            Get QingStor credentials from runtime
                --qingstor-secret-access-key string            QingStor Secret Access Key (password)
                --qingstor-upload-concurrency int              Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 1)
                --qingstor-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix            Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                --qingstor-zone string                         Zone to connect to
                --s3-access-key-id string                      AWS Access Key ID
                --s3-acl string                                Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects
                --s3-bucket-acl string                         Canned ACL used when creating buckets
                --s3-chunk-size SizeSuffix                     Chunk size to use for uploading (default 5Mi)
                --s3-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                    Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4.656Gi)
                --s3-decompress                                If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects
                --s3-disable-checksum                          Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
                --s3-disable-http2                             Disable usage of http2 for S3 backends
                --s3-download-url string                       Custom endpoint for downloads
                --s3-encoding MultiEncoder                     The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --s3-endpoint string                           Endpoint for S3 API
                --s3-env-auth                                  Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars)
                --s3-force-path-style                          If true use path style access if false use virtual hosted style (default true)
                --s3-leave-parts-on-error                      If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery
                --s3-list-chunk int                            Size of listing chunk (response list for each ListObject S3 request) (default 1000)
                --s3-list-url-encode Tristate                  Whether to url encode listings: true/false/unset (default unset)
                --s3-list-version int                          Version of ListObjects to use: 1,2 or 0 for auto
                --s3-location-constraint string                Location constraint - must be set to match the Region
                --s3-max-upload-parts int                      Maximum number of parts in a multipart upload (default 10000)
                --s3-memory-pool-flush-time Duration           How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed (default 1m0s)
                --s3-memory-pool-use-mmap                      Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool
                --s3-might-gzip Tristate                       Set this if the backend might gzip objects (default unset)
                --s3-no-check-bucket                           If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
                --s3-no-head                                   If set, don't HEAD uploaded objects to check integrity
                --s3-no-head-object                            If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects
                --s3-no-system-metadata                        Suppress setting and reading of system metadata
                --s3-profile string                            Profile to use in the shared credentials file
                --s3-provider string                           Choose your S3 provider
                --s3-region string                             Region to connect to
                --s3-requester-pays                            Enables requester pays option when interacting with S3 bucket
                --s3-secret-access-key string                  AWS Secret Access Key (password)
                --s3-server-side-encryption string             The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
                --s3-session-token string                      An AWS session token
                --s3-shared-credentials-file string            Path to the shared credentials file
                --s3-sse-customer-algorithm string             If using SSE-C, the server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
                --s3-sse-customer-key string                   To use SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key used to encrypt/decrypt your data
                --s3-sse-customer-key-base64 string            If using SSE-C you must provide the secret encryption key encoded in base64 format to encrypt/decrypt your data
                --s3-sse-customer-key-md5 string               If using SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key MD5 checksum (optional)
                --s3-sse-kms-key-id string                     If using KMS ID you must provide the ARN of Key
                --s3-storage-class string                      The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3
                --s3-upload-concurrency int                    Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 4)
                --s3-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                  Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                --s3-use-accelerate-endpoint                   If true use the AWS S3 accelerated endpoint
                --s3-use-multipart-etag Tristate               Whether to use ETag in multipart uploads for verification (default unset)
                --s3-use-presigned-request                     Whether to use a presigned request or PutObject for single part uploads
                --s3-v2-auth                                   If true use v2 authentication
                --s3-version-at Time                           Show file versions as they were at the specified time (default off)
                --s3-versions                                  Include old versions in directory listings
                --seafile-2fa                                  Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
                --seafile-create-library                       Should rclone create a library if it doesn't exist
                --seafile-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
                --seafile-library string                       Name of the library
                --seafile-library-key string                   Library password (for encrypted libraries only) (obscured)
                --seafile-pass string                          Password (obscured)
                --seafile-url string                           URL of seafile host to connect to
                --seafile-user string                          User name (usually email address)
                --sftp-ask-password                            Allow asking for SFTP password when needed
                --sftp-chunk-size SizeSuffix                   Upload and download chunk size (default 32Ki)
                --sftp-concurrency int                         The maximum number of outstanding requests for one file (default 64)
                --sftp-disable-concurrent-reads                If set don't use concurrent reads
                --sftp-disable-concurrent-writes               If set don't use concurrent writes
                --sftp-disable-hashcheck                       Disable the execution of SSH commands to determine if remote file hashing is available
                --sftp-host string                             SSH host to connect to
                --sftp-idle-timeout Duration                   Max time before closing idle connections (default 1m0s)
                --sftp-key-file string                         Path to PEM-encoded private key file
                --sftp-key-file-pass string                    The passphrase to decrypt the PEM-encoded private key file (obscured)
                --sftp-key-pem string                          Raw PEM-encoded private key
                --sftp-key-use-agent                           When set forces the usage of the ssh-agent
                --sftp-known-hosts-file string                 Optional path to known_hosts file
                --sftp-md5sum-command string                   The command used to read md5 hashes
                --sftp-pass string                             SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent (obscured)
                --sftp-path-override string                    Override path used by SSH shell commands
                --sftp-port int                                SSH port number (default 22)
                --sftp-pubkey-file string                      Optional path to public key file
                --sftp-server-command string                   Specifies the path or command to run a sftp server on the remote host
                --sftp-set-env SpaceSepList                    Environment variables to pass to sftp and commands
                --sftp-set-modtime                             Set the modified time on the remote if set (default true)
                --sftp-sha1sum-command string                  The command used to read sha1 hashes
                --sftp-shell-type string                       The type of SSH shell on remote server, if any
                --sftp-skip-links                              Set to skip any symlinks and any other non regular files
                --sftp-subsystem string                        Specifies the SSH2 subsystem on the remote host (default "sftp")
                --sftp-use-fstat                               If set use fstat instead of stat
                --sftp-use-insecure-cipher                     Enable the use of insecure ciphers and key exchange methods
                --sftp-user string                             SSH username (default "$USER")
                --sharefile-chunk-size SizeSuffix              Upload chunk size (default 64Mi)
                --sharefile-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftPeriod,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --sharefile-endpoint string                    Endpoint for API calls
                --sharefile-root-folder-id string              ID of the root folder
                --sharefile-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix           Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (default 128Mi)
                --sia-api-password string                      Sia Daemon API Password (obscured)
                --sia-api-url string                           Sia daemon API URL, like http://sia.daemon.host:9980 (default "http://127.0.0.1:9980")
                --sia-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Question,Hash,Percent,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --sia-user-agent string                        Siad User Agent (default "Sia-Agent")
                --skip-links                                   Don't warn about skipped symlinks
                --smb-case-insensitive                         Whether the server is configured to be case-insensitive (default true)
                --smb-domain string                            Domain name for NTLM authentication (default "WORKGROUP")
                --smb-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --smb-hide-special-share                       Hide special shares (e.g. print$) which users aren't supposed to access (default true)
                --smb-host string                              SMB server hostname to connect to
                --smb-idle-timeout Duration                    Max time before closing idle connections (default 1m0s)
                --smb-pass string                              SMB password (obscured)
                --smb-port int                                 SMB port number (default 445)
                --smb-user string                              SMB username (default "$USER")
                --storj-access-grant string                    Access grant
                --storj-api-key string                         API key
                --storj-passphrase string                      Encryption passphrase
                --storj-provider string                        Choose an authentication method (default "existing")
                --storj-satellite-address string               Satellite address (default "us-central-1.storj.io")
                --sugarsync-access-key-id string               Sugarsync Access Key ID
                --sugarsync-app-id string                      Sugarsync App ID
                --sugarsync-authorization string               Sugarsync authorization
                --sugarsync-authorization-expiry string        Sugarsync authorization expiry
                --sugarsync-deleted-id string                  Sugarsync deleted folder id
                --sugarsync-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --sugarsync-hard-delete                        Permanently delete files if true
                --sugarsync-private-access-key string          Sugarsync Private Access Key
                --sugarsync-refresh-token string               Sugarsync refresh token
                --sugarsync-root-id string                     Sugarsync root id
                --sugarsync-user string                        Sugarsync user
                --swift-application-credential-id string       Application Credential ID (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID)
                --swift-application-credential-name string     Application Credential Name (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME)
                --swift-application-credential-secret string   Application Credential Secret (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET)
                --swift-auth string                            Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL)
                --swift-auth-token string                      Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)
                --swift-auth-version int                       AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)
                --swift-chunk-size SizeSuffix                  Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container (default 5Gi)
                --swift-domain string                          User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)
                --swift-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8)
                --swift-endpoint-type string                   Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE) (default "public")
                --swift-env-auth                               Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form
                --swift-key string                             API key or password (OS_PASSWORD)
                --swift-leave-parts-on-error                   If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure
                --swift-no-chunk                               Don't chunk files during streaming upload
                --swift-no-large-objects                       Disable support for static and dynamic large objects
                --swift-region string                          Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)
                --swift-storage-policy string                  The storage policy to use when creating a new container
                --swift-storage-url string                     Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)
                --swift-tenant string                          Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)
                --swift-tenant-domain string                   Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)
                --swift-tenant-id string                       Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)
                --swift-user string                            User name to log in (OS_USERNAME)
                --swift-user-id string                         User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID)
                --union-action-policy string                   Policy to choose upstream on ACTION category (default "epall")
                --union-cache-time int                         Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds) (default 120)
                --union-create-policy string                   Policy to choose upstream on CREATE category (default "epmfs")
                --union-min-free-space SizeSuffix              Minimum viable free space for lfs/eplfs policies (default 1Gi)
                --union-search-policy string                   Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH category (default "ff")
                --union-upstreams string                       List of space separated upstreams
                --uptobox-access-token string                  Your access token
                --uptobox-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,BackQuote,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --webdav-bearer-token string                   Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)
                --webdav-bearer-token-command string           Command to run to get a bearer token
                --webdav-encoding string                       The encoding for the backend
                --webdav-headers CommaSepList                  Set HTTP headers for all transactions
                --webdav-pass string                           Password (obscured)
                --webdav-url string                            URL of http host to connect to
                --webdav-user string                           User name
                --webdav-vendor string                         Name of the WebDAV site/service/software you are using
                --yandex-auth-url string                       Auth server URL
                --yandex-client-id string                      OAuth Client Id
                --yandex-client-secret string                  OAuth Client Secret
                --yandex-encoding MultiEncoder                 The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                --yandex-hard-delete                           Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash
                --yandex-token string                          OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --yandex-token-url string                      Token server url
                --zoho-auth-url string                         Auth server URL
                --zoho-client-id string                        OAuth Client Id
                --zoho-client-secret string                    OAuth Client Secret
                --zoho-encoding MultiEncoder                   The encoding for the backend (default Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
                --zoho-region string                           Zoho region to connect to
                --zoho-token string                            OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                --zoho-token-url string                        Token server url

Docker Volume Plugin Introduction

   Docker 1.9 has added support for creating named volumes (https://docs.docker.com/storage/volumes/) via  command-line  interface  (https://docs.docker.com/en
   gine/reference/commandline/volume_create/)  and mounting them in containers as a way to share data between them.  Since Docker 1.10 you can create named vol
   umes with Docker Compose (https://docs.docker.com/compose/) by descriptions in docker-compose.yml (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-
   v2/#volume-configuration-reference)  files  for  use  by  container  groups  on  a  single  host.   As  of  Docker 1.12 volumes are supported by Docker Swarm
   (https://docs.docker.com/engine/swarm/key-concepts/) included with Docker Engine and created  from  descriptions  in  swarm  compose  v3  (https://docs.dock
   er.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-v3/#volume-configuration-reference) files for use with swarm stacks across multiple cluster nodes.

   Docker  Volume  Plugins (https://docs.docker.com/engine/extend/plugins_volume/) augment the default local volume driver included in Docker with stateful vol
   umes shared across containers and hosts.  Unlike local volumes, your data will not be deleted when such volume is removed.  Plugins can run  managed  by  the
   docker  daemon,  as  a  native  system service (under systemd, sysv or upstart) or as a standalone executable.  Rclone can run as docker volume plugin in all
   these modes.  It interacts with the local docker daemon via plugin API (https://docs.docker.com/engine/extend/plugin_api/) and  handles  mounting  of  remote
   file systems into docker containers so it must run on the same host as the docker daemon or on every Swarm node.

Getting started

   In the first example we will use the SFTP (https://rclone.org/sftp/) rclone volume with Docker engine on a standalone Ubuntu machine.

   Start from installing Docker (https://docs.docker.com/engine/install/) on the host.

   The FUSE driver is a prerequisite for rclone mounting and should be installed on host:

          sudo apt-get -y install fuse

   Create two directories required by rclone docker plugin:

          sudo mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/config
          sudo mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/cache

   Install the managed rclone docker plugin for your architecture (here amd64):

          docker plugin install rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64 args="-v" --alias rclone --grant-all-permissions
          docker plugin list

   Create your SFTP volume (https://rclone.org/sftp/#standard-options):

          docker volume create firstvolume -d rclone -o type=sftp -o sftp-host=_hostname_ -o sftp-user=_username_ -o sftp-pass=_password_ -o allow-other=true

   Note  that  since  all  options are static, you don't even have to run rclone config or create the rclone.conf file (but the config directory should still be
   present).  In the simplest case you can use localhost as hostname and your SSH credentials as username and password.  You can also change the remote path  to
   your home directory on the host, for example -o path=/home/username.

   Time to create a test container and mount the volume into it:

          docker run --rm -it -v firstvolume:/mnt --workdir /mnt ubuntu:latest bash

   If  all  goes well, you will enter the new container and change right to the mounted SFTP remote.  You can type ls to list the mounted directory or otherwise
   play with it.  Type exit when you are done.  The container will stop but the volume will stay, ready to be reused.  When it's not needed anymore, remove it:

          docker volume list
          docker volume remove firstvolume

   Now let us try something more elaborate: Google Drive (https://rclone.org/drive/) volume on multi-node Docker Swarm.

   You should start from installing Docker and FUSE, creating plugin directories and installing rclone plugin  on  every  swarm  node.   Then  setup  the  Swarm
   (https://docs.docker.com/engine/swarm/swarm-mode/).

   Google  Drive  volumes  need  an access token which can be setup via web browser and will be periodically renewed by rclone.  The managed plugin cannot run a
   browser so we will use a technique similar to the rclone setup on a headless box (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/).

   Run rclone config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/) on another machine equipped with web browser and graphical user interface.  Create  the
   Google  Drive  remote  (https://rclone.org/drive/#standard-options).   When  done,  transfer  the  resulting  rclone.conf  to  the  Swarm cluster and save as
   /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/config/rclone.conf on every node.  By default this location is accessible only to the root user so you will  need  appropriate
   privileges.  The resulting config will look like this:

          [gdrive]
          type = drive
          scope = drive
          drive_id = 1234567...
          root_folder_id = 0Abcd...
          token = {"access_token":...}

   Now create the file named example.yml with a swarm stack description like this:

          version: '3'
          services:
            heimdall:
              image: linuxserver/heimdall:latest
              ports: [8080:80]
              volumes: [configdata:/config]
          volumes:
            configdata:
              driver: rclone
              driver_opts:
                remote: 'gdrive:heimdall'
                allow_other: 'true'
                vfs_cache_mode: full
                poll_interval: 0

   and run the stack:

          docker stack deploy example -c ./example.yml

   After a few seconds docker will spread the parsed stack description over cluster, create the example_heimdall service on port 8080, run service containers on
   one or more cluster nodes and request the example_configdata volume from rclone plugins on the node hosts.  You can use the following commands to confirm re
   sults:

          docker service ls
          docker service ps example_heimdall
          docker volume ls

   Point your browser to http://cluster.host.address:8080 and play with the service.  Stop it with docker stack remove example when you are done.  Note that the
   example_configdata volume(s) created on demand at the cluster nodes will not be automatically removed together with the stack but stay for future reuse.  You
   can remove them manually by invoking the docker volume remove example_configdata command on every node.

Creating Volumes via CLI

   Volumes can be created with docker volume create (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/volume_create/).  Here are a few examples:

          docker volume create vol1 -d rclone -o remote=storj: -o vfs-cache-mode=full
          docker volume create vol2 -d rclone -o remote=:storj,access_grant=xxx:heimdall
          docker volume create vol3 -d rclone -o type=storj -o path=heimdall -o storj-access-grant=xxx -o poll-interval=0

   Note  the  -d  rclone  flag  that  tells  docker  to request volume from the rclone driver.  This works even if you installed managed driver by its full name
   rclone/docker-volume-rclone because you provided the --alias rclone option.

   Volumes can be inspected as follows:

          docker volume list
          docker volume inspect vol1

Volume Configuration

   Rclone flags and volume options are set via the -o flag to the docker volume create command.  They include backend-specific parameters as well as  mount  and
   VFS options.  Also there are a few special -o options: remote, fs, type, path, mount-type and persist.

   remote  determines  an  existing  remote name from the config file, with trailing colon and optionally with a remote path.  See the full syntax in the rclone
   documentation (https://rclone.org/docs/#syntax-of-remote-paths).  This option can be aliased as fs to prevent confusion with the  remote  parameter  of  such
   backends as crypt or alias.

   The  remote=:backend:dir/subdir  syntax can be used to create on-the-fly (config-less) remotes (https://rclone.org/docs/#backend-path-to-dir), while the type
   and path options provide a simpler alternative for this.  Using two split options

          -o type=backend -o path=dir/subdir

   is equivalent to the combined syntax

          -o remote=:backend:dir/subdir

   but is arguably easier to parameterize in scripts.  The path part is optional.

   Mount and VFS options (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/#options) as well as backend parameters (https://rclone.org/flags/#backend-flags)  are
   named  like  their  twin  command-line  flags without the -- CLI prefix.  Optionally you can use underscores instead of dashes in option names.  For example,
   --vfs-cache-mode full becomes -o vfs-cache-mode=full or -o vfs_cache_mode=full.  Boolean CLI flags without value will gain the true value, e.g.  --allow-oth
   er becomes -o allow-other=true or -o allow_other=true.

   Please note that you can provide parameters only for the backend immediately referenced by the backend type of mounted remote.  If this is a wrapping backend
   like alias, chunker or crypt, you cannot provide options for the referred to remote or backend.  This limitation is imposed by the rclone  connection  string
   parser.  The only workaround is to feed plugin with rclone.conf or configure plugin arguments (see below).

Special Volume Options

   mount-type  determines  the mount method and in general can be one of: mount, cmount, or mount2.  This can be aliased as mount_type.  It should be noted that
   the managed rclone docker plugin currently does not support the cmount method and mount2 is rarely needed.  This option defaults to the first  found  method,
   which is usually mount so you generally won't need it.

   persist is a reserved boolean (true/false) option.  In future it will allow to persist on-the-fly remotes in the plugin rclone.conf file.

Connection Strings

   The  remote  value  can be extended with connection strings (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings) as an alternative way to supply backend parameters.
   This is equivalent to the -o backend options with one syntactic difference.  Inside connection string the backend prefix must be dropped from parameter names
   but in the -o param=value array it must be present.  For instance, compare the following option array

          -o remote=:sftp:/home -o sftp-host=localhost

   with equivalent connection string:

          -o remote=:sftp,host=localhost:/home

   This difference exists because flag options -o key=val include not only backend parameters but also mount/VFS flags and possibly other settings.  Also it al
   lows to discriminate the remote option from the crypt-remote (or similarly named backend parameters) and arguably simplifies scripting due to  clearer  value
   substitution.

Using with Swarm or Compose

   Both  Docker  Swarm  and  Docker  Compose use YAML (http://yaml.org/spec/1.2/spec.html)-formatted text files to describe groups (stacks) of containers, their
   properties, networks and volumes.  Compose uses the compose v2 (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-v2/#volume-configuration-reference)
   format,  Swarm  uses  the  compose v3 (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-v3/#volume-configuration-reference) format.  They are mostly
   similar, differences are explained in the docker documentation (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-versioning/#upgrading).

   Volumes are described by the children of the top-level volumes: node.  Each of them should be named after its volume and have  at  least  two  elements,  the
   self-explanatory driver: rclone value and the driver_opts: structure playing the same role as -o key=val CLI flags:

          volumes:
            volume_name_1:
              driver: rclone
              driver_opts:
                remote: 'gdrive:'
                allow_other: 'true'
                vfs_cache_mode: full
                token: '{"type": "borrower", "expires": "2021-12-31"}'
                poll_interval: 0

   Notice  a  few important details: - YAML prefers _ in option names instead of -.  - YAML treats single and double quotes interchangeably.  Simple strings and
   integers can be left unquoted.  - Boolean values must be quoted like 'true' or "false" because these two words are reserved by YAML.  - The filesystem string
   is  keyed  with remote (or with fs).  Normally you can omit quotes here, but if the string ends with colon, you must quote it like remote: "storage_box:".  -
   YAML is picky about surrounding braces in values as this is in fact another syntax  for  key/value  mappings  (http://yaml.org/spec/1.2/spec.html#id2790832).
   For example, JSON access tokens usually contain double quotes and surrounding braces, so you must put them in single quotes.

Installing as Managed Plugin

   Docker daemon can install plugins from an image registry and run them managed.  We maintain the docker-volume-rclone (https://hub.docker.com/p/rclone/docker-
   volume-rclone/) plugin image on Docker Hub (https://hub.docker.com).

   Rclone volume plugin requires Docker Engine >= 19.03.15

   The plugin requires presence of two directories on the host before it can be installed.  Note that plugin will not create  them  automatically.   By  default
   they  must exist on host at the following locations (though you can tweak the paths): - /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/config is reserved for the rclone.conf
   config file and must exist even if it's empty and the config file is not present.  - /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/cache holds the plugin state file as well
   as optional VFS caches.

   You can install managed plugin (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/plugin_install/) with default settings as follows:

          docker plugin install rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64 --grant-all-permissions --alias rclone

   The  :amd64  part of the image specification after colon is called a tag.  Usually you will want to install the latest plugin for your architecture.  In this
   case the tag will just name it, like amd64 above.  The following plugin architectures are currently available: - amd64 - arm64 - arm-v7

   Sometimes you might want a concrete plugin version, not the latest one.  Then you should use image tag in the form :ARCHITECTURE-VERSION.   For  example,  to
   install  plugin version v1.56.2 on architecture arm64 you will use tag arm64-1.56.2 (note the removed v) so the full image specification becomes rclone/dock‐
   er-volume-rclone:arm64-1.56.2.

   We also provide the latest plugin tag, but since docker does not support multi-architecture plugins as of the time of this writing, this tag is currently  an
   alias  for  amd64.   By convention the latest tag is the default one and can be omitted, thus both rclone/docker-volume-rclone:latest and just rclone/docker-
   volume-rclone will refer to the latest plugin release for the amd64 platform.

   Also the amd64 part can be omitted from the versioned rclone plugin tags.  For example, rclone image reference  rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64-1.56.2  can
   be  abbreviated  as  rclone/docker-volume-rclone:1.56.2 for convenience.  However, for non-intel architectures you still have to use the full tag as amd64 or
   latest will fail to start.

   Managed plugin is in fact a special container running in a namespace separate from normal docker containers.  Inside it runs the rclone serve docker command.
   The config and cache directories are bind-mounted into the container at start.  The docker daemon connects to a unix socket created by the command inside the
   container.  The command creates on-demand remote mounts right inside, then docker machinery propagates them through kernel mount namespaces  and  bind-mounts
   into requesting user containers.

   You can tweak a few plugin settings after installation when it's disabled (not in use), for instance:

          docker plugin disable rclone
          docker plugin set rclone RCLONE_VERBOSE=2 config=/etc/rclone args="--vfs-cache-mode=writes --allow-other"
          docker plugin enable rclone
          docker plugin inspect rclone

   Note  that  if docker refuses to disable the plugin, you should find and remove all active volumes connected with it as well as containers and swarm services
   that use them.  This is rather tedious so please carefully plan in advance.

   You can tweak the following settings: args, config, cache, HTTP_PROXY, HTTPS_PROXY, NO_PROXY and RCLONE_VERBOSE.  It's your task to keep plugin  settings  in
   sync across swarm cluster nodes.

   args  sets command-line arguments for the rclone serve docker command (none by default).  Arguments should be separated by space so you will normally want to
   put them in quotes on the docker plugin  set  (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/plugin_set/)  command  line.   Both  serve  docker  flags
   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/#options)  and  generic rclone flags (https://rclone.org/flags/) are supported, including backend parameters
   that will be used as defaults for volume creation.  Note that plugin will fail (due  to  this  docker  bug  (https://github.com/moby/moby/blob/v20.10.7/plug‐
   in/v2/plugin.go#L195)) if the args value is empty.  Use e.g.  args="-v" as a workaround.

   config=/host/dir  sets  alternative  host location for the config directory.  Plugin will look for rclone.conf here.  It's not an error if the config file is
   not present but the directory must exist.  Please note that plugin can periodically rewrite the config file, for example when it renews  storage  access  to
   kens.   Keep  this in mind and try to avoid races between the plugin and other instances of rclone on the host that might try to change the config simultane
   ously resulting in corrupted rclone.conf.  You can also put stuff like private key files for SFTP remotes in this directory.  Just note that it's bind-mount
   ed inside the plugin container at the predefined path /data/config.  For example, if your key file is named sftp-box1.key on the host, the corresponding vol
   ume config option should read -o sftp-key-file=/data/config/sftp-box1.key.

   cache=/host/dir sets alternative host location for the cache directory.  The plugin will keep VFS caches here.  Also it will create and maintain the  docker-
   plugin.state file in this directory.  When the plugin is restarted or reinstalled, it will look in this file to recreate any volumes that existed previously.
   However, they will not be re-mounted into consuming containers after restart.  Usually this is not a problem as the docker daemon normally will  restart  af
   fected user containers after failures, daemon restarts or host reboots.

   RCLONE_VERBOSE  sets  plugin verbosity from 0 (errors only, by default) to 2 (debugging).  Verbosity can be also tweaked via args="-v [-v] ...".  Since argu
   ments are more generic, you will rarely need this setting.  The plugin output by default feeds the docker daemon log on local host.  Log entries are reflect
   ed as errors in the docker log but retain their actual level assigned by rclone in the encapsulated message string.

   HTTP_PROXY, HTTPS_PROXY, NO_PROXY customize the plugin proxy settings.

   You can set custom plugin options right when you install it, in one go:

          docker plugin remove rclone
          docker plugin install rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64 \
                 --alias rclone --grant-all-permissions \
                 args="-v --allow-other" config=/etc/rclone
          docker plugin inspect rclone

Healthchecks

   The  docker  plugin  volume  protocol doesn't provide a way for plugins to inform the docker daemon that a volume is (un-)available.  As a workaround you can
   setup a healthcheck to verify that the mount is responding, for example:

          services:
            my_service:
              image: my_image
              healthcheck:
                test: ls /path/to/rclone/mount || exit 1
                interval: 1m
                timeout: 15s
                retries: 3
                start_period: 15s

Running Plugin under Systemd

   In most cases you should prefer managed mode.  Moreover, MacOS and Windows do not support native Docker plugins.  Please use managed mode on  these  systems.
   Proceed further only if you are on Linux.

   First, install rclone (https://rclone.org/install/).  You can just run it (type rclone serve docker and hit enter) for the test.

   Install FUSE:

          sudo apt-get -y install fuse

   Download  two  systemd  configuration  files: docker-volume-rclone.service (https://raw.githubusercontent.com/rclone/rclone/master/contrib/docker-plugin/sys
   temd/docker-volume-rclone.service)   and    docker-volume-rclone.socket    (https://raw.githubusercontent.com/rclone/rclone/master/contrib/docker-plugin/sys
   temd/docker-volume-rclone.socket).

   Put them to the /etc/systemd/system/ directory:

          cp docker-volume-plugin.service /etc/systemd/system/
          cp docker-volume-plugin.socket  /etc/systemd/system/

   Please note that all commands in this section must be run as root but we omit sudo prefix for brevity.  Now create directories required by the service:

          mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-volumes/rclone
          mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/config
          mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/cache

   Run the docker plugin service in the socket activated mode:

          systemctl daemon-reload
          systemctl start docker-volume-rclone.service
          systemctl enable docker-volume-rclone.socket
          systemctl start docker-volume-rclone.socket
          systemctl restart docker

   Or  run the service directly: - run systemctl daemon-reload to let systemd pick up new config - run systemctl enable docker-volume-rclone.service to make the
   new service start automatically when you power on your machine.  - run systemctl start docker-volume-rclone.service to start the service now.  - run  system
   ctl  restart  docker  to restart docker daemon and let it detect the new plugin socket.  Note that this step is not needed in managed mode where docker knows
   about plugin state changes.

   The two methods are equivalent from the user perspective, but I personally prefer socket activation.

Troubleshooting

   You can see managed plugin settings (https://docs.docker.com/engine/extend/#debugging-plugins) with

          docker plugin list
          docker plugin inspect rclone

   Note that docker (including latest 20.10.7) will not show actual values of args, just the defaults.

   Use journalctl --unit docker to see managed plugin output as part of the docker daemon log.  Note that docker reflects plugin lines as errors but their actu
   al level can be seen from encapsulated message string.

   You will usually install the latest version of managed plugin for your platform.  Use the following commands to print the actual installed version:

          PLUGID=$(docker plugin list --no-trunc | awk '/rclone/{print$1}')
          sudo runc --root /run/docker/runtime-runc/plugins.moby exec $PLUGID rclone version

   You can even use runc to run shell inside the plugin container:

          sudo runc --root /run/docker/runtime-runc/plugins.moby exec --tty $PLUGID bash

   Also you can use curl to check the plugin socket connectivity:

          docker plugin list --no-trunc
          PLUGID=123abc...
          sudo curl -H Content-Type:application/json -XPOST -d {} --unix-socket /run/docker/plugins/$PLUGID/rclone.sock http://localhost/Plugin.Activate

   though this is rarely needed.

Caveats

   Finally  I'd  like  to  mention  a  caveat with updating volume settings.  Docker CLI does not have a dedicated command like docker volume update.  It may be
   tempting to invoke docker volume create with updated options on existing volume, but there is a gotcha.  The command will do nothing, it won't even return an
   error.   I hope that docker maintainers will fix this some day.  In the meantime be aware that you must remove your volume before recreating it with new set
   tings:

          docker volume remove my_vol
          docker volume create my_vol -d rclone -o opt1=new_val1 ...

   and verify that settings did update:

          docker volume list
          docker volume inspect my_vol

   If docker refuses to remove the volume, you should find containers or swarm services that use it and stop them first.

Getting started

    Install rclone (https://rclone.org/install/) and setup your remotes.

    Bisync will create its working directory at ~/.cache/rclone/bisync on Linux or C:\Users\MyLogin\AppData\Local\rclone\bisync on  Windows.   Make  sure  that
     this location is writable.

    Run bisync with the --resync flag, specifying the paths to the local and remote sync directory roots.

    For successive sync runs, leave off the --resync flag.

    Consider using a filters file for excluding unnecessary files and directories from the sync.

    Consider setting up the --check-access feature for safety.

    On Linux, consider setting up a crontab entry.  bisync can safely run in concurrent cron jobs thanks to lock files it maintains.

   Here is a typical run log (with timestamps removed for clarity):

          rclone bisync /testdir/path1/ /testdir/path2/ --verbose
          INFO  : Synching Path1 "/testdir/path1/" with Path2 "/testdir/path2/"
          INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
          INFO  : - Path1    File is new                         - file11.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    File is newer                       - file2.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    File is newer                       - file5.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    File is newer                       - file7.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    File was deleted                    - file4.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    File was deleted                    - file6.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    File was deleted                    - file8.txt
          INFO  : Path1:    7 changes:    1 new,    3 newer,    0 older,    3 deleted
          INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
          INFO  : - Path2    File is new                         - file10.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    File is newer                       - file1.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    File is newer                       - file5.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    File is newer                       - file6.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    File was deleted                    - file3.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    File was deleted                    - file7.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    File was deleted                    - file8.txt
          INFO  : Path2:    7 changes:    1 new,    3 newer,    0 older,    3 deleted
          INFO  : Applying changes
          INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file11.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file2.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    Queue delete                        - /testdir/path2/file4.txt
          NOTICE: - WARNING  New or changed in both paths        - file5.txt
          NOTICE: - Path1    Renaming Path1 copy                 - /testdir/path1/file5.txt..path1
          NOTICE: - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file5.txt..path1
          NOTICE: - Path2    Renaming Path2 copy                 - /testdir/path2/file5.txt..path2
          NOTICE: - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file5.txt..path2
          INFO  : - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file6.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file7.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file1.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file10.txt
          INFO  : - Path1    Queue delete                        - /testdir/path1/file3.txt
          INFO  : - Path2    Do queued copies to                 - Path1
          INFO  : - Path1    Do queued copies to                 - Path2
          INFO  : -          Do queued deletes on                - Path1
          INFO  : -          Do queued deletes on                - Path2
          INFO  : Updating listings
          INFO  : Validating listings for Path1 "/testdir/path1/" vs Path2 "/testdir/path2/"
          INFO  : Bisync successful

Command line syntax

          $ rclone bisync --help
          Usage:
            rclone bisync remote1:path1 remote2:path2 [flags]

          Positional arguments:
            Path1, Path2  Local path, or remote storage with ':' plus optional path.
                          Type 'rclone listremotes' for list of configured remotes.

          Optional Flags:
                --check-access            Ensure expected `RCLONE_TEST` files are found on
                                          both Path1 and Path2 filesystems, else abort.
                --check-filename FILENAME Filename for `--check-access` (default: `RCLONE_TEST`)
                --check-sync CHOICE       Controls comparison of final listings:
                                          `true | false | only` (default: true)
                                          If set to `only`, bisync will only compare listings
                                          from the last run but skip actual sync.
                --filters-file PATH       Read filtering patterns from a file
                --max-delete PERCENT      Safety check on maximum percentage of deleted files allowed.
                                          If exceeded, the bisync run will abort. (default: 50%)
                --force                   Bypass `--max-delete` safety check and run the sync.
                                          Consider using with `--verbose`
                --remove-empty-dirs       Remove empty directories at the final cleanup step.
            -1, --resync                  Performs the resync run.
                                          Warning: Path1 files may overwrite Path2 versions.
                                          Consider using `--verbose` or `--dry-run` first.
                --localtime               Use local time in listings (default: UTC)
                --no-cleanup              Retain working files (useful for troubleshooting and testing).
                --workdir PATH            Use custom working directory (useful for testing).
                                          (default: `~/.cache/rclone/bisync`)
            -n, --dry-run                 Go through the motions - No files are copied/deleted.
            -v, --verbose                 Increases logging verbosity.
                                          May be specified more than once for more details.
            -h, --help                    help for bisync

   Arbitrary  rclone  flags may be specified on the bisync command line (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_bisync/), for example rclone bisync ./testdir/path1/
   gdrive:testdir/path2/ --drive-skip-gdocs -v -v --timeout 10s Note that interactions of various rclone flags with bisync process flow has not been fully test
   ed yet.

Paths

   Path1  and Path2 arguments may be references to any mix of local directory paths (absolute or relative), UNC paths (//server/share/path), Windows drive paths
   (with a drive letter and :) or configured remotes (https://rclone.org/docs/#syntax-of-remote-paths) with optional subdirectory paths.  Cloud  references  are
   distinguished by having a : in the argument (see Windows support below).

   Path1  and  Path2  are  treated equally, in that neither has priority for file changes, and access efficiency does not change whether a remote is on Path1 or
   Path2.

   The listings in bisync working directory (default: ~/.cache/rclone/bisync) are named based on the Path1 and Path2 arguments so that separate syncs  to  indi
   vidual directories within the tree may be set up, e.g.: path_to_local_tree..dropbox_subdir.lst.

   Any  empty directories after the sync on both the Path1 and Path2 filesystems are not deleted by default.  If the --remove-empty-dirs flag is specified, then
   both paths will have any empty directories purged as the last step in the process.

Command-line flags --resync

   This will effectively make both Path1 and Path2 filesystems contain a matching superset of all files.  Path2 files that do not exist in Path1 will be  copied
   to Path1, and the process will then sync the Path1 tree to Path2.

   The  base directories on the both Path1 and Path2 filesystems must exist or bisync will fail.  This is required for safety - that bisync can verify that both
   paths are valid.

   When using --resync, a newer version of a file either on Path1 or Path2 filesystem, will overwrite the file on the other path (only the last version will  be
   kept).  Carefully evaluate deltas using --dry-run (https://rclone.org/flags/#non-backend-flags).

   For  a  resync run, one of the paths may be empty (no files in the path tree).  The resync run should result in files on both paths, else a normal non-resync
   run will fail.

   For a non-resync run, either path being empty (no files in the tree) fails with Empty current PathN listing. Cannot sync to an empty  directory:  X.pathN.lst
   This is a safety check that an unexpected empty path does not result in deleting everything in the other path.

--check-access

   Access  check  files are an additional safety measure against data loss.  bisync will ensure it can find matching RCLONE_TEST files in the same places in the
   Path1 and Path2 filesystems.  RCLONE_TEST files are not generated automatically.  For --check-accessto succeed, you must first either: A) Place one  or  more
   RCLONE_TEST  files  in the Path1 or Path2 filesystem and then do either a run without --check-access or a --resync to set matching files on both filesystems,
   or B) Set --check-filename to a filename already in use in various locations throughout your sync'd fileset.  Time stamps and file contents  are  not  impor
   tant,  just  the  names  and locations.  If you have symbolic links in your sync tree it is recommended to place RCLONE_TEST files in the linked-to directory
   tree to protect against bisync assuming a bunch of deleted files if the linked-to tree should not be accessible.  See also the --check-filename flag.

--check-filename

   Name of the file(s) used in access health validation.  The default --check-filename is RCLONE_TEST.  One or more files having this filename must exist,  syn
   chronized between your source and destination filesets, in order for --check-access to succeed.  See --check-access for additional details.

--max-delete

   As  a  safety  check,  if  greater than the --max-delete percent of files were deleted on either the Path1 or Path2 filesystem, then bisync will abort with a
   warning message, without making any changes.  The default --max-delete is 50%.  One way to trigger this limit is to rename a  directory  that  contains  more
   than  half  of  your  files.  This will appear to bisync as a bunch of deleted files and a bunch of new files.  This safety check is intended to block bisync
   from deleting all of the files on both filesystems due to a temporary network access issue, or if the user had inadvertently deleted the files on one side or
   the other.  To force the sync either set a different delete percentage limit, e.g.  --max-delete 75 (allows up to 75% deletion), or use --force to bypass the
   check.

   Also see the all files changed check.

--filters-file

   By using rclone filter features you can exclude file types or directory sub-trees from the sync.  See the bisync filters section  and  generic  --filter-from
   (https://rclone.org/filtering/#filter-from-read-filtering-patterns-from-a-file)  documentation.   An  example  filters  file contains filters for non-allowed
   files for synching with Dropbox.

   If you make changes to your filters file then bisync requires a run with --resync.  This is a safety feature, which avoids existing files on the Path1 and/or
   Path2  side  from  seeming to disappear from view (since they are excluded in the new listings), which would fool bisync into seeing them as deleted (as com
   pared to the prior run listings), and then bisync would proceed to delete them for real.

   To block this from happening bisync calculates an MD5 hash of the filters file and stores the hash in a .md5 file in the same place as your filters file.  On
   the  next  runs  with  --filters-file set, bisync re-calculates the MD5 hash of the current filters file and compares it to the hash stored in .md5 file.  If
   they don't match the run aborts with a critical error and thus forces you to do a --resync, likely avoiding a disaster.

--check-sync

   Enabled by default, the check-sync function checks that all of the same files exist in both the Path1 and Path2 history listings.  This check-sync  integrity
   check  is  performed at the end of the sync run by default.  Any untrapped failing copy/deletes between the two paths might result in differences between the
   two listings and in the untracked file content differences between the two paths.  A resync run would correct the error.

   Note that the default-enabled integrity check locally executes a load of both the final Path1 and Path2 listings, and thus adds to the run time  of  a  sync.
   Using --check-sync=false will disable it and may significantly reduce the sync run times for very large numbers of files.

   The check may be run manually with --check-sync=only.  It runs only the integrity check and terminates without actually synching.

Operation Runtime flow details

   bisync retains the listings of the Path1 and Path2 filesystems from the prior run.  On each successive run it will:

    list files on path1 and path2, and check for changes on each side.  Changes include New, Newer, Older, and Deleted files.

    Propagate changes on path1 to path2, and vice-versa.

Safety measures

    Lock file prevents multiple simultaneous runs when taking a while.  This can be particularly useful if bisync is run by cron scheduler.

    Handle change conflicts non-destructively by creating ..path1 and ..path2 file versions.

    File system access health check using RCLONE_TEST files (see the --check-access flag).

    Abort on excessive deletes - protects against a failed listing being interpreted as all the files were deleted.  See the --max-delete and --force flags.

    If something evil happens, bisync goes into a safe state to block damage by later runs.  (See Error Handling)

Normal sync checks

   Type       Description                     Result             Implementation
   
   Path2      File is new on  Path2,  does    Path2    version   rclone copy Path2
   new        not exist on Path1              survives           to Path1
   Path2      File is newer on Path2,  un    Path2    version   rclone copy Path2
   newer      changed on Path1                survives           to Path1
   Path2      File is  deleted  on  Path2,    File is deleted    rclone     delete
   deleted    unchanged on Path1                                 Path1
   Path1      File  is  new on Path1, does    Path1    version   rclone copy Path1
   new        not exist on Path2              survives           to Path2
   Path1      File  is newer on Path1, un    Path1    version   rclone copy Path1
   newer      changed on Path2                survives           to Path2
   Path1      File  is older on Path1, un    Path1    version   rclone copy Path1
   older      changed on Path2                survives           to Path2
   Path2      File  is older on Path2, un    Path2    version   rclone copy Path2
   older      changed on Path1                survives           to Path1
   Path1      File  no  longer  exists  on    File is deleted    rclone     delete
   deleted    Path1                                              Path2

Unusual sync checks

   Type                Description             Result                 Implementa
                                                                      tion
   

   Path1   new   AND   File  is new on Path1   Files  renamed   to    rclone  copy
   Path2 new           AND new on Path2        _Path1 and _Path2      _Path2  file
                                                                      to    Path1,
                                                                      rclone  copy
                                                                      _Path1  file
                                                                      to Path2
   Path2  newer  AND   File   is   newer  on   Files  renamed   to    rclone  copy
   Path1 changed       Path2    AND     also   _Path1 and _Path2      _Path2  file
                       changed   (newer/old                          to    Path1,
                       er/size) on Path1                              rclone  copy
                                                                      _Path1  file
                                                                      to Path2
   Path2  newer  AND   File   is   newer  on   Path2  version sur    rclone  copy
   Path1 deleted       Path2 AND also delet   vives                  Path2     to
                       ed on Path1                                    Path1
   Path2 deleted AND   File  is  deleted  on   Path1 version  sur    rclone  copy
   Path1 changed       Path2   AND   changed   vives                  Path1     to
                       (newer/older/size) on                          Path2
                       Path1
   Path1 deleted AND   File  is  deleted  on   Path2  version sur    rclone  copy
   Path2 changed       Path1   AND   changed   vives                  Path2     to
                       (newer/older/size) on                          Path1
                       Path2

All files changed check

   if all prior existing files on either of the filesystems have changed (e.g.  timestamps have changed due to changing the system's timezone) then bisync  will
   abort  without making any changes.  Any new files are not considered for this check.  You could use --force to force the sync (whichever side has the changed
   timestamp files wins).  Alternately, a --resync may be used (Path1 versions will be pushed to Path2).  Consider  the  situation  carefully  and  perhaps  use
   --dry-run before you commit to the changes.

Modification time

   Bisync relies on file timestamps to identify changed files and will refuse to operate if backend lacks the modification time support.

   If  you  or your application should change the content of a file without changing the modification time then bisync will not notice the change, and thus will
   not copy it to the other side.

   Note that on some cloud storage systems it is not possible to have file timestamps that match precisely between the local and other filesystems.

   Bisync's approach to this problem is by tracking the changes on each side separately over time with a local database of files in that side then applying  the
   resulting changes on the other side.

Error handling

   Certain  bisync critical errors, such as file copy/move failing, will result in a bisync lockout of following runs.  The lockout is asserted because the sync
   status and history of the Path1 and Path2 filesystems cannot be trusted, so it is safer to block any further changes until someone checks  things  out.   The
   recovery is to do a --resync again.

   It is recommended to use --resync --dry-run --verbose initially and carefully review what changes will be made before running the --resync without --dry-run.

   Most of these events come up due to a error status from an internal call.  On such a critical error the {...}.path1.lst and {...}.path2.lst listing files are
   renamed to extension .lst-err, which blocks any future bisync runs (since the normal .lst files are not found).  Bisync keeps them under bisync  subdirectory
   of the rclone cache directory, typically at ${HOME}/.cache/rclone/bisync/ on Linux.

   Some errors are considered temporary and re-running the bisync is not blocked.  The critical return blocks further bisync runs.

Lock file

   When  bisync  is  running,  a lock file is created in the bisync working directory, typically at ~/.cache/rclone/bisync/PATH1..PATH2.lck on Linux.  If bisync
   should crash or hang, the lock file will remain in place and block any further runs of bisync for the same paths.  Delete the lock file as part of  debugging
   the  situation.   The  lock  file effectively blocks follow-on (e.g., scheduled by cron) runs when the prior invocation is taking a long time.  The lock file
   contains PID of the blocking process, which may help in debug.

   Note that while concurrent bisync runs are allowed, be very cautious that there is no overlap in the trees being synched between concurrent runs, lest  there
   be replicated files, deleted files and general mayhem.

Return codes

   rclone  bisync  returns  the following codes to calling program: - 0 on a successful run, - 1 for a non-critical failing run (a rerun may be successful), - 2
   for a critically aborted run (requires a --resync to recover).

Limitations Supported backends

   Bisync is considered BETA and has been tested with the following backends: - Local filesystem - Google Drive - Dropbox - OneDrive - S3 - SFTP - Yandex Disk

   It has not been fully tested with other services yet.  If it works, or sorta works, please let us know and we'll update the list.   Run  the  test  suite  to
   check for proper operation as described below.

   First  release  of  rclone bisync requires that underlying backend supported the modification time feature and will refuse to run otherwise.  This limitation
   will be lifted in a future rclone bisync release.

Concurrent modifications

   When using Local, FTP or SFTP remotes rclone does not create temporary files at the destination when copying, and thus if the connection is lost the  created
   file  may  be  corrupt,  which will likely propagate back to the original path on the next sync, resulting in data loss.  This will be solved in a future re
   lease, there is no workaround at the moment.

   Files that change during a bisync run may result in data loss.  This has been seen in a highly dynamic environment, where the filesystem is getting  hammered
   by running processes during the sync.  The solution is to sync at quiet times or filter out unnecessary directories and files.

Empty directories

   New  empty  directories  on one path are not propagated to the other side.  This is because bisync (and rclone) natively works on files not directories.  The
   following sequence is a workaround but will not propagate the delete of an empty directory to the other side:

          rclone bisync PATH1 PATH2
          rclone copy PATH1 PATH2 --filter "+ */" --filter "- **" --create-empty-src-dirs
          rclone copy PATH2 PATH2 --filter "+ */" --filter "- **" --create-empty-src-dirs

Renamed directories

   Renaming a folder on the Path1 side results is deleting all files on the Path2 side and then copying all files again from Path1 to Path2.  Bisync  sees  this
   as  all files in the old directory name as deleted and all files in the new directory name as new.  Similarly, renaming a directory on both sides to the same
   name will result in creating ..path1 and ..path2 files on both sides.  Currently the most effective and efficient method of renaming a directory is to rename
   it on both sides, then do a --resync.

Case sensitivity

   Synching  with  case-insensitive  filesystems,  such as Windows or Box, can result in file name conflicts.  This will be fixed in a future release.  The near
   term workaround is to make sure that files on both sides don't have spelling case differences (Smile.jpg vs.  smile.jpg).

Windows support

   Bisync has been tested on Windows 8.1, Windows 10 Pro 64-bit and on Windows GitHub runners.

   Drive letters are allowed, including drive letters mapped to network drives (rclone bisync J:\localsync GDrive:).  If a drive letter is  omitted,  the  shell
   current drive is the default.  Drive letters are a single character follows by :, so cloud names must be more than one character long.

   Absolute paths (with or without a drive letter), and relative paths (with or without a drive letter) are supported.

   Working directory is created at C:\Users\MyLogin\AppData\Local\rclone\bisync.

   Note that bisync output may show a mix of forward / and back \ slashes.

   Be careful of case independent directory and file naming on Windows vs.  case dependent Linux

Filtering

   See filtering documentation (https://rclone.org/filtering/) for how filter rules are written and interpreted.

   Bisync's --filters-file flag slightly extends the rclone's --filter-from (https://rclone.org/filtering/#filter-from-read-filtering-patterns-from-a-file) fil‐
   tering mechanism.  For a given bisync run you may provide only one --filters-file.  The --include*, --exclude*, and --filter flags are also supported.

How to filter directories

   Filtering portions of the directory tree is a critical feature for synching.

   Examples of directory trees (always beneath the Path1/Path2 root level) you may want to exclude from your sync: - Directory trees  containing  only  software
   build intermediate files.  - Directory trees containing application temporary files and data such as the Windows C:\Users\MyLogin\AppData\ tree.  - Directory
   trees containing files that are large, less important, or are getting thrashed continuously by ongoing processes.

   On the other hand, there may be only select directories that you actually want to sync, and exclude all others.  See the Example  include-style  filters  for
   Windows user directories below.

Filters file writing guidelines

   1. Begin with excluding directory trees:

        e.g.  - /AppData/

        ** on the end is not necessary.  Once a given directory level is excluded then everything beneath it won't be looked at by rclone.

        Exclude such directories that are unneeded, are big, dynamically thrashed, or where there may be access permission issues.

        Excluding such dirs first will make rclone operations (much) faster.

        Specific files may also be excluded, as with the Dropbox exclusions example below.

   2. Decide if its easier (or cleaner) to:

        Include select directories and therefore exclude everything else -- or --

        Exclude select directories and therefore include everything else

   3. Include select directories:

        Add lines like: + /Documents/PersonalFiles/** to select which directories to include in the sync.

        ** on the end specifies to include the full depth of the specified tree.

        With Include-style filters, files at the Path1/Path2 root are not included.  They may be included with + /*.

        Place RCLONE_TEST files within these included directory trees.  They will only be looked for in these directory trees.

        Finish by excluding everything else by adding - ** at the end of the filters file.

        Disregard step 4.

   4. Exclude select directories:

        Add more lines like in step 1.  For example: -/Desktop/tempfiles/, or - /testdir/.  Again, a ** on the end is not necessary.

        Do not add a - ** in the file.  Without this line, everything will be included that has not be explicitly excluded.

        Disregard step 3.

   A few rules for the syntax of a filter file expanding on filtering documentation (https://rclone.org/filtering/):

    Lines may start with spaces and tabs - rclone strips leading whitespace.

    If the first non-whitespace character is a # then the line is a comment and will be ignored.

    Blank lines are ignored.

    The first non-whitespace character on a filter line must be a + or -.

    Exactly 1 space is allowed between the +/- and the path term.

    Only forward slashes (/) are used in path terms, even on Windows.

    The rest of the line is taken as the path term.  Trailing whitespace is taken literally, and probably is an error.

Example include-style filters for Windows user directories

   This  Windows  include-style example is based on the sync root (Path1) set to C:\Users\MyLogin.  The strategy is to select specific directories to be synched
   with a network drive (Path2).

    - /AppData/ excludes an entire tree of Windows stored stuff that need not be synched.  In my case, AppData has >11 GB of stuff  I  don't  care  about,  and
     there are some subdirectories beneath AppData that are not accessible to my user login, resulting in bisync critical aborts.

   • Windows creates cache files starting with both upper and lowercase NTUSER at C:\Users\MyLogin.  These files may be dynamic, locked, and are generally don't
     care.

    There are just a few directories with my data that I do want synched, in the form of + /<path>.  By selecting only the directory trees I want to avoid  the
     dozen plus directories that various apps make at C:\Users\MyLogin\Documents.

    Include files in the root of the sync point, C:\Users\MyLogin, by adding the + /* line.

    This is an Include-style filters file, therefore it ends with - ** which excludes everything not explicitly included.

     - /AppData/
     - NTUSER*
     - ntuser*
     + /Documents/Family/**
     + /Documents/Sketchup/**
     + /Documents/Microcapture_Photo/**
     + /Documents/Microcapture_Video/**
     + /Desktop/**
     + /Pictures/**
     + /*
     - **

   Note  also  that  Windows  implements several "library" links such as C:\Users\MyLogin\My Documents\My Music pointing to C:\Users\MyLogin\Music.  rclone sees
   these as links, so you must add --links to the bisync command line if you which to follow these links.  I find that I get permission errors in trying to fol
   low  the links, so I don't include the rclone --links flag, but then you get lots of Can't follow symlink... noise from rclone about not following the links.
   This noise can be quashed by adding --quiet to the bisync command line.

Example exclude-style filters files for use with Dropbox

    Dropbox disallows synching the listed temporary and configuration/data files.  The - <filename> filters exclude these files where ever they  may  occur  in
     the sync tree.  Consider adding similar exclusions for file types you don't need to sync, such as core dump and software build files.

   • bisync  testing  creates  /testdir/  at the top level of the sync tree, and usually deletes the tree after the test.  If a normal sync should run while the
     /testdir/ tree exists the --check-access phase may fail due to unbalanced RCLONE_TEST files.  The - /testdir/ filter blocks this tree from  being  synched.
     You don't need this exclusion if you are not doing bisync development testing.

    Everything else beneath the Path1/Path2 root will be synched.

    RCLONE_TEST files may be placed anywhere within the tree, including the root.

Example filters file for Dropbox

          # Filter file for use with bisync
          # See https://rclone.org/filtering/ for filtering rules
          # NOTICE: If you make changes to this file you MUST do a --resync run.
          #         Run with --dry-run to see what changes will be made.

          # Dropbox wont sync some files so filter them away here.
          # See https://help.dropbox.com/installs-integrations/sync-uploads/files-not-syncing
          - .dropbox.attr
          - ~*.tmp
          - ~$*
          - .~*
          - desktop.ini
          - .dropbox

          # Used for bisync testing, so excluded from normal runs
          - /testdir/

          # Other example filters
          #- /TiBU/
          #- /Photos/

How --check-access handles filters

   At  the  start of a bisync run, listings are gathered for Path1 and Path2 while using the user's --filters-file.  During the check access phase, bisync scans
   these listings for RCLONE_TEST files.  Any RCLONE_TEST files hidden by the --filters-file are not in the listings and thus not checked during the  check  ac
   cess phase.

Troubleshooting Reading bisync logs

   Here are two normal runs.  The first one has a newer file on the remote.  The second has no deltas between local and remote.

          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" with Path2 "dropbox:/"
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : - Path1    File is new                         - file.txt
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Path1:    1 changes:    1 new,    0 newer,    0 older,    0 deleted
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Applying changes
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - dropbox:/file.txt
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : - Path1    Do queued copies to                 - Path2
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Updating listings
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Validating listings for Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" vs Path2 "dropbox:/"
          2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Bisync successful

          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" with Path2 "dropbox:/"
          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : No changes found
          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Updating listings
          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Validating listings for Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" vs Path2 "dropbox:/"
          2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Bisync successful

Dry run oddity

   The --dry-run messages may indicate that it would try to delete some files.  For example, if a file is new on Path2 and does not exist on Path1 then it would
   normally be copied to Path1, but with --dry-run enabled those copies don't happen, which leads to the attempted delete on the Path2, blocked again by  --dry-
   run: ... Not deleting as --dry-run.

   This  whole  confusing situation is an artifact of the --dry-run flag.  Scrutinize the proposed deletes carefully, and if the files would have been copied to
   Path1 then the threatened deletes on Path2 may be disregarded.

Retries

   Rclone has built in retries.  If you run with --verbose you'll see error and retry messages such as shown below.  This is usually not a bug.  If at  the  end
   of the run you see Bisync successful and not Bisync critical error or Bisync aborted then the run was successful, and you can ignore the error messages.

   The  following run shows an intermittent fail.  Lines 5 and _6- are low level messages.  Line 6 is a bubbled-up warning message, conveying the error.  Rclone
   normally retries failing commands, so there may be numerous such messages in the log.

   Since there are no final error/warning messages on line 7, rclone has recovered from failure after a retry, and the overall sync was successful.

          1: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree" with Path2 "dropbox:"
          2: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
          3: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
          4: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Path2:  113 changes:   22 new,    0 newer,    0 older,   91 deleted
          5: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 ERROR : /path/to/local/tree/objects/af: error listing: unexpected end of JSON input
          6: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 NOTICE: WARNING  listing try 1 failed.                 - dropbox:
          7: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Bisync successful

   This log shows a Critical failure which requires a --resync to recover from.  See the Runtime Error Handling section.

          2021/05/12 00:49:40 INFO  : Google drive root '': Waiting for checks to finish
          2021/05/12 00:49:40 INFO  : Google drive root '': Waiting for transfers to finish
          2021/05/12 00:49:40 INFO  : Google drive root '': not deleting files as there were IO errors
          2021/05/12 00:49:40 ERROR : Attempt 3/3 failed with 3 errors and: not deleting files as there were IO errors
          2021/05/12 00:49:40 ERROR : Failed to sync: not deleting files as there were IO errors
          2021/05/12 00:49:40 NOTICE: WARNING  rclone sync try 3 failed.           - /path/to/local/tree/
          2021/05/12 00:49:40 ERROR : Bisync aborted. Must run --resync to recover.

Denied downloads of "infected" or "abusive" files

   Google Drive has a filter for certain file types (.exe, .apk, et cetera) that by default cannot be copied from Google Drive to the local filesystem.  If  you
   are  having problems, run with --verbose to see specifically which files are generating complaints.  If the error is This file has been identified as malware
   or spam and cannot be downloaded, consider using the flag --drive-acknowledge-abuse (https://rclone.org/drive/#drive-acknowledge-abuse).

Google Doc files

   Google docs exist as virtual files on Google Drive and cannot be transferred to other filesystems natively.  While it is possible to export a Google doc to a
   normal file (with .xlsx extension, for example), it is not possible to import a normal file back into a Google document.

   Bisync's  handling  of Google Doc files is to flag them in the run log output for user's attention and ignore them for any file transfers, deletes, or syncs.
   They will show up with a length of -1 in the listings.  This bisync run is otherwise successful:

          2021/05/11 08:23:15 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/base/" with Path2 "GDrive:"
          2021/05/11 08:23:15 INFO  : ...path2.lst-new: Ignoring incorrect line: "- -1 - - 2018-07-29T08:49:30.136000000+0000 GoogleDoc.docx"
          2021/05/11 08:23:15 INFO  : Bisync successful

Usage examples Cron

   Rclone does not yet have a built-in capability to monitor the local file system for changes and must be blindly run periodically.  On  Windows  this  can  be
   done using a Task Scheduler, on Linux you can use Cron which is described below.

   The 1st example runs a sync every 5 minutes between a local directory and an OwnCloud server, with output logged to a runlog file:

          # Minute (0-59)
          #      Hour (0-23)
          #           Day of Month (1-31)
          #                Month (1-12 or Jan-Dec)
          #                     Day of Week (0-6 or Sun-Sat)
          #                         Command
            */5  *    *    *    *   /path/to/rclone bisync /local/files MyCloud: --check-access --filters-file /path/to/bysync-filters.txt --log-file /path/to//bisync.log

   See crontab syntax (https://www.man7.org/linux/man-pages/man1/crontab.1p.html#INPUT_FILES)).  for the details of crontab time interval expressions.

   If you run rclone bisync as a cron job, redirect stdout/stderr to a file.  The 2nd example runs a sync to Dropbox every hour and logs all stdout (via the >>)
   and stderr (via 2>&1) to a log file.

          0 * * * * /path/to/rclone bisync /path/to/local/dropbox Dropbox: --check-access --filters-file /home/user/filters.txt >> /path/to/logs/dropbox-run.log 2>&1

Sharing an encrypted folder tree between hosts

   bisync can keep a local folder in sync with a cloud service, but what if you have some highly sensitive files to be synched?

   Usage of a cloud service is for exchanging both routine and sensitive personal files between one's home network, one's personal notebook when  on  the  road,
   and  with  one's  work computer.  The routine data is not sensitive.  For the sensitive data, configure an rclone crypt remote (https://rclone.org/crypt/) to
   point to a subdirectory within the local disk tree that is bisync'd to Dropbox, and then set up an bisync for this local crypt directory to a directory  out
   side of the main sync tree.

Linux server setup

    /path/to/DBoxroot is the root of my local sync tree.  There are numerous subdirectories.

    /path/to/DBoxroot/crypt  is  the  root  subdirectory  for  files  that are encrypted.  This local directory target is setup as an rclone crypt remote named
     Dropcrypt:.  See rclone.conf snippet below.

    /path/to/my/unencrypted/files is the root of my sensitive files - not encrypted, not within the tree synched to Dropbox.

    To sync my local unencrypted files with the encrypted Dropbox versions I manually run bisync /path/to/my/unencrypted/files DropCrypt:.  This step could  be
     bundled into a script to run before and after the full Dropbox tree sync in the last step, thus actively keeping the sensitive files in sync.

    bisync /path/to/DBoxroot Dropbox: runs periodically via cron, keeping my full local sync tree in sync with Dropbox.

Windows notebook setup

    The Dropbox client runs keeping the local tree C:\Users\MyLogin\Dropbox always in sync with Dropbox.  I could have used rclone bisync instead.

    A separate directory tree at C:\Users\MyLogin\Documents\DropLocal hosts the tree of unencrypted files/folders.

    To  sync  my  local  unencrypted  files  with  the  encrypted  Dropbox  versions I manually run the following command: rclone bisync C:\Users\MyLogin\Docu
     ments\DropLocal Dropcrypt:.

    The Dropbox client then syncs the changes with Dropbox.

rclone.conf snippet

          [Dropbox]
          type = dropbox
          ...

          [Dropcrypt]
          type = crypt
          remote = /path/to/DBoxroot/crypt          # on the Linux server
          remote = C:\Users\MyLogin\Dropbox\crypt   # on the Windows notebook
          filename_encryption = standard
          directory_name_encryption = true
          password = ...
          ...

Testing

   You should read this section only if you are developing for rclone.  You need to have rclone source code locally to work with bisync tests.

   Bisync has a dedicated test framework implemented in the bisync_test.go file located in the rclone source tree.  The test suite is based on the go test  com
   mand.   Series  of tests are stored in subdirectories below the cmd/bisync/testdata directory.  Individual tests can be invoked by their directory name, e.g.
   go test . -case basic -remote local -remote2 gdrive: -v

   Tests will make a temporary folder on remote and purge it afterwards.  If during test run there are intermittent errors and rclone retries, these errors will
   be captured and flagged as invalid MISCOMPAREs.  Rerunning the test will let it pass.  Consider such failures as noise.

Test command syntax

          usage: go test ./cmd/bisync [options...]

          Options:
            -case NAME        Name(s) of the test case(s) to run. Multiple names should
                              be separated by commas. You can remove the `test_` prefix
                              and replace `_` by `-` in test name for convenience.
                              If not `all`, the name(s) should map to a directory under
                              `./cmd/bisync/testdata`.
                              Use `all` to run all tests (default: all)
            -remote PATH1     `local` or name of cloud service with `:` (default: local)
            -remote2 PATH2    `local` or name of cloud service with `:` (default: local)
            -no-compare       Disable comparing test results with the golden directory
                              (default: compare)
            -no-cleanup       Disable cleanup of Path1 and Path2 testdirs.
                              Useful for troubleshooting. (default: cleanup)
            -golden           Store results in the golden directory (default: false)
                              This flag can be used with multiple tests.
            -debug            Print debug messages
            -stop-at NUM      Stop test after given step number. (default: run to the end)
                              Implies `-no-compare` and `-no-cleanup`, if the test really
                              ends prematurely. Only meaningful for a single test case.
            -refresh-times    Force refreshing the target modtime, useful for Dropbox
                              (default: false)
            -verbose          Run tests verbosely

   Note: unlike rclone flags which must be prefixed by double dash (--), the test command flags can be equally prefixed by a single - or double dash.

Running tests

    go test . -case basic -remote local -remote2 local runs the test_basic test case using only the local filesystem, synching one local directory with another
     local directory.  Test script output is to the console, while commands within scenario.txt have their output sent to the .../workdir/test.log  file,  which
     is finally compared to the golden copy.

    The first argument after go test should be a relative name of the directory containing bisync source code.  If you run tests right from there, the argument
     will be .  (current directory) as in most examples below.  If you run bisync tests from the  rclone  source  directory,  the  command  should  be  go  test
     ./cmd/bisync ....

    The test engine will mangle rclone output to ensure comparability with golden listings and logs.

    Test  scenarios  are  located  in ./cmd/bisync/testdata.  The test -case argument should match the full name of a subdirectory under that directory.  Every
     test subdirectory name on disk must start with test_, this prefix can be omitted on command line for brevity.  Also, underscores in the  name  can  be  re
     placed by dashes for convenience.

    go test . -remote local -remote2 local -case all runs all tests.

    Path1 and Path2 may either be the keyword local or may be names of configured cloud services.  go test . -remote gdrive: -remote2 dropbox: -case basic will
     run the test between these two services, without transferring any files to the local filesystem.

    Test run stdout and stderr console output may be directed to a file, e.g.  go test . -remote gdrive: -remote2 local -case all > runlog.txt 2>&1

Test execution flow

   1. The base setup in the initial directory of the testcase is applied on the Path1 and Path2 filesystems (via rclone copy the  initial  directory  to  Path1,
      then rclone sync Path1 to Path2).

   2. The  commands  in the scenario.txt file are applied, with output directed to the test.log file in the test working directory.  Typically, the first actual
      command in the scenario.txt file is to do a --resync, which establishes the baseline {...}.path1.lst and {...}.path2.lst files in the test working  direc
      tory (.../workdir/ relative to the temporary test directory).  Various commands and listing snapshots are done within the test.

   3. Finally, the contents of the test working directory are compared to the contents of the testcase's golden directory.

Notes about testing

    Test  cases are in individual directories beneath ./cmd/bisync/testdata.  A command line reference to a test is understood to reference a directory beneath
     testdata.  For example, go test ./cmd/bisync -case dry-run -remote gdrive: -remote2 local refers to the test case in ./cmd/bisync/testdata/test_dry_run.

    The test working directory is located at .../workdir relative to a temporary test directory, usually under /tmp on Linux.

    The local test sync tree is created at a temporary directory named like bisync.XXX under system temporary directory.

    The remote test sync tree is located at a temporary directory under <remote:>/bisync.XXX/.

    path1 and/or path2 subdirectories are created in a temporary directory under the respective local or cloud test remote.

    By default, the Path1 and Path2 test dirs and workdir will be deleted after each test run.  The -no-cleanup flag disables purging  these  directories  when
     validating and debugging a given test.  These directories will be flushed before running another test, independent of the -no-cleanup usage.

    You  will  likely  want to add - /testdir/ to your normal bisync --filters-file so that normal syncs do not attempt to sync the test temporary directories,
     which may have RCLONE_TEST miscompares in some testcases which would otherwise trip the --check-access system.  The --check-access mechanism is  hard-coded
     to  ignore  RCLONE_TEST files beneath bisync/testdata, so the test cases may reside on the synched tree even if there are check file mismatches in the test
     tree.

    Some Dropbox tests can fail, notably printing the following message: src and dst identical but can't set mod time without deleting and re-uploading This is
     expected and happens due a way Dropbox handles modification times.  You should use the -refresh-times test flag to make up for this.

    If  Dropbox  tests hit request limit for you and print error message too_many_requests/...: Too many requests or write operations.  then follow the Dropbox
     App ID instructions (https://rclone.org/dropbox/#get-your-own-dropbox-app-id).

Updating golden results

   Sometimes even a slight change in the bisync source can cause little changes spread around many log files.  Updating them manually would be a nightmare.

   The -golden flag will store the test.log and *.lst listings from each test case into respective golden directories.  Golden results will  automatically  con
   tain generic strings instead of local or cloud paths which means that they should match when run with a different cloud service.

   Your  normal  workflow might be as follows: 1.  Git-clone the rclone sources locally 2.  Modify bisync source and check that it builds 3.  Run the whole test
   suite go test ./cmd/bisync -remote local 4.  If some tests show log difference, recheck them individually, e.g.: go test ./cmd/bisync -remote local -case ba
   sic 5.  If you are convinced with the difference, goldenize all tests at once: go test ./cmd/bisync -remote local -golden 6.  Use word diff: git diff --word-
   diff ./cmd/bisync/testdata/.  Please note that normal line-level diff is generally useless here.  7.  Check the difference carefully!  8.  Commit the  change
   (git commit) only if you are sure.  If unsure, save your code changes then wipe the log diffs from git: git reset [--hard].

Structure of test scenarios

    <testname>/initial/ contains a tree of files that will be set as the initial condition on both Path1 and Path2 testdirs.

    <testname>/modfiles/ contains files that will be used to modify the Path1 and/or Path2 filesystems.

    <testname>/golden/ contains the expected content of the test working directory (workdir) at the completion of the testcase.

    <testname>/scenario.txt  contains  the  body  of the test, in the form of various commands to modify files, run bisync, and snapshot listings.  Output from
     these commands is captured to .../workdir/test.log for comparison to the golden files.

Supported test commands

    test <some message> Print the line to the console and to the test.log: test sync is working correctly with options x, y, z

    copy-listings <prefix> Save a copy of all .lst listings in the test working directory with the specified prefix: save-listings exclude-pass-run

    move-listings <prefix> Similar to copy-listings but removes the source

    purge-children <dir> This will delete all child files and purge all child subdirs under given directory but keep the parent intact.  This behavior  is  im
     portant for tests with Google Drive because removing and re-creating the parent would change its ID.

    delete-file <file> Delete a single file.

    delete-glob <dir> <pattern> Delete a group of files located one level deep in the given directory with names maching a given glob pattern.

    touch-glob YYYY-MM-DD <dir> <pattern> Change modification time on a group of files.

    touch-copy YYYY-MM-DD <source-file> <dest-dir> Change file modification time then copy it to destination.

    copy-file <source-file> <dest-dir> Copy a single file to given directory.

    copy-as <source-file> <dest-file> Similar to above but destination must include both directory and the new file name at destination.

    copy-dir <src> <dst> and sync-dir <src> <dst> Copy/sync a directory.  Equivalent of rclone copy and rclone sync.

    list-dirs <dir> Equivalent to rclone lsf -R --dirs-only <dir>

    bisync [options] Runs bisync against -remote and -remote2.

Supported substitution terms

    {testdir/} - the root dir of the testcase

    {datadir/} - the modfiles dir under the testcase root

    {workdir/} - the temporary test working directory

    {path1/} - the root of the Path1 test directory tree

    {path2/} - the root of the Path2 test directory tree

    {session} - base name of the test listings

    {/} - OS-specific path separator

    {spc}, {tab}, {eol} - whitespace

    {chr:HH} - raw byte with given hexadecimal code

   Substitution  results of the terms named like {dir/} will end with / (or backslash on Windows), so it is not necessary to include slash in the usage, for ex
   ample delete-file {path1/}file1.txt.

Benchmarks

   This section is work in progress.

   Here are a few data points for scale, execution times, and memory usage.

   The first set of data was taken between a local disk to Dropbox.  The speedtest.net (https://speedtest.net) download speed was ~170 Mbps,  and  upload  speed
   was ~10 Mbps.  500 files (~9.5 MB each) had been already synched.  50 files were added in a new directory, each ~9.5 MB, ~475 MB total.

   Change                     Operations and times                  Overall run
                                                                    time
   
   500 files synched (noth   1x listings for Path1 & Path2         1.5 sec
   ing to move)
   500  files  synched with   1x listings for Path1 & Path2         1.5 sec
   --check-access
   50 new files on remote     Queued 50 copies down: 27 sec         29 sec
   Moved local dir            Queued 50 copies up:  410  sec,  50   421 sec
                              deletes up: 9 sec
   Moved remote dir           Queued  50  copies down: 31 sec, 50   33 sec
                              deletes down: <1 sec
   Delete local dir           Queued 50 deletes up: 9 sec           13 sec

   This next data is from a user's application.  They had ~400GB of data over 1.96 million files being sync'ed between a Windows  local  disk  and  some  remote
   cloud.  The file full path length was on average 35 characters (which factors into load time and RAM required).

    Loading the prior listing into memory (1.96 million files, listing file size 140 MB) took ~30 sec and occupied about 1 GB of RAM.

    Getting a fresh listing of the local file system (producing the 140 MB output file) took about XXX sec.

    Getting  a  fresh  listing of the remote file system (producing the 140 MB output file) took about XXX sec.  The network download speed was measured at XXX
     Mb/s.

    Once the prior and current Path1 and Path2 listings were loaded (a total of four to be loaded, two at a time), determining the deltas was pretty  quick  (a
     few seconds for this test case), and the transfer time for any files to be copied was dominated by the network bandwidth.

References

   rclone's  bisync  implementation was derived from the rclonesync-V2 (https://github.com/cjnaz/rclonesync-V2) project, including documentation and test mecha‐
   nisms, with @cjnaz (https://github.com/cjnaz)'s full support and encouragement.

   rclone bisync is similar in nature to a range of other projects:

    unison (https://github.com/bcpierce00/unison)

    syncthing (https://github.com/syncthing/syncthing)

    cjnaz/rclonesync (https://github.com/cjnaz/rclonesync-V2)

    ConorWilliams/rsinc (https://github.com/ConorWilliams/rsinc)

    jwink3101/syncrclone (https://github.com/Jwink3101/syncrclone)

    DavideRossi/upback (https://github.com/DavideRossi/upback)

   Bisync adopts the differential synchronization technique, which is based on keeping history of changes performed by both synchronizing sides.  See  the  Dual
   Shadow Method section in the Neil Fraser's article (https://neil.fraser.name/writing/sync/).

   Also  note a number of academic publications by Benjamin Pierce (http://www.cis.upenn.edu/%7Ebcpierce/papers/index.shtml#File%20Synchronization) about Unison
   and synchronization in general.

1Fichier

   This is a backend for the 1fichier (https://1fichier.com) cloud storage service.  Note that a Premium subscription is required to use the API.

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for 1Fichier involves getting the API key from the website which you need to do in your browser.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / 1Fichier
             \ "fichier"
          [snip]
          Storage> fichier
          ** See help for fichier backend at: https://rclone.org/fichier/ **

          Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          api_key> example_key

          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = fichier
          api_key = example_key
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your 1Fichier account

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your 1Fichier account

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to a 1Fichier directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   1Fichier does not support modification times.  It supports the Whirlpool hash algorithm.

Duplicated files

   1Fichier can have two files with exactly the same name and path (unlike a normal file system).

   Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will see messages in the log about duplicates.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        
   "           0x22        
   $           0x24        
   `           0x60        
   '           0x27        '

   File names can also not start or end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   ────────────────────────────────
   SP          0x20         ␠

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to fichier (1Fichier).

--fichier-api-key

   Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl.

   Properties:

    Config: api_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_API_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to fichier (1Fichier).

--fichier-shared-folder

   If you want to download a shared folder, add this parameter.

   Properties:

    Config: shared_folder

    Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_SHARED_FOLDER

    Type: string

    Required: false

--fichier-file-password

   If you want to download a shared file that is password protected, add this parameter.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: file_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_FILE_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

--fichier-folder-password

   If you want to list the files in a shared folder that is password protected, add this parameter.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: folder_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_FOLDER_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

--fichier-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,SingleQuote,BackQuote,Dollar,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   rclone about is not supported by the 1Fichier backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or  use  policy  mfs
   (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Alias

   The alias remote provides a new name for another remote.

   Paths may be as deep as required or a local path, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory or /directory/subdirectory.

   During the initial setup with rclone config you will specify the target remote.  The target remote can either be a local path or another remote.

   Subfolders can be used in target remote.  Assume an alias remote named backup with the target mydrive:private/backup.  Invoking rclone  mkdir  backup:desktop
   is exactly the same as invoking rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/desktop.

   There will be no special handling of paths containing ..  segments.  Invoking rclone mkdir backup:../desktop is exactly the same as invoking rclone mkdir my
   drive:private/backup/../desktop.  The empty path is not allowed as a remote.  To alias the current directory use . instead.

   The target remote can also be a connection string (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings).  This can be used to modify the config of a remote for  dif‐
   ferent uses, e.g.  the alias myDriveTrash with the target remote myDrive,trashed_only: can be used to only show the trashed files in myDrive.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make an alias called remote for local folder.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Alias for an existing remote
             \ "alias"
          [snip]
          Storage> alias
          Remote or path to alias.
          Can be "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket", "myremote:" or "/local/path".
          remote> /mnt/storage/backup
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          remote = /mnt/storage/backup
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          remote               alias

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level in /mnt/storage/backup

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in /mnt/storage/backup

          rclone ls remote:

   Copy another local directory to the alias directory called source

          rclone copy /home/source remote:source

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to alias (Alias for an existing remote).

--alias-remote

   Remote or path to alias.

   Can be "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket", "myremote:" or "/local/path".

   Properties:

    Config: remote

    Env Var: RCLONE_ALIAS_REMOTE

    Type: string

    Required: true

Amazon Drive

   Amazon Drive, formerly known as Amazon Cloud Drive, is a cloud storage service run by Amazon for consumers.

Status

   Important:  rclone supports Amazon Drive only if you have your own set of API keys.  Unfortunately the Amazon Drive developer program (https://developer.ama
   zon.com/amazon-drive) is now closed to new entries so if you don't already have your own set of keys you will not be able to use rclone with Amazon Drive.

   For the history on why rclone no longer has a set of Amazon Drive API  keys  see  the  forum  (https://forum.rclone.org/t/rclone-has-been-banned-from-amazon-
   drive/2314).

   If you happen to know anyone who works at Amazon then please ask them to re-instate rclone into the Amazon Drive developer program - thanks!

Configuration

   The initial setup for Amazon Drive involves getting a token from Amazon which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   The configuration process for Amazon Drive may involve using an oauth proxy (https://github.com/ncw/oauthproxy).  This is used to keep the Amazon credentials
   out of the source code.  The proxy runs in Google's very secure App Engine environment and doesn't store any credentials which pass through it.

   Since rclone doesn't currently have its own Amazon Drive credentials so you will either need to have your own client_id and client_secret with Amazon  Drive,
   or use a third-party oauth proxy in which case you will need to enter client_id, client_secret, auth_url and token_url.

   Note  also  if  you are not using Amazon's auth_url and token_url, (ie you filled in something for those) then if setting up on a remote machine you can only
   use the copying the config method of configuration (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/#configuring-by-copying-the-config-file)  -  rclone  authorize  will  not
   work.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/r/c/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon Drive
             \ "amazon cloud drive"
          [snip]
          Storage> amazon cloud drive
          Amazon Application Client Id - required.
          client_id> your client ID goes here
          Amazon Application Client Secret - required.
          client_secret> your client secret goes here
          Auth server URL - leave blank to use Amazon's.
          auth_url> Optional auth URL
          Token server url - leave blank to use Amazon's.
          token_url> Optional token URL
          Remote config
          Make sure your Redirect URL is set to "http://127.0.0.1:53682/" in your custom config.
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          client_id = your client ID goes here
          client_secret = your client secret goes here
          auth_url = Optional auth URL
          token_url = Optional token URL
          token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"2015-09-06T16:07:39.658438471+01:00"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note  that  rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Amazon.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser
   to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you  are  run
   ning a host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Amazon Drive

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your Amazon Drive

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an Amazon Drive directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and MD5SUMs

   Amazon Drive doesn't allow modification times to be changed via the API so these won't be accurate or used for syncing.

   It does store MD5SUMs so for a more accurate sync, you can use the --checksum flag.

Restricted filename characters

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Deleting files

   Any files you delete with rclone will end up in the trash.  Amazon don't provide an API to permanently delete files, nor to empty the trash, so you will have
   to do that with one of Amazon's apps or via the Amazon Drive website.  As of November 17, 2016, files are automatically deleted by Amazon from the trash  af
   ter 30 days.

Using with non .com Amazon accounts

   Let's  say  you  usually  use amazon.co.uk.  When you authenticate with rclone it will take you to an amazon.com page to log in.  Your amazon.co.uk email and
   password should work here just fine.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to amazon cloud drive (Amazon Drive).

--acd-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--acd-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to amazon cloud drive (Amazon Drive).

--acd-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--acd-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--acd-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--acd-checkpoint

   Checkpoint for internal polling (debug).

   Properties:

    Config: checkpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CHECKPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--acd-upload-wait-per-gb

   Additional time per GiB to wait after a failed complete upload to see if it appears.

   Sometimes Amazon Drive gives an error when a file has been fully uploaded but the file appears anyway after a little while.  This happens sometimes for files
   over 1 GiB in size and nearly every time for files bigger than 10 GiB.  This parameter controls the time rclone waits for the file to appear.

   The default value for this parameter is 3 minutes per GiB, so by default it will wait 3 minutes for every GiB uploaded to see if the file appears.

   You  can  disable  this  feature by setting it to 0.  This may cause conflict errors as rclone retries the failed upload but the file will most likely appear
   correctly eventually.

   These values were determined empirically by observing lots of uploads of big files for a range of file sizes.

   Upload with the "-v" flag to see more info about what rclone is doing in this situation.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_wait_per_gb

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_UPLOAD_WAIT_PER_GB

    Type: Duration

    Default: 3m0s

--acd-templink-threshold

   Files >= this size will be downloaded via their tempLink.

   Files this size or more will be downloaded via their "tempLink".  This is to work around a problem with Amazon Drive which blocks downloads of  files  bigger
   than about 10 GiB.  The default for this is 9 GiB which shouldn't need to be changed.

   To  download  files above this threshold, rclone requests a "tempLink" which downloads the file through a temporary URL directly from the underlying S3 stor
   age.

   Properties:

    Config: templink_threshold

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TEMPLINK_THRESHOLD

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 9Gi

--acd-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that Amazon Drive is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   Amazon Drive has rate limiting so you may notice errors in the sync (429 errors).  rclone will automatically retry the sync up to 3  times  by  default  (see
   --retries flag) which should hopefully work around this problem.

   Amazon Drive has an internal limit of file sizes that can be uploaded to the service.  This limit is not officially published, but all files larger than this
   will fail.

   At the time of writing (Jan 2016) is in the area of 50 GiB per file.  This means that larger files are likely to fail.

   Unfortunately there is no way for rclone to see that this failure is because of file size, so it will retry the operation, as any other  failure.   To  avoid
   this problem, use --max-size 50000M option to limit the maximum size of uploaded files.  Note that --max-size does not split files into segments, it only ig
   nores files over this size.

   rclone about is not supported by the Amazon Drive backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount  or  use  policy
   mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Amazon S3 Storage Providers

   The S3 backend can be used with a number of different providers:

    AWS S3

    Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) Object Storage System (OSS)

    Ceph

    China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

    Cloudflare R2

    Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS)

    DigitalOcean Spaces

    Dreamhost

    Huawei OBS

    IBM COS S3

    IDrive e2

    IONOS Cloud

    Liara Object Storage

    Minio

    Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo)

    RackCorp Object Storage

    Scaleway

    Seagate Lyve Cloud

    SeaweedFS

    StackPath

    Storj

    Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)

    Wasabi

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

   Once you have made a remote (see the provider specific section above) you can use it like this:

   See all buckets

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new bucket

          rclone mkdir remote:bucket

   List the contents of a bucket

          rclone ls remote:bucket

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:bucket

Configuration

   Here is an example of making an s3 configuration for the AWS S3 provider.  Most applies to the other providers as well, any differences are described below.

   First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Liara, Minio, and Tencent COS
             \ "s3"
          [snip]
          Storage> s3
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
             \ "AWS"
           2 / Ceph Object Storage
             \ "Ceph"
           3 / DigitalOcean Spaces
             \ "DigitalOcean"
           4 / Dreamhost DreamObjects
             \ "Dreamhost"
           5 / IBM COS S3
             \ "IBMCOS"
           6 / Minio Object Storage
             \ "Minio"
           7 / Wasabi Object Storage
             \ "Wasabi"
           8 / Any other S3 compatible provider
             \ "Other"
          provider> 1
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          access_key_id> XXX
          AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          secret_access_key> YYY
          Region to connect to.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
             / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
           1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
             | Leave location constraint empty.
             \ "us-east-1"
             / US East (Ohio) Region
           2 | Needs location constraint us-east-2.
             \ "us-east-2"
             / US West (Oregon) Region
           3 | Needs location constraint us-west-2.
             \ "us-west-2"
             / US West (Northern California) Region
           4 | Needs location constraint us-west-1.
             \ "us-west-1"
             / Canada (Central) Region
           5 | Needs location constraint ca-central-1.
             \ "ca-central-1"
             / EU (Ireland) Region
           6 | Needs location constraint EU or eu-west-1.
             \ "eu-west-1"
             / EU (London) Region
           7 | Needs location constraint eu-west-2.
             \ "eu-west-2"
             / EU (Frankfurt) Region
           8 | Needs location constraint eu-central-1.
             \ "eu-central-1"
             / Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region
           9 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.
             \ "ap-southeast-1"
             / Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region
          10 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-2.
             \ "ap-southeast-2"
             / Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region
          11 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.
             \ "ap-northeast-1"
             / Asia Pacific (Seoul)
          12 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-2.
             \ "ap-northeast-2"
             / Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
          13 | Needs location constraint ap-south-1.
             \ "ap-south-1"
             / Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region
          14 | Needs location constraint ap-east-1.
             \ "ap-east-1"
             / South America (Sao Paulo) Region
          15 | Needs location constraint sa-east-1.
             \ "sa-east-1"
          region> 1
          Endpoint for S3 API.
          Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.
          endpoint>
          Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
             \ ""
           2 / US East (Ohio) Region.
             \ "us-east-2"
           3 / US West (Oregon) Region.
             \ "us-west-2"
           4 / US West (Northern California) Region.
             \ "us-west-1"
           5 / Canada (Central) Region.
             \ "ca-central-1"
           6 / EU (Ireland) Region.
             \ "eu-west-1"
           7 / EU (London) Region.
             \ "eu-west-2"
           8 / EU Region.
             \ "EU"
           9 / Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region.
             \ "ap-southeast-1"
          10 / Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region.
             \ "ap-southeast-2"
          11 / Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region.
             \ "ap-northeast-1"
          12 / Asia Pacific (Seoul)
             \ "ap-northeast-2"
          13 / Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
             \ "ap-south-1"
          14 / Asia Pacific (Hong Kong)
             \ "ap-east-1"
          15 / South America (Sao Paulo) Region.
             \ "sa-east-1"
          location_constraint> 1
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
             \ "private"
           2 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
             \ "public-read"
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
           3 | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
             \ "public-read-write"
           4 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
             \ "authenticated-read"
             / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL. Bucket owner gets READ access.
           5 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
             \ "bucket-owner-read"
             / Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.
           6 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
             \ "bucket-owner-full-control"
          acl> 1
          The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / None
             \ ""
           2 / AES256
             \ "AES256"
          server_side_encryption> 1
          The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
           2 / Standard storage class
             \ "STANDARD"
           3 / Reduced redundancy storage class
             \ "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
           4 / Standard Infrequent Access storage class
             \ "STANDARD_IA"
           5 / One Zone Infrequent Access storage class
             \ "ONEZONE_IA"
           6 / Glacier storage class
             \ "GLACIER"
           7 / Glacier Deep Archive storage class
             \ "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
           8 / Intelligent-Tiering storage class
             \ "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
           9 / Glacier Instant Retrieval storage class
             \ "GLACIER_IR"
          storage_class> 1
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = s3
          provider = AWS
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = XXX
          secret_access_key = YYY
          region = us-east-1
          endpoint =
          location_constraint =
          acl = private
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d>

Modified time

   The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as X-Amz-Meta-Mtime as floating point since the epoch, accurate to 1 ns.

   If the modification time needs to be updated rclone will attempt to perform a server side copy to update the modification if the object can be  copied  in  a
   single part.  In the case the object is larger than 5Gb or is in Glacier or Glacier Deep Archive storage the object will be uploaded rather than copied.

   Note that reading this from the object takes an additional HEAD request as the metadata isn't returned in object listings.

Reducing costs Avoiding HEAD requests to read the modification time

   By  default, rclone will use the modification time of objects stored in S3 for syncing.  This is stored in object metadata which unfortunately takes an extra
   HEAD request to read which can be expensive (in time and money).

   The modification time is used by default for all operations that require checking the time a file was last updated.  It allows rclone  to  treat  the  remote
   more like a true filesystem, but it is inefficient on S3 because it requires an extra API call to retrieve the metadata.

   The extra API calls can be avoided when syncing (using rclone sync or rclone copy) in a few different ways, each with its own tradeoffs.

    --size-only

      Only checks the size of files.

      Uses no extra transactions.

      If the file doesn't change size then rclone won't detect it has changed.

      rclone sync --size-only /path/to/source s3:bucket

    --checksum

      Checks the size and MD5 checksum of files.

      Uses no extra transactions.

      The most accurate detection of changes possible.

      Will cause the source to read an MD5 checksum which, if it is a local disk, will cause lots of disk activity.

      If the source and destination are both S3 this is the recommended flag to use for maximum efficiency.

      rclone sync --checksum /path/to/source s3:bucket

    --update --use-server-modtime

      Uses no extra transactions.

      Modification time becomes the time the object was uploaded.

      For many operations this is sufficient to determine if it needs uploading.

      Using  --update  along with --use-server-modtime, avoids the extra API call and uploads files whose local modification time is newer than the time it was
       last uploaded.

      Files created with timestamps in the past will be missed by the sync.

      rclone sync --update --use-server-modtime /path/to/source s3:bucket

   These flags can and should be used in combination with --fast-list - see below.

   If using rclone mount or any command using the VFS (eg rclone serve) commands then you might want to consider using the VFS flag --no-modtime which will stop
   rclone  reading  the modification time for every object.  You could also use --use-server-modtime if you are happy with the modification times of the objects
   being the time of upload.

Avoiding GET requests to read directory listings

   Rclone's default directory traversal is to process each directory individually.  This takes one API call per directory.  Using the --fast-list flag will read
   all info about the objects into memory first using a smaller number of API calls (one per 1000 objects).  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

          rclone sync --fast-list --checksum /path/to/source s3:bucket

   --fast-list trades off API transactions for memory use.  As a rough guide rclone uses 1k of memory per object stored, so using --fast-list on  a  sync  of  a
   million objects will use roughly 1 GiB of RAM.

   If  you  are  only  copying  a  small  number of files into a big repository then using --no-traverse is a good idea.  This finds objects directly instead of
   through directory listings.  You can do a "top-up" sync very cheaply by using --max-age and --no-traverse to copy only recent files, eg

          rclone copy --max-age 24h --no-traverse /path/to/source s3:bucket

   You'd then do a full rclone sync less often.

   Note that --fast-list isn't required in the top-up sync.

Avoiding HEAD requests after PUT

   By default, rclone will HEAD every object it uploads.  It does this to check the object got uploaded correctly.

   You can disable this with the --s3-no-head option - see there for more details.

   Setting this flag increases the chance for undetected upload failures.

Hashes

   For small objects which weren't uploaded as multipart uploads (objects sized below --s3-upload-cutoff if uploaded with rclone) rclone uses the  ETag:  header
   as an MD5 checksum.

   However  for  objects  which were uploaded as multipart uploads or with server side encryption (SSE-AWS or SSE-C) the ETag header is no longer the MD5 sum of
   the data, so rclone adds an additional piece of metadata X-Amz-Meta-Md5chksum which is a base64 encoded MD5 hash (in the same format as is required for  Con‐
   tent-MD5).

   For  large  objects,  calculating  this hash can take some time so the addition of this hash can be disabled with --s3-disable-checksum.  This will mean that
   these objects do not have an MD5 checksum.

   Note that reading this from the object takes an additional HEAD request as the metadata isn't returned in object listings.

Versions

   When bucket versioning is enabled (this can be done with rclone with the rclone backend versioning command) when rclone uploads a new version of  a  file  it
   creates  a new version of it (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/userguide/Versioning.html) Likewise when you delete a file, the old version will be
   marked hidden and still be available.

   Old versions of files, where available, are visible using the --s3-versions flag.

   It is also possible to view a bucket as it was at a certain point in time, using the --s3-version-at flag.  This will show the file versions as they were  at
   that time, showing files that have been deleted afterwards, and hiding files that were created since.

   If you wish to remove all the old versions then you can use the rclone backend cleanup-hidden remote:bucket command which will delete all the old hidden ver
   sions of files, leaving the current ones intact.  You can also supply a path and only old versions under that path will  be  deleted,  e.g.   rclone  backend
   cleanup-hidden remote:bucket/path/to/stuff.

   When you purge a bucket, the current and the old versions will be deleted then the bucket will be deleted.

   However delete will cause the current versions of the files to become hidden old versions.

   Here is a session showing the listing and retrieval of an old version followed by a cleanup of the old versions.

   Show current version and all the versions with --s3-versions flag.

          $ rclone -q ls s3:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

          $ rclone -q --s3-versions ls s3:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt
                  8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
                 16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
                 15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

   Retrieve an old version

          $ rclone -q --s3-versions copy s3:cleanup-test/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt /tmp

          $ ls -l /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
          -rw-rw-r-- 1 ncw ncw 16 Jul  2 17:46 /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt

   Clean up all the old versions and show that they've gone.

          $ rclone -q backend cleanup-hidden s3:cleanup-test

          $ rclone -q ls s3:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

          $ rclone -q --s3-versions ls s3:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

Cleanup

   If you run rclone cleanup s3:bucket then it will remove all pending multipart uploads older than 24 hours.  You can use the --interactive/i or --dry-run flag
   to see exactly what it will do.  If you want more control over the expiry date then run rclone backend cleanup s3:bucket -o max-age=1h to expire all  uploads
   older than one hour.  You can use rclone backend list-multipart-uploads s3:bucket to see the pending multipart uploads.

Restricted filename characters

   S3 allows any valid UTF-8 string as a key.

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in XML.

   The following characters are replaced since these are problematic when dealing with the REST API:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        

   The encoding will also encode these file names as they don't seem to work with the SDK properly:

   File name   Replacement
   
   .               
   ..             

Multipart uploads

   rclone supports multipart uploads with S3 which means that it can upload files bigger than 5 GiB.

   Note that files uploaded both with multipart upload and through crypt remotes do not have MD5 sums.

   rclone  switches from single part uploads to multipart uploads at the point specified by --s3-upload-cutoff.  This can be a maximum of 5 GiB and a minimum of
   0 (ie always upload multipart files).

   The chunk sizes used in the multipart upload are specified by --s3-chunk-size and the number of chunks uploaded concurrently is specified by --s3-upload-con
   currency.

   Multipart uploads will use --transfers * --s3-upload-concurrency * --s3-chunk-size extra memory.  Single part uploads to not use extra memory.

   Single  part  transfers  can  be  faster than multipart transfers or slower depending on your latency from S3 - the more latency, the more likely single part
   transfers will be faster.

   Increasing --s3-upload-concurrency will increase throughput (8 would be a sensible value) and increasing --s3-chunk-size also increases throughput (16M would
   be  sensible).   Increasing  either of these will use more memory.  The default values are high enough to gain most of the possible performance without using
   too much memory.

Buckets and Regions

   With Amazon S3 you can list buckets (rclone lsd) using any region, but you can only access the content of a bucket from the region it was created in.  If you
   attempt to access a bucket from the wrong region, you will get an error, incorrect region, the bucket is not in 'XXX' region.

Authentication

   There are a number of ways to supply rclone with a set of AWS credentials, with and without using the environment.

   The different authentication methods are tried in this order:

    Directly in the rclone configuration file (env_auth = false in the config file):

      access_key_id and secret_access_key are required.

      session_token can be optionally set when using AWS STS.

    Runtime configuration (env_auth = true in the config file):

      Export the following environment variables before running rclone:

        Access Key ID: AWS_ACCESS_KEY_ID or AWS_ACCESS_KEY

        Secret Access Key: AWS_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY or AWS_SECRET_KEY

        Session Token: AWS_SESSION_TOKEN (optional)

      Or, use a named profile (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/cli/latest/userguide/cli-multiple-profiles.html):

        Profile files are standard files used by AWS CLI tools

        By  default  it  will use the profile in your home directory (e.g.  ~/.aws/credentials on unix based systems) file and the "default" profile, to change
         set these environment variables:

          AWS_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE to control which file.

          AWS_PROFILE to control which profile to use.

      Or, run rclone in an ECS task with an IAM role (AWS only).

      Or, run rclone on an EC2 instance with an IAM role (AWS only).

      Or, run rclone in an EKS pod with an IAM role that is associated with a service account (AWS only).

   If none of these option actually end up providing rclone with AWS credentials then S3 interaction will be non-authenticated (see below).

S3 Permissions

   When using the sync subcommand of rclone the following minimum permissions are required to be available on the bucket being written to:

    ListBucket

    DeleteObject

    GetObject

    PutObject

    PutObjectACL

   When using the lsd subcommand, the ListAllMyBuckets permission is required.

   Example policy:

          {
              "Version": "2012-10-17",
              "Statement": [
                  {
                      "Effect": "Allow",
                      "Principal": {
                          "AWS": "arn:aws:iam::USER_SID:user/USER_NAME"
                      },
                      "Action": [
                          "s3:ListBucket",
                          "s3:DeleteObject",
                          "s3:GetObject",
                          "s3:PutObject",
                          "s3:PutObjectAcl"
                      ],
                      "Resource": [
                        "arn:aws:s3:::BUCKET_NAME/*",
                        "arn:aws:s3:::BUCKET_NAME"
                      ]
                  },
                  {
                      "Effect": "Allow",
                      "Action": "s3:ListAllMyBuckets",
                      "Resource": "arn:aws:s3:::*"
                  }
              ]
          }

   Notes on above:

   1. This is a policy that can be used when creating bucket.  It assumes that USER_NAME has been created.

   2. The Resource entry must include both resource ARNs, as one implies the bucket and the other implies the bucket's objects.

   For reference, here's an Ansible script (https://gist.github.com/ebridges/ebfc9042dd7c756cd101cfa807b7ae2b) that will generate one or more buckets that  will
   work with rclone sync.

Key Management System (KMS)

   If  you  are using server-side encryption with KMS then you must make sure rclone is configured with server_side_encryption = aws:kms otherwise you will find
   you can't transfer small objects - these will create checksum errors.

Glacier and Glacier Deep Archive

   You can upload objects using the glacier storage class or transition them to glacier using a lifecycle policy (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/us
   er-guide/create-lifecycle.html).   The  bucket can still be synced or copied into normally, but if rclone tries to access data from the glacier storage class
   you will see an error like below.

          2017/09/11 19:07:43 Failed to sync: failed to open source object: Object in GLACIER, restore first: path/to/file

   In this case you need to restore (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/user-guide/restore-archived-objects.html) the object(s) in question before using
   rclone.

   Note that rclone only speaks the S3 API it does not speak the Glacier Vault API, so rclone cannot directly access Glacier Vaults.

Object-lock enabled S3 bucket

   According to AWS's documentation on S3 Object Lock (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/userguide/object-lock-overview.html#object-lock-permission):

          If you configure a default retention period on a bucket, requests to upload objects in such a bucket must include the Content-MD5 header.

   As mentioned in the Hashes section, small files that are not uploaded as multipart, use a different tag, causing the upload to fail.  A simple solution is to
   set the --s3-upload-cutoff 0 and force all the files to be uploaded as multipart.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to s3 (Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digi
   talOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, IONOS Cloud, Liara, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent
   COS, Qiniu and Wasabi).

--s3-provider

   Choose your S3 provider.

   Properties:

    Config: provider

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_PROVIDER

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "AWS"

        Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3

      "Alibaba"

        Alibaba Cloud Object Storage System (OSS) formerly Aliyun

      "Ceph"

        Ceph Object Storage

      "ChinaMobile"

        China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

      "Cloudflare"

        Cloudflare R2 Storage

      "ArvanCloud"

        Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS)

      "DigitalOcean"

        DigitalOcean Spaces

      "Dreamhost"

        Dreamhost DreamObjects

      "HuaweiOBS"

        Huawei Object Storage Service

      "IBMCOS"

        IBM COS S3

      "IDrive"

        IDrive e2

      "IONOS"

        IONOS Cloud

      "LyveCloud"

        Seagate Lyve Cloud

      "Liara"

        Liara Object Storage

      "Minio"

        Minio Object Storage

      "Netease"

        Netease Object Storage (NOS)

      "RackCorp"

        RackCorp Object Storage

      "Scaleway"

        Scaleway Object Storage

      "SeaweedFS"

        SeaweedFS S3

      "StackPath"

        StackPath Object Storage

      "Storj"

        Storj (S3 Compatible Gateway)

      "TencentCOS"

        Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)

      "Wasabi"

        Wasabi Object Storage

      "Qiniu"

        Qiniu Object Storage (Kodo)

      "Other"

        Any other S3 compatible provider

--s3-env-auth

   Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).

   Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.

   Properties:

    Config: env_auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENV_AUTH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "false"

        Enter AWS credentials in the next step.

      "true"

        Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).

--s3-access-key-id

   AWS Access Key ID.

   Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

   Properties:

    Config: access_key_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ACCESS_KEY_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-secret-access-key

   AWS Secret Access Key (password).

   Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

   Properties:

    Config: secret_access_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-region

   Region to connect to.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: AWS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "us-east-1"

        The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

        US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.

        Leave location constraint empty.

      "us-east-2"

        US East (Ohio) Region.

        Needs location constraint us-east-2.

      "us-west-1"

        US West (Northern California) Region.

        Needs location constraint us-west-1.

      "us-west-2"

        US West (Oregon) Region.

        Needs location constraint us-west-2.

      "ca-central-1"

        Canada (Central) Region.

        Needs location constraint ca-central-1.

      "eu-west-1"

        EU (Ireland) Region.

        Needs location constraint EU or eu-west-1.

      "eu-west-2"

        EU (London) Region.

        Needs location constraint eu-west-2.

      "eu-west-3"

        EU (Paris) Region.

        Needs location constraint eu-west-3.

      "eu-north-1"

        EU (Stockholm) Region.

        Needs location constraint eu-north-1.

      "eu-south-1"

        EU (Milan) Region.

        Needs location constraint eu-south-1.

      "eu-central-1"

        EU (Frankfurt) Region.

        Needs location constraint eu-central-1.

      "ap-southeast-1"

        Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region.

        Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.

      "ap-southeast-2"

        Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region.

        Needs location constraint ap-southeast-2.

      "ap-northeast-1"

        Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region.

        Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.

      "ap-northeast-2"

        Asia Pacific (Seoul).

        Needs location constraint ap-northeast-2.

      "ap-northeast-3"

        Asia Pacific (Osaka-Local).

        Needs location constraint ap-northeast-3.

      "ap-south-1"

        Asia Pacific (Mumbai).

        Needs location constraint ap-south-1.

      "ap-east-1"

        Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region.

        Needs location constraint ap-east-1.

      "sa-east-1"

        South America (Sao Paulo) Region.

        Needs location constraint sa-east-1.

      "me-south-1"

        Middle East (Bahrain) Region.

        Needs location constraint me-south-1.

      "af-south-1"

        Africa (Cape Town) Region.

        Needs location constraint af-south-1.

      "cn-north-1"

        China (Beijing) Region.

        Needs location constraint cn-north-1.

      "cn-northwest-1"

        China (Ningxia) Region.

        Needs location constraint cn-northwest-1.

      "us-gov-east-1"

        AWS GovCloud (US-East) Region.

        Needs location constraint us-gov-east-1.

      "us-gov-west-1"

        AWS GovCloud (US) Region.

        Needs location constraint us-gov-west-1.

--s3-region

   region - the location where your bucket will be created and your data stored.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: RackCorp

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "global"

        Global CDN (All locations) Region

      "au"

        Australia (All states)

      "au-nsw"

        NSW (Australia) Region

      "au-qld"

        QLD (Australia) Region

      "au-vic"

        VIC (Australia) Region

      "au-wa"

        Perth (Australia) Region

      "ph"

        Manila (Philippines) Region

      "th"

        Bangkok (Thailand) Region

      "hk"

        HK (Hong Kong) Region

      "mn"

        Ulaanbaatar (Mongolia) Region

      "kg"

        Bishkek (Kyrgyzstan) Region

      "id"

        Jakarta (Indonesia) Region

      "jp"

        Tokyo (Japan) Region

      "sg"

        SG (Singapore) Region

      "de"

        Frankfurt (Germany) Region

      "us"

        USA (AnyCast) Region

      "us-east-1"

        New York (USA) Region

      "us-west-1"

        Freemont (USA) Region

      "nz"

        Auckland (New Zealand) Region

--s3-region

   Region to connect to.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: Scaleway

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "nl-ams"

        Amsterdam, The Netherlands

      "fr-par"

        Paris, France

      "pl-waw"

        Warsaw, Poland

--s3-region

   Region to connect to.  - the location where your bucket will be created and your data stored.  Need bo be same with your endpoint.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: HuaweiOBS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "af-south-1"

        AF-Johannesburg

      "ap-southeast-2"

        AP-Bangkok

      "ap-southeast-3"

        AP-Singapore

      "cn-east-3"

        CN East-Shanghai1

      "cn-east-2"

        CN East-Shanghai2

      "cn-north-1"

        CN North-Beijing1

      "cn-north-4"

        CN North-Beijing4

      "cn-south-1"

        CN South-Guangzhou

      "ap-southeast-1"

        CN-Hong Kong

      "sa-argentina-1"

        LA-Buenos Aires1

      "sa-peru-1"

        LA-Lima1

      "na-mexico-1"

        LA-Mexico City1

      "sa-chile-1"

        LA-Santiago2

      "sa-brazil-1"

        LA-Sao Paulo1

      "ru-northwest-2"

        RU-Moscow2

--s3-region

   Region to connect to.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: Cloudflare

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "auto"

        R2 buckets are automatically distributed across Cloudflare's data centers for low latency.

--s3-region

   Region to connect to.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: Qiniu

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "cn-east-1"

        The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

        East China Region 1.

        Needs location constraint cn-east-1.

      "cn-east-2"

        East China Region 2.

        Needs location constraint cn-east-2.

      "cn-north-1"

        North China Region 1.

        Needs location constraint cn-north-1.

      "cn-south-1"

        South China Region 1.

        Needs location constraint cn-south-1.

      "us-north-1"

        North America Region.

        Needs location constraint us-north-1.

      "ap-southeast-1"

        Southeast Asia Region 1.

        Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.

      "ap-northeast-1"

        Northeast Asia Region 1.

        Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.

--s3-region

   Region where your bucket will be created and your data stored.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

    Provider: IONOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "de"

        Frankfurt, Germany

      "eu-central-2"

        Berlin, Germany

      "eu-south-2"

        Logrono, Spain

--s3-region

   Region to connect to.

   Leave blank if you are using an S3 clone and you don't have a region.

   Properties:

   • Config: region

   • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

   • Provider: !AWS,Alibaba,ChinaMobile,Cloudflare,IONOS,ArvanCloud,Liara,Qiniu,RackCorp,Scaleway,Storj,TencentCOS,HuaweiOBS,IDrive

   • Type: string

   • Required: false

   • Examples:

     • ""

       • Use this if unsure.

       • Will use v4 signatures and an empty region.

     • "other-v2-signature"

       • Use this only if v4 signatures don't work.

        E.g.  pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for S3 API.

   Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: AWS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS) API.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: ChinaMobile

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "eos-wuxi-1.cmecloud.cn"

        The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

        East China (Suzhou)

      "eos-jinan-1.cmecloud.cn"

        East China (Jinan)

      "eos-ningbo-1.cmecloud.cn"

        East China (Hangzhou)

      "eos-shanghai-1.cmecloud.cn"

        East China (Shanghai-1)

      "eos-zhengzhou-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Central China (Zhengzhou)

      "eos-hunan-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Central China (Changsha-1)

      "eos-zhuzhou-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Central China (Changsha-2)

      "eos-guangzhou-1.cmecloud.cn"

        South China (Guangzhou-2)

      "eos-dongguan-1.cmecloud.cn"

        South China (Guangzhou-3)

      "eos-beijing-1.cmecloud.cn"

        North China (Beijing-1)

      "eos-beijing-2.cmecloud.cn"

        North China (Beijing-2)

      "eos-beijing-4.cmecloud.cn"

        North China (Beijing-3)

      "eos-huhehaote-1.cmecloud.cn"

        North China (Huhehaote)

      "eos-chengdu-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Southwest China (Chengdu)

      "eos-chongqing-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Southwest China (Chongqing)

      "eos-guiyang-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Southwest China (Guiyang)

      "eos-xian-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Nouthwest China (Xian)

      "eos-yunnan.cmecloud.cn"

        Yunnan China (Kunming)

      "eos-yunnan-2.cmecloud.cn"

        Yunnan China (Kunming-2)

      "eos-tianjin-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Tianjin China (Tianjin)

      "eos-jilin-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Jilin China (Changchun)

      "eos-hubei-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Hubei China (Xiangyan)

      "eos-jiangxi-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Jiangxi China (Nanchang)

      "eos-gansu-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Gansu China (Lanzhou)

      "eos-shanxi-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Shanxi China (Taiyuan)

      "eos-liaoning-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Liaoning China (Shenyang)

      "eos-hebei-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)

      "eos-fujian-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Fujian China (Xiamen)

      "eos-guangxi-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Guangxi China (Nanning)

      "eos-anhui-1.cmecloud.cn"

        Anhui China (Huainan)

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS) API.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: ArvanCloud

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3.ir-thr-at1.arvanstorage.com"

        The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

        Tehran Iran (Asiatech)

      "s3.ir-tbz-sh1.arvanstorage.com"

        Tabriz Iran (Shahriar)

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for IBM COS S3 API.

   Specify if using an IBM COS On Premise.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: IBMCOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region Endpoint

      "s3.dal.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region Dallas Endpoint

      "s3.wdc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region Washington DC Endpoint

      "s3.sjc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region San Jose Endpoint

      "s3.private.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.dal.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region Dallas Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.wdc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region Washington DC Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.sjc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Cross Region San Jose Private Endpoint

      "s3.us-east.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Region East Endpoint

      "s3.private.us-east.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Region East Private Endpoint

      "s3.us-south.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Region South Endpoint

      "s3.private.us-south.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        US Region South Private Endpoint

      "s3.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Endpoint

      "s3.fra.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Frankfurt Endpoint

      "s3.mil.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Milan Endpoint

      "s3.ams.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Amsterdam Endpoint

      "s3.private.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.fra.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Frankfurt Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.mil.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Milan Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.ams.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Cross Region Amsterdam Private Endpoint

      "s3.eu-gb.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Great Britain Endpoint

      "s3.private.eu-gb.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Great Britain Private Endpoint

      "s3.eu-de.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Region DE Endpoint

      "s3.private.eu-de.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        EU Region DE Private Endpoint

      "s3.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional Endpoint

      "s3.tok.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional Tokyo Endpoint

      "s3.hkg.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional HongKong Endpoint

      "s3.seo.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional Seoul Endpoint

      "s3.private.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.tok.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional Tokyo Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.hkg.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional HongKong Private Endpoint

      "s3.private.seo.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Cross Regional Seoul Private Endpoint

      "s3.jp-tok.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Region Japan Endpoint

      "s3.private.jp-tok.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Region Japan Private Endpoint

      "s3.au-syd.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Region Australia Endpoint

      "s3.private.au-syd.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        APAC Region Australia Private Endpoint

      "s3.ams03.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Amsterdam Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.ams03.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Amsterdam Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.che01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Chennai Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.che01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Chennai Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.mel01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Melbourne Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.mel01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Melbourne Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.osl01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Oslo Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.osl01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Oslo Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.tor01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Toronto Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.tor01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Toronto Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.seo01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Seoul Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.seo01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Seoul Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.mon01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Montreal Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.mon01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Montreal Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.mex01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Mexico Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.mex01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Mexico Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.sjc04.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        San Jose Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.sjc04.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        San Jose Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.mil01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Milan Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.mil01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Milan Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.hkg02.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Hong Kong Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.hkg02.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Hong Kong Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.par01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Paris Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.par01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Paris Single Site Private Endpoint

      "s3.sng01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Singapore Single Site Endpoint

      "s3.private.sng01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"

        Singapore Single Site Private Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for IONOS S3 Object Storage.

   Specify the endpoint from the same region.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: IONOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3-eu-central-1.ionoscloud.com"

        Frankfurt, Germany

      "s3-eu-central-2.ionoscloud.com"

        Berlin, Germany

      "s3-eu-south-2.ionoscloud.com"

        Logrono, Spain

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for Liara Object Storage API.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: Liara

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "storage.iran.liara.space"

        The default endpoint

        Iran

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for OSS API.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: Alibaba

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "oss-accelerate.aliyuncs.com"

        Global Accelerate

      "oss-accelerate-overseas.aliyuncs.com"

        Global Accelerate (outside mainland China)

      "oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com"

        East China 1 (Hangzhou)

      "oss-cn-shanghai.aliyuncs.com"

        East China 2 (Shanghai)

      "oss-cn-qingdao.aliyuncs.com"

        North China 1 (Qingdao)

      "oss-cn-beijing.aliyuncs.com"

        North China 2 (Beijing)

      "oss-cn-zhangjiakou.aliyuncs.com"

        North China 3 (Zhangjiakou)

      "oss-cn-huhehaote.aliyuncs.com"

        North China 5 (Hohhot)

      "oss-cn-wulanchabu.aliyuncs.com"

        North China 6 (Ulanqab)

      "oss-cn-shenzhen.aliyuncs.com"

        South China 1 (Shenzhen)

      "oss-cn-heyuan.aliyuncs.com"

        South China 2 (Heyuan)

      "oss-cn-guangzhou.aliyuncs.com"

        South China 3 (Guangzhou)

      "oss-cn-chengdu.aliyuncs.com"

        West China 1 (Chengdu)

      "oss-cn-hongkong.aliyuncs.com"

        Hong Kong (Hong Kong)

      "oss-us-west-1.aliyuncs.com"

        US West 1 (Silicon Valley)

      "oss-us-east-1.aliyuncs.com"

        US East 1 (Virginia)

      "oss-ap-southeast-1.aliyuncs.com"

        Southeast Asia Southeast 1 (Singapore)

      "oss-ap-southeast-2.aliyuncs.com"

        Asia Pacific Southeast 2 (Sydney)

      "oss-ap-southeast-3.aliyuncs.com"

        Southeast Asia Southeast 3 (Kuala Lumpur)

      "oss-ap-southeast-5.aliyuncs.com"

        Asia Pacific Southeast 5 (Jakarta)

      "oss-ap-northeast-1.aliyuncs.com"

        Asia Pacific Northeast 1 (Japan)

      "oss-ap-south-1.aliyuncs.com"

        Asia Pacific South 1 (Mumbai)

      "oss-eu-central-1.aliyuncs.com"

        Central Europe 1 (Frankfurt)

      "oss-eu-west-1.aliyuncs.com"

        West Europe (London)

      "oss-me-east-1.aliyuncs.com"

        Middle East 1 (Dubai)

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for OBS API.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: HuaweiOBS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        AF-Johannesburg

      "obs.ap-southeast-2.myhuaweicloud.com"

        AP-Bangkok

      "obs.ap-southeast-3.myhuaweicloud.com"

        AP-Singapore

      "obs.cn-east-3.myhuaweicloud.com"

        CN East-Shanghai1

      "obs.cn-east-2.myhuaweicloud.com"

        CN East-Shanghai2

      "obs.cn-north-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        CN North-Beijing1

      "obs.cn-north-4.myhuaweicloud.com"

        CN North-Beijing4

      "obs.cn-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        CN South-Guangzhou

      "obs.ap-southeast-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        CN-Hong Kong

      "obs.sa-argentina-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        LA-Buenos Aires1

      "obs.sa-peru-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        LA-Lima1

      "obs.na-mexico-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        LA-Mexico City1

      "obs.sa-chile-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        LA-Santiago2

      "obs.sa-brazil-1.myhuaweicloud.com"

        LA-Sao Paulo1

      "obs.ru-northwest-2.myhuaweicloud.com"

        RU-Moscow2

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for Scaleway Object Storage.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: Scaleway

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3.nl-ams.scw.cloud"

        Amsterdam Endpoint

      "s3.fr-par.scw.cloud"

        Paris Endpoint

      "s3.pl-waw.scw.cloud"

        Warsaw Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for StackPath Object Storage.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: StackPath

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3.us-east-2.stackpathstorage.com"

        US East Endpoint

      "s3.us-west-1.stackpathstorage.com"

        US West Endpoint

      "s3.eu-central-1.stackpathstorage.com"

        EU Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for Storj Gateway.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: Storj

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "gateway.storjshare.io"

        Global Hosted Gateway

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for Tencent COS API.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: TencentCOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "cos.ap-beijing.myqcloud.com"

        Beijing Region

      "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"

        Nanjing Region

      "cos.ap-shanghai.myqcloud.com"

        Shanghai Region

      "cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com"

        Guangzhou Region

      "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"

        Nanjing Region

      "cos.ap-chengdu.myqcloud.com"

        Chengdu Region

      "cos.ap-chongqing.myqcloud.com"

        Chongqing Region

      "cos.ap-hongkong.myqcloud.com"

        Hong Kong (China) Region

      "cos.ap-singapore.myqcloud.com"

        Singapore Region

      "cos.ap-mumbai.myqcloud.com"

        Mumbai Region

      "cos.ap-seoul.myqcloud.com"

        Seoul Region

      "cos.ap-bangkok.myqcloud.com"

        Bangkok Region

      "cos.ap-tokyo.myqcloud.com"

        Tokyo Region

      "cos.na-siliconvalley.myqcloud.com"

        Silicon Valley Region

      "cos.na-ashburn.myqcloud.com"

        Virginia Region

      "cos.na-toronto.myqcloud.com"

        Toronto Region

      "cos.eu-frankfurt.myqcloud.com"

        Frankfurt Region

      "cos.eu-moscow.myqcloud.com"

        Moscow Region

      "cos.accelerate.myqcloud.com"

        Use Tencent COS Accelerate Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for RackCorp Object Storage.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: RackCorp

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3.rackcorp.com"

        Global (AnyCast) Endpoint

      "au.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Australia (Anycast) Endpoint

      "au-nsw.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Sydney (Australia) Endpoint

      "au-qld.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Brisbane (Australia) Endpoint

      "au-vic.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Melbourne (Australia) Endpoint

      "au-wa.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Perth (Australia) Endpoint

      "ph.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Manila (Philippines) Endpoint

      "th.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Bangkok (Thailand) Endpoint

      "hk.s3.rackcorp.com"

        HK (Hong Kong) Endpoint

      "mn.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Ulaanbaatar (Mongolia) Endpoint

      "kg.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Bishkek (Kyrgyzstan) Endpoint

      "id.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Jakarta (Indonesia) Endpoint

      "jp.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Tokyo (Japan) Endpoint

      "sg.s3.rackcorp.com"

        SG (Singapore) Endpoint

      "de.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Frankfurt (Germany) Endpoint

      "us.s3.rackcorp.com"

        USA (AnyCast) Endpoint

      "us-east-1.s3.rackcorp.com"

        New York (USA) Endpoint

      "us-west-1.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Freemont (USA) Endpoint

      "nz.s3.rackcorp.com"

        Auckland (New Zealand) Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for Qiniu Object Storage.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: Qiniu

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "s3-cn-east-1.qiniucs.com"

        East China Endpoint 1

      "s3-cn-east-2.qiniucs.com"

        East China Endpoint 2

      "s3-cn-north-1.qiniucs.com"

        North China Endpoint 1

      "s3-cn-south-1.qiniucs.com"

        South China Endpoint 1

      "s3-us-north-1.qiniucs.com"

        North America Endpoint 1

      "s3-ap-southeast-1.qiniucs.com"

        Southeast Asia Endpoint 1

      "s3-ap-northeast-1.qiniucs.com"

        Northeast Asia Endpoint 1

--s3-endpoint

   Endpoint for S3 API.

   Required when using an S3 clone.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

    Provider: !AWS,IBMCOS,IDrive,IONOS,TencentCOS,HuaweiOBS,Alibaba,ChinaMobile,Liara,ArvanCloud,Scaleway,StackPath,Storj,RackCorp,Qiniu

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "objects-us-east-1.dream.io"

        Dream Objects endpoint

      "syd1.digitaloceanspaces.com"

        DigitalOcean Spaces Sydney 1

      "sfo3.digitaloceanspaces.com"

        DigitalOcean Spaces San Francisco 3

      "fra1.digitaloceanspaces.com"

        DigitalOcean Spaces Frankfurt 1

      "nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com"

        DigitalOcean Spaces New York 3

      "ams3.digitaloceanspaces.com"

        DigitalOcean Spaces Amsterdam 3

      "sgp1.digitaloceanspaces.com"

        DigitalOcean Spaces Singapore 1

      "localhost:8333"

        SeaweedFS S3 localhost

      "s3.us-east-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com"

        Seagate Lyve Cloud US East 1 (Virginia)

      "s3.us-west-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com"

        Seagate Lyve Cloud US West 1 (California)

      "s3.ap-southeast-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com"

        Seagate Lyve Cloud AP Southeast 1 (Singapore)

      "s3.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi US East 1 (N.  Virginia)

      "s3.us-east-2.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi US East 2 (N.  Virginia)

      "s3.us-central-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi US Central 1 (Texas)

      "s3.us-west-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi US West 1 (Oregon)

      "s3.ca-central-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi CA Central 1 (Toronto)

      "s3.eu-central-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi EU Central 1 (Amsterdam)

      "s3.eu-central-2.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi EU Central 2 (Frankfurt)

      "s3.eu-west-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi EU West 1 (London)

      "s3.eu-west-2.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi EU West 2 (Paris)

      "s3.ap-northeast-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi AP Northeast 1 (Tokyo) endpoint

      "s3.ap-northeast-2.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi AP Northeast 2 (Osaka) endpoint

      "s3.ap-southeast-1.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi AP Southeast 1 (Singapore)

      "s3.ap-southeast-2.wasabisys.com"

        Wasabi AP Southeast 2 (Sydney)

      "storage.iran.liara.space"

        Liara Iran endpoint

      "s3.ir-thr-at1.arvanstorage.com"

        ArvanCloud Tehran Iran (Asiatech) endpoint

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.

   Used when creating buckets only.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: AWS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest

      "us-east-2"

        US East (Ohio) Region

      "us-west-1"

        US West (Northern California) Region

      "us-west-2"

        US West (Oregon) Region

      "ca-central-1"

        Canada (Central) Region

      "eu-west-1"

        EU (Ireland) Region

      "eu-west-2"

        EU (London) Region

      "eu-west-3"

        EU (Paris) Region

      "eu-north-1"

        EU (Stockholm) Region

      "eu-south-1"

        EU (Milan) Region

      "EU"

        EU Region

      "ap-southeast-1"

        Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region

      "ap-southeast-2"

        Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region

      "ap-northeast-1"

        Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region

      "ap-northeast-2"

        Asia Pacific (Seoul) Region

      "ap-northeast-3"

        Asia Pacific (Osaka-Local) Region

      "ap-south-1"

        Asia Pacific (Mumbai) Region

      "ap-east-1"

        Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region

      "sa-east-1"

        South America (Sao Paulo) Region

      "me-south-1"

        Middle East (Bahrain) Region

      "af-south-1"

        Africa (Cape Town) Region

      "cn-north-1"

        China (Beijing) Region

      "cn-northwest-1"

        China (Ningxia) Region

      "us-gov-east-1"

        AWS GovCloud (US-East) Region

      "us-gov-west-1"

        AWS GovCloud (US) Region

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - must match endpoint.

   Used when creating buckets only.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: ChinaMobile

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "wuxi1"

        East China (Suzhou)

      "jinan1"

        East China (Jinan)

      "ningbo1"

        East China (Hangzhou)

      "shanghai1"

        East China (Shanghai-1)

      "zhengzhou1"

        Central China (Zhengzhou)

      "hunan1"

        Central China (Changsha-1)

      "zhuzhou1"

        Central China (Changsha-2)

      "guangzhou1"

        South China (Guangzhou-2)

      "dongguan1"

        South China (Guangzhou-3)

      "beijing1"

        North China (Beijing-1)

      "beijing2"

        North China (Beijing-2)

      "beijing4"

        North China (Beijing-3)

      "huhehaote1"

        North China (Huhehaote)

      "chengdu1"

        Southwest China (Chengdu)

      "chongqing1"

        Southwest China (Chongqing)

      "guiyang1"

        Southwest China (Guiyang)

      "xian1"

        Nouthwest China (Xian)

      "yunnan"

        Yunnan China (Kunming)

      "yunnan2"

        Yunnan China (Kunming-2)

      "tianjin1"

        Tianjin China (Tianjin)

      "jilin1"

        Jilin China (Changchun)

      "hubei1"

        Hubei China (Xiangyan)

      "jiangxi1"

        Jiangxi China (Nanchang)

      "gansu1"

        Gansu China (Lanzhou)

      "shanxi1"

        Shanxi China (Taiyuan)

      "liaoning1"

        Liaoning China (Shenyang)

      "hebei1"

        Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)

      "fujian1"

        Fujian China (Xiamen)

      "guangxi1"

        Guangxi China (Nanning)

      "anhui1"

        Anhui China (Huainan)

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - must match endpoint.

   Used when creating buckets only.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: ArvanCloud

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "ir-thr-at1"

        Tehran Iran (Asiatech)

      "ir-tbz-sh1"

        Tabriz Iran (Shahriar)

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - must match endpoint when using IBM Cloud Public.

   For on-prem COS, do not make a selection from this list, hit enter.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: IBMCOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "us-standard"

        US Cross Region Standard

      "us-vault"

        US Cross Region Vault

      "us-cold"

        US Cross Region Cold

      "us-flex"

        US Cross Region Flex

      "us-east-standard"

        US East Region Standard

      "us-east-vault"

        US East Region Vault

      "us-east-cold"

        US East Region Cold

      "us-east-flex"

        US East Region Flex

      "us-south-standard"

        US South Region Standard

      "us-south-vault"

        US South Region Vault

      "us-south-cold"

        US South Region Cold

      "us-south-flex"

        US South Region Flex

      "eu-standard"

        EU Cross Region Standard

      "eu-vault"

        EU Cross Region Vault

      "eu-cold"

        EU Cross Region Cold

      "eu-flex"

        EU Cross Region Flex

      "eu-gb-standard"

        Great Britain Standard

      "eu-gb-vault"

        Great Britain Vault

      "eu-gb-cold"

        Great Britain Cold

      "eu-gb-flex"

        Great Britain Flex

      "ap-standard"

        APAC Standard

      "ap-vault"

        APAC Vault

      "ap-cold"

        APAC Cold

      "ap-flex"

        APAC Flex

      "mel01-standard"

        Melbourne Standard

      "mel01-vault"

        Melbourne Vault

      "mel01-cold"

        Melbourne Cold

      "mel01-flex"

        Melbourne Flex

      "tor01-standard"

        Toronto Standard

      "tor01-vault"

        Toronto Vault

      "tor01-cold"

        Toronto Cold

      "tor01-flex"

        Toronto Flex

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - the location where your bucket will be located and your data stored.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: RackCorp

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "global"

        Global CDN Region

      "au"

        Australia (All locations)

      "au-nsw"

        NSW (Australia) Region

      "au-qld"

        QLD (Australia) Region

      "au-vic"

        VIC (Australia) Region

      "au-wa"

        Perth (Australia) Region

      "ph"

        Manila (Philippines) Region

      "th"

        Bangkok (Thailand) Region

      "hk"

        HK (Hong Kong) Region

      "mn"

        Ulaanbaatar (Mongolia) Region

      "kg"

        Bishkek (Kyrgyzstan) Region

      "id"

        Jakarta (Indonesia) Region

      "jp"

        Tokyo (Japan) Region

      "sg"

        SG (Singapore) Region

      "de"

        Frankfurt (Germany) Region

      "us"

        USA (AnyCast) Region

      "us-east-1"

        New York (USA) Region

      "us-west-1"

        Freemont (USA) Region

      "nz"

        Auckland (New Zealand) Region

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.

   Used when creating buckets only.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: Qiniu

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "cn-east-1"

        East China Region 1

      "cn-east-2"

        East China Region 2

      "cn-north-1"

        North China Region 1

      "cn-south-1"

        South China Region 1

      "us-north-1"

        North America Region 1

      "ap-southeast-1"

        Southeast Asia Region 1

      "ap-northeast-1"

        Northeast Asia Region 1

--s3-location-constraint

   Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.

   Leave blank if not sure.  Used when creating buckets only.

   Properties:

    Config: location_constraint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

    Provider: !AWS,Alibaba,HuaweiOBS,ChinaMobile,Cloudflare,IBMCOS,IDrive,IONOS,Liara,ArvanCloud,Qiniu,RackCorp,Scaleway,StackPath,Storj,TencentCOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-acl

   Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.

   This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.

   For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl

   Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3 doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.

   If the acl is an empty string then no X-Amz-Acl: header is added and the default (private) will be used.

   Properties:

    Config: acl

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ACL

    Provider: !Storj,Cloudflare

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "default"

        Owner gets Full_CONTROL.

        No one else has access rights (default).

      "private"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        No one else has access rights (default).

      "public-read"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AllUsers group gets READ access.

      "public-read-write"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.

        Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.

      "authenticated-read"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

      "bucket-owner-read"

        Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        Bucket owner gets READ access.

        If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.

      "bucket-owner-full-control"

        Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.

        If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.

      "private"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        No one else has access rights (default).

        This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise COS.

      "public-read"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AllUsers group gets READ access.

        This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise IBM COS.

      "public-read-write"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.

        This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), On-Premise IBM COS.

      "authenticated-read"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

        Not supported on Buckets.

        This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra) and On-Premise IBM COS.

--s3-server-side-encryption

   The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.

   Properties:

    Config: server_side_encryption

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SERVER_SIDE_ENCRYPTION

    Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

      "AES256"

        AES256

      "aws:kms"

        aws:kms

--s3-sse-kms-key-id

   If using KMS ID you must provide the ARN of Key.

   Properties:

    Config: sse_kms_key_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_KMS_KEY_ID

    Provider: AWS,Ceph,Minio

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

      "arn:aws:kms:us-east-1:*"

        arn:aws:kms:*

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: AWS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

      "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"

        Reduced redundancy storage class

      "STANDARD_IA"

        Standard Infrequent Access storage class

      "ONEZONE_IA"

        One Zone Infrequent Access storage class

      "GLACIER"

        Glacier storage class

      "DEEP_ARCHIVE"

        Glacier Deep Archive storage class

      "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"

        Intelligent-Tiering storage class

      "GLACIER_IR"

        Glacier Instant Retrieval storage class

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in OSS.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: Alibaba

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

      "GLACIER"

        Archive storage mode

      "STANDARD_IA"

        Infrequent access storage mode

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in ChinaMobile.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: ChinaMobile

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

      "GLACIER"

        Archive storage mode

      "STANDARD_IA"

        Infrequent access storage mode

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in Liara

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: Liara

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in ArvanCloud.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: ArvanCloud

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: TencentCOS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

      "ARCHIVE"

        Archive storage mode

      "STANDARD_IA"

        Infrequent access storage mode

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: Scaleway

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default.

      "STANDARD"

        The Standard class for any upload.

        Suitable for on-demand content like streaming or CDN.

      "GLACIER"

        Archived storage.

        Prices are lower, but it needs to be restored first to be accessed.

--s3-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in Qiniu.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

    Provider: Qiniu

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "STANDARD"

        Standard storage class

      "LINE"

        Infrequent access storage mode

      "GLACIER"

        Archive storage mode

      "DEEP_ARCHIVE"

        Deep archive storage mode

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to s3 (Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digi
   talOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, IONOS Cloud, Liara, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent
   COS, Qiniu and Wasabi).

--s3-bucket-acl

   Canned ACL used when creating buckets.

   For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl

   Note that this ACL is applied when only when creating buckets.  If it isn't set then "acl" is used instead.

   If the "acl" and "bucket_acl" are empty strings then no X-Amz-Acl: header is added and the default (private) will be used.

   Properties:

    Config: bucket_acl

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_BUCKET_ACL

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "private"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        No one else has access rights (default).

      "public-read"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AllUsers group gets READ access.

      "public-read-write"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.

        Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.

      "authenticated-read"

        Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

        The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

--s3-requester-pays

   Enables requester pays option when interacting with S3 bucket.

   Properties:

    Config: requester_pays

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REQUESTER_PAYS

    Provider: AWS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-sse-customer-algorithm

   If using SSE-C, the server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_algorithm

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_ALGORITHM

    Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

      "AES256"

        AES256

--s3-sse-customer-key

   To use SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key used to encrypt/decrypt your data.

   Alternatively you can provide --sse-customer-key-base64.

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY

    Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--s3-sse-customer-key-base64

   If using SSE-C you must provide the secret encryption key encoded in base64 format to encrypt/decrypt your data.

   Alternatively you can provide --sse-customer-key.

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_key_base64

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_BASE64

    Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--s3-sse-customer-key-md5

   If using SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key MD5 checksum (optional).

   If you leave it blank, this is calculated automatically from the sse_customer_key provided.

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_key_md5

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_MD5

    Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--s3-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

   Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.  The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 200Mi

--s3-chunk-size

   Chunk size to use for uploading.

   When uploading files larger than upload_cutoff or files with unknown size (e.g.  from "rclone rcat" or uploaded with  "rclone  mount"  or  google  photos  or
   google docs) they will be uploaded as multipart uploads using this chunk size.

   Note that "--s3-upload-concurrency" chunks of this size are buffered in memory per transfer.

   If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have enough memory, then increasing this will speed up the transfers.

   Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a large file of known size to stay below the 10,000 chunks limit.

   Files  of unknown size are uploaded with the configured chunk_size.  Since the default chunk size is 5 MiB and there can be at most 10,000 chunks, this means
   that by default the maximum size of a file you can stream upload is 48 GiB.  If you wish to stream upload  larger  files  then  you  will  need  to  increase
   chunk_size.

   Increasing  the chunk size decreases the accuracy of the progress statistics displayed with "-P" flag.  Rclone treats chunk as sent when it's buffered by the
   AWS SDK, when in fact it may still be uploading.  A bigger chunk size means a bigger AWS SDK buffer and progress reporting more deviating from the truth.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 5Mi

--s3-max-upload-parts

   Maximum number of parts in a multipart upload.

   This option defines the maximum number of multipart chunks to use when doing a multipart upload.

   This can be useful if a service does not support the AWS S3 specification of 10,000 chunks.

   Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a large file of a known size to stay below this number of chunks limit.

   Properties:

    Config: max_upload_parts

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MAX_UPLOAD_PARTS

    Type: int

    Default: 10000

--s3-copy-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to multipart copy.

   Any files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be copied in chunks of this size.

   The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

   Properties:

    Config: copy_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_COPY_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 4.656Gi

--s3-disable-checksum

   Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

   Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for  data  integ
   rity checking but can cause long delays for large files to start uploading.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_checksum

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-shared-credentials-file

   Path to the shared credentials file.

   If env_auth = true then rclone can use a shared credentials file.

   If  this variable is empty rclone will look for the "AWS_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE" env variable.  If the env value is empty it will default to the current us
   er's home directory.

          Linux/OSX: "$HOME/.aws/credentials"
          Windows:   "%USERPROFILE%\.aws\credentials"

   Properties:

    Config: shared_credentials_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-profile

   Profile to use in the shared credentials file.

   If env_auth = true then rclone can use a shared credentials file.  This variable controls which profile is used in that file.

   If empty it will default to the environment variable "AWS_PROFILE" or "default" if that environment variable is also not set.

   Properties:

    Config: profile

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_PROFILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-session-token

   An AWS session token.

   Properties:

    Config: session_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SESSION_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-upload-concurrency

   Concurrency for multipart uploads.

   This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

   If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing this may  help
   to speed up the transfers.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 4

--s3-force-path-style

   If true use path style access if false use virtual hosted style.

   If  this  is  true  (the  default)  then  rclone  will  use  path  style  access,  if  false  then  rclone  will use virtual path style.  See the AWS S3 docs
   (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/UsingBucket.html#access-bucket-intro) for more info.

   Some providers (e.g.  AWS, Aliyun OSS, Netease COS, or Tencent COS) require this set to false - rclone will do this automatically based on the provider  set
   ting.

   Properties:

    Config: force_path_style

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_FORCE_PATH_STYLE

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--s3-v2-auth

   If true use v2 authentication.

   If this is false (the default) then rclone will use v4 authentication.  If it is set then rclone will use v2 authentication.

   Use this only if v4 signatures don't work, e.g.  pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.

   Properties:

    Config: v2_auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_V2_AUTH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-use-accelerate-endpoint

   If true use the AWS S3 accelerated endpoint.

   See: AWS S3 Transfer acceleration (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/transfer-acceleration-examples.html)

   Properties:

    Config: use_accelerate_endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_ACCELERATE_ENDPOINT

    Provider: AWS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-leave-parts-on-error

   If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery.

   It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

   WARNING: Storing parts of an incomplete multipart upload counts towards space usage on S3 and will add additional costs if not cleaned up.

   Properties:

    Config: leave_parts_on_error

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR

    Provider: AWS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-list-chunk

   Size of listing chunk (response list for each ListObject S3 request).

   This  option is also known as "MaxKeys", "max-items", or "page-size" from the AWS S3 specification.  Most services truncate the response list to 1000 objects
   even if requested more than that.  In AWS S3 this is a global maximum and  cannot  be  changed,  see  AWS  S3  (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/cli/latest/refer
   ence/s3/ls.html).  In Ceph, this can be increased with the "rgw list buckets max chunk" option.

   Properties:

    Config: list_chunk

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_CHUNK

    Type: int

    Default: 1000

--s3-list-version

   Version of ListObjects to use: 1,2 or 0 for auto.

   When S3 originally launched it only provided the ListObjects call to enumerate objects in a bucket.

   However in May 2016 the ListObjectsV2 call was introduced.  This is much higher performance and should be used if at all possible.

   If set to the default, 0, rclone will guess according to the provider set which list objects method to call.  If it guesses wrong, then it may be set manual
   ly here.

   Properties:

    Config: list_version

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_VERSION

    Type: int

    Default: 0

--s3-list-url-encode

   Whether to url encode listings: true/false/unset

   Some providers support URL encoding listings and where this is available this is more reliable when using control characters in file names.  If this  is  set
   to unset (the default) then rclone will choose according to the provider setting what to apply, but you can override rclone's choice here.

   Properties:

    Config: list_url_encode

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_URL_ENCODE

    Type: Tristate

    Default: unset

--s3-no-check-bucket

   If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it.

   This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does if you know the bucket exists already.

   It can also be needed if the user you are using does not have bucket creation permissions.  Before v1.52.0 this would have passed silently due to a bug.

   Properties:

    Config: no_check_bucket

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_CHECK_BUCKET

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-no-head

   If set, don't HEAD uploaded objects to check integrity.

   This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does.

   Setting it means that if rclone receives a 200 OK message after uploading an object with PUT then it will assume that it got uploaded properly.

   In particular it will assume:

   • the metadata, including modtime, storage class and content type was as uploaded

   • the size was as uploaded

   It reads the following items from the response for a single part PUT:

   • the MD5SUM

   • The uploaded date

   For multipart uploads these items aren't read.

   If an source object of unknown length is uploaded then rclone will do a HEAD request.

   Setting  this  flag  increases  the chance for undetected upload failures, in particular an incorrect size, so it isn't recommended for normal operation.  In
   practice the chance of an undetected upload failure is very small even with this flag.

   Properties:

    Config: no_head

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_HEAD

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-no-head-object

   If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects.

   Properties:

    Config: no_head_object

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_HEAD_OBJECT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--s3-memory-pool-flush-time

   How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.

   Uploads which requires additional buffers (f.e multipart) will use memory pool for allocations.  This option controls how often unused buffers  will  be  re
   moved from the pool.

   Properties:

    Config: memory_pool_flush_time

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--s3-memory-pool-use-mmap

   Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

   Properties:

    Config: memory_pool_use_mmap

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-disable-http2

   Disable usage of http2 for S3 backends.

   There  is  currently  an unsolved issue with the s3 (specifically minio) backend and HTTP/2.  HTTP/2 is enabled by default for the s3 backend but can be dis
   abled here.  When the issue is solved this flag will be removed.

   See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4673, https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3631

   Properties:

    Config: disable_http2

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DISABLE_HTTP2

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-download-url

   Custom endpoint for downloads.  This is usually set to a CloudFront CDN URL as AWS S3 offers cheaper egress for data downloaded through the  CloudFront  net
   work.

   Properties:

    Config: download_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DOWNLOAD_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--s3-use-multipart-etag

   Whether to use ETag in multipart uploads for verification

   This should be true, false or left unset to use the default for the provider.

   Properties:

    Config: use_multipart_etag

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_MULTIPART_ETAG

    Type: Tristate

    Default: unset

--s3-use-presigned-request

   Whether to use a presigned request or PutObject for single part uploads

   If this is false rclone will use PutObject from the AWS SDK to upload an object.

   Versions  of  rclone  <  1.59  use  presigned  requests to upload a single part object and setting this flag to true will re-enable that functionality.  This
   shouldn't be necessary except in exceptional circumstances or for testing.

   Properties:

    Config: use_presigned_request

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_PRESIGNED_REQUEST

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-versions

   Include old versions in directory listings.

   Properties:

    Config: versions

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_VERSIONS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-version-at

   Show file versions as they were at the specified time.

   The parameter should be a date, "2006-01-02", datetime "2006-01-02 15:04:05" or a duration for that long ago, eg "100d" or "1h".

   Note that when using this no file write operations are permitted, so you can't upload files or delete them.

   See the time option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#time-option) for valid formats.

   Properties:

    Config: version_at

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_VERSION_AT

    Type: Time

    Default: off

--s3-decompress

   If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects.

   It is possible to upload objects to S3 with "Content-Encoding: gzip" set.  Normally rclone will download these files as compressed objects.

   If this flag is set then rclone will decompress these files with "Content-Encoding: gzip" as they are received.  This means that rclone can't check the  size
   and hash but the file contents will be decompressed.

   Properties:

    Config: decompress

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DECOMPRESS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-might-gzip

   Set this if the backend might gzip objects.

   Normally  providers will not alter objects when they are downloaded.  If an object was not uploaded with Content-Encoding: gzip then it won't be set on down‐
   load.

   However some providers may gzip objects even if they weren't uploaded with Content-Encoding: gzip (eg Cloudflare).

   A symptom of this would be receiving errors like

          ERROR corrupted on transfer: sizes differ NNN vs MMM

   If you set this flag and rclone downloads an object with Content-Encoding: gzip set and chunked transfer encoding, then rclone will decompress the object  on
   the fly.

   If this is set to unset (the default) then rclone will choose according to the provider setting what to apply, but you can override rclone's choice here.

   Properties:

    Config: might_gzip

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MIGHT_GZIP

    Type: Tristate

    Default: unset

--s3-no-system-metadata

   Suppress setting and reading of system metadata

   Properties:

    Config: no_system_metadata

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_SYSTEM_METADATA

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--s3-sts-endpoint

   Endpoint for STS.

   Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.

   Properties:

    Config: sts_endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STS_ENDPOINT

    Provider: AWS

    Type: string

    Required: false

Metadata

   User metadata is stored as x-amz-meta- keys.  S3 metadata keys are case insensitive and are always returned in lower case.

   Here are the possible system metadata items for the s3 backend.

   Name          Help          Type          Example                               Read Only
   
   btime         Time     of   RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   Y
                 file  birth
                 (creation)
                 read   from
                 Last-Modi
                 fied header
   cache-con    Cache-Con    string        no-cache                              N
   trol          trol header
   content-      Content-      string        inline                                N
   disposition   Disposition
                 header
   content-en   Content-En   string        gzip                                  N
   coding        coding
                 header
   content-      Content-      string        en-US                                 N
   language      Language
                 header
   content-      Content-      string        text/plain                            N
   type          Type header
   mtime         Time     of   RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                 last  modi
                 fication,
                 read   from
                 rclone
                 metadata
   tier          Tier of the   string        GLACIER                               Y
                 object

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the s3 backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

restore

   Restore objects from GLACIER to normal storage

          rclone backend restore remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command can be used to restore one or more objects from GLACIER to normal storage.

   Usage Examples:

          rclone backend restore s3:bucket/path/to/object [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]
          rclone backend restore s3:bucket/path/to/directory [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]
          rclone backend restore s3:bucket [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]

   This flag also obeys the filters.  Test first with --interactive/-i or --dry-run flags

          rclone --interactive backend restore --include "*.txt" s3:bucket/path -o priority=Standard

   All the objects shown will be marked for restore, then

          rclone backend restore --include "*.txt" s3:bucket/path -o priority=Standard

   It returns a list of status dictionaries with Remote and Status keys.  The Status will be OK if it was successful or an error message if not.

          [
              {
                  "Status": "OK",
                  "Path": "test.txt"
              },
              {
                  "Status": "OK",
                  "Path": "test/file4.txt"
              }
          ]

   Options:

    "description": The optional description for the job.

    "lifetime": Lifetime of the active copy in days

    "priority": Priority of restore: Standard|Expedited|Bulk

list-multipart-uploads

   List the unfinished multipart uploads

          rclone backend list-multipart-uploads remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command lists the unfinished multipart uploads in JSON format.

          rclone backend list-multipart s3:bucket/path/to/object

   It returns a dictionary of buckets with values as lists of unfinished multipart uploads.

   You can call it with no bucket in which case it lists all bucket, with a bucket or with a bucket and path.

          {
            "rclone": [
              {
                "Initiated": "2020-06-26T14:20:36Z",
                "Initiator": {
                  "DisplayName": "XXX",
                  "ID": "arn:aws:iam::XXX:user/XXX"
                },
                "Key": "KEY",
                "Owner": {
                  "DisplayName": null,
                  "ID": "XXX"
                },
                "StorageClass": "STANDARD",
                "UploadId": "XXX"
              }
            ],
            "rclone-1000files": [],
            "rclone-dst": []
          }

cleanup

   Remove unfinished multipart uploads.

          rclone backend cleanup remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command removes unfinished multipart uploads of age greater than max-age which defaults to 24 hours.

   Note that you can use --interactive/-i or --dry-run with this command to see what it would do.

          rclone backend cleanup s3:bucket/path/to/object
          rclone backend cleanup -o max-age=7w s3:bucket/path/to/object

   Durations are parsed as per the rest of rclone, 2h, 7d, 7w etc.

   Options:

    "max-age": Max age of upload to delete

cleanup-hidden

   Remove old versions of files.

          rclone backend cleanup-hidden remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command removes any old hidden versions of files on a versions enabled bucket.

   Note that you can use --interactive/-i or --dry-run with this command to see what it would do.

          rclone backend cleanup-hidden s3:bucket/path/to/dir

versioning

   Set/get versioning support for a bucket.

          rclone backend versioning remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command sets versioning support if a parameter is passed and then returns the current versioning status for the bucket supplied.

          rclone backend versioning s3:bucket # read status only
          rclone backend versioning s3:bucket Enabled
          rclone backend versioning s3:bucket Suspended

   It may return "Enabled", "Suspended" or "Unversioned".  Note that once versioning has been enabled the status can't be set back to "Unversioned".

Anonymous access to public buckets

   If you want to use rclone to access a public bucket, configure with a blank access_key_id and secret_access_key.  Your config  should  end  up  looking  like
   this:

          [anons3]
          type = s3
          provider = AWS
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id =
          secret_access_key =
          region = us-east-1
          endpoint =
          location_constraint =
          acl = private
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

   Then use it as normal with the name of the public bucket, e.g.

          rclone lsd anons3:1000genomes

   You will be able to list and copy data but not upload it.

Providers AWS S3

   This is the provider used as main example and described in the configuration section above.

AWS Snowball Edge

   AWS  Snowball  (https://aws.amazon.com/snowball/) is a hardware appliance used for transferring bulk data back to AWS.  Its main software interface is S3 ob
   ject storage.

   To use rclone with AWS Snowball Edge devices, configure as standard for an 'S3 Compatible Service'.

   If using rclone pre v1.59 be sure to set upload_cutoff = 0 otherwise you will run into authentication header issues as the snowball device does  not  support
   query parameter based authentication.

   With rclone v1.59 or later setting upload_cutoff should not be necessary.

   eg.

          [snowball]
          type = s3
          provider = Other
          access_key_id = YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
          secret_access_key = YOUR_SECRET_KEY
          endpoint = http://[IP of Snowball]:8080
          upload_cutoff = 0

Ceph

   Ceph  (https://ceph.com/)  is an open-source, unified, distributed storage system designed for excellent performance, reliability and scalability.  It has an
   S3 compatible object storage interface.

   To use rclone with Ceph, configure as above but leave the region blank and set the endpoint.  You should end up with something like this in your config:

          [ceph]
          type = s3
          provider = Ceph
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = XXX
          secret_access_key = YYY
          region =
          endpoint = https://ceph.endpoint.example.com
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

   If you are using an older version of CEPH (e.g.  10.2.x Jewel) and a version of rclone before v1.59 then you may need to supply  the  parameter  --s3-upload-
   cutoff 0 or put this in the config file as upload_cutoff 0 to work around a bug which causes uploading of small files to fail.

   Note  also  that  Ceph  sometimes puts / in the passwords it gives users.  If you read the secret access key using the command line tools you will get a JSON
   blob with the / escaped as \/.  Make sure you only write / in the secret access key.

   Eg the dump from Ceph looks something like this (irrelevant keys removed).

          {
              "user_id": "xxx",
              "display_name": "xxxx",
              "keys": [
                  {
                      "user": "xxx",
                      "access_key": "xxxxxx",
                      "secret_key": "xxxxxx\/xxxx"
                  }
              ],
          }

   Because this is a json dump, it is encoding the / as \/, so if you use the secret key as xxxxxx/xxxx it will work fine.

Cloudflare R2

   Cloudflare R2 (https://blog.cloudflare.com/r2-open-beta/) Storage allows developers to store large amounts of unstructured data  without  the  costly  egress
   bandwidth fees associated with typical cloud storage services.

   Here is an example of making a Cloudflare R2 configuration.  First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

   Note  that all buckets are private, and all are stored in the same "auto" region.  It is necessary to use Cloudflare workers to share the content of a bucket
   publicly.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> r2
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          ...
          XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
             \ (s3)
          ...
          Storage> s3
          Option provider.
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
          ...
          XX / Cloudflare R2 Storage
             \ (Cloudflare)
          ...
          provider> Cloudflare
          Option env_auth.
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth> 1
          Option access_key_id.
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> ACCESS_KEY
          Option secret_access_key.
          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> SECRET_ACCESS_KEY
          Option region.
          Region to connect to.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / R2 buckets are automatically distributed across Cloudflare's data centers for low latency.
             \ (auto)
          region> 1
          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint for S3 API.
          Required when using an S3 clone.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          endpoint> https://ACCOUNT_ID.r2.cloudflarestorage.com
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This will leave your config looking something like:

          [r2]
          type = s3
          provider = Cloudflare
          access_key_id = ACCESS_KEY
          secret_access_key = SECRET_ACCESS_KEY
          region = auto
          endpoint = https://ACCOUNT_ID.r2.cloudflarestorage.com
          acl = private

   Now run rclone lsf r2: to see your buckets and rclone lsf r2:bucket to look within a bucket.

Dreamhost

   Dreamhost DreamObjects (https://www.dreamhost.com/cloud/storage/) is an object storage system based on CEPH.

   To use rclone with Dreamhost, configure as above but leave the region blank and set the endpoint.  You should end up with something like this in your config:

          [dreamobjects]
          type = s3
          provider = DreamHost
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = your_access_key
          secret_access_key = your_secret_key
          region =
          endpoint = objects-us-west-1.dream.io
          location_constraint =
          acl = private
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

DigitalOcean Spaces

   Spaces (https://www.digitalocean.com/products/object-storage/)  is  an  S3-interoperable  (https://developers.digitalocean.com/documentation/spaces/)  object
   storage service from cloud provider DigitalOcean.

   To  connect  to  DigitalOcean  Spaces you will need an access key and secret key.  These can be retrieved on the "Applications & API (https://cloud.digitalo‐
   cean.com/settings/api/tokens)" page of the DigitalOcean control panel.  They will be needed when prompted by rclone config for  your  access_key_id  and  se
   cret_access_key.

   When  prompted  for  a  region  or  location_constraint,  press  enter  to  use the default value.  The region must be included in the endpoint setting (e.g.
   nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com).  The default values can be used for other settings.

   Going through the whole process of creating a new remote by running rclone config, each prompt should be answered as shown below:

          Storage> s3
          env_auth> 1
          access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
          secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY
          region>
          endpoint> nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com
          location_constraint>
          acl>
          storage_class>

   The resulting configuration file should look like:

          [spaces]
          type = s3
          provider = DigitalOcean
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
          secret_access_key = YOUR_SECRET_KEY
          region =
          endpoint = nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

   Once configured, you can create a new Space and begin copying files.  For example:

          rclone mkdir spaces:my-new-space
          rclone copy /path/to/files spaces:my-new-space

Huawei OBS

   Object Storage Service (OBS) provides stable, secure, efficient, and easy-to-use cloud storage that lets you store virtually any volume of unstructured  data
   in any format and access it from anywhere.

   OBS provides an S3 interface, you can copy and modify the following configuration and add it to your rclone configuration file.

          [obs]
          type = s3
          provider = HuaweiOBS
          access_key_id = your-access-key-id
          secret_access_key = your-secret-access-key
          region = af-south-1
          endpoint = obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com
          acl = private

   Or you can also configure via the interactive command line:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> obs
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
           5 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
             \ (s3)
          [snip]
          Storage> 5
          Option provider.
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
          [snip]
           9 / Huawei Object Storage Service
             \ (HuaweiOBS)
          [snip]
          provider> 9
          Option env_auth.
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth> 1
          Option access_key_id.
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> your-access-key-id
          Option secret_access_key.
          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> your-secret-access-key
          Option region.
          Region to connect to.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / AF-Johannesburg
             \ (af-south-1)
           2 / AP-Bangkok
             \ (ap-southeast-2)
          [snip]
          region> 1
          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint for OBS API.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / AF-Johannesburg
             \ (obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com)
           2 / AP-Bangkok
             \ (obs.ap-southeast-2.myhuaweicloud.com)
          [snip]
          endpoint> 1
          Option acl.
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
          This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           1 | No one else has access rights (default).
             \ (private)
          [snip]
          acl> 1
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n>
          --------------------
          [obs]
          type = s3
          provider = HuaweiOBS
          access_key_id = your-access-key-id
          secret_access_key = your-secret-access-key
          region = af-south-1
          endpoint = obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com
          acl = private
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          obs                  s3

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

IBM COS (S3)

   Information  stored  with IBM Cloud Object Storage is encrypted and dispersed across multiple geographic locations, and accessed through an implementation of
   the S3 API.  This service makes use of the distributed storage technologies provided by IBMs Cloud Object Storage System (formerly  Cleversafe).   For  more
   information visit: (http://www.ibm.com/cloud/object-storage)

   To configure access to IBM COS S3, follow the steps below:

   1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.

          2018/02/14 14:13:11 NOTICE: Config file "C:\\Users\\a\\.config\\rclone\\rclone.conf" not found - using defaults
          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n

   2. Enter the name for the configuration

          name> <YOUR NAME>

   3. Select "s3" storage.

      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          1 / Alias for an existing remote
          \ "alias"
          2 / Amazon Drive
          \ "amazon cloud drive"
          3 / Amazon S3 Complaint Storage Providers (Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, Liara, ArvanCloud, Minio, IBM COS)
          \ "s3"
          4 / Backblaze B2
          \ "b2"
      [snip]
          23 / HTTP
          \ "http"
      Storage> 3

   4. Select IBM COS as the S3 Storage Provider.

      Choose the S3 provider.
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Choose this option to configure Storage to AWS S3
             \ "AWS"
           2 / Choose this option to configure Storage to Ceph Systems
           \ "Ceph"
           3 /  Choose this option to configure Storage to Dreamhost
           \ "Dreamhost"
         4 / Choose this option to the configure Storage to IBM COS S3
           \ "IBMCOS"
           5 / Choose this option to the configure Storage to Minio
           \ "Minio"
           Provider>4

   5. Enter the Access Key and Secret.

          AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          access_key_id> <>
          AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          secret_access_key> <>

   6. Specify the endpoint for IBM COS.  For Public IBM COS, choose from the option below.  For On Premise IBM COS, enter an endpoint address.

          Endpoint for IBM COS S3 API.
          Specify if using an IBM COS On Premise.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / US Cross Region Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
           2 / US Cross Region Dallas Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.dal.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
           3 / US Cross Region Washington DC Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.wdc-us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
           4 / US Cross Region San Jose Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.sjc-us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
           5 / US Cross Region Private Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
           6 / US Cross Region Dallas Private Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.dal-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
           7 / US Cross Region Washington DC Private Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.wdc-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
           8 / US Cross Region San Jose Private Endpoint
             \ "s3-api.sjc-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
           9 / US Region East Endpoint
             \ "s3.us-east.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
          10 / US Region East Private Endpoint
             \ "s3.us-east.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
          11 / US Region South Endpoint
      [snip]
          34 / Toronto Single Site Private Endpoint
             \ "s3.tor01.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
          endpoint>1

   7. Specify a IBM COS Location Constraint.  The location constraint must match endpoint when using IBM Cloud Public.  For on-prem COS, do not make a selection
      from this list, hit enter

           1 / US Cross Region Standard
             \ "us-standard"
           2 / US Cross Region Vault
             \ "us-vault"
           3 / US Cross Region Cold
             \ "us-cold"
           4 / US Cross Region Flex
             \ "us-flex"
           5 / US East Region Standard
             \ "us-east-standard"
           6 / US East Region Vault
             \ "us-east-vault"
           7 / US East Region Cold
             \ "us-east-cold"
           8 / US East Region Flex
             \ "us-east-flex"
           9 / US South Region Standard
             \ "us-south-standard"
          10 / US South Region Vault
             \ "us-south-vault"
      [snip]
          32 / Toronto Flex
             \ "tor01-flex"
      location_constraint>1

   9. Specify a canned ACL.  IBM Cloud (Storage) supports "public-read" and "private".  IBM Cloud(Infra) supports all the canned ACLs.  On-Premise COS  supports
      all the canned ACLs.

      Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
      For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
            1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default). This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise COS
            \ "private"
            2  / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise IBM COS
            \ "public-read"
            3 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), On-Premise IBM COS
            \ "public-read-write"
            4  / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access. Not supported on Buckets. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra) and On-Premise IBM COS
            \ "authenticated-read"
      acl> 1

   12. Review the displayed configuration and accept to save the "remote" then quit.  The config file should look like this

           [xxx]
           type = s3
           Provider = IBMCOS
           access_key_id = xxx
           secret_access_key = yyy
           endpoint = s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net
           location_constraint = us-standard
           acl = private

   13. Execute rclone commands

           1)  Create a bucket.
               rclone mkdir IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
           2)  List available buckets.
               rclone lsd IBM-COS-XREGION:
               -1 2017-11-08 21:16:22        -1 test
               -1 2018-02-14 20:16:39        -1 newbucket
           3)  List contents of a bucket.
               rclone ls IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
               18685952 test.exe
           4)  Copy a file from local to remote.
               rclone copy /Users/file.txt IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
           5)  Copy a file from remote to local.
               rclone copy IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket/file.txt .
           6)  Delete a file on remote.
               rclone delete IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket/file.txt

IDrive e2

   Here is an example of making an IDrive e2 (https://www.idrive.com/e2/) configuration.  First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n

          Enter name for new remote.
          name> e2

          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
             \ (s3)
          [snip]
          Storage> s3

          Option provider.
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
          [snip]
          XX / IDrive e2
             \ (IDrive)
          [snip]
          provider> IDrive

          Option env_auth.
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth>

          Option access_key_id.
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY

          Option secret_access_key.
          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY

          Option acl.
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
          This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           1 | No one else has access rights (default).
             \ (private)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           2 | The AllUsers group gets READ access.
             \ (public-read)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           3 | The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
             | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
             \ (public-read-write)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           4 | The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
             \ (authenticated-read)
             / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           5 | Bucket owner gets READ access.
             | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
             \ (bucket-owner-read)
             / Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.
           6 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
             \ (bucket-owner-full-control)
          acl>

          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n>

          Configuration complete.
          Options:
          - type: s3
          - provider: IDrive
          - access_key_id: YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
          - secret_access_key: YOUR_SECRET_KEY
          - endpoint: q9d9.la12.idrivee2-5.com
          Keep this "e2" remote?
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

IONOS Cloud

   IONOS  S3 Object Storage (https://cloud.ionos.com/storage/object-storage) is a service offered by IONOS for storing and accessing unstructured data.  To con
   nect to the service, you will need an access key and a secret key.  These can be found in the Data Center  Designer  (https://dcd.ionos.com/),  by  selecting
   Manager resources > Object Storage Key Manager.

   Here  is  an  example of a configuration.  First, run rclone config.  This will walk you through an interactive setup process.  Type n to add the new remote,
   and then enter a name:

          Enter name for new remote.
          name> ionos-fra

   Type s3 to choose the connection type:

          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, IONOS Cloud, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
             \ (s3)
          [snip]
          Storage> s3

   Type IONOS:

          Option provider.
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
          [snip]
          XX / IONOS Cloud
             \ (IONOS)
          [snip]
          provider> IONOS

   Press Enter to choose the default option Enter AWS credentials in the next step:

          Option env_auth.
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth>

   Enter your Access Key and Secret key.  These can be retrieved in the Data Center Designer (https://dcd.ionos.com/), click on the menu Manager  resources  /
   "Object Storage Key Manager".

          Option access_key_id.
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY

          Option secret_access_key.
          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY

   Choose the region where your bucket is located:

          Option region.
          Region where your bucket will be created and your data stored.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Frankfurt, Germany
             \ (de)
           2 / Berlin, Germany
             \ (eu-central-2)
           3 / Logrono, Spain
             \ (eu-south-2)
          region> 2

   Choose the endpoint from the same region:

          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint for IONOS S3 Object Storage.
          Specify the endpoint from the same region.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Frankfurt, Germany
             \ (s3-eu-central-1.ionoscloud.com)
           2 / Berlin, Germany
             \ (s3-eu-central-2.ionoscloud.com)
           3 / Logrono, Spain
             \ (s3-eu-south-2.ionoscloud.com)
          endpoint> 1

   Press Enter to choose the default option or choose the desired ACL setting:

          Option acl.
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
          This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           1 | No one else has access rights (default).
             \ (private)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
          [snip]
          acl>

   Press Enter to skip the advanced config:

          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n>

   Press Enter to save the configuration, and then q to quit the configuration process:

          Configuration complete.
          Options:
          - type: s3
          - provider: IONOS
          - access_key_id: YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
          - secret_access_key: YOUR_SECRET_KEY
          - endpoint: s3-eu-central-1.ionoscloud.com
          Keep this "ionos-fra" remote?
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Done!  Now you can try some commands (for macOS, use ./rclone instead of rclone).

   1) Create a bucket (the name must be unique within the whole IONOS S3)

      rclone mkdir ionos-fra:my-bucket

   2) List available buckets

      rclone lsd ionos-fra:

   4) Copy a file from local to remote

      rclone copy /Users/file.txt ionos-fra:my-bucket

   3) List contents of a bucket

      rclone ls ionos-fra:my-bucket

   5) Copy a file from remote to local

      rclone copy ionos-fra:my-bucket/file.txt

Minio

   Minio (https://minio.io/) is an object storage server built for cloud application developers and devops.

   It is very easy to install and provides an S3 compatible server which can be used by rclone.

   To use it, install Minio following the instructions here (https://docs.minio.io/docs/minio-quickstart-guide).

   When it configures itself Minio will print something like this

          Endpoint:  http://192.168.1.106:9000  http://172.23.0.1:9000
          AccessKey: USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
          SecretKey: MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
          Region:    us-east-1
          SQS ARNs:  arn:minio:sqs:us-east-1:1:redis arn:minio:sqs:us-east-1:2:redis

          Browser Access:
             http://192.168.1.106:9000  http://172.23.0.1:9000

          Command-line Access: https://docs.minio.io/docs/minio-client-quickstart-guide
             $ mc config host add myminio http://192.168.1.106:9000 USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03

          Object API (Amazon S3 compatible):
             Go:         https://docs.minio.io/docs/golang-client-quickstart-guide
             Java:       https://docs.minio.io/docs/java-client-quickstart-guide
             Python:     https://docs.minio.io/docs/python-client-quickstart-guide
             JavaScript: https://docs.minio.io/docs/javascript-client-quickstart-guide
             .NET:       https://docs.minio.io/docs/dotnet-client-quickstart-guide

          Drive Capacity: 26 GiB Free, 165 GiB Total

   These details need to go into rclone config like this.  Note that it is important to put the region in as stated above.

          env_auth> 1
          access_key_id> USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
          secret_access_key> MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
          region> us-east-1
          endpoint> http://192.168.1.106:9000
          location_constraint>
          server_side_encryption>

   Which makes the config file look like this

          [minio]
          type = s3
          provider = Minio
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
          secret_access_key = MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
          region = us-east-1
          endpoint = http://192.168.1.106:9000
          location_constraint =
          server_side_encryption =

   So once set up, for example, to copy files into a bucket

          rclone copy /path/to/files minio:bucket

Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo)

   Qiniu  Cloud  Object Storage (Kodo) (https://www.qiniu.com/en/products/kodo), a completely independent-researched core technology which is proven by repeated
   customer experience has occupied absolute leading market leader position.  Kodo can be widely applied to mass data management.

   To configure access to Qiniu Kodo, follow the steps below:

   1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.

      rclone config
      No remotes found, make a new one?
      n) New remote
      s) Set configuration password
      q) Quit config
      n/s/q> n

   2. Give the name of the configuration.  For example, name it 'qiniu'.

      name> qiniu

   3. Select s3 storage.

      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / 1Fichier
         \ (fichier)
       2 / Akamai NetStorage
         \ (netstorage)
       3 / Alias for an existing remote
         \ (alias)
       4 / Amazon Drive
         \ (amazon cloud drive)
       5 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, Liara, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS, Qiniu and Wasabi
         \ (s3)
      [snip]
      Storage> s3

   4. Select Qiniu provider.

      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
      1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
         \ "AWS"
      [snip]
      22 / Qiniu Object Storage (Kodo)
         \ (Qiniu)
      [snip]
      provider> Qiniu

   5. Enter your SecretId and SecretKey of Qiniu Kodo.

      Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
      Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
      Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
         \ "false"
       2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
         \ "true"
      env_auth> 1
      AWS Access Key ID.
      Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      access_key_id> AKIDxxxxxxxxxx
      AWS Secret Access Key (password)
      Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      secret_access_key> xxxxxxxxxxx

   6. Select endpoint for Qiniu Kodo.  This is the standard endpoint for different region.

         / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
       1 | East China Region 1.
         | Needs location constraint cn-east-1.
         \ (cn-east-1)
         / East China Region 2.
       2 | Needs location constraint cn-east-2.
         \ (cn-east-2)
         / North China Region 1.
       3 | Needs location constraint cn-north-1.
         \ (cn-north-1)
         / South China Region 1.
       4 | Needs location constraint cn-south-1.
         \ (cn-south-1)
         / North America Region.
       5 | Needs location constraint us-north-1.
         \ (us-north-1)
         / Southeast Asia Region 1.
       6 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.
         \ (ap-southeast-1)
         / Northeast Asia Region 1.
       7 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.
         \ (ap-northeast-1)
      [snip]
      endpoint> 1

      Option endpoint.
      Endpoint for Qiniu Object Storage.
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
      Press Enter to leave empty.
       1 / East China Endpoint 1
         \ (s3-cn-east-1.qiniucs.com)
       2 / East China Endpoint 2
         \ (s3-cn-east-2.qiniucs.com)
       3 / North China Endpoint 1
         \ (s3-cn-north-1.qiniucs.com)
       4 / South China Endpoint 1
         \ (s3-cn-south-1.qiniucs.com)
       5 / North America Endpoint 1
         \ (s3-us-north-1.qiniucs.com)
       6 / Southeast Asia Endpoint 1
         \ (s3-ap-southeast-1.qiniucs.com)
       7 / Northeast Asia Endpoint 1
         \ (s3-ap-northeast-1.qiniucs.com)
      endpoint> 1

      Option location_constraint.
      Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
      Used when creating buckets only.
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
      Press Enter to leave empty.
       1 / East China Region 1
         \ (cn-east-1)
       2 / East China Region 2
         \ (cn-east-2)
       3 / North China Region 1
         \ (cn-north-1)
       4 / South China Region 1
         \ (cn-south-1)
       5 / North America Region 1
         \ (us-north-1)
       6 / Southeast Asia Region 1
         \ (ap-southeast-1)
       7 / Northeast Asia Region 1
         \ (ap-northeast-1)
      location_constraint> 1

   7. Choose acl and storage class.

      Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
      doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
         / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
       1 | No one else has access rights (default).
         \ (private)
         / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
       2 | The AllUsers group gets READ access.
         \ (public-read)
      [snip]
      acl> 2
      The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / Standard storage class
         \ (STANDARD)
       2 / Infrequent access storage mode
         \ (LINE)
       3 / Archive storage mode
         \ (GLACIER)
       4 / Deep archive storage mode
         \ (DEEP_ARCHIVE)
      [snip]
      storage_class> 1
      Edit advanced config? (y/n)
      y) Yes
      n) No (default)
      y/n> n
      Remote config
      --------------------
      [qiniu]
      - type: s3
      - provider: Qiniu
      - access_key_id: xxx
      - secret_access_key: xxx
      - region: cn-east-1
      - endpoint: s3-cn-east-1.qiniucs.com
      - location_constraint: cn-east-1
      - acl: public-read
      - storage_class: STANDARD
      --------------------
      y) Yes this is OK (default)
      e) Edit this remote
      d) Delete this remote
      y/e/d> y
      Current remotes:

      Name                 Type
      ====                 ====
      qiniu                s3

RackCorp

   RackCorp Object Storage (https://www.rackcorp.com/storage/s3storage) is an S3 compatible object storage platform from your friendly cloud provider  RackCorp.
   The service is fast, reliable, well priced and located in many strategic locations unserviced by others, to ensure you can maintain data sovereignty.

   Before  you  can  use RackCorp Object Storage, you'll need to "sign up (https://www.rackcorp.com/signup)" for an account on our "portal (https://portal.rack‐
   corp.com)".  Next you can create an access key, a secret key and buckets, in your location of choice with ease.  These details  are  required  for  the  next
   steps of configuration, when rclone config asks for your access_key_id and secret_access_key.

   Your config should end up looking a bit like this:

          [RCS3-demo-config]
          type = s3
          provider = RackCorp
          env_auth = true
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          region = au-nsw
          endpoint = s3.rackcorp.com
          location_constraint = au-nsw

Scaleway

   Scaleway  (https://www.scaleway.com/object-storage/)  The Object Storage platform allows you to store anything from backups, logs and web assets to documents
   and photos.  Files can be dropped from the Scaleway console or transferred through our API and CLI or using any S3-compatible tool.

   Scaleway provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this:

          [scaleway]
          type = s3
          provider = Scaleway
          env_auth = false
          endpoint = s3.nl-ams.scw.cloud
          access_key_id = SCWXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
          secret_access_key = 1111111-2222-3333-44444-55555555555555
          region = nl-ams
          location_constraint =
          acl = private
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

   C14 Cold Storage (https://www.online.net/en/storage/c14-cold-storage) is the low-cost S3 Glacier alternative from Scaleway and it works the same way as on S3
   by  accepting the "GLACIER" storage_class.  So you can configure your remote with the storage_class = GLACIER option to upload directly to C14.  Don't forget
   that in this state you can't read files back after, you will need to restore them to "STANDARD" storage_class first before being able to read them (see  "re‐
   store" section above)

Seagate Lyve Cloud

   Seagate  Lyve  Cloud  (https://www.seagate.com/gb/en/services/cloud/storage/) is an S3 compatible object storage platform from Seagate (https://seagate.com/)
   intended for enterprise use.

   Here is a config run through for a remote called remote - you may choose a different name of course.  Note that to create an access key and  secret  key  you
   will need to create a service account first.

          $ rclone config
          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote

   Choose s3 backend

          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Liara, Lyve Cloud, Minio, RackCorp, SeaweedFS, and Tencent COS
             \ (s3)
          [snip]
          Storage> s3

   Choose LyveCloud as S3 provider

          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
          [snip]
          XX / Seagate Lyve Cloud
             \ (LyveCloud)
          [snip]
          provider> LyveCloud

   Take the default (just press enter) to enter access key and secret in the config file.

          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth>

          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> XXX

          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> YYY

   Leave region blank

          Region to connect to.
          Leave blank if you are using an S3 clone and you don't have a region.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / Use this if unsure.
           1 | Will use v4 signatures and an empty region.
             \ ()
             / Use this only if v4 signatures don't work.
           2 | E.g. pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.
             \ (other-v2-signature)
          region>

   Choose an endpoint from the list

          Endpoint for S3 API.
          Required when using an S3 clone.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Seagate Lyve Cloud US East 1 (Virginia)
             \ (s3.us-east-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com)
           2 / Seagate Lyve Cloud US West 1 (California)
             \ (s3.us-west-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com)
           3 / Seagate Lyve Cloud AP Southeast 1 (Singapore)
             \ (s3.ap-southeast-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com)
          endpoint> 1

   Leave location constraint blank

          Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
          Leave blank if not sure. Used when creating buckets only.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          location_constraint>

   Choose default ACL (private).

          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
          This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           1 | No one else has access rights (default).
             \ (private)
          [snip]
          acl>

   And the config file should end up looking like this:

          [remote]
          type = s3
          provider = LyveCloud
          access_key_id = XXX
          secret_access_key = YYY
          endpoint = s3.us-east-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com

SeaweedFS

   SeaweedFS (https://github.com/chrislusf/seaweedfs/) is a distributed storage system for blobs, objects, files, and data lake, with O(1) disk seek and a scal
   able file metadata store.  It has an S3 compatible object storage interface.  SeaweedFS can also act as a  gateway  to  remote  S3  compatible  object  store
   (https://github.com/chrislusf/seaweedfs/wiki/Gateway-to-Remote-Object-Storage)  to cache data and metadata with asynchronous write back, for fast local speed
   and minimize access cost.

   Assuming the SeaweedFS are configured with weed shell as such:

          > s3.bucket.create -name foo
          > s3.configure -access_key=any -secret_key=any -buckets=foo -user=me -actions=Read,Write,List,Tagging,Admin -apply
          {
            "identities": [
              {
                "name": "me",
                "credentials": [
                  {
                    "accessKey": "any",
                    "secretKey": "any"
                  }
                ],
                "actions": [
                  "Read:foo",
                  "Write:foo",
                  "List:foo",
                  "Tagging:foo",
                  "Admin:foo"
                ]
              }
            ]
          }

   To use rclone with SeaweedFS, above configuration should end up with something like this in your config:

          [seaweedfs_s3]
          type = s3
          provider = SeaweedFS
          access_key_id = any
          secret_access_key = any
          endpoint = localhost:8333

   So once set up, for example to copy files into a bucket

          rclone copy /path/to/files seaweedfs_s3:foo

Wasabi

   Wasabi (https://wasabi.com) is a cloud-based object storage service for a broad range of applications and use cases.  Wasabi is designed for individuals  and
   organizations that require a high-performance, reliable, and secure data storage infrastructure at minimal cost.

   Wasabi provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          n/s> n
          name> wasabi
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 (also Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Minio, Liara)
             \ "s3"
          [snip]
          Storage> s3
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          access_key_id> YOURACCESSKEY
          AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          secret_access_key> YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          Region to connect to.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
             / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
           1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
             | Leave location constraint empty.
             \ "us-east-1"
          [snip]
          region> us-east-1
          Endpoint for S3 API.
          Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.
          Specify if using an S3 clone such as Ceph.
          endpoint> s3.wasabisys.com
          Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
             \ ""
          [snip]
          location_constraint>
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
             \ "private"
          [snip]
          acl>
          The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / None
             \ ""
           2 / AES256
             \ "AES256"
          server_side_encryption>
          The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
           2 / Standard storage class
             \ "STANDARD"
           3 / Reduced redundancy storage class
             \ "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
           4 / Standard Infrequent Access storage class
             \ "STANDARD_IA"
          storage_class>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [wasabi]
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          region = us-east-1
          endpoint = s3.wasabisys.com
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This will leave the config file looking like this.

          [wasabi]
          type = s3
          provider = Wasabi
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          region =
          endpoint = s3.wasabisys.com
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

Alibaba OSS

   Here is an example of making an Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) OSS (https://www.alibabacloud.com/product/oss/) configuration.  First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> oss
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
           4 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Liara, Minio, and Tencent COS
             \ "s3"
          [snip]
          Storage> s3
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
             \ "AWS"
           2 / Alibaba Cloud Object Storage System (OSS) formerly Aliyun
             \ "Alibaba"
           3 / Ceph Object Storage
             \ "Ceph"
          [snip]
          provider> Alibaba
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          access_key_id> accesskeyid
          AWS Secret Access Key (password)
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          secret_access_key> secretaccesskey
          Endpoint for OSS API.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / East China 1 (Hangzhou)
             \ "oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com"
           2 / East China 2 (Shanghai)
             \ "oss-cn-shanghai.aliyuncs.com"
           3 / North China 1 (Qingdao)
             \ "oss-cn-qingdao.aliyuncs.com"
          [snip]
          endpoint> 1
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.

          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
             \ "private"
           2 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
             \ "public-read"
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
          [snip]
          acl> 1
          The storage class to use when storing new objects in OSS.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
           2 / Standard storage class
             \ "STANDARD"
           3 / Archive storage mode.
             \ "GLACIER"
           4 / Infrequent access storage mode.
             \ "STANDARD_IA"
          storage_class> 1
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [oss]
          type = s3
          provider = Alibaba
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = accesskeyid
          secret_access_key = secretaccesskey
          endpoint = oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com
          acl = private
          storage_class = Standard
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

   Here  is  an  example  of making an China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS) (https:///ecloud.10086.cn/home/product-introduction/eos/) configuration.
   First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> ChinaMobile
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
           ...
           5 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, RackCorp, SeaweedFS, and Tencent COS
             \ (s3)
           ...
          Storage> s3
          Option provider.
          Choose your S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           ...
           4 / China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)
             \ (ChinaMobile)
           ...
          provider> ChinaMobile
          Option env_auth.
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth>
          Option access_key_id.
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> accesskeyid
          Option secret_access_key.
          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> secretaccesskey
          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint for China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS) API.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
           1 | East China (Suzhou)
             \ (eos-wuxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
           2 / East China (Jinan)
             \ (eos-jinan-1.cmecloud.cn)
           3 / East China (Hangzhou)
             \ (eos-ningbo-1.cmecloud.cn)
           4 / East China (Shanghai-1)
             \ (eos-shanghai-1.cmecloud.cn)
           5 / Central China (Zhengzhou)
             \ (eos-zhengzhou-1.cmecloud.cn)
           6 / Central China (Changsha-1)
             \ (eos-hunan-1.cmecloud.cn)
           7 / Central China (Changsha-2)
             \ (eos-zhuzhou-1.cmecloud.cn)
           8 / South China (Guangzhou-2)
             \ (eos-guangzhou-1.cmecloud.cn)
           9 / South China (Guangzhou-3)
             \ (eos-dongguan-1.cmecloud.cn)
          10 / North China (Beijing-1)
             \ (eos-beijing-1.cmecloud.cn)
          11 / North China (Beijing-2)
             \ (eos-beijing-2.cmecloud.cn)
          12 / North China (Beijing-3)
             \ (eos-beijing-4.cmecloud.cn)
          13 / North China (Huhehaote)
             \ (eos-huhehaote-1.cmecloud.cn)
          14 / Southwest China (Chengdu)
             \ (eos-chengdu-1.cmecloud.cn)
          15 / Southwest China (Chongqing)
             \ (eos-chongqing-1.cmecloud.cn)
          16 / Southwest China (Guiyang)
             \ (eos-guiyang-1.cmecloud.cn)
          17 / Nouthwest China (Xian)
             \ (eos-xian-1.cmecloud.cn)
          18 / Yunnan China (Kunming)
             \ (eos-yunnan.cmecloud.cn)
          19 / Yunnan China (Kunming-2)
             \ (eos-yunnan-2.cmecloud.cn)
          20 / Tianjin China (Tianjin)
             \ (eos-tianjin-1.cmecloud.cn)
          21 / Jilin China (Changchun)
             \ (eos-jilin-1.cmecloud.cn)
          22 / Hubei China (Xiangyan)
             \ (eos-hubei-1.cmecloud.cn)
          23 / Jiangxi China (Nanchang)
             \ (eos-jiangxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
          24 / Gansu China (Lanzhou)
             \ (eos-gansu-1.cmecloud.cn)
          25 / Shanxi China (Taiyuan)
             \ (eos-shanxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
          26 / Liaoning China (Shenyang)
             \ (eos-liaoning-1.cmecloud.cn)
          27 / Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)
             \ (eos-hebei-1.cmecloud.cn)
          28 / Fujian China (Xiamen)
             \ (eos-fujian-1.cmecloud.cn)
          29 / Guangxi China (Nanning)
             \ (eos-guangxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
          30 / Anhui China (Huainan)
             \ (eos-anhui-1.cmecloud.cn)
          endpoint> 1
          Option location_constraint.
          Location constraint - must match endpoint.
          Used when creating buckets only.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / East China (Suzhou)
             \ (wuxi1)
           2 / East China (Jinan)
             \ (jinan1)
           3 / East China (Hangzhou)
             \ (ningbo1)
           4 / East China (Shanghai-1)
             \ (shanghai1)
           5 / Central China (Zhengzhou)
             \ (zhengzhou1)
           6 / Central China (Changsha-1)
             \ (hunan1)
           7 / Central China (Changsha-2)
             \ (zhuzhou1)
           8 / South China (Guangzhou-2)
             \ (guangzhou1)
           9 / South China (Guangzhou-3)
             \ (dongguan1)
          10 / North China (Beijing-1)
             \ (beijing1)
          11 / North China (Beijing-2)
             \ (beijing2)
          12 / North China (Beijing-3)
             \ (beijing4)
          13 / North China (Huhehaote)
             \ (huhehaote1)
          14 / Southwest China (Chengdu)
             \ (chengdu1)
          15 / Southwest China (Chongqing)
             \ (chongqing1)
          16 / Southwest China (Guiyang)
             \ (guiyang1)
          17 / Nouthwest China (Xian)
             \ (xian1)
          18 / Yunnan China (Kunming)
             \ (yunnan)
          19 / Yunnan China (Kunming-2)
             \ (yunnan2)
          20 / Tianjin China (Tianjin)
             \ (tianjin1)
          21 / Jilin China (Changchun)
             \ (jilin1)
          22 / Hubei China (Xiangyan)
             \ (hubei1)
          23 / Jiangxi China (Nanchang)
             \ (jiangxi1)
          24 / Gansu China (Lanzhou)
             \ (gansu1)
          25 / Shanxi China (Taiyuan)
             \ (shanxi1)
          26 / Liaoning China (Shenyang)
             \ (liaoning1)
          27 / Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)
             \ (hebei1)
          28 / Fujian China (Xiamen)
             \ (fujian1)
          29 / Guangxi China (Nanning)
             \ (guangxi1)
          30 / Anhui China (Huainan)
             \ (anhui1)
          location_constraint> 1
          Option acl.
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
          This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           1 | No one else has access rights (default).
             \ (private)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           2 | The AllUsers group gets READ access.
             \ (public-read)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           3 | The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
             | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
             \ (public-read-write)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           4 | The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
             \ (authenticated-read)
             / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
          acl> private
          Option server_side_encryption.
          The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / None
             \ ()
           2 / AES256
             \ (AES256)
          server_side_encryption>
          Option storage_class.
          The storage class to use when storing new objects in ChinaMobile.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Default
             \ ()
           2 / Standard storage class
             \ (STANDARD)
           3 / Archive storage mode
             \ (GLACIER)
           4 / Infrequent access storage mode
             \ (STANDARD_IA)
          storage_class>
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          [ChinaMobile]
          type = s3
          provider = ChinaMobile
          access_key_id = accesskeyid
          secret_access_key = secretaccesskey
          endpoint = eos-wuxi-1.cmecloud.cn
          location_constraint = wuxi1
          acl = private
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Liara

   Here is an example of making a Liara Object Storage (https://liara.ir/landing/object-storage) configuration.  First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          n/s> n
          name> Liara
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 (also Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Liara, Minio)
             \ "s3"
          [snip]
          Storage> s3
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          access_key_id> YOURACCESSKEY
          AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          secret_access_key> YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          Region to connect to.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
             / The default endpoint
           1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
             | Leave location constraint empty.
             \ "us-east-1"
          [snip]
          region>
          Endpoint for S3 API.
          Leave blank if using Liara to use the default endpoint for the region.
          Specify if using an S3 clone such as Ceph.
          endpoint> storage.iran.liara.space
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
             \ "private"
          [snip]
          acl>
          The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / None
             \ ""
           2 / AES256
             \ "AES256"
          server_side_encryption>
          The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
           2 / Standard storage class
             \ "STANDARD"
          storage_class>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [Liara]
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          endpoint = storage.iran.liara.space
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This will leave the config file looking like this.

          [Liara]
          type = s3
          provider = Liara
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          region =
          endpoint = storage.iran.liara.space
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

ArvanCloud

   ArvanCloud (https://www.arvancloud.com/en/products/cloud-storage) ArvanCloud Object Storage goes beyond the limited traditional file storage.  It  gives  you
   access to backup and archived files and allows sharing.  Files like profile image in the app, images sent by users or scanned documents can be stored secure
   ly and easily in our Object Storage service.

   ArvanCloud provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          n/s> n
          name> ArvanCloud
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Amazon S3 (also Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Liara, Minio)
             \ "s3"
          [snip]
          Storage> s3
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          access_key_id> YOURACCESSKEY
          AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          secret_access_key> YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          Region to connect to.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
             / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
           1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
             | Leave location constraint empty.
             \ "us-east-1"
          [snip]
          region>
          Endpoint for S3 API.
          Leave blank if using ArvanCloud to use the default endpoint for the region.
          Specify if using an S3 clone such as Ceph.
          endpoint> s3.arvanstorage.com
          Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Empty for Iran-Tehran Region.
             \ ""
          [snip]
          location_constraint>
          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
             \ "private"
          [snip]
          acl>
          The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / None
             \ ""
           2 / AES256
             \ "AES256"
          server_side_encryption>
          The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
           2 / Standard storage class
             \ "STANDARD"
          storage_class>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [ArvanCloud]
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          region = ir-thr-at1
          endpoint = s3.arvanstorage.com
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This will leave the config file looking like this.

          [ArvanCloud]
          type = s3
          provider = ArvanCloud
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
          secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
          region =
          endpoint = s3.arvanstorage.com
          location_constraint =
          acl =
          server_side_encryption =
          storage_class =

Tencent COS

   Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS) (https://intl.cloud.tencent.com/product/cos) is a distributed storage service offered by Tencent  Cloud  for  unstructured
   data.  It is secure, stable, massive, convenient, low-delay and low-cost.

   To configure access to Tencent COS, follow the steps below:

   1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.

      rclone config
      No remotes found, make a new one?
      n) New remote
      s) Set configuration password
      q) Quit config
      n/s/q> n

   2. Give the name of the configuration.  For example, name it 'cos'.

      name> cos

   3. Select s3 storage.

      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
      1 / 1Fichier
         \ "fichier"
       2 / Alias for an existing remote
         \ "alias"
       3 / Amazon Drive
         \ "amazon cloud drive"
       4 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, DigitalOcean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Liara, Minio, and Tencent COS
         \ "s3"
      [snip]
      Storage> s3

   4. Select TencentCOS provider.

      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
      1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
         \ "AWS"
      [snip]
      11 / Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)
         \ "TencentCOS"
      [snip]
      provider> TencentCOS

   5. Enter your SecretId and SecretKey of Tencent Cloud.

      Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
      Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
      Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
         \ "false"
       2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
         \ "true"
      env_auth> 1
      AWS Access Key ID.
      Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      access_key_id> AKIDxxxxxxxxxx
      AWS Secret Access Key (password)
      Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      secret_access_key> xxxxxxxxxxx

   6. Select endpoint for Tencent COS.  This is the standard endpoint for different region.

       1 / Beijing Region.
         \ "cos.ap-beijing.myqcloud.com"
       2 / Nanjing Region.
         \ "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"
       3 / Shanghai Region.
         \ "cos.ap-shanghai.myqcloud.com"
       4 / Guangzhou Region.
         \ "cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com"
      [snip]
      endpoint> 4

   7. Choose acl and storage class.

      Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
      doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / Owner gets Full_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
         \ "default"
      [snip]
      acl> 1
      The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / Default
         \ ""
      [snip]
      storage_class> 1
      Edit advanced config? (y/n)
      y) Yes
      n) No (default)
      y/n> n
      Remote config
      --------------------
      [cos]
      type = s3
      provider = TencentCOS
      env_auth = false
      access_key_id = xxx
      secret_access_key = xxx
      endpoint = cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com
      acl = default
      --------------------
      y) Yes this is OK (default)
      e) Edit this remote
      d) Delete this remote
      y/e/d> y
      Current remotes:

      Name                 Type
      ====                 ====
      cos                  s3

Netease NOS

   For  Netease NOS configure as per the configurator rclone config setting the provider Netease.  This will automatically set force_path_style = false which is
   necessary for it to run properly.

Storj

   Storj is a decentralized cloud storage which can be used through its native protocol or an S3 compatible gateway.

   The S3 compatible gateway is configured using rclone config with a type of s3 and with a provider name of Storj.  Here is an example run of the configurator.

          Type of storage to configure.
          Storage> s3
          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
          Press Enter for the default (false).
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
             \ (false)
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
             \ (true)
          env_auth> 1
          Option access_key_id.
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> XXXX (as shown when creating the access grant)
          Option secret_access_key.
          AWS Secret Access Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> XXXX (as shown when creating the access grant)
          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint of the Shared Gateway.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / EU1 Shared Gateway
             \ (gateway.eu1.storjshare.io)
           2 / US1 Shared Gateway
             \ (gateway.us1.storjshare.io)
           3 / Asia-Pacific Shared Gateway
             \ (gateway.ap1.storjshare.io)
          endpoint> 1 (as shown when creating the access grant)
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n

   Note that s3 credentials are generated when you create an access grant (https://docs.storj.io/dcs/api-reference/s3-compatible-gateway#usage).

Backend quirks

    --chunk-size is forced to be 64 MiB or greater.  This will use more memory than the default of 5 MiB.

    Server side copy is disabled as it isn't currently supported in the gateway.

    GetTier and SetTier are not supported.

Backend bugs

   Due to issue #39 (https://github.com/storj/gateway-mt/issues/39) uploading multipart files via the S3 gateway  causes  them  to  lose  their  metadata.   For
   rclone's purpose this means that the modification time is not stored, nor is any MD5SUM (if one is available from the source).

   This has the following consequences:

   • Using rclone rcat will fail as the medatada doesn't match after upload

    Uploading files with rclone mount will fail for the same reason

      This can worked around by using --vfs-cache-mode writes or --vfs-cache-mode full or setting --s3-upload-cutoff large

    Files uploaded via a multipart upload won't have their modtimes

      This will mean that rclone sync will likely keep trying to upload files bigger than --s3-upload-cutoff

      This can be worked around with --checksum or --size-only or setting --s3-upload-cutoff large

      The maximum value for --s3-upload-cutoff is 5GiB though

   One  general purpose workaround is to set --s3-upload-cutoff 5G.  This means that rclone will upload files smaller than 5GiB as single parts.  Note that this
   can be set in the config file with upload_cutoff = 5G or configured in the advanced settings.  If you regularly transfer files  larger  than  5G  then  using
   --checksum or --size-only in rclone sync is the recommended workaround.

Comparison with the native protocol

   Use  the  the native protocol to take advantage of client-side encryption as well as to achieve the best possible download performance.  Uploads will be era
   sure-coded locally, thus a 1gb upload will result in 2.68gb of data being uploaded to storage nodes across the network.

   Use this backend and the S3 compatible Hosted Gateway to increase upload performance and reduce the load on your systems and network.  Uploads  will  be  en
   crypted and erasure-coded server-side, thus a 1GB upload will result in only in 1GB of data being uploaded to storage nodes across the network.

   For more detailed comparison please check the documentation of the storj backend.

Limitations

   rclone  about  is  not supported by the S3 backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most
   free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Backblaze B2

   B2 is Backblaze's cloud storage system (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/).

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a b2 configuration.  First run

          rclone config

   This  will  guide you through an interactive setup process.  To authenticate you will either need your Account ID (a short hex number) and Master Application
   Key (a long hex number) OR an Application Key, which is the recommended method.  See below for further details on generating and using an Application Key.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          q) Quit config
          n/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Backblaze B2
             \ "b2"
          [snip]
          Storage> b2
          Account ID or Application Key ID
          account> 123456789abc
          Application Key
          key> 0123456789abcdef0123456789abcdef0123456789
          Endpoint for the service - leave blank normally.
          endpoint>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          account = 123456789abc
          key = 0123456789abcdef0123456789abcdef0123456789
          endpoint =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all buckets

          rclone lsd remote:

   Create a new bucket

          rclone mkdir remote:bucket

   List the contents of a bucket

          rclone ls remote:bucket

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:bucket

Application Keys

   B2 supports multiple Application Keys for different access permission to B2 Buckets (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/docs/application_keys.html).

   You can use these with rclone too; you will need to use rclone version 1.43 or later.

   Follow Backblaze's docs to create an Application Key with the required permission and add the applicationKeyId as the account and the Application Key  itself
   as the key.

   Note that you must put the applicationKeyId as the account – you can't use the master Account ID.  If you try then B2 will return 401 errors.

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

Modified time

   The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as X-Bz-Info-src_last_modified_millis as milliseconds since 1970-01-01 in the Backblaze standard.  Oth
   er tools should be able to use this as a modified time.

   Modified times are used in syncing and are fully supported.  Note that if a modification time needs to be updated on an object then it will create a new ver
   sion of the object.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

   Note that in 2020-05 Backblaze started allowing  characters in file names.  Rclone hasn't changed its encoding as  this  could  cause  syncs  to  re-transfer
   files.  If you want rclone not to replace  then see the --b2-encoding flag below and remove the BackSlash from the string.  This can be set in the config.

SHA1 checksums

   The SHA1 checksums of the files are checked on upload and download and will be used in the syncing process.

   Large  files  (bigger  than the limit in --b2-upload-cutoff) which are uploaded in chunks will store their SHA1 on the object as X-Bz-Info-large_file_sha1 as
   recommended by Backblaze.

   For a large file to be uploaded with an SHA1 checksum, the source needs to support SHA1 checksums.  The local disk supports  SHA1  checksums  so  large  file
   transfers from local disk will have an SHA1.  See the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#features) for exactly which remotes support SHA1.

   Sources  which  don't  support  SHA1,  in  particular  crypt  will  upload  large  files  without SHA1 checksums.  This may be fixed in the future (see #1767
   (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1767)).

   Files sizes below --b2-upload-cutoff will always have an SHA1 regardless of the source.

Transfers

   Backblaze recommends that you do lots of transfers simultaneously for maximum speed.  In tests from my SSD equipped  laptop  the  optimum  setting  is  about
   --transfers 32 though higher numbers may be used for a slight speed improvement.  The optimum number for you may vary depending on your hardware, how big the
   files are, how much you want to load your computer, etc.  The default of --transfers 4 is definitely too low for Backblaze B2 though.

   Note that uploading big files (bigger than 200 MiB by default) will use a 96 MiB RAM buffer by default.  There can be at most --transfers of these in use  at
   any moment, so this sets the upper limit on the memory used.

Versions

   When  rclone uploads a new version of a file it creates a new version of it (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/docs/file_versions.html).  Likewise when you delete
   a file, the old version will be marked hidden and still be available.  Conversely, you may opt in to a "hard delete" of files with the --b2-hard-delete  flag
   which would permanently remove the file instead of hiding it.

   Old versions of files, where available, are visible using the --b2-versions flag.

   It  is also possible to view a bucket as it was at a certain point in time, using the --b2-version-at flag.  This will show the file versions as they were at
   that time, showing files that have been deleted afterwards, and hiding files that were created since.

   If you wish to remove all the old versions then you can use the rclone cleanup remote:bucket command which will delete all the old versions of files, leaving
   the current ones intact.  You can also supply a path and only old versions under that path will be deleted, e.g.  rclone cleanup remote:bucket/path/to/stuff.

   Note that cleanup will remove partially uploaded files from the bucket if they are more than a day old.

   When you purge a bucket, the current and the old versions will be deleted then the bucket will be deleted.

   However delete will cause the current versions of the files to become hidden old versions.

   Here is a session showing the listing and retrieval of an old version followed by a cleanup of the old versions.

   Show current version and all the versions with --b2-versions flag.

          $ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

          $ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt
                  8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
                 16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
                 15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

   Retrieve an old version

          $ rclone -q --b2-versions copy b2:cleanup-test/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt /tmp

          $ ls -l /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
          -rw-rw-r-- 1 ncw ncw 16 Jul  2 17:46 /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt

   Clean up all the old versions and show that they've gone.

          $ rclone -q cleanup b2:cleanup-test

          $ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

          $ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

Data usage

   It is useful to know how many requests are sent to the server in different scenarios.

   All copy commands send the following 4 requests:

          /b2api/v1/b2_authorize_account
          /b2api/v1/b2_create_bucket
          /b2api/v1/b2_list_buckets
          /b2api/v1/b2_list_file_names

   The b2_list_file_names request will be sent once for every 1k files in the remote path, providing the checksum and modification time of the listed files.  As
   of version 1.33 issue #818 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/818) causes extra requests to be sent when using B2 with Crypt.  When  a  copy  operation
   does not require any files to be uploaded, no more requests will be sent.

   Uploading files that do not require chunking, will send 2 requests per file upload:

          /b2api/v1/b2_get_upload_url
          /b2api/v1/b2_upload_file/

   Uploading files requiring chunking, will send 2 requests (one each to start and finish the upload) and another 2 requests for each chunk:

          /b2api/v1/b2_start_large_file
          /b2api/v1/b2_get_upload_part_url
          /b2api/v1/b2_upload_part/
          /b2api/v1/b2_finish_large_file

Versions

   Versions can be viewed with the --b2-versions flag.  When it is set rclone will show and act on older versions of files.  For example

   Listing without --b2-versions

          $ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt

   And with

          $ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
                  9 one.txt
                  8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
                 16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
                 15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

   Showing  that  the current version is unchanged but older versions can be seen.  These have the UTC date that they were uploaded to the server to the nearest
   millisecond appended to them.

   Note that when using --b2-versions no file write operations are permitted, so you can't upload files or delete them.

B2 and rclone link

   Rclone supports generating file share links for private B2 buckets.  They can either be for a file for example:

          ./rclone link B2:bucket/path/to/file.txt
          https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/to/file.txt?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

   or if run on a directory you will get:

          ./rclone link B2:bucket/path
          https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

   you can then use the authorization token (the part of the url from the ?Authorization= on) on any file path under that directory.  For example:

          https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/to/file1?Authorization=xxxxxxxx
          https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/file2?Authorization=xxxxxxxx
          https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/folder/file3?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to b2 (Backblaze B2).

--b2-account

   Account ID or Application Key ID.

   Properties:

    Config: account

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ACCOUNT

    Type: string

    Required: true

--b2-key

   Application Key.

   Properties:

    Config: key

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: true

--b2-hard-delete

   Permanently delete files on remote removal, otherwise hide files.

   Properties:

    Config: hard_delete

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_HARD_DELETE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to b2 (Backblaze B2).

--b2-endpoint

   Endpoint for the service.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--b2-test-mode

   A flag string for X-Bz-Test-Mode header for debugging.

   This is for debugging purposes only.  Setting it to one of the strings below will cause b2 to return specific errors:

    "fail_some_uploads"

    "expire_some_account_authorization_tokens"

    "force_cap_exceeded"

   These will be set in the "X-Bz-Test-Mode" header which is documented in the b2 integrations  checklist  (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/docs/integration_check
   list.html).

   Properties:

    Config: test_mode

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_TEST_MODE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--b2-versions

   Include old versions in directory listings.

   Note that when using this no file write operations are permitted, so you can't upload files or delete them.

   Properties:

    Config: versions

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_VERSIONS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--b2-version-at

   Show file versions as they were at the specified time.

   Note that when using this no file write operations are permitted, so you can't upload files or delete them.

   Properties:

    Config: version_at

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_VERSION_AT

    Type: Time

    Default: off

--b2-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

   Files above this size will be uploaded in chunks of "--b2-chunk-size".

   This value should be set no larger than 4.657 GiB (== 5 GB).

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 200Mi

--b2-copy-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to multipart copy.

   Any files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be copied in chunks of this size.

   The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 4.6 GiB.

   Properties:

    Config: copy_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_COPY_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 4Gi

--b2-chunk-size

   Upload chunk size.

   When uploading large files, chunk the file into this size.

   Must fit in memory.  These chunks are buffered in memory and there might a maximum of "--transfers" chunks in progress at once.

   5,000,000 Bytes is the minimum size.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 96Mi

--b2-disable-checksum

   Disable checksums for large (> upload cutoff) files.

   Normally  rclone will calculate the SHA1 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for data integ
   rity checking but can cause long delays for large files to start uploading.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_checksum

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--b2-download-url

   Custom endpoint for downloads.

   This is usually set to a Cloudflare CDN URL as Backblaze offers free egress for data downloaded through the Cloudflare network.  Rclone  works  with  private
   buckets  by  sending  an  "Authorization"  header.  If the custom endpoint rewrites the requests for authentication, e.g., in Cloudflare Workers, this header
   needs to be handled properly.  Leave blank if you want to use the endpoint provided by Backblaze.

   The URL provided here SHOULD have the protocol and SHOULD NOT have a trailing slash or specify the /file/bucket subpath as rclone  will  request  files  with
   "{download_url}/file/{bucket_name}/{path}".

   Example: > https://mysubdomain.mydomain.tld (No trailing "/", "file" or "bucket")

   Properties:

    Config: download_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DOWNLOAD_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--b2-download-auth-duration

   Time before the authorization token will expire in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d.

   The duration before the download authorization token will expire.  The minimum value is 1 second.  The maximum value is one week.

   Properties:

    Config: download_auth_duration

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DOWNLOAD_AUTH_DURATION

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1w

--b2-memory-pool-flush-time

   How  often  internal  memory  buffer  pools will be flushed.  Uploads which requires additional buffers (f.e multipart) will use memory pool for allocations.
   This option controls how often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

   Properties:

    Config: memory_pool_flush_time

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--b2-memory-pool-use-mmap

   Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

   Properties:

    Config: memory_pool_use_mmap

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--b2-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   rclone about is not supported by the B2 backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use  policy  mfs  (most
   free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Box

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

   The initial setup for Box involves getting a token from Box which you can do either in your browser, or with a config.json downloaded from Box to use JWT au
   thentication.  rclone config walks you through it.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Box
             \ "box"
          [snip]
          Storage> box
          Box App Client Id - leave blank normally.
          client_id>
          Box App Client Secret - leave blank normally.
          client_secret>
          Box App config.json location
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          box_config_file>
          Box App Primary Access Token
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          access_token>

          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("user").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Rclone should act on behalf of a user
             \ "user"
           2 / Rclone should act on behalf of a service account
             \ "enterprise"
          box_sub_type>
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"XXX"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note  that  rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Box.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to
   the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a
   host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Box

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your Box

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an Box directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Using rclone with an Enterprise account with SSO

   If  you have an "Enterprise" account type with Box with single sign on (SSO), you need to create a password to use Box with rclone.  This can be done at your
   Enterprise Box account by going to Settings, "Account" Tab, and then set the password in the "Authentication" field.

   Once you have done this, you can setup your Enterprise Box account using the same procedure detailed above in the, using the password you have just set.

Invalid refresh token

   According to the box docs (https://developer.box.com/v2.0/docs/oauth-20#section-6-using-the-access-and-refresh-tokens):

          Each refresh_token is valid for one use in 60 days.

   This means that if you

    Don't use the box remote for 60 days

   • Copy the config file with a box refresh token in and use it in two places

   • Get an error on a token refresh

   then rclone will return an error which includes the text Invalid refresh token.

   To fix this you will need to use oauth2 again to update the refresh token.  You can use the methods in the remote setup docs  (https://rclone.org/remote_set‐
   up/), bearing in mind that if you use the copy the config file method, you should not use that remote on the computer you did the authentication on.

   Here is how to do it.

          $ rclone config
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          remote               box

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> e
          Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
           1 > remote
          remote> remote
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = box
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2017-07-08T23:40:08.059167677+01:00"}
          --------------------
          Edit remote
          Value "client_id" = ""
          Edit? (y/n)>
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Value "client_secret" = ""
          Edit? (y/n)>
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Already have a token - refresh?
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = box
          token = {"access_token":"YYY","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"YYY","expiry":"2017-07-23T12:22:29.259137901+01:00"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Modified time and hashes

   Box allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

   Box supports SHA1 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum flag.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        

   File names can also not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Transfers

   For  files above 50 MiB rclone will use a chunked transfer.  Rclone will upload up to --transfers chunks at the same time (shared among all the multipart up
   loads).  Chunks are buffered in memory and are normally 8 MiB so increasing --transfers will increase memory use.

Deleting files

   Depending on the enterprise settings for your user, the item will either be actually deleted from Box or moved to the trash.

   Emptying the trash is supported via the rclone however cleanup command however this deletes every trashed file and folder individually so it may take a  very
   long time.  Emptying the trash via the WebUI does not have this limitation so it is advised to empty the trash via the WebUI.

Root folder ID

   You can set the root_folder_id for rclone.  This is the directory (identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root of your Box drive.

   Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the correct root to use itself.

   However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

   In  order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you wish rclone to display.  This will be the last segment of the URL when you open
   the relevant folder in the Box web interface.

   So if the folder you want rclone to use has a URL which looks like https://app.box.com/folder/11xxxxxxxxx8 in the browser, then you use 11xxxxxxxxx8  as  the
   root_folder_id in the config.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to box (Box).

--box-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-box-config-file

   Box App config.json location

   Leave blank normally.

   Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

   Properties:

    Config: box_config_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_BOX_CONFIG_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-access-token

   Box App Primary Access Token

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: access_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ACCESS_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-box-sub-type

   Properties:

    Config: box_sub_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_BOX_SUB_TYPE

    Type: string

    Default: "user"

    Examples:

      "user"

        Rclone should act on behalf of a user.

      "enterprise"

        Rclone should act on behalf of a service account.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to box (Box).

--box-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-root-folder-id

   Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

   Properties:

    Config: root_folder_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

    Type: string

    Default: "0"

--box-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (>= 50 MiB).

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 50Mi

--box-commit-retries

   Max number of times to try committing a multipart file.

   Properties:

    Config: commit_retries

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_COMMIT_RETRIES

    Type: int

    Default: 100

--box-list-chunk

   Size of listing chunk 1-1000.

   Properties:

    Config: list_chunk

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_LIST_CHUNK

    Type: int

    Default: 1000

--box-owned-by

   Only show items owned by the login (email address) passed in.

   Properties:

    Config: owned_by

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_OWNED_BY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--box-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that Box is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   Box file names can't have the \ character in.  rclone maps this to and from an identical looking unicode equivalent  (U+FF3C Fullwidth Reverse Solidus).

   Box only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

   Box has API rate limits (https://developer.box.com/guides/api-calls/permissions-and-errors/rate-limits/) that sometimes reduce the speed of rclone.

   rclone  about  is not supported by the Box backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most
   free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Cache

   The cache remote wraps another existing remote and stores file structure and its data for long running tasks like rclone mount.

Status

   The  cache  backend  code  is  working  but  it  currently  doesn't  have  a  maintainer  so there are outstanding bugs (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/is‐
   sues?q=is%3Aopen+is%3Aissue+label%3Abug+label%3A%22Remote%3A+Cache%22) which aren't getting fixed.

   The cache backend is due to be phased out in favour of the VFS caching layer eventually which is more tightly integrated into rclone.

   Until this happens we recommend only using the cache backend if you find you can't work without it.  There are many docs online describing  the  use  of  the
   cache backend to minimize API hits and by-and-large these are out of date and the cache backend isn't needed in those scenarios any more.

Configuration

   To get started you just need to have an existing remote which can be configured with cache.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called test-cache.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/r/c/s/q> n
          name> test-cache
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Cache a remote
             \ "cache"
          [snip]
          Storage> cache
          Remote to cache.
          Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
          "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
          remote> local:/test
          Optional: The URL of the Plex server
          plex_url> http://127.0.0.1:32400
          Optional: The username of the Plex user
          plex_username> dummyusername
          Optional: The password of the Plex user
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank
          y/g/n> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          The size of a chunk. Lower value good for slow connections but can affect seamless reading.
          Default: 5M
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / 1 MiB
             \ "1M"
           2 / 5 MiB
             \ "5M"
           3 / 10 MiB
             \ "10M"
          chunk_size> 2
          How much time should object info (file size, file hashes, etc.) be stored in cache. Use a very high value if you don't plan on changing the source FS from outside the cache.
          Accepted units are: "s", "m", "h".
          Default: 5m
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / 1 hour
             \ "1h"
           2 / 24 hours
             \ "24h"
           3 / 24 hours
             \ "48h"
          info_age> 2
          The maximum size of stored chunks. When the storage grows beyond this size, the oldest chunks will be deleted.
          Default: 10G
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / 500 MiB
             \ "500M"
           2 / 1 GiB
             \ "1G"
           3 / 10 GiB
             \ "10G"
          chunk_total_size> 3
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [test-cache]
          remote = local:/test
          plex_url = http://127.0.0.1:32400
          plex_username = dummyusername
          plex_password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          chunk_size = 5M
          info_age = 48h
          chunk_total_size = 10G

   You can then use it like this,

   List directories in top level of your drive

          rclone lsd test-cache:

   List all the files in your drive

          rclone ls test-cache:

   To start a cached mount

          rclone mount --allow-other test-cache: /var/tmp/test-cache

Write Features Offline uploading

   In an effort to make writing through cache more reliable, the backend now supports this feature which can be activated by specifying a cache-tmp-upload-path.

   A files goes through these states when using this feature:

   1. An upload is started (usually by copying a file on the cache remote)

   2. When the copy to the temporary location is complete the file is part of the cached remote and looks and behaves like any other file (reading included)

   3. After cache-tmp-wait-time passes and the file is next in line, rclone move is used to move the file to the cloud provider

   4. Reading the file still works during the upload but most modifications on it will be prohibited

   5. Once the move is complete the file is unlocked for modifications as it becomes as any other regular file

   6. If  the  file  is being read through cache when it's actually deleted from the temporary path then cache will simply swap the source to the cloud provider
      without interrupting the reading (small blip can happen though)

   Files are uploaded in sequence and only one file is uploaded at a time.  Uploads will be stored in a queue and be processed based  on  the  order  they  were
   added.  The queue and the temporary storage is persistent across restarts but can be cleared on startup with the --cache-db-purge flag.

Write Support

   Writes  are  supported  through cache.  One caveat is that a mounted cache remote does not add any retry or fallback mechanism to the upload operation.  This
   will depend on the implementation of the wrapped remote.  Consider using Offline uploading for reliable writes.

   One special case is covered with cache-writes which will cache the file data at the same time as the upload when it is enabled making it available  from  the
   cache store immediately once the upload is finished.

Read Features Multiple connections

   To  counter  the  high  latency  between  a  local  PC where rclone is running and cloud providers, the cache remote can split multiple requests to the cloud
   provider for smaller file chunks and combines them together locally where they can be available almost immediately before the reader usually needs them.

   This is similar to buffering when media files are played online.  Rclone will stay around the current marker but always try its best to stay ahead  and  pre
   pare the data before.

Plex Integration

   There  is  a  direct  integration  with Plex which allows cache to detect during reading if the file is in playback or not.  This helps cache to adapt how it
   queries the cloud provider depending on what is needed for.

   Scans will have a minimum amount of workers (1) while in a confirmed playback cache will deploy the configured number of workers.

   This integration opens the doorway to additional performance improvements which will be explored in the near future.

   Note: If Plex options are not configured, cache will function with its configured options without adapting any of its settings.

   How to enable?  Run rclone config and add all the Plex options (endpoint, username and password) in your remote and it will be automatically enabled.

   Affected settings: - cache-workers: Configured value during confirmed playback or 1 all the other times

Certificate Validation

   When the Plex server is configured to only accept secure connections, it is possible to use .plex.direct URLs  to  ensure  certificate  validation  succeeds.
   These URLs are used by Plex internally to connect to the Plex server securely.

   The format for these URLs is the following:

   https://ip-with-dots-replaced.server-hash.plex.direct:32400/

   The ip-with-dots-replaced part can be any IPv4 address, where the dots have been replaced with dashes, e.g.  127.0.0.1 becomes 127-0-0-1.

   To get the server-hash part, the easiest way is to visit

   https://plex.tv/api/resources?includeHttps=1&X-Plex-Token=your-plex-token

   This  page  will  list all the available Plex servers for your account with at least one .plex.direct link for each.  Copy one URL and replace the IP address
   with the desired address.  This can be used as the plex_url value.

Known issues Mount and --dir-cache-time

   --dir-cache-time controls the first layer of directory caching which works at the mount layer.  Being an independent caching mechanism from the  cache  back
   end, it will manage its own entries based on the configured time.

   To  avoid  getting  in  a  scenario  where dir cache has obsolete data and cache would have the correct one, try to set --dir-cache-time to a lower time than
   --cache-info-age.  Default values are already configured in this way.

Windows support - Experimental

   There are a couple of issues with Windows mount functionality that still require some investigations.  It should be considered as experimental  thus  far  as
   fixes come in for this OS.

   Most of the issues seem to be related to the difference between filesystems on Linux flavors and Windows as cache is heavily dependent on them.

   Any reports or feedback on how cache behaves on this OS is greatly appreciated.

    https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1935

    https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1907

    https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1834

Risk of throttling

   Future  iterations  of  the  cache  backend will make use of the pooling functionality of the cloud provider to synchronize and at the same time make writing
   through it more tolerant to failures.

   There are a couple of enhancements in track to add these but in the meantime there is a valid concern that the expiring cache  listings  can  lead  to  cloud
   provider throttles or bans due to repeated queries on it for very large mounts.

   Some  recommendations:  -  don't  use a very small interval for entry information (--cache-info-age) - while writes aren't yet optimised, you can still write
   through cache which gives you the advantage of adding the file in the cache at the same time if configured to do so.

   Future enhancements:

    https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1937

    https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1936

cache and crypt

   One common scenario is to keep your data encrypted in the cloud provider using the crypt remote.  crypt uses a similar technique to wrap around  an  existing
   remote and handles this translation in a seamless way.

   There is an issue with wrapping the remotes in this order: cloud remote -> crypt -> cache

   During  testing,  I  experienced  a lot of bans with the remotes in this order.  I suspect it might be related to how crypt opens files on the cloud provider
   which makes it think we're downloading the full file instead of small chunks.  Organizing the remotes in this order yields better results:  cloud  remote  ->
   cache -> crypt

absolute remote paths

   cache  can not differentiate between relative and absolute paths for the wrapped remote.  Any path given in the remote config setting and on the command line
   will be passed to the wrapped remote as is, but for storing the chunks on disk the path will be made relative by removing any leading / character.

   This behavior is irrelevant for most backend types, but there are backends where a leading / changes the effective directory, e.g.  in the sftp backend paths
   starting  with  a / are relative to the root of the SSH server and paths without are relative to the user home directory.  As a result sftp:bin and sftp:/bin
   will share the same cache folder, even if they represent a different directory on the SSH server.

Cache and Remote Control (--rc)

   Cache supports the new --rc mode in rclone and can be remote controlled through the following end points: By default, the listener is disabled if you do  not
   add the flag.

rc cache/expire

   Purge  a remote from the cache backend.  Supports either a directory or a file.  It supports both encrypted and unencrypted file names if cache is wrapped by
   crypt.

   Params: - remote = path to remote (required) - withData = true/false to delete cached data (chunks) as well (optional, false by default)

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to cache (Cache a remote).

--cache-remote

   Remote to cache.

   Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g.  "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).

   Properties:

    Config: remote

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_REMOTE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--cache-plex-url

   The URL of the Plex server.

   Properties:

    Config: plex_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--cache-plex-username

   The username of the Plex user.

   Properties:

    Config: plex_username

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_USERNAME

    Type: string

    Required: false

--cache-plex-password

   The password of the Plex user.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: plex_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

--cache-chunk-size

   The size of a chunk (partial file data).

   Use lower numbers for slower connections.  If the chunk size is changed, any downloaded chunks will be invalid and cache-chunk-path will need to  be  cleared
   or unexpected EOF errors will occur.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 5Mi

    Examples:

      "1M"

        1 MiB

      "5M"

        5 MiB

      "10M"

        10 MiB

--cache-info-age

   How  long  to cache file structure information (directory listings, file size, times, etc.).  If all write operations are done through the cache then you can
   safely make this value very large as the cache store will also be updated in real time.

   Properties:

    Config: info_age

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_INFO_AGE

    Type: Duration

    Default: 6h0m0s

    Examples:

      "1h"

        1 hour

      "24h"

        24 hours

      "48h"

        48 hours

--cache-chunk-total-size

   The total size that the chunks can take up on the local disk.

   If the cache exceeds this value then it will start to delete the oldest chunks until it goes under this value.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_total_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_TOTAL_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 10Gi

    Examples:

      "500M"

        500 MiB

      "1G"

        1 GiB

      "10G"

        10 GiB

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to cache (Cache a remote).

--cache-plex-token

   The plex token for authentication - auto set normally.

   Properties:

    Config: plex_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--cache-plex-insecure

   Skip all certificate verification when connecting to the Plex server.

   Properties:

    Config: plex_insecure

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_INSECURE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--cache-db-path

   Directory to store file structure metadata DB.

   The remote name is used as the DB file name.

   Properties:

    Config: db_path

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_PATH

    Type: string

    Default: "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend"

--cache-chunk-path

   Directory to cache chunk files.

   Path to where partial file data (chunks) are stored locally.  The remote name is appended to the final path.

   This config follows the "--cache-db-path".  If you specify a custom location for "--cache-db-path"  and  don't  specify  one  for  "--cache-chunk-path"  then
   "--cache-chunk-path" will use the same path as "--cache-db-path".

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_path

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_PATH

    Type: string

    Default: "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend"

--cache-db-purge

   Clear all the cached data for this remote on start.

   Properties:

    Config: db_purge

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_PURGE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--cache-chunk-clean-interval

   How often should the cache perform cleanups of the chunk storage.

   The  default  value  should  be  ok for most people.  If you find that the cache goes over "cache-chunk-total-size" too often then try to lower this value to
   force it to perform cleanups more often.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_clean_interval

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_CLEAN_INTERVAL

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--cache-read-retries

   How many times to retry a read from a cache storage.

   Since reading from a cache stream is independent from downloading file data, readers can get to a point where there's no more data in the cache.  Most of the
   times this can indicate a connectivity issue if cache isn't able to provide file data anymore.

   For really slow connections, increase this to a point where the stream is able to provide data but your experience will be very stuttering.

   Properties:

    Config: read_retries

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_READ_RETRIES

    Type: int

    Default: 10

--cache-workers

   How many workers should run in parallel to download chunks.

   Higher  values  will mean more parallel processing (better CPU needed) and more concurrent requests on the cloud provider.  This impacts several aspects like
   the cloud provider API limits, more stress on the hardware that rclone runs on but it also means that streams will be more fluid and data will  be  available
   much more faster to readers.

   Note:  If the optional Plex integration is enabled then this setting will adapt to the type of reading performed and the value specified here will be used as
   a maximum number of workers to use.

   Properties:

    Config: workers

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_WORKERS

    Type: int

    Default: 4

--cache-chunk-no-memory

   Disable the in-memory cache for storing chunks during streaming.

   By default, cache will keep file data during streaming in RAM as well to provide it to readers as fast as possible.

   This transient data is evicted as soon as it is read and the number of chunks stored doesn't exceed the number of workers.  However, depending on other  set
   tings like "cache-chunk-size" and "cache-workers" this footprint can increase if there are parallel streams too (multiple files being read at the same time).

   If the hardware permits it, use this feature to provide an overall better performance during streaming but it can also be disabled if RAM is not available on
   the local machine.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_no_memory

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_NO_MEMORY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--cache-rps

   Limits the number of requests per second to the source FS (-1 to disable).

   This setting places a hard limit on the number of requests per second that cache will be doing to the cloud provider remote and try to respect that value  by
   setting waits between reads.

   If you find that you're getting banned or limited on the cloud provider through cache and know that a smaller number of requests per second will allow you to
   work with it then you can use this setting for that.

   A good balance of all the other settings should make this setting useless but it is available to set for more special cases.

   NOTE: This will limit the number of requests during streams but other API calls to the cloud provider like directory listings will still pass.

   Properties:

    Config: rps

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_RPS

    Type: int

    Default: -1

--cache-writes

   Cache file data on writes through the FS.

   If you need to read files immediately after you upload them through cache you can enable this flag to have their data stored in the cache store at  the  same
   time during upload.

   Properties:

    Config: writes

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_WRITES

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--cache-tmp-upload-path

   Directory to keep temporary files until they are uploaded.

   This is the path where cache will use as a temporary storage for new files that need to be uploaded to the cloud provider.

   Specifying a value will enable this feature.  Without it, it is completely disabled and files will be uploaded directly to the cloud provider

   Properties:

    Config: tmp_upload_path

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_TMP_UPLOAD_PATH

    Type: string

    Required: false

--cache-tmp-wait-time

   How long should files be stored in local cache before being uploaded.

   This is the duration that a file must wait in the temporary location cache-tmp-upload-path before it is selected for upload.

   Note that only one file is uploaded at a time and it can take longer to start the upload if a queue formed for this purpose.

   Properties:

    Config: tmp_wait_time

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_TMP_WAIT_TIME

    Type: Duration

    Default: 15s

--cache-db-wait-time

   How long to wait for the DB to be available - 0 is unlimited.

   Only one process can have the DB open at any one time, so rclone waits for this duration for the DB to become available before it gives an error.

   If you set it to 0 then it will wait forever.

   Properties:

    Config: db_wait_time

    Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_WAIT_TIME

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1s

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the cache backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

stats

   Print stats on the cache backend in JSON format.

          rclone backend stats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

Chunker

   The  chunker overlay transparently splits large files into smaller chunks during upload to wrapped remote and transparently assembles them back when the file
   is downloaded.  This allows to effectively overcome size limits imposed by storage providers.

Configuration

   To use it, first set up the underlying remote following the configuration instructions for that remote.  You can also use a local pathname instead of  a  re
   mote.

   First  check  your  chosen  remote  is  working - we'll call it remote:path here.  Note that anything inside remote:path will be chunked and anything outside
   won't.  This means that if you are using a bucket-based remote (e.g.  S3, B2, swift) then you should probably put the bucket in the remote s3:bucket.

   Now configure chunker using rclone config.  We will call this one overlay to separate it from the remote itself.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> overlay
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Transparently chunk/split large files
             \ "chunker"
          [snip]
          Storage> chunker
          Remote to chunk/unchunk.
          Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
          "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          remote> remote:path
          Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks.
          Enter a size with suffix K,M,G,T. Press Enter for the default ("2G").
          chunk_size> 100M
          Choose how chunker handles hash sums. All modes but "none" require metadata.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("md5").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Pass any hash supported by wrapped remote for non-chunked files, return nothing otherwise
             \ "none"
           2 / MD5 for composite files
             \ "md5"
           3 / SHA1 for composite files
             \ "sha1"
           4 / MD5 for all files
             \ "md5all"
           5 / SHA1 for all files
             \ "sha1all"
           6 / Copying a file to chunker will request MD5 from the source falling back to SHA1 if unsupported
             \ "md5quick"
           7 / Similar to "md5quick" but prefers SHA1 over MD5
             \ "sha1quick"
          hash_type> md5
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [overlay]
          type = chunker
          remote = remote:bucket
          chunk_size = 100M
          hash_type = md5
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Specifying the remote

   In normal use, make sure the remote has a : in.  If you specify the remote without a : then rclone will use a local directory of that name.  So if you use  a
   remote of /path/to/secret/files then rclone will chunk stuff in that directory.  If you use a remote of name then rclone will put files in a directory called
   name in the current directory.

Chunking

   When rclone starts a file upload, chunker checks the file size.  If it doesn't exceed the configured chunk size, chunker will  just  pass  the  file  to  the
   wrapped  remote.   If  a file is large, chunker will transparently cut data in pieces with temporary names and stream them one by one, on the fly.  Each data
   chunk will contain the specified number of bytes, except for the last one which may have less data.  If file size is unknown in advance  (this  is  called  a
   streaming upload), chunker will internally create a temporary copy, record its size and repeat the above process.

   When  upload  completes,  temporary  chunk files are finally renamed.  This scheme guarantees that operations can be run in parallel and look from outside as
   atomic.  A similar method with hidden temporary chunks is used for other operations (copy/move/rename, etc.).  If an operation fails, hidden chunks are  nor
   mally destroyed, and the target composite file stays intact.

   When  a  composite  file  download is requested, chunker transparently assembles it by concatenating data chunks in order.  As the split is trivial one could
   even manually concatenate data chunks together to obtain the original content.

   When the list rclone command scans a directory on wrapped remote, the potential chunk files are accounted for, grouped and assembled into composite directory
   entries.  Any temporary chunks are hidden.

   List  and  other  commands  can sometimes come across composite files with missing or invalid chunks, e.g.  shadowed by like-named directory or another file.
   This usually means that wrapped file system has been directly tampered with or damaged.  If chunker detects a missing chunk it will by default print warning,
   skip  the whole incomplete group of chunks but proceed with current command.  You can set the --chunker-fail-hard flag to have commands abort with error mes
   sage in such cases.

Chunk names

   The default chunk name format is *.rclone_chunk.###, hence by default chunk names  are  BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.001,  BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.002  etc.
   You  can  configure  another name format using the name_format configuration file option.  The format uses asterisk * as a placeholder for the base file name
   and one or more consecutive hash characters # as a placeholder for sequential chunk number.  There must be one and only one asterisk.  The number of consecu‐
   tive  hash characters defines the minimum length of a string representing a chunk number.  If decimal chunk number has less digits than the number of hashes,
   it is left-padded by zeros.  If the decimal string is longer, it is left intact.  By default numbering starts from 1 but there is another option that  allows
   user to start from 0, e.g.  for compatibility with legacy software.

   For  example,  if  name  format  is  big_*-##.part and original file name is data.txt and numbering starts from 0, then the first chunk will be named big_da‐
   ta.txt-00.part, the 99th chunk will be big_data.txt-98.part and the 302nd chunk will become big_data.txt-301.part.

   Note that list assembles composite directory entries only when chunk names match the configured format and treats non-conforming file names  as  normal  non-
   chunked files.

   When using norename transactions, chunk names will additionally have a unique file version suffix.  For example, BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.001_bp562k.

Metadata

   Besides  data  chunks chunker will by default create metadata object for a composite file.  The object is named after the original file.  Chunker allows user
   to disable metadata completely (the none format).  Note that metadata is normally not created for files smaller than the configured  chunk  size.   This  may
   change in future rclone releases.

Simple JSON metadata format

   This is the default format.  It supports hash sums and chunk validation for composite files.  Meta objects carry the following fields:

    ver - version of format, currently 1

    size - total size of composite file

    nchunks - number of data chunks in file

    md5 - MD5 hashsum of composite file (if present)

    sha1 - SHA1 hashsum (if present)

    txn - identifies current version of the file

   There is no field for composite file name as it's simply equal to the name of meta object on the wrapped remote.  Please refer to respective sections for de
   tails on hashsums and modified time handling.

No metadata

   You can disable meta objects by setting the meta format option to none.  In this mode chunker will scan directory for all files that follow configured  chunk
   name  format,  group  them by detecting chunks with the same base name and show group names as virtual composite files.  This method is more prone to missing
   chunk errors (especially missing last chunk) than format with metadata enabled.

Hashsums

   Chunker supports hashsums only when a compatible metadata is present.  Hence, if you choose metadata format of none, chunker will report  hashsum  as  UNSUP
   PORTED.

   Please  note  that by default metadata is stored only for composite files.  If a file is smaller than configured chunk size, chunker will transparently redi
   rect hash requests to wrapped remote, so support depends on that.  You will see the empty string as a hashsum of  requested  type  for  small  files  if  the
   wrapped remote doesn't support it.

   Many  storage  backends support MD5 and SHA1 hash types, so does chunker.  With chunker you can choose one or another but not both.  MD5 is set by default as
   the most supported type.  Since chunker keeps hashes for composite files and falls back to the wrapped remote hash for non-chunked ones,  we  advise  you  to
   choose the same hash type as supported by wrapped remote so that your file listings look coherent.

   If your storage backend does not support MD5 or SHA1 but you need consistent file hashing, configure chunker with md5all or sha1all.  These two modes guaran‐
   tee given hash for all files.  If wrapped remote doesn't support it, chunker will then add metadata to all files, even small.  However, this can  double  the
   amount  of small files in storage and incur additional service charges.  You can even use chunker to force md5/sha1 support in any other remote at expense of
   sidecar meta objects by setting e.g.  chunk_type=sha1all to force hashsums and chunk_size=1P to effectively disable chunking.

   Normally, when a file is copied to chunker controlled remote, chunker will ask the file source for compatible file hash and revert to on-the-fly  calculation
   if none is found.  This involves some CPU overhead but provides a guarantee that given hashsum is available.  Also, chunker will reject a server-side copy or
   move operation if source and destination hashsum types are different resulting in the extra network bandwidth, too.  In some rare cases  this  may  be  unde
   sired,  so  chunker  provides  two optional choices: sha1quick and md5quick.  If the source does not support primary hash type and the quick mode is enabled,
   chunker will try to fall back to the secondary type.  This will save CPU and bandwidth but can result in empty hashsums at  destination.   Beware  of  conse
   quences: the sync command will revert (sometimes silently) to time/size comparison if compatible hashsums between source and target are not found.

Modified time

   Chunker  stores  modification times using the wrapped remote so support depends on that.  For a small non-chunked file the chunker overlay simply manipulates
   modification time of the wrapped remote file.  For a composite file with metadata chunker will get and set modification time of the metadata  object  on  the
   wrapped remote.  If file is chunked but metadata format is none then chunker will use modification time of the first data chunk.

Migrations

   The idiomatic way to migrate to a different chunk size, hash type, transaction style or chunk naming scheme is to:

    Collect all your chunked files under a directory and have your chunker remote point to it.

    Create another directory (most probably on the same cloud storage) and configure a new remote with desired metadata format, hash type, chunk naming etc.

    Now  run rclone sync --interactive oldchunks: newchunks: and all your data will be transparently converted in transfer.  This may take some time, yet chun
     ker will try server-side copy if possible.

    After checking data integrity you may remove configuration section of the old remote.

   If rclone gets killed during a long operation on a big composite file, hidden temporary chunks may stay in the directory.  They will not be shown by the list
   command  but will eat up your account quota.  Please note that the deletefile command deletes only active chunks of a file.  As a workaround, you can use re
   mote of the wrapped file system to see them.  An easy way to get rid of hidden garbage is to copy littered directory somewhere using the chunker  remote  and
   purge the original directory.  The copy command will copy only active chunks while the purge will remove everything including garbage.

Caveats and Limitations

   Chunker  requires wrapped remote to support server-side move (or copy + delete) operations, otherwise it will explicitly refuse to start.  This is because it
   internally renames temporary chunk files to their final names when an operation completes successfully.

   Chunker encodes chunk number in file name, so with default name_format setting it adds 17 characters.  Also chunker adds 7  characters  of  temporary  suffix
   during  operations.   Many  file  systems limit base file name without path by 255 characters.  Using rclone's crypt remote as a base file system limits file
   name by 143 characters.  Thus, maximum name length is 231 for most files and 119 for chunker-over-crypt.  A user in need  can  change  name  format  to  e.g.
   *.rcc## and save 10 characters (provided at most 99 chunks per file).

   Note that a move implemented using the copy-and-delete method may incur double charging with some cloud storage providers.

   Chunker will not automatically rename existing chunks when you run rclone config on a live remote and change the chunk name format.  Beware that in result of
   this some files which have been treated as chunks before the change can pop up in directory listings as normal files and vice versa.  The same warning  holds
   for the chunk size.  If you desperately need to change critical chunking settings, you should run data migration as described above.

   If  wrapped  remote  is  case insensitive, the chunker overlay will inherit that property (so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and "hello.doc" in the
   same directory).

   Chunker included in rclone releases up to v1.54 can sometimes fail to detect metadata produced by recent versions of rclone.   We  recommend  users  to  keep
   rclone up-to-date to avoid data corruption.

   Changing transactions is dangerous and requires explicit migration.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to chunker (Transparently chunk/split large files).

--chunker-remote

   Remote to chunk/unchunk.

   Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g.  "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).

   Properties:

    Config: remote

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_REMOTE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--chunker-chunk-size

   Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 2Gi

--chunker-hash-type

   Choose how chunker handles hash sums.

   All modes but "none" require metadata.

   Properties:

    Config: hash_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_HASH_TYPE

    Type: string

    Default: "md5"

    Examples:

      "none"

        Pass any hash supported by wrapped remote for non-chunked files.

        Return nothing otherwise.

      "md5"

        MD5 for composite files.

      "sha1"

        SHA1 for composite files.

      "md5all"

        MD5 for all files.

      "sha1all"

        SHA1 for all files.

      "md5quick"

        Copying a file to chunker will request MD5 from the source.

        Falling back to SHA1 if unsupported.

      "sha1quick"

        Similar to "md5quick" but prefers SHA1 over MD5.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to chunker (Transparently chunk/split large files).

--chunker-name-format

   String format of chunk file names.

   The  two  placeholders are: base file name (*) and chunk number (#...).  There must be one and only one asterisk and one or more consecutive hash characters.
   If chunk number has less digits than the number of hashes, it is left-padded by zeros.  If there are more digits in the number, they are left as is.   Possi
   ble chunk files are ignored if their name does not match given format.

   Properties:

    Config: name_format

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_NAME_FORMAT

    Type: string

    Default: "*.rclone_chunk.###"

--chunker-start-from

   Minimum valid chunk number.  Usually 0 or 1.

   By default chunk numbers start from 1.

   Properties:

    Config: start_from

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_START_FROM

    Type: int

    Default: 1

--chunker-meta-format

   Format of the metadata object or "none".

   By default "simplejson".  Metadata is a small JSON file named after the composite file.

   Properties:

    Config: meta_format

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_META_FORMAT

    Type: string

    Default: "simplejson"

    Examples:

      "none"

        Do not use metadata files at all.

        Requires hash type "none".

      "simplejson"

        Simple JSON supports hash sums and chunk validation.

        It has the following fields: ver, size, nchunks, md5, sha1.

--chunker-fail-hard

   Choose how chunker should handle files with missing or invalid chunks.

   Properties:

    Config: fail_hard

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_FAIL_HARD

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "true"

        Report errors and abort current command.

      "false"

        Warn user, skip incomplete file and proceed.

--chunker-transactions

   Choose how chunker should handle temporary files during transactions.

   Properties:

    Config: transactions

    Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_TRANSACTIONS

    Type: string

    Default: "rename"

    Examples:

      "rename"

        Rename temporary files after a successful transaction.

      "norename"

        Leave temporary file names and write transaction ID to metadata file.

        Metadata is required for no rename transactions (meta format cannot be "none").

        If you are using norename transactions you should be careful not to downgrade Rclone

        as older versions of Rclone don't support this transaction style and will misinterpret

       • files manipulated by norename transactions.

       • This method is EXPERIMENTAL, don't use on production systems.

      "auto"

        Rename or norename will be used depending on capabilities of the backend.

        If meta format is set to "none", rename transactions will always be used.

        This method is EXPERIMENTAL, don't use on production systems.

Citrix ShareFile

   Citrix ShareFile (https://sharefile.com) is a secure file sharing and transfer service aimed as business.

Configuration

   The initial setup for Citrix ShareFile involves getting a token from Citrix ShareFile which you can in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          XX / Citrix Sharefile
             \ "sharefile"
          Storage> sharefile
          ** See help for sharefile backend at: https://rclone.org/sharefile/ **

          ID of the root folder

          Leave blank to access "Personal Folders".  You can use one of the
          standard values here or any folder ID (long hex number ID).
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Access the Personal Folders. (Default)
             \ ""
           2 / Access the Favorites folder.
             \ "favorites"
           3 / Access all the shared folders.
             \ "allshared"
           4 / Access all the individual connectors.
             \ "connectors"
           5 / Access the home, favorites, and shared folders as well as the connectors.
             \ "top"
          root_folder_id>
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=XXX
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = sharefile
          endpoint = https://XXX.sharefile.com
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2019-09-30T19:41:45.878561877+01:00"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Citrix ShareFile.  This only runs from the moment it opens your
   browser to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it  temporarily  if  you
   are running a host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your ShareFile

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your ShareFile

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an ShareFile directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Modified time and hashes

   ShareFile allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

   ShareFile supports MD5 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum flag.

Transfers

   For files above 128 MiB rclone will use a chunked transfer.  Rclone will upload up to --transfers chunks at the same time (shared among all the multipart up
   loads).  Chunks are buffered in memory and are normally 64 MiB so increasing --transfers will increase memory use.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        
   *           0x2A        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        
   ?           0x3F        
   :           0x3A        
   |           0x7C        
   "           0x22        

   File names can also not start or end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         
   .           0x2E        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to sharefile (Citrix Sharefile).

--sharefile-root-folder-id

   ID of the root folder.

   Leave blank to access "Personal Folders".  You can use one of the standard values here or any folder ID (long hex number ID).

   Properties:

    Config: root_folder_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Access the Personal Folders (default).

      "favorites"

        Access the Favorites folder.

      "allshared"

        Access all the shared folders.

      "connectors"

        Access all the individual connectors.

      "top"

        Access the home, favorites, and shared folders as well as the connectors.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to sharefile (Citrix Sharefile).

--sharefile-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to multipart upload.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 128Mi

--sharefile-chunk-size

   Upload chunk size.

   Must a power of 2 >= 256k.

   Making this larger will improve performance, but note that each chunk is buffered in memory one per transfer.

   Reducing this will reduce memory usage but decrease performance.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 64Mi

--sharefile-endpoint

   Endpoint for API calls.

   This is usually auto discovered as part of the oauth process, but can be set manually to something like: https://XXX.sharefile.com

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sharefile-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftPeriod,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that ShareFile is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   ShareFile only supports filenames up to 256 characters in length.

   rclone about is not supported by the Citrix ShareFile backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use poli
   cy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Crypt

   Rclone crypt remotes encrypt and decrypt other remotes.

   A remote of type crypt does not access a storage system (https://rclone.org/overview/) directly, but instead wraps another remote, which in turn accesses the
   storage system.  This is similar to how alias (https://rclone.org/alias/), union (https://rclone.org/union/), chunker (https://rclone.org/chunker/) and a few
   others work.  It makes the usage very flexible, as you can add a layer, in this case an encryption layer, on top of any other backend, even in multiple  lay
   ers.  Rclone's functionality can be used as with any other remote, for example you can mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) a crypt remote.

   Accessing  a storage system through a crypt remote realizes client-side encryption, which makes it safe to keep your data in a location you do not trust will
   not get compromised.  When working against the crypt remote, rclone will automatically encrypt (before uploading) and decrypt (after downloading) on your lo
   cal  system as needed on the fly, leaving the data encrypted at rest in the wrapped remote.  If you access the storage system using an application other than
   rclone, or access the wrapped remote directly using rclone, there will not be any encryption/decryption: Downloading existing content will just give you  the
   encrypted (scrambled) format, and anything you upload will not become encrypted.

   The  encryption  is  a secret-key encryption (also called symmetric key encryption) algorithm, where a password (or pass phrase) is used to generate real en
   cryption key.  The password can be supplied by user, or you may chose to let rclone generate one.  It will be stored in the configuration file, in a  lightly
   obscured  form.   If  you  are  in  an  environment  where  you  are  not  able  to  keep your configuration secured, you should add configuration encryption
   (https://rclone.org/docs/#configuration-encryption) as protection.  As long as you have this configuration file, you will  be  able  to  decrypt  your  data.
   Without the configuration file, as long as you remember the password (or keep it in a safe place), you can re-create the configuration and gain access to the
   existing data.  You may also configure a corresponding remote in a different installation to access the same data.  See below for guidance to changing  pass
   word.

   Encryption uses cryptographic salt (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Salt_(cryptography)), to permute the encryption key so that the same string may be encrypt
   ed in different ways.  When configuring the crypt remote it is optional to enter a salt, or to let rclone generate a unique salt.  If omitted, rclone uses  a
   built-in unique string.  Normally in cryptography, the salt is stored together with the encrypted content, and do not have to be memorized by the user.  This
   is not the case in rclone, because rclone does not store any additional information on the remotes.  Use of custom salt is effectively a second password that
   must be memorized.

   File  content  encryption is performed using NaCl SecretBox (https://godoc.org/golang.org/x/crypto/nacl/secretbox), based on XSalsa20 cipher and Poly1305 for
   integrity.  Names (file- and directory names) are also encrypted by default, but this has some implications and is therefore possible to be turned off.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called secret.

   To use crypt, first set up the underlying remote.  Follow the rclone config instructions for the specific backend.

   Before configuring the crypt remote, check the underlying remote is working.  In this example the underlying remote is called remote.  We  will  configure  a
   path path within this remote to contain the encrypted content.  Anything inside remote:path will be encrypted and anything outside will not.

   Configure crypt using rclone config.  In this example the crypt remote is called secret, to differentiate it from the underlying remote.

   When  you are done you can use the crypt remote named secret just as you would with any other remote, e.g.  rclone copy D:\docs secret:\docs, and rclone will
   encrypt and decrypt as needed on the fly.  If you access the wrapped remote remote:path directly you will bypass the encryption, and anything you  read  will
   be in encrypted form, and anything you write will be unencrypted.  To avoid issues it is best to configure a dedicated path for encrypted content, and access
   it exclusively through a crypt remote.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> secret
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Encrypt/Decrypt a remote
             \ "crypt"
          [snip]
          Storage> crypt
          ** See help for crypt backend at: https://rclone.org/crypt/ **

          Remote to encrypt/decrypt.
          Normally should contain a ':' and a path, eg "myremote:path/to/dir",
          "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          remote> remote:path
          How to encrypt the filenames.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("standard").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
             / Encrypt the filenames.
           1 | See the docs for the details.
             \ "standard"
           2 / Very simple filename obfuscation.
             \ "obfuscate"
             / Don't encrypt the file names.
           3 | Adds a ".bin" extension only.
             \ "off"
          filename_encryption>
          Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact.

          NB If filename_encryption is "off" then this option will do nothing.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("true").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Encrypt directory names.
             \ "true"
           2 / Don't encrypt directory names, leave them intact.
             \ "false"
          directory_name_encryption>
          Password or pass phrase for encryption.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Password or pass phrase for salt. Optional but recommended.
          Should be different to the previous password.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g/n> g
          Password strength in bits.
          64 is just about memorable
          128 is secure
          1024 is the maximum
          Bits> 128
          Your password is: JAsJvRcgR-_veXNfy_sGmQ
          Use this password? Please note that an obscured version of this
          password (and not the password itself) will be stored under your
          configuration file, so keep this generated password in a safe place.
          y) Yes (default)
          n) No
          y/n>
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [secret]
          type = crypt
          remote = remote:path
          password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          password2 = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d>

   Important The crypt password stored in rclone.conf is lightly obscured.  That only protects it from cursory inspection.  It is not secure  unless  configura
   tion encryption (https://rclone.org/docs/#configuration-encryption) of rclone.conf is specified.

   A long passphrase is recommended, or rclone config can generate a random one.

   The obscured password is created using AES-CTR with a static key.  The salt is stored verbatim at the beginning of the obscured password.  This static key is
   shared between all versions of rclone.

   If you reconfigure rclone with the same passwords/passphrases elsewhere it will be compatible, but the obscured version will be different due to the  differ
   ent salt.

   Rclone does not encrypt

    file length - this can be calculated within 16 bytes

    modification time - used for syncing

Specifying the remote

   When configuring the remote to encrypt/decrypt, you may specify any string that rclone accepts as a source/destination of other commands.

   The  primary  use  case  is to specify the path into an already configured remote (e.g.  remote:path/to/dir or remote:bucket), such that data in a remote un
   trusted location can be stored encrypted.

   You may also specify a local filesystem path, such as /path/to/dir on Linux, C:\path\to\dir on Windows.  By creating a crypt remote pointing to such a  local
   filesystem path, you can use rclone as a utility for pure local file encryption, for example to keep encrypted files on a removable USB drive.

   Note:  A  string  which  do  not contain a : will by rclone be treated as a relative path in the local filesystem.  For example, if you enter the name remote
   without the trailing :, it will be treated as a subdirectory of the current directory with name "remote".

   If a path remote:path/to/dir is specified, rclone stores encrypted files in path/to/dir on the remote.  With file name encryption, files saved to secret:sub
   dir/subfile are stored in the unencrypted path path/to/dir but the subdir/subpath element is encrypted.

   The path you specify does not have to exist, rclone will create it when needed.

   If  you intend to use the wrapped remote both directly for keeping unencrypted content, as well as through a crypt remote for encrypted content, it is recom
   mended to point the crypt remote to a separate directory within the wrapped remote.  If you use a bucket-based storage system (e.g.  Swift, S3,  Google  Com
   pute Storage, B2) it is generally advisable to wrap the crypt remote around a specific bucket (s3:bucket).  If wrapping around the entire root of the storage
   (s3:), and use the optional file name encryption, rclone will encrypt the bucket name.

Changing password

   Should the password, or the configuration file containing a lightly obscured form of the password, be compromised, you need to re-encrypt your  data  with  a
   new password.  Since rclone uses secret-key encryption, where the encryption key is generated directly from the password kept on the client, it is not possi
   ble to change the password/key of already encrypted content.  Just changing the password configured for an existing crypt remote means  you  will  no  longer
   able  to  decrypt any of the previously encrypted content.  The only possibility is to re-upload everything via a crypt remote configured with your new pass
   word.

   Depending on the size of your data, your bandwidth, storage quota etc, there are different approaches you can take: - If you have everything in  a  different
   location,  for  example  on  your  local  system, you could remove all of the prior encrypted files, change the password for your configured crypt remote (or
   delete and re-create the crypt configuration), and then re-upload everything from the alternative location.  - If you have enough space on the storage system
   you can create a new crypt remote pointing to a separate directory on the same backend, and then use rclone to copy everything from the original crypt remote
   to the new, effectively decrypting everything on the fly using the old password and re-encrypting using the new password.  When  done,  delete  the  original
   crypt  remote directory and finally the rclone crypt configuration with the old password.  All data will be streamed from the storage system and back, so you
   will get half the bandwidth and be charged twice if you have upload and download quota on the storage system.

   Note: A security problem related to the random password generator was fixed in rclone version 1.53.3 (released 2020-11-19).  Passwords  generated  by  rclone
   config  in  version  1.49.0  (released  2019-08-26) to 1.53.2 (released 2020-10-26) are not considered secure and should be changed.  If you made up your own
   password, or used rclone version older than 1.49.0  or  newer  than  1.53.2  to  generate  it,  you  are  not  affected  by  this  issue.   See  issue  #4783
   (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4783) for more details, and a tool you can use to check if you are affected.

Example

   Create the following file structure using "standard" file name encryption.

          plaintext/
           file0.txt
           file1.txt
           subdir
               file2.txt
               file3.txt
               subsubdir
                   file4.txt

   Copy these to the remote, and list them

          $ rclone -q copy plaintext secret:
          $ rclone -q ls secret:
                  7 file1.txt
                  6 file0.txt
                  8 subdir/file2.txt
                 10 subdir/subsubdir/file4.txt
                  9 subdir/file3.txt

   The crypt remote looks like

          $ rclone -q ls remote:path
                 55 hagjclgavj2mbiqm6u6cnjjqcg
                 54 v05749mltvv1tf4onltun46gls
                 57 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/dlj7fkq4kdq72emafg7a7s41uo
                 58 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/7uu829995du6o42n32otfhjqp4/b9pausrfansjth5ob3jkdqd4lc
                 56 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/8njh1sk437gttmep3p70g81aps

   The directory structure is preserved

          $ rclone -q ls secret:subdir
                  8 file2.txt
                  9 file3.txt
                 10 subsubdir/file4.txt

   Without file name encryption .bin extensions are added to underlying names.  This prevents the cloud provider attempting to interpret file content.

          $ rclone -q ls remote:path
                 54 file0.txt.bin
                 57 subdir/file3.txt.bin
                 56 subdir/file2.txt.bin
                 58 subdir/subsubdir/file4.txt.bin
                 55 file1.txt.bin

File name encryption modes

   Off

    doesn't hide file names or directory structure

   • allows for longer file names (~246 characters)

   • can use sub paths and copy single files

   Standard

   • file names encrypted

   • file names can't be as long (~143 characters)

    can use sub paths and copy single files

    directory structure visible

    identical files names will have identical uploaded names

    can use shortcuts to shorten the directory recursion

   Obfuscation

   This  is  a  simple "rotate" of the filename, with each file having a rot distance based on the filename.  Rclone stores the distance at the beginning of the
   filename.  A file called "hello" may become "53.jgnnq".

   Obfuscation is not a strong encryption of filenames, but hinders automated scanning tools picking up on filename patterns.  It  is  an  intermediate  between
   "off" and "standard" which allows for longer path segment names.

   There is a possibility with some unicode based filenames that the obfuscation is weak and may map lower case characters to upper case equivalents.

   Obfuscation cannot be relied upon for strong protection.

    file names very lightly obfuscated

    file names can be longer than standard encryption

    can use sub paths and copy single files

    directory structure visible

    identical files names will have identical uploaded names

   Cloud  storage  systems  have  limits  on file name length and total path length which rclone is more likely to breach using "Standard" file name encryption.
   Where file names are less than 156 characters in length issues should not be encountered, irrespective of cloud storage provider.

   An experimental advanced option filename_encoding is now provided to address this problem to a certain degree.  For cloud storage systems with case sensitive
   file  names (e.g.  Google Drive), base64 can be used to reduce file name length.  For cloud storage systems using UTF-16 to store file names internally (e.g.
   OneDrive), base32768 can be used to drastically reduce file name length.

   An alternative, future rclone file name encryption mode may tolerate backend provider path length limits.

Directory name encryption

   Crypt offers the option of encrypting dir names or leaving them intact.  There are two options:

   True

   Encrypts      the      whole      file      path      including      directory      names       Example:       1/12/123.txt       is       encrypted       to
   p0e52nreeaj0a5ea7s64m4j72s/l42g6771hnv3an9cgc8cr2n1ng/qgm4avr35m5loi1th53ato71v0

   False

   Only encrypts file names, skips directory names Example: 1/12/123.txt is encrypted to 1/12/qgm4avr35m5loi1th53ato71v0

Modified time and hashes

   Crypt stores modification times using the underlying remote so support depends on that.

   Hashes are not stored for crypt.  However the data integrity is protected by an extremely strong crypto authenticator.

   Use the rclone cryptcheck command to check the integrity of a crypted remote instead of rclone check which can't check the checksums properly.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to crypt (Encrypt/Decrypt a remote).

--crypt-remote

   Remote to encrypt/decrypt.

   Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g.  "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).

   Properties:

    Config: remote

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_REMOTE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--crypt-filename-encryption

   How to encrypt the filenames.

   Properties:

    Config: filename_encryption

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_FILENAME_ENCRYPTION

    Type: string

    Default: "standard"

    Examples:

      "standard"

        Encrypt the filenames.

        See the docs for the details.

      "obfuscate"

        Very simple filename obfuscation.

      "off"

        Don't encrypt the file names.

        Adds a ".bin" extension only.

--crypt-directory-name-encryption

   Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact.

   NB If filename_encryption is "off" then this option will do nothing.

   Properties:

    Config: directory_name_encryption

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_DIRECTORY_NAME_ENCRYPTION

    Type: bool

    Default: true

    Examples:

      "true"

        Encrypt directory names.

      "false"

        Don't encrypt directory names, leave them intact.

--crypt-password

   Password or pass phrase for encryption.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: true

--crypt-password2

   Password or pass phrase for salt.

   Optional but recommended.  Should be different to the previous password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password2

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_PASSWORD2

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to crypt (Encrypt/Decrypt a remote).

--crypt-server-side-across-configs

   Allow server-side operations (e.g.  copy) to work across different crypt configs.

   Normally this option is not what you want, but if you have two crypts pointing to the same backend you can use it.

   This can be used, for example, to change file name encryption type without re-uploading all the data.  Just make two crypt backends pointing to two different
   directories with the single changed parameter and use rclone move to move the files between the crypt remotes.

   Properties:

    Config: server_side_across_configs

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--crypt-show-mapping

   For all files listed show how the names encrypt.

   If this flag is set then for each file that the remote is asked to list, it will log (at level INFO) a line stating the decrypted file name and the encrypted
   file name.

   This  is  so you can work out which encrypted names are which decrypted names just in case you need to do something with the encrypted file names, or for de
   bugging purposes.

   Properties:

    Config: show_mapping

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_SHOW_MAPPING

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--crypt-no-data-encryption

   Option to either encrypt file data or leave it unencrypted.

   Properties:

    Config: no_data_encryption

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_NO_DATA_ENCRYPTION

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "true"

        Don't encrypt file data, leave it unencrypted.

      "false"

        Encrypt file data.

--crypt-filename-encoding

   How to encode the encrypted filename to text string.

   This option could help with shortening the encrypted filename.  The suitable option would depend on the way your remote count the filename length and if it's
   case sensitive.

   Properties:

    Config: filename_encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_FILENAME_ENCODING

    Type: string

    Default: "base32"

    Examples:

      "base32"

        Encode using base32.  Suitable for all remote.

      "base64"

        Encode using base64.  Suitable for case sensitive remote.

      "base32768"

        Encode using base32768.  Suitable if your remote counts UTF-16 or

        Unicode codepoint instead of UTF-8 byte length.  (Eg.  Onedrive)

Metadata

   Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the crypt backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

encode

   Encode the given filename(s)

          rclone backend encode remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This encodes the filenames given as arguments returning a list of strings of the encoded results.

   Usage Example:

          rclone backend encode crypt: file1 [file2...]
          rclone rc backend/command command=encode fs=crypt: file1 [file2...]

decode

   Decode the given filename(s)

          rclone backend decode remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This decodes the filenames given as arguments returning a list of strings of the decoded results.  It will return an error if any of the inputs are invalid.

   Usage Example:

          rclone backend decode crypt: encryptedfile1 [encryptedfile2...]
          rclone rc backend/command command=decode fs=crypt: encryptedfile1 [encryptedfile2...]

Backing up a crypted remote

   If  you  wish  to backup a crypted remote, it is recommended that you use rclone sync on the encrypted files, and make sure the passwords are the same in the
   new encrypted remote.

   This will have the following advantages

    rclone sync will check the checksums while copying

    you can use rclone check between the encrypted remotes

    you don't decrypt and encrypt unnecessarily

   For example, let's say you have your original remote at remote: with the encrypted version at eremote: with path remote:crypt.  You would then set up the new
   remote remote2: and then the encrypted version eremote2: with path remote2:crypt using the same passwords as eremote:.

   To sync the two remotes you would do

          rclone sync --interactive remote:crypt remote2:crypt

   And to check the integrity you would do

          rclone check remote:crypt remote2:crypt

File formats File encryption

   Files are encrypted 1:1 source file to destination object.  The file has a header and is divided into chunks.

Header

    8 bytes magic string RCLONE\x00\x00

    24 bytes Nonce (IV)

   The  initial  nonce  is generated from the operating systems crypto strong random number generator.  The nonce is incremented for each chunk read making sure
   each nonce is unique for each block written.  The chance of a nonce being re-used is minuscule.  If you wrote an exabyte of data (10¹ bytes) you would  have
   a probability of approximately 2×10³² of re-using a nonce.

Chunk

   Each  chunk  will  contain 64 KiB of data, except for the last one which may have less data.  The data chunk is in standard NaCl SecretBox format.  SecretBox
   uses XSalsa20 and Poly1305 to encrypt and authenticate messages.

   Each chunk contains:

    16 Bytes of Poly1305 authenticator

    1 - 65536 bytes XSalsa20 encrypted data

   64k chunk size was chosen as the best performing chunk size (the authenticator takes too much time below this and the performance drops off due to cache  ef
   fects above this).  Note that these chunks are buffered in memory so they can't be too big.

   This uses a 32 byte (256 bit key) key derived from the user password.

Examples

   1 byte file will encrypt to

    32 bytes header

    17 bytes data chunk

   49 bytes total

   1 MiB (1048576 bytes) file will encrypt to

    32 bytes header

    16 chunks of 65568 bytes

   1049120 bytes total (a 0.05% overhead).  This is the overhead for big files.

Name encryption

   File names are encrypted segment by segment - the path is broken up into / separated strings and these are encrypted individually.

   File segments are padded using PKCS#7 to a multiple of 16 bytes before encryption.

   They are then encrypted with EME using AES with 256 bit key.  EME (ECB-Mix-ECB) is a wide-block encryption mode presented in the 2003 paper "A Parallelizable
   Enciphering Mode" by Halevi and Rogaway.

   This makes for deterministic encryption which is what we want - the same filename must encrypt to the same thing otherwise we can't  find  it  on  the  cloud
   storage system.

   This means that

   • filenames with the same name will encrypt the same

   • filenames which start the same won't have a common prefix

   This uses a 32 byte key (256 bits) and a 16 byte (128 bits) IV both of which are derived from the user password.

   After encryption they are written out using a modified version of standard base32 encoding as described in RFC4648.  The standard encoding is modified in two
   ways:

    it becomes lower case (no-one likes upper case filenames!)

    we strip the padding character =

   base32 is used rather than the more efficient base64 so rclone can be used on case insensitive remotes (e.g.  Windows, Amazon Drive).

Key derivation

   Rclone uses scrypt with parameters N=16384, r=8, p=1 with an optional user supplied salt (password2) to derive the 32+32+16 = 80 bytes of  key  material  re
   quired.  If the user doesn't supply a salt then rclone uses an internal one.

   scrypt makes it impractical to mount a dictionary attack on rclone encrypted data.  For full protection against this you should always use a salt.

SEE ALSO

    rclone cryptdecode (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cryptdecode/) - Show forward/reverse mapping of encrypted filenames

Compress Warning

   This  remote is currently experimental.  Things may break and data may be lost.  Anything you do with this remote is at your own risk.  Please understand the
   risks associated with using experimental code and don't use this remote in critical applications.

   The Compress remote adds compression to another remote.  It is best used with remotes containing many large compressible files.

Configuration

   To use this remote, all you need to do is specify another remote and a compression mode to use:

          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          remote_to_press      sometype

          e) Edit existing remote
          $ rclone config
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
          name> compress
          ...
           8 / Compress a remote
             \ "compress"
          ...
          Storage> compress
          ** See help for compress backend at: https://rclone.org/compress/ **

          Remote to compress.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          remote> remote_to_press:subdir
          Compression mode.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("gzip").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Gzip compression balanced for speed and compression strength.
             \ "gzip"
          compression_mode> gzip
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [compress]
          type = compress
          remote = remote_to_press:subdir
          compression_mode = gzip
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Compression Modes

   Currently only gzip compression is supported.  It provides a decent balance between speed and size and is well supported by other applications.   Compression
   strength can further be configured via an advanced setting where 0 is no compression and 9 is strongest compression.

File types

   If  you  open  a  remote  wrapped by compress, you will see that there are many files with an extension corresponding to the compression algorithm you chose.
   These files are standard files that can be opened by various archive programs, but they have some hidden metadata that allows them  to  be  used  by  rclone.
   While  you  may download and decompress these files at will, do not manually delete or rename files.  Files without correct metadata files will not be recog
   nized by rclone.

File names

   The compressed files will be named *.###########.gz where * is the base file and the # part is base64 encoded size of the uncompressed file.  The file  names
   should not be changed by anything other than the rclone compression backend.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to compress (Compress a remote).

--compress-remote

   Remote to compress.

   Properties:

    Config: remote

    Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_REMOTE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--compress-mode

   Compression mode.

   Properties:

    Config: mode

    Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_MODE

    Type: string

    Default: "gzip"

    Examples:

      "gzip"

        Standard gzip compression with fastest parameters.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to compress (Compress a remote).

--compress-level

   GZIP compression level (-2 to 9).

   Generally  -1 (default, equivalent to 5) is recommended.  Levels 1 to 9 increase compression at the cost of speed.  Going past 6 generally offers very little
   return.

   Level -2 uses Huffman encoding only.  Only use if you know what you are doing.  Level 0 turns off compression.

   Properties:

    Config: level

    Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_LEVEL

    Type: int

    Default: -1

--compress-ram-cache-limit

   Some remotes don't allow the upload of files with unknown size.  In this case the compressed file will need to be cached to determine it's size.

   Files smaller than this limit will be cached in RAM, files larger than this limit will be cached on disk.

   Properties:

    Config: ram_cache_limit

    Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_RAM_CACHE_LIMIT

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 20Mi

Metadata

   Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Combine

   The combine backend joins remotes together into a single directory tree.

   For example you might have a remote for images on one provider:

          $ rclone tree s3:imagesbucket
          /
           image1.jpg
           image2.jpg

   And a remote for files on another:

          $ rclone tree drive:important/files
          /
           file1.txt
           file2.txt

   The combine backend can join these together into a synthetic directory structure like this:

          $ rclone tree combined:
          /
           files
              file1.txt
              file2.txt
           images
               image1.jpg
               image2.jpg

   You'd do this by specifying an upstreams parameter in the config like this

          upstreams = images=s3:imagesbucket files=drive:important/files

   During the initial setup with rclone config you will specify the upstreams remotes as a space separated list.  The upstream remotes can  either  be  a  local
   paths or other remotes.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a combine called remote for the example above.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          ...
          XX / Combine several remotes into one
             \ (combine)
          ...
          Storage> combine
          Option upstreams.
          Upstreams for combining
          These should be in the form
              dir=remote:path dir2=remote2:path
          Where before the = is specified the root directory and after is the remote to
          put there.
          Embedded spaces can be added using quotes
              "dir=remote:path with space" "dir2=remote2:path with space"
          Enter a fs.SpaceSepList value.
          upstreams> images=s3:imagesbucket files=drive:important/files
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = combine
          upstreams = images=s3:imagesbucket files=drive:important/files
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Configuring for Google Drive Shared Drives

   Rclone has a convenience feature for making a combine backend for all the shared drives you have access to.

   Assuming your main (non shared drive) Google drive remote is called drive: you would run

          rclone backend -o config drives drive:

   This would produce something like this:

          [My Drive]
          type = alias
          remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEF-01234567890,root_folder_id=:

          [Test Drive]
          type = alias
          remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl,root_folder_id=:

          [AllDrives]
          type = combine
          upstreams = "My Drive=My Drive:" "Test Drive=Test Drive:"

   If  you then add that config to your config file (find it with rclone config file) then you can access all the shared drives in one place with the AllDrives:
   remote.

   See the Google Drive docs (https://rclone.org/drive/#drives) for full info.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to combine (Combine several remotes into one).

--combine-upstreams

   Upstreams for combining

   These should be in the form

          dir=remote:path dir2=remote2:path

   Where before the = is specified the root directory and after is the remote to put there.

   Embedded spaces can be added using quotes

          "dir=remote:path with space" "dir2=remote2:path with space"

   Properties:

    Config: upstreams

    Env Var: RCLONE_COMBINE_UPSTREAMS

    Type: SpaceSepList

    Default:

Metadata

   Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Dropbox

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Dropbox paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for dropbox involves getting a token from Dropbox which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Dropbox
             \ "dropbox"
          [snip]
          Storage> dropbox
          Dropbox App Key - leave blank normally.
          app_key>
          Dropbox App Secret - leave blank normally.
          app_secret>
          Remote config
          Please visit:
          https://www.dropbox.com/1/oauth2/authorize?client_id=XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX&response_type=code
          Enter the code: XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX_XXXXXXXXXX
          --------------------
          [remote]
          app_key =
          app_secret =
          token = XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX_XXXX_XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Dropbox.  This only runs from the moment it opens your  browser
   to  the  moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a
   host firewall, or use manual mode.

   You can then use it like this,

   List directories in top level of your dropbox

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your dropbox

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to a dropbox directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Dropbox for business

   Rclone supports Dropbox for business and Team Folders.

   When using Dropbox for business remote: and remote:path/to/file will refer to your personal folder.

   If you wish to see Team Folders you must use a leading / in the path, so rclone lsd remote:/ will refer to the root and show you all Team  Folders  and  your
   User Folder.

   You can then use team folders like this remote:/TeamFolder and remote:/TeamFolder/path/to/file.

   A leading / for a Dropbox personal account will do nothing, but it will take an extra HTTP transaction so it should be avoided.

Modified time and Hashes

   Dropbox supports modified times, but the only way to set a modification time is to re-upload the file.

   This  means  that  if you uploaded your data with an older version of rclone which didn't support the v2 API and modified times, rclone will decide to upload
   all your old data to fix the modification times.  If you don't want this to happen use --size-only or --checksum flag to stop it.

   Dropbox supports its own hash type (https://www.dropbox.com/developers/reference/content-hash) which is checked for all transfers.

Restricted filename characters

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        
   DEL         0x7F         
   \           0x5C        

   File names can also not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Batch mode uploads

   Using batch mode uploads is very important for performance when  using  the  Dropbox  API.   See  the  dropbox  performance  guide  (https://developers.drop
   box.com/dbx-performance-guide) for more info.

   There are 3 modes rclone can use for uploads.

--dropbox-batch-mode off

   In  this  mode  rclone  will not use upload batching.  This was the default before rclone v1.55.  It has the disadvantage that it is very likely to encounter
   too_many_requests errors like this

          NOTICE: too_many_requests/.: Too many requests or write operations. Trying again in 15 seconds.

   When rclone receives these it has to wait for 15s or sometimes 300s before continuing which really slows down transfers.

   This will happen especially if --transfers is large, so this mode isn't recommended except for compatibility or investigating problems.

--dropbox-batch-mode sync

   In this mode rclone will batch up uploads to the size specified by --dropbox-batch-size and commit them together.

   Using this mode means you can use a much higher --transfers parameter (32 or 64 works fine) without receiving too_many_requests errors.

   This mode ensures full data integrity.

   Note that there may be a pause when quitting rclone while rclone finishes up the last batch using this mode.

--dropbox-batch-mode async

   In this mode rclone will batch up uploads to the size specified by --dropbox-batch-size and commit them together.

   However it will not wait for the status of the batch to be returned to the caller.  This means rclone can use a much bigger  batch  size  (much  bigger  than
   --transfers), at the cost of not being able to check the status of the upload.

   This  provides  the  maximum  possible upload speed especially with lots of small files, however rclone can't check the file got uploaded properly using this
   mode.

   If you are using this mode then using "rclone check" after the transfer completes is recommended.  Or you could do an initial transfer with  --dropbox-batch-
   mode async then do a final transfer with --dropbox-batch-mode sync (the default).

   Note that there may be a pause when quitting rclone while rclone finishes up the last batch using this mode.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to dropbox (Dropbox).

--dropbox-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--dropbox-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to dropbox (Dropbox).

--dropbox-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--dropbox-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--dropbox-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--dropbox-chunk-size

   Upload chunk size (< 150Mi).

   Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of this size.

   Note  that  chunks are buffered in memory (one at a time) so rclone can deal with retries.  Setting this larger will increase the speed slightly (at most 10%
   for 128 MiB in tests) at the cost of using more memory.  It can be set smaller if you are tight on memory.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 48Mi

--dropbox-impersonate

   Impersonate this user when using a business account.

   Note that if you want to use impersonate, you should make sure this flag is set when running "rclone config" as this will cause rclone to request  the  "mem‐
   bers.read" scope which it won't normally.  This is needed to lookup a members email address into the internal ID that dropbox uses in the API.

   Using the "members.read" scope will require a Dropbox Team Admin to approve during the OAuth flow.

   You  will have to use your own App (setting your own client_id and client_secret) to use this option as currently rclone's default set of permissions doesn't
   include "members.read".  This can be added once v1.55 or later is in use everywhere.

   Properties:

    Config: impersonate

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_IMPERSONATE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--dropbox-shared-files

   Instructs rclone to work on individual shared files.

   In this mode rclone's features are extremely limited - only list (ls, lsl, etc.)  operations and read operations (e.g.  downloading) are  supported  in  this
   mode.  All other operations will be disabled.

   Properties:

    Config: shared_files

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_SHARED_FILES

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--dropbox-shared-folders

   Instructs rclone to work on shared folders.

   When  this  flag  is used with no path only the List operation is supported and all available shared folders will be listed.  If you specify a path the first
   part will be interpreted as the name of shared folder.  Rclone will then try to mount this shared to the root namespace.  On  success  shared  folder  rclone
   proceeds normally.  The shared folder is now pretty much a normal folder and all normal operations are supported.

   Note that we don't unmount the shared folder afterwards so the --dropbox-shared-folders can be omitted after the first use of a particular shared folder.

   Properties:

    Config: shared_folders

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_SHARED_FOLDERS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--dropbox-batch-mode

   Upload file batching sync|async|off.

   This sets the batch mode used by rclone.

   For full info see the main docs (https://rclone.org/dropbox/#batch-mode)

   This has 3 possible values

    off - no batching

    sync - batch uploads and check completion (default)

    async - batch upload and don't check completion

   Rclone will close any outstanding batches when it exits which may make a delay on quit.

   Properties:

    Config: batch_mode

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_MODE

    Type: string

    Default: "sync"

--dropbox-batch-size

   Max number of files in upload batch.

   This sets the batch size of files to upload.  It has to be less than 1000.

   By default this is 0 which means rclone which calculate the batch size depending on the setting of batch_mode.

    batch_mode: async - default batch_size is 100

    batch_mode: sync - default batch_size is the same as --transfers

    batch_mode: off - not in use

   Rclone will close any outstanding batches when it exits which may make a delay on quit.

   Setting this is a great idea if you are uploading lots of small files as it will make them a lot quicker.  You can use --transfers 32 to maximise throughput.

   Properties:

    Config: batch_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_SIZE

    Type: int

    Default: 0

--dropbox-batch-timeout

   Max time to allow an idle upload batch before uploading.

   If an upload batch is idle for more than this long then it will be uploaded.

   The default for this is 0 which means rclone will choose a sensible default based on the batch_mode in use.

    batch_mode: async - default batch_timeout is 500ms

    batch_mode: sync - default batch_timeout is 10s

    batch_mode: off - not in use

   Properties:

    Config: batch_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 0s

--dropbox-batch-commit-timeout

   Max time to wait for a batch to finish committing

   Properties:

    Config: batch_commit_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_COMMIT_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 10m0s

--dropbox-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that Dropbox is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   There  are  some  file  names  such  as  thumbs.db  which  Dropbox can't store.  There is a full list of them in the "Ignored Files" section of this document
   (https://www.dropbox.com/en/help/145).  Rclone will issue an error message File name disallowed - not uploading if it attempts to upload one  of  those  file
   names, but the sync won't fail.

   Some  errors  may  occur  if you try to sync copyright-protected files because Dropbox has its own copyright detector (https://techcrunch.com/2014/03/30/how-
   dropbox-knows-when-youre-sharing-copyrighted-stuff-without-actually-looking-at-your-stuff/) that prevents this sort of file being downloaded.  This will  re‐
   turn the error ERROR : /path/to/your/file: Failed to copy: failed to open source object: path/restricted_content/.

   If  you  have more than 10,000 files in a directory then rclone purge dropbox:dir will return the error Failed to purge: There are too many files involved in
   this operation.  As a work-around do an rclone delete dropbox:dir followed by an rclone rmdir dropbox:dir.

   When using rclone link you'll need to set --expire if using a non-personal account otherwise the visibility may not be correct.  (Note  that  --expire  isn't
   supported  on  personal  accounts).   See  the  forum discussion (https://forum.rclone.org/t/rclone-link-dropbox-permissions/23211) and the dropbox SDK issue
   (https://github.com/dropbox/dropbox-sdk-go-unofficial/issues/75).

Get your own Dropbox App ID

   When you use rclone with Dropbox in its default configuration you are using rclone's App ID.  This is shared between all the rclone users.

   Here is how to create your own Dropbox App ID for rclone:

   1. Log into the Dropbox App console (https://www.dropbox.com/developers/apps/create) with your Dropbox Account (It need not to be the  same  account  as  the
      Dropbox you want to access)

   2. Choose an API => Usually this should be Dropbox API

   3. Choose the type of access you want to use => Full Dropbox or App Folder

   4. Name your App.  The app name is global, so you can't use rclone for example

   5. Click the button Create App

   6. Switch  to  the  Permissions  tab.   Enable  at  least the following permissions: account_info.read, files.metadata.write, files.content.write, files.con
      tent.read, sharing.write.  The files.metadata.read and sharing.read checkboxes will be marked too.  Click Submit

   7. Switch to the Settings tab.  Fill OAuth2 - Redirect URIs as http://localhost:53682/

   8. Find the App key and App secret values on the Settings tab.  Use these values in rclone config to add a new remote or edit an existing  remote.   The  App
      key setting corresponds to client_id in rclone config, the App secret corresponds to client_secret

Enterprise File Fabric

   This  backend  supports  Storage Made Easy's Enterprise File Fabric (https://storagemadeeasy.com/about/) which provides a software solution to integrate and
   unify File and Object Storage accessible through a global file system.

Configuration

   The initial setup for the Enterprise File Fabric backend involves getting a token from the Enterprise File Fabric which you  need  to  do  in  your  browser.
   rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Enterprise File Fabric
             \ "filefabric"
          [snip]
          Storage> filefabric
          ** See help for filefabric backend at: https://rclone.org/filefabric/ **

          URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Storage Made Easy US
             \ "https://storagemadeeasy.com"
           2 / Storage Made Easy EU
             \ "https://eu.storagemadeeasy.com"
           3 / Connect to your Enterprise File Fabric
             \ "https://yourfabric.smestorage.com"
          url> https://yourfabric.smestorage.com/
          ID of the root folder
          Leave blank normally.

          Fill in to make rclone start with directory of a given ID.

          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          root_folder_id>
          Permanent Authentication Token

          A Permanent Authentication Token can be created in the Enterprise File
          Fabric, on the users Dashboard under Security, there is an entry
          you'll see called "My Authentication Tokens". Click the Manage button
          to create one.

          These tokens are normally valid for several years.

          For more info see: https://docs.storagemadeeasy.com/organisationcloud/api-tokens

          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          permanent_token> xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = filefabric
          url = https://yourfabric.smestorage.com/
          permanent_token = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Enterprise File Fabric

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your Enterprise File Fabric

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an Enterprise File Fabric directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   The  Enterprise  File Fabric allows modification times to be set on files accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
   not.

   The Enterprise File Fabric does not support any data hashes at this time.

Restricted filename characters

   The default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) will be replaced.

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Empty files

   Empty files aren't supported by the Enterprise File Fabric.  Rclone will therefore upload an empty file as a single  space  with  a  mime  type  of  applica
   tion/vnd.rclone.empty.file and files with that mime type are treated as empty.

Root folder ID

   You  can set the root_folder_id for rclone.  This is the directory (identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root of your Enterprise File
   Fabric.

   Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the correct root to use itself.

   However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

   In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you wish rclone to display.  These aren't displayed in the web  interface,  but  you
   can use rclone lsf to find them, for example

          $ rclone lsf --dirs-only -Fip --csv filefabric:
          120673758,Burnt PDFs/
          120673759,My Quick Uploads/
          120673755,My Syncs/
          120673756,My backups/
          120673757,My contacts/
          120673761,S3 Storage/

   The ID for "S3 Storage" would be 120673761.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to filefabric (Enterprise File Fabric).

--filefabric-url

   URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to.

   Properties:

    Config: url

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_URL

    Type: string

    Required: true

    Examples:

      "https://storagemadeeasy.com"

        Storage Made Easy US

      "https://eu.storagemadeeasy.com"

        Storage Made Easy EU

      "https://yourfabric.smestorage.com"

        Connect to your Enterprise File Fabric

--filefabric-root-folder-id

   ID of the root folder.

   Leave blank normally.

   Fill in to make rclone start with directory of a given ID.

   Properties:

    Config: root_folder_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--filefabric-permanent-token

   Permanent Authentication Token.

   A Permanent Authentication Token can be created in the Enterprise File Fabric, on the users Dashboard under Security, there is an entry you'll see called "My
   Authentication Tokens".  Click the Manage button to create one.

   These tokens are normally valid for several years.

   For more info see: https://docs.storagemadeeasy.com/organisationcloud/api-tokens

   Properties:

    Config: permanent_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_PERMANENT_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to filefabric (Enterprise File Fabric).

--filefabric-token

   Session Token.

   This is a session token which rclone caches in the config file.  It is usually valid for 1 hour.

   Don't set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--filefabric-token-expiry

   Token expiry time.

   Don't set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

   Properties:

    Config: token_expiry

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_TOKEN_EXPIRY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--filefabric-version

   Version read from the file fabric.

   Don't set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

   Properties:

    Config: version

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_VERSION

    Type: string

    Required: false

--filefabric-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

FTP

   FTP is the File Transfer Protocol.  Rclone FTP support is provided using the github.com/jlaffaye/ftp (https://godoc.org/github.com/jlaffaye/ftp) package.

   Limitations of Rclone's FTP backend

   Paths are specified as remote:path.  If the path does not begin with a / it is relative to the home directory of the user.  An empty path remote:  refers  to
   the user's home directory.

Configuration

   To create an FTP configuration named remote, run

          rclone config

   Rclone  config  guides  you  through an interactive setup process.  A minimal rclone FTP remote definition only requires host, username and password.  For an
   anonymous FTP server, see below.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/r/c/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / FTP
             \ "ftp"
          [snip]
          Storage> ftp
          ** See help for ftp backend at: https://rclone.org/ftp/ **

          FTP host to connect to
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to ftp.example.com
             \ "ftp.example.com"
          host> ftp.example.com
          FTP username
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("$USER").
          user>
          FTP port number
          Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default (21).
          port>
          FTP password
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Use FTP over TLS (Implicit)
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          tls>
          Use FTP over TLS (Explicit)
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          explicit_tls>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = ftp
          host = ftp.example.com
          pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   To see all directories in the home directory of remote

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new directory

          rclone mkdir remote:path/to/directory

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:path/to/directory

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote directory, deleting any excess files in the directory.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:directory

Anonymous FTP

   When connecting to a FTP server that allows anonymous login, you can use the special "anonymous" username.  Traditionally,  this  user  account  accepts  any
   string  as  a  password,  although it is common to use either the password "anonymous" or "guest".  Some servers require the use of a valid e-mail address as
   password.

   Using on-the-fly or connection string (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings) remotes makes it easy to access such servers, without requiring any  con‐
   figuration in advance.  The following are examples of that:

          rclone lsf :ftp: --ftp-host=speedtest.tele2.net --ftp-user=anonymous --ftp-pass=$(rclone obscure dummy)
          rclone lsf :ftp,host=speedtest.tele2.net,user=anonymous,pass=$(rclone obscure dummy):

   The  above  examples  work  in  Linux  shells  and  in  PowerShell, but not Windows Command Prompt.  They execute the rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/com
   mands/rclone_obscure/) command to create a password string in the format required by the pass option.  The following examples are exactly  the  same,  except
   use an already obscured string representation of the same password "dummy", and therefore works even in Windows Command Prompt:

          rclone lsf :ftp: --ftp-host=speedtest.tele2.net --ftp-user=anonymous --ftp-pass=IXs2wc8OJOz7SYLBk47Ji1rHTmxM
          rclone lsf :ftp,host=speedtest.tele2.net,user=anonymous,pass=IXs2wc8OJOz7SYLBk47Ji1rHTmxM:

Implicit TLS

   Rlone  FTP  supports  implicit FTP over TLS servers (FTPS).  This has to be enabled in the FTP backend config for the remote, or with --ftp-tls.  The default
   FTPS port is 990, not 21 and can be set with --ftp-port.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   File names cannot end with the following characters.  Replacement is limited to the last character in a file name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         

   Not all FTP servers can have all characters in file names, for example:

   FTP Server   Forbidden characters
   
   proftpd               *
   pureftpd            \ [ ]

   This backend's interactive configuration wizard provides a selection of sensible encoding settings for major FTP servers: ProFTPd,  PureFTPd,  VsFTPd.   Just
   hit a selection number when prompted.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to ftp (FTP).

--ftp-host

   FTP host to connect to.

   E.g.  "ftp.example.com".

   Properties:

    Config: host

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_HOST

    Type: string

    Required: true

--ftp-user

   FTP username.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_USER

    Type: string

    Default: "$USER"

--ftp-port

   FTP port number.

   Properties:

    Config: port

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_PORT

    Type: int

    Default: 21

--ftp-pass

   FTP password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--ftp-tls

   Use Implicit FTPS (FTP over TLS).

   When  using  implicit FTP over TLS the client connects using TLS right from the start which breaks compatibility with non-TLS-aware servers.  This is usually
   served over port 990 rather than port 21.  Cannot be used in combination with explicit FTPS.

   Properties:

    Config: tls

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_TLS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-explicit-tls

   Use Explicit FTPS (FTP over TLS).

   When using explicit FTP over TLS the client explicitly requests security from the server in order to upgrade a plain text connection  to  an  encrypted  one.
   Cannot be used in combination with implicit FTPS.

   Properties:

    Config: explicit_tls

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_EXPLICIT_TLS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to ftp (FTP).

--ftp-concurrency

   Maximum number of FTP simultaneous connections, 0 for unlimited.

   Note that setting this is very likely to cause deadlocks so it should be used with care.

   If you are doing a sync or copy then make sure concurrency is one more than the sum of --transfers and --checkers.

   If you use --check-first then it just needs to be one more than the maximum of --checkers and --transfers.

   So for concurrency 3 you'd use --checkers 2 --transfers 2 --check-first or --checkers 1 --transfers 1.

   Properties:

    Config: concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 0

--ftp-no-check-certificate

   Do not verify the TLS certificate of the server.

   Properties:

    Config: no_check_certificate

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_NO_CHECK_CERTIFICATE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-disable-epsv

   Disable using EPSV even if server advertises support.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_epsv

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_EPSV

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-disable-mlsd

   Disable using MLSD even if server advertises support.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_mlsd

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_MLSD

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-disable-utf8

   Disable using UTF-8 even if server advertises support.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_utf8

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_UTF8

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-writing-mdtm

   Use MDTM to set modification time (VsFtpd quirk)

   Properties:

    Config: writing_mdtm

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_WRITING_MDTM

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-force-list-hidden

   Use LIST -a to force listing of hidden files and folders.  This will disable the use of MLSD.

   Properties:

    Config: force_list_hidden

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_FORCE_LIST_HIDDEN

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-idle-timeout

   Max time before closing idle connections.

   If no connections have been returned to the connection pool in the time given, rclone will empty the connection pool.

   Set to 0 to keep connections indefinitely.

   Properties:

    Config: idle_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_IDLE_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--ftp-close-timeout

   Maximum time to wait for a response to close.

   Properties:

    Config: close_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_CLOSE_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--ftp-tls-cache-size

   Size of TLS session cache for all control and data connections.

   TLS  cache  allows to resume TLS sessions and reuse PSK between connections.  Increase if default size is not enough resulting in TLS resumption errors.  En
   abled by default.  Use 0 to disable.

   Properties:

    Config: tls_cache_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_TLS_CACHE_SIZE

    Type: int

    Default: 32

--ftp-disable-tls13

   Disable TLS 1.3 (workaround for FTP servers with buggy TLS)

   Properties:

    Config: disable_tls13

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_TLS13

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-shut-timeout

   Maximum time to wait for data connection closing status.

   Properties:

    Config: shut_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_SHUT_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--ftp-ask-password

   Allow asking for FTP password when needed.

   If this is set and no password is supplied then rclone will ask for a password

   Properties:

    Config: ask_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_ASK_PASSWORD

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--ftp-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot

    Examples:

      "Asterisk,Ctl,Dot,Slash"

        ProFTPd can't handle '*' in file names

     • "BackSlash,Ctl,Del,Dot,RightSpace,Slash,SquareBracket"

       • PureFTPd can't handle '[]' or '*' in file names

      "Ctl,LeftPeriod,Slash"

        VsFTPd can't handle file names starting with dot

Limitations

   FTP servers acting as rclone remotes must support passive mode.  The mode cannot be configured as passive is the only supported one.  Rclone's FTP  implemen‐
   tation  is  not compatible with active mode as the library it uses doesn't support it (https://github.com/jlaffaye/ftp/issues/29).  This will likely never be
   supported due to security concerns.

   Rclone's FTP backend does not support any checksums but can compare file sizes.

   rclone about is not supported by the FTP backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy  mfs  (most
   free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

   The implementation of : --dump headers, --dump bodies, --dump auth for debugging isn't the same as for rclone HTTP based backends - it has less fine  grained
   control.

   --timeout isn't supported (but --contimeout is).

   --bind isn't supported.

   Rclone's FTP backend could support server-side move but does not at present.

   The ftp_proxy environment variable is not currently supported.

Modified time

   File  modification time (timestamps) is supported to 1 second resolution for major FTP servers: ProFTPd, PureFTPd, VsFTPd, and FileZilla FTP server.  The Vs
   FTPd server has non-standard implementation of time related protocol commands and needs a special configuration setting: writing_mdtm = true.

   Support for precise file time with other FTP servers varies depending on what protocol extensions they advertise.  If all the MLSD, MDTM and MFTM  extensions
   are  present, rclone will use them together to provide precise time.  Otherwise the times you see on the FTP server through rclone are those of the last file
   upload.

   You can use the following command to check whether rclone can use precise time with your FTP server: rclone backend features your_ftp_remote:  (the  trailing
   colon  is  important).   Look  for  the  number  in  the line tagged by Precision designating the remote time precision expressed as nanoseconds.  A value of
   1000000000 means that file time precision of 1 second is available.  A value of 3153600000000000000 (or another large number) means "unsupported".

Google Cloud Storage

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Configuration

   The initial setup for google cloud storage involves getting a token from Google Cloud Storage which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks  you
   through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)
             \ "google cloud storage"
          [snip]
          Storage> google cloud storage
          Google Application Client Id - leave blank normally.
          client_id>
          Google Application Client Secret - leave blank normally.
          client_secret>
          Project number optional - needed only for list/create/delete buckets - see your developer console.
          project_number> 12345678
          Service Account Credentials JSON file path - needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.
          service_account_file>
          Access Control List for new objects.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
             \ "authenticatedRead"
           2 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get OWNER access.
             \ "bucketOwnerFullControl"
           3 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get READER access.
             \ "bucketOwnerRead"
           4 / Object owner gets OWNER access [default if left blank].
             \ "private"
           5 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team members get access according to their roles.
             \ "projectPrivate"
           6 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
             \ "publicRead"
          object_acl> 4
          Access Control List for new buckets.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
             \ "authenticatedRead"
           2 / Project team owners get OWNER access [default if left blank].
             \ "private"
           3 / Project team members get access according to their roles.
             \ "projectPrivate"
           4 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
             \ "publicRead"
           5 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get WRITER access.
             \ "publicReadWrite"
          bucket_acl> 2
          Location for the newly created buckets.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Empty for default location (US).
             \ ""
           2 / Multi-regional location for Asia.
             \ "asia"
           3 / Multi-regional location for Europe.
             \ "eu"
           4 / Multi-regional location for United States.
             \ "us"
           5 / Taiwan.
             \ "asia-east1"
           6 / Tokyo.
             \ "asia-northeast1"
           7 / Singapore.
             \ "asia-southeast1"
           8 / Sydney.
             \ "australia-southeast1"
           9 / Belgium.
             \ "europe-west1"
          10 / London.
             \ "europe-west2"
          11 / Iowa.
             \ "us-central1"
          12 / South Carolina.
             \ "us-east1"
          13 / Northern Virginia.
             \ "us-east4"
          14 / Oregon.
             \ "us-west1"
          location> 12
          The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
           2 / Multi-regional storage class
             \ "MULTI_REGIONAL"
           3 / Regional storage class
             \ "REGIONAL"
           4 / Nearline storage class
             \ "NEARLINE"
           5 / Coldline storage class
             \ "COLDLINE"
           6 / Durable reduced availability storage class
             \ "DURABLE_REDUCED_AVAILABILITY"
          storage_class> 5
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = google cloud storage
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          token = {"AccessToken":"xxxx.xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","RefreshToken":"x/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxx","Expiry":"2014-07-17T20:49:14.929208288+01:00","Extra":null}
          project_number = 12345678
          object_acl = private
          bucket_acl = private
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note  that  rclone  runs  a  webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Google if using web browser to automatically authenticate.
   This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and  this  it  may
   require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all the buckets in your project

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new bucket

          rclone mkdir remote:bucket

   List the contents of a bucket

          rclone ls remote:bucket

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:bucket

Service Account support

   You can set up rclone with Google Cloud Storage in an unattended mode, i.e.  not tied to a specific end-user Google account.  This is useful when you want to
   synchronise files onto machines that don't have actively logged-in users, for example build machines.

   To get credentials for Google Cloud Platform IAM Service Accounts (https://cloud.google.com/iam/docs/service-accounts), please head to  the  Service  Account
   (https://console.cloud.google.com/permissions/serviceaccounts)  section  of the Google Developer Console.  Service Accounts behave just like normal User per‐
   missions in Google Cloud Storage ACLs (https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/access-control), so you can limit their access (e.g.  make them read only).  Af‐
   ter  creating  an account, a JSON file containing the Service Account's credentials will be downloaded onto your machines.  These credentials are what rclone
   will use for authentication.

   To use a Service Account instead of OAuth2 token flow, enter the path to your Service Account credentials at the service_account_file prompt and rclone won't
   use  the  browser based authentication flow.  If you'd rather stuff the contents of the credentials file into the rclone config file, you can set service_ac
   count_credentials with the actual contents of the file instead, or set the equivalent environment variable.

Anonymous Access

   For downloads of objects that permit public access you can configure rclone to use anonymous access by setting anonymous to true.  With  unauthorized  access
   you can't write or create files but only read or list those buckets and objects that have public read access.

Application Default Credentials

   If  no  other  source  of  credentials  is  provided,  rclone  will  fall  back  to  Application Default Credentials (https://cloud.google.com/video-intelli
   gence/docs/common/auth#authenticating_with_application_default_credentials) this is useful both when you already have configured authentication for your  de‐
   veloper  account,  or  in  production when running on a google compute host.  Note that if running in docker, you may need to run additional commands on your
   google compute machine - see this page (https://cloud.google.com/container-registry/docs/advanced-authentication#gcloud_as_a_docker_credential_helper).

   Note that in the case application default credentials are used, there is no need to explicitly configure a project number.

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

Custom upload headers

   You  can  set custom upload headers with the --header-upload flag.  Google Cloud Storage supports the headers as described in the working with metadata docu
   mentation (https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/gsutil/addlhelp/WorkingWithObjectMetadata)

    Cache-Control

    Content-Disposition

    Content-Encoding

    Content-Language

    Content-Type

    X-Goog-Storage-Class

    X-Goog-Meta-

   Eg --header-upload "Content-Type text/potato"

   Note that the last of these is for setting custom metadata in the form --header-upload "x-goog-meta-key: value"

Modification time

   Google Cloud Storage stores md5sum natively.  Google's gsutil (https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/gsutil) tool stores modification  time  with  one-second
   precision as goog-reserved-file-mtime in file metadata.

   To  ensure  compatibility  with gsutil, rclone stores modification time in 2 separate metadata entries.  mtime uses RFC3339 format with one-nanosecond preci‐
   sion.  goog-reserved-file-mtime uses Unix timestamp format with one-second precision.  To get modification time from object metadata, rclone reads the  meta‐
   data in the following order: mtime, goog-reserved-file-mtime, object updated time.

   Note  that  rclone's  default  modify  window is 1ns.  Files uploaded by gsutil only contain timestamps with one-second precision.  If you use rclone to sync
   files previously uploaded by gsutil, rclone will attempt to update modification time for all these files.  To avoid these possibly unnecessary  updates,  use
   --modify-window 1s.

Restricted filename characters

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   LF          0x0A         
   CR          0x0D         
   /           0x2F        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to google cloud storage (Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)).

--gcs-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-project-number

   Project number.

   Optional - needed only for list/create/delete buckets - see your developer console.

   Properties:

    Config: project_number

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_PROJECT_NUMBER

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-service-account-file

   Service Account Credentials JSON file path.

   Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

   Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

   Properties:

    Config: service_account_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-service-account-credentials

   Service Account Credentials JSON blob.

   Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

   Properties:

    Config: service_account_credentials

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_CREDENTIALS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-anonymous

   Access public buckets and objects without credentials.

   Set to 'true' if you just want to download files and don't configure credentials.

   Properties:

    Config: anonymous

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ANONYMOUS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--gcs-object-acl

   Access Control List for new objects.

   Properties:

    Config: object_acl

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_OBJECT_ACL

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "authenticatedRead"

        Object owner gets OWNER access.

        All Authenticated Users get READER access.

      "bucketOwnerFullControl"

        Object owner gets OWNER access.

        Project team owners get OWNER access.

      "bucketOwnerRead"

        Object owner gets OWNER access.

        Project team owners get READER access.

      "private"

        Object owner gets OWNER access.

        Default if left blank.

      "projectPrivate"

        Object owner gets OWNER access.

        Project team members get access according to their roles.

      "publicRead"

        Object owner gets OWNER access.

        All Users get READER access.

--gcs-bucket-acl

   Access Control List for new buckets.

   Properties:

    Config: bucket_acl

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_BUCKET_ACL

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "authenticatedRead"

        Project team owners get OWNER access.

        All Authenticated Users get READER access.

      "private"

        Project team owners get OWNER access.

        Default if left blank.

      "projectPrivate"

        Project team members get access according to their roles.

      "publicRead"

        Project team owners get OWNER access.

        All Users get READER access.

      "publicReadWrite"

        Project team owners get OWNER access.

        All Users get WRITER access.

--gcs-bucket-policy-only

   Access checks should use bucket-level IAM policies.

   If you want to upload objects to a bucket with Bucket Policy Only set then you will need to set this.

   When it is set, rclone:

    ignores ACLs set on buckets

    ignores ACLs set on objects

    creates buckets with Bucket Policy Only set

   Docs: https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/bucket-policy-only

   Properties:

    Config: bucket_policy_only

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_BUCKET_POLICY_ONLY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--gcs-location

   Location for the newly created buckets.

   Properties:

    Config: location

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_LOCATION

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Empty for default location (US)

      "asia"

        Multi-regional location for Asia

      "eu"

        Multi-regional location for Europe

      "us"

        Multi-regional location for United States

      "asia-east1"

        Taiwan

      "asia-east2"

        Hong Kong

      "asia-northeast1"

        Tokyo

      "asia-northeast2"

        Osaka

      "asia-northeast3"

        Seoul

      "asia-south1"

        Mumbai

      "asia-south2"

        Delhi

      "asia-southeast1"

        Singapore

      "asia-southeast2"

        Jakarta

      "australia-southeast1"

        Sydney

      "australia-southeast2"

        Melbourne

      "europe-north1"

        Finland

      "europe-west1"

        Belgium

      "europe-west2"

        London

      "europe-west3"

        Frankfurt

      "europe-west4"

        Netherlands

      "europe-west6"

        Zürich

      "europe-central2"

        Warsaw

      "us-central1"

        Iowa

      "us-east1"

        South Carolina

      "us-east4"

        Northern Virginia

      "us-west1"

        Oregon

      "us-west2"

        California

      "us-west3"

        Salt Lake City

      "us-west4"

        Las Vegas

      "northamerica-northeast1"

        Montréal

      "northamerica-northeast2"

        Toronto

      "southamerica-east1"

        São Paulo

      "southamerica-west1"

        Santiago

      "asia1"

        Dual region: asia-northeast1 and asia-northeast2.

      "eur4"

        Dual region: europe-north1 and europe-west4.

      "nam4"

        Dual region: us-central1 and us-east1.

--gcs-storage-class

   The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_class

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_STORAGE_CLASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default

      "MULTI_REGIONAL"

        Multi-regional storage class

      "REGIONAL"

        Regional storage class

      "NEARLINE"

        Nearline storage class

      "COLDLINE"

        Coldline storage class

      "ARCHIVE"

        Archive storage class

      "DURABLE_REDUCED_AVAILABILITY"

        Durable reduced availability storage class

--gcs-env-auth

   Get GCP IAM credentials from runtime (environment variables or instance meta data if no env vars).

   Only applies if service_account_file and service_account_credentials is blank.

   Properties:

    Config: env_auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ENV_AUTH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "false"

        Enter credentials in the next step.

      "true"

        Get GCP IAM credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to google cloud storage (Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)).

--gcs-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-no-check-bucket

   If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it.

   This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does if you know the bucket exists already.

   Properties:

    Config: no_check_bucket

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_NO_CHECK_BUCKET

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--gcs-decompress

   If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects.

   It is possible to upload objects to GCS with "Content-Encoding: gzip" set.  Normally rclone will download these files as compressed objects.

   If  this flag is set then rclone will decompress these files with "Content-Encoding: gzip" as they are received.  This means that rclone can't check the size
   and hash but the file contents will be decompressed.

   Properties:

    Config: decompress

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_DECOMPRESS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--gcs-endpoint

   Endpoint for the service.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gcs-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   rclone about is not supported by the Google Cloud Storage backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount  or  use
   policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Google Drive

   Paths are specified as drive:path

   Drive paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  drive:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for drive involves getting a token from Google drive which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/r/c/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Google Drive
             \ "drive"
          [snip]
          Storage> drive
          Google Application Client Id - leave blank normally.
          client_id>
          Google Application Client Secret - leave blank normally.
          client_secret>
          Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Full access all files, excluding Application Data Folder.
             \ "drive"
           2 / Read-only access to file metadata and file contents.
             \ "drive.readonly"
             / Access to files created by rclone only.
           3 | These are visible in the drive website.
             | File authorization is revoked when the user deauthorizes the app.
             \ "drive.file"
             / Allows read and write access to the Application Data folder.
           4 | This is not visible in the drive website.
             \ "drive.appfolder"
             / Allows read-only access to file metadata but
           5 | does not allow any access to read or download file content.
             \ "drive.metadata.readonly"
          scope> 1
          Service Account Credentials JSON file path - needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.
          service_account_file>
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          Configure this as a Shared Drive (Team Drive)?
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          [remote]
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          scope = drive
          root_folder_id =
          service_account_file =
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2014-03-16T13:57:58.955387075Z"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Google if using  web  browser  to  automatically  authenticate.
   This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and it may require
   you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

   You can then use it like this,

   List directories in top level of your drive

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your drive

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to a drive directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Scopes

   Rclone allows you to select which scope you would like for rclone to use.  This changes what type of token is granted to rclone.  The scopes are defined here
   (https://developers.google.com/drive/v3/web/about-auth).

   The scope are

drive

   This is the default scope and allows full access to all files, except for the Application Data Folder (see below).

   Choose this one if you aren't sure.

drive.readonly

   This allows read only access to all files.  Files may be listed and downloaded but not uploaded, renamed or deleted.

drive.file

   With this scope rclone can read/view/modify only those files and folders it creates.

   So if you uploaded files to drive via the web interface (or any other means) they will not be visible to rclone.

   This can be useful if you are using rclone to backup data and you want to be sure confidential data on your drive is not visible to rclone.

   Files created with this scope are visible in the web interface.

drive.appfolder

   This  gives  rclone  its own private area to store files.  Rclone will not be able to see any other files on your drive and you won't be able to see rclone's
   files from the web interface either.

drive.metadata.readonly

   This allows read only access to file names only.  It does not allow rclone to download or upload data, or rename or delete files or directories.

Root folder ID

   This option has been moved to the advanced section.  You can set the root_folder_id for rclone.  This is the directory (identified by  its  Folder  ID)  that
   rclone considers to be the root of your drive.

   Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the correct root to use itself.

   However  you  can  set  this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy or to access data within the "Computers" tab on the drive web interface (where
   files from Google's Backup and Sync desktop program go).

   In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you wish rclone to display.  This will be the last segment of the URL when you  open
   the relevant folder in the drive web interface.

   So  if  the folder you want rclone to use has a URL which looks like https://drive.google.com/drive/folders/1XyfxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxKHCh in the browser,
   then you use 1XyfxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxKHCh as the root_folder_id in the config.

   NB folders under the "Computers" tab seem to be read only (drive gives a 500 error) when using rclone.

   There doesn't appear to be an API to discover the folder IDs of the "Computers" tab - please contact us if you know otherwise!

   Note also that rclone can't access any data under the "Backups" tab on the google drive web interface yet.

Service Account support

   You can set up rclone with Google Drive in an unattended mode, i.e.  not tied to a specific end-user Google account.  This is useful when you  want  to  syn
   chronise files onto machines that don't have actively logged-in users, for example build machines.

   To  use  a  Service Account instead of OAuth2 token flow, enter the path to your Service Account credentials at the service_account_file prompt during rclone
   config and rclone won't use the browser based authentication flow.  If you'd rather stuff the contents of the credentials file into the rclone  config  file,
   you can set service_account_credentials with the actual contents of the file instead, or set the equivalent environment variable.

Use case - Google Apps/G-suite account and individual Drive

   Let's  say  that  you  are the administrator of a Google Apps (old) or G-suite account.  The goal is to store data on an individual's Drive account, who IS a
   member of the domain.  We'll call the domain example.com, and the user foo@example.com.

   There's a few steps we need to go through to accomplish this:
  1. Create a service account for example.com • To create a service account and obtain its credentials, go to the Google Developer Console (https://console.developers.google.com).

    • You must have a project - create one if you don't.

    • Then go to "IAM & admin" -> "Service Accounts".

    • Use the "Create Credentials" button. Fill in "Service account name" with something that identifies your client. "Role" can be empty.

    • Tick "Furnish a new private key" - select "Key type JSON".

    • Tick "Enable G Suite Domain-wide Delegation". This option makes "impersonation" possible, as documented here: Delegating domain-wide authority to the ser‐ vice account (https://developers.google.com/identity/protocols/OAuth2ServiceAccount#delegatingauthority)

    • These credentials are what rclone will use for authentication. If you ever need to remove access, press the "Delete service account key" button.

  2. Allowing API access to example.com Google Drive • Go to example.com's admin console

    • Go into "Security" (or use the search bar)

    • Select "Show more" and then "Advanced settings"

    • Select "Manage API client access" in the "Authentication" section

    • In the "Client Name" field enter the service account's "Client ID" - this can be found in the Developer Console under "IAM & Admin" -> "Service Accounts", then "View Client ID" for the newly created service account. It is a ~21 character numerical string.

    • In the next field, "One or More API Scopes", enter https://www.googleapis.com/auth/drive to grant access to Google Drive specifically.

  3. Configure rclone, assuming a new install

        rclone config
    
        n/s/q> n         # New
        name>gdrive      # Gdrive is an example name
        Storage>         # Select the number shown for Google Drive
        client_id>       # Can be left blank
        client_secret>   # Can be left blank
        scope>           # Select your scope, 1 for example
        root_folder_id>  # Can be left blank
        service_account_file> /home/foo/myJSONfile.json # This is where the JSON file goes!
        y/n>             # Auto config, n
  4. Verify that it's working • rclone -v --drive-impersonate foo@example.com lsf gdrive:backup

    • The arguments do:

    • -v - verbose logging

    • --drive-impersonate foo@example.com - this is what does the magic, pretending to be user foo.

    • lsf - list files in a parsing friendly way

    • gdrive:backup - use the remote called gdrive, work in the folder named backup.

    Note: in case you configured a specific root folder on gdrive and rclone is unable to access the contents of that folder when using --drive-impersonate, do this instead: - in the gdrive web interface, share your root folder with the user/email of the new Service Account you created/selected at step #1 - use rclone without specifying the --drive-impersonate option, like this: rclone -v lsf gdrive:backup

Shared drives (team drives)

   If you want to configure the remote to point to a Google Shared Drive (previously known as Team Drives) then answer y to the question  Configure  this  as  a
   Shared Drive (Team Drive)?.

   This  will  fetch  the list of Shared Drives from google and allow you to configure which one you want to use.  You can also type in a Shared Drive ID if you
   prefer.

   For example:

          Configure this as a Shared Drive (Team Drive)?
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          Fetching Shared Drive list...
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Rclone Test
             \ "xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx"
           2 / Rclone Test 2
             \ "yyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyy"
           3 / Rclone Test 3
             \ "zzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzz"
          Enter a Shared Drive ID> 1
          --------------------
          [remote]
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          token = {"AccessToken":"xxxx.x.xxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","RefreshToken":"1/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","Expiry":"2014-03-16T13:57:58.955387075Z","Extra":null}
          team_drive = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

   It does this by combining multiple list calls into a single API request.

   This  works  by  combining  many '%s' in parents filters into one expression.  To list the contents of directories a, b and c, the following requests will be
   send by the regular List function:

          trashed=false and 'a' in parents
          trashed=false and 'b' in parents
          trashed=false and 'c' in parents

   These can now be combined into a single request:

          trashed=false and ('a' in parents or 'b' in parents or 'c' in parents)

   The implementation of ListR will put up to 50 parents filters into one request.  It will use the --checkers value to specify the number of requests to run in
   parallel.

   In tests, these batch requests were up to 20x faster than the regular method.  Running the following command against different sized folders gives:

          rclone lsjson -vv -R --checkers=6 gdrive:folder

   small folder (220 directories, 700 files):

    without --fast-list: 38s

    with --fast-list: 10s

   large folder (10600 directories, 39000 files):

    without --fast-list: 22:05 min

    with --fast-list: 58s

Modified time

   Google drive stores modification times accurate to 1 ms.

Restricted filename characters

   Only Invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

   In contrast to other backends, / can also be used in names and . or .. are valid names.

Revisions

   Google  drive  stores  revisions  of  files.  When you upload a change to an existing file to google drive using rclone it will create a new revision of that
   file.

   Revisions follow the standard google policy which at time of writing was

    They are deleted after 30 days or 100 revisions (whatever comes first).

    They do not count towards a user storage quota.

Deleting files

   By default rclone will send all files to the trash when deleting files.  If deleting them permanently is required then use the --drive-use-trash=false  flag,
   or set the equivalent environment variable.

Shortcuts

   In March 2020 Google introduced a new feature in Google Drive called drive shortcuts (https://support.google.com/drive/answer/9700156) (API (https://develop
   ers.google.com/drive/api/v3/shortcuts)).  These will (by September 2020) replace the ability for  files  or  folders  to  be  in  multiple  folders  at  once
   (https://cloud.google.com/blog/products/g-suite/simplifying-google-drives-folder-structure-and-sharing-models).

   Shortcuts  are files that link to other files on Google Drive somewhat like a symlink in unix, except they point to the underlying file data (e.g.  the inode
   in unix terms) so they don't break if the source is renamed or moved about.

   Be default rclone treats these as follows.

   For shortcuts pointing to files:

    When listing a file shortcut appears as the destination file.

    When downloading the contents of the destination file is downloaded.

    When updating shortcut file with a non shortcut file, the shortcut is removed then a new file is uploaded in place of the shortcut.

    When server-side moving (renaming) the shortcut is renamed, not the destination file.

    When server-side copying the shortcut is copied, not the contents of the shortcut.  (unless --drive-copy-shortcut-content is in use in which case the  con
     tents of the shortcut gets copied).

    When deleting the shortcut is deleted not the linked file.

    When setting the modification time, the modification time of the linked file will be set.

   For shortcuts pointing to folders:

    When listing the shortcut appears as a folder and that folder will contain the contents of the linked folder appear (including any sub folders)

    When downloading the contents of the linked folder and sub contents are downloaded

    When uploading to a shortcut folder the file will be placed in the linked folder

    When server-side moving (renaming) the shortcut is renamed, not the destination folder

    When server-side copying the contents of the linked folder is copied, not the shortcut.

    When deleting with rclone rmdir or rclone purge the shortcut is deleted not the linked folder.

    NB When deleting with rclone remove or rclone mount the contents of the linked folder will be deleted.

   The rclone backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command can be used to create shortcuts.

   Shortcuts can be completely ignored with the --drive-skip-shortcuts flag or the corresponding skip_shortcuts configuration setting.

Emptying trash

   If  you  wish to empty your trash you can use the rclone cleanup remote: command which will permanently delete all your trashed files.  This command does not
   take any path arguments.

   Note that Google Drive takes some time (minutes to days) to empty the trash even though the command returns within a few seconds.  No output  is  echoed,  so
   there will be no confirmation even using -v or -vv.

Quota information

   To  view  your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display your usage limit (quota), the usage in Google Drive, the size of
   all files in the Trash and the space used by other Google services such as Gmail.  This command does not take any path arguments.

Import/Export of google documents

   Google documents can be exported from and uploaded to Google Drive.

   When rclone downloads a Google doc it chooses a format to download depending upon the --drive-export-formats setting.  By  default  the  export  formats  are
   docx,xlsx,pptx,svg which are a sensible default for an editable document.

   When  choosing a format, rclone runs down the list provided in order and chooses the first file format the doc can be exported as from the list.  If the file
   can't be exported to a format on the formats list, then rclone will choose a format from the default list.

   If you prefer an archive copy then you might use --drive-export-formats pdf, or if you prefer openoffice/libreoffice formats you  might  use  --drive-export-
   formats ods,odt,odp.

   Note  that  rclone  adds  the extension to the google doc, so if it is called My Spreadsheet on google docs, it will be exported as My Spreadsheet.xlsx or My
   Spreadsheet.pdf etc.

   When importing files into Google Drive, rclone will convert all files with an extension in --drive-import-formats to their associated document type.   rclone
   will not convert any files by default, since the conversion is lossy process.

   The conversion must result in a file with the same extension when the --drive-export-formats rules are applied to the uploaded document.

   Here are some examples for allowed and prohibited conversions.

   export-formats      import-formats      Upload Ext      Document Ext     Allowed
   
   odt                 odt                 odt             odt              Yes
   odt                 docx,odt            odt             odt              Yes
                       docx                docx            docx             Yes
                       odt                 odt             docx             No
   odt,docx            docx,odt            docx            odt              No
   docx,odt            docx,odt            docx            docx             Yes
   docx,odt            docx,odt            odt             docx             No

   This  limitation  can be disabled by specifying --drive-allow-import-name-change.  When using this flag, rclone can convert multiple files types resulting in
   the same document type at once, e.g.  with --drive-import-formats docx,odt,txt, all files having these extension would result in a document represented as  a
   docx  file.   This  brings  the additional risk of overwriting a document, if multiple files have the same stem.  Many rclone operations will not handle this
   name change in any way.  They assume an equal name when copying files and might copy the file again or delete them when the name changes.

   Here are the possible export extensions with their corresponding mime types.  Most of these can also be used for importing, but there more that are not list
   ed here.  Some of these additional ones might only be available when the operating system provides the correct MIME type entries.

   This list can be changed by Google Drive at any time and might not represent the currently available conversions.

   Extension              Mime Type                  Description
   
   bmp                    image/bmp                  Windows Bitmap format
   csv                    text/csv                   Standard  CSV  format  for
                                                     Spreadsheets
   doc                    application/msword         Classic Word file
   docx                   application/vnd.openxml   Microsoft Office Document
                          formats-officedocu
                          ment.wordprocess
                          ingml.document
   epub                   application/epub+zip       E-book format
   html                   text/html                  An HTML Document
   jpg                    image/jpeg                 A JPEG Image File
   json                   application/vnd.google-    JSON   Text   Format   for
                          apps.script+json           Google Apps scripts
   odp                    application/vnd.oa        Openoffice Presentation
                          sis.opendocument.presen
                          tation
   ods                    application/vnd.oa        Openoffice Spreadsheet
                          sis.opendocument.spread
                          sheet
   ods                    application/x-vnd.oa      Openoffice Spreadsheet
                          sis.opendocument.spread
                          sheet
   odt                    application/vnd.oa        Openoffice Document
                          sis.opendocument.text
   pdf                    application/pdf            Adobe PDF Format
   pjpeg                  image/pjpeg                Progressive JPEG Image
   png                    image/png                  PNG Image Format

   pptx                   application/vnd.openxml   Microsoft   Office  Power
                          formats-officedocu        point
                          ment.presentationml.pre
                          sentation
   rtf                    application/rtf            Rich Text Format
   svg                    image/svg+xml              Scalable  Vector  Graphics
                                                     Format
   tsv                    text/tab-separated-val    Standard  TSV  format  for
                          ues                        spreadsheets
   txt                    text/plain                 Plain Text
   wmf                    application/x-msmetafile   Windows Meta File
   xls                    application/vnd.ms-excel   Classic Excel file
   xlsx                   application/vnd.openxml   Microsoft  Office  Spread
                          formats-officedocu        sheet
                          ment.spreadsheetml.sheet
   zip                    application/zip            A ZIP file of HTML, Images
                                                     CSS

   Google  documents  can also be exported as link files.  These files will open a browser window for the Google Docs website of that document when opened.  The
   link file extension has to be specified as a --drive-export-formats parameter.  They will match all available Google Documents.

   Extension   Description                               OS Support
   
   desktop     freedesktop.org specified desktop entry   Linux
   link.html   An HTML Document with a redirect          All
   url         INI style link file                       macOS, Windows
   webloc      macOS specific XML format                 macOS

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to drive (Google Drive).

--drive-client-id

   Google Application Client Id Setting your own is recommended.  See https://rclone.org/drive/#making-your-own-client-id for how to create your  own.   If  you
   leave this blank, it will use an internal key which is low performance.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-scope

   Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.

   Properties:

    Config: scope

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SCOPE

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "drive"

        Full access all files, excluding Application Data Folder.

      "drive.readonly"

        Read-only access to file metadata and file contents.

      "drive.file"

        Access to files created by rclone only.

        These are visible in the drive website.

        File authorization is revoked when the user deauthorizes the app.

      "drive.appfolder"

        Allows read and write access to the Application Data folder.

        This is not visible in the drive website.

      "drive.metadata.readonly"

        Allows read-only access to file metadata but

        does not allow any access to read or download file content.

--drive-service-account-file

   Service Account Credentials JSON file path.

   Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

   Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

   Properties:

    Config: service_account_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-alternate-export

   Deprecated: No longer needed.

   Properties:

    Config: alternate_export

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ALTERNATE_EXPORT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to drive (Google Drive).

--drive-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-root-folder-id

   ID of the root folder.  Leave blank normally.

   Fill in to access "Computers" folders (see docs), or for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

   Properties:

    Config: root_folder_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-service-account-credentials

   Service Account Credentials JSON blob.

   Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

   Properties:

    Config: service_account_credentials

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_CREDENTIALS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-team-drive

   ID of the Shared Drive (Team Drive).

   Properties:

    Config: team_drive

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TEAM_DRIVE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-auth-owner-only

   Only consider files owned by the authenticated user.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_owner_only

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_AUTH_OWNER_ONLY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-use-trash

   Send files to the trash instead of deleting permanently.

   Defaults to true, namely sending files to the trash.  Use --drive-use-trash=false to delete files permanently instead.

   Properties:

    Config: use_trash

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--drive-copy-shortcut-content

   Server side copy contents of shortcuts instead of the shortcut.

   When doing server side copies, normally rclone will copy shortcuts as shortcuts.

   If this flag is used then rclone will copy the contents of shortcuts rather than shortcuts themselves when doing server side copies.

   Properties:

    Config: copy_shortcut_content

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_COPY_SHORTCUT_CONTENT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-skip-gdocs

   Skip google documents in all listings.

   If given, gdocs practically become invisible to rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: skip_gdocs

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_GDOCS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-skip-checksum-gphotos

   Skip MD5 checksum on Google photos and videos only.

   Use this if you get checksum errors when transferring Google photos or videos.

   Setting this flag will cause Google photos and videos to return a blank MD5 checksum.

   Google photos are identified by being in the "photos" space.

   Corrupted checksums are caused by Google modifying the image/video but not updating the checksum.

   Properties:

    Config: skip_checksum_gphotos

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_CHECKSUM_GPHOTOS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-shared-with-me

   Only show files that are shared with me.

   Instructs rclone to operate on your "Shared with me" folder (where Google Drive lets you access the files and folders others have shared with you).

   This works both with the "list" (lsd, lsl, etc.)  and the "copy" commands (copy, sync, etc.), and with all other commands too.

   Properties:

    Config: shared_with_me

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SHARED_WITH_ME

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-trashed-only

   Only show files that are in the trash.

   This will show trashed files in their original directory structure.

   Properties:

    Config: trashed_only

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TRASHED_ONLY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-starred-only

   Only show files that are starred.

   Properties:

    Config: starred_only

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STARRED_ONLY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-formats

   Deprecated: See export_formats.

   Properties:

    Config: formats

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_FORMATS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-export-formats

   Comma separated list of preferred formats for downloading Google docs.

   Properties:

    Config: export_formats

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_EXPORT_FORMATS

    Type: string

    Default: "docx,xlsx,pptx,svg"

--drive-import-formats

   Comma separated list of preferred formats for uploading Google docs.

   Properties:

    Config: import_formats

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_IMPORT_FORMATS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-allow-import-name-change

   Allow the filetype to change when uploading Google docs.

   E.g.  file.doc to file.docx.  This will confuse sync and reupload every time.

   Properties:

    Config: allow_import_name_change

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ALLOW_IMPORT_NAME_CHANGE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-use-created-date

   Use file created date instead of modified date.

   Useful when downloading data and you want the creation date used in place of the last modified date.

   WARNING: This flag may have some unexpected consequences.

   When  uploading  to  your drive all files will be overwritten unless they haven't been modified since their creation.  And the inverse will occur while down
   loading.  This side effect can be avoided by using the "--checksum" flag.

   This feature was implemented to retain photos capture date as recorded by google photos.  You will first need to check the "Create a  Google  Photos  folder"
   option  in  your  google drive settings.  You can then copy or move the photos locally and use the date the image was taken (created) set as the modification
   date.

   Properties:

    Config: use_created_date

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_CREATED_DATE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-use-shared-date

   Use date file was shared instead of modified date.

   Note that, as with "--drive-use-created-date", this flag may have unexpected consequences when uploading/downloading files.

   If both this flag and "--drive-use-created-date" are set, the created date is used.

   Properties:

    Config: use_shared_date

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_SHARED_DATE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-list-chunk

   Size of listing chunk 100-1000, 0 to disable.

   Properties:

    Config: list_chunk

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_LIST_CHUNK

    Type: int

    Default: 1000

--drive-impersonate

   Impersonate this user when using a service account.

   Properties:

    Config: impersonate

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_IMPERSONATE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 8Mi

--drive-chunk-size

   Upload chunk size.

   Must a power of 2 >= 256k.

   Making this larger will improve performance, but note that each chunk is buffered in memory one per transfer.

   Reducing this will reduce memory usage but decrease performance.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 8Mi

--drive-acknowledge-abuse

   Set to allow files which return cannotDownloadAbusiveFile to be downloaded.

   If downloading a file returns the error "This file has been identified as malware or spam and cannot be downloaded" with the error  code  "cannotDownloadAbu‐
   siveFile" then supply this flag to rclone to indicate you acknowledge the risks of downloading the file and rclone will download it anyway.

   Note that if you are using service account it will need Manager permission (not Content Manager) to for this flag to work.  If the SA does not have the right
   permission, Google will just ignore the flag.

   Properties:

    Config: acknowledge_abuse

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ACKNOWLEDGE_ABUSE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-keep-revision-forever

   Keep new head revision of each file forever.

   Properties:

    Config: keep_revision_forever

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_KEEP_REVISION_FOREVER

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-size-as-quota

   Show sizes as storage quota usage, not actual size.

   Show the size of a file as the storage quota used.  This is the current version plus any older versions that have been set to keep forever.

   WARNING: This flag may have some unexpected consequences.

   It is not recommended to set this flag in your config - the recommended usage is using the flag form --drive-size-as-quota when doing rclone  ls/lsl/lsf/lsj
   son/etc only.

   If you do use this flag for syncing (not recommended) then you will need to use --ignore size also.

   Properties:

    Config: size_as_quota

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SIZE_AS_QUOTA

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-v2-download-min-size

   If Object's are greater, use drive v2 API to download.

   Properties:

    Config: v2_download_min_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_V2_DOWNLOAD_MIN_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: off

--drive-pacer-min-sleep

   Minimum time to sleep between API calls.

   Properties:

    Config: pacer_min_sleep

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_PACER_MIN_SLEEP

    Type: Duration

    Default: 100ms

--drive-pacer-burst

   Number of API calls to allow without sleeping.

   Properties:

    Config: pacer_burst

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_PACER_BURST

    Type: int

    Default: 100

--drive-server-side-across-configs

   Allow server-side operations (e.g.  copy) to work across different drive configs.

   This  can  be useful if you wish to do a server-side copy between two different Google drives.  Note that this isn't enabled by default because it isn't easy
   to tell if it will work between any two configurations.

   Properties:

    Config: server_side_across_configs

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-disable-http2

   Disable drive using http2.

   There is currently an unsolved issue with the google drive backend and HTTP/2.  HTTP/2 is therefore disabled by default for the drive backend but can be  re-
   enabled here.  When the issue is solved this flag will be removed.

   See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3631

   Properties:

    Config: disable_http2

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_DISABLE_HTTP2

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--drive-stop-on-upload-limit

   Make upload limit errors be fatal.

   At  the  time  of  writing  it  is only possible to upload 750 GiB of data to Google Drive a day (this is an undocumented limit).  When this limit is reached
   Google Drive produces a slightly different error message.  When this flag is set it causes these errors to be fatal.  These will stop the in-progress sync.

   Note that this detection is relying on error message strings which Google don't document so it may break in the future.

   See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3857

   Properties:

    Config: stop_on_upload_limit

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STOP_ON_UPLOAD_LIMIT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-stop-on-download-limit

   Make download limit errors be fatal.

   At the time of writing it is only possible to download 10 TiB of data from Google Drive a day (this is an undocumented limit).  When this  limit  is  reached
   Google Drive produces a slightly different error message.  When this flag is set it causes these errors to be fatal.  These will stop the in-progress sync.

   Note that this detection is relying on error message strings which Google don't document so it may break in the future.

   Properties:

    Config: stop_on_download_limit

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STOP_ON_DOWNLOAD_LIMIT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-skip-shortcuts

   If set skip shortcut files.

   Normally rclone dereferences shortcut files making them appear as if they are the original file (see the shortcuts section).  If this flag is set then rclone
   will ignore shortcut files completely.

   Properties:

    Config: skip_shortcuts

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_SHORTCUTS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-skip-dangling-shortcuts

   If set skip dangling shortcut files.

   If this is set then rclone will not show any dangling shortcuts in listings.

   Properties:

    Config: skip_dangling_shortcuts

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_DANGLING_SHORTCUTS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--drive-resource-key

   Resource key for accessing a link-shared file.

   If you need to access files shared with a link like this

          https://drive.google.com/drive/folders/XXX?resourcekey=YYY&usp=sharing

   Then you will need to use the first part "XXX" as the "root_folder_id" and the second part "YYY" as the "resource_key" otherwise you will get 404  not  found
   errors when trying to access the directory.

   See: https://developers.google.com/drive/api/guides/resource-keys

   This resource key requirement only applies to a subset of old files.

   Note  also  that opening the folder once in the web interface (with the user you've authenticated rclone with) seems to be enough so that the resource key is
   no needed.

   Properties:

    Config: resource_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_RESOURCE_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--drive-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: InvalidUtf8

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the drive backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

get

   Get command for fetching the drive config parameters

          rclone backend get remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This is a get command which will be used to fetch the various drive config parameters

   Usage Examples:

          rclone backend get drive: [-o service_account_file] [-o chunk_size]
          rclone rc backend/command command=get fs=drive: [-o service_account_file] [-o chunk_size]

   Options:

    "chunk_size": show the current upload chunk size

    "service_account_file": show the current service account file

set

   Set command for updating the drive config parameters

          rclone backend set remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This is a set command which will be used to update the various drive config parameters

   Usage Examples:

          rclone backend set drive: [-o service_account_file=sa.json] [-o chunk_size=67108864]
          rclone rc backend/command command=set fs=drive: [-o service_account_file=sa.json] [-o chunk_size=67108864]

   Options:

    "chunk_size": update the current upload chunk size

    "service_account_file": update the current service account file

shortcut

   Create shortcuts from files or directories

          rclone backend shortcut remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command creates shortcuts from files or directories.

   Usage:

          rclone backend shortcut drive: source_item destination_shortcut
          rclone backend shortcut drive: source_item -o target=drive2: destination_shortcut

   In the first example this creates a shortcut from the "source_item" which can be a file or a directory to the "destination_shortcut".  The "source_item"  and
   the "destination_shortcut" should be relative paths from "drive:"

   In the second example this creates a shortcut from the "source_item" relative to "drive:" to the "destination_shortcut" relative to "drive2:".  This may fail
   with a permission error if the user authenticated with "drive2:" can't read files from "drive:".

   Options:

    "target": optional target remote for the shortcut destination

drives

   List the Shared Drives available to this account

          rclone backend drives remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command lists the Shared Drives (Team Drives) available to this account.

   Usage:

          rclone backend [-o config] drives drive:

   This will return a JSON list of objects like this

          [
              {
                  "id": "0ABCDEF-01234567890",
                  "kind": "drive#teamDrive",
                  "name": "My Drive"
              },
              {
                  "id": "0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl",
                  "kind": "drive#teamDrive",
                  "name": "Test Drive"
              }
          ]

   With the -o config parameter it will output the list in a format suitable for adding to a config file to make aliases for all the drives found and a combined
   drive.

          [My Drive]
          type = alias
          remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEF-01234567890,root_folder_id=:

          [Test Drive]
          type = alias
          remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl,root_folder_id=:

          [AllDrives]
          type = combine
          upstreams = "My Drive=My Drive:" "Test Drive=Test Drive:"

   Adding  this to the rclone config file will cause those team drives to be accessible with the aliases shown.  Any illegal characters will be substituted with
   "_" and duplicate names will have numbers suffixed.  It will also add a remote called AllDrives which shows all the shared drives combined into one directory
   tree.

untrash

   Untrash files and directories

          rclone backend untrash remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command untrashes all the files and directories in the directory passed in recursively.

   Usage:

   This takes an optional directory to trash which make this easier to use via the API.

          rclone backend untrash drive:directory
          rclone backend --interactive untrash drive:directory subdir

   Use the --interactive/-i or --dry-run flag to see what would be restored before restoring it.

   Result:

          {
              "Untrashed": 17,
              "Errors": 0
          }

copyid

   Copy files by ID

          rclone backend copyid remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command copies files by ID

   Usage:

          rclone backend copyid drive: ID path
          rclone backend copyid drive: ID1 path1 ID2 path2

   It copies the drive file with ID given to the path (an rclone path which will be passed internally to rclone copyto).  The ID and path pairs can be repeated.

   The  path  should end with a / to indicate copy the file as named to this directory.  If it doesn't end with a / then the last path component will be used as
   the file name.

   If the destination is a drive backend then server-side copying will be attempted if possible.

   Use the --interactive/-i or --dry-run flag to see what would be copied before copying.

exportformats

   Dump the export formats for debug purposes

          rclone backend exportformats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

importformats

   Dump the import formats for debug purposes

          rclone backend importformats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

Limitations

   Drive has quite a lot of rate limiting.  This causes rclone to be limited to transferring about 2 files per second only.  Individual files may be transferred
   much faster at 100s of MiB/s but lots of small files can take a long time.

   Server side copies are also subject to a separate rate limit.  If you see User rate limit exceeded errors, wait at least 24 hours and retry.  You can disable
   server-side copies with --disable copy to download and upload the files if you prefer.

Limitations of Google Docs

   Google docs will appear as size -1 in rclone ls, rclone ncdu etc, and as size 0 in anything which uses the VFS layer, e.g.  rclone mount  and  rclone  serve.
   When calculating directory totals, e.g.  in rclone size and rclone ncdu, they will be counted in as empty files.

   This is because rclone can't find out the size of the Google docs without downloading them.

   Google docs will transfer correctly with rclone sync, rclone copy etc as rclone knows to ignore the size when doing the transfer.

   However an unfortunate consequence of this is that you may not be able to download Google docs using rclone mount.  If it doesn't work you will get a 0 sized
   file.  If you try again the doc may gain its correct size and be downloadable.  Whether it will work on not depends on the application  accessing  the  mount
   and the OS you are running - experiment to find out if it does work for you!

Duplicated files

   Sometimes,  for  no reason I've been able to track down, drive will duplicate a file that rclone uploads.  Drive unlike all the other remotes can have dupli‐
   cated files.

   Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will see messages in the log about duplicates.

   Use rclone dedupe to fix duplicated files.

   Note that this isn't just a problem with rclone, even Google Photos on Android duplicates files on drive sometimes.

Rclone appears to be re-copying files it shouldn't

   The most likely cause of this is the duplicated file issue above - run rclone dedupe and check your logs for duplicate object or directory messages.

   This can also be caused by a delay/caching on google drive's end when comparing directory listings.  Specifically with team drives used in  combination  with
   --fast-list.  Files that were uploaded recently may not appear on the directory list sent to rclone when using --fast-list.

   Waiting  a moderate period of time between attempts (estimated to be approximately 1 hour) and/or not using --fast-list both seem to be effective in prevent
   ing the problem.

Making your own client_id

   When you use rclone with Google drive in its default configuration you are using rclone's client_id.  This is shared between all the rclone users.  There  is
   a  global  rate  limit  on the number of queries per second that each client_id can do set by Google.  rclone already has a high quota and I will continue to
   make sure it is high enough by contacting Google.

   It is strongly recommended to use your own client ID as the default rclone ID is heavily used.  If you have multiple services running, it is  recommended  to
   use  an  API  key for each service.  The default Google quota is 10 transactions per second so it is recommended to stay under that number as if you use more
   than that, it will cause rclone to rate limit and make things slower.

   Here is how to create your own Google Drive client ID for rclone:

    1. Log into the Google API Console (https://console.developers.google.com/) with your Google account.  It doesn't matter what Google account you  use.   (It
       need not be the same account as the Google Drive you want to access)

    2. Select a project or create a new project.

    3. Under "ENABLE APIS AND SERVICES" search for "Drive", and enable the "Google Drive API".

    4. Click "Credentials" in the left-side panel (not "Create credentials", which opens the wizard), then "Create credentials"

    5. If  you  already configured an "Oauth Consent Screen", then skip to the next step; if not, click on "CONFIGURE CONSENT SCREEN" button (near the top right
       corner of the right panel), then select "External" and click on "CREATE"; on the next screen, enter an "Application name" ("rclone" is OK);  enter  "User
       Support  Email"  (your  own email is OK); enter "Developer Contact Email" (your own email is OK); then click on "Save" (all other data is optional).  You
       will also have to add some scopes, including .../auth/docs and .../auth/drive in order to be able to edit, create and delete files with RClone.  You  may
       also  want  to include the ../auth/drive.metadata.readonly scope.  After adding scopes, click "Save and continue" to add test users.  Be sure to add your
       own account to the test users.  Once you've added yourself as a test user and saved the changes, click again on "Credentials" on the  left  panel  to  go
       back to the "Credentials" screen.

       (PS:  if you are a GSuite user, you could also select "Internal" instead of "External" above, but this will restrict API use to Google Workspace users in
       your organisation).

    6. Click on the "+ CREATE CREDENTIALS" button at the top of the screen, then select "OAuth client ID".

    7. Choose an application type of "Desktop app" and click "Create".  (the default name is fine)

    8. It will show you a client ID and client secret.  Make a note of these.

       (If you selected "External" at Step 5 continue to Step 9.  If you chose "Internal" you don't need to publish and can skip straight to Step  10  but  your
       destination drive must be part of the same Google Workspace.)

    9. Go to "Oauth consent screen" and then click "PUBLISH APP" button and confirm.  You will also want to add yourself as a test user.

   10. Provide the noted client ID and client secret to rclone.

   Be  aware  that,  due to the "enhanced security" recently introduced by Google, you are theoretically expected to "submit your app for verification" and then
   wait a few weeks(!)  for their response; in practice, you can go right ahead and use the client ID and client secret with rclone, the only issue  will  be  a
   very  scary confirmation screen shown when you connect via your browser for rclone to be able to get its token-id (but as this only happens during the remote
   configuration, it's not such a big deal).  Keeping the application in "Testing" will work as well, but the limitation is that any grants will expire after  a
   week,  which  can  be  annoying to refresh constantly.  If, for whatever reason, a short grant time is not a problem, then keeping the application in testing
   mode would also be sufficient.

   (Thanks to @balazer on github for these instructions.)

   Sometimes, creation of an OAuth consent in Google API Console fails due to an error message The request failed because changes to one of the  field  of  the
   resource  is  not  supported.   As  a  convenient  workaround,  the necessary Google Drive API key can be created on the Python Quickstart (https://develop
   ers.google.com/drive/api/v3/quickstart/python) page.  Just push the Enable the Drive API button to receive the Client ID and Secret.  Note that it will auto
   matically create a new project in the API Console.

Google Photos

   The  rclone  backend  for Google Photos (https://www.google.com/photos/about/) is a specialized backend for transferring photos and videos to and from Google
   Photos.

   NB The Google Photos API which rclone uses has quite a few limitations, so please read the limitations section carefully to make sure it is suitable for your
   use.

Configuration

   The initial setup for google cloud storage involves getting a token from Google Photos which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through
   it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Google Photos
             \ "google photos"
          [snip]
          Storage> google photos
          ** See help for google photos backend at: https://rclone.org/googlephotos/ **

          Google Application Client Id
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          client_id>
          Google Application Client Secret
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          client_secret>
          Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.

          If you choose read only then rclone will only request read only access
          to your photos, otherwise rclone will request full access.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          read_only>
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code

          *** IMPORTANT: All media items uploaded to Google Photos with rclone
          *** are stored in full resolution at original quality.  These uploads
          *** will count towards storage in your Google Account.

          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = google photos
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2019-06-28T17:38:04.644930156+01:00"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Google if using  web  browser  to  automatically  authenticate.
   This  only  runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this may re
   quire you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all the albums in your photos

          rclone lsd remote:album

   Make a new album

          rclone mkdir remote:album/newAlbum

   List the contents of an album

          rclone ls remote:album/newAlbum

   Sync /home/local/images to the Google Photos, removing any excess files in the album.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/image remote:album/newAlbum

Layout

   As Google Photos is not a general purpose cloud storage system, the backend is laid out to help you navigate it.

   The directories under media show different ways of categorizing the media.  Each file will appear multiple times.  So if you want to make a  backup  of  your
   google photos you might choose to backup remote:media/by-month.  (NB remote:media/by-day is rather slow at the moment so avoid for syncing.)

   Note that all your photos and videos will appear somewhere under media, but they may not appear under album unless you've put them into albums.

          /
          - upload
              - file1.jpg
              - file2.jpg
              - ...
          - media
              - all
                  - file1.jpg
                  - file2.jpg
                  - ...
              - by-year
                  - 2000
                      - file1.jpg
                      - ...
                  - 2001
                      - file2.jpg
                      - ...
                  - ...
              - by-month
                  - 2000
                      - 2000-01
                          - file1.jpg
                          - ...
                      - 2000-02
                          - file2.jpg
                          - ...
                  - ...
              - by-day
                  - 2000
                      - 2000-01-01
                          - file1.jpg
                          - ...
                      - 2000-01-02
                          - file2.jpg
                          - ...
                  - ...
          - album
              - album name
              - album name/sub
          - shared-album
              - album name
              - album name/sub
          - feature
              - favorites
                  - file1.jpg
                  - file2.jpg

   There are two writable parts of the tree, the upload directory and sub directories of the album directory.

   The  upload  directory is for uploading files you don't want to put into albums.  This will be empty to start with and will contain the files you've uploaded
   for one rclone session only, becoming empty again when you restart rclone.  The use case for this would be if you have a load of files you just want to  once
   off dump into Google Photos.  For repeated syncing, uploading to album will work better.

   Directories  within the album directory are also writeable and you may create new directories (albums) under album.  If you copy files with a directory hier
   archy in there then rclone will create albums with the / character in them.  For example if you do

          rclone copy /path/to/images remote:album/images

   and the images directory contains

          images
              - file1.jpg
              dir
                  file2.jpg
              dir2
                  dir3
                      file3.jpg

   Then rclone will create the following albums with the following files in

    images

      file1.jpg

    images/dir

      file2.jpg

    images/dir2/dir3

      file3.jpg

   This means that you can use the album path pretty much like a normal filesystem and it is a good target for repeated syncing.

   The shared-album directory shows albums shared with you or by you.  This is similar to the Sharing tab in the Google Photos web interface.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to google photos (Google Photos).

--gphotos-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gphotos-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gphotos-read-only

   Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.

   If you choose read only then rclone will only request read only access to your photos, otherwise rclone will request full access.

   Properties:

    Config: read_only

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_READ_ONLY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to google photos (Google Photos).

--gphotos-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gphotos-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gphotos-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--gphotos-read-size

   Set to read the size of media items.

   Normally rclone does not read the size of media items since this takes another transaction.  This isn't necessary for syncing.  However rclone mount needs to
   know the size of files in advance of reading them, so setting this flag when using rclone mount is recommended if you want to read the media.

   Properties:

    Config: read_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_READ_SIZE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--gphotos-start-year

   Year limits the photos to be downloaded to those which are uploaded after the given year.

   Properties:

    Config: start_year

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_START_YEAR

    Type: int

    Default: 2000

--gphotos-include-archived

   Also view and download archived media.

   By default, rclone does not request archived media.  Thus, when syncing, archived media is not visible in directory listings or transferred.

   Note that media in albums is always visible and synced, no matter their archive status.

   With this flag, archived media are always visible in directory listings and transferred.

   Without this flag, archived media will not be visible in directory listings and won't be transferred.

   Properties:

    Config: include_archived

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_INCLUDE_ARCHIVED

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--gphotos-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Only  images  and videos can be uploaded.  If you attempt to upload non videos or images or formats that Google Photos doesn't understand, rclone will upload
   the file, then Google Photos will give an error when it is put turned into a media item.

   Note that all media items uploaded to Google Photos through the API are stored in full resolution at "original quality" and will count towards  your  storage
   quota in your Google Account.  The API does not offer a way to upload in "high quality" mode..

   rclone  about  is not supported by the Google Photos backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy
   mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  See  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Downloading Images

   When  Images  are downloaded this strips EXIF location (according to the docs and my tests).  This is a limitation of the Google Photos API and is covered by
   bug #112096115 (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/112096115).

   The current google API does not allow photos to be downloaded at original resolution.  This is very important if you are, for  example,  relying  on  "Google
   Photos"  as a backup of your photos.  You will not be able to use rclone to redownload original images.  You could use 'google takeout' to recover the origi
   nal photos as a last resort

Downloading Videos

   When videos are downloaded they are downloaded in a really compressed version of the video compared to downloading it via the Google  Photos  web  interface.
   This is covered by bug #113672044 (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/113672044).

Duplicates

   If  a  file  name  is  duplicated  in  a  directory  then  rclone will add the file ID into its name.  So two files called file.jpg would then appear as file
   {123456}.jpg and file {ABCDEF}.jpg (the actual IDs are a lot longer alas!).

   If you upload the same image (with the same binary data) twice then Google Photos will deduplicate it.  However it will retain the filename  from  the  first
   upload  which may confuse rclone.  For example if you uploaded an image to upload then uploaded the same image to album/my_album the filename of the image in
   album/my_album will be what it was uploaded with initially, not what you uploaded it with to album.  In practise this shouldn't cause too many problems.

Modified time

   The date shown of media in Google Photos is the creation date as determined by the EXIF information, or the upload date if that is not known.

   This is not changeable by rclone and is not the modification date of the media on local disk.  This means that rclone cannot use the dates from Google Photos
   for syncing purposes.

Size

   The Google Photos API does not return the size of media.  This means that when syncing to Google Photos, rclone can only do a file existence check.

   It  is  possible  to  read the size of the media, but this needs an extra HTTP HEAD request per media item so is very slow and uses up a lot of transactions.
   This can be enabled with the --gphotos-read-size option or the read_size = true config parameter.

   If you want to use the backend with rclone mount you may need to enable this flag (depending on your OS and application using the photos) otherwise  you  may
   not be able to read media off the mount.  You'll need to experiment to see if it works for you without the flag.

Albums

   Rclone  can  only upload files to albums it created.  This is a limitation of the Google Photos API (https://developers.google.com/photos/library/guides/man
   age-albums).

   Rclone can remove files it uploaded from albums it created only.

Deleting files

   Rclone can remove files from albums it created, but note that the Google Photos API does not allow media to be deleted permanently so this media  will  still
   remain.  See bug #109759781 (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/109759781).

   Rclone cannot delete files anywhere except under album.

Deleting albums

   The Google Photos API does not support deleting albums - see bug #135714733 (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/135714733).

Hasher

   Hasher  is  a special overlay backend to create remotes which handle checksums for other remotes.  It's main functions include: - Emulate hash types unimple
   mented by backends - Cache checksums to help with slow hashing of large local or (S)FTP files - Warm up checksum cache from external SUM files

Getting started

   To use Hasher, first set up the underlying remote following the configuration instructions for that remote.  You can also use a local pathname instead  of  a
   remote.  Check that your base remote is working.

   Let's  call  the  base  remote myRemote:path here.  Note that anything inside myRemote:path will be handled by hasher and anything outside won't.  This means
   that if you are using a bucket based remote (S3, B2, Swift) then you should put the bucket in the remote s3:bucket.

   Now proceed to interactive or manual configuration.

Interactive configuration

   Run rclone config:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> Hasher1
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Handle checksums for other remotes
             \ "hasher"
          [snip]
          Storage> hasher
          Remote to cache checksums for, like myremote:mypath.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          remote> myRemote:path
          Comma separated list of supported checksum types.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("md5,sha1").
          hashsums> md5
          Maximum time to keep checksums in cache. 0 = no cache, off = cache forever.
          max_age> off
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [Hasher1]
          type = hasher
          remote = myRemote:path
          hashsums = md5
          max_age = off
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Manual configuration

   Run rclone config path to see the path of current active config file, usually YOURHOME/.config/rclone/rclone.conf.  Open it in  your  favorite  text  editor,
   find section for the base remote and create new section for hasher like in the following examples:

          [Hasher1]
          type = hasher
          remote = myRemote:path
          hashes = md5
          max_age = off

          [Hasher2]
          type = hasher
          remote = /local/path
          hashes = dropbox,sha1
          max_age = 24h

   Hasher  takes  basically  the  following parameters: - remote is required, - hashes is a comma separated list of supported checksums (by default md5,sha1), -
   max_age - maximum time to keep a checksum value in the cache, 0 will disable caching completely, off will cache  "forever"  (that  is  until  the  files  get
   changed).

   Make  sure  the remote has : (colon) in.  If you specify the remote without a colon then rclone will use a local directory of that name.  So if you use a re
   mote of /local/path then rclone will handle hashes for that directory.  If you use remote = name literally then rclone will put files in a  directory  called
   name located under current directory.

Usage Basic operations

   Now  you  can  use  it as Hasher2:subdir/file instead of base remote.  Hasher will transparently update cache with new checksums when a file is fully read or
   overwritten, like:

          rclone copy External:path/file Hasher:dest/path

          rclone cat Hasher:path/to/file > /dev/null

   The way to refresh all cached checksums (even unsupported by the base backend) for a subtree is to re-download all files in the subtree.   For  example,  use
   hashsum --download using any supported hashsum on the command line (we just care to re-read):

          rclone hashsum MD5 --download Hasher:path/to/subtree > /dev/null

          rclone backend dump Hasher:path/to/subtree

   You can print or drop hashsum cache using custom backend commands:

          rclone backend dump Hasher:dir/subdir

          rclone backend drop Hasher:

Pre-Seed from a SUM File

   Hasher supports two backend commands: generic SUM file import and faster but less consistent stickyimport.

          rclone backend import Hasher:dir/subdir SHA1 /path/to/SHA1SUM [--checkers 4]

   Instead  of  SHA1 it can be any hash supported by the remote.  The last argument can point to either a local or an other-remote:path text file in SUM format.
   The command will parse the SUM file, then walk down the path given by the first argument, snapshot current fingerprints and fill in the cache entries  corre
   spondingly.   - Paths in the SUM file are treated as relative to hasher:dir/subdir.  - The command will not check that supplied values are correct.  You must
   know what you are doing.  - This is a one-time action.  The SUM file will not get "attached" to the remote.  Cache entries can still  be  overwritten  later,
   should  the  object's  fingerprint change.  - The tree walk can take long depending on the tree size.  You can increase --checkers to make it faster.  Or use
   stickyimport if you don't care about fingerprints and consistency.

          rclone backend stickyimport hasher:path/to/data sha1 remote:/path/to/sum.sha1

   stickyimport is similar to import but works much faster because it does not need to stat existing files and skips initial  tree  walk.   Instead  of  binding
   cache entries to file fingerprints it creates sticky entries bound to the file name alone ignoring size, modification time etc.  Such hash entries can be re
   placed only by purge, delete, backend drop or by full re-read/re-write of the files.

Configuration reference Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to hasher (Better checksums for other remotes).

--hasher-remote

   Remote to cache checksums for (e.g.  myRemote:path).

   Properties:

    Config: remote

    Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_REMOTE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--hasher-hashes

   Comma separated list of supported checksum types.

   Properties:

    Config: hashes

    Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_HASHES

    Type: CommaSepList

    Default: md5,sha1

--hasher-max-age

   Maximum time to keep checksums in cache (0 = no cache, off = cache forever).

   Properties:

    Config: max_age

    Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_MAX_AGE

    Type: Duration

    Default: off

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to hasher (Better checksums for other remotes).

--hasher-auto-size

   Auto-update checksum for files smaller than this size (disabled by default).

   Properties:

    Config: auto_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_AUTO_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 0

Metadata

   Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the hasher backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

drop

   Drop cache

          rclone backend drop remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   Completely drop checksum cache.  Usage Example: rclone backend drop hasher:

dump

   Dump the database

          rclone backend dump remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   Dump cache records covered by the current remote

fulldump

   Full dump of the database

          rclone backend fulldump remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   Dump all cache records in the database

import

   Import a SUM file

          rclone backend import remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   Amend hash cache from a SUM file and bind checksums to files by size/time.  Usage Example: rclone backend import hasher:subdir md5 /path/to/sum.md5

stickyimport

   Perform fast import of a SUM file

          rclone backend stickyimport remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   Fill hash cache from a SUM file without verifying file fingerprints.  Usage Example: rclone backend stickyimport hasher:subdir md5 remote:path/to/sum.md5

Implementation details (advanced)

   This section explains how various rclone operations work on a hasher remote.

   Disclaimer.  This section describes current implementation which can change in future rclone versions!.

Hashsum command

   The rclone hashsum (or md5sum or sha1sum) command will:

   1. if requested hash is supported by lower level, just pass it.

   2. if object size is below auto_size then download object and calculate requested hashes on the fly.

   3. if unsupported and the size is big enough, build object fingerprint (including size, modtime if supported, first-found other hash if any).

   4. if the strict match is found in cache for the requested remote, return the stored hash.

   5. if remote found but fingerprint mismatched, then purge the entry and proceed to step 6.

   6. if remote not found or had no requested hash type or after step 5: download object, calculate all supported hashes on the fly and store in  cache;  return
      requested hash.

Other operations

    whenever a file is uploaded or downloaded in full, capture the stream to calculate all supported hashes on the fly and update database

    server-side move will update keys of existing cache entries

    deletefile will remove a single cache entry

    purge will remove all cache entries under the purged path

   Note that setting max_age = 0 will disable checksum caching completely.

   If you set max_age = off, checksums in cache will never age, unless you fully rewrite or delete the file.

Cache storage

   Cached checksums are stored as bolt database files under rclone cache directory, usually ~/.cache/rclone/kv/.  Databases are maintained one per base backend,
   named like BaseRemote~hasher.bolt.  Checksums for multiple alias-es into a single base backend will be stored in the single database.  All  local  paths  are
   treated  as  aliases  into the local backend (unless crypted or chunked) and stored in ~/.cache/rclone/kv/local~hasher.bolt.  Databases can be shared between
   multiple rclone processes.

HDFS

   HDFS (https://hadoop.apache.org/docs/stable/hadoop-project-dist/hadoop-hdfs/HdfsDesign.html)  is  a  distributed  file-system,  part  of  the  Apache  Hadoop
   (https://hadoop.apache.org/) framework.

   Paths are specified as remote: or remote:path/to/dir.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [skip]
          XX / Hadoop distributed file system
             \ "hdfs"
          [skip]
          Storage> hdfs
          ** See help for hdfs backend at: https://rclone.org/hdfs/ **

          hadoop name node and port
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to host namenode at port 8020
             \ "namenode:8020"
          namenode> namenode.hadoop:8020
          hadoop user name
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to hdfs as root
             \ "root"
          username> root
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = hdfs
          namenode = namenode.hadoop:8020
          username = root
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          hadoop               hdfs

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all the top level directories

          rclone lsd remote:

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:directory

   Sync the remote directory to /home/local/directory, deleting any excess files.

          rclone sync --interactive remote:directory /home/local/directory

Setting up your own HDFS instance for testing

   You  may  start with a manual setup (https://hadoop.apache.org/docs/stable/hadoop-project-dist/hadoop-common/SingleCluster.html) or use the docker image from
   the tests:

   If you want to build the docker image

          git clone https://github.com/rclone/rclone.git
          cd rclone/fstest/testserver/images/test-hdfs
          docker build --rm -t rclone/test-hdfs .

   Or you can just use the latest one pushed

          docker run --rm --name "rclone-hdfs" -p 127.0.0.1:9866:9866 -p 127.0.0.1:8020:8020 --hostname "rclone-hdfs" rclone/test-hdfs

   NB it need few seconds to startup.

   For this docker image the remote needs to be configured like this:

          [remote]
          type = hdfs
          namenode = 127.0.0.1:8020
          username = root

   You can stop this image with docker kill rclone-hdfs (NB it does not use volumes, so all data uploaded will be lost.)

Modified time

   Time accurate to 1 second is stored.

Checksum

   No checksums are implemented.

Usage information

   You can use the rclone about remote: command which will display filesystem size and current usage.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   :           0x3A        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8).

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to hdfs (Hadoop distributed file system).

--hdfs-namenode

   Hadoop name node and port.

   E.g.  "namenode:8020" to connect to host namenode at port 8020.

   Properties:

    Config: namenode

    Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_NAMENODE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--hdfs-username

   Hadoop user name.

   Properties:

    Config: username

    Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_USERNAME

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "root"

        Connect to hdfs as root.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to hdfs (Hadoop distributed file system).

--hdfs-service-principal-name

   Kerberos service principal name for the namenode.

   Enables KERBEROS authentication.  Specifies the Service Principal Name (SERVICE/FQDN) for the namenode.   E.g.   "hdfs/namenode.hadoop.docker"  for  namenode
   running as service 'hdfs' with FQDN 'namenode.hadoop.docker'.

   Properties:

    Config: service_principal_name

    Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_SERVICE_PRINCIPAL_NAME

    Type: string

    Required: false

--hdfs-data-transfer-protection

   Kerberos data transfer protection: authentication|integrity|privacy.

   Specifies  whether  or  not  authentication, data signature integrity checks, and wire encryption is required when communicating the the datanodes.  Possible
   values are 'authentication', 'integrity' and 'privacy'.  Used only with KERBEROS enabled.

   Properties:

    Config: data_transfer_protection

    Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_DATA_TRANSFER_PROTECTION

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "privacy"

        Ensure authentication, integrity and encryption enabled.

--hdfs-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Colon,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

    No server-side Move or DirMove.

    Checksums not implemented.

HiDrive

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

   The initial setup for hidrive involves getting a token from HiDrive which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found - make a new one
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / HiDrive
             \ "hidrive"
          [snip]
          Storage> hidrive
          OAuth Client Id - Leave blank normally.
          client_id>
          OAuth Client Secret - Leave blank normally.
          client_secret>
          Access permissions that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive.
          Leave blank normally.
          scope_access>
          Edit advanced config?
          y/n> n
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = hidrive
          token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   You should be aware that OAuth-tokens can be used to access your account and hence should not be shared with other persons. See the below  section  for  more
   information.

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note  that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from HiDrive.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser
   to the moment you get back the verification code.  The webserver runs on http://127.0.0.1:53682/.  If local port 53682 is protected by  a  firewall  you  may
   need to temporarily unblock the firewall to complete authorization.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your HiDrive root folder

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your HiDrive filesystem

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to a HiDrive directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Keeping your tokens safe

   Any  OAuth-tokens  will  be  stored  by  rclone  in the remote's configuration file as unencrypted text.  Anyone can use a valid refresh-token to access your
   HiDrive filesystem without knowing your password.  Therefore you should make sure no one else can access your configuration.

   It is possible to encrypt rclone's configuration file.  You can find information on securing your configuration file by viewing the configuration  encryption
   docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#configuration-encryption).

Invalid refresh token

   As  can be verified here (https://developer.hidrive.com/basics-flows/), each refresh_token (for Native Applications) is valid for 60 days.  If used to access
   HiDrivei, its validity will be automatically extended.

   This means that if you

    Don't use the HiDrive remote for 60 days

   then rclone will return an error which includes a text that implies the refresh token is invalid or expired.

   To fix this you will need to authorize rclone to access your HiDrive account again.

   Using

          rclone config reconnect remote:

   the process is very similar to the process of initial setup exemplified before.

Modified time and hashes

   HiDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.

   HiDrive supports its own hash type (https://static.hidrive.com/dev/0001) which is used to verify the integrity of file contents after successful transfers.

Restricted filename characters

   HiDrive cannot store files or folders that include / (0x2F) or null-bytes (0x00) in their name.  Any other characters can be used in the names  of  files  or
   folders.  Additionally, files or folders cannot be named either of the following: . or ..

   Therefore rclone will automatically replace these characters, if files or folders are stored or accessed with such names.

   You can read about how this filename encoding works in general here.

   Keep in mind that HiDrive only supports file or folder names with a length of 255 characters or less.

Transfers

   HiDrive  limits  file  sizes per single request to a maximum of 2 GiB.  To allow storage of larger files and allow for better upload performance, the hidrive
   backend will use a chunked transfer for files larger than 96 MiB.  Rclone will upload multiple parts/chunks of the file at the  same  time.   Chunks  in  the
   process of being uploaded are buffered in memory, so you may want to restrict this behaviour on systems with limited resources.

   You can customize this behaviour using the following options:

    chunk_size: size of file parts

    upload_cutoff: files larger or equal to this in size will use a chunked transfer

    upload_concurrency: number of file-parts to upload at the same time

   See the below section about configuration options for more details.

Root folder

   You can set the root folder for rclone.  This is the directory that rclone considers to be the root of your HiDrive.

   Usually, you will leave this blank, and rclone will use the root of the account.

   However, you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

   This  works by prepending the contents of the root_prefix option to any paths accessed by rclone.  For example, the following two ways to access the home di
   rectory are equivalent:

          rclone lsd --hidrive-root-prefix="/users/test/" remote:path

          rclone lsd remote:/users/test/path

   See the below section about configuration options for more details.

Directory member count

   By default, rclone will know the number of directory members contained in a directory.  For example, rclone lsd uses this information.

   The acquisition of this information will result in additional time costs for HiDrive's API.  When dealing with large directory structures, it may  be  desir
   able  to  circumvent  this  time  cost, especially when this information is not explicitly needed.  For this, the disable_fetching_member_count option can be
   used.

   See the below section about configuration options for more details.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to hidrive (HiDrive).

--hidrive-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--hidrive-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--hidrive-scope-access

   Access permissions that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive.

   Properties:

    Config: scope_access

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_SCOPE_ACCESS

    Type: string

    Default: "rw"

    Examples:

      "rw"

        Read and write access to resources.

      "ro"

        Read-only access to resources.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to hidrive (HiDrive).

--hidrive-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--hidrive-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--hidrive-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--hidrive-scope-role

   User-level that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive.

   Properties:

    Config: scope_role

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_SCOPE_ROLE

    Type: string

    Default: "user"

    Examples:

      "user"

        User-level access to management permissions.

        This will be sufficient in most cases.

      "admin"

        Extensive access to management permissions.

      "owner"

        Full access to management permissions.

--hidrive-root-prefix

   The root/parent folder for all paths.

   Fill in to use the specified folder as the parent for all paths given to the remote.  This way rclone can use any folder as its starting point.

   Properties:

    Config: root_prefix

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_ROOT_PREFIX

    Type: string

    Default: "/"

    Examples:

      "/"

        The topmost directory accessible by rclone.

        This will be equivalent with "root" if rclone uses a regular HiDrive user account.

      "root"

        The topmost directory of the HiDrive user account

      ""

        This specifies that there is no root-prefix for your paths.

        When using this you will always need to specify paths to this remote with a valid parent e.g.  "remote:/path/to/dir" or "remote:root/path/to/dir".

--hidrive-endpoint

   Endpoint for the service.

   This is the URL that API-calls will be made to.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Default: "https://api.hidrive.strato.com/2.1"

--hidrive-disable-fetching-member-count

   Do not fetch number of objects in directories unless it is absolutely necessary.

   Requests may be faster if the number of objects in subdirectories is not fetched.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_fetching_member_count

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_DISABLE_FETCHING_MEMBER_COUNT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--hidrive-chunk-size

   Chunksize for chunked uploads.

   Any files larger than the configured cutoff (or files of unknown size) will be uploaded in chunks of this size.

   The upper limit for this is 2147483647 bytes (about 2.000Gi).  That is the maximum amount of bytes a single  upload-operation  will  support.   Setting  this
   above the upper limit or to a negative value will cause uploads to fail.

   Setting this to larger values may increase the upload speed at the cost of using more memory.  It can be set to smaller values smaller to save on memory.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 48Mi

--hidrive-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff/Threshold for chunked uploads.

   Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of the configured chunksize.

   The  upper  limit  for  this  is 2147483647 bytes (about 2.000Gi).  That is the maximum amount of bytes a single upload-operation will support.  Setting this
   above the upper limit will cause uploads to fail.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 96Mi

--hidrive-upload-concurrency

   Concurrency for chunked uploads.

   This is the upper limit for how many transfers for the same file are running concurrently.  Setting this above to a value smaller than 1 will  cause  uploads
   to deadlock.

   If  you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing this may help
   to speed up the transfers.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 4

--hidrive-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Dot

Limitations Symbolic links

   HiDrive is able to store symbolic links (symlinks) by design, for example, when unpacked from a zip archive.

   There exists no direct mechanism to manage native symlinks in remotes.  As such this implementation has chosen to ignore any native symlinks present  in  the
   remote.  rclone will not be able to access or show any symlinks stored in the hidrive-remote.  This means symlinks cannot be individually removed, copied, or
   moved, except when removing, copying, or moving the parent folder.

   This does not affect the .rclonelink-files that rclone uses to encode and store symbolic links.

Sparse files

   It is possible to store sparse files in HiDrive.

   Note that copying a sparse file will expand the holes into null-byte (0x00) regions that will then consume disk space.  Likewise, when downloading  a  sparse
   file, the resulting file will have null-byte regions in the place of file holes.

HTTP

   The  HTTP  remote  is a read only remote for reading files of a webserver.  The webserver should provide file listings which rclone will read and turn into a
   remote.  This has been tested with common webservers such as Apache/Nginx/Caddy and will likely work with file  listings  from  most  web  servers.   (If  it
   doesn't then please file an issue, or send a pull request!)

   Paths are specified as remote: or remote:path.

   The  remote:  represents the configured url, and any path following it will be resolved relative to this url, according to the URL standard.  This means with
   remote url https://beta.rclone.org/branch and path fix, the resolved URL will be https://beta.rclone.org/branch/fix, while with path /fix  the  resolved  URL
   will be https://beta.rclone.org/fix as the absolute path is resolved from the root of the domain.

   If  the  path following the remote: ends with / it will be assumed to point to a directory.  If the path does not end with /, then a HEAD request is sent and
   the response used to decide if it it is treated as a file or a directory (run with -vv to see details).  When --http-no-head is  specified,  a  path  without
   ending / is always assumed to be a file.  If rclone incorrectly assumes the path is a file, the solution is to specify the path with ending /.  When you know
   the path is a directory, ending it with / is always better as it avoids the initial HEAD request.

   To just download a single file it is easier to use copyurl (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copyurl/).

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / HTTP
             \ "http"
          [snip]
          Storage> http
          URL of http host to connect to
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to example.com
             \ "https://example.com"
          url> https://beta.rclone.org
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          url = https://beta.rclone.org
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          remote               http

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all the top level directories

          rclone lsd remote:

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:directory

   Sync the remote directory to /home/local/directory, deleting any excess files.

          rclone sync --interactive remote:directory /home/local/directory

Read only

   This remote is read only - you can't upload files to an HTTP server.

Modified time

   Most HTTP servers store time accurate to 1 second.

Checksum

   No checksums are stored.

Usage without a config file

   Since the http remote only has one config parameter it is easy to use without a config file:

          rclone lsd --http-url https://beta.rclone.org :http:

   or:

          rclone lsd :http,url='https://beta.rclone.org':

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to http (HTTP).

--http-url

   URL of HTTP host to connect to.

   E.g.  "https://example.com", or "https://user:pass@example.com" to use a username and password.

   Properties:

    Config: url

    Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_URL

    Type: string

    Required: true

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to http (HTTP).

--http-headers

   Set HTTP headers for all transactions.

   Use this to set additional HTTP headers for all transactions.

   The input format is comma separated list of key,value pairs.  Standard CSV encoding (https://godoc.org/encoding/csv) may be used.

   For example, to set a Cookie use 'Cookie,name=value', or '"Cookie","name=value"'.

   You can set multiple headers, e.g.  '"Cookie","name=value","Authorization","xxx"'.

   Properties:

    Config: headers

    Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_HEADERS

    Type: CommaSepList

    Default:

--http-no-slash

   Set this if the site doesn't end directories with /.

   Use this if your target website does not use / on the end of directories.

   A / on the end of a path is how rclone normally tells the difference between files and directories.  If this flag is set, then rclone will  treat  all  files
   with Content-Type: text/html as directories and read URLs from them rather than downloading them.

   Note that this may cause rclone to confuse genuine HTML files with directories.

   Properties:

    Config: no_slash

    Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_NO_SLASH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--http-no-head

   Don't use HEAD requests.

   HEAD requests are mainly used to find file sizes in dir listing.  If your site is being very slow to load then you can try this option.  Normally rclone does
   a HEAD request for each potential file in a directory listing to:

   • find its size

   • check it really exists

   • check to see if it is a directory

   If you set this option, rclone will not do the HEAD request.  This will mean that directory listings are much quicker, but rclone won't  have  the  times  or
   sizes of any files, and some files that don't exist may be in the listing.

   Properties:

    Config: no_head

    Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_NO_HEAD

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Limitations

   rclone  about is not supported by the HTTP backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most
   free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Internet Archive

   The Internet Archive backend utilizes Items on archive.org (https://archive.org/)

   Refer to IAS3 API documentation (https://archive.org/services/docs/api/ias3.html) for the API this backend uses.

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:item/path/to/dir.

   Unlike S3, listing up all items uploaded by you isn't supported.

   Once you have made a remote, you can use it like this:

   Make a new item

          rclone mkdir remote:item

   List the contents of a item

          rclone ls remote:item

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote item, deleting any excess files in the item.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:item

Notes

   Because  of  Internet  Archive's  architecture, it enqueues write operations (and extra post-processings) in a per-item queue.  You can check item's queue at
   https://catalogd.archive.org/history/item-name-here .  Because of that, all uploads/deletes will not show up immediately and takes some time to be available.
   The  per-item  queue  is  enqueued  to  an  another  queue,  Item  Deriver Queue.  You can check the status of Item Deriver Queue here. (https://catalogd.ar
   chive.org/catalog.php?whereami=1) This queue has a limit, and it may block you from uploading, or even deleting.  You should avoid uploading a lot  of  small
   files for better behavior.

   You  can  optionally wait for the server's processing to finish, by setting non-zero value to wait_archive key.  By making it wait, rclone can do normal file
   comparison.  Make sure to set a large enough value (e.g.  30m0s for smaller files) as it can take a long time depending on server's queue.

About metadata

   This backend supports setting, updating and reading metadata of each file.  The metadata will appear as file metadata on  Internet  Archive.   However,  some
   fields are reserved by both Internet Archive and rclone.

   The following are reserved by Internet Archive: - name - source - size - md5 - crc32 - sha1 - format - old_version - viruscheck - summation

   Trying  to  set values to these keys is ignored with a warning.  Only setting mtime is an exception.  Doing so make it the identical behavior as setting Mod
   Time.

   rclone reserves all the keys starting with rclone-.  Setting value for these keys will give you warnings, but values are set according to request.

   If there are multiple values for a key, only the first one is returned.  This is a limitation of rclone, that supports one value per  one  key.   It  can  be
   triggered when you did a server-side copy.

   Reading metadata will also provide custom (non-standard nor reserved) ones.

Filtering auto generated files

   The  Internet Archive automatically creates metadata files after upload.  These can cause problems when doing an rclone sync as rclone will try, and fail, to
   delete them.  These metadata files are not changeable, as they are created by the Internet Archive automatically.

   These auto-created files can be excluded from the sync using metadata filtering (https://rclone.org/filtering/#metadata).

          rclone sync ... --metadata-exclude "source=metadata" --metadata-exclude "format=Metadata"

   Which excludes from the sync any files which have the source=metadata or format=Metadata flags which are added to Internet Archive auto-created files.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making an internetarchive configuration.  Most applies to the other providers as well, any differences are described below.

   First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          XX / InternetArchive Items
             \ (internetarchive)
          Storage> internetarchive
          Option access_key_id.
          IAS3 Access Key.
          Leave blank for anonymous access.
          You can find one here: https://archive.org/account/s3.php
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          access_key_id> XXXX
          Option secret_access_key.
          IAS3 Secret Key (password).
          Leave blank for anonymous access.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          secret_access_key> XXXX
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> y
          Option endpoint.
          IAS3 Endpoint.
          Leave blank for default value.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (https://s3.us.archive.org).
          endpoint>
          Option front_endpoint.
          Host of InternetArchive Frontend.
          Leave blank for default value.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (https://archive.org).
          front_endpoint>
          Option disable_checksum.
          Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.
          Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before
          uploading it so it can ask the server to check the object against checksum.
          This is great for data integrity checking but can cause long delays for
          large files to start uploading.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default (true).
          disable_checksum> true
          Option encoding.
          The encoding for the backend.
          See the [encoding section in the overview](https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.
          Enter a encoder.MultiEncoder value. Press Enter for the default (Slash,Question,Hash,Percent,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot).
          encoding>
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = internetarchive
          access_key_id = XXXX
          secret_access_key = XXXX
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to internetarchive (Internet Archive).

--internetarchive-access-key-id

   IAS3 Access Key.

   Leave blank for anonymous access.  You can find one here: https://archive.org/account/s3.php

   Properties:

    Config: access_key_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_ACCESS_KEY_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--internetarchive-secret-access-key

   IAS3 Secret Key (password).

   Leave blank for anonymous access.

   Properties:

    Config: secret_access_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to internetarchive (Internet Archive).

--internetarchive-endpoint

   IAS3 Endpoint.

   Leave blank for default value.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Default: "https://s3.us.archive.org"

--internetarchive-front-endpoint

   Host of InternetArchive Frontend.

   Leave blank for default value.

   Properties:

    Config: front_endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_FRONT_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Default: "https://archive.org"

--internetarchive-disable-checksum

   Don't ask the server to test against MD5 checksum calculated by rclone.  Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it  so
   it can ask the server to check the object against checksum.  This is great for data integrity checking but can cause long delays for large files to start up
   loading.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_checksum

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--internetarchive-wait-archive

   Timeout for waiting the server's processing tasks (specifically archive and book_op) to finish.  Only enable if you need to be guaranteed to be reflected af
   ter write operations.  0 to disable waiting.  No errors to be thrown in case of timeout.

   Properties:

    Config: wait_archive

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_WAIT_ARCHIVE

    Type: Duration

    Default: 0s

--internetarchive-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,CrLf,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Metadata

   Metadata  fields provided by Internet Archive.  If there are multiple values for a key, only the first one is returned.  This is a limitation of Rclone, that
   supports one value per one key.

   Owner is able to add custom keys.  Metadata feature grabs all the keys including them.

   Here are the possible system metadata items for the internetarchive backend.

   Name          Help                     Type          Example                                    Read Only
   
   crc32         CRC32  cal              string        01234567                                   Y
                 culated  by
                 Internet
                 Archive
   format        Name     of              string        Comma-Separated                            Y
                 format                                 Values
                 identified
                 by Internet
                 Archive
   md5           MD5    hash              string        01234567012345670123456701234567           Y
                 calculated
                 by Internet
                 Archive
   mtime         Time     of              RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z             Y
                 last  modi
                 fication,
                 managed  by
                 Rclone
   name          Full   file              filename      backend/internetarchive/inter             Y
                 path, with                            netarchive.go
                 out     the
                 bucket part
   old_version   Whether the              boolean       true                                       Y
                 file    was
                 replaced
                 and   moved
                 by    keep-
                 old-version
                 flag
   rclone-ia-    Time     of              RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z             N
   mtime         last  modi
                 fication,
                 managed  by
                 Internet
                 Archive
   rclone-       Time     of              RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z             N
   mtime         last  modi
                 fication,
                 managed  by
                 Rclone
   rclone-up    Random val              string        aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa           N
   date-track    ue  used by
                 Rclone  for
                 tracking
                 changes in
                 side Inter
                 net Archive
   sha1          SHA1   hash              string        0123456701234567012345670123456701234567   Y
                 calculated
                 by Internet
                 Archive
   size          File   size              decimal       123456                                     Y
                 in bytes                 number
   source        The  source              string        original                                   Y
                 of the file

   summation     Check                    string        md5                                        Y
                 https://fo
                 rum.rclone.org/t/31922
                 for how  it
                 is used
   viruscheck    The   last  time  vir   unixtime      1654191352                                 Y
                 uscheck  process   was
                 run for the file (?)

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Jottacloud

   Jottacloud  is a cloud storage service provider from a Norwegian company, using its own datacenters in Norway.  In addition to the official service at jotta
   cloud.com (https://www.jottacloud.com/), it also provides white-label solutions to different companies, such as: * Telia *  Telia  Cloud  (cloud.telia.se)  *
   Telia  Sky  (sky.telia.no)  *  Tele2  *  Tele2  Cloud (mittcloud.tele2.se) * Elkjøp (with subsidiaries): * Elkjøp Cloud (cloud.elkjop.no) * Elgiganten Sweden
   (cloud.elgiganten.se) * Elgiganten Denmark (cloud.elgiganten.dk) * Giganti Cloud (cloud.gigantti.fi) * ELKO Cloud (cloud.elko.is)

   Most of the white-label versions are supported by this backend, although may require different authentication setup - described below.

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Authentication types

   Some of the whitelabel versions uses a different authentication method than the official service, and you have to choose the correct one when setting up  the
   remote.

Standard authentication

   The standard authentication method used by the official service (jottacloud.com), as well as some of the whitelabel services, requires you to generate a sin
   gle-use personal login token from the account security settings in the service's web interface.  Log in to your account, go to "Settings" and  then  "Securi‐
   ty",  or  use  the  direct  link presented to you by rclone when configuring the remote: <https://www.jottacloud.com/web/secure>.  Scroll down to the section
   "Personal login token", and click the "Generate" button.  Note that if you are using a whitelabel service you probably can't use the direct link, you need to
   find the same page in their dedicated web interface, and also it may be in a different location than described above.

   To access your account from multiple instances of rclone, you need to configure each of them with a separate personal login token.  E.g.  you create a Jotta
   cloud remote with rclone in one location, and copy the configuration file to a second location where you also want to run rclone and access the same  remote.
   Then you need to replace the token for one of them, using the config reconnect (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_reconnect/) command, which requires
   you to generate a new personal login token and supply as input.  If you do not do this, the token may easily end up being invalidated, resulting in both  in
   stances failing with an error message something along the lines of:

          oauth2: cannot fetch token: 400 Bad Request
          Response: {"error":"invalid_grant","error_description":"Stale token"}

   When this happens, you need to replace the token as described above to be able to use your remote again.

   All  personal login tokens you have taken into use will be listed in the web interface under "My logged in devices", and from the right side of that list you
   can click the "X" button to revoke individual tokens.

Legacy authentication

   If you are using one of the whitelabel versions (e.g.  from Elkjøp) you may not have the option to generate a CLI token.  In this case you'll have to use the
   legacy  authentication.   To do this select yes when the setup asks for legacy authentication and enter your username and password.  The rest of the setup is
   identical to the default setup.

Telia Cloud authentication

   Similar to other whitelabel versions Telia Cloud doesn't offer the option of creating a CLI token, and additionally uses a separate authentication flow where
   the  username is generated internally.  To setup rclone to use Telia Cloud, choose Telia Cloud authentication in the setup.  The rest of the setup is identi
   cal to the default setup.

Tele2 Cloud authentication

   As Tele2-Com Hem merger was completed this authentication can be used for former Com Hem Cloud and Tele2 Cloud customers as no support for creating a CLI to
   ken  exists,  and  additionally  uses  a separate authentication flow where the username is generated internally.  To setup rclone to use Tele2 Cloud, choose
   Tele2 Cloud authentication in the setup.  The rest of the setup is identical to the default setup.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote with the default setup.  First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          XX / Jottacloud
             \ (jottacloud)
          [snip]
          Storage> jottacloud
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Option config_type.
          Select authentication type.
          Choose a number from below, or type in an existing string value.
          Press Enter for the default (standard).
             / Standard authentication.
           1 | Use this if you're a normal Jottacloud user.
             \ (standard)
             / Legacy authentication.
           2 | This is only required for certain whitelabel versions of Jottacloud and not recommended for normal users.
             \ (legacy)
             / Telia Cloud authentication.
           3 | Use this if you are using Telia Cloud.
             \ (telia)
             / Tele2 Cloud authentication.
           4 | Use this if you are using Tele2 Cloud.
             \ (tele2)
          config_type> 1
          Personal login token.
          Generate here: https://www.jottacloud.com/web/secure
          Login Token> <your token here>
          Use a non-standard device/mountpoint?
          Choosing no, the default, will let you access the storage used for the archive
          section of the official Jottacloud client. If you instead want to access the
          sync or the backup section, for example, you must choose yes.
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> y
          Option config_device.
          The device to use. In standard setup the built-in Jotta device is used,
          which contains predefined mountpoints for archive, sync etc. All other devices
          are treated as backup devices by the official Jottacloud client. You may create
          a new by entering a unique name.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
          Press Enter for the default (DESKTOP-3H31129).
           1 > DESKTOP-3H31129
           2 > Jotta
          config_device> 2
          Option config_mountpoint.
          The mountpoint to use for the built-in device Jotta.
          The standard setup is to use the Archive mountpoint. Most other mountpoints
          have very limited support in rclone and should generally be avoided.
          Choose a number from below, or type in an existing string value.
          Press Enter for the default (Archive).
           1 > Archive
           2 > Shared
           3 > Sync
          config_mountpoint> 1
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = jottacloud
          configVersion = 1
          client_id = jottacli
          client_secret =
          tokenURL = https://id.jottacloud.com/auth/realms/jottacloud/protocol/openid-connect/token
          token = {........}
          username = 2940e57271a93d987d6f8a21
          device = Jotta
          mountpoint = Archive
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Jottacloud

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your Jottacloud

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an Jottacloud directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Devices and Mountpoints

   The official Jottacloud client registers a device for each computer you install it on, and shows them in the backup section of the user interface.  For  each
   folder  you  select  for backup it will create a mountpoint within this device.  A built-in device called Jotta is special, and contains mountpoints Archive,
   Sync and some others, used for corresponding features in official clients.

   With rclone you'll want to use the standard Jotta/Archive device/mountpoint in most cases.  However, you may for example want to access files from  the  sync
   or backup functionality provided by the official clients, and rclone therefore provides the option to select other devices and mountpoints during config.

   You  are  allowed  to  create new devices and mountpoints.  All devices except the built-in Jotta device are treated as backup devices by official Jottacloud
   clients, and the mountpoints on them are individual backup sets.

   With the built-in Jotta device, only existing, built-in, mountpoints can be selected.  In addition to the mentioned Archive and Sync, it may contain  several
   other mountpoints such as: Latest, Links, Shared and Trash.  All of these are special mountpoints with a different internal representation than the "regular"
   mountpoints.  Rclone will only to a very limited degree support them.  Generally you should avoid these, unless you know what you are doing.

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

   Note  that  the  implementation in Jottacloud always uses only a single API request to get the entire list, so for large folders this could lead to long wait
   time before the first results are shown.

   Note also that with rclone version 1.58 and newer information about MIME types (https://rclone.org/overview/#mime-type) are not available when using  --fast-
   list.

Modified time and hashes

   Jottacloud allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

   Jottacloud supports MD5 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum flag.

   Note  that Jottacloud requires the MD5 hash before upload so if the source does not have an MD5 checksum then the file will be cached temporarily on disk (in
   location given by --temp-dir (https://rclone.org/docs/#temp-dir-dir)) before it is uploaded.  Small files will be cached in memory -  see  the  --jottacloud-
   md5-memory-limit  flag.   When  uploading from local disk the source checksum is always available, so this does not apply.  Starting with rclone version 1.52
   the same is true for crypted remotes (in older versions the crypt backend would not calculate hashes for uploads from local disk, so the  Jottacloud  backend
   had to do it as described above).

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   "           0x22        
   *           0x2A        
   :           0x3A        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        
   ?           0x3F        
   |           0x7C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in XML strings.

Deleting files

   By  default,  rclone will send all files to the trash when deleting files.  They will be permanently deleted automatically after 30 days.  You may bypass the
   trash and permanently delete files immediately by using the --jottacloud-hard-delete flag, or set the equivalent environment variable.  Emptying the trash is
   supported by the cleanup (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cleanup/) command.

Versions

   Jottacloud  supports file versioning.  When rclone uploads a new version of a file it creates a new version of it.  Currently rclone only supports retrieving
   the current version but older versions can be accessed via the Jottacloud Website.

   Versioning can be disabled by --jottacloud-no-versions option.  This is achieved by deleting the remote file prior to uploading a new version.  If the upload
   the fails no version of the file will be available in the remote.

Quota information

   To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display your usage limit (unless it is unlimited) and the current usage.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to jottacloud (Jottacloud).

--jottacloud-md5-memory-limit

   Files bigger than this will be cached on disk to calculate the MD5 if required.

   Properties:

    Config: md5_memory_limit

    Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_MD5_MEMORY_LIMIT

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 10Mi

--jottacloud-trashed-only

   Only show files that are in the trash.

   This will show trashed files in their original directory structure.

   Properties:

    Config: trashed_only

    Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_TRASHED_ONLY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--jottacloud-hard-delete

   Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

   Properties:

    Config: hard_delete

    Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_HARD_DELETE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--jottacloud-upload-resume-limit

   Files bigger than this can be resumed if the upload fail's.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_resume_limit

    Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_UPLOAD_RESUME_LIMIT

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 10Mi

--jottacloud-no-versions

   Avoid server side versioning by deleting files and recreating files instead of overwriting them.

   Properties:

    Config: no_versions

    Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_NO_VERSIONS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--jottacloud-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that Jottacloud is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   There  are  quite  a few characters that can't be in Jottacloud file names.  Rclone will map these names to and from an identical looking unicode equivalent.
   For example if a file has a ?  in it will be mapped to  instead.

   Jottacloud only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

Troubleshooting

   Jottacloud exhibits some inconsistent behaviours regarding deleted files and folders which may cause Copy, Move and DirMove operations to previously  deleted
   paths to fail.  Emptying the trash should help in such cases.

Koofr

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The   initial  setup  for  Koofr  involves  creating  an  application  password  for  rclone.   You  can  do  that  by  opening  the  Koofr  web  application
   (https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password), giving the password a nice name like rclone and clicking on generate.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called koofr.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> koofr
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          22 / Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers
             \ (koofr)
          [snip]
          Storage> koofr
          Option provider.
          Choose your storage provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/
             \ (koofr)
           2 / Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/
             \ (digistorage)
           3 / Any other Koofr API compatible storage service
             \ (other)
          provider> 1
          Option user.
          Your user name.
          Enter a value.
          user> USERNAME
          Option password.
          Your password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password).
          Choose an alternative below.
          y) Yes, type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [koofr]
          type = koofr
          provider = koofr
          user = USERNAME
          password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   You can choose to edit advanced config in order to enter your own service URL if you use an on-premise or white label Koofr instance, or choose  an  alterna
   tive mount instead of your primary storage.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Koofr

          rclone lsd koofr:

   List all the files in your Koofr

          rclone ls koofr:

   To copy a local directory to an Koofr directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source koofr:backup

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in XML strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to koofr (Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers).

--koofr-provider

   Choose your storage provider.

   Properties:

    Config: provider

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PROVIDER

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "koofr"

        Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/

      "digistorage"

        Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/

      "other"

        Any other Koofr API compatible storage service

--koofr-endpoint

   The Koofr API endpoint to use.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_ENDPOINT

    Provider: other

    Type: string

    Required: true

--koofr-user

   Your user name.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_USER

    Type: string

    Required: true

--koofr-password

   Your password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password).

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD

    Provider: koofr

    Type: string

    Required: true

--koofr-password

   Your password for rclone (generate one at https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/app/admin/preferences/password).

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD

    Provider: digistorage

    Type: string

    Required: true

--koofr-password

   Your password for rclone (generate one at your service's settings page).

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD

    Provider: other

    Type: string

    Required: true

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to koofr (Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers).

--koofr-mountid

   Mount ID of the mount to use.

   If omitted, the primary mount is used.

   Properties:

    Config: mountid

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_MOUNTID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--koofr-setmtime

   Does the backend support setting modification time.

   Set this to false if you use a mount ID that points to a Dropbox or Amazon Drive backend.

   Properties:

    Config: setmtime

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_SETMTIME

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--koofr-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that Koofr is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

Providers Koofr

   This is the original Koofr (https://koofr.eu) storage provider used as main example and described in the configuration section above.

Digi Storage

   Digi Storage (https://www.digi.ro/servicii/online/digi-storage) is a cloud storage service run by Digi.ro (https://www.digi.ro/) that provides a Koofr API.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called ds.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> ds
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          22 / Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers
             \ (koofr)
          [snip]
          Storage> koofr
          Option provider.
          Choose your storage provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/
             \ (koofr)
           2 / Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/
             \ (digistorage)
           3 / Any other Koofr API compatible storage service
             \ (other)
          provider> 2
          Option user.
          Your user name.
          Enter a value.
          user> USERNAME
          Option password.
          Your password for rclone (generate one at https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/app/admin/preferences/password).
          Choose an alternative below.
          y) Yes, type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          [ds]
          type = koofr
          provider = digistorage
          user = USERNAME
          password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Other

   You  may  also  want to use another, public or private storage provider that runs a Koofr API compatible service, by simply providing the base URL to connect
   to.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called other.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> other
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          22 / Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers
             \ (koofr)
          [snip]
          Storage> koofr
          Option provider.
          Choose your storage provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/
             \ (koofr)
           2 / Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/
             \ (digistorage)
           3 / Any other Koofr API compatible storage service
             \ (other)
          provider> 3
          Option endpoint.
          The Koofr API endpoint to use.
          Enter a value.
          endpoint> https://koofr.other.org
          Option user.
          Your user name.
          Enter a value.
          user> USERNAME
          Option password.
          Your password for rclone (generate one at your service's settings page).
          Choose an alternative below.
          y) Yes, type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          [other]
          type = koofr
          provider = other
          endpoint = https://koofr.other.org
          user = USERNAME
          password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Mail.ru Cloud

   Mail.ru Cloud (https://cloud.mail.ru/) is a cloud storage provided by a Russian internet company  Mail.Ru  Group  (https://mail.ru).   The  official  desktop
   client is Disk-O: (https://disk-o.cloud/en), available on Windows and Mac OS.

   Currently it is recommended to disable 2FA on Mail.ru accounts intended for rclone until it gets eventually implemented.

Features highlights

    Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory

    Files have a last modified time property, directories don't

    Deleted files are by default moved to the trash

    Files and directories can be shared via public links

    Partial uploads or streaming are not supported, file size must be known before upload

    Maximum file size is limited to 2G for a free account, unlimited for paid accounts

    Storage keeps hash for all files and performs transparent deduplication, the hash algorithm is a modified SHA1

    If a particular file is already present in storage, one can quickly submit file hash instead of long file upload (this optimization is supported by rclone)

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a mailru configuration.

   First create a Mail.ru Cloud account and choose a tariff.

   You  will  need  to  log  in and create an app password for rclone.  Rclone will not work with your normal username and password - it will give an error like
   oauth2: server response missing access_token.

    Click on your user icon in the top right

    Go to Security / "Пароль и безопасность"

    Click password for apps / "Пароли для внешних приложений"

    Add the password - give it a name - eg "rclone"

    Copy the password and use this password below - your normal login password won't work.

   Now run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Mail.ru Cloud
             \ "mailru"
          [snip]
          Storage> mailru
          User name (usually email)
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          user> username@mail.ru
          Password

          This must be an app password - rclone will not work with your normal
          password. See the Configuration section in the docs for how to make an
          app password.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash.
          This feature is called "speedup" or "put by hash". It is especially efficient
          in case of generally available files like popular books, video or audio clips
          [snip]
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("true").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enable
             \ "true"
           2 / Disable
             \ "false"
          speedup_enable> 1
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = mailru
          user = username@mail.ru
          pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          speedup_enable = true
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Configuration of this backend does not require a local web browser.  You can use the configured backend as shown below:

   See top level directories

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new directory

          rclone mkdir remote:directory

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:directory

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any excess files in the path.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:directory

Modified time

   Files support a modification time attribute with up to 1 second precision.  Directories do not have a modification time, which is shown as "Jan 1 1970".

Hash checksums

   Hash sums use a custom Mail.ru algorithm based on SHA1.  If file size is less than or equal to the SHA1 block size (20 bytes), its hash is  simply  its  data
   right-padded  with  zero bytes.  Hash sum of a larger file is computed as a SHA1 sum of the file data bytes concatenated with a decimal representation of the
   data length.

Emptying Trash

   Removing a file or directory actually moves it to the trash, which is not visible to rclone but can be seen in a web browser.  The trashed file  still  occu
   pies part of total quota.  If you wish to empty your trash and free some quota, you can use the rclone cleanup remote: command, which will permanently delete
   all your trashed files.  This command does not take any path arguments.

Quota information

   To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display your usage limit (quota) and the current usage.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   "           0x22        
   *           0x2A        
   :           0x3A        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        
   ?           0x3F        
   \           0x5C        
   |           0x7C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to mailru (Mail.ru Cloud).

--mailru-user

   User name (usually email).

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_USER

    Type: string

    Required: true

--mailru-pass

   Password.

   This must be an app password - rclone will not work with your normal password.  See the Configuration section in the docs for how to make an app password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: true

--mailru-speedup-enable

   Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash.

   This feature is called "speedup" or "put by hash".  It is especially efficient in case of generally available files like popular books, video or audio clips,
   because  files  are  searched  by hash in all accounts of all mailru users.  It is meaningless and ineffective if source file is unique or encrypted.  Please
   note that rclone may need local memory and disk space to calculate content hash in advance and decide whether full upload is required.  Also, if rclone  does
   not know file size in advance (e.g.  in case of streaming or partial uploads), it will not even try this optimization.

   Properties:

    Config: speedup_enable

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_ENABLE

    Type: bool

    Default: true

    Examples:

      "true"

        Enable

      "false"

        Disable

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to mailru (Mail.ru Cloud).

--mailru-speedup-file-patterns

   Comma separated list of file name patterns eligible for speedup (put by hash).

   Patterns are case insensitive and can contain '*' or '?' meta characters.

   Properties:

    Config: speedup_file_patterns

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_FILE_PATTERNS

    Type: string

    Default: ".mkv,.avi,.mp4,.mp3,.zip,.gz,.rar,.pdf"

    Examples:

      ""

        Empty list completely disables speedup (put by hash).

      "*"

        All files will be attempted for speedup.

      ".mkv,.avi,.mp4,.mp3"

        Only common audio/video files will be tried for put by hash.

      ".zip,.gz,.rar,.pdf"

        Only common archives or PDF books will be tried for speedup.

--mailru-speedup-max-disk

   This option allows you to disable speedup (put by hash) for large files.

   Reason is that preliminary hashing can exhaust your RAM or disk space.

   Properties:

    Config: speedup_max_disk

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_MAX_DISK

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 3Gi

    Examples:

      "0"

        Completely disable speedup (put by hash).

      "1G"

        Files larger than 1Gb will be uploaded directly.

      "3G"

        Choose this option if you have less than 3Gb free on local disk.

--mailru-speedup-max-memory

   Files larger than the size given below will always be hashed on disk.

   Properties:

    Config: speedup_max_memory

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_MAX_MEMORY

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 32Mi

    Examples:

      "0"

        Preliminary hashing will always be done in a temporary disk location.

      "32M"

        Do not dedicate more than 32Mb RAM for preliminary hashing.

      "256M"

        You have at most 256Mb RAM free for hash calculations.

--mailru-check-hash

   What should copy do if file checksum is mismatched or invalid.

   Properties:

    Config: check_hash

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_CHECK_HASH

    Type: bool

    Default: true

    Examples:

      "true"

        Fail with error.

      "false"

        Ignore and continue.

--mailru-user-agent

   HTTP user agent used internally by client.

   Defaults to "rclone/VERSION" or "--user-agent" provided on command line.

   Properties:

    Config: user_agent

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_USER_AGENT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--mailru-quirks

   Comma separated list of internal maintenance flags.

   This  option  must  not be used by an ordinary user.  It is intended only to facilitate remote troubleshooting of backend issues.  Strict meaning of flags is
   not documented and not guaranteed to persist between releases.  Quirks will be removed when the backend grows stable.  Supported quirks: atomicmkdir  binlist
   unknowndirs

   Properties:

    Config: quirks

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_QUIRKS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--mailru-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   File size limits depend on your account.  A single file size is limited by 2G for a free account and unlimited for paid tariffs.  Please refer to the Mail.ru
   site for the total uploaded size limits.

   Note that Mailru is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

Mega

   Mega (https://mega.nz/) is a cloud storage and file hosting service known for its security feature where all files are encrypted locally before they are  up
   loaded.  This prevents anyone (including employees of Mega) from accessing the files without knowledge of the key used for encryption.

   This is an rclone backend for Mega which supports the file transfer features of Mega using the same client side encryption.

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Mega
             \ "mega"
          [snip]
          Storage> mega
          User name
          user> you@example.com
          Password.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank
          y/g/n> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = mega
          user = you@example.com
          pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   NOTE:  The  encryption  keys need to have been already generated after a regular login via the browser, otherwise attempting to use the credentials in rclone
   will fail.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Mega

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your Mega

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an Mega directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   Mega does not support modification times or hashes yet.

Restricted filename characters

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Duplicated files

   Mega can have two files with exactly the same name and path (unlike a normal file system).

   Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will see messages in the log about duplicates.

   Use rclone dedupe to fix duplicated files.

Failure to log-in Object not found

   If you are connecting to your Mega remote for the first time, to test access and synchronization, you may receive an error such as

          Failed to create file system for "my-mega-remote:":
          couldn't login: Object (typically, node or user) not found

   The diagnostic steps often recommended in the rclone forum (https://forum.rclone.org/search?q=mega) start with the MEGAcmd utility.  Note that this refers to
   the official C++ command from https://github.com/meganz/MEGAcmd and not the go language built command from t3rm1n4l/megacmd that is no longer maintained.

   Follow  the  instructions  for  installing  MEGAcmd  and  try accessing your remote as they recommend.  You can establish whether or not you can log in using
   MEGAcmd, and obtain diagnostic information to help you, and search or work with others in the forum.

          MEGA CMD> login me@example.com
          Password:
          Fetching nodes ...
          Loading transfers from local cache
          Login complete as me@example.com
          me@example.com:/$

   Note that some have found issues with passwords containing special characters.  If you can not log on with rclone, but MEGAcmd logs on just fine,  then  con
   sider changing your password temporarily to pure alphanumeric characters, in case that helps.

Repeated commands blocks access

   Mega remotes seem to get blocked (reject logins) under "heavy use".  We haven't worked out the exact blocking rules but it seems to be related to fast paced,
   successive rclone commands.

   For example, executing this command 90 times in a row rclone link remote:file will cause the remote to become "blocked".  This is not an abnormal  situation,
   for  example if you wish to get the public links of a directory with hundred of files...  After more or less a week, the remote will remote accept rclone lo‐
   gins normally again.

   You can mitigate this issue by mounting the remote it with rclone mount.  This will log-in when mounting and a log-out when unmounting only.   You  can  also
   run rclone rcd and then use rclone rc to run the commands over the API to avoid logging in each time.

   Rclone does not currently close mega sessions (you can see them in the web interface), however closing the sessions does not solve the issue.

   If  you  space  rclone commands by 3 seconds it will avoid blocking the remote.  We haven't identified the exact blocking rules, so perhaps one could execute
   the command 80 times without waiting and avoid blocking by waiting 3 seconds, then continuing...

   Note that this has been observed by trial and error and might not be set in stone.

   Other tools seem not to produce this blocking effect, as they use a different working approach (state-based, using sessionIDs instead of log-in) which  isn't
   compatible with the current stateless rclone approach.

   Note that once blocked, the use of other tools (such as megacmd) is not a sure workaround: following megacmd login times have been observed in succession for
   blocked remote: 7 minutes, 20 min, 30min, 30 min, 30min.  Web access looks unaffected though.

   Investigation is continuing in relation to workarounds based on timeouts, pacers, retrials and tpslimits - if you discover something relevant, please post on
   the forum.

   So, if rclone was working nicely and suddenly you are unable to log-in and you are sure the user and the password are correct, likely you have got the remote
   blocked for a while.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to mega (Mega).

--mega-user

   User name.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_USER

    Type: string

    Required: true

--mega-pass

   Password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: true

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to mega (Mega).

--mega-debug

   Output more debug from Mega.

   If this flag is set (along with -vv) it will print further debugging information from the mega backend.

   Properties:

    Config: debug

    Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_DEBUG

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--mega-hard-delete

   Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

   Normally the mega backend will put all deletions into the trash rather than permanently deleting them.  If you specify  this  then  rclone  will  permanently
   delete objects instead.

   Properties:

    Config: hard_delete

    Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_HARD_DELETE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--mega-use-https

   Use HTTPS for transfers.

   MEGA  uses plain text HTTP connections by default.  Some ISPs throttle HTTP connections, this causes transfers to become very slow.  Enabling this will force
   MEGA to use HTTPS for all transfers.  HTTPS is normally not necesary since all data is already encrypted anyway.  Enabling it will increase CPU usage and add
   network overhead.

   Properties:

    Config: use_https

    Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_USE_HTTPS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--mega-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   This  backend  uses  the go-mega go library (https://github.com/t3rm1n4l/go-mega) which is an opensource go library implementing the Mega API.  There doesn't
   appear to be any documentation for the mega protocol beyond the mega C++ SDK (https://github.com/meganz/sdk) source code so there are likely quite a few  er
   rors still remaining in this library.

   Mega allows duplicate files which may confuse rclone.

Memory

   The memory backend is an in RAM backend.  It does not persist its data - use the local backend for that.

   The memory backend behaves like a bucket-based remote (e.g.  like s3).  Because it has no parameters you can just use it with the :memory: remote name.

Configuration

   You can configure it as a remote like this with rclone config too if you want to:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Memory
             \ "memory"
          [snip]
          Storage> memory
          ** See help for memory backend at: https://rclone.org/memory/ **

          Remote config

          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = memory
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Because the memory backend isn't persistent it is most useful for testing or with an rclone server or rclone mount, e.g.

          rclone mount :memory: /mnt/tmp
          rclone serve webdav :memory:
          rclone serve sftp :memory:

Modified time and hashes

   The memory backend supports MD5 hashes and modification times accurate to 1 nS.

Restricted filename characters

   The memory backend replaces the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters).

Akamai NetStorage

   Paths  are specified as remote: You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:/path/to/dir.  If you have a CP code you can use that as the folder after the
   domain such as <domain>/<cpcode>/<internal directories within cpcode>.

   For example, this is commonly configured with or without a CP code: * With a CP code.  [your-domain-prefix]-nsu.akamaihd.net/123456/subdirectory/ * Without a
   CP code.  [your-domain-prefix]-nsu.akamaihd.net

   See  all buckets rclone lsd remote: The initial setup for Netstorage involves getting an account and secret.  Use rclone config to walk you through the setup
   process.

Configuration

   Here's an example of how to make a remote called ns1.

   1. To begin the interactive configuration process, enter this command:

      rclone config

   2. Type n to create a new remote.

      n) New remote
      d) Delete remote
      q) Quit config
      e/n/d/q> n

   3. For this example, enter ns1 when you reach the name> prompt.

      name> ns1

   4. Enter netstorage as the type of storage to configure.

      Type of storage to configure.
      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
      XX / NetStorage
         \ "netstorage"
      Storage> netstorage

   5. Select between the HTTP or HTTPS protocol.  Most users should choose HTTPS, which is the default.  HTTP is provided primarily for debugging purposes.

      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
       1 / HTTP protocol
         \ "http"
       2 / HTTPS protocol
         \ "https"
      protocol> 1

   6. Specify your NetStorage host, CP code, and any necessary content paths using this format: <domain>/<cpcode>/<content>/

      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      host> baseball-nsu.akamaihd.net/123456/content/

   7. Set the netstorage account name

      Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
      account> username

   8. Set the Netstorage account secret/G2O key which will be used for authentication purposes.  Select the y option to set your own password  then  enter  your
      secret.  Note: The secret is stored in the rclone.conf file with hex-encoded encryption.

      y) Yes type in my own password
      g) Generate random password
      y/g> y
      Enter the password:
      password:
      Confirm the password:
      password:

   9. View the summary and confirm your remote configuration.

      [ns1]
      type = netstorage
      protocol = http
      host = baseball-nsu.akamaihd.net/123456/content/
      account = username
      secret = *** ENCRYPTED ***
      --------------------
      y) Yes this is OK (default)
      e) Edit this remote
      d) Delete this remote
      y/e/d> y

   This remote is called ns1 and can now be used.

Example operations

   Get started with rclone and NetStorage with these examples.  For additional rclone commands, visit https://rclone.org/commands/.

See contents of a directory in your project

          rclone lsd ns1:/974012/testing/

Sync the contents local with remote

          rclone sync . ns1:/974012/testing/

Upload local content to remote

          rclone copy notes.txt ns1:/974012/testing/

Delete content on remote

          rclone delete ns1:/974012/testing/notes.txt

Move or copy content between CP codes.

   Your credentials must have access to two CP codes on the same remote.  You can't perform operations between different remotes.

          rclone move ns1:/974012/testing/notes.txt ns1:/974450/testing2/

Features Symlink Support

   The  Netstorage backend changes the rclone --links, -l behavior.  When uploading, instead of creating the .rclonelink file, use the "symlink" API in order to
   create the corresponding symlink on the remote.  The .rclonelink file will not be created, the upload will be intercepted and  only  the  symlink  file  that
   matches the source file name with no suffix will be created on the remote.

   This will effectively allow commands like copy/copyto, move/moveto and sync to upload from local to remote and download from remote to local directories with
   symlinks.  Due to internal rclone limitations, it is not possible to upload an individual symlink file to any remote backend.  You can always use the  "back‐
   end symlink" command to create a symlink on the NetStorage server, refer to "symlink" section below.

   Individual  symlink  files  on  the  remote  can  be used with the commands like "cat" to print the destination name, or "delete" to delete symlink, or copy,
   copy/to and move/moveto to download from the remote to local.  Note: individual symlink files  on  the  remote  should  be  specified  including  the  suffix
   .rclonelink.

   Note:  No  file with the suffix .rclonelink should ever exist on the server since it is not possible to actually upload/create a file with .rclonelink suffix
   with rclone, it can only exist if it is manually created through a non-rclone method on the remote.

Implicit vs. Explicit Directories

   With NetStorage, directories can exist in one of two forms:

   1. Explicit Directory.  This is an actual, physical directory that you have created in a storage group.

   2. Implicit Directory.  This refers to a directory within a path that has not been physically created.  For example, during upload  of  a  file,  nonexistent
      subdirectories  can  be specified in the target path.  NetStorage creates these as "implicit." While the directories aren't physically created, they exist
      implicitly and the noted path is connected with the uploaded file.

   Rclone will intercept all file uploads and mkdir commands for the NetStorage remote and will explicitly issue the mkdir command for each directory in the up
   loading  path.  This will help with the interoperability with the other Akamai services such as SFTP and the Content Management Shell (CMShell).  Rclone will
   not guarantee correctness of operations with implicit directories which might have been created as a result of using an upload API directly.

--fast-list / ListR support

   NetStorage remote supports the ListR feature by using the "list" NetStorage API action to return a lexicographical list of all objects within  the  specified
   CP code, recursing into subdirectories as they're encountered.

   • Rclone  will use the ListR method for some commands by default.  Commands such as lsf -R will use ListR by default.  To disable this, include the --disable
     listR option to use the non-recursive method of listing objects.

   • Rclone will not use the ListR method for some commands.  Commands such as sync don't use ListR by default.  To force using the ListR  method,  include  the
     --fast-list option.

   There  are pros and cons of using the ListR method, refer to rclone documentation (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list).  In general, the sync command over an
   existing deep tree on the remote will run faster with the "--fast-list" flag but with extra memory usage as a side effect.  It might also  result  in  higher
   CPU utilization but the whole task can be completed faster.

   Note:  There is a known limitation that "lsf -R" will display number of files in the directory and directory size as -1 when ListR method is used.  The work
   around is to pass "--disable listR" flag if these numbers are important in the output.

Purge

   NetStorage remote supports the purge feature by using the "quick-delete" NetStorage API action.  The quick-delete action is disabled by default for  security
   reasons  and  can  be  enabled for the account through the Akamai portal.  Rclone will first try to use quick-delete action for the purge command and if this
   functionality is disabled then will fall back to a standard delete method.

   Note: Read  the  NetStorage  Usage  API  (https://learn.akamai.com/en-us/webhelp/netstorage/netstorage-http-api-developer-guide/GUID-15836617-9F50-405A-833C-
   EA2556756A30.html) for considerations when using "quick-delete".  In general, using quick-delete method will not delete the tree immediately and objects tar
   geted for quick-delete may still be accessible.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to netstorage (Akamai NetStorage).

--netstorage-host

   Domain+path of NetStorage host to connect to.

   Format should be <domain>/<internal folders>

   Properties:

    Config: host

    Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_HOST

    Type: string

    Required: true

--netstorage-account

   Set the NetStorage account name

   Properties:

    Config: account

    Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_ACCOUNT

    Type: string

    Required: true

--netstorage-secret

   Set the NetStorage account secret/G2O key for authentication.

   Please choose the 'y' option to set your own password then enter your secret.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: true

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to netstorage (Akamai NetStorage).

--netstorage-protocol

   Select between HTTP or HTTPS protocol.

   Most users should choose HTTPS, which is the default.  HTTP is provided primarily for debugging purposes.

   Properties:

    Config: protocol

    Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_PROTOCOL

    Type: string

    Default: "https"

    Examples:

      "http"

        HTTP protocol

      "https"

        HTTPS protocol

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the netstorage backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

du

   Return disk usage information for a specified directory

          rclone backend du remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   The usage information returned, includes the targeted directory as well as all files stored in any sub-directories that may exist.

symlink

   You can create a symbolic link in ObjectStore with the symlink action.

          rclone backend symlink remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   The desired path location (including applicable sub-directories) ending in the object that will be the target of the symlink  (for  example,  /links/mylink).
   Include the file extension for the object, if applicable.  rclone backend symlink <src> <path>

Microsoft Azure Blob Storage

   Paths are specified as remote:container (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:container/path/to/dir.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a Microsoft Azure Blob Storage configuration.  For a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Microsoft Azure Blob Storage
             \ "azureblob"
          [snip]
          Storage> azureblob
          Storage Account Name
          account> account_name
          Storage Account Key
          key> base64encodedkey==
          Endpoint for the service - leave blank normally.
          endpoint>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          account = account_name
          key = base64encodedkey==
          endpoint =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See all containers

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new container

          rclone mkdir remote:container

   List the contents of a container

          rclone ls remote:container

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote container, deleting any excess files in the container.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:container

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

Modified time

   The modified time is stored as metadata on the object with the mtime key.  It is stored using RFC3339 Format time with nanosecond precision.  The metadata is
   supplied during directory listings so there is no performance overhead to using it.

   If  you wish to use the Azure standard LastModified time stored on the object as the modified time, then use the --use-server-modtime flag.  Note that rclone
   can't set LastModified, so using the --update flag when syncing is recommended if using --use-server-modtime.

Performance

   When uploading large files, increasing the value of --azureblob-upload-concurrency will increase performance at the cost of using more memory.   The  default
   of  16  is  set  quite conservatively to use less memory.  It maybe be necessary raise it to 64 or higher to fully utilize a 1 GBit/s link with a single file
   transfer.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   /           0x2F        
   \           0x5C        

   File names can also not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   .           0x2E        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Hashes

   MD5 hashes are stored with blobs.  However blobs that were uploaded in chunks only have an MD5 if the source remote was capable of MD5 hashes, e.g.  the  lo
   cal disk.

Authentication

   There are a number of ways of supplying credentials for Azure Blob Storage.  Rclone tries them in the order of the sections below.

Env Auth

   If the env_auth config parameter is true then rclone will pull credentials from the environment or runtime.

   It tries these authentication methods in this order:

   1. Environment Variables

   2. Managed Service Identity Credentials

   3. Azure CLI credentials (as used by the az tool)

   These are described in the following sections

Env Auth: 1. Environment Variables

   If  env_auth  is  set and environment variables are present rclone authenticates a service principal with a secret or certificate, or a user with a password,
   depending on which environment variable are set.  It reads configuration from these variables, in the following order:

   1. Service principal with client secret

        AZURE_TENANT_ID: ID of the service principal's tenant.  Also called its "directory" ID.

       • AZURE_CLIENT_ID: the service principal's client ID

        AZURE_CLIENT_SECRET: one of the service principal's client secrets

   2. Service principal with certificate

       • AZURE_TENANT_ID: ID of the service principal's tenant.  Also called its "directory" ID.

        AZURE_CLIENT_ID: the service principal's client ID

       • AZURE_CLIENT_CERTIFICATE_PATH: path to a PEM or PKCS12 certificate file including the private key.

       • AZURE_CLIENT_CERTIFICATE_PASSWORD: (optional) password for the certificate file.

       • AZURE_CLIENT_SEND_CERTIFICATE_CHAIN: (optional) Specifies whether an authentication request will include an x5c header to support subject name / issuer
         based authentication.  When set to "true" or "1", authentication requests include the x5c header.

   3. User with username and password

       • AZURE_TENANT_ID: (optional) tenant to authenticate in.  Defaults to "organizations".

       • AZURE_CLIENT_ID: client ID of the application the user will authenticate to

       • AZURE_USERNAME: a username (usually an email address)

       • AZURE_PASSWORD: the user's password

Env Auth: 2. Managed Service Identity Credentials

   When  using  Managed  Service Identity if the VM(SS) on which this program is running has a system-assigned identity, it will be used by default.  If the re
   source has no system-assigned but exactly one user-assigned identity, the user-assigned identity will be used by default.

   If the resource has multiple user-assigned identities you will need to unset env_auth and set use_msi instead.  See the use_msi section.

Env Auth: 3. Azure CLI credentials (as used by the az tool)

   Credentials created with the az tool can be picked up using env_auth.

   For example if you were to login with a service principal like this:

          az login --service-principal -u XXX -p XXX --tenant XXX

   Then you could access rclone resources like this:

          rclone lsf :azureblob,env_auth,account=ACCOUNT:CONTAINER

   Or

          rclone lsf --azureblob-env-auth --azureblob-acccount=ACCOUNT :azureblob:CONTAINER

   Which is analogous to using the az tool:

          az storage blob list --container-name CONTAINER --account-name ACCOUNT --auth-mode login

Account and Shared Key

   This is the most straight forward and least flexible way.  Just fill in the account and key lines and leave the rest blank.

SAS URL

   This can be an account level SAS URL or container level SAS URL.

   To use it leave account and key blank and fill in sas_url.

   An account level SAS URL or container level SAS URL can be obtained from the Azure portal or the Azure Storage Explorer.  To get a container  level  SAS  URL
   right click on a container in the Azure Blob explorer in the Azure portal.

   If you use a container level SAS URL, rclone operations are permitted only on a particular container, e.g.

          rclone ls azureblob:container

   You can also list the single container from the root.  This will only show the container specified by the SAS URL.

          $ rclone lsd azureblob:
          container/

   Note that you can't see or access any other containers - this will fail

          rclone ls azureblob:othercontainer

   Container  level SAS URLs are useful for temporarily allowing third parties access to a single container or putting credentials into an untrusted environment
   such as a CI build server.

Service principal with client secret

   If these variables are set, rclone will authenticate with a service principal with a client secret.

    tenant: ID of the service principal's tenant.  Also called its "directory" ID.

   • client_id: the service principal's client ID

    client_secret: one of the service principal's client secrets

   The credentials can also be placed in a file using the service_principal_file configuration option.

Service principal with certificate

   If these variables are set, rclone will authenticate with a service principal with certificate.

    tenant: ID of the service principal's tenant.  Also called its "directory" ID.

   • client_id: the service principal's client ID

    client_certificate_path: path to a PEM or PKCS12 certificate file including the private key.

    client_certificate_password: (optional) password for the certificate file.

    client_send_certificate_chain: (optional) Specifies whether an authentication request will include an x5c header to support subject name / issuer based au
     thentication.  When set to "true" or "1", authentication requests include the x5c header.

   NB client_certificate_password must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

User with username and password

   If these variables are set, rclone will authenticate with username and password.

    tenant: (optional) tenant to authenticate in.  Defaults to "organizations".

    client_id: client ID of the application the user will authenticate to

    username: a username (usually an email address)

    password: the user's password

   Microsoft  doesn't  recommend  this  kind of authentication, because it's less secure than other authentication flows.  This method is not interactive, so it
   isn't compatible with any form of multi-factor authentication, and the application must already have user or admin consent.  This credential can only authen
   ticate work and school accounts; it can't authenticate Microsoft accounts.

   NB password must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

Managed Service Identity Credentials

   If use_msi is set then managed service identity credentials are used.  This authentication only works when running in an Azure service.  env_auth needs to be
   unset to use this.

   However if you have multiple user identities to choose from these must be explicitly specified using exactly one  of  the  msi_object_id,  msi_client_id,  or
   msi_mi_res_id parameters.

   If none of msi_object_id, msi_client_id, or msi_mi_res_id is set, this is is equivalent to using env_auth.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to azureblob (Microsoft Azure Blob Storage).

--azureblob-account

   Azure Storage Account Name.

   Set this to the Azure Storage Account Name in use.

   Leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator, otherwise it needs to be set.

   If this is blank and if env_auth is set it will be read from the environment variable AZURE_STORAGE_ACCOUNT_NAME if possible.

   Properties:

    Config: account

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ACCOUNT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-env-auth

   Read credentials from runtime (environment variables, CLI or MSI).

   See the authentication docs for full info.

   Properties:

    Config: env_auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENV_AUTH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-key

   Storage Account Shared Key.

   Leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator.

   Properties:

    Config: key

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-sas-url

   SAS URL for container level access only.

   Leave blank if using account/key or Emulator.

   Properties:

    Config: sas_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_SAS_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-tenant

   ID of the service principal's tenant.  Also called its directory ID.

   Set this if using - Service principal with client secret - Service principal with certificate - User with username and password

   Properties:

    Config: tenant

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_TENANT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-client-id

   The ID of the client in use.

   Set this if using - Service principal with client secret - Service principal with certificate - User with username and password

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-client-secret

   One of the service principal's client secrets

   Set this if using - Service principal with client secret

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-client-certificate-path

   Path to a PEM or PKCS12 certificate file including the private key.

   Set this if using - Service principal with certificate

   Properties:

    Config: client_certificate_path

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CLIENT_CERTIFICATE_PATH

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-client-certificate-password

   Password for the certificate file (optional).

   Optionally set this if using - Service principal with certificate

   And the certificate has a password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: client_certificate_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CLIENT_CERTIFICATE_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to azureblob (Microsoft Azure Blob Storage).

--azureblob-client-send-certificate-chain

   Send the certificate chain when using certificate auth.

   Specifies  whether an authentication request will include an x5c header to support subject name / issuer based authentication.  When set to true, authentica
   tion requests include the x5c header.

   Optionally set this if using - Service principal with certificate

   Properties:

    Config: client_send_certificate_chain

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CLIENT_SEND_CERTIFICATE_CHAIN

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-username

   User name (usually an email address)

   Set this if using - User with username and password

   Properties:

    Config: username

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USERNAME

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-password

   The user's password

   Set this if using - User with username and password

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-service-principal-file

   Path to file containing credentials for use with a service principal.

   Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want to use a service principal instead of interactive login.

          $ az ad sp create-for-rbac --name "<name>" \
            --role "Storage Blob Data Owner" \
            --scopes "/subscriptions/<subscription>/resourceGroups/<resource-group>/providers/Microsoft.Storage/storageAccounts/<storage-account>/blobServices/default/containers/<container>" \
            > azure-principal.json

   See "Create an Azure service principal" (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/cli/azure/create-an-azure-service-principal-azure-cli) and "Assign  an  Azure  role
   for access to blob data" (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/storage/common/storage-auth-aad-rbac-cli) pages for more details.

   It  may  be more convenient to put the credentials directly into the rclone config file under the client_id, tenant and client_secret keys instead of setting
   service_principal_file.

   Properties:

    Config: service_principal_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_SERVICE_PRINCIPAL_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-use-msi

   Use a managed service identity to authenticate (only works in Azure).

   When true, use a managed service identity (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/active-directory/managed-identities-azure-resources/)  to  authenticate  to
   Azure Storage instead of a SAS token or account key.

   If the VM(SS) on which this program is running has a system-assigned identity, it will be used by default.  If the resource has no system-assigned but exact
   ly one user-assigned identity, the user-assigned identity will be used by default.  If the resource has multiple user-assigned identities,  the  identity  to
   use must be explicitly specified using exactly one of the msi_object_id, msi_client_id, or msi_mi_res_id parameters.

   Properties:

    Config: use_msi

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USE_MSI

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-msi-object-id

   Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any.

   Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.

   Properties:

    Config: msi_object_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_OBJECT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-msi-client-id

   Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any.

   Leave blank if msi_object_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.

   Properties:

    Config: msi_client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-msi-mi-res-id

   Azure resource ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any.

   Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_object_id specified.

   Properties:

    Config: msi_mi_res_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_MI_RES_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-use-emulator

   Uses local storage emulator if provided as 'true'.

   Leave blank if using real azure storage endpoint.

   Properties:

    Config: use_emulator

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USE_EMULATOR

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-endpoint

   Endpoint for the service.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (<= 256 MiB) (deprecated).

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-chunk-size

   Upload chunk size.

   Note that this is stored in memory and there may be up to "--transfers" * "--azureblob-upload-concurrency" chunks stored at once in memory.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 4Mi

--azureblob-upload-concurrency

   Concurrency for multipart uploads.

   This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

   If  you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing this may help
   to speed up the transfers.

   In tests, upload speed increases almost linearly with upload concurrency.  For example to fill a gigabit pipe it may be necessary to raise this to 64.   Note
   that this will use more memory.

   Note that chunks are stored in memory and there may be up to "--transfers" * "--azureblob-upload-concurrency" chunks stored at once in memory.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 16

--azureblob-list-chunk

   Size of blob list.

   This  sets the number of blobs requested in each listing chunk.  Default is the maximum, 5000.  "List blobs" requests are permitted 2 minutes per megabyte to
   complete.  If an operation is  taking  longer  than  2  minutes  per  megabyte  on  average,  it  will  time  out  (  source  (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-
   us/rest/api/storageservices/setting-timeouts-for-blob-service-operations#exceptions-to-default-timeout-interval)  ).  This can be used to limit the number of
   blobs items to return, to avoid the time out.

   Properties:

    Config: list_chunk

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_LIST_CHUNK

    Type: int

    Default: 5000

--azureblob-access-tier

   Access tier of blob: hot, cool or archive.

   Archived blobs can be restored by setting access tier to hot or cool.  Leave blank if you intend to use default access tier, which is set at account level

   If there is no "access tier" specified, rclone doesn't apply any tier.  rclone performs "Set Tier" operation on blobs while uploading,  if  objects  are  not
   modified, specifying "access tier" to new one will have no effect.  If blobs are in "archive tier" at remote, trying to perform data transfer operations from
   remote will not be allowed.  User should first restore by tiering blob to "Hot" or "Cool".

   Properties:

    Config: access_tier

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ACCESS_TIER

    Type: string

    Required: false

--azureblob-archive-tier-delete

   Delete archive tier blobs before overwriting.

   Archive tier blobs cannot be updated.  So without this flag, if you attempt to update an archive tier blob, then rclone will produce the error:

          can't update archive tier blob without --azureblob-archive-tier-delete

   With this flag set then before rclone attempts to overwrite an archive tier blob, it will delete the existing blob before uploading  its  replacement.   This
   has  the  potential  for  data loss if the upload fails (unlike updating a normal blob) and also may cost more since deleting archive tier blobs early may be
   chargable.

   Properties:

    Config: archive_tier_delete

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ARCHIVE_TIER_DELETE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-disable-checksum

   Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

   Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for  data  integ
   rity checking but can cause long delays for large files to start uploading.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_checksum

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-memory-pool-flush-time

   How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.

   Uploads  which  requires  additional buffers (f.e multipart) will use memory pool for allocations.  This option controls how often unused buffers will be re
   moved from the pool.

   Properties:

    Config: memory_pool_flush_time

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--azureblob-memory-pool-use-mmap

   Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

   Properties:

    Config: memory_pool_use_mmap

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8

--azureblob-public-access

   Public access level of a container: blob or container.

   Properties:

    Config: public_access

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_PUBLIC_ACCESS

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        The container and its blobs can be accessed only with an authorized request.

        It's a default value.

      "blob"

        Blob data within this container can be read via anonymous request.

      "container"

        Allow full public read access for container and blob data.

--azureblob-no-check-container

   If set, don't attempt to check the container exists or create it.

   This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does if you know the container exists already.

   Properties:

    Config: no_check_container

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_NO_CHECK_CONTAINER

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--azureblob-no-head-object

   If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects.

   Properties:

    Config: no_head_object

    Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_NO_HEAD_OBJECT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Custom upload headers

   You can set custom upload headers with the --header-upload flag.

    Cache-Control

    Content-Disposition

    Content-Encoding

    Content-Language

    Content-Type

   Eg --header-upload "Content-Type: text/potato"

Limitations

   MD5 sums are only uploaded with chunked files if the source has an MD5 sum.  This will always be the case for a local to azure copy.

   rclone about is not supported by the Microsoft Azure Blob storage backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone  mount
   or use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Azure Storage Emulator Support

   You can run rclone with the storage emulator (usually azurite).

   To do this, just set up a new remote with rclone config following the instructions in the introduction and set use_emulator in the advanced settings as true.
   You  do  not need to provide a default account name nor an account key.  But you can override them in the account and key options.  (Prior to v1.61 they were
   hard coded to azurite's devstoreaccount1.)

   Also, if you want to access a storage emulator instance running on a different machine, you can override the endpoint parameter  in  the  advanced  settings,
   setting it to http(s)://<host>:<port>/devstoreaccount1 (e.g.  http://10.254.2.5:10000/devstoreaccount1).

Microsoft OneDrive

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for OneDrive involves getting a token from Microsoft which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Microsoft OneDrive
             \ "onedrive"
          [snip]
          Storage> onedrive
          Microsoft App Client Id
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          client_id>
          Microsoft App Client Secret
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          client_secret>
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
           1 / OneDrive Personal or Business
             \ "onedrive"
           2 / Sharepoint site
             \ "sharepoint"
           3 / Type in driveID
             \ "driveid"
           4 / Type in SiteID
             \ "siteid"
           5 / Search a Sharepoint site
             \ "search"
          Your choice> 1
          Found 1 drives, please select the one you want to use:
          0: OneDrive (business) id=b!Eqwertyuiopasdfghjklzxcvbnm-7mnbvcxzlkjhgfdsapoiuytrewqk
          Chose drive to use:> 0
          Found drive 'root' of type 'business', URL: https://org-my.sharepoint.com/personal/you/Documents
          Is that okay?
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = onedrive
          token = {"access_token":"youraccesstoken","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"yourrefreshtoken","expiry":"2018-08-26T22:39:52.486512262+08:00"}
          drive_id = b!Eqwertyuiopasdfghjklzxcvbnm-7mnbvcxzlkjhgfdsapoiuytrewqk
          drive_type = business
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Microsoft.  This only runs from the moment it opens your brows
   er to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it  temporarily  if  you  are
   running a host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your OneDrive

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your OneDrive

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an OneDrive directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Getting your own Client ID and Key

   rclone  uses a default Client ID when talking to OneDrive, unless a custom client_id is specified in the config.  The default Client ID and Key are shared by
   all rclone users when performing requests.

   You may choose to create and use your own Client ID, in case the default one does not work well for you.  For example, you might see throttling.

Creating Client ID for OneDrive Personal

   To create your own Client ID, please follow these steps:

   1. Open https://portal.azure.com/#blade/Microsoft_AAD_RegisteredApps/ApplicationsListBlade and then click New registration.

   2. Enter a name for your app, choose account type Accounts in any organizational directory (Any Azure AD directory - Multitenant) and personal Microsoft  ac
      counts  (e.g.  Skype,  Xbox), select Web in Redirect URI, then type (do not copy and paste) http://localhost:53682/ and click Register.  Copy and keep the
      Application (client) ID under the app name for later use.

   3. Under manage select Certificates & secrets, click New client secret.  Enter a description (can be anything) and set Expires to 24 months.  Copy  and  keep
      that secret Value for later use (you won't be able to see this value afterwards).

   4. Under manage select API permissions, click Add a permission and select Microsoft Graph then select delegated permissions.

   5. Search   and   select  the  following  permissions:  Files.Read,  Files.ReadWrite,  Files.Read.All,  Files.ReadWrite.All,  offline_access,  User.Read  and
      Sites.Read.All (if custom access scopes are configured, select the permissions accordingly).  Once selected click Add permissions at the bottom.

   Now the application is complete.  Run rclone config to create or edit a OneDrive remote.  Supply the app ID and password as Client ID and Secret, respective
   ly.  rclone will walk you through the remaining steps.

   The  access_scopes  option  allows  you to configure the permissions requested by rclone.  See Microsoft Docs (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/graph/permis
   sions-reference#files-permissions) for more information about the different scopes.

   The Sites.Read.All permission is required if you need to search SharePoint sites when configuring  the  remote  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/pull/5883).
   However,  if that permission is not assigned, you need to exclude Sites.Read.All from your access scopes or set disable_site_permission option to true in the
   advanced options.

Creating Client ID for OneDrive Business

   The steps for OneDrive Personal may or may not work for OneDrive Business, depending on the security settings of the organization.  A common  error  is  that
   the publisher of the App is not verified.

   You  may try to verify you account (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/active-directory/develop/publisher-verification-overview), or try to limit the App
   to your organization only, as shown below.

   1. Make sure to create the App with your business account.

   2. Follow the steps above to create an App.  However, we need a different account type here: Accounts in this organizational directory  only  (***  -  Single
      tenant).  Note that you can also change the account type after creating the App.

   3. Find the tenant ID (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/active-directory/fundamentals/active-directory-how-to-find-tenant) of your organization.

   4. In the rclone config, set auth_url to https://login.microsoftonline.com/YOUR_TENANT_ID/oauth2/v2.0/authorize.

   5. In the rclone config, set token_url to https://login.microsoftonline.com/YOUR_TENANT_ID/oauth2/v2.0/token.

   Note:    If    you    have    a    special    region,    you    may    need    a    different    host   in   step   4   and   5.    Here   are   some   hints
   (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/bc23bf11db1c78c6ebbf8ea538fbebf7058b4176/backend/onedrive/onedrive.go#L86).

Modification time and hashes

   OneDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

   OneDrive Personal, OneDrive for Business and Sharepoint Server support QuickXorHash (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/onedrive/developer/code-snippets/quick
   xorhash).

   Before rclone 1.62 the default hash for Onedrive Personal was SHA1.  For rclone 1.62 and above the default for all Onedrive backends is QuickXorHash.

   Starting  from  July  2023  SHA1  support is being phased out in Onedrive Personal in favour of QuickXorHash.  If necessary the --onedrive-hash-type flag (or
   hash_type config option) can be used to select SHA1 during the transition period if this is important your workflow.

   For all types of OneDrive you can use the --checksum flag.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   "           0x22        
   *           0x2A        
   :           0x3A        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        
   ?           0x3F        
   \           0x5C        
   |           0x7C        

   File names can also not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         
   .           0x2E        

   File names can also not begin with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the first character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         
   ~           0x7E        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Deleting files

   Any files you delete with rclone will end up in the trash.  Microsoft doesn't provide an API to permanently delete files, nor to empty the trash, so you will
   have to do that with one of Microsoft's apps or via the OneDrive website.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to onedrive (Microsoft OneDrive).

--onedrive-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-region

   Choose national cloud region for OneDrive.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_REGION

    Type: string

    Default: "global"

    Examples:

      "global"

        Microsoft Cloud Global

      "us"

        Microsoft Cloud for US Government

      "de"

        Microsoft Cloud Germany

      "cn"

        Azure and Office 365 operated by Vnet Group in China

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to onedrive (Microsoft OneDrive).

--onedrive-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-chunk-size

   Chunk size to upload files with - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes).

   Above  this  size files will be chunked - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes) and should not exceed 250M (262,144,000 bytes) else you may encounter "Mi‐
   crosoft.SharePoint.Client.InvalidClientQueryException: The request message is too big." Note that the chunks will be buffered into memory.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 10Mi

--onedrive-drive-id

   The ID of the drive to use.

   Properties:

    Config: drive_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DRIVE_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-drive-type

   The type of the drive (personal | business | documentLibrary).

   Properties:

    Config: drive_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DRIVE_TYPE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-root-folder-id

   ID of the root folder.

   This isn't normally needed, but in special circumstances you might know the folder ID that you wish to access but not be able to get  there  through  a  path
   traversal.

   Properties:

    Config: root_folder_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-access-scopes

   Set scopes to be requested by rclone.

   Choose or manually enter a custom space separated list with all scopes, that rclone should request.

   Properties:

    Config: access_scopes

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ACCESS_SCOPES

    Type: SpaceSepList

    Default: Files.Read Files.ReadWrite Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All Sites.Read.All offline_access

    Examples:

      "Files.Read Files.ReadWrite Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All Sites.Read.All offline_access"

        Read and write access to all resources

      "Files.Read Files.Read.All Sites.Read.All offline_access"

        Read only access to all resources

      "Files.Read Files.ReadWrite Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All offline_access"

        Read and write access to all resources, without the ability to browse SharePoint sites.

        Same as if disable_site_permission was set to true

--onedrive-disable-site-permission

   Disable the request for Sites.Read.All permission.

   If  set to true, you will no longer be able to search for a SharePoint site when configuring drive ID, because rclone will not request Sites.Read.All permis
   sion.  Set it to true if your organization didn't assign Sites.Read.All permission to the application, and your organization disallows users to  consent  app
   permission request on their own.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_site_permission

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DISABLE_SITE_PERMISSION

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--onedrive-expose-onenote-files

   Set to make OneNote files show up in directory listings.

   By default, rclone will hide OneNote files in directory listings because operations like "Open" and "Update" won't work on them.  But this behaviour may also
   prevent you from deleting them.  If you want to delete OneNote files or otherwise want them to show up in directory listing, set this option.

   Properties:

    Config: expose_onenote_files

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_EXPOSE_ONENOTE_FILES

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--onedrive-server-side-across-configs

   Allow server-side operations (e.g.  copy) to work across different onedrive configs.

   This will only work if you are copying between two OneDrive Personal drives AND the files to copy are already shared between them.  In  other  cases,  rclone
   will fall back to normal copy (which will be slightly slower).

   Properties:

    Config: server_side_across_configs

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--onedrive-list-chunk

   Size of listing chunk.

   Properties:

    Config: list_chunk

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LIST_CHUNK

    Type: int

    Default: 1000

--onedrive-no-versions

   Remove all versions on modifying operations.

   Onedrive for business creates versions when rclone uploads new files overwriting an existing one and when it sets the modification time.

   These versions take up space out of the quota.

   This flag checks for versions after file upload and setting modification time and removes all but the last version.

   NB Onedrive personal can't currently delete versions so don't use this flag there.

   Properties:

    Config: no_versions

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_NO_VERSIONS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--onedrive-link-scope

   Set the scope of the links created by the link command.

   Properties:

    Config: link_scope

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_SCOPE

    Type: string

    Default: "anonymous"

    Examples:

      "anonymous"

        Anyone with the link has access, without needing to sign in.

        This may include people outside of your organization.

        Anonymous link support may be disabled by an administrator.

      "organization"

        Anyone signed into your organization (tenant) can use the link to get access.

        Only available in OneDrive for Business and SharePoint.

--onedrive-link-type

   Set the type of the links created by the link command.

   Properties:

    Config: link_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_TYPE

    Type: string

    Default: "view"

    Examples:

      "view"

        Creates a read-only link to the item.

      "edit"

        Creates a read-write link to the item.

      "embed"

        Creates an embeddable link to the item.

--onedrive-link-password

   Set the password for links created by the link command.

   At the time of writing this only works with OneDrive personal paid accounts.

   Properties:

    Config: link_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

--onedrive-hash-type

   Specify the hash in use for the backend.

   This specifies the hash type in use.  If set to "auto" it will use the default hash which is is QuickXorHash.

   Before  rclone  1.62 an SHA1 hash was used by default for Onedrive Personal.  For 1.62 and later the default is to use a QuickXorHash for all onedrive types.
   If an SHA1 hash is desired then set this option accordingly.

   From July 2023 QuickXorHash will be the only available hash for both OneDrive for Business and OneDriver Personal.

   This can be set to "none" to not use any hashes.

   If the hash requested does not exist on the object, it will be returned as an empty string which is treated as a missing hash by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: hash_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_HASH_TYPE

    Type: string

    Default: "auto"

    Examples:

      "auto"

        Rclone chooses the best hash

      "quickxor"

        QuickXor

      "sha1"

        SHA1

      "sha256"

        SHA256

      "crc32"

        CRC32

      "none"

        None - don't use any hashes

--onedrive-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   If you don't use rclone for 90 days the refresh token will expire.  This will result in authorization problems.  This is easy to fix by  running  the  rclone
   config reconnect remote: command to get a new token and refresh token.

Naming

   Note that OneDrive is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   There are quite a few characters that can't be in OneDrive file names.  These can't occur on Windows platforms, but on non-Windows platforms they are common.
   Rclone will map these names to and from an identical looking unicode equivalent.  For example if a file has a ? in it will be mapped to  instead.

File sizes

   The largest allowed file size is 250 GiB for both OneDrive Personal and OneDrive for Business (Updated 13 Jan 2021)  (https://support.microsoft.com/en-us/of
   fice/invalid-file-names-and-file-types-in-onedrive-and-sharepoint-64883a5d-228e-48f5-b3d2-eb39e07630fa?ui=en-us&rs=en-us&ad=us#individualfilesize).

Path length

   The  entire  path, including the file name, must contain fewer than 400 characters for OneDrive, OneDrive for Business and SharePoint Online.  If you are en
   crypting file and folder names with rclone, you may want to pay attention to this limitation because the encrypted names are typically longer than the origi
   nal ones.

Number of files

   OneDrive  seems  to  be  OK with at least 50,000 files in a folder, but at 100,000 rclone will get errors listing the directory like couldnt list files: Un
   knownError:.  See #2707 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2707) for more info.

   An official document about the limitations for different types of OneDrive can be  found  here  (https://support.office.com/en-us/article/invalid-file-names-
   and-file-types-in-onedrive-onedrive-for-business-and-sharepoint-64883a5d-228e-48f5-b3d2-eb39e07630fa).

Versions

   Every change in a file OneDrive causes the service to create a new version of the file.  This counts against a users quota.  For example changing the modifi
   cation time of a file creates a second version, so the file apparently uses twice the space.

   For example the copy command is affected by this as rclone copies the file and then afterwards sets the modification time to match the source file which uses
   another version.

   You can use the rclone cleanup command (see below) to remove all old versions.

   Or  you  can set the no_versions parameter to true and rclone will remove versions after operations which create new versions.  This takes extra transactions
   so only enable it if you need it.

   Note At the time of writing Onedrive Personal creates versions (but not for setting the modification time) but the API for removing  them  returns  "API  not
   found" so cleanup and no_versions should not be used on Onedrive Personal.

Disabling versioning

   Starting  October 2018, users will no longer be able to disable versioning by default.  This is because Microsoft has brought an update (https://techcommuni
   ty.microsoft.com/t5/Microsoft-OneDrive-Blog/New-Updates-to-OneDrive-and-SharePoint-Team-Site-Versioning/ba-p/204390) to the mechanism.  To  change  this  new
   default  setting,  a PowerShell command is required to be run by a SharePoint admin.  If you are an admin, you can run these commands in PowerShell to change
   that setting:

   1. Install-Module -Name Microsoft.Online.SharePoint.PowerShell (in case you haven't installed this already)

   2. Import-Module Microsoft.Online.SharePoint.PowerShell -DisableNameChecking

   3. Connect-SPOService -Url https://YOURSITE-admin.sharepoint.com -Credential YOU@YOURSITE.COM (replacing YOURSITE, YOU, YOURSITE.COM with the actual  values;
      this will prompt for your credentials)

   4. Set-SPOTenant -EnableMinimumVersionRequirement $False

   5. Disconnect-SPOService (to disconnect from the server)

   Below are the steps for normal users to disable versioning.  If you don't see the "No Versioning" option, make sure the above requirements are met.

   User Weropol (https://github.com/Weropol) has found a method to disable versioning on OneDrive

   1. Open the settings menu by clicking on the gear symbol at the top of the OneDrive Business page.

   2. Click Site settings.

   3. Once on the Site settings page, navigate to Site Administration > Site libraries and lists.

   4. Click Customize "Documents".

   5. Click General Settings > Versioning Settings.

   6. Under Document Version History select the option No versioning.  Note: This will disable the creation of new file versions, but will not remove any previ
      ous versions.  Your documents are safe.

   7. Apply the changes by clicking OK.

   8. Use rclone to upload or modify files.  (I also use the --no-update-modtime flag)

   9. Restore the versioning settings after using rclone.  (Optional)

Cleanup

   OneDrive supports rclone cleanup which causes rclone to look through every file under the path supplied and delete all version but the current version.   Be
   cause this involves traversing all the files, then querying each file for versions it can be quite slow.  Rclone does --checkers tests in parallel.  The com
   mand also supports --interactive/i or --dry-run which is a great way to see what it would do.

          rclone cleanup --interactive remote:path/subdir # interactively remove all old version for path/subdir
          rclone cleanup remote:path/subdir               # unconditionally remove all old version for path/subdir

   NB Onedrive personal can't currently delete versions

Troubleshooting Excessive throttling or blocked on SharePoint

   If you experience excessive throttling or is being blocked on SharePoint then it may help to set the user agent explicitly with a  flag  like  this:  --user-
   agent "ISV|rclone.org|rclone/v1.55.1"

   The specific details can be found in the Microsoft document: Avoid getting throttled or blocked in SharePoint Online (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/share
   point/dev/general-development/how-to-avoid-getting-throttled-or-blocked-in-sharepoint-online#how-to-decorate-your-http-traffic-to-avoid-throttling)

Unexpected file size/hash differences on Sharepoint

   It is a known (https://github.com/OneDrive/onedrive-api-docs/issues/935#issuecomment-441741631) issue that Sharepoint (not OneDrive or OneDrive for Business)
   silently  modifies uploaded files, mainly Office files (.docx, .xlsx, etc.), causing file size and hash checks to fail.  There are also other situations that
   will cause OneDrive to report inconsistent file sizes.  To use rclone with such affected files on Sharepoint, you may disable these checks with the following
   command line arguments:

          --ignore-checksum --ignore-size

   Alternatively, if you have write access to the OneDrive files, it may be possible to fix this problem for certain files, by attempting the steps below.  Open
   the web interface for OneDrive (https://onedrive.live.com) and find the affected files (which will be in the error messages/log for rclone).  Simply click on
   each  of  these files, causing OneDrive to open them on the web.  This will cause each file to be converted in place to a format that is functionally equiva
   lent but which will no longer trigger the size discrepancy.  Once all problematic files are converted you will no longer need the ignore options above.

Replacing/deleting existing files on Sharepoint gets "item not found"

   It is a known (https://github.com/OneDrive/onedrive-api-docs/issues/1068) issue that Sharepoint (not OneDrive or OneDrive for Business) may return "item  not
   found" errors when users try to replace or delete uploaded files; this seems to mainly affect Office files (.docx, .xlsx, etc.)  and web files (.html, .aspx,
   etc.).  As a workaround, you may use the --backup-dir <BACKUP_DIR> command line argument so rclone moves the files to be replaced/deleted into a given backup
   directory  (instead  of directly replacing/deleting them).  For example, to instruct rclone to move the files into the directory rclone-backup-dir on backend
   mysharepoint, you may use:

          --backup-dir mysharepoint:rclone-backup-dir

access_denied (AADSTS65005)

          Error: access_denied
          Code: AADSTS65005
          Description: Using application 'rclone' is currently not supported for your organization [YOUR_ORGANIZATION] because it is in an unmanaged state. An administrator needs to claim ownership of the company by DNS validation of [YOUR_ORGANIZATION] before the application rclone can be provisioned.

   This means that rclone can't use the OneDrive for Business API with your account.  You can't do much about it, maybe write an email to your admins.

   However, there are other ways to interact with your OneDrive account.  Have a look at the WebDAV backend: https://rclone.org/webdav/#sharepoint

invalid_grant (AADSTS50076)

          Error: invalid_grant
          Code: AADSTS50076
          Description: Due to a configuration change made by your administrator, or because you moved to a new location, you must use multi-factor authentication to access '...'.

   If you see the error above after enabling multi-factor authentication for your account, you can fix it by refreshing your OAuth refresh token.  To  do  that,
   run rclone config, and choose to edit your OneDrive backend.  Then, you don't need to actually make any changes until you reach this question: Already have a
   token - refresh?.  For this question, answer y and go through the process to refresh your token, just like the first time the backend is  configured.   After
   this, rclone should work again for this backend.

Invalid request when making public links

   On  Sharepoint  and  OneDrive  for Business, rclone link may return an "Invalid request" error.  A possible cause is that the organisation admin didn't allow
   public links to be made for the organisation/sharepoint library.  To fix the permissions as an admin,  take  a  look  at  the  docs:  1  (https://docs.micro
   soft.com/en-us/sharepoint/turn-external-sharing-on-or-off),             2            (https://support.microsoft.com/en-us/office/set-up-and-manage-access-re
   quests-94b26e0b-2822-49d4-929a-8455698654b3).

Can not access Shared with me files

   Shared with me files is not supported by rclone currently (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4062), but there is a workaround:

   1. Visit https://onedrive.live.com (https://onedrive.live.com/)

   2. Right click a  item  in  Shared,  then  click  Add  shortcut  to  My  files  in  the  context  [IMAGE:  make_shortcut  (https://user-images.githubusercon
      tent.com/60313789/206118040-7e762b3b-aa61-41a1-8649-cc18889f3572.png)]

   3. The   shortcut   will   appear   in   My   files,   you  can  access  it  with  rclone,  it  behaves  like  a  normal  folder/file.   [IMAGE:  in_my_files
      (https://i.imgur.com/0S8H3li.png)] [IMAGE: rclone_mount (https://i.imgur.com/2Iq66sW.png)]

Live Photos uploaded from iOS (small video clips in .heic files)

   The iOS OneDrive app introduced upload and storage (https://techcommunity.microsoft.com/t5/microsoft-onedrive-blog/live-photos-come-to-onedrive/ba-p/1953452)
   of  Live  Photos  (https://support.apple.com/en-gb/HT207310)  in  2020.  The usage and download of these uploaded Live Photos is unfortunately still work-in-
   progress and this introduces several issues when copying, synchronising and mounting  both in rclone and in the native OneDrive client on Windows.

   The root cause can easily be seen if you locate one of your Live Photos in the OneDrive web interface.  Then download the photo from the web interface.   You
   will then see that the size of downloaded .heic file is smaller than the size displayed in the web interface.  The downloaded file is smaller because it only
   contains a single frame (still photo) extracted from the Live Photo (movie) stored in OneDrive.

   The different sizes will cause rclone copy/sync to repeatedly recopy unmodified photos something like this:

          DEBUG : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: Sizes differ (src 4470314 vs dst 1298667)
          DEBUG : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: sha1 = fc2edde7863b7a7c93ca6771498ac797f8460750 OK
          INFO  : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: Copied (replaced existing)

   These recopies can be worked around by adding --ignore-size.  Please note that this workaround only syncs the still-picture not the movie clip, and relies on
   modification dates being correctly updated on all files in all situations.

   The different sizes will also cause rclone check to report size errors something like this:

          ERROR : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: sizes differ

   These check errors can be suppressed by adding --ignore-size.

   The different sizes will also cause rclone mount to fail downloading with an error something like this:

          ERROR : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: ReadFileHandle.Read error: low level retry 1/10: unexpected EOF

   or like this when using --cache-mode=full:

          INFO  : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: vfs cache: downloader: error count now 1: vfs reader: failed to write to cache file: 416 Requested Range Not Satisfiable:
          ERROR : 20230203_123826234_iOS.heic: vfs cache: failed to download: vfs reader: failed to write to cache file: 416 Requested Range Not Satisfiable:

OpenDrive

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / OpenDrive
             \ "opendrive"
          [snip]
          Storage> opendrive
          Username
          username>
          Password
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          --------------------
          [remote]
          username =
          password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   List directories in top level of your OpenDrive

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your OpenDrive

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an OpenDrive directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and MD5SUMs

   OpenDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

Restricted filename characters

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        
   "           0x22        
   *           0x2A        
   :           0x3A        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        

   ?           0x3F        
   \           0x5C        
   |           0x7C        

   File names can also not begin or end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         
   HT          0x09         
   LF          0x0A         
   VT          0x0B         
   CR          0x0D         

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to opendrive (OpenDrive).

--opendrive-username

   Username.

   Properties:

    Config: username

    Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_USERNAME

    Type: string

    Required: true

--opendrive-password

   Password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: true

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to opendrive (OpenDrive).

--opendrive-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,LeftSpace,LeftCrLfHtVt,RightSpace,RightCrLfHtVt,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--opendrive-chunk-size

   Files will be uploaded in chunks this size.

   Note that these chunks are buffered in memory so increasing them will increase memory use.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 10Mi

Limitations

   Note that OpenDrive is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   There  are  quite a few characters that can't be in OpenDrive file names.  These can't occur on Windows platforms, but on non-Windows platforms they are com
   mon.  Rclone will map these names to and from an identical looking unicode equivalent.  For example if a file has a ? in it will be mapped to  instead.

   rclone about is not supported by the OpenDrive backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use  policy  mfs
   (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Oracle Object Storage

   Oracle Object Storage Overview (https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/Object/Concepts/objectstorageoverview.htm)

   Oracle Object Storage FAQ (https://www.oracle.com/cloud/storage/object-storage/faq/)

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making an oracle object storage configuration.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n

          Enter name for new remote.
          name> remote

          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          [snip]
          XX / Oracle Cloud Infrastructure Object Storage
             \ (oracleobjectstorage)
          Storage> oracleobjectstorage

          Option provider.
          Choose your Auth Provider
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
          Press Enter for the default (env_auth).
           1 / automatically pickup the credentials from runtime(env), first one to provide auth wins
             \ (env_auth)
             / use an OCI user and an API key for authentication.
           2 | youll need to put in a config file your tenancy OCID, user OCID, region, the path, fingerprint to an API key.
             | https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/API/Concepts/sdkconfig.htm
             \ (user_principal_auth)
             / use instance principals to authorize an instance to make API calls.
           3 | each instance has its own identity, and authenticates using the certificates that are read from instance metadata.
             | https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/Identity/Tasks/callingservicesfrominstances.htm
             \ (instance_principal_auth)
           4 / use resource principals to make API calls
             \ (resource_principal_auth)
           5 / no credentials needed, this is typically for reading public buckets
             \ (no_auth)
          provider> 2

          Option namespace.
          Object storage namespace
          Enter a value.
          namespace> idbamagbg734

          Option compartment.
          Object storage compartment OCID
          Enter a value.
          compartment> ocid1.compartment.oc1..aaaaaaaapufkxc7ame3sthry5i7ujrwfc7ejnthhu6bhanm5oqfjpyasjkba

          Option region.
          Object storage Region
          Enter a value.
          region> us-ashburn-1

          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint for Object storage API.
          Leave blank to use the default endpoint for the region.
          Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
          endpoint>

          Option config_file.
          Full Path to OCI config file
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
          Press Enter for the default (~/.oci/config).
           1 / oci configuration file location
             \ (~/.oci/config)
          config_file> /etc/oci/dev.conf

          Option config_profile.
          Profile name inside OCI config file
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
          Press Enter for the default (Default).
           1 / Use the default profile
             \ (Default)
          config_profile> Test

          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n

          Configuration complete.
          Options:
          - type: oracleobjectstorage
          - namespace: idbamagbg734
          - compartment: ocid1.compartment.oc1..aaaaaaaapufkxc7ame3sthry5i7ujrwfc7ejnthhu6bhanm5oqfjpyasjkba
          - region: us-ashburn-1
          - provider: user_principal_auth
          - config_file: /etc/oci/dev.conf
          - config_profile: Test
          Keep this "remote" remote?
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See all buckets

          rclone lsd remote:

   Create a new bucket

          rclone mkdir remote:bucket

   List the contents of a bucket

          rclone ls remote:bucket
          rclone ls remote:bucket --max-depth 1

OCI Authentication Provider

   OCI has various authentication methods.  To learn more about authentication methods please  refer  oci  authentication  methods  (https://docs.oracle.com/en-
   us/iaas/Content/API/Concepts/sdk_authentication_methods.htm) These choices can be specified in the rclone config file.

   Rclone supports the following OCI authentication provider.

          User Principal
          Instance Principal
          Resource Principal
          No authentication

Authentication provider choice: User Principal

   Sample rclone config file for Authentication Provider User Principal:

          [oos]
          type = oracleobjectstorage
          namespace = id<redacted>34
          compartment = ocid1.compartment.oc1..aa<redacted>ba
          region = us-ashburn-1
          provider = user_principal_auth
          config_file = /home/opc/.oci/config
          config_profile = Default

   Advantages: - One can use this method from any server within OCI or on-premises or from other cloud provider.

   Considerations: - you need to configure users privileges / policy to allow access to object storage - Overhead of managing users and keys.  - If the user is
   deleted, the config file will no longer work and may cause automation regressions that use the user's credentials.

Authentication provider choice: Instance Principal

   An OCI compute instance can be authorized to use rclone by using it's identity and certificates as an instance principal.  With this approach no  credentials
   have to be stored and managed.

   Sample rclone configuration file for Authentication Provider Instance Principal:

          [opc@rclone ~]$ cat ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf
          [oos]
          type = oracleobjectstorage
          namespace = id<redacted>fn
          compartment = ocid1.compartment.oc1..aa<redacted>k7a
          region = us-ashburn-1
          provider = instance_principal_auth

   Advantages:

   • With instance principals, you don't need to configure user credentials and transfer/ save it to disk in your compute instances or rotate the credentials.

    You dont need to deal with users and keys.

    Greatly helps in automation as you don't have to manage access keys, user private keys, storing them in vault, using kms etc.

   Considerations:

    You need to configure a dynamic group having this instance as member and add policy to read object storage to that dynamic group.

    Everyone who has access to this machine can execute the CLI commands.

    It is applicable for oci compute instances only.  It cannot be used on external instance or resources.

Authentication provider choice: Resource Principal

   Resource  principal  auth  is  very  similar  to  instance  principal auth but used for resources that are not compute instances such as serverless functions
   (https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/Functions/Concepts/functionsoverview.htm).  To use resource principal ensure Rclone process is started with these
   environment variables set in its process.

          export OCI_RESOURCE_PRINCIPAL_VERSION=2.2
          export OCI_RESOURCE_PRINCIPAL_REGION=us-ashburn-1
          export OCI_RESOURCE_PRINCIPAL_PRIVATE_PEM=/usr/share/model-server/key.pem
          export OCI_RESOURCE_PRINCIPAL_RPST=/usr/share/model-server/security_token

   Sample rclone configuration file for Authentication Provider Resource Principal:

          [oos]
          type = oracleobjectstorage
          namespace = id<redacted>34
          compartment = ocid1.compartment.oc1..aa<redacted>ba
          region = us-ashburn-1
          provider = resource_principal_auth

Authentication provider choice: No authentication

   Public buckets do not require any authentication mechanism to read objects.  Sample rclone configuration file for No authentication:

          [oos]
          type = oracleobjectstorage
          namespace = id<redacted>34
          compartment = ocid1.compartment.oc1..aa<redacted>ba
          region = us-ashburn-1
          provider = no_auth

Options Modified time

   The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as opc-meta-mtime as floating point since the epoch, accurate to 1 ns.

   If  the  modification  time needs to be updated rclone will attempt to perform a server side copy to update the modification if the object can be copied in a
   single part.  In the case the object is larger than 5Gb, the object will be uploaded rather than copied.

   Note that reading this from the object takes an additional HEAD request as the metadata isn't returned in object listings.

Multipart uploads

   rclone supports multipart uploads with OOS which means that it can upload files bigger than 5 GiB.

   Note that files uploaded both with multipart upload and through crypt remotes do not have MD5 sums.

   rclone switches from single part uploads to multipart uploads at the point specified by --oos-upload-cutoff.  This can be a maximum of 5 GiB and a minimum of
   0 (ie always upload multipart files).

   The  chunk  sizes used in the multipart upload are specified by --oos-chunk-size and the number of chunks uploaded concurrently is specified by --oos-upload-
   concurrency.

   Multipart uploads will use --transfers * --oos-upload-concurrency * --oos-chunk-size extra memory.  Single part uploads to not use extra memory.

   Single part transfers can be faster than multipart transfers or slower depending on your latency from oos - the more latency, the  more  likely  single  part
   transfers will be faster.

   Increasing  --oos-upload-concurrency  will  increase  throughput (8 would be a sensible value) and increasing --oos-chunk-size also increases throughput (16M
   would be sensible).  Increasing either of these will use more memory.  The default values are high enough to gain most of the  possible  performance  without
   using too much memory.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to oracleobjectstorage (Oracle Cloud Infrastructure Object Storage).

--oos-provider

   Choose your Auth Provider

   Properties:

    Config: provider

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_PROVIDER

    Type: string

    Default: "env_auth"

    Examples:

      "env_auth"

        automatically pickup the credentials from runtime(env), first one to provide auth wins

      "user_principal_auth"

        use an OCI user and an API key for authentication.

        youll need to put in a config file your tenancy OCID, user OCID, region, the path, fingerprint to an API key.

        https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/API/Concepts/sdkconfig.htm

      "instance_principal_auth"

        use instance principals to authorize an instance to make API calls.

        each instance has its own identity, and authenticates using the certificates that are read from instance metadata.

        https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/Identity/Tasks/callingservicesfrominstances.htm

      "resource_principal_auth"

        use resource principals to make API calls

      "no_auth"

        no credentials needed, this is typically for reading public buckets

--oos-namespace

   Object storage namespace

   Properties:

    Config: namespace

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_NAMESPACE

    Type: string

    Required: true

--oos-compartment

   Object storage compartment OCID

   Properties:

    Config: compartment

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_COMPARTMENT

    Provider: !no_auth

    Type: string

    Required: true

--oos-region

   Object storage Region

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_REGION

    Type: string

    Required: true

--oos-endpoint

   Endpoint for Object storage API.

   Leave blank to use the default endpoint for the region.

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--oos-config-file

   Path to OCI config file

   Properties:

    Config: config_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_CONFIG_FILE

    Provider: user_principal_auth

    Type: string

    Default: "~/.oci/config"

    Examples:

      "~/.oci/config"

        oci configuration file location

--oos-config-profile

   Profile name inside the oci config file

   Properties:

    Config: config_profile

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_CONFIG_PROFILE

    Provider: user_principal_auth

    Type: string

    Default: "Default"

    Examples:

      "Default"

        Use the default profile

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to oracleobjectstorage (Oracle Cloud Infrastructure Object Storage).

--oos-storage-tier

   The storage class to use when storing new objects in storage.  https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/Object/Concepts/understandingstoragetiers.htm

   Properties:

    Config: storage_tier

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_STORAGE_TIER

    Type: string

    Default: "Standard"

    Examples:

      "Standard"

        Standard storage tier, this is the default tier

      "InfrequentAccess"

        InfrequentAccess storage tier

      "Archive"

        Archive storage tier

--oos-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

   Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.  The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 200Mi

--oos-chunk-size

   Chunk size to use for uploading.

   When  uploading  files  larger  than  upload_cutoff  or files with unknown size (e.g.  from "rclone rcat" or uploaded with "rclone mount" or google photos or
   google docs) they will be uploaded as multipart uploads using this chunk size.

   Note that "upload_concurrency" chunks of this size are buffered in memory per transfer.

   If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have enough memory, then increasing this will speed up the transfers.

   Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a large file of known size to stay below the 10,000 chunks limit.

   Files of unknown size are uploaded with the configured chunk_size.  Since the default chunk size is 5 MiB and there can be at most 10,000 chunks, this  means
   that  by  default  the  maximum  size  of  a  file you can stream upload is 48 GiB.  If you wish to stream upload larger files then you will need to increase
   chunk_size.

   Increasing the chunk size decreases the accuracy of the progress statistics displayed with "-P" flag.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 5Mi

--oos-upload-concurrency

   Concurrency for multipart uploads.

   This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

   If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing this may  help
   to speed up the transfers.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 10

--oos-copy-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to multipart copy.

   Any files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be copied in chunks of this size.

   The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

   Properties:

    Config: copy_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_COPY_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 4.656Gi

--oos-copy-timeout

   Timeout for copy.

   Copy is an asynchronous operation, specify timeout to wait for copy to succeed

   Properties:

    Config: copy_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_COPY_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--oos-disable-checksum

   Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

   Normally  rclone  will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for data integ
   rity checking but can cause long delays for large files to start uploading.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_checksum

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--oos-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--oos-leave-parts-on-error

   If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery.

   It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

   WARNING: Storing parts of an incomplete multipart upload counts towards space usage on object storage and will add additional costs if not cleaned up.

   Properties:

    Config: leave_parts_on_error

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--oos-no-check-bucket

   If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it.

   This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does if you know the bucket exists already.

   It can also be needed if the user you are using does not have bucket creation permissions.

   Properties:

    Config: no_check_bucket

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_NO_CHECK_BUCKET

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--oos-sse-customer-key-file

   To use SSE-C, a file containing the base64-encoded string of the AES-256 encryption key associated with  the  object.   Please  note  only  one  of  sse_cus
   tomer_key_file|sse_customer_key|sse_kms_key_id is needed.'

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_key_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--oos-sse-customer-key

   To  use  SSE-C,  the optional header that specifies the base64-encoded 256-bit encryption key to use to encrypt or decrypt the data.  Please note only one of
   sse_customer_key_file|sse_customer_key|sse_kms_key_id  is  needed.   For  more  information,  see  Using   Your   Own   Keys   for   Server-Side   Encryption
   (https://docs.cloud.oracle.com/Content/Object/Tasks/usingyourencryptionkeys.htm)

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--oos-sse-customer-key-sha256

   If  using  SSE-C,  The optional header that specifies the base64-encoded SHA256 hash of the encryption key.  This value is used to check the integrity of the
   encryption key.  see Using Your Own Keys for Server-Side Encryption (https://docs.cloud.oracle.com/Content/Object/Tasks/usingyourencryptionkeys.htm).

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_key_sha256

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_SHA256

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--oos-sse-kms-key-id

   if using using your own master key in vault, this header specifies the  OCID  (https://docs.cloud.oracle.com/Content/General/Concepts/identifiers.htm)  of  a
   master  encryption key used to call the Key Management service to generate a data encryption key or to encrypt or decrypt a data encryption key.  Please note
   only one of sse_customer_key_file|sse_customer_key|sse_kms_key_id is needed.

   Properties:

    Config: sse_kms_key_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_SSE_KMS_KEY_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

--oos-sse-customer-algorithm

   If using SSE-C, the optional header that specifies "AES256" as the encryption algorithm.  Object Storage supports "AES256" as the encryption algorithm.   For
   more information, see Using Your Own Keys for Server-Side Encryption (https://docs.cloud.oracle.com/Content/Object/Tasks/usingyourencryptionkeys.htm).

   Properties:

    Config: sse_customer_algorithm

    Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_SSE_CUSTOMER_ALGORITHM

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        None

      "AES256"

        AES256

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the oracleobjectstorage backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

rename

   change the name of an object

          rclone backend rename remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command can be used to rename a object.

   Usage Examples:

          rclone backend rename oos:bucket relative-object-path-under-bucket object-new-name

list-multipart-uploads

   List the unfinished multipart uploads

          rclone backend list-multipart-uploads remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command lists the unfinished multipart uploads in JSON format.

          rclone backend list-multipart-uploads oos:bucket/path/to/object

   It returns a dictionary of buckets with values as lists of unfinished multipart uploads.

   You can call it with no bucket in which case it lists all bucket, with a bucket or with a bucket and path.

          {
            "test-bucket": [
                      {
                              "namespace": "test-namespace",
                              "bucket": "test-bucket",
                              "object": "600m.bin",
                              "uploadId": "51dd8114-52a4-b2f2-c42f-5291f05eb3c8",
                              "timeCreated": "2022-07-29T06:21:16.595Z",
                              "storageTier": "Standard"
                      }
              ]

cleanup

   Remove unfinished multipart uploads.

          rclone backend cleanup remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This command removes unfinished multipart uploads of age greater than max-age which defaults to 24 hours.

   Note that you can use --interactive/-i or --dry-run with this command to see what it would do.

          rclone backend cleanup oos:bucket/path/to/object
          rclone backend cleanup -o max-age=7w oos:bucket/path/to/object

   Durations are parsed as per the rest of rclone, 2h, 7d, 7w etc.

   Options:

    "max-age": Max age of upload to delete

QingStor

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making an QingStor configuration.  First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/r/c/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / QingStor Object Storage
             \ "qingstor"
          [snip]
          Storage> qingstor
          Get QingStor credentials from runtime. Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter QingStor credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get QingStor credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          QingStor Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          access_key_id> access_key
          QingStor Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          secret_access_key> secret_key
          Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.
          Leave blank will use the default value "https://qingstor.com:443"
          endpoint>
          Zone connect to. Default is "pek3a".
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
             / The Beijing (China) Three Zone
           1 | Needs location constraint pek3a.
             \ "pek3a"
             / The Shanghai (China) First Zone
           2 | Needs location constraint sh1a.
             \ "sh1a"
          zone> 1
          Number of connection retry.
          Leave blank will use the default value "3".
          connection_retries>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = access_key
          secret_access_key = secret_key
          endpoint =
          zone = pek3a
          connection_retries =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all buckets

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new bucket

          rclone mkdir remote:bucket

   List the contents of a bucket

          rclone ls remote:bucket

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:bucket

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

Multipart uploads

   rclone supports multipart uploads with QingStor which means that it can upload files bigger than 5 GiB.  Note that files uploaded with multipart upload don't
   have an MD5SUM.

   Note  that  incomplete  multipart uploads older than 24 hours can be removed with rclone cleanup remote:bucket just for one bucket rclone cleanup remote: for
   all buckets.  QingStor does not ever remove incomplete multipart uploads so it may be necessary to run this from time to time.

Buckets and Zone

   With QingStor you can list buckets (rclone lsd) using any zone, but you can only access the content of a bucket from the zone it was created in.  If you  at
   tempt to access a bucket from the wrong zone, you will get an error, incorrect zone, the bucket is not in 'XXX' zone.

Authentication

   There are two ways to supply rclone with a set of QingStor credentials.  In order of precedence:

    Directly in the rclone configuration file (as configured by rclone config)

      set access_key_id and secret_access_key

    Runtime configuration:

      set env_auth to true in the config file

      Exporting the following environment variables before running rclone

        Access Key ID: QS_ACCESS_KEY_ID or QS_ACCESS_KEY

        Secret Access Key: QS_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY or QS_SECRET_KEY

Restricted filename characters

   The  control  characters 0x00-0x1F and / are replaced as in the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters).  Note
   that 0x7F is not replaced.

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to qingstor (QingCloud Object Storage).

--qingstor-env-auth

   Get QingStor credentials from runtime.

   Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.

   Properties:

    Config: env_auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENV_AUTH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "false"

        Enter QingStor credentials in the next step.

      "true"

        Get QingStor credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).

--qingstor-access-key-id

   QingStor Access Key ID.

   Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

   Properties:

    Config: access_key_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ACCESS_KEY_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--qingstor-secret-access-key

   QingStor Secret Access Key (password).

   Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

   Properties:

    Config: secret_access_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--qingstor-endpoint

   Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.

   Leave blank will use the default value "https://qingstor.com:443".

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENDPOINT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--qingstor-zone

   Zone to connect to.

   Default is "pek3a".

   Properties:

    Config: zone

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ZONE

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "pek3a"

        The Beijing (China) Three Zone.

        Needs location constraint pek3a.

      "sh1a"

        The Shanghai (China) First Zone.

        Needs location constraint sh1a.

      "gd2a"

        The Guangdong (China) Second Zone.

        Needs location constraint gd2a.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to qingstor (QingCloud Object Storage).

--qingstor-connection-retries

   Number of connection retries.

   Properties:

    Config: connection_retries

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_CONNECTION_RETRIES

    Type: int

    Default: 3

--qingstor-upload-cutoff

   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

   Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.  The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_cutoff

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 200Mi

--qingstor-chunk-size

   Chunk size to use for uploading.

   When uploading files larger than upload_cutoff they will be uploaded as multipart uploads using this chunk size.

   Note that "--qingstor-upload-concurrency" chunks of this size are buffered in memory per transfer.

   If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have enough memory, then increasing this will speed up the transfers.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 4Mi

--qingstor-upload-concurrency

   Concurrency for multipart uploads.

   This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

   NB if you set this to > 1 then the checksums of multipart uploads become corrupted (the uploads themselves are not corrupted though).

   If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing this may  help
   to speed up the transfers.

   Properties:

    Config: upload_concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 1

--qingstor-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

Limitations

   rclone  about  is  not supported by the qingstor backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs
   (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Sia

   Sia  (sia.tech  (https://sia.tech/))  is  a  decentralized cloud storage platform based on the blockchain (https://wikipedia.org/wiki/Blockchain) technology.
   With rclone you can use it like any other remote filesystem or mount Sia folders locally.  The technology behind it involves a number of new concepts such as
   Siacoins and Wallet, Blockchain and Consensus, Renting and Hosting, and so on.  If you are new to it, you'd better first familiarize yourself using their ex
   cellent support documentation (https://support.sia.tech/).

Introduction

   Before you can use rclone with Sia, you will need to have a running copy of Sia-UI or siad (the Sia daemon) locally on your  computer  or  on  local  network
   (e.g.  a NAS).  Please follow the Get started (https://sia.tech/get-started) guide and install one.

   rclone interacts with Sia network by talking to the Sia daemon via HTTP API (https://sia.tech/docs/) which is usually available on port 9980.  By default you
   will run the daemon locally on the same computer so it's safe to leave the API password blank (the API URL will be http://127.0.0.1:9980 making external  ac‐
   cess impossible).

   However,  if  you want to access Sia daemon running on another node, for example due to memory constraints or because you want to share single daemon between
   several rclone and Sia-UI instances, you'll need to make a few more provisions: - Ensure you have Sia daemon installed directly  or  in  a  docker  container
   (https://github.com/SiaFoundation/siad/pkgs/container/siad)  because Sia-UI does not support this mode natively.  - Run it on externally accessible port, for
   example provide --api-addr :9980 and --disable-api-security arguments on the daemon command line.  - Enforce API password for the siad daemon via environment
   variable SIA_API_PASSWORD or text file named apipassword in the daemon directory.  - Set rclone backend option api_password taking it from above locations.

   Notes:  1.  If your wallet is locked, rclone cannot unlock it automatically.  You should either unlock it in advance by using Sia-UI or via command line siac
   wallet unlock.  Alternatively you can make siad unlock your wallet automatically upon startup by running it with  environment  variable  SIA_WALLET_PASSWORD.
   2.   If  siad cannot find the SIA_API_PASSWORD variable or the apipassword file in the SIA_DIR directory, it will generate a random password and store in the
   text file named apipassword under YOUR_HOME/.sia/ directory on Unix or C:\Users\YOUR_HOME\AppData\Local\Sia\apipassword on Windows.  Remember this  when  you
   configure  password in rclone.  3.  The only way to use siad without API password is to run it on localhost with command line argument --authorize-api=false,
   but this is insecure and strongly discouraged.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a sia remote called mySia.  First, run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> mySia
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          ...
          29 / Sia Decentralized Cloud
             \ "sia"
          ...
          Storage> sia
          Sia daemon API URL, like http://sia.daemon.host:9980.
          Note that siad must run with --disable-api-security to open API port for other hosts (not recommended).
          Keep default if Sia daemon runs on localhost.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("http://127.0.0.1:9980").
          api_url> http://127.0.0.1:9980
          Sia Daemon API Password.
          Can be found in the apipassword file located in HOME/.sia/ or in the daemon directory.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g/n> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          --------------------
          [mySia]
          type = sia
          api_url = http://127.0.0.1:9980
          api_password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Once configured, you can then use rclone like this:

    List directories in top level of your Sia storage

     rclone lsd mySia:

    List all the files in your Sia storage

     rclone ls mySia:

    Upload a local directory to the Sia directory called backup

     rclone copy /home/source mySia:backup

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to sia (Sia Decentralized Cloud).

--sia-api-url

   Sia daemon API URL, like http://sia.daemon.host:9980.

   Note that siad must run with --disable-api-security to open API port for other hosts (not recommended).  Keep default if Sia daemon runs on localhost.

   Properties:

    Config: api_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_API_URL

    Type: string

    Default: "http://127.0.0.1:9980"

--sia-api-password

   Sia Daemon API Password.

   Can be found in the apipassword file located in HOME/.sia/ or in the daemon directory.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: api_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_API_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to sia (Sia Decentralized Cloud).

--sia-user-agent

   Siad User Agent

   Sia daemon requires the 'Sia-Agent' user agent by default for security

   Properties:

    Config: user_agent

    Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_USER_AGENT

    Type: string

    Default: "Sia-Agent"

--sia-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Question,Hash,Percent,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

    Modification times not supported

    Checksums not supported

    rclone about not supported

    rclone can work only with Siad or Sia-UI at the moment, the SkyNet daemon is not supported yet.

    Sia does not allow control characters or symbols like question and pound signs in file names.  rclone will transparently  encode  (https://rclone.org/over
     view/#encoding) them for you, but you'd better be aware

Swift

   Swift refers to OpenStack Object Storage (https://docs.openstack.org/swift/latest/).  Commercial implementations of that being:

    Rackspace Cloud Files (https://www.rackspace.com/cloud/files/)

    Memset Memstore (https://www.memset.com/cloud/storage/)

    OVH Object Storage (https://www.ovh.co.uk/public-cloud/storage/object-storage/)

    Oracle Cloud Storage (https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/integration/doc/configure-object-storage.html)

    IBM Bluemix Cloud ObjectStorage Swift (https://console.bluemix.net/docs/infrastructure/objectstorage-swift/index.html)

   Paths are specified as remote:container (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:container/path/to/dir.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a swift configuration.  First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)
             \ "swift"
          [snip]
          Storage> swift
          Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter swift credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get swift credentials from environment vars. Leave other fields blank if using this.
             \ "true"
          env_auth> true
          User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).
          user>
          API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).
          key>
          Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Rackspace US
             \ "https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"
           2 / Rackspace UK
             \ "https://lon.auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"
           3 / Rackspace v2
             \ "https://identity.api.rackspacecloud.com/v2.0"
           4 / Memset Memstore UK
             \ "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v1.0"
           5 / Memset Memstore UK v2
             \ "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v2.0"
           6 / OVH
             \ "https://auth.cloud.ovh.net/v3"
          auth>
          User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID).
          user_id>
          User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)
          domain>
          Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)
          tenant>
          Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)
          tenant_id>
          Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)
          tenant_domain>
          Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)
          region>
          Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)
          storage_url>
          Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)
          auth_token>
          AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)
          auth_version>
          Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE)
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Public (default, choose this if not sure)
             \ "public"
           2 / Internal (use internal service net)
             \ "internal"
           3 / Admin
             \ "admin"
          endpoint_type>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [test]
          env_auth = true
          user =
          key =
          auth =
          user_id =
          domain =
          tenant =
          tenant_id =
          tenant_domain =
          region =
          storage_url =
          auth_token =
          auth_version =
          endpoint_type =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

   See all containers

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new container

          rclone mkdir remote:container

   List the contents of a container

          rclone ls remote:container

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote container, deleting any excess files in the container.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:container

Configuration from an OpenStack credentials file

   An OpenStack credentials file typically looks something something like this (without the comments)

          export OS_AUTH_URL=https://a.provider.net/v2.0
          export OS_TENANT_ID=ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff
          export OS_TENANT_NAME="1234567890123456"
          export OS_USERNAME="123abc567xy"
          echo "Please enter your OpenStack Password: "
          read -sr OS_PASSWORD_INPUT
          export OS_PASSWORD=$OS_PASSWORD_INPUT
          export OS_REGION_NAME="SBG1"
          if [ -z "$OS_REGION_NAME" ]; then unset OS_REGION_NAME; fi

   The config file needs to look something like this where $OS_USERNAME represents the value of the OS_USERNAME variable - 123abc567xy in the example above.

          [remote]
          type = swift
          user = $OS_USERNAME
          key = $OS_PASSWORD
          auth = $OS_AUTH_URL
          tenant = $OS_TENANT_NAME

   Note that you may (or may not) need to set region too - try without first.

Configuration from the environment

   If you prefer you can configure rclone to use swift using a standard set of OpenStack environment variables.

   When you run through the config, make sure you choose true for env_auth and leave everything else blank.

   rclone  will  then  set  any  empty  config parameters from the environment using standard OpenStack environment variables.  There is a list of the variables
   (https://godoc.org/github.com/ncw/swift#Connection.ApplyEnvironment) in the docs for the swift library.

Using an alternate authentication method

   If your OpenStack installation uses a non-standard authentication method that might not be yet supported by rclone or the underlying swift library,  you  can
   authenticate externally (e.g.  calling manually the openstack commands to get a token).  Then, you just need to pass the two configuration variables auth_to
   ken and storage_url.  If they are both provided, the other variables are ignored.  rclone will not try to authenticate but instead assume it is  already  au
   thenticated and use these two variables to access the OpenStack installation.

Using rclone without a config file

   You can use rclone with swift without a config file, if desired, like this:

          source openstack-credentials-file
          export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_TYPE=swift
          export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_ENV_AUTH=true
          rclone lsd myremote:

--fast-list

   This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange for more memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-
   list) for more details.

--update and --use-server-modtime

   As noted below, the modified time is stored on metadata on the object.  It is used by default for all operations that require checking the time  a  file  was
   last  updated.  It allows rclone to treat the remote more like a true filesystem, but it is inefficient because it requires an extra API call to retrieve the
   metadata.

   For many operations, the time the object was last uploaded to the remote is sufficient to determine if it is "dirty".  By using --update  along  with  --use-
   server-modtime, you can avoid the extra API call and simply upload files whose local modtime is newer than the time it was last uploaded.

Modified time

   The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as X-Object-Meta-Mtime as floating point since the epoch accurate to 1 ns.

   This is a de facto standard (used in the official python-swiftclient amongst others) for storing the modification time for an object.

Restricted filename characters

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to swift (OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)).

--swift-env-auth

   Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.

   Properties:

    Config: env_auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENV_AUTH

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "false"

        Enter swift credentials in the next step.

      "true"

        Get swift credentials from environment vars.

        Leave other fields blank if using this.

--swift-user

   User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_USER

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-key

   API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).

   Properties:

    Config: key

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-auth

   Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).

   Properties:

    Config: auth

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"

        Rackspace US

      "https://lon.auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"

        Rackspace UK

      "https://identity.api.rackspacecloud.com/v2.0"

        Rackspace v2

      "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v1.0"

        Memset Memstore UK

      "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v2.0"

        Memset Memstore UK v2

      "https://auth.cloud.ovh.net/v3"

        OVH

--swift-user-id

   User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID).

   Properties:

    Config: user_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_USER_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-domain

   User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)

   Properties:

    Config: domain

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_DOMAIN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-tenant

   Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME).

   Properties:

    Config: tenant

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-tenant-id

   Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID).

   Properties:

    Config: tenant_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-tenant-domain

   Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME).

   Properties:

    Config: tenant_domain

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT_DOMAIN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-region

   Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME).

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_REGION

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-storage-url

   Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL).

   Properties:

    Config: storage_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_STORAGE_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-auth-token

   Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN).

   Properties:

    Config: auth_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-application-credential-id

   Application Credential ID (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID).

   Properties:

    Config: application_credential_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-application-credential-name

   Application Credential Name (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME).

   Properties:

    Config: application_credential_name

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-application-credential-secret

   Application Credential Secret (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET).

   Properties:

    Config: application_credential_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--swift-auth-version

   AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION).

   Properties:

    Config: auth_version

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH_VERSION

    Type: int

    Default: 0

--swift-endpoint-type

   Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE).

   Properties:

    Config: endpoint_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENDPOINT_TYPE

    Type: string

    Default: "public"

    Examples:

      "public"

        Public (default, choose this if not sure)

      "internal"

        Internal (use internal service net)

      "admin"

        Admin

--swift-storage-policy

   The storage policy to use when creating a new container.

   This  applies  the  specified  storage  policy when creating a new container.  The policy cannot be changed afterwards.  The allowed configuration values and
   their meaning depend on your Swift storage provider.

   Properties:

    Config: storage_policy

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_STORAGE_POLICY

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      ""

        Default

      "pcs"

        OVH Public Cloud Storage

      "pca"

        OVH Public Cloud Archive

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to swift (OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)).

--swift-leave-parts-on-error

   If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure.

   It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

   Properties:

    Config: leave_parts_on_error

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--swift-chunk-size

   Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container.

   Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container.  The default for this is 5 GiB which is its maximum value.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 5Gi

--swift-no-chunk

   Don't chunk files during streaming upload.

   When doing streaming uploads (e.g.  using rcat or mount) setting this flag will cause the swift backend to not upload chunked files.

   This will limit the maximum upload size to 5 GiB.  However non chunked files are easier to deal with and have an MD5SUM.

   Rclone will still chunk files bigger than chunk_size when doing normal copy operations.

   Properties:

    Config: no_chunk

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_NO_CHUNK

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--swift-no-large-objects

   Disable support for static and dynamic large objects

   Swift cannot transparently store files bigger than 5 GiB.  There are two schemes for doing that, static or dynamic large objects, and the API does not  allow
   rclone  to determine whether a file is a static or dynamic large object without doing a HEAD on the object.  Since these need to be treated differently, this
   means rclone has to issue HEAD requests for objects for example when reading checksums.

   When no_large_objects is set, rclone will assume that there are no static or dynamic large objects stored.  This means it can stop doing the extra HEAD calls
   which in turn increases performance greatly especially when doing a swift to swift transfer with --checksum set.

   Setting this option implies no_chunk and also that no files will be uploaded in chunks, so files bigger than 5 GiB will just fail on upload.

   If you set this option and there are static or dynamic large objects, then this will give incorrect hashes for them.  Downloads will succeed, but other oper
   ations such as Remove and Copy will fail.

   Properties:

    Config: no_large_objects

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_NO_LARGE_OBJECTS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--swift-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8

Limitations

   The Swift API doesn't return a correct MD5SUM for segmented files (Dynamic or Static Large Objects) so rclone won't check or use the MD5SUM for these.

Troubleshooting Rclone gives Failed to create file system for "remote:": Bad Request

   Due to an oddity of the underlying swift library, it gives a "Bad Request" error rather than a more sensible error when the authentication fails for Swift.

   So this most likely means your username / password is wrong.  You can investigate further with the --dump-bodies flag.

   This may also be caused by specifying the region when you shouldn't have (e.g.  OVH).

Rclone gives Failed to create file system: Response didn't have storage url and auth token

   This is most likely caused by forgetting to specify your tenant when setting up a swift remote.

OVH Cloud Archive

   To use rclone with OVH cloud archive, first use rclone config to set up a swift backend with OVH, choosing pca as the storage_policy.

Uploading Objects

   Uploading objects to OVH cloud archive is no different to object storage, you just simply run the command you like (move, copy or sync)  to  upload  the  ob
   jects.  Once uploaded the objects will show in a "Frozen" state within the OVH control panel.

Retrieving Objects

   To retrieve objects use rclone copy as normal.  If the objects are in a frozen state then rclone will ask for them all to be unfrozen and it will wait at the
   end of the output with a message like the following:

   2019/03/23 13:06:33 NOTICE: Received retry after error - sleeping until 2019-03-23T13:16:33.481657164+01:00 (9m59.99985121s)

   Rclone will wait for the time specified then retry the copy.

pCloud

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for pCloud involves getting a token from pCloud which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Pcloud
             \ "pcloud"
          [snip]
          Storage> pcloud
          Pcloud App Client Id - leave blank normally.
          client_id>
          Pcloud App Client Secret - leave blank normally.
          client_secret>
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","expiry":"0001-01-01T00:00:00Z"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from pCloud.  This only runs from the moment it opens  your  browser
   to  the  moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are run
   ning a host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your pCloud

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your pCloud

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to a pCloud directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   pCloud allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.  In  order  to
   set a Modification time pCloud requires the object be re-uploaded.

   pCloud supports MD5 and SHA1 hashes in the US region, and SHA1 and SHA256 hashes in the EU region, so you can use the --checksum flag.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Deleting files

   Deleted  files will be moved to the trash.  Your subscription level will determine how long items stay in the trash.  rclone cleanup can be used to empty the
   trash.

Emptying the trash

   Due to an API limitation, the rclone cleanup command will only work if you set your username and password in the advanced options for this backend.  Since we
   generally want to avoid storing user passwords in the rclone config file, we advise you to only set this up if you need the rclone cleanup command to work.

Root folder ID

   You can set the root_folder_id for rclone.  This is the directory (identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root of your pCloud drive.

   Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the correct root to use itself.

   However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

   In  order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you wish rclone to display.  This will be the folder field of the URL when you open
   the relevant folder in the pCloud web interface.

   So if the folder you want rclone to use has a URL which looks like https://my.pcloud.com/#page=filemanager&folder=5xxxxxxxx8&tpl=foldergrid in  the  browser,
   then you use 5xxxxxxxx8 as the root_folder_id in the config.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to pcloud (Pcloud).

--pcloud-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--pcloud-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to pcloud (Pcloud).

--pcloud-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--pcloud-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--pcloud-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--pcloud-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--pcloud-root-folder-id

   Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

   Properties:

    Config: root_folder_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

    Type: string

    Default: "d0"

--pcloud-hostname

   Hostname to connect to.

   This  is normally set when rclone initially does the oauth connection, however you will need to set it by hand if you are using remote config with rclone au
   thorize.

   Properties:

    Config: hostname

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_HOSTNAME

    Type: string

    Default: "api.pcloud.com"

    Examples:

      "api.pcloud.com"

        Original/US region

      "eapi.pcloud.com"

        EU region

--pcloud-username

   Your pcloud username.

   This is only required when you want to use the cleanup command.  Due to a bug in the pcloud API the required API does not support OAuth authentication so  we
   have to rely on user password authentication for it.

   Properties:

    Config: username

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_USERNAME

    Type: string

    Required: false

--pcloud-password

   Your pcloud password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: password

    Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_PASSWORD

    Type: string

    Required: false

premiumize.me

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for premiumize.me (https://premiumize.me/) involves getting a token from premiumize.me which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config
   walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / premiumize.me
             \ "premiumizeme"
          [snip]
          Storage> premiumizeme
          ** See help for premiumizeme backend at: https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/ **

          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = premiumizeme
          token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2029-08-07T18:44:15.548915378+01:00"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d>

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from premiumize.me.  This only runs from the moment  it  opens  your
   browser  to  the  moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you
   are running a host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your premiumize.me

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your premiumize.me

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an premiumize.me directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   premiumize.me does not support modification times or hashes, therefore syncing will default to --size-only checking.  Note that using --update will work.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        
   "           0x22        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to premiumizeme (premiumize.me).

--premiumizeme-api-key

   API Key.

   This is not normally used - use oauth instead.

   Properties:

    Config: api_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_PREMIUMIZEME_API_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to premiumizeme (premiumize.me).

--premiumizeme-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_PREMIUMIZEME_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Note that premiumize.me is case insensitive so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

   premiumize.me file names can't have the \ or " characters in.  rclone maps these to and from an identical looking unicode equivalents  and 

   premiumize.me only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

put.io

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   put.io paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   The initial setup for put.io involves getting a token from put.io which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> putio
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Put.io
             \ "putio"
          [snip]
          Storage> putio
          ** See help for putio backend at: https://rclone.org/putio/ **

          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [putio]
          type = putio
          token = {"access_token":"XXXXXXXX","expiry":"0001-01-01T00:00:00Z"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          putio                putio

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from put.io if using  web  browser  to  automatically  authenticate.
   This  only  runs  from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may
   require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

   You can then use it like this,

   List directories in top level of your put.io

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your put.io

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to a put.io directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   \           0x5C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to putio (Put.io).

--putio-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_PUTIO_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   put.io has rate limiting.  When you hit a limit, rclone automatically retries after waiting the amount of time requested by the server.

   If you want to avoid ever hitting these limits, you may use the --tpslimit flag with a low number.  Note that the imposed limits may be different for differ
   ent operations, and may change over time.

Seafile

   This is a backend for the Seafile (https://www.seafile.com/) storage service: - It works with both the free community edition or the professional edition.  -
   Seafile versions 6.x, 7.x, 8.x and 9.x are all supported.  - Encrypted libraries are also supported.  - It supports 2FA enabled users - Using a  Library  API
   Token is not supported

Configuration

   There  are  two  distinct  modes you can setup your remote: - you point your remote to the root of the server, meaning you don't specify a library during the
   configuration: Paths are specified as remote:library.  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:library/path/to/dir.  - you point  your  remote  to  a
   specific  library  during  the configuration: Paths are specified as remote:path/to/dir.  This is the recommended mode when using encrypted libraries.  (This
   mode is possibly slightly faster than the root mode)

Configuration in root mode

   Here is an example of making a seafile configuration for a user with no two-factor authentication.  First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.  To authenticate you will need the URL of your server, your email (or username) and your password.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> seafile
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Seafile
             \ "seafile"
          [snip]
          Storage> seafile
          ** See help for seafile backend at: https://rclone.org/seafile/ **

          URL of seafile host to connect to
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to cloud.seafile.com
             \ "https://cloud.seafile.com/"
          url> http://my.seafile.server/
          User name (usually email address)
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          user> me@example.com
          Password
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          2fa> false
          Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          library>
          Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g/n> n
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Two-factor authentication is not enabled on this account.
          --------------------
          [seafile]
          type = seafile
          url = http://my.seafile.server/
          user = me@example.com
          pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          2fa = false
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This remote is called seafile.  It's pointing to the root of your seafile server and can now be used like this:

   See all libraries

          rclone lsd seafile:

   Create a new library

          rclone mkdir seafile:library

   List the contents of a library

          rclone ls seafile:library

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote library, deleting any excess files in the library.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory seafile:library

Configuration in library mode

   Here's an example of a configuration in library mode with a user that has the two-factor authentication enabled.  Your 2FA code will be asked at the  end  of
   the configuration, and will attempt to authenticate you:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> seafile
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Seafile
             \ "seafile"
          [snip]
          Storage> seafile
          ** See help for seafile backend at: https://rclone.org/seafile/ **

          URL of seafile host to connect to
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to cloud.seafile.com
             \ "https://cloud.seafile.com/"
          url> http://my.seafile.server/
          User name (usually email address)
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          user> me@example.com
          Password
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          2fa> true
          Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          library> My Library
          Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g/n> n
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Two-factor authentication: please enter your 2FA code
          2fa code> 123456
          Authenticating...
          Success!
          --------------------
          [seafile]
          type = seafile
          url = http://my.seafile.server/
          user = me@example.com
          pass =
          2fa = true
          library = My Library
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   You'll notice your password is blank in the configuration.  It's because we only need the password to authenticate you once.

   You specified My Library during the configuration.  The root of the remote is pointing at the root of the library My Library:

   See all files in the library:

          rclone lsd seafile:

   Create a new directory inside the library

          rclone mkdir seafile:directory

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls seafile:directory

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote library, deleting any excess files in the library.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory seafile:

--fast-list

   Seafile   version   7+   supports   --fast-list   which  allows  you  to  use  fewer  transactions  in  exchange  for  more  memory.   See  the  rclone  docs
   (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more details.  Please note this is not supported on seafile server version 6.x

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   /           0x2F        
   "           0x22        
   \           0x5C        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Seafile and rclone link

   Rclone supports generating share links for non-encrypted libraries only.  They can either be for a file or a directory:

          rclone link seafile:seafile-tutorial.doc
          http://my.seafile.server/f/fdcd8a2f93f84b8b90f4/

   or if run on a directory you will get:

          rclone link seafile:dir
          http://my.seafile.server/d/9ea2455f6f55478bbb0d/

   Please note a share link is unique for each file or directory.  If you run a link command on a file/dir that has already been shared, you will get the  exact
   same link.

Compatibility

   It has been actively developed using the seafile docker image (https://github.com/haiwen/seafile-docker) of these versions: - 6.3.4 community edition - 7.0.5
   community edition - 7.1.3 community edition - 9.0.10 community edition

   Versions below 6.0 are not supported.  Versions between 6.0 and 6.3 haven't been tested and might not work properly.

   Each new version of rclone is automatically tested against the latest docker image (https://hub.docker.com/r/seafileltd/seafile-mc/) of the seafile community
   server.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to seafile (seafile).

--seafile-url

   URL of seafile host to connect to.

   Properties:

    Config: url

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_URL

    Type: string

    Required: true

    Examples:

      "https://cloud.seafile.com/"

        Connect to cloud.seafile.com.

--seafile-user

   User name (usually email address).

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_USER

    Type: string

    Required: true

--seafile-pass

   Password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--seafile-2fa

   Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled).

   Properties:

    Config: 2fa

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_2FA

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--seafile-library

   Name of the library.

   Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.

   Properties:

    Config: library

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_LIBRARY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--seafile-library-key

   Library password (for encrypted libraries only).

   Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: library_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_LIBRARY_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--seafile-auth-token

   Authentication token.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_AUTH_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to seafile (seafile).

--seafile-create-library

   Should rclone create a library if it doesn't exist.

   Properties:

    Config: create_library

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_CREATE_LIBRARY

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--seafile-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

SFTP

   SFTP is the Secure (or SSH) File Transfer Protocol (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SSH_File_Transfer_Protocol).

   The SFTP backend can be used with a number of different providers:

    Hetzner Storage Box

    rsync.net

   SFTP runs over SSH v2 and is installed as standard with most modern SSH installations.

   Paths  are  specified as remote:path.  If the path does not begin with a / it is relative to the home directory of the user.  An empty path remote: refers to
   the user's home directory.  For example, rclone lsd remote: would list the home directory of the user configured in the rclone remote config (i.e  /home/sft
   puser).  However, rclone lsd remote:/ would list the root directory for remote machine (i.e.  /)

   Note  that  some SFTP servers will need the leading / - Synology is a good example of this.  rsync.net and Hetzner, on the other hand, requires users to OMIT
   the leading /.

   Note that by default rclone will try to execute shell commands on the server, see shell access considerations.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making an SFTP configuration.  First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / SSH/SFTP
             \ "sftp"
          [snip]
          Storage> sftp
          SSH host to connect to
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to example.com
             \ "example.com"
          host> example.com
          SSH username
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("$USER").
          user> sftpuser
          SSH port number
          Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default (22).
          port>
          SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank
          y/g/n> n
          Path to unencrypted PEM-encoded private key file, leave blank to use ssh-agent.
          key_file>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          host = example.com
          user = sftpuser
          port =
          pass =
          key_file =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   This remote is called remote and can now be used like this:

   See all directories in the home directory

          rclone lsd remote:

   See all directories in the root directory

          rclone lsd remote:/

   Make a new directory

          rclone mkdir remote:path/to/directory

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:path/to/directory

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote directory, deleting any excess files in the directory.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:directory

   Mount the remote path /srv/www-data/ to the local path /mnt/www-data

          rclone mount remote:/srv/www-data/ /mnt/www-data

SSH Authentication

   The SFTP remote supports three authentication methods:

    Password

    Key file, including certificate signed keys

    ssh-agent

   Key files should be PEM-encoded private key files.  For instance /home/$USER/.ssh/id_rsa.  Only unencrypted OpenSSH or PEM encrypted files are supported.

   The key file can be specified in either an external file (key_file) or contained within the rclone config file (key_pem).  If using  key_pem  in  the  config
   file, the entry should be on a single line with new line ('' or '') separating lines.  i.e.

          key_pem = -----BEGIN RSA PRIVATE KEY-----\nMaMbaIXtE\n0gAMbMbaSsd\nMbaass\n-----END RSA PRIVATE KEY-----

   This will generate it correctly for key_pem for use in the config:

          awk '{printf "%s\\n", $0}' < ~/.ssh/id_rsa

   If  you  don't  specify  pass,  key_file, or key_pem or ask_password then rclone will attempt to contact an ssh-agent.  You can also specify key_use_agent to
   force the usage of an ssh-agent.  In this case key_file or key_pem can also be specified to force the usage of a specific key in the ssh-agent.

   Using an ssh-agent is the only way to load encrypted OpenSSH keys at the moment.

   If you set the ask_password option, rclone will prompt for a password when needed and no password has been configured.

Certificate-signed keys

   With traditional key-based authentication, you configure your private key only, and the public key built into it  will  be  used  during  the  authentication
   process.

   If  you  have  a certificate you may use it to sign your public key, creating a separate SSH user certificate that should be used instead of the plain public
   key extracted from the private key.  Then you must provide the path to the user certificate public key file in pubkey_file.

   Note: This is not the traditional public key paired with your private key, typically saved as /home/$USER/.ssh/id_rsa.pub.  Setting this path in  pubkey_file
   will not work.

   Example:

          [remote]
          type = sftp
          host = example.com
          user = sftpuser
          key_file = ~/id_rsa
          pubkey_file = ~/id_rsa-cert.pub

   If you concatenate a cert with a private key then you can specify the merged file in both places.

   Note: the cert must come first in the file.  e.g.

          cat id_rsa-cert.pub id_rsa > merged_key

Host key validation

   By default rclone will not check the server's host key for validation.  This can allow an attacker to replace a server with their own and if you use password
   authentication then this can lead to that password being exposed.

   Host key matching, using standard known_hosts files can be turned on by enabling the known_hosts_file option.  This can  point  to  the  file  maintained  by
   OpenSSH or can point to a unique file.

   e.g.  using the OpenSSH known_hosts file:

          [remote]
          type = sftp
          host = example.com
          user = sftpuser
          pass =
          known_hosts_file = ~/.ssh/known_hosts

   Alternatively you can create your own known hosts file like this:

          ssh-keyscan -t dsa,rsa,ecdsa,ed25519 example.com >> known_hosts

   There are some limitations:

   • rclone will not manage this file for you.  If the key is missing or wrong then the connection will be refused.

   • If the server is set up for a certificate host key then the entry in the known_hosts file must be the @cert-authority entry for the CA

   If the host key provided by the server does not match the one in the file (or is missing) then the connection will be aborted and an error returned such as

          NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: knownhosts: key mismatch

   or

          NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: knownhosts: key is unknown

   If you see an error such as

          NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: ssh: no authorities for hostname: example.com:22

   then it is likely the server has presented a CA signed host certificate and you will need to add the appropriate @cert-authority entry.

   The known_hosts_file setting can be set during rclone config as an advanced option.

ssh-agent on macOS

   Note  that there seem to be various problems with using an ssh-agent on macOS due to recent changes in the OS.  The most effective work-around seems to be to
   start an ssh-agent in each session, e.g.

          eval `ssh-agent -s` && ssh-add -A

   And then at the end of the session

          eval `ssh-agent -k`

   These commands can be used in scripts of course.

Shell access

   Some functionality of the SFTP backend relies on remote shell access, and the possibility to execute commands.  This includes checksum, and in some cases al
   so about.  The shell commands that must be executed may be different on different type of shells, and also quoting/escaping of file path arguments containing
   special characters may be different.  Rclone therefore needs to know what type of shell it is, and if shell access is available at all.

   Most servers run on some version of Unix, and then a basic Unix shell can be assumed, without further distinction.  Windows 10, Server 2019,  and  later  can
   also  run  a  SSH  server,  which  is  a  port  of  OpenSSH  (see  official  installation  guide (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows-server/administra
   tion/openssh/openssh_install_firstuse)).  On a Windows server the shell handling is different: Although it can also be set up to use a Unix type shell,  e.g.
   Cygwin  bash,  the  default  is  to use Windows Command Prompt (cmd.exe), and PowerShell is a recommended alternative.  All of these have behave differently,
   which rclone must handle.

   Rclone tries to auto-detect what type of shell is used on the server, first time you access the SFTP remote.  If a remote shell session is successfully  cre
   ated, it will look for indications that it is CMD or PowerShell, with fall-back to Unix if not something else is detected.  If unable to even create a remote
   shell session, then shell command execution will be disabled entirely.  The result is stored in the SFTP remote configuration, in option shell_type, so  that
   the  auto-detection only have to be performed once.  If you manually set a value for this option before first run, the auto-detection will be skipped, and if
   you set a different value later this will override any existing.  Value none can be set to avoid any attempts at executing shell commands, e.g.  if  this  is
   not allowed on the server.

   When the server is rclone serve sftp (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/), the rclone SFTP remote will detect this as a Unix type shell - even if
   it is running on Windows.  This server does not actually have a shell, but it accepts input commands matching the specific ones that the SFTP backend  relies
   on  for  Unix shells, e.g.  md5sum and df.  Also it handles the string escape rules used for Unix shell.  Treating it as a Unix type shell from a SFTP remote
   will therefore always be correct, and support all features.

Shell access considerations

   The shell type auto-detection logic, described above, means that by default rclone will try to run a shell command the first time a new sftp  remote  is  ac
   cessed.  If you configure a sftp remote without a config file, e.g.  an on the fly (https://rclone.org/docs/#backend-path-to-dir%5D) remote, rclone will have
   nowhere to store the result, and it will re-run the command on every access.  To avoid this you should explicitly set the shell_type option  to  the  correct
   value, or to none if you want to prevent rclone from executing any remote shell commands.

   It  is also important to note that, since the shell type decides how quoting and escaping of file paths used as command-line arguments are performed, config
   uring the wrong shell type may leave you exposed to command injection exploits.  Make sure to confirm the auto-detected shell type,  or  explicitly  set  the
   shell type you know is correct, or disable shell access until you know.

Checksum

   SFTP  does not natively support checksums (file hash), but rclone is able to use checksumming if the same login has shell access, and can execute remote com
   mands.  If there is a command that can calculate compatible checksums on the remote system, Rclone can then be configured to execute this whenever a checksum
   is needed, and read back the results.  Currently MD5 and SHA-1 are supported.

   Normally  this  requires an external utility being available on the server.  By default rclone will try commands md5sum, md5 and rclone md5sum for MD5 check
   sums, and the first one found usable will be picked.  Same with sha1sum, sha1 and rclone sha1sum commands for SHA-1 checksums.  These utilities normally need
   to be in the remote's PATH to be found.

   In  some  cases  the shell itself is capable of calculating checksums.  PowerShell is an example of such a shell.  If rclone detects that the remote shell is
   PowerShell, which means it most probably is a Windows OpenSSH server, rclone will use a predefined script block to produce the  checksums  when  no  external
   checksum commands are found (see shell access).  This assumes PowerShell version 4.0 or newer.

   The options md5sum_command and sha1_command can be used to customize the command to be executed for calculation of checksums.  You can for example set a spe
   cific path to where md5sum and sha1sum executables are located, or use them to specify some other tools that print checksums in compatible format.  The value
   can   include   command-line  arguments,  or  even  shell  script  blocks  as  with  PowerShell.   Rclone  has  subcommands  md5sum  (https://rclone.org/com
   mands/rclone_md5sum/) and sha1sum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sha1sum/) that use compatible format, which means if you have an rclone  executable  on
   the  server it can be used.  As mentioned above, they will be automatically picked up if found in PATH, but if not you can set something like /path/to/rclone
   md5sum as the value of option md5sum_command to make sure a specific executable is used.

   Remote checksumming is recommended and enabled by default.  First time rclone is using a SFTP remote, if options md5sum_command or sha1_command are not  set,
   it  will  check  if  any of the default commands for each of them, as described above, can be used.  The result will be saved in the remote configuration, so
   next time it will use the same.  Value none will be set if none of the default commands could be used for a specific algorithm, and this algorithm  will  not
   be supported by the remote.

   Disabling the checksumming may be required if you are connecting to SFTP servers which are not under your control, and to which the execution of remote shell
   commands is prohibited.  Set the configuration option disable_hashcheck to true to disable checksumming entirely, or set shell_type to none  to  disable  all
   functionality based on remote shell command execution.

Modified time

   Modified times are stored on the server to 1 second precision.

   Modified times are used in syncing and are fully supported.

   Some  SFTP  servers disable setting/modifying the file modification time after upload (for example, certain configurations of ProFTPd with mod_sftp).  If you
   are using one of these servers, you can set the option set_modtime = false in your RClone backend configuration to disable this behaviour.

About command

   The about command returns the total space, free space, and used space on the remote for the disk of the specified path on the remote or, if not set, the disk
   of the root on the remote.

   SFTP  usually supports the about (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/) command, but it depends on the server.  If the server implements the vendor-spe
   cific VFS statistics extension, which is normally the case with OpenSSH instances, it will be used.  If not, but the same login has access to a  Unix  shell,
   where  the  df command is available (e.g.  in the remote's PATH), then this will be used instead.  If the server shell is PowerShell, probably with a Windows
   OpenSSH server, rclone will use a built-in shell command (see shell access).  If none of the above is applicable, about will fail.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to sftp (SSH/SFTP).

--sftp-host

   SSH host to connect to.

   E.g.  "example.com".

   Properties:

    Config: host

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_HOST

    Type: string

    Required: true

--sftp-user

   SSH username.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USER

    Type: string

    Default: "$USER"

--sftp-port

   SSH port number.

   Properties:

    Config: port

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PORT

    Type: int

    Default: 22

--sftp-pass

   SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-key-pem

   Raw PEM-encoded private key.

   If specified, will override key_file parameter.

   Properties:

    Config: key_pem

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_PEM

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-key-file

   Path to PEM-encoded private key file.

   Leave blank or set key-use-agent to use ssh-agent.

   Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

   Properties:

    Config: key_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-key-file-pass

   The passphrase to decrypt the PEM-encoded private key file.

   Only PEM encrypted key files (old OpenSSH format) are supported.  Encrypted keys in the new OpenSSH format can't be used.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: key_file_pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_FILE_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-pubkey-file

   Optional path to public key file.

   Set this if you have a signed certificate you want to use for authentication.

   Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

   Properties:

    Config: pubkey_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PUBKEY_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-key-use-agent

   When set forces the usage of the ssh-agent.

   When key-file is also set, the ".pub" file of the specified key-file is read and only the associated key is requested from the  ssh-agent.   This  allows  to
   avoid Too many authentication failures for *username* errors when the ssh-agent contains many keys.

   Properties:

    Config: key_use_agent

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_USE_AGENT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--sftp-use-insecure-cipher

   Enable the use of insecure ciphers and key exchange methods.

   This enables the use of the following insecure ciphers and key exchange methods:

    aes128-cbc

    aes192-cbc

    aes256-cbc

    3des-cbc

    diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256

    diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1

   Those algorithms are insecure and may allow plaintext data to be recovered by an attacker.

   This must be false if you use either ciphers or key_exchange advanced options.

   Properties:

    Config: use_insecure_cipher

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USE_INSECURE_CIPHER

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "false"

        Use default Cipher list.

      "true"

        Enables the use of the aes128-cbc cipher and diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256, diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1 key exchange.

--sftp-disable-hashcheck

   Disable the execution of SSH commands to determine if remote file hashing is available.

   Leave blank or set to false to enable hashing (recommended), set to true to disable hashing.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_hashcheck

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_HASHCHECK

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to sftp (SSH/SFTP).

--sftp-known-hosts-file

   Optional path to known_hosts file.

   Set this value to enable server host key validation.

   Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

   Properties:

    Config: known_hosts_file

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KNOWN_HOSTS_FILE

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "~/.ssh/known_hosts"

        Use OpenSSH's known_hosts file.

--sftp-ask-password

   Allow asking for SFTP password when needed.

   If this is set and no password is supplied then rclone will: - ask for a password - not contact the ssh agent

   Properties:

    Config: ask_password

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_ASK_PASSWORD

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--sftp-path-override

   Override path used by SSH shell commands.

   This allows checksum calculation when SFTP and SSH paths are different.  This issue affects among others Synology NAS boxes.

   E.g.  if shared folders can be found in directories representing volumes:

          rclone sync /home/local/directory remote:/directory --sftp-path-override /volume2/directory

   E.g.  if home directory can be found in a shared folder called "home":

          rclone sync /home/local/directory remote:/home/directory --sftp-path-override /volume1/homes/USER/directory

   Properties:

    Config: path_override

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PATH_OVERRIDE

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-set-modtime

   Set the modified time on the remote if set.

   Properties:

    Config: set_modtime

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SET_MODTIME

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--sftp-shell-type

   The type of SSH shell on remote server, if any.

   Leave blank for autodetect.

   Properties:

    Config: shell_type

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SHELL_TYPE

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "none"

        No shell access

      "unix"

        Unix shell

      "powershell"

        PowerShell

      "cmd"

        Windows Command Prompt

--sftp-md5sum-command

   The command used to read md5 hashes.

   Leave blank for autodetect.

   Properties:

    Config: md5sum_command

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_MD5SUM_COMMAND

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-sha1sum-command

   The command used to read sha1 hashes.

   Leave blank for autodetect.

   Properties:

    Config: sha1sum_command

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SHA1SUM_COMMAND

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-skip-links

   Set to skip any symlinks and any other non regular files.

   Properties:

    Config: skip_links

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SKIP_LINKS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--sftp-subsystem

   Specifies the SSH2 subsystem on the remote host.

   Properties:

    Config: subsystem

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SUBSYSTEM

    Type: string

    Default: "sftp"

--sftp-server-command

   Specifies the path or command to run a sftp server on the remote host.

   The subsystem option is ignored when server_command is defined.

   Properties:

    Config: server_command

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SERVER_COMMAND

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sftp-use-fstat

   If set use fstat instead of stat.

   Some  servers  limit the amount of open files and calling Stat after opening the file will throw an error from the server.  Setting this flag will call Fstat
   instead of Stat which is called on an already open file handle.

   It has been found that this helps with IBM Sterling SFTP servers which have "extractability" level set to 1 which means only 1 file can be opened at any giv
   en time.

   Properties:

    Config: use_fstat

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USE_FSTAT

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--sftp-disable-concurrent-reads

   If set don't use concurrent reads.

   Normally concurrent reads are safe to use and not using them will degrade performance, so this option is disabled by default.

   Some servers limit the amount number of times a file can be downloaded.  Using concurrent reads can trigger this limit, so if you have a server which returns

          Failed to copy: file does not exist

   Then you may need to enable this flag.

   If concurrent reads are disabled, the use_fstat option is ignored.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_concurrent_reads

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_CONCURRENT_READS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--sftp-disable-concurrent-writes

   If set don't use concurrent writes.

   Normally rclone uses concurrent writes to upload files.  This improves the performance greatly, especially for distant servers.

   This option disables concurrent writes should that be necessary.

   Properties:

    Config: disable_concurrent_writes

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_CONCURRENT_WRITES

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--sftp-idle-timeout

   Max time before closing idle connections.

   If no connections have been returned to the connection pool in the time given, rclone will empty the connection pool.

   Set to 0 to keep connections indefinitely.

   Properties:

    Config: idle_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_IDLE_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--sftp-chunk-size

   Upload and download chunk size.

   This  controls  the  maximum  size  of  payload in SFTP protocol packets.  The RFC limits this to 32768 bytes (32k), which is the default.  However, a lot of
   servers support larger sizes, typically limited to a maximum total package size of 256k, and setting it larger will increase transfer speed  dramatically  on
   high latency links.  This includes OpenSSH, and, for example, using the value of 255k works well, leaving plenty of room for overhead while still being with
   in a total packet size of 256k.

   Make sure to test thoroughly before using a value higher than 32k, and only use it if you always connect to the same server or after sufficiently broad test
   ing.   If you get errors such as "failed to send packet payload: EOF", lots of "connection lost", or "corrupted on transfer", when copying a larger file, try
   lowering the value.  The server run by rclone serve sftp sends packets with standard 32k maximum payload so you must not  set  a  different  chunk_size  when
   downloading files, but it accepts packets up to the 256k total size, so for uploads the chunk_size can be set as for the OpenSSH example above.

   Properties:

    Config: chunk_size

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_CHUNK_SIZE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 32Ki

--sftp-concurrency

   The maximum number of outstanding requests for one file

   This  controls  the  maximum  number of outstanding requests for one file.  Increasing it will increase throughput on high latency links at the cost of using
   more memory.

   Properties:

    Config: concurrency

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_CONCURRENCY

    Type: int

    Default: 64

--sftp-set-env

   Environment variables to pass to sftp and commands

   Set environment variables in the form:

          VAR=value

   to be passed to the sftp client and to any commands run (eg md5sum).

   Pass multiple variables space separated, eg

          VAR1=value VAR2=value

   and pass variables with spaces in in quotes, eg

          "VAR3=value with space" "VAR4=value with space" VAR5=nospacehere

   Properties:

    Config: set_env

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SET_ENV

    Type: SpaceSepList

    Default:

--sftp-ciphers

   Space separated list of ciphers to be used for session encryption, ordered by preference.

   At least one must match with server configuration.  This can be checked for example using ssh -Q cipher.

   This must not be set if use_insecure_cipher is true.

   Example:

          aes128-ctr aes192-ctr aes256-ctr aes128-gcm@openssh.com aes256-gcm@openssh.com

   Properties:

    Config: ciphers

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_CIPHERS

    Type: SpaceSepList

    Default:

--sftp-key-exchange

   Space separated list of key exchange algorithms, ordered by preference.

   At least one must match with server configuration.  This can be checked for example using ssh -Q kex.

   This must not be set if use_insecure_cipher is true.

   Example:

          sntrup761x25519-sha512@openssh.com curve25519-sha256 curve25519-sha256@libssh.org ecdh-sha2-nistp256

   Properties:

    Config: key_exchange

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_EXCHANGE

    Type: SpaceSepList

    Default:

--sftp-macs

   Space separated list of MACs (message authentication code) algorithms, ordered by preference.

   At least one must match with server configuration.  This can be checked for example using ssh -Q mac.

   Example:

          umac-64-etm@openssh.com umac-128-etm@openssh.com hmac-sha2-256-etm@openssh.com

   Properties:

    Config: macs

    Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_MACS

    Type: SpaceSepList

    Default:

Limitations

   On some SFTP servers (e.g.  Synology) the paths are different for SSH and SFTP so the hashes can't be calculated properly.  For them using  disable_hashcheck
   is a good idea.

   The only ssh agent supported under Windows is Putty's pageant.

   The  Go SSH library disables the use of the aes128-cbc cipher by default, due to security concerns.  This can be re-enabled on a per-connection basis by set
   ting the use_insecure_cipher setting in the configuration file to true.  Further details on the insecurity  of  this  cipher  can  be  found  in  this  paper
   (http://www.isg.rhul.ac.uk/~kp/SandPfinal.pdf).

   SFTP isn't supported under plan9 until this issue (https://github.com/pkg/sftp/issues/156) is fixed.

   Note that since SFTP isn't HTTP based the following flags don't work with it: --dump-headers, --dump-bodies, --dump-auth.

   Note that --timeout and --contimeout are both supported.

rsync.net

   rsync.net is supported through the SFTP backend.

   See rsync.net's documentation of rclone examples (https://www.rsync.net/products/rclone.html).

Hetzner Storage Box

   Hetzner Storage Boxes are supported through the SFTP backend on port 23.

   See Hetzner's documentation for details (https://docs.hetzner.com/robot/storage-box/access/access-ssh-rsync-borg#rclone)

SMB

   SMB is a communication protocol to share files over network (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Server_Message_Block).

   This relies on go-smb2 library (https://github.com/hirochachacha/go-smb2/) for communication with SMB protocol.

   Paths are specified as remote:sharename (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:item/path/to/dir.

Notes

   The  first  path  segment must be the name of the share, which you entered when you started to share on Windows.  On smbd, it's the section title in smb.conf
   (usually in /etc/samba/) file.  You can find shares by quering the root if you're unsure (e.g.  rclone lsd remote:).

   You can't access to the shared printers from rclone, obviously.

   You can't use Anonymous access for logging in.  You have to use the guest user with an empty password instead.  The rclone client tries to  avoid  8.3  names
   when  uploading  files by encoding trailing spaces and periods.  Alternatively, the local backend (https://rclone.org/local/#paths-on-windows) on Windows can
   access SMB servers using UNC paths, by \\server\share.  This doesn't apply to non-Windows OSes, such as Linux and macOS.

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a SMB configuration.

   First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Option Storage.
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          XX / SMB / CIFS
             \ (smb)
          Storage> smb

          Option host.
          Samba hostname to connect to.
          E.g. "example.com".
          Enter a value.
          host> localhost

          Option user.
          Samba username.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (lesmi).
          user> guest

          Option port.
          Samba port number.
          Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default (445).
          port>

          Option pass.
          Samba password.
          Choose an alternative below. Press Enter for the default (n).
          y) Yes, type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No, leave this optional password blank (default)
          y/g/n> g
          Password strength in bits.
          64 is just about memorable
          128 is secure
          1024 is the maximum
          Bits> 64
          Your password is: XXXX
          Use this password? Please note that an obscured version of this
          password (and not the password itself) will be stored under your
          configuration file, so keep this generated password in a safe place.
          y) Yes (default)
          n) No
          y/n> y

          Option domain.
          Domain name for NTLM authentication.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (WORKGROUP).
          domain>

          Edit advanced config?
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n

          Configuration complete.
          Options:
          - type: samba
          - host: localhost
          - user: guest
          - pass: *** ENCRYPTED ***
          Keep this "remote" remote?
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> d

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to smb (SMB / CIFS).

--smb-host

   SMB server hostname to connect to.

   E.g.  "example.com".

   Properties:

    Config: host

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_HOST

    Type: string

    Required: true

--smb-user

   SMB username.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_USER

    Type: string

    Default: "$USER"

--smb-port

   SMB port number.

   Properties:

    Config: port

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_PORT

    Type: int

    Default: 445

--smb-pass

   SMB password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--smb-domain

   Domain name for NTLM authentication.

   Properties:

    Config: domain

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_DOMAIN

    Type: string

    Default: "WORKGROUP"

--smb-spn

   Service principal name.

   Rclone presents this name to the server.  Some servers use this as further authentication, and it often needs to be set for clusters.  For example:

          cifs/remotehost:1020

   Leave blank if not sure.

   Properties:

    Config: spn

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_SPN

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to smb (SMB / CIFS).

--smb-idle-timeout

   Max time before closing idle connections.

   If no connections have been returned to the connection pool in the time given, rclone will empty the connection pool.

   Set to 0 to keep connections indefinitely.

   Properties:

    Config: idle_timeout

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_IDLE_TIMEOUT

    Type: Duration

    Default: 1m0s

--smb-hide-special-share

   Hide special shares (e.g.  print$) which users aren't supposed to access.

   Properties:

    Config: hide_special_share

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_HIDE_SPECIAL_SHARE

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--smb-case-insensitive

   Whether the server is configured to be case-insensitive.

   Always true on Windows shares.

   Properties:

    Config: case_insensitive

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_CASE_INSENSITIVE

    Type: bool

    Default: true

--smb-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Storj

   Storj (https://storj.io) is an encrypted, secure, and cost-effective object storage service that enables you to store, back up, and archive large amounts  of
   data in a decentralized manner.

Backend options

   Storj  can be used both with this native backend and with the s3 backend using the Storj S3 compatible gateway (https://rclone.org/s3/#storj) (shared or pri‐
   vate).

   Use this backend to take advantage of client-side encryption as well as to achieve the best possible download performance.  Uploads will be erasure-coded lo
   cally, thus a 1gb upload will result in 2.68gb of data being uploaded to storage nodes across the network.

   Use the s3 backend and one of the S3 compatible Hosted Gateways to increase upload performance and reduce the load on your systems and network.  Uploads will
   be encrypted and erasure-coded server-side, thus a 1GB upload will result in only in 1GB of data being uploaded to storage nodes across the network.

   Side by side comparison with more details:

    Characteristics:

      Storj backend: Uses native RPC protocol, connects directly to the storage nodes which hosts the data.  Requires more CPU  resource  of  encoding/decoding
       and has network amplification (especially during the upload), uses lots of TCP connections

      S3  backend: Uses S3 compatible HTTP Rest API via the shared gateways.  There is no network amplification, but performance depends on the shared gateways
       and the secret encryption key is shared with the gateway.

    Typical usage:

      Storj backend: Server environments and desktops with enough resources, internet speed and connectivity - and applications where  storjs  client-side  en
       cryption is required.

      S3 backend: Desktops and similar with limited resources, internet speed or connectivity.

    Security:

      Storj backend: strong.  Private encryption key doesn't need to leave the local computer.

     • S3  backend:  weaker.   Private encryption key is shared with (https://docs.storj.io/dcs/api-reference/s3-compatible-gateway#security-and-encryption) the
       authentication service of the hosted gateway, where it's stored encrypted.  It can be stronger when combining with the rclone crypt backend.

    Bandwidth usage (upload):

      Storj backend: higher.  As data is erasure coded on the client side both the original data and the parities should be uploaded.  About  ~2.7  times  more
       data is required to be uploaded.  Client may start to upload with even higher number of nodes (~3.7 times more) and abandon/stop the slow uploads.

      S3 backend: normal.  Only the raw data is uploaded, erasure coding happens on the gateway.

    Bandwidth usage (download)

      Storj  backend:  almost  normal.   Only the minimal number of data is required, but to avoid very slow data providers a few more sources are used and the
       slowest are ignored (max 1.2x overhead).

      S3 backend: normal.  Only the raw data is downloaded, erasure coding happens on the shared gateway.

    CPU usage:

      Storj backend: higher, but more predictable.  Erasure code and encryption/decryption happens locally which requires significant CPU usage.

      S3 backend: less.  Erasure code and encryption/decryption happens on shared s3 gateways (and as is, it depends on the current load on the gateways)

    TCP connection usage:

      Storj backend: high.  A direct connection is required to each of the Storj nodes resulting in 110 connections on upload and 35 on download per 64 MB seg
       ment.   Not  all  the  connections  are  actively  used  (slow  ones  are  pruned),  but  they  are  all  opened.   Adjusting  the  max  open  file limit
       (https://rclone.org/storj/#known-issues) may be required.

      S3 backend: normal.  Only one connection per download/upload thread is required to the shared gateway.

    Overall performance:

      Storj backend: with enough resources (CPU and bandwidth) storj backend can provide even 2x better performance.  Data is directly downloaded to / uploaded
       from to the client instead of the gateway.

      S3  backend:  Can  be faster on edge devices where CPU and network bandwidth is limited as the shared S3 compatible gateways take care about the encrypt
       ing/decryption and erasure coding and no download/upload amplification.

    Decentralization:

      Storj backend: high.  Data is downloaded directly from the distributed cloud of storage providers.

      S3 backend: low.  Requires a running S3 gateway (either self-hosted or Storj-hosted).

    Limitations:

      Storj backend: rclone checksum is not possible without download, as checksum metadata is not calculated during upload

      S3 backend: secret encryption key is shared with the gateway

Configuration

   To make a new Storj configuration you need one of the following: *  Access  Grant  that  someone  else  shared  with  you.   *  API  Key  (https://documenta
   tion.storj.io/getting-started/uploading-your-first-object/create-an-api-key) of a Storj project you are a member of.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

Setup with access grant

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Storj Decentralized Cloud Storage
             \ "storj"
          [snip]
          Storage> storj
          ** See help for storj backend at: https://rclone.org/storj/ **

          Choose an authentication method.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("existing").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Use an existing access grant.
             \ "existing"
           2 / Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.
             \ "new"
          provider> existing
          Access Grant.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          access_grant> your-access-grant-received-by-someone-else
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = storj
          access_grant = your-access-grant-received-by-someone-else
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Setup with API key and passphrase

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Storj Decentralized Cloud Storage
             \ "storj"
          [snip]
          Storage> storj
          ** See help for storj backend at: https://rclone.org/storj/ **

          Choose an authentication method.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("existing").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Use an existing access grant.
             \ "existing"
           2 / Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.
             \ "new"
          provider> new
          Satellite Address. Custom satellite address should match the format: `<nodeid>@<address>:<port>`.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("us1.storj.io").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / US1
             \ "us1.storj.io"
           2 / EU1
             \ "eu1.storj.io"
           3 / AP1
             \ "ap1.storj.io"
          satellite_address> 1
          API Key.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          api_key> your-api-key-for-your-storj-project
          Encryption Passphrase. To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          passphrase> your-human-readable-encryption-passphrase
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = storj
          satellite_address = 12EayRS2V1kEsWESU9QMRseFhdxYxKicsiFmxrsLZHeLUtdps3S@us1.storj.io:7777
          api_key = your-api-key-for-your-storj-project
          passphrase = your-human-readable-encryption-passphrase
          access_grant = the-access-grant-generated-from-the-api-key-and-passphrase
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to storj (Storj Decentralized Cloud Storage).

--storj-provider

   Choose an authentication method.

   Properties:

    Config: provider

    Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_PROVIDER

    Type: string

    Default: "existing"

    Examples:

      "existing"

        Use an existing access grant.

      "new"

        Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.

--storj-access-grant

   Access grant.

   Properties:

    Config: access_grant

    Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_ACCESS_GRANT

    Provider: existing

    Type: string

    Required: false

--storj-satellite-address

   Satellite address.

   Custom satellite address should match the format: <nodeid>@<address>:<port>.

   Properties:

    Config: satellite_address

    Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_SATELLITE_ADDRESS

    Provider: new

    Type: string

    Default: "us1.storj.io"

    Examples:

      "us1.storj.io"

        US1

      "eu1.storj.io"

        EU1

      "ap1.storj.io"

        AP1

--storj-api-key

   API key.

   Properties:

    Config: api_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_API_KEY

    Provider: new

    Type: string

    Required: false

--storj-passphrase

   Encryption passphrase.

   To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.

   Properties:

    Config: passphrase

    Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_PASSPHRASE

    Provider: new

    Type: string

    Required: false

Usage

   Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsf command.)  You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this.

Create a new bucket

   Use the mkdir command to create new bucket, e.g.  bucket.

          rclone mkdir remote:bucket

List all buckets

   Use the lsf command to list all buckets.

          rclone lsf remote:

   Note the colon (:) character at the end of the command line.

Delete a bucket

   Use the rmdir command to delete an empty bucket.

          rclone rmdir remote:bucket

   Use the purge command to delete a non-empty bucket with all its content.

          rclone purge remote:bucket

Upload objects

   Use the copy command to upload an object.

          rclone copy --progress /home/local/directory/file.ext remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.  Remove it if you don't need this information.

   Use a folder in the local path to upload all its objects.

          rclone copy --progress /home/local/directory/ remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Only modified files will be copied.

List objects

   Use the ls command to list recursively all objects in a bucket.

          rclone ls remote:bucket

   Add the folder to the remote path to list recursively all objects in this folder.

          rclone ls remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Use the lsf command to list non-recursively all objects in a bucket or a folder.

          rclone lsf remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Download objects

   Use the copy command to download an object.

          rclone copy --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/file.ext /home/local/directory/

   The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.  Remove it if you don't need this information.

   Use a folder in the remote path to download all its objects.

          rclone copy --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/ /home/local/directory/

Delete objects

   Use the deletefile command to delete a single object.

          rclone deletefile remote:bucket/path/to/dir/file.ext

   Use the delete command to delete all object in a folder.

          rclone delete remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Print the total size of objects

   Use the size command to print the total size of objects in a bucket or a folder.

          rclone size remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Sync two Locations

   Use the sync command to sync the source to the destination, changing the destination only, deleting any excess files.

          rclone sync --interactive --progress /home/local/directory/ remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.  Remove it if you don't need this information.

   Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run flag to see exactly what would be copied and deleted.

   The sync can be done also from Storj to the local file system.

          rclone sync --interactive --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/ /home/local/directory/

   Or between two Storj buckets.

          rclone sync --interactive --progress remote-us:bucket/path/to/dir/ remote-europe:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Or even between another cloud storage and Storj.

          rclone sync --interactive --progress s3:bucket/path/to/dir/ storj:bucket/path/to/dir/

Limitations

   rclone  about  is  not supported by the rclone Storj backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy
   mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Known issues

   If you get errors like too many open files this usually happens when the default ulimit for system max open files is exceeded.  Native Storj protocol opens a
   large number of TCP connections (each of which is counted as an open file).  For a single upload stream you can expect 110 TCP connections to be opened.  For
   a  single download stream you can expect 35.  This batch of connections will be opened for every 64 MiB segment and you should also expect TCP connections to
   be reused.  If you do many transfers you eventually open a connection to most storage nodes (thousands of nodes).

   To fix these, please raise your system limits.  You can do this issuing a ulimit -n 65536 just before you run rclone.  To change the limits more  permanently
   you  can  add  this  to your shell startup script, e.g.  $HOME/.bashrc, or change the system-wide configuration, usually /etc/sysctl.conf and/or /etc/securi
   ty/limits.conf, but please refer to your operating system manual.

SugarSync

   SugarSync (https://sugarsync.com) is a cloud service that enables active synchronization of files across computers and other devices for file backup, access,
   syncing, and sharing.

Configuration

   The initial setup for SugarSync involves getting a token from SugarSync which you can do with rclone.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Sugarsync
             \ "sugarsync"
          [snip]
          Storage> sugarsync
          ** See help for sugarsync backend at: https://rclone.org/sugarsync/ **

          Sugarsync App ID.
          Leave blank to use rclone's.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          app_id>
          Sugarsync Access Key ID.
          Leave blank to use rclone's.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          access_key_id>
          Sugarsync Private Access Key
          Leave blank to use rclone's.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          private_access_key>
          Permanently delete files if true
          otherwise put them in the deleted files.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          hard_delete>
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Username (email address)> nick@craig-wood.com
          Your Sugarsync password is only required during setup and will not be stored.
          password:
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = sugarsync
          refresh_token = https://api.sugarsync.com/app-authorization/XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Note that the config asks for your email and password but doesn't store them, it only uses them to get the initial token.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories (sync folders) in top level of your SugarSync

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your SugarSync folder "Test"

          rclone ls remote:Test

   To copy a local directory to an SugarSync folder called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

   NB you can't create files in the top level folder you have to create a folder, which rclone will create as a "Sync Folder" with SugarSync.

Modified time and hashes

   SugarSync  does  not  support  modification  times  or hashes, therefore syncing will default to --size-only checking.  Note that using --update will work as
   rclone can read the time files were uploaded.

Restricted filename characters

   SugarSync replaces the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) except for DEL.

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in XML strings.

Deleting files

   Deleted files will be moved to the "Deleted items" folder by default.

   However you can supply the flag --sugarsync-hard-delete or set the config parameter hard_delete = true if you would like files to be deleted straight away.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to sugarsync (Sugarsync).

--sugarsync-app-id

   Sugarsync App ID.

   Leave blank to use rclone's.

   Properties:

    Config: app_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_APP_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-access-key-id

   Sugarsync Access Key ID.

   Leave blank to use rclone's.

   Properties:

    Config: access_key_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ACCESS_KEY_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-private-access-key

   Sugarsync Private Access Key.

   Leave blank to use rclone's.

   Properties:

    Config: private_access_key

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_PRIVATE_ACCESS_KEY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-hard-delete

   Permanently delete files if true otherwise put them in the deleted files.

   Properties:

    Config: hard_delete

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_HARD_DELETE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to sugarsync (Sugarsync).

--sugarsync-refresh-token

   Sugarsync refresh token.

   Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: refresh_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_REFRESH_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-authorization

   Sugarsync authorization.

   Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: authorization

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_AUTHORIZATION

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-authorization-expiry

   Sugarsync authorization expiry.

   Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: authorization_expiry

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_AUTHORIZATION_EXPIRY

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-user

   Sugarsync user.

   Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_USER

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-root-id

   Sugarsync root id.

   Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: root_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ROOT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-deleted-id

   Sugarsync deleted folder id.

   Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

   Properties:

    Config: deleted_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_DELETED_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--sugarsync-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   rclone about is not supported by the SugarSync backend.  Backends without this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use  policy  mfs
   (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

   See  List  of  backends  that  do  not  support  rclone  about  (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  and  rclone  about (https://rclone.org/com‐
   mands/rclone_about/)

Tardigrade

   The Tardigrade backend has been renamed to be the Storj backend (https://rclone.org/storj/).  Old configuration files will continue to work.

Uptobox

   This is a Backend for Uptobox file storage service.  Uptobox is closer to a one-click hoster than a traditional cloud  storage  provider  and  therefore  not
   suitable for long term storage.

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   To configure an Uptobox backend you'll need your personal api token.  You'll find it in your account settings (https://uptobox.com/my_account)

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote with the default setup.  First run:

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          TestUptobox          uptobox

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
          name> uptobox
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [...]
          37 / Uptobox
             \ "uptobox"
          [...]
          Storage> uptobox
          ** See help for uptobox backend at: https://rclone.org/uptobox/ **

          Your API Key, get it from https://uptobox.com/my_account
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          api_key> xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [uptobox]
          type = uptobox
          api_key = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d>

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your Uptobox

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your Uptobox

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an Uptobox directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   Uptobox supports neither modified times nor checksums.

Restricted filename characters

   In addition to the default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the following characters are also replaced:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   "           0x22        
   `           0x41        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in XML strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to uptobox (Uptobox).

--uptobox-access-token

   Your access token.

   Get it from https://uptobox.com/my_account.

   Properties:

    Config: access_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_UPTOBOX_ACCESS_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to uptobox (Uptobox).

--uptobox-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_UPTOBOX_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,BackQuote,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   Uptobox will delete inactive files that have not been accessed in 60 days.

   rclone about is not supported by this backend an overview of used space can however been seen in the uptobox web interface.

Union

   The union remote provides a unification similar to UnionFS using other remotes.

   Paths may be as deep as required or a local path, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory or /directory/subdirectory.

   During  the  initial  setup  with  rclone config you will specify the upstream remotes as a space separated list.  The upstream remotes can either be a local
   paths or other remotes.

   Attribute :ro and :nc can be attach to the end of path to tag the remote as read only or no create, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory:ro or remote:directo
   ry/subdirectory:nc.

   Subfolders  can be used in upstream remotes.  Assume a union remote named backup with the remotes mydrive:private/backup.  Invoking rclone mkdir backup:desk
   top is exactly the same as invoking rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/desktop.

   There will be no special handling of paths containing ..  segments.  Invoking rclone mkdir backup:../desktop is exactly the same as invoking rclone mkdir my
   drive:private/backup/../desktop.

Configuration

   Here is an example of how to make a union called remote for local folders.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Union merges the contents of several remotes
             \ "union"
          [snip]
          Storage> union
          List of space separated upstreams.
          Can be 'upstreama:test/dir upstreamb:', '\"upstreama:test/space:ro dir\" upstreamb:', etc.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          upstreams> remote1:dir1 remote2:dir2 remote3:dir3
          Policy to choose upstream on ACTION class.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("epall").
          action_policy>
          Policy to choose upstream on CREATE class.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("epmfs").
          create_policy>
          Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH class.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("ff").
          search_policy>
          Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds). This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used.
          Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default ("120").
          cache_time>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = union
          upstreams = remote1:dir1 remote2:dir2 remote3:dir3
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          remote               union

          e) Edit existing remote
          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          r) Rename remote
          c) Copy remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level in remote1:dir1, remote2:dir2 and remote3:dir3

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in remote1:dir1, remote2:dir2 and remote3:dir3

          rclone ls remote:

   Copy another local directory to the union directory called source, which will be placed into remote3:dir3

          rclone copy C:\source remote:source

Behavior / Policies

   The  behavior of union backend is inspired by trapexit/mergerfs (https://github.com/trapexit/mergerfs).  All functions are grouped into 3 categories: action,
   create and search.  These functions and categories can be assigned a policy which dictates what file or directory is chosen when  performing  that  behavior.
   Any policy can be assigned to a function or category though some may not be very useful in practice.  For instance: rand (random) may be useful for file cre
   ation (create) but could lead to very odd behavior if used for delete if there were more than one copy of the file.

Function / Category classifications

   Cate    Description       Functions
   gory
   
   action   Writing  Exist   move, rmdir, rmdirs, delete, purge and copy, sync
            ing file          (as destination when file exist)
   create   Create  non-ex   copy, sync (as destination when file not exist)
            isting file
   search   Reading     and   ls, lsd, lsl, cat, md5sum, sha1sum and copy, sync
            listing file      (as source)
   N/A                        size, about

Path Preservation

   Policies, as described below, are of two basic types.  path preserving and non-path preserving.

   All policies which start with ep (epff, eplfs, eplus, epmfs, eprand) are path preserving.  ep stands for existing path.

   A path preserving policy will only consider upstreams where the relative path being accessed already exists.

   When using non-path preserving policies paths will be created in target upstreams as necessary.

Quota Relevant Policies

   Some policies rely on quota information.  These policies should be used only if your upstreams support the respective quota fields.

   Policy       Required Field
   
   lfs, eplfs   Free
   mfs, epmfs   Free
   lus, eplus   Used
   lno, eplno   Objects

   To check if your upstream supports the field, run rclone about remote: [flags] and see if the required field exists.

Filters

   Policies basically search upstream remotes and create a list of files / paths for functions to work on.  The policy is responsible for filtering and sorting.
   The policy type defines the sorting but filtering is mostly uniform as described below.

    No search policies filter.

    All action policies will filter out remotes which are tagged as read-only.

    All create policies will filter out remotes which are tagged read-only or no-create.

   If all remotes are filtered an error will be returned.

Policy descriptions

   The  policies  definition are inspired by trapexit/mergerfs (https://github.com/trapexit/mergerfs) but not exactly the same.  Some policy definition could be
   different due to the much larger latency of remote file systems.

   Policy             Description
   
   all                Search category: same as epall.  Action category: same
                      as epall.  Create category: act on all upstreams.
   epall  (existing   Search category: Given this order configured,  act  on
   path, all)         the  first  one  found where the relative path exists.
                      Action category: apply to all found.  Create category:
                      act on all upstreams where the relative path exists.
   epff   (existing   Act  on the first one found, by the time upstreams re
   path,      first   ply, where the relative path exists.
   found)
   eplfs  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
   path, least free   choose the one with the least free space.
   space)
   eplus  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
   path, least used   choose the one with the least used space.
   space)
   eplno  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
   path, least num   choose the one with the least number of objects.
   ber of objects)
   epmfs  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
   path, most  free   choose the one with the most free space.
   space)
   eprand (existing   Calls epall and then randomizes.  Returns only one up
   path, random)      stream.
   ff (first found)   Search category: same as epff.  Action category:  same
                      as  epff.  Create category: Act on the first one found
                      by the time upstreams reply.
   lfs (least  free   Search category: same as eplfs.  Action category: same
   space)             as eplfs.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                      least available free space.
   lus  (least used   Search category: same as eplus.  Action category: same
   space)             as eplus.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                      least used space.
   lno (least  num   Search category: same as eplno.  Action category: same
   ber of objects)    as eplno.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                      least number of objects.
   mfs  (most  free   Search category: same as epmfs.  Action category: same
   space)             as epmfs.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                      most available free space.
   newest             Pick the file / directory with the largest mtime.

   rand (random)      Calls all and then randomizes.  Returns only  one  up
                      stream.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to union (Union merges the contents of several upstream fs).

--union-upstreams

   List of space separated upstreams.

   Can be 'upstreama:test/dir upstreamb:', '"upstreama:test/space:ro dir" upstreamb:', etc.

   Properties:

    Config: upstreams

    Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_UPSTREAMS

    Type: string

    Required: true

--union-action-policy

   Policy to choose upstream on ACTION category.

   Properties:

    Config: action_policy

    Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_ACTION_POLICY

    Type: string

    Default: "epall"

--union-create-policy

   Policy to choose upstream on CREATE category.

   Properties:

    Config: create_policy

    Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_CREATE_POLICY

    Type: string

    Default: "epmfs"

--union-search-policy

   Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH category.

   Properties:

    Config: search_policy

    Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_SEARCH_POLICY

    Type: string

    Default: "ff"

--union-cache-time

   Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds).

   This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used.

   Properties:

    Config: cache_time

    Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_CACHE_TIME

    Type: int

    Default: 120

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to union (Union merges the contents of several upstream fs).

--union-min-free-space

   Minimum viable free space for lfs/eplfs policies.

   If a remote has less than this much free space then it won't be considered for use in lfs or eplfs policies.

   Properties:

    Config: min_free_space

    Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_MIN_FREE_SPACE

    Type: SizeSuffix

    Default: 1Gi

Metadata

   Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

WebDAV

   Paths are specified as remote:path

   Paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Configuration

   To  configure  the WebDAV remote you will need to have a URL for it, and a username and password.  If you know what kind of system you are connecting to then
   rclone can enable extra features.

   Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

           rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / WebDAV
             \ "webdav"
          [snip]
          Storage> webdav
          URL of http host to connect to
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Connect to example.com
             \ "https://example.com"
          url> https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/
          Name of the WebDAV site/service/software you are using
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Nextcloud
             \ "nextcloud"
           2 / Owncloud
             \ "owncloud"
           3 / Sharepoint Online, authenticated by Microsoft account.
             \ "sharepoint"
           4 / Sharepoint with NTLM authentication. Usually self-hosted or on-premises.
             \ "sharepoint-ntlm"
           5 / Other site/service or software
             \ "other"
          vendor> 1
          User name
          user> user
          Password.
          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          n) No leave this optional password blank
          y/g/n> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:
          Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)
          bearer_token>
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = webdav
          url = https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/
          vendor = nextcloud
          user = user
          pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          bearer_token =
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   List directories in top level of your WebDAV

          rclone lsd remote:

   List all the files in your WebDAV

          rclone ls remote:

   To copy a local directory to an WebDAV directory called backup

          rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

   Plain WebDAV does not support modified times.  However when used with Owncloud or Nextcloud rclone will support modified times.

   Likewise plain WebDAV does not support hashes, however when used with Owncloud or Nextcloud rclone will support SHA1 and MD5 hashes.  Depending on the  exact
   version of Owncloud or Nextcloud hashes may appear on all objects, or only on objects which had a hash uploaded with them.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to webdav (WebDAV).

--webdav-url

   URL of http host to connect to.

   E.g.  https://example.com.

   Properties:

    Config: url

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_URL

    Type: string

    Required: true

--webdav-vendor

   Name of the WebDAV site/service/software you are using.

   Properties:

    Config: vendor

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_VENDOR

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "nextcloud"

        Nextcloud

      "owncloud"

        Owncloud

      "sharepoint"

        Sharepoint Online, authenticated by Microsoft account

      "sharepoint-ntlm"

        Sharepoint with NTLM authentication, usually self-hosted or on-premises

      "other"

        Other site/service or software

--webdav-user

   User name.

   In case NTLM authentication is used, the username should be in the format 'Domain'.

   Properties:

    Config: user

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_USER

    Type: string

    Required: false

--webdav-pass

   Password.

   NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

   Properties:

    Config: pass

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_PASS

    Type: string

    Required: false

--webdav-bearer-token

   Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g.  a Macaroon).

   Properties:

    Config: bearer_token

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_BEARER_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to webdav (WebDAV).

--webdav-bearer-token-command

   Command to run to get a bearer token.

   Properties:

    Config: bearer_token_command

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_BEARER_TOKEN_COMMAND

    Type: string

    Required: false

--webdav-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Default encoding is Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Hash,Percent,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8
   for sharepoint-ntlm or identity otherwise.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_ENCODING

    Type: string

    Required: false

--webdav-headers

   Set HTTP headers for all transactions.

   Use this to set additional HTTP headers for all transactions

   The input format is comma separated list of key,value pairs.  Standard CSV encoding (https://godoc.org/encoding/csv) may be used.

   For example, to set a Cookie use 'Cookie,name=value', or '"Cookie","name=value"'.

   You can set multiple headers, e.g.  '"Cookie","name=value","Authorization","xxx"'.

   Properties:

    Config: headers

    Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_HEADERS

    Type: CommaSepList

    Default:

Provider notes

   See below for notes on specific providers.

Owncloud

   Click on the settings cog in the bottom right of the page and this will show the WebDAV URL that rclone needs in the config step.   It  will  look  something
   like https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/.

   Owncloud supports modified times using the X-OC-Mtime header.

Nextcloud

   This  is  configured in an identical way to Owncloud.  Note that Nextcloud initially did not support streaming of files (rcat) whereas Owncloud did, but this
   (https://github.com/nextcloud/nextcloud-snap/issues/365) seems to be fixed as of 2020-11-27 (tested with rclone v1.53.1 and Nextcloud Server v19).

Sharepoint Online

   Rclone can be used with Sharepoint provided by OneDrive for Business or Office365 Education Accounts.  This feature is only needed for a  few  of  these  Ac
   counts,  mostly  Office365  Education  ones.  These accounts are sometimes not verified by the domain owner github#1975 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/is‐
   sues/1975)

   This means that these accounts can't be added using the official API (other Accounts should work with the "onedrive" option).  However, it is possible to ac‐
   cess them using webdav.

   To use a sharepoint remote with rclone, add it like this: First, you need to get your remote's URL:

    Go here (https://onedrive.live.com/about/en-us/signin/) to open your OneDrive or to sign in

    Now take a look at your address bar, the URL should look like this: https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/_layouts/15/onedrive.aspx

   You'll  only  need  this  URL  up to the email address.  After that, you'll most likely want to add "/Documents".  That subdirectory contains the actual data
   stored on your OneDrive.

   Add the remote to rclone like this: Configure the url as https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/Documents and use your normal  account
   email and password for user and pass.  If you have 2FA enabled, you have to generate an app password.  Set the vendor to sharepoint.

   Your config file should look like this:

          [sharepoint]
          type = webdav
          url = https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/Documents
          vendor = sharepoint
          user = YourEmailAddress
          pass = encryptedpassword

Sharepoint with NTLM Authentication

   Use this option in case your (hosted) Sharepoint is not tied to OneDrive accounts and uses NTLM authentication.

   To get the url configuration, similarly to the above, first navigate to the desired directory in your browser to get the URL, then strip everything after the
   name of the opened directory.

   Example: If the URL is: https://example.sharepoint.com/sites/12345/Documents/Forms/AllItems.aspx

   The configuration to use would be: https://example.sharepoint.com/sites/12345/Documents

   Set the vendor to sharepoint-ntlm.

   NTLM uses domain and user name combination for authentication, set user to DOMAIN\username.

   Your config file should look like this:

          [sharepoint]
          type = webdav
          url = https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]/some-path-to/Documents
          vendor = sharepoint-ntlm
          user = DOMAIN\user
          pass = encryptedpassword

Required Flags for SharePoint

   As SharePoint does some special things with uploaded documents, you won't be able to use the documents size or the documents hash to compare if  a  file  has
   been changed since the upload / which file is newer.

   For  Rclone  calls  copying  files  (especially Office files such as .docx, .xlsx, etc.)  from/to SharePoint (like copy, sync, etc.), you should append these
   flags to ensure Rclone uses the "Last Modified" datetime property to compare your documents:

          --ignore-size --ignore-checksum --update

dCache

   dCache is a storage system that supports many protocols and authentication/authorisation schemes.  For WebDAV clients, it allows users to  authenticate  with
   username    and   password   (BASIC),   X.509,   Kerberos,   and   various   bearer   tokens,   including   Macaroons   (https://www.dcache.org/manuals/work
   shop-2017-05-29-Umea/000-Final/anupam_macaroons_v02.pdf) and OpenID-Connect (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/OpenID_Connect) access tokens.

   Configure as normal using the other type.  Don't enter a username or password, instead enter your Macaroon as the bearer_token.

   The config will end up looking something like this.

          [dcache]
          type = webdav
          url = https://dcache...
          vendor = other
          user =
          pass =
          bearer_token = your-macaroon

   There is a script (https://github.com/sara-nl/GridScripts/blob/master/get-macaroon) that obtains a Macaroon from a dCache WebDAV  endpoint,  and  creates  an
   rclone config file.

   Macaroons may also be obtained from the dCacheView web-browser/JavaScript client that comes with dCache.

OpenID-Connect

   dCache  also  supports  authenticating with OpenID-Connect access tokens.  OpenID-Connect is a protocol (based on OAuth 2.0) that allows services to identify
   users who have authenticated with some central service.

   Support for OpenID-Connect in rclone is currently achieved using another software package called oidc-agent (https://github.com/indigo-dc/oidc-agent).   This
   is a command-line tool that facilitates obtaining an access token.  Once installed and configured, an access token is obtained by running the oidc-token com
   mand.  The following example shows a (shortened) access token obtained from the XDC OIDC Provider.

          paul@celebrimbor:~$ oidc-token XDC
          eyJraWQ[...]QFXDt0
          paul@celebrimbor:~$

   Note Before the oidc-token command will work, the refresh token must be loaded into the oidc agent.  This is done with the oidc-add command  (e.g.,  oidc-add
   XDC).   This is typically done once per login session.  Full details on this and how to register oidc-agent with your OIDC Provider are provided in the oidc-
   agent documentation (https://indigo-dc.gitbooks.io/oidc-agent/).

   The rclone bearer_token_command configuration option is used to fetch the access token from oidc-agent.

   Configure as a normal WebDAV endpoint, using the 'other' vendor, leaving the username and password empty.  When prompted, choose to edit the advanced  config
   and enter the command to get a bearer token (e.g., oidc-agent XDC).

   The following example config shows a WebDAV endpoint that uses oidc-agent to supply an access token from the XDC OIDC Provider.

          [dcache]
          type = webdav
          url = https://dcache.example.org/
          vendor = other
          bearer_token_command = oidc-token XDC

Yandex Disk

   Yandex Disk (https://disk.yandex.com) is a cloud storage solution created by Yandex (https://yandex.com).

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a yandex configuration.  First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          n/s> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Yandex Disk
             \ "yandex"
          [snip]
          Storage> yandex
          Yandex Client Id - leave blank normally.
          client_id>
          Yandex Client Secret - leave blank normally.
          client_secret>
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes
          n) No
          y/n> y
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          --------------------
          [remote]
          client_id =
          client_secret =
          token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"OAuth","expiry":"2016-12-29T12:27:11.362788025Z"}
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Note  that  rclone  runs  a  webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned from Yandex Disk.  This only runs from the moment it opens your
   browser to the moment you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it  temporarily  if  you
   are running a host firewall.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   See top level directories

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new directory

          rclone mkdir remote:directory

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:directory

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any excess files in the path.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:directory

   Yandex paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

Modified time

   Modified times are supported and are stored accurate to 1 ns in custom metadata called rclone_modified in RFC3339 with nanoseconds format.

MD5 checksums

   MD5 checksums are natively supported by Yandex Disk.

Emptying Trash

   If  you  wish to empty your trash you can use the rclone cleanup remote: command which will permanently delete all your trashed files.  This command does not
   take any path arguments.

Quota information

   To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display your usage limit (quota) and the current usage.

Restricted filename characters

   The default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) are replaced.

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to yandex (Yandex Disk).

--yandex-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--yandex-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to yandex (Yandex Disk).

--yandex-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--yandex-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--yandex-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--yandex-hard-delete

   Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

   Properties:

    Config: hard_delete

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_HARD_DELETE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--yandex-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

   When uploading very large files (bigger than about 5 GiB) you will need to increase the --timeout parameter.  This is because Yandex pauses (perhaps to  cal
   culate  the  MD5SUM for the entire file) before returning confirmation that the file has been uploaded.  The default handling of timeouts in rclone is to as
   sume a 5 minute pause is an error and close the connection - you'll see net/http: timeout awaiting response headers errors in the logs if this is  happening.
   Setting  the  timeout  to  twice  the max size of file in GiB should be enough, so if you want to upload a 30 GiB file set a timeout of 2 * 30 = 60m, that is
   --timeout 60m.

   Having a Yandex Mail account is mandatory to use the Yandex.Disk subscription.  Token generation will work without a mail account, but Rclone won't  be  able
   to complete any actions.

          [403 - DiskUnsupportedUserAccountTypeError] User account type is not supported.

Zoho Workdrive

   Zoho WorkDrive (https://www.zoho.com/workdrive/) is a cloud storage solution created by Zoho (https://zoho.com).

Configuration

   Here is an example of making a zoho configuration.  First run

          rclone config

   This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          n/s> n
          name> remote
          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          [snip]
          XX / Zoho
             \ "zoho"
          [snip]
          Storage> zoho
          ** See help for zoho backend at: https://rclone.org/zoho/ **

          OAuth Client Id
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          client_id>
          OAuth Client Secret
          Leave blank normally.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          client_secret>
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          Use web browser to automatically authenticate rclone with remote?
           * Say Y if the machine running rclone has a web browser you can use
           * Say N if running rclone on a (remote) machine without web browser access
          If not sure try Y. If Y failed, try N.
          y) Yes (default)
          n) No
          y/n>
          If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=LVn0IHzxej1ZkmQw31d0wQ
          Log in and authorize rclone for access
          Waiting for code...
          Got code
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / MyTeam
             \ "4u28602177065ff22426787a6745dba8954eb"
          Enter a Team ID> 1
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / General
             \ "4u2869d2aa6fca04f4f2f896b6539243b85b1"
          Enter a Workspace ID> 1
          --------------------
          [remote]
          type = zoho
          token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"Zoho-oauthtoken","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"2020-10-12T00:54:52.370275223+02:00"}
          root_folder_id = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d>

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a machine with no Internet browser available.

   Rclone  runs  a webserver on your local computer to collect the authorization token from Zoho Workdrive.  This is only from the moment your browser is opened
   until the token is returned.  The webserver runs on http://127.0.0.1:53682/.  If local port 53682 is protected by a firewall you may need to temporarily  un
   block the firewall to complete authorization.

   Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

   See top level directories

          rclone lsd remote:

   Make a new directory

          rclone mkdir remote:directory

   List the contents of a directory

          rclone ls remote:directory

   Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any excess files in the path.

          rclone sync --interactive /home/local/directory remote:directory

   Zoho paths may be as deep as required, eg remote:directory/subdirectory.

Modified time

   Modified times are currently not supported for Zoho Workdrive

Checksums

   No checksums are supported.

Usage information

   To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display your current usage.

Restricted filename characters

   Only  control  characters  and  invalid UTF-8 are replaced.  In addition most Unicode full-width characters are not supported at all and will be removed from
   filenames during upload.

Standard options

   Here are the Standard options specific to zoho (Zoho).

--zoho-client-id

   OAuth Client Id.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_id

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_CLIENT_ID

    Type: string

    Required: false

--zoho-client-secret

   OAuth Client Secret.

   Leave blank normally.

   Properties:

    Config: client_secret

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_CLIENT_SECRET

    Type: string

    Required: false

--zoho-region

   Zoho region to connect to.

   You'll have to use the region your organization is registered in.  If not sure use the same top level domain as you connect to in your browser.

   Properties:

    Config: region

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_REGION

    Type: string

    Required: false

    Examples:

      "com"

        United states / Global

      "eu"

        Europe

      "in"

        India

      "jp"

        Japan

      "com.cn"

        China

      "com.au"

        Australia

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to zoho (Zoho).

--zoho-token

   OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

   Properties:

    Config: token

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_TOKEN

    Type: string

    Required: false

--zoho-auth-url

   Auth server URL.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: auth_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_AUTH_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--zoho-token-url

   Token server url.

   Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

   Properties:

    Config: token_url

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_TOKEN_URL

    Type: string

    Required: false

--zoho-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

Setting up your own client_id

   For Zoho we advise you to set up your own client_id.  To do so you have to complete the following steps.

   1. Log in to the Zoho API Console (https://api-console.zoho.com)

   2. Create a new client of type "Server-based Application".  The name and website don't matter, but you must add the redirect URL http://localhost:53682/.

   3. Once the client is created, you can go to the settings tab and enable it in other regions.

   The client id and client secret can now be used with rclone.

Local Filesystem

   Local paths are specified as normal filesystem paths, e.g.  /path/to/wherever, so

          rclone sync --interactive /home/source /tmp/destination

   Will sync /home/source to /tmp/destination.

Configuration

   For consistencies sake one can also configure a remote of type local in the config file, and access the local filesystem using rclone remote paths, e.g.  re
   mote:path/to/wherever, but it is probably easier not to.

Modified time

   Rclone reads and writes the modified time using an accuracy determined by the OS.  Typically this is 1ns on Linux, 10 ns on Windows and 1 Second on OS X.

Filenames

   Filenames should be encoded in UTF-8 on disk.  This is the normal case for Windows and OS X.

   There is a bit more uncertainty in the Linux world, but new distributions will have UTF-8 encoded files names.  If you are using an old Linux filesystem with
   non UTF-8 file names (e.g.  latin1) then you can use the convmv tool to convert the filesystem to UTF-8.  This tool is available in most distributions' pack
   age managers.

   If  an invalid (non-UTF8) filename is read, the invalid characters will be replaced with a quoted representation of the invalid bytes.  The name gro\xdf will
   be transferred as groDF.  rclone will emit a debug message in this case (use -v to see), e.g.

          Local file system at .: Replacing invalid UTF-8 characters in "gro\xdf"

Restricted characters

   With the local backend, restrictions on the characters that are usable in file or directory names depend on the operating system.  To check what rclone  will
   replace by default on your system, run rclone help flags local-encoding.

   On non Windows platforms the following characters are replaced when handling file names.

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   /           0x2F        

   When  running  on  Windows  the following characters are replaced.  This list is based on the Windows file naming conventions (https://docs.microsoft.com/de-
   de/windows/desktop/FileIO/naming-a-file#naming-conventions).

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   NUL         0x00         
   SOH         0x01         
   STX         0x02         
   ETX         0x03         
   EOT         0x04         
   ENQ         0x05         
   ACK         0x06         
   BEL         0x07         
   BS          0x08         
   HT          0x09         
   LF          0x0A         
   VT          0x0B         
   FF          0x0C         
   CR          0x0D         
   SO          0x0E         
   SI          0x0F         
   DLE         0x10         
   DC1         0x11         
   DC2         0x12         
   DC3         0x13         
   DC4         0x14         
   NAK         0x15         
   SYN         0x16         
   ETB         0x17         
   CAN         0x18         
   EM          0x19         
   SUB         0x1A         
   ESC         0x1B         
   FS          0x1C         
   GS          0x1D         
   RS          0x1E         
   US          0x1F         
   /           0x2F        
   "           0x22        
   *           0x2A        
   :           0x3A        
   <           0x3C        
   >           0x3E        
   ?           0x3F        
   \           0x5C        
   |           0x7C        

   File names on Windows can also not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

   Character   Value   Replacement
   
   SP          0x20         
   .           0x2E        

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they can't be converted to UTF-16.

Paths on Windows

   On Windows there are many ways of specifying a path to a file system resource.  Local paths can be absolute,  like  C:\path\to\wherever,  or  relative,  like
   ..\wherever.   Network  paths  in  UNC  format,  \\server\share,  are also supported.  Path separator can be either \ (as in C:\path\to\wherever) or / (as in
   C:/path/to/wherever).  Length of these paths are limited to 259 characters for files and 247 characters for directories, but there is an alternative  extend
   ed-length  path  format  increasing  the  limit  to  (approximately) 32,767 characters.  This format requires absolute paths and the use of prefix \\?\, e.g.
   \\?\D:\some\very\long\path.  For convenience rclone will automatically convert regular paths into the corresponding extended-length paths, so in  most  cases
   you do not have to worry about this (read more below).

   Note   that   Windows   supports   using   the   same   prefix   \\?\   to   specify   path   to   volumes   identified   by   their   GUID,  e.g.   \\?\Vol
   ume{b75e2c83-0000-0000-0000-602f00000000}\some\path.  This is not supported in rclone, due to an issue (https://github.com/golang/go/issues/39785) in go.

Long paths

   Rclone handles long paths automatically, by converting all paths to extended-length path format  (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/win32/fileio/maxi
   mum-file-path-limitation), which allows paths up to 32,767 characters.

   This  conversion  will  ensure  paths are absolute and prefix them with the \\?\.  This is why you will see that your paths, for instance .\files is shown as
   path \\?\C:\files in the output, and \\server\share as \\?\UNC\server\share.

   However, in rare cases this may cause problems with buggy file system drivers like EncFS (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/261).  To disable UNC  con
   version globally, add this to your .rclone.conf file:

          [local]
          nounc = true

   If you want to selectively disable UNC, you can add it to a separate entry like this:

          [nounc]
          type = local
          nounc = true

   And use rclone like this:

   rclone copy c:\src nounc:z:\dst

   This  will  use UNC paths on c:\src but not on z:\dst.  Of course this will cause problems if the absolute path length of a file exceeds 259 characters on z,
   so only use this option if you have to.

Symlinks / Junction points

   Normally rclone will ignore symlinks or junction points (which behave like symlinks under Windows).

   If you supply --copy-links or -L then rclone will follow the symlink and copy the pointed to file or directory.  Note that this  flag  is  incompatible  with
   --links / -l.

   This flag applies to all commands.

   For example, supposing you have a directory structure like this

          $ tree /tmp/a
          /tmp/a
           b -> ../b
           expected -> ../expected
           one
           two
               three

   Then you can see the difference with and without the flag like this

          $ rclone ls /tmp/a
                  6 one
                  6 two/three

   and

          $ rclone -L ls /tmp/a
               4174 expected
                  6 one
                  6 two/three
                  6 b/two
                  6 b/one

--links, -l

   Normally rclone will ignore symlinks or junction points (which behave like symlinks under Windows).

   If  you supply this flag then rclone will copy symbolic links from the local storage, and store them as text files, with a '.rclonelink' suffix in the remote
   storage.

   The text file will contain the target of the symbolic link (see example).

   This flag applies to all commands.

   For example, supposing you have a directory structure like this

          $ tree /tmp/a
          /tmp/a
           file1 -> ./file4
           file2 -> /home/user/file3

   Copying the entire directory with '-l'

          $ rclone copyto -l /tmp/a/file1 remote:/tmp/a/

   The remote files are created with a '.rclonelink' suffix

          $ rclone ls remote:/tmp/a
                 5 file1.rclonelink
                14 file2.rclonelink

   The remote files will contain the target of the symbolic links

          $ rclone cat remote:/tmp/a/file1.rclonelink
          ./file4

          $ rclone cat remote:/tmp/a/file2.rclonelink
          /home/user/file3

   Copying them back with '-l'

          $ rclone copyto -l remote:/tmp/a/ /tmp/b/

          $ tree /tmp/b
          /tmp/b
           file1 -> ./file4
           file2 -> /home/user/file3

   However, if copied back without '-l'

          $ rclone copyto remote:/tmp/a/ /tmp/b/

          $ tree /tmp/b
          /tmp/b
           file1.rclonelink
           file2.rclonelink

   Note that this flag is incompatible with -copy-links / -L.

Restricting filesystems with --one-file-system

   Normally rclone will recurse through filesystems as mounted.

   However if you set --one-file-system or -x this tells rclone to stay in the filesystem specified by the root and not to recurse into different file systems.

   For example if you have a directory hierarchy like this

          root
           disk1     - disk1 mounted on the root
              file3 - stored on disk1
           disk2     - disk2 mounted on the root
              file4 - stored on disk12
           file1     - stored on the root disk
           file2     - stored on the root disk

   Using rclone --one-file-system copy root remote: will only copy file1 and file2.  Eg

          $ rclone -q --one-file-system ls root
                  0 file1
                  0 file2

          $ rclone -q ls root
                  0 disk1/file3
                  0 disk2/file4
                  0 file1
                  0 file2

   NB Rclone (like most unix tools such as du, rsync and tar) treats a bind mount to the same device as being on the same filesystem.

   NB This flag is only available on Unix based systems.  On systems where it isn't supported (e.g.  Windows) it will be ignored.

Advanced options

   Here are the Advanced options specific to local (Local Disk).

--local-nounc

   Disable UNC (long path names) conversion on Windows.

   Properties:

    Config: nounc

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NOUNC

    Type: bool

    Default: false

    Examples:

      "true"

        Disables long file names.

--copy-links / -L

   Follow symlinks and copy the pointed to item.

   Properties:

    Config: copy_links

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_COPY_LINKS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--links / -l

   Translate symlinks to/from regular files with a '.rclonelink' extension.

   Properties:

    Config: links

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_LINKS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--skip-links

   Don't warn about skipped symlinks.

   This flag disables warning messages on skipped symlinks or junction points, as you explicitly acknowledge that they should be skipped.

   Properties:

    Config: skip_links

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-zero-size-links

   Assume the Stat size of links is zero (and read them instead) (deprecated).

   Rclone used to use the Stat size of links as the link size, but this fails in quite a few places:

    Windows

    On some virtual filesystems (such ash LucidLink)

    Android

   So rclone now always reads the link.

   Properties:

    Config: zero_size_links

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ZERO_SIZE_LINKS

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-unicode-normalization

   Apply unicode NFC normalization to paths and filenames.

   This flag can be used to normalize file names into unicode NFC form that are read from the local filesystem.

   Rclone does not normally touch the encoding of file names it reads from the file system.

   This can be useful when using macOS as it normally provides decomposed (NFD) unicode which in some language (eg Korean) doesn't display properly on some  OS‐
   es.

   Note that rclone compares filenames with unicode normalization in the sync routine so this flag shouldn't normally be used.

   Properties:

    Config: unicode_normalization

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_UNICODE_NORMALIZATION

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-no-check-updated

   Don't check to see if the files change during upload.

   Normally rclone checks the size and modification time of files as they are being uploaded and aborts with a message which starts "can't copy - source file is
   being updated" if the file changes during upload.

   However on some file systems this modification time check may fail (e.g.  Glusterfs #2206 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2206)) so this  check  can
   be disabled with this flag.

   If  this  flag is set, rclone will use its best efforts to transfer a file which is being updated.  If the file is only having things appended to it (e.g.  a
   log) then rclone will transfer the log file with the size it had the first time rclone saw it.

   If the file is being modified throughout (not just appended to) then the transfer may fail with a hash check failure.

   In detail, once the file has had stat() called on it for the first time we:

    Only transfer the size that stat gave

    Only checksum the size that stat gave

    Don't update the stat info for the file

   Properties:

    Config: no_check_updated

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_CHECK_UPDATED

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--one-file-system / -x

   Don't cross filesystem boundaries (unix/macOS only).

   Properties:

    Config: one_file_system

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ONE_FILE_SYSTEM

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-case-sensitive

   Force the filesystem to report itself as case sensitive.

   Normally the local backend declares itself as case insensitive on Windows/macOS and case sensitive for everything else.  Use this flag to  override  the  de
   fault choice.

   Properties:

    Config: case_sensitive

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_CASE_SENSITIVE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-case-insensitive

   Force the filesystem to report itself as case insensitive.

   Normally  the  local  backend declares itself as case insensitive on Windows/macOS and case sensitive for everything else.  Use this flag to override the de
   fault choice.

   Properties:

    Config: case_insensitive

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_CASE_INSENSITIVE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-no-preallocate

   Disable preallocation of disk space for transferred files.

   Preallocation of disk space helps prevent filesystem fragmentation.  However, some virtual filesystem layers (such as Google Drive File  Stream)  may  incor
   rectly set the actual file size equal to the preallocated space, causing checksum and file size checks to fail.  Use this flag to disable preallocation.

   Properties:

    Config: no_preallocate

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_PREALLOCATE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-no-sparse

   Disable sparse files for multi-thread downloads.

   On  Windows  platforms  rclone will make sparse files when doing multi-thread downloads.  This avoids long pauses on large files where the OS zeros the file.
   However sparse files may be undesirable as they cause disk fragmentation and can be slow to work with.

   Properties:

    Config: no_sparse

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_SPARSE

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-no-set-modtime

   Disable setting modtime.

   Normally rclone updates modification time of files after they are done uploading.  This can cause permissions issues on Linux platforms when the user  rclone
   is  running  as does not own the file uploaded, such as when copying to a CIFS mount owned by another user.  If this option is enabled, rclone will no longer
   update the modtime after copying a file.

   Properties:

    Config: no_set_modtime

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_SET_MODTIME

    Type: bool

    Default: false

--local-encoding

   The encoding for the backend.

   See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.

   Properties:

    Config: encoding

    Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ENCODING

    Type: MultiEncoder

    Default: Slash,Dot

Metadata

   Depending on which OS is in use the local backend may return only some of the system metadata.  Setting system metadata is supported on all OSes but  setting
   user   metadata   is   only   supported   on   linux,  freebsd,  netbsd,  macOS  and  Solaris.   It  is  not  supported  on  Windows  yet  (see  pkg/attrs#47
   (https://github.com/pkg/xattr/issues/47)).

   User metadata is stored as extended attributes (which may not be supported by all file systems) under the "user.*" prefix.

   Here are the possible system metadata items for the local backend.

   Name          Help          Type          Example                               Read Only
   
   atime         Time     of   RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                 last access
   btime         Time     of   RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                 file  birth
                 (creation)
   gid           Group ID of   decimal       500                                   N
                 owner         number
   mode          File   type   octal, unix   0100664                               N
                 and mode      style
   mtime         Time     of   RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                 last  modi
                 fication
   rdev          Device   ID   hexadecimal   1abc                                  N
                 (if special
                 file)
   uid           User ID  of   decimal       500                                   N
                 owner         number

   See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Backend commands

   Here are the commands specific to the local backend.

   Run them with

          rclone backend COMMAND remote:

   The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

   See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how to pass options and arguments.

   These can be run on a running backend using the rc command backend/command (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

noop

   A null operation for testing backend commands

          rclone backend noop remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   This is a test command which has some options you can try to change the output.

   Options:

    "echo": echo the input arguments

    "error": return an error based on option value

Changelog v1.62.2 - 2023-03-16

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.62.1...v1.62.2)

    Bug Fixes

      docker volume plugin: Add missing fuse3 dependency (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs: Fix size documentation (asdffdsazqqq)

    FTP

      Fix 426 errors on downloads with vsftpd (Lesmiscore)

v1.62.1 - 2023-03-15

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.62.0...v1.62.1)

    Bug Fixes

      docker: Add missing fuse3 dependency (cycneuramus)

      build: Update release docs to be more careful with the tag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build: Set Github release to draft while uploading binaries (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.62.0 - 2023-03-14

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.61.0...v1.62.0)

    New Features

      accounting: Make checkers show what they are doing (Nick Craig-Wood)

      authorize: Add support for custom templates (Hunter Wittenborn)

      build

        Update to go1.20 (Nick Craig-Wood, Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

        Add winget releaser workflow (Ryan Caezar Itang)

        Add dependabot (Ryan Caezar Itang)

      doc updates (albertony, Bryan Kaplan, Gerard Bosch, IMTheNachoMan, Justin Winokur, Manoj Ghosh, Nick Craig-Wood, Ole Frost,  Peter  Brunner,  piyushgarg,
       Ryan Caezar Itang, Simmon Li, ToBeFree)

      filter: Emit INFO message when can't work out directory filters (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • fs

       • Added multiple ca certificate support.  (alankrit)

       • Add --max-delete-size a delete size threshold (Leandro Sacchet)

     • fspath: Allow the symbols @ and + in remote names (albertony)

     • lib/terminal: Enable windows console virtual terminal sequences processing (ANSI/VT100 colors) (albertony)

     • move: If --check-first and --order-by are set then delete with perfect ordering (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • serve http: Support --auth-proxy (Matthias Baur)

   • Bug Fixes

     • accounting

       • Avoid negative ETA values for very slow speeds (albertony)

       • Limit length of ETA string (albertony)

       • Show human readable elapsed time when longer than a day (albertony)

     • all: Apply codeql fixes (Aaron Gokaslan)

     • build

       • Fix condition for manual workflow run (albertony)

       • Fix building for ARMv5 and ARMv6 (albertony)

         • selfupdate: Consider ARM version

         • install.sh: fix ARMv6 download

         • version: Report ARM version

     • deletefile: Return error code 4 if file does not exist (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • docker: Fix volume plugin does not remount volume on docker restart (logopk)

     • fs: Fix race conditions in --max-delete and --max-delete-size (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • lib/oauthutil: Handle fatal errors better (Alex Chen)

     • mount2: Fix --allow-non-empty (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • operations: Fix concurrency: use --checkers unless transferring files (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • serve ftp: Fix timestamps older than 1 year in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • sync: Fix concurrency: use --checkers unless transferring files (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • tree

       • Fix nil pointer exception on stat failure (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix colored output on windows (albertony)

       • Fix display of files with illegal Windows file system names (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Mount

     • Fix creating and renaming files on case insensitive backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Do not treat \\?\ prefixed paths as network share paths on windows (albertony)

     • Fix check for empty mount point on Linux (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix --allow-non-empty (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Avoid incorrect or premature overlap check on windows (albertony)

     • Update to fuse3 after bazil.org/fuse update (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • Make uploaded files retain modtime with non-modtime backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix incorrect modtime on fs which don't support setting modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix rename of directory containing files to be uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Fix %!w(<nil>) in "failed to read directory" error (Marks Polakovs)

      Fix exclusion of dangling symlinks with -L/--copy-links (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Crypt

      Obey --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix for unencrypted directory names on case insensitive remotes (Ole Frost)

    Azure Blob

      Remove workarounds for SDK bugs after v0.6.1 update (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Fix uploading files bigger than 1TiB (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Note that --drive-acknowledge-abuse needs SA Manager permission (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make --drive-stop-on-upload-limit to respond to storageQuotaExceeded (Ninh Pham)

    FTP

      Retry 426 errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Retry errors when initiating downloads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Revert to upstream github.com/jlaffaye/ftp now fix is merged (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add --gcs-env-auth to pick up IAM credentials from env/instance (Peter Brunner)

    Mega

      Add --mega-use-https flag (NodudeWasTaken)

    Onedrive

      Default onedrive personal to QuickXorHash as Microsoft is removing SHA1 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --onedrive-hash-type to change the hash in use (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Improve speed of QuickXorHash (LXY)

    Oracle Object Storage

      Speed up operations by using S3 pacer and setting minsleep to 10ms (Manoj Ghosh)

      Expose the storage_tier option in config (Manoj Ghosh)

      Bring your own encryption keys (Manoj Ghosh)

    S3

      Check multipart upload ETag when --s3-no-head is in use (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-sts-endpoint to specify STS endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix incorrect tier support for StorJ and IDrive when pointing at a file (Ole Frost)

      Fix AWS STS failing if --s3-endpoint is set (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make purge remove directory markers too (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Seafile

      Renew library password (Fred)

    SFTP

      Fix uploads being 65% slower than they should be with crypt (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Smb

      Allow SPN (service principal name) to be configured (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Check smb connection is closed (happyxhw)

    Storj

      Implement rclone link (Kaloyan Raev)

      Implement rclone purge (Kaloyan Raev)

      Update satellite urls and labels (Kaloyan Raev)

    WebDAV

      Fix interop with davrods server (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.61.1 - 2022-12-23

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.61.0...v1.61.1)

    Bug Fixes

      docs:

        Show only significant parts of version number in version introduced label (albertony)

        Fix unescaped HTML (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lib/http: Shutdown all servers on exit to remove unix socket (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc: Fix --rc-addr flag (which is an alternate for --url) (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

      serve restic

        Don't serve via http if serving via --stdio (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix immediate exit when not using stdio (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve webdav

        Fix --baseurl handling after lib/http refactor (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix running duplicate Serve call (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Fix "409 Public access is not permitted on this storage account" (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      storj: Update endpoints (Kaloyan Raev)

v1.61.0 - 2022-12-20

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.60.0...v1.61.0)

    New backends

      New S3 providers

        Liara LOS (https://rclone.org/s3/#liara-cloud) (MohammadReza)

    New Features

      build: Add vulnerability testing using govulncheck (albertony)

      cmd: Enable SIGINFO (Ctrl-T) handler on FreeBSD, NetBSD, OpenBSD and Dragonfly BSD (x3-apptech)

      config: Add config/setpath (https://rclone.org/rc/#config-setpath) for setting config path via rc/librclone (Nick Craig-Wood)

      dedupe

        Count Checks in the stats while scanning for duplicates (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make dedupe obey the filters (Nick Craig-Wood)

      dlna: Properly attribute code used from https://github.com/anacrolix/dms (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs

        Add minimum versions and status badges to backend and command docs (Nick Craig-Wood, albertony)

        Remote names may not start or end with space (albertony)

      filter: Add metadata filters --metadata-include/exclude/filter (https://rclone.org/filtering/#metadata) and friends (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fs

        Make all duration flags take y, M, w, d etc suffixes (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add global flag --color to control terminal colors (Kevin Verstaen)

      fspath: Allow unicode numbers and letters in remote names (albertony)

      lib/file: Improve error message for creating dir on non-existent network host on windows (albertony)

      lib/http: Finish port of rclone servers to lib/http (Tom Mombourquette, Nick Craig-Wood)

      lib/oauthutil: Improved usability of config flows needing web browser (Ole Frost)

      ncdu

        Add support for modification time (albertony)

        Fallback to sort by name also for sort by average size (albertony)

        Rework to use tcell directly instead of the termbox wrapper (eNV25)

      rc: Add commands to set GC Percent (https://rclone.org/rc/#debug-set-gc-percent) & Memory Limit (go 1.19+) (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

      rcat: Preserve metadata when Copy falls back to Rcat (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rcd: Refactor rclone rc server to use lib/http (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rcserver: Avoid generating default credentials with htpasswd (Kamui)

      restic: Refactor to use lib/http (Nolan Woods)

      serve http: Support unix sockets and multiple listeners (Tom Mombourquette)

      serve webdav: Refactor to use lib/http (Nick Craig-Wood)

      test: Replace defer cleanup with t.Cleanup (Eng Zer Jun)

      test memory: Read metadata if -M flag is specified (Nick Craig-Wood)

      wasm: Comply with wasm_exec.js licence terms (Matthew Vernon)

    Bug Fixes

      build: Update golang.org/x/net/http2 to fix GO-2022-1144 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      restic: Fix typo in docs 'remove' should be 'remote' (asdffdsazqqq)

      serve dlna: Fix panic: Logger uninitialized.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Update cgofuse for FUSE-T support for mounting volumes on Mac (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Windows: fix slow opening of exe files by not truncating files when not necessary (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix IO Error opening a file with O_CREATE|O_RDONLY in --vfs-cache-mode not full (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Crypt

      Fix compress wrapping crypt giving upload errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Port to new SDK (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Revamp authentication to include all methods and docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Port old authentication methods to new SDK (Nick Craig-Wood, Brad Ackerman)

        Thanks to Stonebranch (https://www.stonebranch.com/) for sponsoring this work.

      Add --azureblob-no-check-container to assume container exists (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --use-server-modtime support (Abdullah Saglam)

      Add support for custom upload headers (rkettelerij)

      Allow emulator account/key override (Roel Arents)

      Support simple "environment credentials" (Nathaniel Wesley Filardo)

      Ignore AuthorizationFailure when trying to create a create a container (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Box

      Added note on Box API rate limits (Ole Frost)

    Drive

      Handle shared drives with leading/trailing space in name (related to) (albertony)

    FTP

      Update help text of implicit/explicit TLS options to refer to FTPS instead of FTP (ycdtosa)

      Improve performance to speed up --files-from and NewObject (Anthony Pessy)

    HTTP

      Parse GET responses when no_head is set (Arnie97)

      Do not update object size based on Range requests (Arnie97)

      Support Content-Range response header (Arnie97)

    Onedrive

      Document workaround for shared with me files (vanplus)

    S3

      Add Liara LOS to provider list (MohammadReza)

      Add DigitalOcean Spaces regions sfo3, fra1, syd1 (Jack)

      Avoid privileged GetBucketLocation to resolve s3 region (Anthony Pessy)

      Stop setting object and bucket ACL to private if it is an empty string (Philip Harvey)

      If bucket or object ACL is empty string then don't add X-Amz-Acl: header (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Reduce memory consumption for s3 objects (Erik Agterdenbos)

      Fix listing loop when using v2 listing on v1 server (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix nil pointer exception when using Versions (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix excess memory usage when using versions (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Ignore versionIDs from uploads unless using --s3-versions or --s3-versions-at (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Add configuration options to set ssh Ciphers / MACs / KeyExchange (dgouju)

      Auto-detect shell type for fish (albertony)

      Fix NewObject with leading / (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Smb

      Fix issue where spurious dot directory is created (albertony)

    Storj

      Implement server side Copy (Kaloyan Raev)

v1.60.1 - 2022-11-17

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.60.0...v1.60.1)

    Bug Fixes

      lib/cache: Fix alias backend shutting down too soon (Nick Craig-Wood)

      wasm: Fix walltime link error by adding up-to-date wasm_exec.js (João Henrique Franco)

      docs

        Update faq.md with bisync (Samuel Johnson)

        Corrected download links in windows install docs (coultonluke)

        Add direct download link for windows arm64 (albertony)

        Remove link to rclone slack as it is no longer supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Faq: how to use a proxy server that requires a username and password (asdffdsazqqq)

        Oracle-object-storage: doc fix (Manoj Ghosh)

        Fix typo remove in rclone_serve_restic command (Joda Stößer)

        Fix character that was incorrectly interpreted as markdown (Clément Notin)

    VFS

      Fix deadlock caused by cache cleaner and upload finishing (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Clean absolute paths (albertony)

      Fix -L/--copy-links with filters missing directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mailru

      Note that an app password is now needed (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Allow timestamps to be before the epoch 1970-01-01 (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Add provider quirk --s3-might-gzip to fix corrupted on transfer: sizes differ (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Allow Storj to server side copy since it seems to work now (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix for unchecked err value in s3 listv2 (Aaron Gokaslan)

      Add additional Wasabi locations (techknowlogick)

    Smb

      Fix Failed to sync: context canceled at the end of syncs (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Fix Move/Copy/DirMove when using -server-side-across-configs (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.60.0 - 2022-10-21

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.59.0...v1.60.0)

    New backends

      Oracle object storage (https://rclone.org/oracleobjectstorage/) (Manoj Ghosh)

      SMB (https://rclone.org/smb/) / CIFS (Windows file sharing) (Lesmiscore)

      New S3 providers

        IONOS Cloud Storage (https://rclone.org/s3/#ionos) (Dmitry Deniskin)

        Qiniu KODO (https://rclone.org/s3/#qiniu) (Bachue Zhou)

    New Features

      build

        Update to go1.19 and make go1.17 the minimum required version (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Install.sh: fix arm-v7 download (Ole Frost)

      fs: Warn the user when using an existing remote name without a colon (Nick Craig-Wood)

      httplib: Add --xxx-min-tls-version option to select minimum TLS version for HTTP servers (Robert Newson)

      librclone: Add PHP bindings and test program (Jordi Gonzalez Muñoz)

      operations

        Add --server-side-across-configs global flag for any backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Optimise --copy-dest and --compare-dest (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc: add job/stopgroup to stop group (Evan Spensley)

      serve dlna

        Add --announce-interval to control SSDP Announce Interval (YanceyChiew)

        Add --interface to Specify SSDP interface names line (Simon Bos)

        Add support for more external subtitles (YanceyChiew)

        Add verification of addresses (YanceyChiew)

      sync: Optimise --copy-dest and --compare-dest (Nick Craig-Wood)

      doc  updates (albertony, Alexander Knorr, anonion, João Henrique Franco, Josh Soref, Lorenzo Milesi, Marco Molteni, Mark Trolley, Ole Frost, partev, Ryan
       Morey, Tom Mombourquette, YFdyh000)

    Bug Fixes

      filter

        Fix incorrect filtering with UseFilter context flag and wrapping backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make sure we check --files-from when looking for a single file (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc

        Fix mount/listmounts not returning the full Fs entered in mount/mount (Tom Mombourquette)

        Handle external unmount when mounting (Isaac Aymerich)

        Validate Daemon option is not set when mounting a volume via RC (Isaac Aymerich)

      sync: Update docs and error messages to reflect fixes to overlap checks (Nick Naumann)

    VFS

      Reduce memory use by embedding sync.Cond (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Reduce memory usage by re-ordering commonly used structures (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix excess CPU used by VFS cache cleaner looping (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Obey file filters in listing to fix errors on excluded files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix "Failed to read metadata: function not implemented" on old Linux kernels (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Compress

      Fix crash due to nil metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix error handling to not use or return nil objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Make --drive-stop-on-upload-limit obey quota exceeded error (Steve Kowalik)

    FTP

      Add --ftp-force-list-hidden option to show hidden items (Øyvind Heddeland Instefjord)

      Fix hang when using ExplicitTLS to certain servers.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add --gcs-endpoint flag and config parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Hubic

      Remove backend as service has now shut down (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Rename Onedrive(cn) 21Vianet to Vnet Group (Yen Hu)

      Disable change notify in China region since it is not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Implement --s3-versions flag to show old versions of objects if enabled (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement --s3-version-at flag to show versions of objects at a particular time (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement backend versioning command to get/set bucket versioning (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement Purge to purge versions and backend cleanup-hidden (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-decompress flag to decompress gzip-encoded files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-sse-customer-key-base64 to supply keys with binary data (Richard Bateman)

      Try to keep the maximum precision in ModTime with --user-server-modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Drop binary metadata with an ERROR message as it can't be stored (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-no-system-metadata to suppress read and write of system metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Fix directory creation races (Lesmiscore)

    Swift

      Add --swift-no-large-objects to reduce HEAD requests (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Union

      Propagate SlowHash feature to fix hasher interaction (Lesmiscore)

v1.59.2 - 2022-09-15

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.59.1...v1.59.2)

    Bug Fixes

      config: Move locking to fix fatal error: concurrent map read and map write (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Disable xattr support if the filesystems indicates it is not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Fix chunksize calculations producing too many parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Fix chunksize calculations producing too many parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Fix chunksize calculations producing too many parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.59.1 - 2022-08-08

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.59.0...v1.59.1)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix panic in core/stats-reset with unknown group (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build: Fix android build after GitHub actions change (Nick Craig-Wood)

      dlna: Fix SOAP action header parsing (Joram Schrijver)

      docs: Fix links to mount command from install docs (albertony)

      dropbox: Fix ChangeNotify was unable to decrypt errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fs: Fix parsing of times and durations of the form "YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS" (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve sftp: Fix checksum detection (Nick Craig-Wood)

      sync: Add accidentally missed filter-sensitivity to --backup-dir option (Nick Naumann)

    Combine

      Fix docs showing remote= instead of upstreams= (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Throw error if duplicate directory name is specified (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix errors with backends shutting down while in use (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Fix hang on quit with --dropbox-batch-mode off (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix infinite loop on uploading a corrupted file (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Internetarchive

      Ignore checksums for files using the different method (Lesmiscore)

      Handle hash symbol in the middle of filename (Lesmiscore)

    Jottacloud

      Fix working with whitelabel Elgiganten Cloud

      Do not store username in config when using standard auth (albertony)

    Mega

      Fix nil pointer exception when bad node received (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Fix --s3-no-head panic: reflect: Elem of invalid type s3.PutObjectInput (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Fix issue with WS_FTP by working around failing RealPath (albertony)

    Union

      Fix duplicated files when using directories with leading / (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix multiple files being uploaded when roots don't exist (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix panic due to misalignment of struct field in 32 bit architectures (r-ricci)

v1.59.0 - 2022-07-09

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.58.0...v1.59.0)

    New backends

      Combine multiple remotes in one directory tree (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Hidrive (https://rclone.org/hidrive/) (Ovidiu Victor Tatar)

      Internet Archive (https://rclone.org/internetarchive/) (Lesmiscore (Naoya Ozaki))

      New S3 providers

        ArvanCloud AOS (https://rclone.org/s3/#arvan-cloud) (ehsantdy)

        Cloudflare R2 (https://rclone.org/s3/#cloudflare-r2) (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Huawei OBS (https://rclone.org/s3/#huawei-obs) (m00594701)

        IDrive e2 (https://rclone.org/s3/#idrive-e2) (vyloy)

    New commands

      test makefile (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_makefile/): Create a single file for testing (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New Features

      Metadata framework (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) to read and write system and user metadata on backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Implemented initially for local, s3 and internetarchive backends

        --metadata/-M flag to control whether metadata is copied

        --metadata-set flag to specify metadata for uploads

        Thanks to Manz Solutions (https://manz-solutions.at/) for sponsoring this work.

      build

        Update to go1.18 and make go1.16 the minimum required version (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Update android go build to 1.18.x and NDK to 23.1.7779620 (Nick Craig-Wood)

        All windows binaries now no longer CGO (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add linux/arm/v6 to docker images (Nick Craig-Wood)

        A huge number of fixes found with staticcheck (https://staticcheck.io/) (albertony)

        Configurable version suffix independent of version number (albertony)

      check: Implement --no-traverse and --no-unicode-normalization (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config: Readability improvements (albertony)

      copyurl: Add --header-filename to honor the HTTP header filename directive (J-P Treen)

      filter: Allow multiple --exclude-if-present flags (albertony)

      fshttp: Add --disable-http-keep-alives to disable HTTP Keep Alives (Nick Craig-Wood)

      install.sh

        Set the modes on the files and/or directories on macOS (Michael C Tiernan - MIT-Research Computing Project)

        Pre verify sudo authorization -v before calling curl.  (Michael C Tiernan - MIT-Research Computing Project)

      lib/encoder: Add Semicolon encoding (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lsf: Add metadata support with M flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lsjson: Add --metadata/-M flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      ncdu

        Implement multi selection (CrossR)

        Replace termbox with tcell's termbox wrapper (eNV25)

       • Display correct path in delete confirmation dialog (Roberto Ricci)

     • operations

       • Speed up hash checking by aborting the other hash if first returns nothing (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Use correct src/dst in some log messages (zzr93)

     • rcat: Check checksums by default like copy does (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • selfupdate: Replace deprecated x/crypto/openpgp package with ProtonMail/go-crypto (albertony)

     • serve ftp: Check --passive-port arguments are correct (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • size: Warn about inaccurate results when objects with unknown size (albertony)

     • sync: Overlap check is now filter-sensitive so --backup-dir can be in the root provided it is filtered (Nick)

     • test info: Check file name lengths using 1,2,3,4 byte unicode characters (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • test makefile(s): --sparse, --zero, --pattern, --ascii, --chargen flags to control file contents (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make sure we call the Shutdown method on backends (Martin Czygan)

   • Bug Fixes

     • accounting: Fix unknown length file transfers counting 3 transfers each (buda)

     • ncdu: Fix issue where dir size is summed when file sizes are -1 (albertony)

     • sync/copy/move

       • Fix --fast-list --create-empty-src-dirs and --exclude (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix --max-duration and --cutoff-mode soft (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix fs cache unpin (Martin Czygan)

     • Set proper exit code for errors that are not low-level retried (e.g.  size/timestamp changing) (albertony)

   • Mount

     • Support windows/arm64 (may still be problems - see #5828 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/5828)) (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Log IO errors at ERROR level (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Ignore _netdev mount argument (Hugal31)

   • VFS

     • Add --vfs-fast-fingerprint for less accurate but faster fingerprints (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --vfs-disk-space-total-size option to manually set the total disk space (Claudio Maradonna)

     • vfscache: Fix fatal error: sync: unlock of unlocked mutex error (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Local

     • Fix parsing of --local-nounc flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add Metadata support (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Crypt

     • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Azure Blob

     • Calculate Chunksize/blocksize to stay below maxUploadParts (Leroy van Logchem)

     • Use chunksize lib to determine chunksize dynamically (Derek Battams)

     • Case insensitive access tier (Rob Pickerill)

     • Allow remote emulator (azurite) (Lorenzo Maiorfi)

   • B2

     • Add --b2-version-at flag to show file versions at time specified (SwazRGB)

     • Use chunksize lib to determine chunksize dynamically (Derek Battams)

   • Chunker

     • Mark as not supporting metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Compress

     • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Drive

     • Make backend config -o config add a combined AllDrives: remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make --drive-shared-with-me work with shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --drive-resource-key for accessing link-shared files (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add backend commands exportformats and importformats for debugging (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix 404 errors on copy/server side copy objects from public folder (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Update Internal OAuth consent screen docs (Phil Shackleton)

     • Moved root_folder_id to advanced section (Abhiraj)

   • Dropbox

     • Migrate from deprecated api (m8rge)

     • Add logs to show when poll interval limits are exceeded (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix nil pointer exception on dropbox impersonate user not found (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Fichier

     • Parse api error codes and them accordingly (buengese)

   • FTP

     • Add support for disable_utf8 option (Jason Zheng)

     • Revert to upstream github.com/jlaffaye/ftp from our fork (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Google Cloud Storage

     • Add --gcs-no-check-bucket to minimise transactions and perms (Nick Gooding)

     • Add --gcs-decompress flag to decompress gzip-encoded files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • by default these will be downloaded compressed (which previously failed)

   • Hasher

     • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • HTTP

     • Fix missing response when using custom auth handler (albertony)

   • Jottacloud

     • Add support for upload to custom device and mountpoint (albertony)

     • Always store username in config and use it to avoid initial API request (albertony)

     • Fix issue with server-side copy when destination is in trash (albertony)

     • Fix listing output of remote with special characters (albertony)

   • Mailru

     • Fix timeout by using int instead of time.Duration for keeping number of seconds (albertony)

   • Mega

     • Document using MEGAcmd to help with login failures (Art M.  Gallagher)

   • Onedrive

     • Implement --poll-interval for onedrive (Hugo Laloge)

     • Add access scopes option (Sven Gerber)

   • Opendrive

     • Resolve lag and truncate bugs (Scott Grimes)

   • Pcloud

     • Fix about with no free space left (buengese)

     • Fix cleanup (buengese)

   • S3

     • Use PUT Object instead of presigned URLs to upload single part objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Backend restore command to skip non-GLACIER objects (Vincent Murphy)

     • Use chunksize lib to determine chunksize dynamically (Derek Battams)

     • Retry RequestTimeout errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement reading and writing of metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • SFTP

     • Add support for about and hashsum on windows server (albertony)

     • Use vendor-specific VFS statistics extension for about if available (albertony)

     • Add --sftp-chunk-size to control packets sizes for high latency links (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --sftp-concurrency to improve high latency transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --sftp-set-env option to set environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add Hetzner Storage Boxes to supported sftp backends (Anthrazz)

   • Storj

     • Fix put which lead to the file being unreadable when using mount (Erik van Velzen)

   • Union

     • Add min_free_space option for lfs/eplfs policies (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix uploading files to union of all bucket based remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix get free space for remotes which don't support it (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix eplus policy to select correct entry for existing files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Uptobox

      Fix root path handling (buengese)

    WebDAV

      Add SharePoint in other specific regions support (Noah Hsu)

    Yandex

      Handle api error on server-side move (albertony)

    Zoho

      Add Japan and China regions (buengese)

v1.58.1 - 2022-04-29

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.58.0...v1.58.1)

    Bug Fixes

      build: Update github.com/billziss-gh to github.com/winfsp (Nick Craig-Wood)

      filter: Fix timezone of --min-age/-max-age from UTC to local as documented (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc/js: Correct RC method names (Sơn Trần-Nguyễn)

      docs

        Fix some links to command pages (albertony)

        Add --multi-thread-streams note to --transfers.  (Zsolt Ero)

    Mount

      Fix --devname and fusermount: unknown option 'fsname' when mounting via rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Remove wording which suggests VFS is only for mounting (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Fix retries of multipart uploads with incorrect_offset error (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Use the s3 pacer to speed up transactions (Nick Craig-Wood)

      pacer: Default the Google pacer to a burst of 100 to fix gcs pacing (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Fix scope in token request (albertony)

    Netstorage

      Fix unescaped HTML in documentation (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make levels of headings consistent (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add support contacts to netstorage doc (Nil Alexandrov)

    Onedrive

      Note that sharepoint also changes web files (.html, .aspx) (GH)

    Putio

      Handle rate limit errors (Berkan Teber)

      Fix multithread download and other ranged requests (rafma0)

    S3

      Add ChinaMobile EOS to provider list (GuoXingbin)

      Sync providers in config description with providers (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Fix OpenSSH 8.8+ RSA keys incompatibility (KARBOWSKI Piotr)

      Note that Scaleway C14 is deprecating SFTP in favor of S3 (Adrien Rey-Jarthon)

    Storj

      Fix bucket creation on Move (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Don't override Referer if user sets it (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.58.0 - 2022-03-18

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.57.0...v1.58.0)

    New backends

      Akamai Netstorage (Nil Alexandrov)

      Seagate Lyve (https://rclone.org/s3/#lyve), SeaweedFS, Storj, RackCorp via s3 backend

      Storj (https://rclone.org/storj/) (renamed from Tardigrade - your old config files will continue working)

    New commands

      bisync (https://rclone.org/bisync/) - experimental bidirectional cloud sync (Ivan Andreev, Chris Nelson)

    New Features

      build

        Add windows/arm64 build (rclone mount not supported yet) (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Raise minimum go version to go1.15 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config: Allow dot in remote names and improve config editing (albertony)

      dedupe: Add quit as a choice in interactive mode (albertony)

      dlna: Change icons to the newest ones.  (Alain Nussbaumer)

      filter: Add {{ regexp }} syntax (https://rclone.org/filtering/#regexp) to pattern matches (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fshttp: Add prometheus metrics for HTTP status code (Michał Matczuk)

      hashsum: Support creating hash from data received on stdin (albertony)

      librclone

        Allow empty string or null input instead of empty json object (albertony)

        Add support for mount commands (albertony)

      operations: Add server-side moves to stats (Ole Frost)

      rc: Allow user to disable authentication for web gui (negative0)

      tree: Remove obsolete --human replaced by global --human-readable (albertony)

      version: Report correct friendly-name for newer Windows 10/11 versions (albertony)

    Bug Fixes

      build

        Fix ARM architecture version in .deb packages after nfpm change (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Hard fork github.com/jlaffaye/ftp to fix go get github.com/rclone/rclone (Nick Craig-Wood)

      oauthutil: Fix crash when webbrowser requests /robots.txt (Nick Craig-Wood)

      operations: Fix goroutine leak in case of copy retry (Ankur Gupta)

      rc:

        Fix operations/publiclink default for expires parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix missing computation of transferQueueSize when summing up statistics group (Carlo Mion)

        Fix missing StatsInfo fields in the computation of the group sum (Carlo Mion)

      sync: Fix --max-duration so it doesn't retry when the duration is exceeded (Nick Craig-Wood)

      touch: Fix issue where a directory is created instead of a file (albertony)

    Mount

      Add --devname to set the device name sent to FUSE for mount display (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Add vfs/stats remote control to show statistics (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix failed to _ensure cache internal error: downloaders is nil error (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix handling of special characters in file names (Bumsu Hyeon)

    Local

      Fix hash invalidation which caused errors with local crypt mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Crypt

      Add base64 and base32768 filename encoding options (Max Sum, Sinan Tan)

    Azure Blob

      Implement --azureblob-upload-concurrency parameter to speed uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Remove 100MB upper limit on chunk_size as it is no longer needed (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Raise --azureblob-upload-concurrency to 16 by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix crash with SAS URL and no container (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Compress

      Fix crash if metadata upload failed (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix memory leak (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Added --drive-copy-shortcut-content (Abhiraj)

      Disable OAuth OOB flow (copy a token) due to Google deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

        See the deprecation note (https://developers.googleblog.com/2022/02/making-oauth-flows-safer.html#disallowed-oob).

      Add --drive-skip-dangling-shortcuts flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      When using a link type --drive-export-formats shows all doc types (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Speed up directory listings by specifying 1000 items in a chunk (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Save an API request when at the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Fichier

      Implemented About functionality (Gourav T)

    FTP

      Add --ftp-ask-password to prompt for password when needed (Borna Butkovic)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add missing regions (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Disable OAuth OOB flow (copy a token) due to Google deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

        See the deprecation note (https://developers.googleblog.com/2022/02/making-oauth-flows-safer.html#disallowed-oob).

    Googlephotos

      Disable OAuth OOB flow (copy a token) due to Google deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

        See the deprecation note (https://developers.googleblog.com/2022/02/making-oauth-flows-safer.html#disallowed-oob).

    Hasher

      Fix crash on object not found (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Hdfs

      Add file (Move) and directory move (DirMove) support (Andy Jackson)

    HTTP

      Improved recognition of URL pointing to a single file (albertony)

    Jottacloud

      Change API used by recursive list (ListR) (Kim)

      Add support for Tele2 Cloud (Fredric Arklid)

    Koofr

      Add Digistorage service as a Koofr provider.  (jaKa)

    Mailru

      Fix int32 overflow on arm32 (Ivan Andreev)

    Onedrive

      Add config option for oauth scope Sites.Read.All (Charlie Jiang)

      Minor optimization of quickxorhash (Isaac Levy)

      Add --onedrive-root-folder-id flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Do not retry on 400 pathIsTooLong error (ctrl-q)

    Pcloud

      Add support for recursive list (ListR) (Niels van de Weem)

      Fix pre-1970 time stamps (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Use ListObjectsV2 for faster listings (Felix Bunemann)

        Fallback to ListObject v1 on unsupported providers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Use the ETag on multipart transfers to verify the transfer was OK (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add --s3-use-multipart-etag provider quirk to disable this on unsupported providers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      New Providers

        RackCorp object storage (bbabich)

        Seagate Lyve Cloud storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

        SeaweedFS (Chris Lu)

        Storj Shared gateways (Márton Elek, Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add Wasabi AP Northeast 2 endpoint info (lindwurm)

      Add GLACIER_IR storage class (Yunhai Luo)

      Document Content-MD5 workaround for object-lock enabled buckets (Paulo Martins)

      Fix multipart upload with --no-head flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Simplify content length processing in s3 with download url (Logeshwaran Murugesan)

    SFTP

      Add rclone to list of supported md5sum/sha1sum commands to look for (albertony)

      Refactor so we only have one way of running remote commands (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix timeout on hashing large files by sending keepalives (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix unnecessary seeking when uploading and downloading files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Update docs on how to create known_hosts file (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Storj

      Rename tardigrade backend to storj backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement server side Move for files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Update docs to explain differences between s3 and this backend (Elek, Márton)

    Swift

      Fix About so it shows info about the current container only (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Union

      Fix treatment of remotes with // in (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix deadlock when one part of a multi-upload fails (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix eplus policy returned nil (Vitor Arruda)

    Yandex

      Add permanent deletion support (deinferno)

v1.57.0 - 2021-11-01

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.56.0...v1.57.0)

    New backends

      Sia: for Sia decentralized cloud (Ian Levesque, Matthew Sevey, Ivan Andreev)

      Hasher: caches hashes and enable hashes for backends that don't support them (Ivan Andreev)

   • New commands

     • lsjson --stat: to get info about a single file/dir and operations/stat api (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • config paths: show configured paths (albertony)

   • New Features

     • about: Make human-readable output more consistent with other commands (albertony)

     • build

       • Use go1.17 for building and make go1.14 the minimum supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Update Go to 1.16 and NDK to 22b for Android builds (x0b)

     • config

       • Support hyphen in remote name from environment variable (albertony)

       • Make temporary directory user-configurable (albertony)

       • Convert --cache-dir value to an absolute path (albertony)

       • Do not override MIME types from OS defaults (albertony)

     • docs

       • Toc styling and header levels cleanup (albertony)

       • Extend documentation on valid remote names (albertony)

       • Mention make for building and cmount tag for macos (Alex Chen)

       • ...and many more contributions to numerous to mention!

     • fs: Move with --ignore-existing will not delete skipped files (Nathan Collins)

     • hashsum

       • Treat hash values in sum file as case insensitive (Ivan Andreev)

       • Don't put ERROR or UNSUPPORTED in output (Ivan Andreev)

      lib/encoder: Add encoding of square brackets (Ivan Andreev)

      lib/file: Improve error message when attempting to create dir on nonexistent drive on windows (albertony)

      lib/http: Factor password hash salt into options with default (Nolan Woods)

      lib/kv: Add key-value database api (Ivan Andreev)

      librclone

        Add RcloneFreeString function (albertony)

        Free strings in python example (albertony)

      log: Optionally print pid in logs (Ivan Andreev)

      ls: Introduce --human-readable global option to print human-readable sizes (albertony)

      ncdu: Introduce key u to toggle human-readable (albertony)

      operations: Add rmdirs -v output (Justin Winokur)

      serve sftp

        Generate an ECDSA server key as well as RSA (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Generate an Ed25519 server key as well as ECDSA and RSA (albertony)

      serve docker

        Allow to customize proxy settings of docker plugin (Ivan Andreev)

        Build docker plugin for multiple platforms (Thomas Stachl)

      size: Include human-readable count (albertony)

      touch: Add support for touching files in directory, with recursive option, filtering and --dry-run/-i (albertony)

      tree: Option to print human-readable sizes removed in favor of global option (albertony)

    Bug Fixes

      lib/http

        Fix bad username check in single auth secret provider (Nolan Woods)

        Fix handling of SSL credentials (Nolan Woods)

      serve ftp: Ensure modtime is passed as UTC always to fix timezone oddities (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve sftp: Fix generation of server keys on windows (albertony)

      serve docker: Fix octal umask (Ivan Andreev)

    Mount

      Enable rclone to be run as mount helper direct from the fstab (Ivan Andreev)

      Use procfs to validate mount on linux (Ivan Andreev)

      Correctly daemonize for compatibility with automount (Ivan Andreev)

    VFS

      Ensure names used in cache path are legal on current OS (albertony)

      Ignore ECLOSED when truncating file handles to fix intermittent bad file descriptor error (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Refactor default OS encoding out from local backend into shared encoder lib (albertony)

    Crypt

      Return wrapped object even with --crypt-no-data-encryption (Ivan Andreev)

      Fix uploads with --crypt-no-data-encryption (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Add --azureblob-no-head-object (Tatsuya Noyori)

    Box

      Make listings of heavily used directories more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

      When doing cleanup delete as much as possible (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --box-list-chunk to control listing chunk size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Delete items in parallel in cleanup using --checkers threads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --box-owned-by to only show items owned by the login passed (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Retry operation_blocked_temporary errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Chunker

      Md5all must create metadata if base hash is slow (Ivan Andreev)

    Drive

      Speed up directory listings by constraining the API listing using the current filters (fotile96, Ivan Andreev)

      Fix buffering for single request upload for files smaller than --drive-upload-cutoff (YenForYang)

      Add -o config option to backend drives to make config for all shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Add --dropbox-batch-commit-timeout to control batch timeout (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Filefabric

      Make backoff exponential for error_background to fix errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix directory move after API change (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Enable tls session cache by default (Ivan Andreev)

      Add option to disable tls13 (Ivan Andreev)

      Fix timeout after long uploads (Ivan Andreev)

      Add support for precise time (Ivan Andreev)

      Enable CI for ProFtpd, PureFtpd, VsFtpd (Ivan Andreev)

    Googlephotos

      Use encoder for album names to fix albums with control characters (Parth Shukla)

    Jottacloud

      Implement SetModTime to support modtime-only changes (albertony)

      Improved error handling with SetModTime and corrupt files in general (albertony)

      Add support for UserInfo (rclone config userinfo) feature (albertony)

      Return direct download link from rclone link command (albertony)

    Koofr

      Create direct share link (Dmitry Bogatov)

    Pcloud

      Add sha256 support (Ken Enrique Morel)

    Premiumizeme

      Fix directory listing after API changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix server side move after API change (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix server side directory move after API changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Add support to use CDN URL to download the file (Logeshwaran)

      Add AWS Snowball Edge to providers examples (r0kk3rz)

      Use a combination of SDK retries and rclone retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix IAM Role for Service Account not working and other auth problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix shared_credentials_file auth after reverting incorrect fix (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix corrupted on transfer: sizes differ 0 vs xxxx with Ceph (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Seafile

      Fix error when not configured for 2fa (Fred)

    SFTP

      Fix timeout when doing MD5SUM of large file (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Swift

      Update OCI URL (David Liu)

      Document OVH Cloud Archive (HNGamingUK)

    Union

      Fix rename not working with union of local disk and bucket based remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.56.2 - 2021-10-01

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.56.1...v1.56.2)

    Bug Fixes

      serve http: Re-add missing auth to http service (Nolan Woods)

      build: Update golang.org/x/sys to fix crash on macOS when compiled with go1.17 (Herby Gillot)

    FTP

      Fix deadlock after failed update when concurrency=1 (Ivan Andreev)

v1.56.1 - 2021-09-19

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.56.0...v1.56.1)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix maximum bwlimit by scaling scale max token bucket size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc: Fix speed does not update in core/stats (negative0)

      selfupdate: Fix --quiet option, not quite quiet (yedamo)

      serve http: Fix serve http exiting directly after starting (Cnly)

      build

        Apply gofmt from golang 1.17 (Ivan Andreev)

        Update Go to 1.16 and NDK to 22b for android/any (x0b)

    Mount

      Fix --daemon mode (Ivan Andreev)

    VFS

      Fix duplicates on rename (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix crash when truncating a just uploaded object (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix issue where empty dirs would build up in cache meta dir (albertony)

    Drive

      Fix instructions for auto config (Greg Sadetsky)

      Fix lsf example without drive-impersonate (Greg Sadetsky)

    Onedrive

      Handle HTTP 400 better in PublicLink (Alex Chen)

      Clarification of the process for creating custom client_id (Mariano Absatz)

    Pcloud

      Return an early error when Put is called with an unknown size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Try harder to delete a failed upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Add Wasabi's AP-Northeast endpoint info (hota)

      Fix typo in s3 documentation (Greg Sadetsky)

    Seafile

      Fix 2fa config state machine (Fred)

    SFTP

      Remove spurious error message on --sftp-disable-concurrent-reads (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Sugarsync

      Fix initial connection after config re-arrangement (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.56.0 - 2021-07-20

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.55.0...v1.56.0)

    New backends

      Uptobox (https://rclone.org/uptobox/) (buengese)

    New commands

      serve docker (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/) (Antoine GIRARD) (Ivan Andreev)

        and accompanying docker volume plugin (https://rclone.org/docker/)

      checksum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_checksum/) to check files against a file of checksums (Ivan Andreev)

        this is also available as rclone md5sum -C etc

      config touch (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_touch/): ensure config exists at configured location (albertony)

      test changenotify (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_changenotify/): command to help debugging changenotify (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Deprecations

      dbhashsum: Remove command deprecated a year ago (Ivan Andreev)

      cache: Deprecate cache backend (Ivan Andreev)

    New Features

      rework config system so it can be used non-interactively via cli and rc API.

        See docs in config create (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/)

        This is a very big change to all the backends so may cause breakages - please file bugs!

      librclone - export the rclone RC as a C library (lewisxy) (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Link a C-API rclone shared object into your project

        Use the RC as an in memory interface

        Python example supplied

        Also supports Android and gomobile

      fs

        Add --disable-http2 for global http2 disable (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make --dump imply -vv (Alex Chen)

        Use binary prefixes for size and rate units (albertony)

        Use decimal prefixes for counts (albertony)

        Add google search widget to rclone.org (Ivan Andreev)

      accounting: Calculate rolling average speed (Haochen Tong)

      atexit: Terminate with non-zero status after receiving signal (Michael Hanselmann)

      build

        Only run event-based workflow scripts under rclone repo with manual override (Mathieu Carbou)

        Add Android build with gomobile (x0b)

      check: Log the hash in use like cryptcheck does (Nick Craig-Wood)

      version: Print os/version, kernel and bitness (Ivan Andreev)

      config

        Prevent use of Windows reserved names in config file name (albertony)

        Create config file in windows appdata directory by default (albertony)

        Treat any config file paths with filename notfound as memory-only config (albertony)

        Delay load config file (albertony)

        Replace defaultConfig with a thread-safe in-memory implementation (Chris Macklin)

        Allow config create and friends to take key=value parameters (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fixed issues with flags/options set by environment vars.  (Ole Frost)

      fshttp: Implement graceful DSCP error handling (Tyson Moore)

      lib/http - provides an abstraction for a central http server that services can bind routes to (Nolan Woods)

        Add --template config and flags to serve/data (Nolan Woods)

        Add default 404 handler (Nolan Woods)

      link: Use "off" value for unset expiry (Nick Craig-Wood)

      oauthutil: Raise fatal error if token expired without refresh token (Alex Chen)

      rcat: Add --size flag for more efficient uploads of known size (Nazar Mishturak)

      serve sftp: Add --stdio flag to serve via stdio (Tom)

      sync: Don't warn about --no-traverse when --files-from is set (Nick Gaya)

     • test makefiles

       • Add --seed flag and make data generated repeatable (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add log levels and speed summary (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Bug Fixes

     • accounting: Fix startTime of statsGroups.sum (Haochen Tong)

     • cmd/ncdu: Fix out of range panic in delete (buengese)

     • config

       • Fix issues with memory-only config file paths (albertony)

       • Fix in memory config not saving on the fly backend config (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • fshttp: Fix address parsing for DSCP (Tyson Moore)

     • ncdu: Update termbox-go library to fix crash (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • oauthutil: Fix old authorize result not recognised (Cnly)

     • operations: Don't update timestamps of files in --compare-dest (Nick Gaya)

      selfupdate: fix archive name on macos (Ivan Andreev)

    Mount

      Refactor before adding serve docker (Antoine GIRARD)

    VFS

      Add cache reset for --vfs-cache-max-size handling at cache poll interval (Leo Luan)

      Fix modtime changing when reading file into cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Avoid unnecessary subdir in cache path (albertony)

      Fix that umask option cannot be set as environment variable (albertony)

      Do not print notice about missing poll-interval support when set to 0 (albertony)

    Local

      Always use readlink to read symlink size for better compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --local-unicode-normalization (and remove --local-no-unicode-normalization) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Skip entries removed concurrently with List() (Ivan Andreev)

    Crypt

      Support timestamped filenames from --b2-versions (Dominik Mydlil)

    B2

      Don't include the bucket name in public link file prefixes (Jeffrey Tolar)

     • Fix versions and .files with no extension (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Factor version handling into lib/version (Dominik Mydlil)

   • Box

     • Use upload preflight check to avoid listings in file uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Return errors instead of calling log.Fatal with them (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Drive

     • Switch to the Drives API for looking up shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix some google docs being treated as files (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Dropbox

     • Add --dropbox-batch-mode flag to speed up uploading (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Read the batch mode (https://rclone.org/dropbox/#batch-mode) docs for more info

     • Set visibility in link sharing when --expire is set (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Simplify chunked uploads (Alexey Ivanov)

     • Improve "own App IP" instructions (Ivan Andreev)

   • Fichier

     • Check if more than one upload link is returned (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Support downloading password protected files and folders (Florian Penzkofer)

     • Make error messages report text from the API (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix move of files in the same directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Check that we actually got a download token and retry if we didn't (buengese)

    Filefabric

      Fix listing after change of from field from "int" to int.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Make upload error 250 indicate success (Nick Craig-Wood)

    GCS

      Make compatible with gsutil's mtime metadata (database64128)

     • Clean up time format constants (database64128)

   • Google Photos

     • Fix read only scope not being used properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • HTTP

     • Replace httplib with lib/http (Nolan Woods)

     • Clean up Bind to better use middleware (Nolan Woods)

   • Jottacloud

     • Fix legacy auth with state based config system (buengese)

     • Fix invalid url in output from link command (albertony)

     • Add no versions option (buengese)

   • Onedrive

     • Add list_chunk option (Nick Gaya)

     • Also report root error if unable to cancel multipart upload (Cnly)

     • Fix failed to configure: empty token found error (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make link return direct download link (Xuanchen Wu)

   • S3

     • Add --s3-no-head-object (Tatsuya Noyori)

     • Remove WebIdentityRoleProvider to fix crash on auth (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Don't check to see if remote is object if it ends with / (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add SeaweedFS (Chris Lu)

      Update Alibaba OSS endpoints (Chuan Zh)

    SFTP

      Fix performance regression by re-enabling concurrent writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Expand tilde and environment variables in configured known_hosts_file (albertony)

    Tardigrade

      Upgrade to uplink v1.4.6 (Caleb Case)

      Use negative offset (Caleb Case)

      Add warning about too many open files (acsfer)

    WebDAV

      Fix sharepoint auth over http (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add headers option (Antoon Prins)

v1.55.1 - 2021-04-26

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.55.0...v1.55.1)

    Bug Fixes

      selfupdate

        Dont detect FUSE if build is static (Ivan Andreev)

        Add build tag noselfupdate (Ivan Andreev)

      sync: Fix incorrect error reported by graceful cutoff (Nick Craig-Wood)

      install.sh: fix macOS arm64 download (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build: Fix version numbers in android branch builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs

        Contributing.md: update setup instructions for go1.16 (Nick Gaya)

        WinFsp 2021 is out of beta (albertony)

        Minor cleanup of space around code section (albertony)

        Fixed some typos (albertony)

    VFS

      Fix a code path which allows dirty data to be removed causing data loss (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Compress

      Fix compressed name regexp (buengese)

    Drive

      Fix backend copyid of google doc to directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Don't open browser when service account...  (Ansh Mittal)

   • Dropbox

     • Add missing team_data.member scope for use with --impersonate (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix About after scopes changes - rclone config reconnect needed (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix Unable to decrypt returned paths from changeNotify (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • FTP

     • Fix implicit TLS (Ivan Andreev)

   • Onedrive

     • Work around for random "Unable to initialize RPS" errors (OleFrost)

   • SFTP

     • Revert sftp library to v1.12.0 from v1.13.0 to fix performance regression (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix Update ReadFrom failed: failed to send packet: EOF errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Zoho

     • Fix error when region isn't set (buengese)

      Do not ask for mountpoint twice when using headless setup (buengese)

v1.55.0 - 2021-03-31

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.54.0...v1.55.0)

    New commands

      selfupdate (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_selfupdate/) (Ivan Andreev)

        Allows rclone to update itself in-place or via a package (using --package flag)

        Reads cryptographically signed signatures for non beta releases

        Works on all OSes.

      test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - these are test commands - use with care!

        histogram - Makes a histogram of file name characters.

        info - Discovers file name or other limitations for paths.

        makefiles - Make a random file hierarchy for testing.

        memory - Load all the objects at remote:path into memory and report memory stats.

    New Features

      Connection strings (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings)

        Config parameters can now be passed as part of the remote name as a connection string.

        For example, to do the equivalent of --drive-shared-with-me use drive,shared_with_me:

        Make sure we don't save on the fly remote config to the config file (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make sure backends with additional config have a different name for caching (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • This work was sponsored by CERN, through the CS3MESH4EOSC Project (https://cs3mesh4eosc.eu/).

         • CS3MESH4EOSC has received funding from the European Union’s Horizon 2020

         • research and innovation programme under Grant Agreement no.  863353.

     • build

       • Update go build version to go1.16 and raise minimum go version to go1.13 (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make a macOS ARM64 build to support Apple Silicon (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Install macfuse 4.x instead of osxfuse 3.x (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Use GO386=softfloat instead of deprecated GO386=387 for 386 builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Disable IOS builds for the time being (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Androids builds made with up to date NDK (x0b)

       • Add an rclone user to the Docker image but don't use it by default (cynthia kwok)

      dedupe: Make largest directory primary to minimize data moved (Saksham Khanna)

      config

        Wrap config library in an interface (Fionera)

        Make config file system pluggable (Nick Craig-Wood)

        --config "" or "/notfound" for in memory config only (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Clear fs cache of stale entries when altering config (Nick Craig-Wood)

      copyurl: Add option to print resulting auto-filename (albertony)

      delete: Make --rmdirs obey the filters (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs - many fixes and reworks from edwardxml, albertony, pvalls, Ivan Andreev, Evan Harris, buengese, Alexey Tabakman

      encoder/filename - add SCSU as tables (Klaus Post)

      Add multiple paths support to --compare-dest and --copy-dest flag (K265)

      filter: Make --exclude "dir/" equivalent to --exclude "dir/**" (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fshttp: Add DSCP support with --dscp for QoS with differentiated services (Max Sum)

      lib/cache: Add Delete and DeletePrefix methods (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lib/file

        Make pre-allocate detect disk full errors and return them (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Don't run preallocate concurrently (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Retry preallocate on EINTR (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • operations: Made copy and sync operations obey a RetryAfterError (Ankur Gupta)

     • rc

       • Add string alternatives for setting options over the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add options/local to see the options configured in the context (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add _config parameter to set global config for just this rc call (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Implement passing filter config with _filter parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add fscache/clear and fscache/entries to control the fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Avoid +Inf value for speed in core/stats (albertony)

       • Add a full set of stats to core/stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Allow fs= params to be a JSON blob (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rcd: Added systemd notification during the rclone rcd command.  (Naveen Honest Raj)

     • rmdirs: Make --rmdirs obey the filters (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • version: Show build tags and type of executable (Ivan Andreev)

   • Bug Fixes

     • install.sh: make it fail on download errors (Ivan Andreev)

     • Fix excessive retries missing --max-duration timeout (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix crash when --low-level-retries=0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix failed token refresh on mounts created via the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • fshttp: Fix bandwidth limiting after bad merge (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • lib/atexit

       • Unregister interrupt handler once it has fired so users can interrupt again (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix occasional failure to unmount with CTRL-C (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix deadlock calling Finalise while Run is running (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • lib/rest: Fix multipart uploads not stopping on context cancel (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Mount

     • Allow mounting to root directory on windows (albertony)

     • Improved handling of relative paths on windows (albertony)

     • Fix unicode issues with accented characters on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Docs: document the new FileSecurity option in WinFsp 2021 (albertony)

     • Docs: add note about volume path syntax on windows (albertony)

     • Fix caching of old directories after renaming them (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Update cgofuse to the latest version to bring in macfuse 4 fix (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • --vfs-used-is-size to report used space using recursive scan (tYYGH)

     • Don't set modification time if it was already correct (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix Create causing windows explorer to truncate files on CTRL-C CTRL-V (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix modtimes not updating when writing via cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix modtimes changing by fractional seconds after upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix modtime set if --vfs-cache-mode writes/full and no write (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Rename files in cache and cancel uploads on directory rename (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix directory renaming by renaming dirs cached in memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Add flag --local-no-preallocate (David Sze)

      Make nounc an advanced option except on Windows (albertony)

      Don't ignore preallocate disk full errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Cache

     • Add --fs-cache-expire-duration to control the fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Crypt

     • Add option to not encrypt data (Vesnyx)

     • Log hash ok on upload (albertony)

   • Azure Blob

     • Add container public access level support.  (Manish Kumar)

   • B2

     • Fix HTML files downloaded via cloudflare (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Box

     • Fix transfers getting stuck on token expiry after API change (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Chunker

     • Partially implement no-rename transactions (Maxwell Calman)

   • Drive

     • Don't stop server side copy if couldn't read description (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Pass context on to drive SDK - to help with cancellation (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Dropbox

     • Add polling for changes support (Robert Thomas)

     • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Raise priority of rate limited message to INFO to make it more noticeable (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Fichier

     • Implement copy & move (buengese)

     • Implement public link (buengese)

   • FTP

     • Implement Shutdown method (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Close idle connections after --ftp-idle-timeout (1m by default) (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --ftp-close-timeout flag for use with awkward ftp servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Retry connections and logins on 421 errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Hdfs

     • Fix permissions for when directory is created (Lucas Messenger)

   • Onedrive

     • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • S3

     • Fix --s3-profile which wasn't working (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Close idle connections after --sftp-idle-timeout (1m by default) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix "file not found" errors for read once servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix SetModTime stat failed: object not found with --sftp-set-modtime=false (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Swift

      Update github.com/ncw/swift to v2.0.0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement copying large objects (nguyenhuuluan434)

    Union

      Fix crash when using epff policy (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix union attempting to update files on a read only file system (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Refactor to use fspath.SplitFs instead of fs.ParseRemote (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix initialisation broken in refactor (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Add support for sharepoint with NTLM authentication (Rauno Ots)

      Make sharepoint-ntlm docs more consistent (Alex Chen)

      Improve terminology in sharepoint-ntlm docs (Ivan Andreev)

      Disable HTTP/2 for NTLM authentication (georne)

      Fix sharepoint-ntlm error 401 for parallel actions (Ivan Andreev)

      Check that purged directory really exists (Ivan Andreev)

    Yandex

      Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Zoho

      Replace client id - you will need to rclone config reconnect after this (buengese)

      Add forgotten setupRegion() to NewFs - this finally fixes regions other than EU (buengese)

v1.54.1 - 2021-03-08

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.54.0...v1.54.1)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix --bwlimit when up or down is off (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs

        Fix nesting of brackets and backticks in ftp docs (edwardxml)

        Fix broken link in sftp page (edwardxml)

        Fix typo in crypt.md (Romeo Kienzler)

        Changelog: Correct link to digitalis.io (Alex JOST)

        Replace #file-caching with #vfs-file-caching (Miron Veryanskiy)

        Convert bogus example link to code (edwardxml)

        Remove dead link from rc.md (edwardxml)

      rc: Sync,copy,move: document createEmptySrcDirs parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lsjson: Fix unterminated JSON in the presence of errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Fix mount dropping on macOS by setting --daemon-timeout 10m (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Document simultaneous usage with the same cache shouldn't be used (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • B2

     • Automatically raise upload cutoff to avoid spurious error (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix failed to create file system with application key limited to a prefix (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Drive

     • Refer to Shared Drives instead of Team Drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Dropbox

     • Add scopes to oauth request and optionally "members.read" (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • S3

     • Fix failed to create file system with folder level permissions policy (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix Wasabi HEAD requests returning stale data by using only 1 transport (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix shared_credentials_file auth (Dmitry Chepurovskiy)

     • Add --s3-no-head to reducing costs docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Union

     • Fix mkdir at root with remote:/ (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Zoho

     • Fix custom client id's (buengese)

v1.54.0 - 2021-02-02

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.0...v1.54.0)

    New backends

      Compression remote (experimental) (buengese)

      Enterprise File Fabric (Nick Craig-Wood)

        This work was sponsored by Storage Made Easy (https://storagemadeeasy.com/)

      HDFS (Hadoop Distributed File System) (Yury Stankevich)

      Zoho workdrive (buengese)

    New Features

      Deglobalise the config (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Global config now read from the context

        This will enable passing of global config via the rc

        This work was sponsored by Digitalis (https://digitalis.io/)

      Add --bwlimit for upload and download (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Obey bwlimit in http Transport for better limiting

      Enhance systemd integration (Hekmon)

        log level identification, manual activation with flag, automatic systemd launch detection

        Don't compile systemd log integration for non unix systems (Benjamin Gustin)

     • Add a --download flag to md5sum/sha1sum/hashsum to force rclone to download and hash files locally (lostheli)

     • Add --progress-terminal-title to print ETA to terminal title (LaSombra)

     • Make backend env vars show in help as the defaults for backend flags (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • build

       • Raise minimum go version to go1.12 (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • dedupe

       • Add --by-hash to dedupe on content hash not file name (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add --dedupe-mode list to just list dupes, changing nothing (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add warning if used on a remote which can't have duplicate names (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fs

        Add Shutdown optional method for backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

        When using --files-from check files concurrently (zhucan)

        Accumulate stats when using --dry-run (Ingo Weiss)

        Always show stats when using --dry-run or --interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add support for flag --no-console on windows to hide the console window (albertony)

      genautocomplete: Add support to output to stdout (Ingo)

      ncdu

        Highlight read errors instead of aborting (Claudio Bantaloukas)

        Add sort by average size in directory (Adam Plánský)

        Add toggle option for average s3ize in directory - key 'a' (Adam Plánský)

        Add empty folder flag into ncdu browser (Adam Plánský)

        Add ! (error) and . (unreadable) file flags to go with e (empty) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      obscure: Make rclone obscure - ignore newline at end of line (Nick Craig-Wood)

      operations

        Add logs when need to upload files to set mod times (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Move and copy log name of the destination object in verbose (Adam Plánský)

        Add size if known to skipped items and JSON log (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc

        Prefer actual listener address if using ":port" or "addr:0" only (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add listener for finished jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      serve ftp: Add options to enable TLS (Deepak Sah)

      serve http/webdav: Redirect requests to the base url without the / (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve restic: Implement object cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      stats: Add counter for deleted directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

      sync: Only print "There was nothing to transfer" if no errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      webui

        Prompt user for updating webui if an update is available (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Fix plugins initialization (negative0)

    Bug Fixes

      fs

        Fix nil pointer on copy & move operations directly to remote (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

        Fix parsing of ..  when joining remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      log: Fix enabling systemd logging when using --log-file (Nick Craig-Wood)

      check

        Make the error count match up in the log message (Nick Craig-Wood)

      move: Fix data loss when source and destination are the same object (Nick Craig-Wood)

      operations

        Fix --cutoff-mode hard not cutting off immediately (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix --immutable error message (Nick Craig-Wood)

      sync

        Fix --cutoff-mode soft & cautious so it doesn't end the transfer early (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix --immutable errors retrying many times (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Docs

     • Many fixes and a rewrite of the filtering docs (edwardxml)

     • Many spelling and grammar fixes (Josh Soref)

     • Doc fixes for commands delete, purge, rmdir, rmdirs and mount (albertony)

     • And thanks to these people for many doc fixes too numerous to list

       • Ameer Dawood, Antoine GIRARD, Bob Bagwill, Christopher Stewart

       • CokeMine, David, Dov Murik, Durval Menezes, Evan Harris, gtorelly

       • Ilyess Bachiri, Janne Johansson, Kerry Su, Marcin Zelent,

       • Martin Michlmayr, Milly, Sơn Trần-Nguyễn

   • Mount

     • Update systemd status with cache stats (Hekmon)

     • Disable bazil/fuse based mount on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make rclone mount actually run rclone cmount under macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement mknod to make NFS file creation work (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make sure we don't call umount more than once (Nick Craig-Wood)

      More user friendly mounting as network drive on windows (albertony)

      Detect if uid or gid are set in same option string: -o uid=123,gid=456 (albertony)

      Don't attempt to unmount if fs has been destroyed already (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • Fix virtual entries causing deleted files to still appear (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix "file already exists" error for stale cache files (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix file leaks with --vfs-cache-mode full and --buffer-size 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix invalid cache path on windows when using :backend: as remote (albertony)

   • Local

     • Continue listing files/folders when a circular symlink is detected (Manish Gupta)

     • New flag --local-zero-size-links to fix sync on some virtual filesystems (Riccardo Iaconelli)

   • Azure Blob

     • Add support for service principals (James Lim)

     • Add support for managed identities (Brad Ackerman)

     • Add examples for access tier (Bob Pusateri)

     • Utilize the streaming capabilities from the SDK for multipart uploads (Denis Neuling)

     • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix crash when listing outside a SAS URL's root (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Delete archive tier blobs before update if --azureblob-archive-tier-delete (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix crash on startup (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix memory usage by upgrading the SDK to v0.13.0 and implementing a TransferManager (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Require go1.14+ to compile due to SDK changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Make NewObject use less expensive API calls (Nick Craig-Wood)

        This will improve --files-from and restic serve in particular

      Fixed crash on an empty file name (lluuaapp)

    Box

      Fix NewObject for files that differ in case (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Chunker

      Skip long local hashing, hash in-transit (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)

      Set Features ReadMimeType to false as Object.MimeType not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix case-insensitive NewObject, test metadata detection (Ivan Andreev)

    Drive

      Implement rclone backend copyid command for copying files by ID (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Added flag --drive-stop-on-download-limit to stop transfers when the download limit is exceeded (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

      Implement CleanUp workaround for team drives (buengese)

      Allow shortcut resolution and creation to be retried (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Log that emptying the trash can take some time (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add xdg office icons to xdg desktop files (Pau Rodriguez-Estivill)

    Dropbox

      Add support for viewing shared files and folders (buengese)

      Enable short lived access tokens (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement IDer on Objects so rclone lsf etc can read the IDs (buengese)

      Set Features ReadMimeType to false as Object.MimeType not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make malformed_path errors from too long files not retriable (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Test file name length before upload to fix upload loop (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Fichier

      Set Features ReadMimeType to true as Object.MimeType is supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Add --ftp-disable-msld option to ignore MLSD for really old servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make --tpslimit apply (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Storage class object header support (Laurens Janssen)

      Fix anonymous client to use rclone's HTTP client (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix Entry doesn't belong in directory "" (same as directory) - ignoring (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Googlephotos

      New flag --gphotos-include-archived to show archived photos as well (Nicolas Rueff)

    Jottacloud

      Don't erroneously report support for writing mime types (buengese)

     • Add support for Telia Cloud (Patrik Nordlén)

   • Mailru

     • Accept special folders eg camera-upload (Ivan Andreev)

     • Avoid prehashing of large local files (Ivan Andreev)

     • Fix uploads after recent changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

     • Fix range requests after June 2020 changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

     • Fix invalid timestamp on corrupted files (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)

     • Remove deprecated protocol quirks (Ivan Andreev)

   • Memory

     • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Onedrive

     • Add support for China region operated by 21vianet and other regional suppliers (NyaMisty)

     • Warn on gateway timeout errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fall back to normal copy if server-side copy unavailable (Alex Chen)

     • Fix server-side copy completely disabled on OneDrive for Business (Cnly)

     • (business only) workaround to replace existing file on server-side copy (Alex Chen)

     • Enhance link creation with expiry, scope, type and password (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Remove % and # from the set of encoded characters (Alex Chen)

     • Support addressing site by server-relative URL (kice)

   • Opendrive

     • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Pcloud

     • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Premiumizeme

     • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Qingstor

     • Fix error propagation in CleanUp (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix rclone cleanup (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • S3

     • Added --s3-disable-http2 to disable http/2 (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

     • Complete SSE-C implementation (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix hashes on small files with AWS:KMS and SSE-C (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add MD5 metadata to objects uploaded with SSE-AWS/SSE-C (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --s3-no-head parameter to minimise transactions on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Update docs with a Reducing Costs section (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Added error handling for error code 429 indicating too many requests (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

     • Add requester pays option (kelv)

     • Fix copy multipart with v2 auth failing with 'SignatureDoesNotMatch' (Louis Koo)

    SFTP

      Allow cert based auth via optional pubkey (Stephen Harris)

      Allow user to optionally check server hosts key to add security (Stephen Harris)

      Defer asking for user passwords until the SSH connection succeeds (Stephen Harris)

      Remember entered password in AskPass mode (Stephen Harris)

      Implement Shutdown method (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement keyboard interactive authentication (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make --tpslimit apply (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement --sftp-use-fstat for unusual SFTP servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Sugarsync

      Fix NewObject for files that differ in case (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Swift

      Fix deletion of parts of Static Large Object (SLO) (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)

      Ensure partially uploaded large files are uploaded unless --swift-leave-parts-on-error (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)

    Tardigrade

      Upgrade to uplink v1.4.1 (Caleb Case)

    WebDAV

      Updated docs to show streaming to nextcloud is working (Durval Menezes)

    Yandex

      Set Features WriteMimeType to false as Yandex ignores mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.4 - 2021-01-20

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.3...v1.53.4)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix data race in Transferred() (Maciej Zimnoch)

      build

        Stop tagged releases making a current beta (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Upgrade docker buildx action (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)

        Add -buildmode to cross-compile.go (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix docker build by upgrading ilteoood/docker_buildx (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Revert GitHub actions brew fix since this is now fixed (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix brew install --cask syntax for macOS build (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Update nfpm syntax to fix build of .deb/.rpm packages (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix for Windows build errors (Ivan Andreev)

      fs: Parseduration: fixed tests to use UTC time (Ankur Gupta)

      fshttp: Prevent overlap of HTTP headers in logs (Nathan Collins)

      rc

        Fix core/command giving 500 internal error (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add Copy method to rc.Params (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix 500 error when marshalling errors from core/command (Nick Craig-Wood)

        plugins: Create plugins files only if webui is enabled.  (negative0)

      serve http: Fix serving files of unknown length (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve sftp: Fix authentication on one connection blocking others (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Add optional brew tag to throw an error when using mount in the binaries installed via Homebrew (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

      Add "." and ".." to directories to match cmount and expectations (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Make cache dir absolute before using it to fix path too long errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Chunker

      Improve detection of incompatible metadata (Ivan Andreev)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fix server side copy of large objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Fix token renewer to fix long uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix token refresh failed: is not a regular file error (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Pcloud

      Only use SHA1 hashes in EU region (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Sharefile

      Undo Fix backend due to API swapping integers for strings (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Fix Open Range requests to fix 4shared mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add "Depth: 0" to GET requests to fix bitrix (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.3 - 2020-11-19

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.2...v1.53.3)

    Bug Fixes

      random: Fix incorrect use of math/rand instead of crypto/rand CVE-2020-28924 (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Passwords you have generated with rclone config may be insecure

        See issue #4783 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4783) for more details and a checking tool

      random: Seed math/rand in one place with crypto strong seed (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Fix vfs/refresh calls with fs= parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Sharefile

      Fix backend due to API swapping integers for strings (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.2 - 2020-10-26

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.1...v1.53.2)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting

        Fix incorrect speed and transferTime in core/stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Stabilize display order of transfers on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

      operations

        Fix use of --suffix without --backup-dir (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix spurious "--checksum is in use but the source and destination have no hashes in common" (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Work around GitHub actions brew problem (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Stop using set-env and set-path in the GitHub actions (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      mount2: Fix the swapped UID / GID values (Russell Cattelan)

    VFS

      Detect and recover from a file being removed externally from the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix a deadlock vulnerability in downloaders.Close (Leo Luan)

      Fix a race condition in retryFailedResets (Leo Luan)

      Fix missed concurrency control between some item operations and reset (Leo Luan)

      Add exponential backoff during ENOSPC retries (Leo Luan)

      Add a missed update of used cache space (Leo Luan)

      Fix --no-modtime to not attempt to set modtimes (as documented) (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Fix sizes and syncing with --links option on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Chunker

      Disable ListR to fix missing files on GDrive (workaround) (Ivan Andreev)

      Fix upload over crypt (Ivan Andreev)

    Fichier

      Increase maximum file size from 100GB to 300GB (gyutw)

    Jottacloud

      Remove clientSecret from config when upgrading to token based authentication (buengese)

      Avoid double url escaping of device/mountpoint (albertony)

      Remove DirMove workaround as it's not required anymore - also (buengese)

    Mailru

      Fix uploads after recent changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

      Fix range requests after june changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

      Fix invalid timestamp on corrupted files (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)

    Onedrive

      Fix disk usage for sharepoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Add missing regions for AWS (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

    Seafile

      Fix accessing libraries > 2GB on 32 bit systems (Muffin King)

    SFTP

      Always convert the checksum to lower case (buengese)

    Union

      Create root directories if none exist (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.1 - 2020-09-13

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.0...v1.53.1)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Remove new line from end of --stats-one-line display (Nick Craig-Wood)

      check

        Add back missing --download flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs

        Note --log-file does append (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add full stops for consistency in rclone --help (edwardxml)

        Add Tencent COS to s3 provider list (wjielai)

        Updated mount command to reflect that it requires Go 1.13 or newer (Evan Harris)

        jottacloud: Mention that uploads from local disk will not need to cache files to disk for md5 calculation (albertony)

        Fix formatting of rc docs page (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Include vendor tar ball in release and fix startdev (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix "Illegal instruction" error for ARMv6 builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix architecture name in ARMv7 build (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Fix spurious error "vfs cache: failed to _ensure cache EOF" (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Log an ERROR if we fail to set the file to be sparse (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Log an ERROR if we fail to set the file to be sparse (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Re-adds special oauth help text (Tim Gallant)

    Opendrive

      Do not retry 400 errors (Evan Harris)

v1.53.0 - 2020-09-02

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.0...v1.53.0)

    New Features

      The VFS layer (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#vfs-virtual-file-system) was heavily reworked for this release - see below for more details

      Interactive mode -i/--interactive (https://rclone.org/docs/#interactive) for destructive operations (fishbullet)

      Add --bwlimit-file (https://rclone.org/docs/#bwlimit-file-bandwidth-spec) flag to limit speeds of individual file transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Transfers are sorted by start time in the stats and progress output (Max Sum)

      Make sure backends expand ~ and environment vars in file names they use (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --refresh-times (https://rclone.org/docs/#refresh-times) flag to set modtimes on hashless backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Remove vendor directory in favour of Go modules (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Build with go1.15.x by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Drop macOS 386 build as it is no longer supported by go1.15 (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add ARMv7 to the supported builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Enable rclone cmount on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make rclone build with gccgo (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make rclone build with wasm (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Change beta numbering to be semver compatible (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add file properties and icon to Windows executable (albertony)

        Add experimental interface for integrating rclone into browsers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lib: Add file name compression (Klaus Post)

      rc

        Allow installation and use of plugins and test plugins with rclone-webui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Add reverse proxy pluginsHandler for serving plugins (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Add mount/listmounts option for listing current mounts (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Add operations/uploadfile to upload a file through rc using encoding multipart/form-data (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Add core/command to execute rclone terminal commands.  (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

      rclone check

        Add reporting of filenames for same/missing/changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make check command obey --dry-run/-i/--interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make check do --checkers files concurrently (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Retry downloads if they fail when using the --download flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make it show stats by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone obscure: Allow obscure command to accept password on STDIN (David Ibarra)

      rclone config

        Set RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR for use in config files and subprocesses (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Reject remote names starting with a dash.  (jtagcat)

      rclone cryptcheck: Add reporting of filenames for same/missing/changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone dedupe: Make it obey the --size-only flag for duplicate detection (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone link: Add --expire and --unlink flags (Roman Kredentser)

      rclone mkdir: Warn when using mkdir on remotes which can't have empty directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rclone rc: Allow JSON parameters to simplify command line usage (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rclone serve ftp

       • Don't compile on < go1.13 after dependency update (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add error message if auth proxy fails (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Use refactored goftp.io/server library for binary shrink (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone serve restic: Expose interfaces so that rclone can be used as a library from within restic (Jack)

      rclone sync: Add --track-renames-strategy leaf (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone touch: Add ability to set nanosecond resolution times (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone tree: Remove -i shorthand for --noindent as it conflicts with -i/--interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting

        Fix documentation for speed/speedAvg (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix elapsed time not show actual time since beginning (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Fix deadlock in stats printing (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Fix file handle leak in GitHub release tool (Garrett Squire)

      rclone check: Fix successful retries with --download counting errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rclone dedupe: Fix logging to be easier to understand (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Warn macOS users that mount implementation is changing (Nick Craig-Wood)

        to test the new implementation use rclone cmount instead of rclone mount

        this is because the library rclone uses has dropped macOS support

      rc interface

        Add call for unmount all (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Make mount/mount remote control take vfsOpt option (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add mountOpt to mount/mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add VFS and Mount options to mount/listmounts (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Catch panics in cgofuse initialization and turn into error messages (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Always supply stat information in Readdir (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add support for reading unknown length files using direct IO (Windows) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix On Windows don't add -o uid/gid=-1 if user supplies -o uid/gid.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix macOS losing directory contents in cmount (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix volume name broken in recent refactor (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • Implement partial reads for --vfs-cache-mode full (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --vfs-writeback option to delay writes back to cloud storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --vfs-read-ahead parameter for use with --vfs-cache-mode full (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Restart pending uploads on restart of the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Support synchronous cache space recovery upon ENOSPC (Leo Luan)

     • Allow ReadAt and WriteAt to run concurrently with themselves (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Change modtime of file before upload to current (Rob Calistri)

     • Recommend --vfs-cache-modes writes on backends which can't stream (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add an optional fs parameter to vfs rc methods (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix errors when using > 260 char files in the cache in Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix renaming of items while they are being uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix very high load caused by slow directory listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix renamed files not being uploaded with --vfs-cache-mode minimal (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix directory locking caused by slow directory listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix saving from chrome without --vfs-cache-mode writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Add --local-no-updated to provide a consistent view of changing objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --local-no-set-modtime option to prevent modtime changes (tyhuber1)

      Fix race conditions updating and reading Object metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Cache

      Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix dedupe on caches wrapping drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Crypt

      Add --crypt-server-side-across-configs flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Alias

      Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Don't compile on < go1.13 after dependency update (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • B2

     • Implement server-side copy for files > 5GB (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Note that b2's encoding now allows  but rclone's hasn't changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix transfers when using download_url (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Box

      Implement rclone cleanup (buengese)

      Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Allow authentication with access token (David)

    Chunker

      Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Add rclone backend drives to list shared drives (teamdrives) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement rclone backend untrash (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Work around drive bug which didn't set modtime of copied docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Added --drive-starred-only to only show starred files (Jay McEntire)

      Deprecate --drive-alternate-export as it is no longer needed (themylogin)

      Fix duplication of Google docs on server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix "panic: send on closed channel" when recycling dir entries (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Add copyright detector info in limitations section in the docs (Alex Guerrero)

      Fix rclone link by removing expires parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Fichier

      Detect Flood detected: IP Locked error and sleep for 30s (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Add explicit TLS support (Heiko Bornholdt)

      Add support for --dump bodies and --dump auth for debugging (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix interoperation with pure-ftpd (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add support for anonymous access (Kai Lüke)

    Jottacloud

      Bring back legacy authentication for use with whitelabel versions (buengese)

      Switch to new api root - also implement a very ugly workaround for the DirMove failures (buengese)

    Onedrive

      Rework cancel of multipart uploads on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement rclone cleanup (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --onedrive-no-versions flag to remove old versions (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Pcloud

      Implement rclone link for public link creation (buengese)

    Qingstor

      Cancel in progress multipart uploads on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Preserve metadata when doing multipart copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add rclone link for public link sharing (Roman Kredentser)

      Add rclone backend restore command to restore objects from GLACIER (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add rclone cleanup and rclone backend cleanup to clean unfinished multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add rclone backend list-multipart-uploads to list unfinished multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-max-upload-parts support (Kamil Trzciński)

      Add --s3-no-check-bucket for minimising rclone transactions and perms (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-profile and --s3-shared-credentials-file options (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Use regional s3 us-east-1 endpoint (David)

      Add Scaleway provider (Vincent Feltz)

      Update IBM COS endpoints (Egor Margineanu)

      Reduce the default --s3-copy-cutoff to < 5GB for Backblaze S3 compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix detection of bucket existing (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Use the absolute path instead of the relative path for listing for improved compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --sftp-subsystem and --sftp-server-command options (aus)

    Swift

      Fix dangling large objects breaking the listing (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix purge not deleting directory markers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix update multipart object removing all of its own parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix missing hash from object returned from upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Tardigrade

      Upgrade to uplink v1.2.0 (Kaloyan Raev)

    Union

      Fix writing with the all policy (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Fix directory creation with 4shared (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.52.3 - 2020-08-07

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.2...v1.52.3)

    Bug Fixes

      docs

        Disable smart typography (e.g.  en-dash) in MANUAL.* and man page (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Update install.md to reflect minimum Go version (Evan Harris)

        Update install from source instructions (Nick Craig-Wood)

        make_manual: Support SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH (Morten Linderud)

      log: Fix --use-json-log going to stderr not --log-file on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve dlna: Fix file list on Samsung Series 6+ TVs (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)

      sync: Fix deadlock with --track-renames-strategy modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Cache

      Fix moveto/copyto remote:file remote:file2 (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Stop using root_folder_id as a cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make dangling shortcuts appear in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Drop "Disabling ListR" messages down to debug (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Workaround and policy for Google Drive API (Dmitry Ustalov)

    FTP

      Add note to docs about home vs root directory selection (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Fix reverting to Copy when Move would have worked (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Avoid comma rendered in URL in onedrive.md (Kevin)

    Pcloud

      Fix oauth on European region "eapi.pcloud.com" (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Fix bucket Region auto detection when Region unset in config (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.52.2 - 2020-06-24

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.1...v1.52.2)

    Bug Fixes

      build

        Fix docker release build action (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix custom timezone in Docker image (NoLooseEnds)

      check: Fix misleading message which printed errors instead of differences (Nick Craig-Wood)

      errors: Add WSAECONNREFUSED and more to the list of retriable Windows errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rcd: Fix incorrect prometheus metrics (Gary Kim)

      serve restic: Fix flags so they use environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve webdav: Fix flags so they use environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

      sync: Fix --track-renames-strategy modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Fix not being able to delete a directory with a trashed shortcut (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix creating a directory inside a shortcut (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --drive-impersonate with cached root_folder_id (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Fix SSH key PEM loading (Zac Rubin)

    Swift

      Speed up deletes by not retrying segment container deletes (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Tardigrade

      Upgrade to uplink v1.1.1 (Caleb Case)

    WebDAV

      Fix free/used display for rclone about/df for certain backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.52.1 - 2020-06-10

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.0...v1.52.1)

    Bug Fixes

      lib/file: Fix SetSparse on Windows 7 which fixes downloads of files > 250MB (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Update go.mod to go1.14 to enable -mod=vendor build (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Remove quicktest from Dockerfile (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Build Docker images with GitHub actions (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)

        Update Docker build workflows (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Set user_allow_other in /etc/fuse.conf in the Docker image (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix xgo build after go1.14 go.mod update (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs

        Add link to source and modified time to footer of every page (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Remove manually set dates and use git dates instead (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Minor tense, punctuation, brevity and positivity changes for the home page (edwardxml)

        Remove leading slash in page reference in footer when present (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Note commands which need obscured input in the docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

        obscure: Write more help as we are referencing it elsewhere (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Fix OS vs Unix path confusion - fixes ChangeNotify on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Fix missing items when listing using --fast-list / ListR (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Putio

      Fix panic on Object.Open (Cenk Alti)

    S3

      Fix upload of single files into buckets without create permission (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --header-upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Tardigrade

      Fix listing bug by upgrading to v1.0.7

      Set UserAgent to rclone (Caleb Case)

v1.52.0 - 2020-05-27

   Special thanks to Martin Michlmayr for proof reading and correcting all the docs and Edward Barker for helping re-write the front page.

   See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.51.0...v1.52.0)

    New backends

      Tardigrade (https://rclone.org/tardigrade/) backend for use with storj.io (Caleb Case)

      Union (https://rclone.org/union/) re-write to have multiple writable remotes (Max Sum)

      Seafile for Seafile server (Fred @creativeprojects)

    New commands

      backend: command for backend-specific commands (see backends) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      cachestats: Deprecate in favour of rclone backend stats cache: (Nick Craig-Wood)

      dbhashsum: Deprecate in favour of rclone hashsum DropboxHash (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New Features

      Add --header-download and --header-upload flags for setting HTTP headers when uploading/downloading (Tim Gallant)

      Add --header flag to add HTTP headers to every HTTP transaction (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --check-first to do all checking before starting transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --track-renames-strategy for configurable matching criteria for --track-renames (Bernd Schoolmann)

      Add --cutoff-mode hard,soft,cautious (Shing Kit Chan & Franklyn Tackitt)

      Filter flags (e.g.  --files-from -) can read from stdin (fishbullet)

      Add --error-on-no-transfer option (Jon Fautley)

      Implement --order-by xxx,mixed for copying some small and some big files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Allow --max-backlog to be negative meaning as large as possible (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Added --no-unicode-normalization flag to allow Unicode filenames to remain unique (Ben Zenker)

      Allow --min-age/--max-age to take a date as well as a duration (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add rename statistics for file and directory renames (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add statistics output to JSON log (reddi)

      Make stats be printed on non-zero exit code (Nick Craig-Wood)

      When running --password-command allow use of stdin (Sébastien Gross)

      Stop empty strings being a valid remote path (Nick Craig-Wood)

      accounting: support WriterTo for less memory copying (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Update to use go1.14 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add -trimpath to release build for reproduceable builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Remove GOOS and GOARCH from Dockerfile (Brandon Philips)

      config

        Fsync the config file after writing to save more reliably (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add --obscure and --no-obscure flags to config create/update (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Make config show take remote: as well as remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

      copyurl: Add --no-clobber flag (Denis)

      delete: Added --rmdirs flag to delete directories as well (Kush)

      filter: Added --files-from-raw flag (Ankur Gupta)

      genautocomplete: Add support for fish shell (Matan Rosenberg)

      log: Add support for syslog LOCAL facilities (Patryk Jakuszew)

      lsjson: Add --hash-type parameter and use it in lsf to speed up hashing (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc

        Add -o/--opt and -a/--arg for more structured input (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Implement backend/command for running backend-specific commands remotely (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add mount/mount command for starting rclone mount via the API (Chaitanya)

      rcd: Add Prometheus metrics support (Gary Kim)

      serve http

        Added a --template flag for user defined markup (calistri)

        Add Last-Modified headers to files and directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve sftp: Add support for multiple host keys by repeating --key flag (Maxime Suret)

      touch: Add --localtime flag to make --timestamp localtime not UTC (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting

        Restore "Max number of stats groups reached" log line (Michał Matczuk)

        Correct exitcode on Transfer Limit Exceeded flag.  (Anuar Serdaliyev)

        Reset bytes read during copy retry (Ankur Gupta)

        Fix race clearing stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

      copy: Only create empty directories when they don't exist on the remote (Ishuah Kariuki)

     • dedupe: Stop dedupe deleting files with identical IDs (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • oauth

       • Use custom http client so that --no-check-certificate is honored by oauth token fetch (Mark Spieth)

       • Replace deprecated oauth2.NoContext (Lars Lehtonen)

     • operations

       • Fix setting the timestamp on Windows for multithread copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make rcat obey --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make --max-transfer more accurate (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rc

       • Fix dropped error (Lars Lehtonen)

       • Fix misplaced http server config (Xiaoxing Ye)

       • Disable duplicate log (ElonH)

     • serve dlna

       • Cds: don't specify childCount at all when unknown (Dan Walters)

        Cds: use modification time as date in dlna metadata (Dan Walters)

      serve restic: Fix tests after restic project removed vendoring (Nick Craig-Wood)

      sync

        Fix incorrect "nothing to transfer" message using --delete-before (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Only create empty directories when they don't exist on the remote (Ishuah Kariuki)

   • Mount

     • Add --async-read flag to disable asynchronous reads (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Ignore --allow-root flag with a warning as it has been removed upstream (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Warn if --allow-non-empty used on Windows and clarify docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Constrain to go1.13 or above otherwise bazil.org/fuse fails to compile (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix fail because of too long volume name (evileye)

     • Report 1PB free for unknown disk sizes (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Map more rclone errors into file systems errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix disappearing cwd problem (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Use ReaddirPlus on Windows to improve directory listing performance (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Send a hint as to whether the filesystem is case insensitive or not (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add rc command mount/types (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Change maximum leaf name length to 1024 bytes (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • Add --vfs-read-wait and --vfs-write-wait flags to control time waiting for a sequential read/write (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Change default --vfs-read-wait to 20ms (it was 5ms and not configurable) (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make df output more consistent on a rclone mount.  (Yves G)

     • Report 1PB free for unknown disk sizes (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix race condition caused by unlocked reading of Dir.path (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make File lock and Dir lock not overlap to avoid deadlock (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement lock ordering between File and Dir to eliminate deadlocks (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Factor the vfs cache into its own package (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Pin the Fs in use in the Fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add SetSys() methods to Node to allow caching stuff on a node (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Ignore file not found errors from Hash in Read.Release (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix hang in read wait code (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Local

     • Speed up multi thread downloads by using sparse files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement --local-no-sparse flag for disabling sparse files (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement rclone backend noop for testing purposes (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix "file not found" errors on post transfer Hash calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Cache

     • Implement rclone backend stats command (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix Server Side Copy with Temp Upload (Brandon McNama)

     • Remove Unused Functions (Lars Lehtonen)

     • Disable race tests until bbolt is fixed (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Move methods used for testing into test file (greatroar)

     • Add Pin and Unpin and canonicalised lookup (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Use proper import path go.etcd.io/bbolt (Robert-André Mauchin)

   • Crypt

     • Calculate hashes for uploads from local disk (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • This allows crypted Jottacloud uploads without using local disk

       • This means crypted s3/b2 uploads will now have hashes

     • Added rclone backend decode/encode commands to replicate functionality of cryptdecode (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

     • Get rid of the unused Cipher interface as it obfuscated the code (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Azure Blob

     • Implement streaming of unknown sized files so rcat is now supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement memory pooling to control memory use (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --azureblob-disable-checksum flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Retry InvalidBlobOrBlock error as it may indicate block concurrency problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Remove unused Object.parseTimeString() (Lars Lehtonen)

     • Fix permission error on SAS URL limited to container (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • B2

     • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

     • Ignore directory markers at the root also (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Force the case of the SHA1 to lowercase (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Remove unused largeUpload.clearUploadURL() (Lars Lehtonen)

   • Box

     • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

     • Implement About to read size used (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add token renew function for jwt auth (David Bramwell)

     • Added support for interchangeable root folder for Box backend (Sunil Patra)

     • Remove unnecessary iat from jws claims (David)

   • Drive

     • Follow shortcuts by default, skip with --drive-skip-shortcuts (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement rclone backend shortcut command for creating shortcuts (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Added rclone backend command to change service_account_file and chunk_size (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

     • Fix missing files when using --fast-list and --drive-shared-with-me (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix duplicate items when using --drive-shared-with-me (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Extend --drive-stop-on-upload-limit to respond to teamDriveFileLimitExceeded.  (harry)

     • Don't delete files with multiple parents to avoid data loss (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Server side copy docs use default description if empty (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Make error insufficient space to be fatal (harry)

      Add info about required redirect url (Elan Ruusamäe)

    Fichier

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

      Implement custom pacer to deal with the new rate limiting (buengese)

    FTP

      Fix lockup when using concurrency limit on failed connections (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix lockup on failed upload when using concurrency limit (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix lockup on Close failures when using concurrency limit (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Work around pureftp sending spurious 150 messages (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add ARCHIVE storage class to help (Adam Stroud)

      Ignore directory markers at the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Googlephotos

      Make the start year configurable (Daven)

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

      Create feature/favorites directory (Brandon Philips)

      Fix "concurrent map write" error (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Don't put an image in error message (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • HTTP

     • Improved directory listing with new template from Caddy project (calisro)

   • Jottacloud

     • Implement --jottacloud-trashed-only (buengese)

     • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

     • Use RawURLEncoding when decoding base64 encoded login token (buengese)

     • Implement cleanup (buengese)

     • Update docs regarding cleanup, removed remains from old auth, and added warning about special mountpoints.  (albertony)

   • Mailru

     • Describe 2FA requirements (valery1707)

   • Onedrive

     • Implement --onedrive-server-side-across-configs (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

     • Fix occasional 416 errors on multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Added maximum chunk size limit warning in the docs (Harry)

     • Fix missing drive on config (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make error quotaLimitReached to be fatal (harry)

   • Opendrive

     • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

   • Pcloud

     • Added support for interchangeable root folder for pCloud backend (Sunil Patra)

     • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

     • Fix initial config "Auth state doesn't match" message (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Premiumizeme

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

      Prune unused functions (Lars Lehtonen)

    Putio

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make downloading files use the rclone http Client (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix parsing of remotes with leading and trailing / (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Qingstor

      Make rclone cleanup remove pending multipart uploads older than 24h (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Try harder to cancel failed multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Prune multiUploader.list() (Lars Lehtonen)

      Lint fix (Lars Lehtonen)

    S3

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

      Use memory pool for buffer allocations (Maciej Zimnoch)

      Add SSE-C support for AWS, Ceph, and MinIO (Jack Anderson)

      Fail fast multipart upload (Michał Matczuk)

      Report errors on bucket creation (mkdir) correctly (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Specify that Minio supports URL encoding in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Added 500 as retryErrorCode (Michał Matczuk)

      Use --low-level-retries as the number of SDK retries (Aleksandar Janković)

      Fix multipart abort context (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      Replace deprecated session.New() with session.NewSession() (Lars Lehtonen)

      Use the provided size parameter when allocating a new memory pool (Joachim Brandon LeBlanc)

      Use rclone's low level retries instead of AWS SDK to fix listing retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Ignore directory markers at the root also (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Use single memory pool (Michał Matczuk)

     • Do not resize buf on put to memBuf (Michał Matczuk)

     • Improve docs for --s3-disable-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Don't leak memory or tokens in edge cases for multipart upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Seafile

      Implement 2FA (Fred)

    SFTP

      Added --sftp-pem-key to support inline key files (calisro)

      Fix post transfer copies failing with 0 size when using set_modtime=false (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Sharefile

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

    Sugarsync

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

    Swift

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix cosmetic issue in error message (Martin Michlmayr)

    Union

      Implement multiple writable remotes (Max Sum)

      Fix server-side copy (Max Sum)

      Implement ListR (Max Sum)

      Enable ListR when upstreams contain local (Max Sum)

    WebDAV

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

      Fix X-OC-Mtime header for Transip compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Report full and consistent usage with about (Yves G)

    Yandex

      Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

v1.51.0 - 2020-02-01

    New backends

      Memory (https://rclone.org/memory/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Sugarsync (https://rclone.org/sugarsync/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New Features

      Adjust all backends to have --backend-encoding parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

        this enables the encoding for special characters to be adjusted or disabled

      Add --max-duration flag to control the maximum duration of a transfer session (boosh)

      Add --expect-continue-timeout flag, default 1s (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --no-check-dest flag for copying without testing the destination (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Implement --order-by flag to order transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      accounting

        Don't show entries in both transferring and checking (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add option to delete stats (Aleksandar Jankovic)

     • build

       • Compress the test builds with gzip (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Implement a framework for starting test servers during tests (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • cmd: Always print elapsed time to tenth place seconds in progress (Gary Kim)

     • config

       • Add --password-command to allow dynamic config password (Damon Permezel)

       • Give config questions default values (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Check a remote exists when creating a new one (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • copyurl: Add --stdout flag to write to stdout (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • dedupe: Implement keep smallest too (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • hashsum: Add flag --base64 flag (landall)

     • lsf: Speed up on s3/swift/etc by not reading mimetype by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • lsjson: Add --no-mimetype flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rc: Add methods to turn on blocking and mutex profiling (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rcd

       • Adding group parameter to stats (Chaitanya)

       • Move webgui apart; option to disable browser (Xiaoxing Ye)

     • serve sftp: Add support for public key with auth proxy (Paul Tinsley)

     • stats: Show deletes in stats and hide zero stats (anuar45)

   • Bug Fixes

     • accounting

       • Fix error counter counting multiple times (Ankur Gupta)

       • Fix error count shown as checks (Cnly)

       • Clear finished transfer in stats-reset (Maciej Zimnoch)

       • Added StatsInfo locking in statsGroups sum function (Michał Matczuk)

     • asyncreader: Fix EOF error (buengese)

     • check: Fix --one-way recursing more directories than it needs to (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • chunkedreader: Disable hash calculation for first segment (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • config

       • Do not open browser on headless on drive/gcs/google photos (Xiaoxing Ye)

       • SetValueAndSave ignore error if config section does not exist yet (buengese)

     • cmd: Fix completion with an encrypted config (Danil Semelenov)

     • dbhashsum: Stop it returning UNSUPPORTED on dropbox (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • dedupe: Add missing modes to help string (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • operations

       • Fix dedupe continuing on errors like insufficientFilePersimmon (SezalAgrawal)

       • Clear accounting before low level retry (Maciej Zimnoch)

       • Write debug message when hashes could not be checked (Ole Schütt)

       • Move interface assertion to tests to remove pflag dependency (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make NewOverrideObjectInfo public and factor uses (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • proxy: Replace use of bcrypt with sha256 (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • vendor

       • Update bazil.org/fuse to fix FreeBSD 12.1 (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Update github.com/t3rm1n4l/go-mega to fix mega "illegal base64 data at input byte 22" (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Update termbox-go to fix ncdu command on FreeBSD (Kuang-che Wu)

       • Update t3rm1n4l/go-mega - fixes mega: couldn't login: crypto/aes: invalid key size 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Enable async reads for a 20% speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Replace use of WriteAt with Write for cache mode >= writes and O_APPEND (Brett Dutro)

      Make sure we call unmount when exiting (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Don't build on go1.10 as bazil/fuse no longer supports it (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • When setting dates discard out of range dates (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • Add a newly created file straight into the directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Only calculate one hash for reads for a speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make ReadAt for non cached files work better with non-sequential reads (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix edge cases when reading ModTime from file (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Make sure existing files opened for write show correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Don't cache the path in RW file objects to fix renaming (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix rename of open files when using the VFS cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      When renaming files in the cache, rename the cache item in memory too (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix open file renaming on drive when using --vfs-cache-mode writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix incorrect modtime for mv into mount with --vfs-cache-modes writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      On rename, rename in cache too if the file exists (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

    Local

      Make source file being updated errors be NoLowLevelRetry errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix update of hidden files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Cache

      Follow move of upstream library github.com/coreos/bbolt github.com/etcd-io/bbolt (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix fatal error: concurrent map writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Crypt

      Reorder the filename encryption options (Thomas Eales)

      Correctly handle trailing dot (buengese)

    Chunker

      Reduce length of temporary suffix (Ivan Andreev)

    Drive

      Add --drive-stop-on-upload-limit flag to stop syncs when upload limit reached (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --drive-use-shared-date to use date file was shared instead of modified date (Garry McNulty)

      Make sure invalid auth for teamdrives always reports an error (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --fast-list when using appDataFolder (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Use multipart resumable uploads for streaming and uploads in mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Log an ERROR if an incomplete search is returned (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Hide dangerous config from the configurator (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Treat insufficient_space errors as non retriable errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Use new auth method used by official client (buengese)

      Add URL to generate Login Token to config wizard (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add support whitelabel versions (buengese)

    Koofr

      Use rclone HTTP client.  (jaKa)

    Onedrive

      Add Sites.Read.All permission (Benjamin Richter)

      Add support "Retry-After" header (Motonori IWAMURO)

    Opendrive

      Implement --opendrive-chunk-size (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Re-implement multipart upload to fix memory issues (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-copy-cutoff for size to switch to multipart copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add new region Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) (Outvi V)

      Reduce memory usage streaming files by reducing max stream upload size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-list-chunk option for bucket listing (Thomas Kriechbaumer)

      Force path style bucket access to off for AWS deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Use AWS web identity role provider if available (Tennix)

      Add StackPath Object Storage Support (Dave Koston)

      Fix ExpiryWindow value (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      Fix DisableChecksum condition (Aleksandar Janković)

      Fix URL decoding of NextMarker (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Add --sftp-skip-links to skip symlinks and non regular files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Retry Creation of Connection (Sebastian Brandt)

      Fix "failed to parse private key file: ssh: not an encrypted key" error (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Open files for update write only to fix AWS SFTP interop (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Swift

      Reserve segments of dynamic large object when delete objects in container what was enabled versioning.  (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)

      Fix parsing of X-Object-Manifest (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Update OVH API endpoint (unbelauscht)

    WebDAV

      Make nextcloud only upload SHA1 checksums (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix case of "Bearer" in Authorization: header to agree with RFC (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add Referer header to fix problems with WAFs (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.50.2 - 2019-11-19

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix memory leak on retries operations (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Fix listing of the root directory with drive.files scope (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --drive-root-folder-id with team/shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.50.1 - 2019-11-02

    Bug Fixes

      hash: Fix accidentally changed hash names for DropboxHash and CRC-32 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fshttp: Fix error reporting on tpslimit token bucket errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      fshttp: Don't print token bucket errors on context cancelled (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Fix listings of .  on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Fix DirMove/Move after Onedrive change (Xiaoxing Ye)

v1.50.0 - 2019-10-26

    New backends

      Citrix Sharefile (https://rclone.org/sharefile/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Chunker (https://rclone.org/chunker/) - an overlay backend to split files into smaller parts (Ivan Andreev)

      Mail.ru Cloud (https://rclone.org/mailru/) (Ivan Andreev)

    New Features

      encodings (Fabian Möller & Nick Craig-Wood)

        All backends now use file name encoding to ensure any file name can be written to any backend.

        See the restricted file name docs (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-filenames) for more info and the local backend docs.

        Some  file  names  may  look  different  in  rclone  if  you  are  using   any   control   characters   in   names   or   unicode   FULLWIDTH   symbols
         (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Halfwidth_and_Fullwidth_Forms_(Unicode_block)).

      build

        Update to use go1.13 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Drop support for go1.9 (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Build rclone with GitHub actions (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Convert python scripts to python3 (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Swap Azure/go-ansiterm for mattn/go-colorable (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Dockerfile fixes (Matei David)

        Add plugin support (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/CONTRIBUTING.md#writing-a-plugin) for backends and commands (Richard Patel)

      config

        Use alternating Red/Green in config to make more obvious (Nick Craig-Wood)

      contrib

        Add sample DLNA server Docker Compose manifest.  (pataquets)

        Add sample WebDAV server Docker Compose manifest.  (pataquets)

      copyurl

        Add --auto-filename flag for using file name from URL in destination path (Denis)

      serve dlna:

        Many compatibility improvements (Dan Walters)

        Support for external srt subtitles (Dan Walters)

      rc

        Added command core/quit (Saksham Khanna)

    Bug Fixes

      sync

        Make --update/-u not transfer files that haven't changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Free objects after they come out of the transfer pipe to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix --files-from without --no-traverse doing a recursive scan (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • operations

       • Fix accounting for server-side copies (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Display 'All duplicates removed' only if dedupe successful (Sezal Agrawal)

       • Display 'Deleted X extra copies' only if dedupe successful (Sezal Agrawal)

     • accounting

       • Only allow up to 100 completed transfers in the accounting list to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cull the old time ranges when possible to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix panic due to server-side copy fallback (Ivan Andreev)

       • Fix memory leak noticeable for transfers of large numbers of objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fix total duration calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • cmd

       • Fix environment variables not setting command line flags (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Make autocomplete compatible with bash's posix mode for macOS (Danil Semelenov)

        Make --progress work in git bash on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix 'compopt: command not found' on autocomplete on macOS (Danil Semelenov)

      config

        Fix setting of non top level flags from environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Check config names more carefully and report errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Remove error: can't use --size-only and --ignore-size together.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • filter: Prevent mixing options when --files-from is in use (Michele Caci)

     • serve sftp: Fix crash on unsupported operations (e.g.  Readlink) (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Mount

     • Allow files of unknown size to be read properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Skip tests on <= 2 CPUs to avoid lockup (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix panic on File.Open (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix "mount_fusefs: -o timeout=: option not supported" on FreeBSD (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Don't pass huge filenames (>4k) to FUSE as it can't cope (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Add flag --vfs-case-insensitive for windows/macOS mounts (Ivan Andreev)

      Make objects of unknown size readable through the VFS (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Move writeback of dirty data out of close() method into its own method (FlushWrites) and remove close() call from Flush() (Brett Dutro)

      Stop empty dirs disappearing when renamed on bucket-based remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Stop change notify polling clearing so much of the directory cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Disable logging to the Windows event log (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Remove unverified: prefix on sha1 to improve interop (e.g.  with CyberDuck) (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Box

      Add options to get access token via JWT auth (David)

    Drive

      Disable HTTP/2 by default to work around INTERNAL_ERROR problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make sure that drive root ID is always canonical (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --drive-shared-with-me from the root with lsand --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix ChangeNotify polling for shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix change notify polling when using appDataFolder (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Make disallowed filenames errors not retry (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix nil pointer exception on restricted files (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Fichier

      Fix accessing files > 2GB on 32 bit systems (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Allow disabling EPSV mode (Jon Fautley)

    HTTP

      HEAD directory entries in parallel to speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --http-no-head to stop rclone doing HEAD in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Putio

      Add ability to resume uploads (Cenk Alti)

    S3

      Fix signature v2_auth headers (Anthony Rusdi)

      Fix encoding for control characters (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Only ask for URL encoded directory listings if we need them on Ceph (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add option for multipart failure behaviour (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      Support for multipart copy (庄天翼)

      Fix nil pointer reference if no metadata returned for object (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Fix --sftp-ask-password trying to contact the ssh agent (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix hashes of files with backslashes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Include more ciphers with --sftp-use-insecure-cipher (Carlos Ferreyra)

    WebDAV

      Parse and return Sharepoint error response (Henning Surmeier)

v1.49.5 - 2019-10-05

    Bug Fixes

      Revert back to go1.12.x for the v1.49.x builds as go1.13.x was causing issues (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix rpm packages by using master builds of nfpm (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix macOS build after brew changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.4 - 2019-09-29

    Bug Fixes

      cmd/rcd: Address ZipSlip vulnerability (Richard Patel)

      accounting: Fix file handle leak on errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      oauthutil: Fix security problem when running with two users on the same machine (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Fix listing of an empty root returning: error dir not found (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Fix SetModTime on GLACIER/ARCHIVE objects and implement set/get tier (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.3 - 2019-09-15

    Bug Fixes

      accounting

        Fix total duration calculation (Aleksandar Jankovic)

        Fix "file already closed" on transfer retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.2 - 2019-09-08

    New Features

      build: Add Docker workflow support (Alfonso Montero)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix locking in Transfer to avoid deadlock with --progress (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs: Fix template argument for mktemp in install.sh (Cnly)

      operations: Fix -u/--update with google photos / files of unknown size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc: Fix docs for config/create /update /password (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fix need for elevated permissions on SetModTime (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.1 - 2019-08-28

    Bug Fixes

      config: Fix generated passwords being stored as empty password (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rcd: Added missing parameter for web-gui info logs.  (Chaitanya)

    Googlephotos

      Fix crash on error response (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Fix crash on error response (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.0 - 2019-08-26

    New backends

      1fichier (https://rclone.org/fichier/) (Laura Hausmann)

      Google Photos (https://rclone.org/googlephotos/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Putio (https://rclone.org/putio/) (Cenk Alti)

      premiumize.me (https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New Features

      Experimental web GUI (https://rclone.org/gui/) (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

      Implement --compare-dest & --copy-dest (yparitcher)

      Implement --suffix without --backup-dir for backup to current dir (yparitcher)

      config reconnect to re-login (re-run the oauth login) for the backend.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config userinfo to discover which user you are logged in as.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config disconnect to disconnect you (log out) from the backend.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --use-json-log for JSON logging (justinalin)

      Add context propagation to rclone (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      Reworking internal statistics interfaces so they work with rc jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      Add Higher units for ETA (AbelThar)

      Update rclone logos to new design (Andreas Chlupka)

      hash: Add CRC-32 support (Cenk Alti)

      help showbackend: Fixed advanced option category when there are no standard options (buengese)

      ncdu: Display/Copy to Clipboard Current Path (Gary Kim)

      operations:

        Run hashing operations in parallel (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Don't calculate checksums when using --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Check transfer hashes when using --size-only mode (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Disable multi thread copy for local to local copies (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Debug successful hashes as well as failures (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • rc

       • Add ability to stop async jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)

       • Return current settings if core/bwlimit called without parameters (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Rclone-WebUI integration with rclone (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

       • Added command line parameter to control the cross origin resource sharing (CORS) in the rcd.  (Security Improvement) (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

       • Add anchor tags to the docs so links are consistent (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Remove _async key from input parameters after parsing so later operations won't get confused (buengese)

        Add call to clear stats (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      rcd

        Auto-login for web-gui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

        Implement --baseurl for rcd and web-gui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

      serve dlna

        Only select interfaces which can multicast for SSDP (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add more builtin mime types to cover standard audio/video (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix missing mime types on Android causing missing videos (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve ftp

        Refactor to bring into line with other serve commands (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Implement --auth-proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve http: Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve restic: Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve sftp

        Implement auth proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix detection of whether server is authorized (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve webdav

        Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Support --auth-proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Bug Fixes

      Make "bad record MAC" a retriable error (Nick Craig-Wood)

      copyurl: Fix copying files that return HTTP errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      march: Fix checking sub-directories when using --no-traverse (buengese)

      rc

        Fix unmarshalable http.AuthFn in options and put in test for marshalability (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Move job expire flags to rc to fix initialization problem (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix --loopback with rc/list and others (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rcat: Fix slowdown on systems with multiple hashes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rcd: Fix permissions problems on cache directory with web gui download (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Default --daemon-timeout to 15 minutes on macOS and FreeBSD (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Update docs to show mounting from root OK for bucket-based (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Remove nonseekable flag from write files (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Make write without cache more efficient (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --vfs-cache-mode minimal and writes ignoring cached files (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Add --local-case-sensitive and --local-case-insensitive (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Avoid polluting page cache when uploading local files to remote backends (Michał Matczuk)

      Don't calculate any hashes by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fadvise run syscall on a dedicated go routine (Michał Matczuk)

    Azure Blob

      Azure Storage Emulator support (Sandeep)

      Updated config help details to remove connection string references (Sandeep)

      Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Implement link sharing (yparitcher)

      Enable server-side copy to copy between buckets (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Fix server-side copy of big files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Update API for teamdrive use (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add error for purge with --drive-trashed-only (ginvine)

    Fichier

      Make FolderID int and adjust related code (buengese)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Reduce oauth scope requested as suggested by Google (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    HTTP

      Add --http-headers flag for setting arbitrary headers (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Use new api for retrieving internal username (buengese)

      Refactor configuration and minor cleanup (buengese)

    Koofr

      Support setting modification times on Koofr backend.  (jaKa)

    Opendrive

      Refactor to use existing lib/rest facilities for uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Qingstor

      Upgrade to v3 SDK and fix listing loop (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Add INTELLIGENT_TIERING storage class (Matti Niemenmaa)

      Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Add missing interface check and fix About (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Completely ignore all modtime checks if SetModTime=false (Jon Fautley)

      Support md5/sha1 with rsync.net (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Save the md5/sha1 command in use to the config file for efficiency (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Opt-in support for diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256 diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1 (Yi FU)

    Swift

      Use FixRangeOption to fix 0 length files via the VFS (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix upload when using no_chunk to return the correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix segments leak during failed large file uploads.  (nguyenhuuluan434)

    WebDAV

      Add --webdav-bearer-token-command (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Refresh token when it expires with --webdav-bearer-token-command (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add docs for using bearer_token_command with oidc-agent (Paul Millar)

v1.48.0 - 2019-06-15

    New commands

      serve sftp: Serve an rclone remote over SFTP (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New Features

      Multi threaded downloads to local storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

        controlled with --multi-thread-cutoff and --multi-thread-streams

      Use rclone.conf from rclone executable directory to enable portable use (albertony)

      Allow sync of a file and a directory with the same name (forgems)

        this is common on bucket-based remotes, e.g.  s3, gcs

      Add --ignore-case-sync for forced case insensitivity (garry415)

      Implement --stats-one-line-date and --stats-one-line-date-format (Peter Berbec)

      Log an ERROR for all commands which exit with non-zero status (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Use go-homedir to read the home directory more reliably (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Enable creating encrypted config through external script invocation (Wojciech Smigielski)

      build: Drop support for go1.8 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config: Make config create/update encrypt passwords where necessary (Nick Craig-Wood)

      copyurl: Honor --no-check-certificate (Stefan Breunig)

      install: Linux skip man pages if no mandb (didil)

      lsf: Support showing the Tier of the object (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lsjson

        Added EncryptedPath to output (calisro)

        Support showing the Tier of the object (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add IsBucket field for bucket-based remote listing of the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc

        Add --loopback flag to run commands directly without a server (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add operations/fsinfo: Return information about the remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Skip auth for OPTIONS request (Nick Craig-Wood)

        cmd/providers: Add DefaultStr, ValueStr and Type fields (Nick Craig-Wood)

        jobs: Make job expiry timeouts configurable (Aleksandar Jankovic)

      serve dlna reworked and improved (Dan Walters)

      serve ftp: add --ftp-public-ip flag to specify public IP (calistri)

      serve restic: Add support for --private-repos in serve restic (Florian Apolloner)

      serve webdav: Combine serve webdav and serve http (Gary Kim)

      size: Ignore negative sizes when calculating total (Garry McNulty)

    Bug Fixes

      Make move and copy individual files obey --backup-dir (Nick Craig-Wood)

      If --ignore-checksum is in effect, don't calculate checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • moveto: Fix case-insensitive same remote move (Gary Kim)

     • rc: Fix serving bucket-based objects with --rc-serve (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • serve webdav: Fix serveDir not being updated with changes from webdav (Gary Kim)

   • Mount

     • Fix poll interval documentation (Animosity022)

   • VFS

     • Make WriteAt for non cached files work with non-sequential writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Local

     • Only calculate the required hashes for big speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Log errors when listing instead of returning an error (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix preallocate warning on Linux with ZFS (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Crypt

     • Make rclone dedupe work through crypt (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix wrapping of ChangeNotify to decrypt directories properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Support PublicLink (rclone link) of underlying backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement Optional methods SetTier, GetTier (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • B2

     • Implement server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement SetModTime (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Drive

     • Fix move and copy from TeamDrive to GDrive (Fionera)

     • Add notes that cleanup works in the background on drive (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --drive-server-side-across-configs to default back to old server-side copy semantics by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --drive-size-as-quota to show storage quota usage for file size (Garry McNulty)

   • FTP

     • Add FTP List timeout (Jeff Quinn)

     • Add FTP over TLS support (Gary Kim)

     • Add --ftp-no-check-certificate option for FTPS (Gary Kim)

   • Google Cloud Storage

     • Fix upload errors when uploading pre 1970 files (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Jottacloud

     • Add support for selecting device and mountpoint.  (buengese)

   • Mega

     • Add cleanup support (Gary Kim)

   • Onedrive

     • More accurately check if root is found (Cnly)

   • S3

     • Support S3 Accelerated endpoints with --s3-use-accelerate-endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add config info for Wasabi's EU Central endpoint (Robert Marko)

      Make SetModTime work for GLACIER while syncing (Philip Harvey)

    SFTP

      Add About support (Gary Kim)

      Fix about parsing of df results so it can cope with -ve results (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Send custom client version and debug server version (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Retry on 423 Locked errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.47.0 - 2019-04-13

    New backends

      Backend for Koofr cloud storage service.  (jaKa)

    New Features

      Resume downloads if the reader fails in copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

        this means rclone will restart transfers if the source has an error

        this is most useful for downloads or cloud to cloud copies

      Use --fast-list for listing operations where it won't use more memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • this should speed up the following operations on remotes which support ListR

       • dedupe, serve restic lsf, ls, lsl, lsjson, lsd, md5sum, sha1sum, hashsum, size, delete, cat, settier

       • use --disable ListR to get old behaviour if required

     • Make --files-from traverse the destination unless --no-traverse is set (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • this fixes --files-from with Google drive and excessive API use in general.

     • Make server-side copy account bytes and obey --max-transfer (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --create-empty-src-dirs flag and default to not creating empty dirs (ishuah)

     • Add client side TLS/SSL flags --ca-cert/--client-cert/--client-key (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Implement --suffix-keep-extension for use with --suffix (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • build:

       • Switch to semver compliant version tags to be go modules compliant (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Update to use go1.12.x for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • serve dlna: Add connection manager service description to improve compatibility (Dan Walters)

     • lsf: Add 'e' format to show encrypted names and 'o' for original IDs (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lsjson: Added --files-only and --dirs-only flags (calistri)

      rc: Implement operations/publiclink the equivalent of rclone link (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting: Fix total ETA when --stats-unit bits is in effect (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Bash TAB completion

        Use private custom func to fix clash between rclone and kubectl (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix for remotes with underscores in their names (Six)

        Fix completion of remotes (Florian Gamböck)

        Fix autocompletion of remote paths with spaces (Danil Semelenov)

      serve dlna: Fix root XML service descriptor (Dan Walters)

      ncdu: Fix display corruption with Chinese characters (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add SIGTERM to signals which run the exit handlers on unix (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc: Reload filter when the options are set via the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS / Mount

      Fix FreeBSD: Ignore Truncate if called with no readers and already the correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Read directory and check for a file before mkdir (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Shorten the locking window for vfs/refresh (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Enable MD5 checksums when uploading files bigger than the "Cutoff" (Dr.Rx)

      Fix SAS URL support (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Allow manual configuration of backblaze downloadUrl (Vince)

      Ignore already_hidden error on remove (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Ignore malformed src_last_modified_millis (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Add --skip-checksum-gphotos to ignore incorrect checksums on Google Photos (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Allow server-side move/copy between different remotes.  (Fionera)

      Add docs on team drives and --fast-list eventual consistency (Nestar47)

      Fix imports of text files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix range requests on 0 length files (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix creation of duplicates with server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Retry blank errors to fix long listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Add --ftp-concurrency to limit maximum number of connections (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fall back to default application credentials (marcintustin)

      Allow bucket policy only buckets (Nick Craig-Wood)

    HTTP

      Add --http-no-slash for websites with directories with no slashes (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Remove duplicates from listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix socket leak on 404 errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Fix token refresh (Sebastian Bünger)

      Add device registration (Oliver Heyme)

    Onedrive

      Implement graceful cancel of multipart uploads if rclone is interrupted (Cnly)

      Always add trailing colon to path when addressing items, (Cnly)

      Return errors instead of panic for invalid uploads (Fabian Möller)

    S3

      Add support for "Glacier Deep Archive" storage class (Manu)

      Update Dreamhost endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Note incompatibility with CEPH Jewel (Nick Craig-Wood)

    SFTP

      Allow custom ssh client config (Alexandru Bumbacea)

    Swift

      Obey Retry-After to enable OVH restore from cold storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Work around token expiry on CEPH (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Allow IsCollection property to be integer or boolean (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix race when creating directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix About/df when reading the available/total returns 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.46 - 2019-02-09

    New backends

      Support Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) OSS via the s3 backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New commands

      serve dlna: serves a remove via DLNA for the local network (nicolov)

    New Features

      copy, move: Restore deprecated --no-traverse flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

        This is useful for when transferring a small number of files into a large destination

      genautocomplete: Add remote path completion for bash completion (Christopher Peterson & Danil Semelenov)

      Buffer memory handling reworked to return memory to the OS better (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Buffer recycling library to replace sync.Pool

        Optionally use memory mapped memory for better memory shrinking

        Enable with --use-mmap if having memory problems - not default yet

      Parallelise reading of files specified by --files-from (Nick Craig-Wood)

      check: Add stats showing total files matched.  (Dario Guzik)

      Allow rename/delete open files under Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

      lsjson: Use exactly the correct number of decimal places in the seconds (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add cookie support with cmdline switch --use-cookies for all HTTP based remotes (qip)

      Warn if --checksum is set but there are no hashes available (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Rework rate limiting (pacer) to be more accurate and allow bursting (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Improve error reporting for too many/few arguments in commands (Nick Craig-Wood)

      listremotes: Remove -l short flag as it conflicts with the new global flag (weetmuts)

      Make http serving with auth generate INFO messages on auth fail (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Bug Fixes

      Fix layout of stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix --progress crash under Windows Jenkins (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix transfer of google/onedrive docs by calling Rcat in Copy when size is -1 (Cnly)

      copyurl: Fix checking of --dry-run (Denis Skovpen)

    Mount

      Check that mountpoint and local directory to mount don't overlap (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix mount size under 32 bit Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • VFS

     • Implement renaming of directories for backends without DirMove (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • now all backends except b2 support renaming directories

     • Implement --vfs-cache-max-size to limit the total size of the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Add --dir-perms and --file-perms flags to set default permissions (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix deadlock on concurrent operations on a directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix deadlock between RWFileHandle.close and File.Remove (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix renaming/deleting open files with cache mode "writes" under Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix panic on rename with --dry-run set (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix vfs/refresh with recurse=true needing the --fast-list flag

   • Local

     • Add support for -l/--links (symbolic link translation) (yair@unicorn)

       • this works by showing links as link.rclonelink - see local backend docs for more info

       • this errors if used with -L/--copy-links

     • Fix renaming/deleting open files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Crypt

     • Check for maximum length before decrypting filename to fix panic (Garry McNulty)

   • Azure Blob

     • Allow building azureblob backend on *BSD (themylogin)

     • Use the rclone HTTP client to support --dump headers, --tpslimit, etc.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Use the s3 pacer for 0 delay in non error conditions (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Ignore directory markers (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Stop Mkdir attempting to create existing containers (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • B2

     • cleanup: will remove unfinished large files >24hrs old (Garry McNulty)

     • For a bucket limited application key check the bucket name (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • before this, rclone would use the authorised bucket regardless of what you put on the command line

     • Added --b2-disable-checksum flag (Wojciech Smigielski)

       • this enables large files to be uploaded without a SHA-1 hash for speed reasons

   • Drive

     • Set default pacer to 100ms for 10 tps (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • This fits the Google defaults much better and reduces the 403 errors massively

       • Add --drive-pacer-min-sleep and --drive-pacer-burst to control the pacer

     • Improve ChangeNotify support for items with multiple parents (Fabian Möller)

     • Fix ListR for items with multiple parents - this fixes oddities with vfs/refresh (Fabian Möller)

     • Fix using --drive-impersonate and appfolders (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Fix google docs in rclone mount for some (not all) applications (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Dropbox

     • Retry-After support for Dropbox backend (Mathieu Carbou)

   • FTP

     • Wait for 60 seconds for a connection to Close then declare it dead (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • helps with indefinite hangs on some FTP servers

   • Google Cloud Storage

     • Update google cloud storage endpoints (weetmuts)

   • HTTP

     • Add an example with username and password which is supported but wasn't documented (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix backend with --files-from and nonexistent files (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Hubic

      Make error message more informative if authentication fails (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Resume and deduplication support (Oliver Heyme)

      Use token auth for all API requests Don't store password anymore (Sebastian Bünger)

      Add support for 2-factor authentication (Sebastian Bünger)

    Mega

      Implement v2 account login which fixes logins for newer Mega accounts (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Return error if an unknown length file is attempted to be uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add new error codes for better error reporting (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Fix broken support for "shared with me" folders (Alex Chen)

      Fix root ID not normalised (Cnly)

      Return err instead of panic on unknown-sized uploads (Cnly)

    Qingstor

      Fix go routine leak on multipart upload errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add upload chunk size/concurrency/cutoff control (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Default --qingstor-upload-concurrency to 1 to work around bug (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Implement --s3-upload-cutoff for single part uploads below this (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Change --s3-upload-concurrency default to 4 to increase performance (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-bucket-acl to control bucket ACL (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Auto detect region for buckets on operation failure (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add GLACIER storage class (William Cocker)

      Add Scaleway to s3 documentation (Rémy Léone)

      Add AWS endpoint eu-north-1 (weetmuts)

    SFTP

      Add support for PEM encrypted private keys (Fabian Möller)

      Add option to force the usage of an ssh-agent (Fabian Möller)

      Perform environment variable expansion on key-file (Fabian Möller)

      Fix rmdir on Windows based servers (e.g.  CrushFTP) (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix rmdir deleting directory contents on some SFTP servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix error on dangling symlinks (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Swift

      Add --swift-no-chunk to disable segmented uploads in rcat/mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Introduce application credential auth support (kayrus)

      Fix memory usage by slimming Object (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix extra requests on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix reauth on big files (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Union

      Fix poll-interval not working (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Support About which means rclone mount will show the correct disk size (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Support MD5 and SHA1 hashes with Owncloud and Nextcloud (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fail soft on time parsing errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix infinite loop on failed directory creation (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix identification of directories for Bitrix Site Manager (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix upload of 0 length files on some servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix if MKCOL fails with 423 Locked assume the directory exists (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.45 - 2018-11-24

    New backends

      The Yandex backend was re-written - see below for details (Sebastian Bünger)

    New commands

      rcd: New command just to serve the remote control API (Nick Craig-Wood)

    New Features

      The remote control API (rc) was greatly expanded to allow full control over rclone (Nick Craig-Wood)

        sensitive operations require authorization or the --rc-no-auth flag

        config/* operations to configure rclone

        options/* for reading/setting command line flags

        operations/* for all low level operations, e.g.  copy file, list directory

        sync/* for sync, copy and move

        --rc-files flag to serve files on the rc http server

          this is for building web native GUIs for rclone

        Optionally serving objects on the rc http server

        Ensure rclone fails to start up if the --rc port is in use already

        See the rc docs (https://rclone.org/rc/) for more info

      sync/copy/move

        Make --files-from only read the objects specified and don't scan directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • This is a huge speed improvement for destinations with lots of files

     • filter: Add --ignore-case flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • ncdu: Add remove function ('d' key) (Henning Surmeier)

     • rc command

       • Add --json flag for structured JSON input (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Add --user and --pass flags and interpret --rc-user, --rc-pass, --rc-addr (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • build

       • Require go1.8 or later for compilation (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Enable softfloat on MIPS arch (Scott Edlund)

       • Integration test framework revamped with a better report and better retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

   • Bug Fixes

     • cmd: Make --progress update the stats correctly at the end (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • config: Create config directory on save if it is missing (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • dedupe: Check for existing filename before renaming a dupe file (ssaqua)

     • move: Don't create directories with --dry-run (Nick Craig-Wood)

      operations: Fix Purge and Rmdirs when dir is not the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

      serve http/webdav/restic: Ensure rclone exits if the port is in use (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Mount

      Make --volname work for Windows and macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Avoid context deadline exceeded error by setting a large TryTimeout value (brused27)

      Fix erroneous Rmdir error "directory not empty" (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Wait for up to 60s to create a just deleted container (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Dropbox

      Add dropbox impersonate support (Jake Coggiano)

    Jottacloud

      Fix bug in --fast-list handing of empty folders (albertony)

    Opendrive

      Fix transfer of files with + and & in (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix retries of upload chunks (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Set ACL for server-side copies to that provided by the user (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix role_arn, credential_source, ...  (Erik Swanson)

      Add config info for Wasabi's US-West endpoint (Henry Ptasinski)

    SFTP

      Ensure file hash checking is really disabled (Jon Fautley)

    Swift

      Add pacer for retries to make swift more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Add Content-Type to PUT requests (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix config parsing so --webdav-user and --webdav-pass flags work (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add RFC3339 date format (Ralf Hemberger)

    Yandex

      The yandex backend was re-written (Sebastian Bünger)

        This implements low level retries (Sebastian Bünger)

        Copy, Move, DirMove, PublicLink and About optional interfaces (Sebastian Bünger)

        Improved general error handling (Sebastian Bünger)

        Removed ListR for now due to inconsistent behaviour (Sebastian Bünger)

v1.44 - 2018-10-15

    New commands

      serve ftp: Add ftp server (Antoine GIRARD)

      settier: perform storage tier changes on supported remotes (sandeepkru)

    New Features

      Reworked command line help

        Make default help less verbose (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Split flags up into global and backend flags (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Implement specialised help for flags and backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Show URL of backend help page when starting config (Nick Craig-Wood)

      stats: Long names now split in center (Joanna Marek)

      Add --log-format flag for more control over log output (dcpu)

      rc: Add support for OPTIONS and basic CORS (frenos)

      stats: show FatalErrors and NoRetryErrors in stats (Cédric Connes)

    Bug Fixes

      Fix -P not ending with a new line (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config: don't create default config dir when user supplies --config (albertony)

     • Don't print non-ASCII characters with --progress on windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Correct logs for excluded items (ssaqua)

    Mount

      Remove EXPERIMENTAL tags (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Fix race condition detected by serve ftp tests (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add vfs/poll-interval rc command (Fabian Möller)

      Enable rename for nearly all remotes using server-side Move or Copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Reduce directory cache cleared by poll-interval (Fabian Möller)

      Remove EXPERIMENTAL tags (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Local

      Skip bad symlinks in dir listing with -L enabled (Cédric Connes)

      Preallocate files on Windows to reduce fragmentation (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Preallocate files on linux with fallocate(2) (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Cache

      Add cache/fetch rc function (Fabian Möller)

      Fix worker scale down (Fabian Möller)

      Improve performance by not sending info requests for cached chunks (dcpu)

      Fix error return value of cache/fetch rc method (Fabian Möller)

      Documentation fix for cache-chunk-total-size (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

      Preserve leading / in wrapped remote path (Fabian Möller)

      Add plex_insecure option to skip certificate validation (Fabian Möller)

      Remove entries that no longer exist in the source (dcpu)

    Crypt

      Preserve leading / in wrapped remote path (Fabian Möller)

    Alias

      Fix handling of Windows network paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Add --azureblob-list-chunk parameter (Santiago Rodríguez)

      Implemented settier command support on azureblob remote.  (sandeepkru)

      Work around SDK bug which causes errors for chunk-sized files (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Box

      Implement link sharing.  (Sebastian Bünger)

    Drive

      Add --drive-import-formats - google docs can now be imported (Fabian Möller)

        Rewrite mime type and extension handling (Fabian Möller)

        Add document links (Fabian Möller)

        Add support for multipart document extensions (Fabian Möller)

        Add support for apps-script to json export (Fabian Möller)

        Fix escaped chars in documents during list (Fabian Möller)

      Add --drive-v2-download-min-size a workaround for slow downloads (Fabian Möller)

      Improve directory notifications in ChangeNotify (Fabian Möller)

      When listing team drives in config, continue on failure (Nick Craig-Wood)

    FTP

      Add a small pause after failed upload before deleting file (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fix service_account_file being ignored (Fabian Möller)

    Jottacloud

      Minor improvement in quota info (omit if unlimited) (albertony)

      Add --fast-list support (albertony)

      Add permanent delete support: --jottacloud-hard-delete (albertony)

      Add link sharing support (albertony)

      Fix handling of reserved characters.  (Sebastian Bünger)

      Fix socket leak on Object.Remove (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Rework to support Microsoft Graph (Cnly)

        NB this will require re-authenticating the remote

      Removed upload cutoff and always do session uploads (Oliver Heyme)

      Use single-part upload for empty files (Cnly)

      Fix new fields not saved when editing old config (Alex Chen)

      Fix sometimes special chars in filenames not replaced (Alex Chen)

      Ignore OneNote files by default (Alex Chen)

      Add link sharing support (jackyzy823)

    S3

      Use custom pacer, to retry operations when reasonable (Craig Miskell)

      Use configured server-side-encryption and storage class options when calling CopyObject() (Paul Kohout)

      Make --s3-v2-auth flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix v2 auth on files with spaces (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Union

      Implement union backend which reads from multiple backends (Felix Brucker)

      Implement optional interfaces (Move, DirMove, Copy, etc.)  (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix ChangeNotify to support multiple remotes (Fabian Möller)

      Fix --backup-dir on union backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Add another time format (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add a small pause after failed upload before deleting file (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add workaround for missing mtime (buergi)

      Sharepoint: Renew cookies after 12hrs (Henning Surmeier)

    Yandex

      Remove redundant nil checks (teresy)

v1.43.1 - 2018-09-07

   Point release to fix hubic and azureblob backends.

    Bug Fixes

      ncdu: Return error instead of log.Fatal in Show (Fabian Möller)

      cmd: Fix crash with --progress and --stats 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

      docs: Tidy website display (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

    Azure Blob:

      Fix multi-part uploads.  (sandeepkru)

    Hubic

      Fix uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Retry auth fetching if it fails to make hubic more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.43 - 2018-09-01

    New backends

      Jottacloud (Sebastian Bünger)

    New commands

      copyurl: copies a URL to a remote (Denis)

    New Features

      Reworked config for backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

        All backend config can now be supplied by command line, env var or config file

        Advanced section in the config wizard for the optional items

        A large step towards rclone backends being usable in other go software

        Allow on the fly remotes with :backend: syntax

      Stats revamp

        Add --progress/-P flag to show interactive progress (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Show the total progress of the sync in the stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Add --stats-one-line flag for single line stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Added weekday schedule into --bwlimit (Mateusz)

      lsjson: Add option to show the original object IDs (Fabian Möller)

      serve webdav: Make Content-Type without reading the file and add --etag-hash (Nick Craig-Wood)

      build

        Build macOS with native compiler (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Update to use go1.11 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

      rc

        Added core/stats to return the stats (reddi1)

      version --check: Prints the current release and beta versions (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Bug Fixes

      accounting

        Fix time to completion estimates (Nick Craig-Wood)

        Fix moving average speed for file stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

      config: Fix error reading password from piped input (Nick Craig-Wood)

      move: Fix --delete-empty-src-dirs flag to delete all empty dirs on move (ishuah)

    Mount

      Implement --daemon-timeout flag for OSXFUSE (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix mount --daemon not working with encrypted config (Alex Chen)

      Clip the number of blocks to 2^32-1 on macOS - fixes borg backup (Nick Craig-Wood)

    VFS

      Enable vfs-read-chunk-size by default (Fabian Möller)

      Add the vfs/refresh rc command (Fabian Möller)

      Add non recursive mode to vfs/refresh rc command (Fabian Möller)

      Try to seek buffer on read only files (Fabian Möller)

    Local

      Fix crash when deprecated --local-no-unicode-normalization is supplied (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix mkdir error when trying to copy files to the root of a drive on windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Cache

      Fix nil pointer deref when using lsjson on cached directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix nil pointer deref for occasional crash on playback (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Crypt

      Fix accounting when checking hashes on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Amazon Cloud Drive

      Make very clear in the docs that rclone has no ACD keys (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Azure Blob

      Add connection string and SAS URL auth (Nick Craig-Wood)

      List the container to see if it exists (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Port new Azure Blob Storage SDK (sandeepkru)

      Added blob tier, tier between Hot, Cool and Archive.  (sandeepkru)

      Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

    B2

      Support Application Keys (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Box

      Fix upload of > 2GB files on 32 bit platforms (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Make --box-commit-retries flag defaulting to 100 to fix large uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Drive

      Add --drive-keep-revision-forever flag (lewapm)

      Handle gdocs when filtering file names in list (Fabian Möller)

      Support using --fast-list for large speedups (Fabian Möller)

    FTP

      Fix Put mkParentDir failed: 521 for BunnyCDN (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fix index out of range error with --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Jottacloud

      Fix MD5 error check (Oliver Heyme)

      Handle empty time values (Martin Polden)

      Calculate missing MD5s (Oliver Heyme)

      Docs, fixes and tests for MD5 calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add optional MimeTyper interface.  (Sebastian Bünger)

      Implement optional About interface (for df support).  (Sebastian Bünger)

    Mega

      Wait for events instead of arbitrary sleeping (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --mega-hard-delete flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix failed logins with upper case chars in email (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Onedrive

      Shared folder support (Yoni Jah)

      Implement DirMove (Cnly)

      Fix rmdir sometimes deleting directories with contents (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Pcloud

      Delete half uploaded files on upload error (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Qingstor

      Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

    S3

      Fix index out of range error with --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add --s3-force-path-style (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add support for KMS Key ID (bsteiss)

      Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Swift

      Add storage_policy (Ruben Vandamme)

      Make it so just storage_url or auth_token can be overridden (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Fix server-side copy bug for unusual file names (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

    WebDAV

      Ensure we call MKCOL with a URL with a trailing / for QNAP interop (Nick Craig-Wood)

      If root ends with / then don't check if it is a file (Nick Craig-Wood)

     • Don't accept redirects when reading metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Add bearer token (Macaroon) support for dCache (Nick Craig-Wood)

      Document dCache and Macaroons (Onno Zweers)

      Sharepoint recursion with different depth (Henning)

      Attempt to remove failed uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

    Yandex

      Fix listing/deleting files in the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.42 - 2018-06-16

    New backends

      OpenDrive (Oliver Heyme, Jakub Karlicek, ncw)

    New commands

      deletefile command (Filip Bartodziej)

    New Features

      copy, move: Copy single files directly, don't use --files-from work-around

       • this makes them much more efficient

     • Implement --max-transfer flag to quit transferring at a limit

       • make exit code 8 for --max-transfer exceeded

     • copy: copy empty source directories to destination (Ishuah Kariuki)

     • check: Add --one-way flag (Kasper Byrdal Nielsen)

     • Add siginfo handler for macOS for ctrl-T stats (kubatasiemski)

     • rc

       • add core/gc to run a garbage collection on demand

       • enable go profiling by default on the --rc port

       • return error from remote on failure

     • lsf

       • Add --absolute flag to add a leading / onto path names

       • Add --csv flag for compliant CSV output

       • Add 'm' format specifier to show the MimeType

       • Implement 'i' format for showing object ID

     • lsjson

       • Add MimeType to the output

       • Add ID field to output to show Object ID

     • Add --retries-sleep flag (Benjamin Joseph Dag)

     • Oauth tidy up web page and error handling (Henning Surmeier)

   • Bug Fixes

     • Password prompt output with --log-file fixed for unix (Filip Bartodziej)

     • Calculate ModifyWindow each time on the fly to fix various problems (Stefan Breunig)

   • Mount

     • Only print "File.rename error" if there actually is an error (Stefan Breunig)

     • Delay rename if file has open writers instead of failing outright (Stefan Breunig)

     • Ensure atexit gets run on interrupt

     • macOS enhancements

       • Make --noappledouble --noapplexattr

       • Add --volname flag and remove special chars from it

       • Make Get/List/Set/Remove xattr return ENOSYS for efficiency

       • Make --daemon work for macOS without CGO

   • VFS

     • Add --vfs-read-chunk-size and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit (Fabian Möller)

     • Fix ChangeNotify for new or changed folders (Fabian Möller)

   • Local

     • Fix symlink/junction point directory handling under Windows

       • NB you will need to add -L to your command line to copy files with reparse points

   • Cache

     • Add non cached dirs on notifications (Remus Bunduc)

     • Allow root to be expired from rc (Remus Bunduc)

     • Clean remaining empty folders from temp upload path (Remus Bunduc)

     • Cache lists using batch writes (Remus Bunduc)

     • Use secure websockets for HTTPS Plex addresses (John Clayton)

     • Reconnect plex websocket on failures (Remus Bunduc)

     • Fix panic when running without plex configs (Remus Bunduc)

     • Fix root folder caching (Remus Bunduc)

   • Crypt

     • Check the crypted hash of files when uploading for extra data security

   • Dropbox

     • Make Dropbox for business folders accessible using an initial / in the path

   • Google Cloud Storage

     • Low level retry all operations if necessary

   • Google Drive

     • Add --drive-acknowledge-abuse to download flagged files

     • Add --drive-alternate-export to fix large doc export

     • Don't attempt to choose Team Drives when using rclone config create

      Fix change list polling with team drives

      Fix ChangeNotify for folders (Fabian Möller)

      Fix about (and df on a mount) for team drives

    Onedrive

      Errorhandler for onedrive for business requests (Henning Surmeier)

    S3

      Adjust upload concurrency with --s3-upload-concurrency (themylogin)

      Fix --s3-chunk-size which was always using the minimum

    SFTP

      Add --ssh-path-override flag (Piotr Oleszczyk)

      Fix slow downloads for long latency connections

    Webdav

      Add workarounds for biz.mail.ru

      Ignore Reason-Phrase in status line to fix 4shared (Rodrigo)

      Better error message generation

v1.41 - 2018-04-28

    New backends

      Mega support added

      Webdav now supports SharePoint cookie authentication (hensur)

    New commands

      link: create public link to files and folders (Stefan Breunig)

      about: gets quota info from a remote (a-roussos, ncw)

      hashsum: a generic tool for any hash to produce md5sum like output

    New Features

      lsd: Add -R flag and fix and update docs for all ls commands

      ncdu: added a "refresh" key - CTRL-L (Keith Goldfarb)

      serve restic: Add append-only mode (Steve Kriss)

      serve restic: Disallow overwriting files in append-only mode (Alexander Neumann)

      serve restic: Print actual listener address (Matt Holt)

      size: Add --json flag (Matthew Holt)

      sync: implement --ignore-errors (Mateusz Pabian)

      dedupe: Add dedupe largest functionality (Richard Yang)

      fs: Extend SizeSuffix to include TB and PB for rclone about

      fs: add --dump goroutines and --dump openfiles for debugging

      rc: implement core/memstats to print internal memory usage info

      rc: new call rc/pid (Michael P.  Dubner)

    Compile

      Drop support for go1.6

    Release

      Fix make tarball (Chih-Hsuan Yen)

    Bug Fixes

      filter: fix --min-age and --max-age together check

      fs: limit MaxIdleConns and MaxIdleConnsPerHost in transport

      lsd,lsf: make sure all times we output are in local time

      rc: fix setting bwlimit to unlimited

      rc: take note of the --rc-addr flag too as per the docs

    Mount

      Use About to return the correct disk total/used/free (e.g.  in df)

      Set --attr-timeout default to 1s - fixes:

        rclone using too much memory

        rclone not serving files to samba

        excessive time listing directories

      Fix df -i (upstream fix)

    VFS

      Filter files . and .. from directory listing

      Only make the VFS cache if --vfs-cache-mode > Off

    Local

      Add --local-no-check-updated to disable updated file checks

      Retry remove on Windows sharing violation error

    Cache

      Flush the memory cache after close

      Purge file data on notification

      Always forget parent dir for notifications

      Integrate with Plex websocket

      Add rc cache/stats (seuffert)

      Add info log on notification

    Box

      Fix failure reading large directories - parse file/directory size as float

    Dropbox

      Fix crypt+obfuscate on dropbox

      Fix repeatedly uploading the same files

    FTP

      Work around strange response from box FTP server

      More workarounds for FTP servers to fix mkParentDir error

      Fix no error on listing nonexistent directory

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add service_account_credentials (Matt Holt)

      Detect bucket presence by listing it - minimises permissions needed

      Ignore zero length directory markers

    Google Drive

      Add service_account_credentials (Matt Holt)

      Fix directory move leaving a hardlinked directory behind

      Return proper google errors when Opening files

      When initialized with a filepath, optional features used incorrect root path (Stefan Breunig)

    HTTP

      Fix sync for servers which don't return Content-Length in HEAD

    Onedrive

      Add QuickXorHash support for OneDrive for business

      Fix socket leak in multipart session upload

    S3

      Look in S3 named profile files for credentials

      Add --s3-disable-checksum to disable checksum uploading (Chris Redekop)

      Hierarchical configuration support (Giri Badanahatti)

      Add in config for all the supported S3 providers

      Add One Zone Infrequent Access storage class (Craig Rachel)

      Add --use-server-modtime support (Peter Baumgartner)

      Add --s3-chunk-size option to control multipart uploads

      Ignore zero length directory markers

    SFTP

      Update docs to match code, fix typos and clarify disable_hashcheck prompt (Michael G.  Noll)

      Update docs with Synology quirks

      Fail soft with a debug on hash failure

    Swift

      Add --use-server-modtime support (Peter Baumgartner)

    Webdav

      Support SharePoint cookie authentication (hensur)

      Strip leading and trailing / off root

v1.40 - 2018-03-19

    New backends

      Alias backend to create aliases for existing remote names (Fabian Möller)

    New commands

      lsf: list for parsing purposes (Jakub Tasiemski)

        by default this is a simple non recursive list of files and directories

        it can be configured to add more info in an easy to parse way

      serve restic: for serving a remote as a Restic REST endpoint

        This enables restic to use any backends that rclone can access

        Thanks Alexander Neumann for help, patches and review

      rc: enable the remote control of a running rclone

        The running rclone must be started with --rc and related flags.

        Currently there is support for bwlimit, and flushing for mount and cache.

    New Features

      --max-delete flag to add a delete threshold (Bjørn Erik Pedersen)

      All backends now support RangeOption for ranged Open

        cat: Use RangeOption for limited fetches to make more efficient

        cryptcheck: make reading of nonce more efficient with RangeOption

      serve http/webdav/restic

        support SSL/TLS

        add --user --pass and --htpasswd for authentication

      copy/move: detect file size change during copy/move and abort transfer (ishuah)

      cryptdecode: added option to return encrypted file names.  (ishuah)

      lsjson: add --encrypted to show encrypted name (Jakub Tasiemski)

      Add --stats-file-name-length to specify the printed file name length for stats (Will Gunn)

    Compile

      Code base was shuffled and factored

        backends moved into a backend directory

        large packages split up

        See the CONTRIBUTING.md doc for info as to what lives where now

      Update to using go1.10 as the default go version

      Implement daily full integration tests (https://pub.rclone.org/integration-tests/)

    Release

      Include a source tarball and sign it and the binaries

      Sign the git tags as part of the release process

      Add .deb and .rpm packages as part of the build

      Make a beta release for all branches on the main repo (but not pull requests)

    Bug Fixes

      config: fixes errors on nonexistent config by loading config file only on first access

      config: retry saving the config after failure (Mateusz)

      sync: when using --backup-dir don't delete files if we can't set their modtime

        this fixes odd behaviour with Dropbox and --backup-dir

      fshttp: fix idle timeouts for HTTP connections

      serve http: fix serving files with : in - fixes

      Fix --exclude-if-present to ignore directories which it doesn't have permission for (Iakov Davydov)

     • Make accounting work properly with crypt and b2

     • remove --no-traverse flag because it is obsolete

   • Mount

     • Add --attr-timeout flag to control attribute caching in kernel

       • this now defaults to 0 which is correct but less efficient

       • see the mount docs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#attribute-caching) for more info

     • Add --daemon flag to allow mount to run in the background (ishuah)

     • Fix: Return ENOSYS rather than EIO on attempted link

       • This fixes FileZilla accessing an rclone mount served over sftp.

     • Fix setting modtime twice

     • Mount tests now run on CI for Linux (mount & cmount)/Mac/Windows

     • Many bugs fixed in the VFS layer - see below

   • VFS

     • Many fixes for --vfs-cache-mode writes and above

       • Update cached copy if we know it has changed (fixes stale data)

       • Clean path names before using them in the cache

       • Disable cache cleaner if --vfs-cache-poll-interval=0

       • Fill and clean the cache immediately on startup

     • Fix Windows opening every file when it stats the file

     • Fix applying modtime for an open Write Handle

     • Fix creation of files when truncating

     • Write 0 bytes when flushing unwritten handles to avoid race conditions in FUSE

     • Downgrade "poll-interval is not supported" message to Info

     • Make OpenFile and friends return EINVAL if O_RDONLY and O_TRUNC

   • Local

     • Downgrade "invalid cross-device link: trying copy" to debug

     • Make DirMove return fs.ErrorCantDirMove to allow fallback to Copy for cross device

     • Fix race conditions updating the hashes

   • Cache

     • Add support for polling - cache will update when remote changes on supported backends

     • Reduce log level for Plex api

     • Fix dir cache issue

     • Implement --cache-db-wait-time flag

     • Improve efficiency with RangeOption and RangeSeek

     • Fix dirmove with temp fs enabled

     • Notify vfs when using temp fs

     • Offline uploading

     • Remote control support for path flushing

   • Amazon cloud drive

     • Rclone no longer has any working keys - disable integration tests

     • Implement DirChangeNotify to notify cache/vfs/mount of changes

   • Azureblob

     • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

        this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

      Improve accounting for chunked uploads

    Backblaze B2

      Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

       • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

   • Box

     • Improve accounting for chunked uploads

   • Dropbox

     • Fix custom oauth client parameters

   • Google Cloud Storage

     • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

        this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

    Google Drive

      Migrate to api v3 (Fabian Möller)

      Add scope configuration and root folder selection

      Add --drive-impersonate for service accounts

        thanks to everyone who tested, explored and contributed docs

      Add --drive-use-created-date to use created date as modified date (nbuchanan)

      Request the export formats only when required

        This makes rclone quicker when there are no google docs

      Fix finding paths with latin1 chars (a workaround for a drive bug)

      Fix copying of a single Google doc file

      Fix --drive-auth-owner-only to look in all directories

    HTTP

      Fix handling of directories with & in

    Onedrive

      Removed upload cutoff and always do session uploads

        this stops the creation of multiple versions on business onedrive

      Overwrite object size value with real size when reading file.  (Victor)

        this fixes oddities when onedrive misreports the size of images

    Pcloud

      Remove unused chunked upload flag and code

    Qingstor

      Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

       • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

   • S3

     • Support hashes for multipart files (Chris Redekop)

     • Initial support for IBM COS (S3) (Giri Badanahatti)

     • Update docs to discourage use of v2 auth with CEPH and others

     • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

        this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

      Fix server-side copy and set modtime on files with + in

    SFTP

      Add option to disable remote hash check command execution (Jon Fautley)

      Add --sftp-ask-password flag to prompt for password when needed (Leo R.  Lundgren)

      Add set_modtime configuration option

      Fix following of symlinks

      Fix reading config file outside of Fs setup

      Fix reading $USER in username fallback not $HOME

      Fix running under crontab - Use correct OS way of reading username

    Swift

      Fix refresh of authentication token

        in v1.39 a bug was introduced which ignored new tokens - this fixes it

      Fix extra HEAD transaction when uploading a new file

      Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

        this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

    Webdav

      Add new time formats to support mydrive.ch and others

v1.39 - 2017-12-23

    New backends

      WebDAV

        tested with nextcloud, owncloud, put.io and others!

      Pcloud

      cache - wraps a cache around other backends (Remus Bunduc)

        useful in combination with mount

        NB this feature is in beta so use with care

    New commands

      serve command with subcommands:

        serve webdav: this implements a webdav server for any rclone remote.

        serve http: command to serve a remote over HTTP

      config: add sub commands for full config file management

        create/delete/dump/edit/file/password/providers/show/update

      touch: to create or update the timestamp of a file (Jakub Tasiemski)

    New Features

      curl install for rclone (Filip Bartodziej)

      --stats now shows percentage, size, rate and ETA in condensed form (Ishuah Kariuki)

      --exclude-if-present to exclude a directory if a file is present (Iakov Davydov)

      rmdirs: add --leave-root flag (lewapm)

      move: add --delete-empty-src-dirs flag to remove dirs after move (Ishuah Kariuki)

      Add --dump flag, introduce --dump requests, responses and remove --dump-auth, --dump-filters

        Obscure X-Auth-Token: from headers when dumping too

      Document and implement exit codes for different failure modes (Ishuah Kariuki)

    Compile

    Bug Fixes

      Retry lots more different types of errors to make multipart transfers more reliable

      Save the config before asking for a token, fixes disappearing oauth config

      Warn the user if --include and --exclude are used together (Ernest Borowski)

      Fix duplicate files (e.g.  on Google drive) causing spurious copies

      Allow trailing and leading whitespace for passwords (Jason Rose)

      ncdu: fix crashes on empty directories

      rcat: fix goroutine leak

      moveto/copyto: Fix to allow copying to the same name

    Mount

      --vfs-cache mode to make writes into mounts more reliable.

        this requires caching files on the disk (see --cache-dir)

        As this is a new feature, use with care

      Use sdnotify to signal systemd the mount is ready (Fabian Möller)

      Check if directory is not empty before mounting (Ernest Borowski)

    Local

      Add error message for cross file system moves

      Fix equality check for times

    Dropbox

      Rework multipart upload

        buffer the chunks when uploading large files so they can be retried

        change default chunk size to 48MB now we are buffering them in memory

        retry every error after the first chunk is done successfully

      Fix error when renaming directories

    Swift

      Fix crash on bad authentication

    Google Drive

      Add service account support (Tim Cooijmans)

    S3

      Make it work properly with Digital Ocean Spaces (Andrew Starr-Bochicchio)

      Fix crash if a bad listing is received

      Add support for ECS task IAM roles (David Minor)

    Backblaze B2

      Fix multipart upload retries

      Fix --hard-delete to make it work 100% of the time

    Swift

      Allow authentication with storage URL and auth key (Giovanni Pizzi)

      Add new fields for swift configuration to support IBM Bluemix Swift (Pierre Carlson)

      Add OS_TENANT_ID and OS_USER_ID to config

      Allow configs with user id instead of user name

      Check if swift segments container exists before creating (John Leach)

      Fix memory leak in swift transfers (upstream fix)

    SFTP

      Add option to enable the use of aes128-cbc cipher (Jon Fautley)

    Amazon cloud drive

      Fix download of large files failing with "Only one auth mechanism allowed"

    crypt

      Option to encrypt directory names or leave them intact

      Implement DirChangeNotify (Fabian Möller)

    onedrive

      Add option to choose resourceURL during setup of OneDrive Business account if more than one is available for user

v1.38 - 2017-09-30

    New backends

      Azure Blob Storage (thanks Andrei Dragomir)

      Box

      Onedrive for Business (thanks Oliver Heyme)

      QingStor from QingCloud (thanks wuyu)

    New commands

      rcat - read from standard input and stream upload

      tree - shows a nicely formatted recursive listing

      cryptdecode - decode crypted file names (thanks ishuah)

      config show - print the config file

      config file - print the config file location

    New Features

      Empty directories are deleted on sync

      dedupe - implement merging of duplicate directories

      check and cryptcheck made more consistent and use less memory

      cleanup for remaining remotes (thanks ishuah)

      --immutable for ensuring that files don't change (thanks Jacob McNamee)

     • --user-agent option (thanks Alex McGrath Kraak)

     • --disable flag to disable optional features

     • --bind flag for choosing the local addr on outgoing connections

     • Support for zsh auto-completion (thanks bpicode)

     • Stop normalizing file names but do a normalized compare in sync

   • Compile

     • Update to using go1.9 as the default go version

     • Remove snapd build due to maintenance problems

   • Bug Fixes

     • Improve retriable error detection which makes multipart uploads better

     • Make check obey --ignore-size

     • Fix bwlimit toggle in conjunction with schedules (thanks cbruegg)

     • config ensures newly written config is on the same mount

   • Local

     • Revert to copy when moving file across file system boundaries

     • --skip-links to suppress symlink warnings (thanks Zhiming Wang)

   • Mount

     • Re-use rcat internals to support uploads from all remotes

   • Dropbox

     • Fix "entry doesn't belong in directory" error

      Stop using deprecated API methods

    Swift

      Fix server-side copy to empty container with --fast-list

    Google Drive

      Change the default for --drive-use-trash to true

    S3

      Set session token when using STS (thanks Girish Ramakrishnan)

      Glacier docs and error messages (thanks Jan Varho)

      Read 1000 (not 1024) items in dir listings to fix Wasabi

    Backblaze B2

      Fix SHA1 mismatch when downloading files with no SHA1

      Calculate missing hashes on the fly instead of spooling

      --b2-hard-delete to permanently delete (not hide) files (thanks John Papandriopoulos)

    Hubic

      Fix creating containers - no longer have to use the default container

    Swift

      Optionally configure from a standard set of OpenStack environment vars

      Add endpoint_type config

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fix bucket creation to work with limited permission users

    SFTP

      Implement connection pooling for multiple ssh connections

      Limit new connections per second

      Add support for MD5 and SHA1 hashes where available (thanks Christian Brüggemann)

    HTTP

      Fix URL encoding issues

      Fix directories with : in

      Fix panic with URL encoded content

v1.37 - 2017-07-22

    New backends

      FTP - thanks to Antonio Messina

      HTTP - thanks to Vasiliy Tolstov

    New commands

      rclone ncdu - for exploring a remote with a text based user interface.

      rclone lsjson - for listing with a machine-readable output

      rclone dbhashsum - to show Dropbox style hashes of files (local or Dropbox)

    New Features

      Implement --fast-list flag

        This allows remotes to list recursively if they can

        This uses less transactions (important if you pay for them)

        This may or may not be quicker

        This will use more memory as it has to hold the listing in memory

        --old-sync-method deprecated - the remaining uses are covered by --fast-list

        This involved a major re-write of all the listing code

      Add --tpslimit and --tpslimit-burst to limit transactions per second

        this is useful in conjunction with rclone mount to limit external apps

      Add --stats-log-level so can see --stats without -v

      Print password prompts to stderr - Hraban Luyat

      Warn about duplicate files when syncing

      Oauth improvements

        allow auth_url and token_url to be set in the config file

        Print redirection URI if using own credentials.

      Don't Mkdir at the start of sync to save transactions

   • Compile

     • Update build to go1.8.3

     • Require go1.6 for building rclone

     • Compile 386 builds with "GO386=387" for maximum compatibility

   • Bug Fixes

     • Fix menu selection when no remotes

     • Config saving reworked to not kill the file if disk gets full

     • Don't delete remote if name does not change while renaming

      moveto, copyto: report transfers and checks as per move and copy

    Local

      Add --local-no-unicode-normalization flag - Bob Potter

    Mount

      Now supported on Windows using cgofuse and WinFsp - thanks to Bill Zissimopoulos for much help

      Compare checksums on upload/download via FUSE

      Unmount when program ends with SIGINT (Ctrl+C) or SIGTERM - Jérôme Vizcaino

      On read only open of file, make open pending until first read

      Make --read-only reject modify operations

      Implement ModTime via FUSE for remotes that support it

      Allow modTime to be changed even before all writers are closed

      Fix panic on renames

      Fix hang on errored upload

    Crypt

      Report the name:root as specified by the user

      Add an "obfuscate" option for filename encryption - Stephen Harris

    Amazon Drive

      Fix initialization order for token renewer

      Remove revoked credentials, allow oauth proxy config and update docs

    B2

      Reduce minimum chunk size to 5MB

    Drive

      Add team drive support

      Reduce bandwidth by adding fields for partial responses - Martin Kristensen

      Implement --drive-shared-with-me flag to view shared with me files - Danny Tsai

      Add --drive-trashed-only to read only the files in the trash

      Remove obsolete --drive-full-list

      Add missing seek to start on retries of chunked uploads

      Fix stats accounting for upload

      Convert / in names to a unicode equivalent ()

      Poll for Google Drive changes when mounted

    OneDrive

      Fix the uploading of files with spaces

      Fix initialization order for token renewer

      Display speeds accurately when uploading - Yoni Jah

      Swap to using http://localhost:53682/ as redirect URL - Michael Ledin

      Retry on token expired error, reset upload body on retry - Yoni Jah

    Google Cloud Storage

      Add ability to specify location and storage class via config and command line - thanks gdm85

      Create container if necessary on server-side copy

      Increase directory listing chunk to 1000 to increase performance

      Obtain a refresh token for GCS - Steven Lu

    Yandex

      Fix the name reported in log messages (was empty)

      Correct error return for listing empty directory

    Dropbox

      Rewritten to use the v2 API

        Now supports ModTime

          Can only set by uploading the file again

          If you uploaded with an old rclone, rclone may upload everything again

          Use --size-only or --checksum to avoid this

        Now supports the Dropbox content hashing scheme

        Now supports low level retries

    S3

      Work around eventual consistency in bucket creation

      Create container if necessary on server-side copy

      Add us-east-2 (Ohio) and eu-west-2 (London) S3 regions - Zahiar Ahmed

    Swift, Hubic

      Fix zero length directory markers showing in the subdirectory listing

        this caused lots of duplicate transfers

      Fix paged directory listings

        this caused duplicate directory errors

      Create container if necessary on server-side copy

      Increase directory listing chunk to 1000 to increase performance

      Make sensible error if the user forgets the container

    SFTP

      Add support for using ssh key files

      Fix under Windows

      Fix ssh agent on Windows

      Adapt to latest version of library - Igor Kharin

v1.36 - 2017-03-18

    New Features

      SFTP remote (Jack Schmidt)

      Re-implement sync routine to work a directory at a time reducing memory usage

      Logging revamped to be more inline with rsync - now much quieter * -v only shows transfers * -vv is for full debug * --syslog to log to syslog on capable
       platforms

      Implement --backup-dir and --suffix

      Implement --track-renames (initial implementation by Bjørn Erik Pedersen)

      Add time-based bandwidth limits (Lukas Loesche)

      rclone cryptcheck: checks integrity of crypt remotes

      Allow all config file variables and options to be set from environment variables

      Add --buffer-size parameter to control buffer size for copy

      Make --delete-after the default

      Add --ignore-checksum flag (fixed by Hisham Zarka)

      rclone check: Add --download flag to check all the data, not just hashes

      rclone cat: add --head, --tail, --offset, --count and --discard

      rclone config: when choosing from a list, allow the value to be entered too

      rclone config: allow rename and copy of remotes

      rclone obscure: for generating encrypted passwords for rclone's config (T.C.  Ferguson)

     • Comply with XDG Base Directory specification (Dario Giovannetti)

       • this moves the default location of the config file in a backwards compatible way

     • Release changes

       • Ubuntu snap support (Dedsec1)

       • Compile with go 1.8

       • MIPS/Linux big and little endian support

   • Bug Fixes

     • Fix copyto copying things to the wrong place if the destination dir didn't exist

      Fix parsing of remotes in moveto and copyto

      Fix --delete-before deleting files on copy

      Fix --files-from with an empty file copying everything

      Fix sync: don't update mod times if --dry-run set

      Fix MimeType propagation

      Fix filters to add ** rules to directory rules

    Local

      Implement -L, --copy-links flag to allow rclone to follow symlinks

      Open files in write only mode so rclone can write to an rclone mount

      Fix unnormalised unicode causing problems reading directories

      Fix interaction between -x flag and --max-depth

    Mount

      Implement proper directory handling (mkdir, rmdir, renaming)

      Make include and exclude filters apply to mount

      Implement read and write async buffers - control with --buffer-size

      Fix fsync on for directories

      Fix retry on network failure when reading off crypt

    Crypt

      Add --crypt-show-mapping to show encrypted file mapping

      Fix crypt writer getting stuck in a loop

        IMPORTANT this bug had the potential to cause data corruption when

          reading data from a network based remote and

          writing to a crypt on Google Drive

        Use the cryptcheck command to validate your data if you are concerned

        If syncing two crypt remotes, sync the unencrypted remote

    Amazon Drive

      Fix panics on Move (rename)

      Fix panic on token expiry

    B2

      Fix inconsistent listings and rclone check

      Fix uploading empty files with go1.8

      Constrain memory usage when doing multipart uploads

      Fix upload url not being refreshed properly

    Drive

      Fix Rmdir on directories with trashed files

      Fix "Ignoring unknown object" when downloading

      Add --drive-list-chunk

      Add --drive-skip-gdocs (Károly Oláh)

    OneDrive

      Implement Move

      Fix Copy

        Fix overwrite detection in Copy

        Fix waitForJob to parse errors correctly

      Use token renewer to stop auth errors on long uploads

      Fix uploading empty files with go1.8

    Google Cloud Storage

      Fix depth 1 directory listings

    Yandex

      Fix single level directory listing

    Dropbox

      Normalise the case for single level directory listings

      Fix depth 1 listing

    S3

      Added ca-central-1 region (Jon Yergatian)

v1.35 - 2017-01-02

    New Features

      moveto and copyto commands for choosing a destination name on copy/move

      rmdirs command to recursively delete empty directories

      Allow repeated --include/--exclude/--filter options

      Only show transfer stats on commands which transfer stuff

        show stats on any command using the --stats flag

      Allow overlapping directories in move when server-side dir move is supported

      Add --stats-unit option - thanks Scott McGillivray

    Bug Fixes

      Fix the config file being overwritten when two rclone instances are running

      Make rclone lsd obey the filters properly

      Fix compilation on mips

      Fix not transferring files that don't differ in size

      Fix panic on nil retry/fatal error

    Mount

      Retry reads on error - should help with reliability a lot

      Report the modification times for directories from the remote

      Add bandwidth accounting and limiting (fixes --bwlimit)

      If --stats provided will show stats and which files are transferring

      Support R/W files if truncate is set.

      Implement statfs interface so df works

      Note that write is now supported on Amazon Drive

      Report number of blocks in a file - thanks Stefan Breunig

    Crypt

      Prevent the user pointing crypt at itself

      Fix failed to authenticate decrypted block errors

        these will now return the underlying unexpected EOF instead

    Amazon Drive

      Add support for server-side move and directory move - thanks Stefan Breunig

      Fix nil pointer deref on size attribute

    B2

      Use new prefix and delimiter parameters in directory listings

        This makes --max-depth 1 dir listings as used in mount much faster

      Reauth the account while doing uploads too - should help with token expiry

    Drive

      Make DirMove more efficient and complain about moving the root

      Create destination directory on Move()

v1.34 - 2016-11-06

    New Features

      Stop single file and --files-from operations iterating through the source bucket.

      Stop removing failed upload to cloud storage remotes

      Make ContentType be preserved for cloud to cloud copies

      Add support to toggle bandwidth limits via SIGUSR2 - thanks Marco Paganini

      rclone check shows count of hashes that couldn't be checked

     • rclone listremotes command

     • Support linux/arm64 build - thanks Fredrik Fornwall

     • Remove Authorization: lines from --dump-headers output

   • Bug Fixes

     • Ignore files with control characters in the names

     • Fix rclone move command

       • Delete src files which already existed in dst

       • Fix deletion of src file when dst file older

     • Fix rclone check on crypted file systems

     • Make failed uploads not count as "Transferred"

     • Make sure high level retries show with -q

     • Use a vendor directory with godep for repeatable builds

   • rclone mount - FUSE

     • Implement FUSE mount options

       • --no-modtime, --debug-fuse, --read-only, --allow-non-empty, --allow-root, --allow-other

       • --default-permissions, --write-back-cache, --max-read-ahead, --umask, --uid, --gid

     • Add --dir-cache-time to control caching of directory entries

     • Implement seek for files opened for read (useful for video players)

       • with -no-seek flag to disable

     • Fix crash on 32 bit ARM (alignment of 64 bit counter)

     • ...and many more internal fixes and improvements!

   • Crypt

     • Don't show encrypted password in configurator to stop confusion

    Amazon Drive

      New wait for upload option --acd-upload-wait-per-gb

        upload timeouts scale by file size and can be disabled

      Add 502 Bad Gateway to list of errors we retry

      Fix overwriting a file with a zero length file

      Fix ACD file size warning limit - thanks Felix Bünemann

    Local

      Unix: implement -x/--one-file-system to stay on a single file system

        thanks Durval Menezes and Luiz Carlos Rumbelsperger Viana

      Windows: ignore the symlink bit on files

      Windows: Ignore directory-based junction points

    B2

      Make sure each upload has at least one upload slot - fixes strange upload stats

      Fix uploads when using crypt

      Fix download of large files (sha1 mismatch)

      Return error when we try to create a bucket which someone else owns

      Update B2 docs with Data usage, and Crypt section - thanks Tomasz Mazur

    S3

      Command line and config file support for

        Setting/overriding ACL - thanks Radek Šenfeld

        Setting storage class - thanks Asko Tamm

    Drive

      Make exponential backoff work exactly as per Google specification

      add .epub, .odp and .tsv as export formats.

    Swift

      Don't read metadata for directory marker objects

v1.33 - 2016-08-24

    New Features

      Implement encryption

        data encrypted in NACL secretbox format

        with optional file name encryption

      New commands

        rclone mount - implements FUSE mounting of remotes (EXPERIMENTAL)

          works on Linux, FreeBSD and OS X (need testers for the last 2!)

        rclone cat - outputs remote file or files to the terminal

        rclone genautocomplete - command to make a bash completion script for rclone

      Editing a remote using rclone config now goes through the wizard

      Compile with go 1.7 - this fixes rclone on macOS Sierra and on 386 processors

      Use cobra for sub commands and docs generation

    drive

      Document how to make your own client_id

    s3

      User-configurable Amazon S3 ACL (thanks Radek Šenfeld)

    b2

      Fix stats accounting for upload - no more jumping to 100% done

      On cleanup delete hide marker if it is the current file

      New B2 API endpoint (thanks Per Cederberg)

      Set maximum backoff to 5 Minutes

    onedrive

      Fix URL escaping in file names - e.g.  uploading files with + in them.

    amazon cloud drive

      Fix token expiry during large uploads

      Work around 408 REQUEST_TIMEOUT and 504 GATEWAY_TIMEOUT errors

    local

      Fix filenames with invalid UTF-8 not being uploaded

      Fix problem with some UTF-8 characters on OS X

v1.32 - 2016-07-13

    Backblaze B2

      Fix upload of files large files not in root

v1.31 - 2016-07-13

    New Features

      Reduce memory on sync by about 50%

      Implement --no-traverse flag to stop copy traversing the destination remote.

        This can be used to reduce memory usage down to the smallest possible.

        Useful to copy a small number of files into a large destination folder.

      Implement cleanup command for emptying trash / removing old versions of files

        Currently B2 only

      Single file handling improved

        Now copied with --files-from

        Automatically sets --no-traverse when copying a single file

      Info on using installing with ansible - thanks Stefan Weichinger

      Implement --no-update-modtime flag to stop rclone fixing the remote modified times.

    Bug Fixes

      Fix move command - stop it running for overlapping Fses - this was causing data loss.

    Local

      Fix incomplete hashes - this was causing problems for B2.

    Amazon Drive

      Rename Amazon Cloud Drive to Amazon Drive - no changes to config file needed.

    Swift

      Add support for non-default project domain - thanks Antonio Messina.

    S3

      Add instructions on how to use rclone with minio.

      Add ap-northeast-2 (Seoul) and ap-south-1 (Mumbai) regions.

      Skip setting the modified time for objects > 5GB as it isn't possible.

   • Backblaze B2

     • Add --b2-versions flag so old versions can be listed and retrieved.

     • Treat 403 errors (e.g.  cap exceeded) as fatal.

     • Implement cleanup command for deleting old file versions.

     • Make error handling compliant with B2 integrations notes.

     • Fix handling of token expiry.

     • Implement --b2-test-mode to set X-Bz-Test-Mode header.

     • Set cutoff for chunked upload to 200MB as per B2 guidelines.

     • Make upload multi-threaded.

   • Dropbox

     • Don't retry 461 errors.

v1.30 - 2016-06-18

    New Features

      Directory listing code reworked for more features and better error reporting (thanks to Klaus Post for help).  This enables

        Directory include filtering for efficiency

        --max-depth parameter

        Better error reporting

        More to come

      Retry more errors

      Add --ignore-size flag - for uploading images to onedrive

      Log -v output to stdout by default

      Display the transfer stats in more human-readable form

      Make 0 size files specifiable with --max-size 0b

      Add b suffix so we can specify bytes in --bwlimit, --min-size, etc.

      Use "password:" instead of "password>" prompt - thanks Klaus Post and Leigh Klotz

    Bug Fixes

      Fix retry doing one too many retries

    Local

      Fix problems with OS X and UTF-8 characters

    Amazon Drive

      Check a file exists before uploading to help with 408 Conflict errors

      Reauth on 401 errors - this has been causing a lot of problems

      Work around spurious 403 errors

      Restart directory listings on error

    Google Drive

      Check a file exists before uploading to help with duplicates

      Fix retry of multipart uploads

    Backblaze B2

      Implement large file uploading

    S3

      Add AES256 server-side encryption for - thanks Justin R.  Wilson

    Google Cloud Storage

      Make sure we don't use conflicting content types on upload

      Add service account support - thanks Michal Witkowski

    Swift

      Add auth version parameter

      Add domain option for openstack (v3 auth) - thanks Fabian Ruff

v1.29 - 2016-04-18

    New Features

      Implement -I, --ignore-times for unconditional upload

      Improve dedupecommand

        Now removes identical copies without asking

        Now obeys --dry-run

        Implement --dedupe-mode for non interactive running

          --dedupe-mode interactive - interactive the default.

          --dedupe-mode skip - removes identical files then skips anything left.

          --dedupe-mode first - removes identical files then keeps the first one.

          --dedupe-mode newest - removes identical files then keeps the newest one.

          --dedupe-mode oldest - removes identical files then keeps the oldest one.

          --dedupe-mode rename - removes identical files then renames the rest to be different.

    Bug fixes

      Make rclone check obey the --size-only flag.

      Use "application/octet-stream" if discovered mime type is invalid.

      Fix missing "quit" option when there are no remotes.

    Google Drive

      Increase default chunk size to 8 MB - increases upload speed of big files

      Speed up directory listings and make more reliable

      Add missing retries for Move and DirMove - increases reliability

      Preserve mime type on file update

    Backblaze B2

      Enable mod time syncing

        This means that B2 will now check modification times

        It will upload new files to update the modification times

        (there isn't an API to just set the mod time.)

       • If you want the old behaviour use --size-only.

     • Update API to new version

     • Fix parsing of mod time when not in metadata

   • Swift/Hubic

     • Don't return an MD5SUM for static large objects

    S3

      Fix uploading files bigger than 50GB

v1.28 - 2016-03-01

    New Features

      Configuration file encryption - thanks Klaus Post

      Improve rclone config adding more help and making it easier to understand

      Implement -u/--update so creation times can be used on all remotes

      Implement --low-level-retries flag

      Optionally disable gzip compression on downloads with --no-gzip-encoding

    Bug fixes

      Don't make directories if --dry-run set

     • Fix and document the move command

     • Fix redirecting stderr on unix-like OSes when using --log-file

     • Fix delete command to wait until all finished - fixes missing deletes.

   • Backblaze B2

     • Use one upload URL per go routine fixes more than one upload using auth token

     • Add pacing, retries and reauthentication - fixes token expiry problems

     • Upload without using a temporary file from local (and remotes which support SHA1)

     • Fix reading metadata for all files when it shouldn't have been

    Drive

      Fix listing drive documents at root

      Disable copy and move for Google docs

    Swift

      Fix uploading of chunked files with non ASCII characters

      Allow setting of storage_url in the config - thanks Xavier Lucas

    S3

      Allow IAM role and credentials from environment variables - thanks Brian Stengaard

      Allow low privilege users to use S3 (check if directory exists during Mkdir) - thanks Jakub Gedeon

    Amazon Drive

      Retry on more things to make directory listings more reliable

v1.27 - 2016-01-31

    New Features

      Easier headless configuration with rclone authorize

      Add support for multiple hash types - we now check SHA1 as well as MD5 hashes.

      delete command which does obey the filters (unlike purge)

      dedupe command to deduplicate a remote.  Useful with Google Drive.

      Add --ignore-existing flag to skip all files that exist on destination.

      Add --delete-before, --delete-during, --delete-after flags.

      Add --memprofile flag to debug memory use.

      Warn the user about files with same name but different case

      Make --include rules add their implicit exclude * at the end of the filter list

      Deprecate compiling with go1.3

    Amazon Drive

      Fix download of files > 10 GB

      Fix directory traversal ("Next token is expired") for large directory listings

      Remove 409 conflict from error codes we will retry - stops very long pauses

    Backblaze B2

      SHA1 hashes now checked by rclone core

    Drive

      Add --drive-auth-owner-only to only consider files owned by the user - thanks Björn Harrtell

      Export Google documents

    Dropbox

      Make file exclusion error controllable with -q

    Swift

      Fix upload from unprivileged user.

    S3

      Fix updating of mod times of files with + in.

    Local

      Add local file system option to disable UNC on Windows.

v1.26 - 2016-01-02

    New Features

      Yandex storage backend - thank you Dmitry Burdeev ("dibu")

      Implement Backblaze B2 storage backend

      Add --min-age and --max-age flags - thank you Adriano Aurélio Meirelles

      Make ls/lsl/md5sum/size/check obey includes and excludes

    Fixes

      Fix crash in http logging

      Upload releases to github too

    Swift

      Fix sync for chunked files

    OneDrive

      Re-enable server-side copy

      Don't mask HTTP error codes with JSON decode error

    S3

      Fix corrupting Content-Type on mod time update (thanks Joseph Spurrier)

v1.25 - 2015-11-14

    New features

      Implement Hubic storage system

    Fixes

      Fix deletion of some excluded files without --delete-excluded

        This could have deleted files unexpectedly on sync

        Always check first with --dry-run!

    Swift

      Stop SetModTime losing metadata (e.g.  X-Object-Manifest)

        This could have caused data loss for files > 5GB in size

      Use ContentType from Object to avoid lookups in listings

    OneDrive

      disable server-side copy as it seems to be broken at Microsoft

v1.24 - 2015-11-07

    New features

      Add support for Microsoft OneDrive

      Add --no-check-certificate option to disable server certificate verification

      Add async readahead buffer for faster transfer of big files

    Fixes

      Allow spaces in remotes and check remote names for validity at creation time

      Allow '&' and disallow ':' in Windows filenames.

    Swift

      Ignore directory marker objects where appropriate - allows working with Hubic

      Don't delete the container if fs wasn't at root

    S3

      Don't delete the bucket if fs wasn't at root

    Google Cloud Storage

      Don't delete the bucket if fs wasn't at root

v1.23 - 2015-10-03

    New features

      Implement rclone size for measuring remotes

    Fixes

      Fix headless config for drive and gcs

      Tell the user they should try again if the webserver method failed

      Improve output of --dump-headers

    S3

      Allow anonymous access to public buckets

    Swift

      Stop chunked operations logging "Failed to read info: Object Not Found"

      Use Content-Length on uploads for extra reliability

v1.22 - 2015-09-28

    Implement rsync like include and exclude flags

    swift

      Support files > 5GB - thanks Sergey Tolmachev

v1.21 - 2015-09-22

    New features

      Display individual transfer progress

      Make lsl output times in localtime

    Fixes

      Fix allowing user to override credentials again in Drive, GCS and ACD

    Amazon Drive

      Implement compliant pacing scheme

    Google Drive

      Make directory reads concurrent for increased speed.

v1.20 - 2015-09-15

    New features

      Amazon Drive support

      Oauth support redone - fix many bugs and improve usability

        Use "golang.org/x/oauth2" as oauth library of choice

        Improve oauth usability for smoother initial signup

        drive, googlecloudstorage: optionally use auto config for the oauth token

      Implement --dump-headers and --dump-bodies debug flags

      Show multiple matched commands if abbreviation too short

      Implement server-side move where possible

    local

      Always use UNC paths internally on Windows - fixes a lot of bugs

    dropbox

      force use of our custom transport which makes timeouts work

    Thanks to Klaus Post for lots of help with this release

v1.19 - 2015-08-28

    New features

      Server side copies for s3/swift/drive/dropbox/gcs

      Move command - uses server-side copies if it can

      Implement --retries flag - tries 3 times by default

      Build for plan9/amd64 and solaris/amd64 too

    Fixes

      Make a current version download with a fixed URL for scripting

      Ignore rmdir in limited fs rather than throwing error

    dropbox

      Increase chunk size to improve upload speeds massively

      Issue an error message when trying to upload bad file name

v1.18 - 2015-08-17

    drive

      Add --drive-use-trash flag so rclone trashes instead of deletes

      Add "Forbidden to download" message for files with no downloadURL

    dropbox

      Remove datastore

        This was deprecated and it caused a lot of problems

        Modification times and MD5SUMs no longer stored

      Fix uploading files > 2GB

    s3

      use official AWS SDK from github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go

      NB will most likely require you to delete and recreate remote

      enable multipart upload which enables files > 5GB

      tested with Ceph / RadosGW / S3 emulation

      many thanks to Sam Liston and Brian Haymore at the Utah Center for High Performance Computing (https://www.chpc.utah.edu/) for a Ceph test account

    misc

      Show errors when reading the config file

      Do not print stats in quiet mode - thanks Leonid Shalupov

      Add FAQ

      Fix created directories not obeying umask

      Linux installation instructions - thanks Shimon Doodkin

v1.17 - 2015-06-14

    dropbox: fix case insensitivity issues - thanks Leonid Shalupov

v1.16 - 2015-06-09

    Fix uploading big files which was causing timeouts or panics

    Don't check md5sum after download with --size-only

v1.15 - 2015-06-06

    Add --checksum flag to only discard transfers by MD5SUM - thanks Alex Couper

    Implement --size-only flag to sync on size not checksum & modtime

    Expand docs and remove duplicated information

    Document rclone's limitations with directories

    dropbox: update docs about case insensitivity

v1.14 - 2015-05-21

    local: fix encoding of non utf-8 file names - fixes a duplicate file problem

    drive: docs about rate limiting

    google cloud storage: Fix compile after API change in "google.golang.org/api/storage/v1"

v1.13 - 2015-05-10

    Revise documentation (especially sync)

    Implement --timeout and --conntimeout

    s3: ignore etags from multipart uploads which aren't md5sums

v1.12 - 2015-03-15

    drive: Use chunked upload for files above a certain size

    drive: add --drive-chunk-size and --drive-upload-cutoff parameters

    drive: switch to insert from update when a failed copy deletes the upload

    core: Log duplicate files if they are detected

v1.11 - 2015-03-04

    swift: add region parameter

    drive: fix crash on failed to update remote mtime

    In remote paths, change native directory separators to /

    Add synchronization to ls/lsl/lsd output to stop corruptions

    Ensure all stats/log messages to go stderr

    Add --log-file flag to log everything (including panics) to file

    Make it possible to disable stats printing with --stats=0

    Implement --bwlimit to limit data transfer bandwidth

v1.10 - 2015-02-12

    s3: list an unlimited number of items

    Fix getting stuck in the configurator

v1.09 - 2015-02-07

    windows: Stop drive letters (e.g.  C:) getting mixed up with remotes (e.g.  drive:)

    local: Fix directory separators on Windows

    drive: fix rate limit exceeded errors

v1.08 - 2015-02-04

    drive: fix subdirectory listing to not list entire drive

    drive: Fix SetModTime

    dropbox: adapt code to recent library changes

v1.07 - 2014-12-23

    google cloud storage: fix memory leak

v1.06 - 2014-12-12

    Fix "Couldn't find home directory" on OSX

    swift: Add tenant parameter

    Use new location of Google API packages

v1.05 - 2014-08-09

    Improved tests and consequently lots of minor fixes

    core: Fix race detected by go race detector

    core: Fixes after running errcheck

    drive: reset root directory on Rmdir and Purge

    fs: Document that Purger returns error on empty directory, test and fix

    google cloud storage: fix ListDir on subdirectory

    google cloud storage: re-read metadata in SetModTime

    s3: make reading metadata more reliable to work around eventual consistency problems

    s3: strip trailing / from ListDir()

    swift: return directories without / in ListDir

v1.04 - 2014-07-21

    google cloud storage: Fix crash on Update

v1.03 - 2014-07-20

    swift, s3, dropbox: fix updated files being marked as corrupted

    Make compile with go 1.1 again

v1.02 - 2014-07-19

    Implement Dropbox remote

    Implement Google Cloud Storage remote

    Verify Md5sums and Sizes after copies

    Remove times from "ls" command - lists sizes only

    Add add "lsl" - lists times and sizes

    Add "md5sum" command

v1.01 - 2014-07-04

    drive: fix transfer of big files using up lots of memory

v1.00 - 2014-07-03

    drive: fix whole second dates

v0.99 - 2014-06-26

    Fix --dry-run not working

    Make compatible with go 1.1

v0.98 - 2014-05-30

    s3: Treat missing Content-Length as 0 for some ceph installations

    rclonetest: add file with a space in

v0.97 - 2014-05-05

    Implement copying of single files

    s3 & swift: support paths inside containers/buckets

v0.96 - 2014-04-24

    drive: Fix multiple files of same name being created

    drive: Use o.Update and fs.Put to optimise transfers

    Add version number, -V and --version

v0.95 - 2014-03-28

    rclone.org: website, docs and graphics

    drive: fix path parsing

v0.94 - 2014-03-27

    Change remote format one last time

    GNU style flags

v0.93 - 2014-03-16

    drive: store token in config file

    cross compile other versions

    set strict permissions on config file

v0.92 - 2014-03-15

    Config fixes and --config option

v0.91 - 2014-03-15

    Make config file

v0.90 - 2013-06-27

    Project named rclone

v0.00 - 2012-11-18

    Project started

Bugs and Limitations Limitations Directory timestamps aren't preserved

   Rclone doesn't currently preserve the timestamps of directories.  This is because rclone only really considers objects when syncing.

Rclone struggles with millions of files in a directory/bucket

   Currently rclone loads each directory/bucket entirely into memory before using it.  Since each rclone object takes 0.5k-1k of memory this  can  take  a  very
   long time and use a large amount of memory.

   Millions  of  files  in  a directory tends to occur on bucket-based remotes (e.g.  S3 buckets) since those remotes do not segregate subdirectories within the
   bucket.

Bucket-based remotes and folders

   Bucket-based remotes (e.g.  S3/GCS/Swift/B2) do not have a concept of directories.  Rclone therefore cannot create directories in them which means that empty
   directories on a bucket-based remote will tend to disappear.

   Some software creates empty keys ending in / as directory markers.  Rclone doesn't do this as it potentially creates more objects and costs more.  This abil
   ity may be added in the future (probably via a flag/option).

Bugs

   Bugs are stored in rclone's GitHub project:

    Reported bugs (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues?q=is%3Aopen+is%3Aissue+label%3Abug)

    Known issues (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues?q=is%3Aopen+is%3Aissue+milestone%3A%22Known+Problem%22)

Frequently Asked Questions Do all cloud storage systems support all rclone commands

   Yes they do.  All the rclone commands (e.g.  sync, copy, etc.)  will work on all the remote storage systems.

Can I copy the config from one machine to another

   Sure!  Rclone stores all of its config in a single file.  If you want to find this file, run rclone config file which will tell you where it is.

   See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for more info.

How do I configure rclone on a remote / headless box with no browser?

   This has now been documented in its own remote setup page (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/).

Can rclone sync directly from drive to s3

   Rclone can sync between two remote cloud storage systems just fine.

   Note that it effectively downloads the file and uploads it again, so the node running rclone would need to have lots of bandwidth.

   The syncs would be incremental (on a file by file basis).

   e.g.

          rclone sync --interactive drive:Folder s3:bucket

Using rclone from multiple locations at the same time

   You can use rclone from multiple places at the same time if you choose different subdirectory for the output, e.g.

          Server A> rclone sync --interactive /tmp/whatever remote:ServerA
          Server B> rclone sync --interactive /tmp/whatever remote:ServerB

   If you sync to the same directory then you should use rclone copy otherwise the two instances of rclone may delete each other's files, e.g.

          Server A> rclone copy /tmp/whatever remote:Backup
          Server B> rclone copy /tmp/whatever remote:Backup

   The file names you upload from Server A and Server B should be different in this case, otherwise some file systems (e.g.  Drive) may make duplicates.

Why doesn't rclone support partial transfers / binary diffs like rsync?

   Rclone stores each file you transfer as a native object on the remote cloud storage system.  This means that you can see the files you upload as expected us
   ing  alternative  access methods (e.g.  using the Google Drive web interface).  There is a 1:1 mapping between files on your hard disk and objects created in
   the cloud storage system.

   Cloud storage systems (at least none I've come across yet) don't support partially uploading an object.  You can't take an existing object, and  change  some
   bytes in the middle of it.

   It would be possible to make a sync system which stored binary diffs instead of whole objects like rclone does, but that would break the 1:1 mapping of files
   on your hard disk to objects in the remote cloud storage system.

   All the cloud storage systems support partial downloads of content, so it would be possible to make partial downloads work.  However to make this work  effi
   ciently this would require storing a significant amount of metadata, which breaks the desired 1:1 mapping of files to objects.

Can rclone do bi-directional sync?

   Yes, since rclone v1.58.0, bidirectional cloud sync (https://rclone.org/bisync/) is available.

Can I use rclone with an HTTP proxy?

   Yes.  rclone will follow the standard environment variables for proxies, similar to cURL and other programs.

   In general the variables are called http_proxy (for services reached over http) and https_proxy (for services reached over https).  Most public services will
   be using https, but you may wish to set both.

   The content of the variable is protocol://server:port.  The protocol value is the one used to talk to the proxy server, itself, and is commonly  either  http
   or socks5.

   Slightly  annoyingly,  there  is  no standard for the name; some applications may use http_proxy but another one HTTP_PROXY.  The Go libraries used by rclone
   will try both variations, but you may wish to set all possibilities.  So, on Linux, you may end up with code similar to

          export http_proxy=http://proxyserver:12345
          export https_proxy=$http_proxy
          export HTTP_PROXY=$http_proxy
          export HTTPS_PROXY=$http_proxy

   Note: If the proxy server requires a username and password, then use

          export http_proxy=http://username:password@proxyserver:12345
          export https_proxy=$http_proxy
          export HTTP_PROXY=$http_proxy
          export HTTPS_PROXY=$http_proxy

   The NO_PROXY allows you to disable the proxy for specific hosts.  Hosts must be comma separated, and can contain domains or parts.   For  instance  "foo.com"
   also matches "bar.foo.com".

   e.g.

          export no_proxy=localhost,127.0.0.0/8,my.host.name
          export NO_PROXY=$no_proxy

   Note that the FTP backend does not support ftp_proxy yet.

Rclone gives x509: failed to load system roots and no roots provided error

   This means that rclone can't find the SSL root certificates.  Likely you are running rclone on a NAS with a cut-down Linux OS, or possibly on Solaris.

   Rclone (via the Go runtime) tries to load the root certificates from these places on Linux.

          "/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt", // Debian/Ubuntu/Gentoo etc.
          "/etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt",   // Fedora/RHEL
          "/etc/ssl/ca-bundle.pem",             // OpenSUSE
          "/etc/pki/tls/cacert.pem",            // OpenELEC

   So doing something like this should fix the problem.  It also sets the time which is important for SSL to work properly.

          mkdir -p /etc/ssl/certs/
          curl -o /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt https://raw.githubusercontent.com/bagder/ca-bundle/master/ca-bundle.crt
          ntpclient -s -h pool.ntp.org

   The  two  environment  variables  SSL_CERT_FILE and SSL_CERT_DIR, mentioned in the x509 package (https://godoc.org/crypto/x509), provide an additional way to
   provide the SSL root certificates.

   Note that you may need to add the --insecure option to the curl command line if it doesn't work without.

          curl --insecure -o /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt https://raw.githubusercontent.com/bagder/ca-bundle/master/ca-bundle.crt

Rclone gives Failed to load config file: function not implemented error

   Likely this means that you are running rclone on Linux version not supported by the go runtime, ie earlier than version 2.6.23.

   See the system requirements section in the go install docs (https://golang.org/doc/install) for full details.

All my uploaded docx/xlsx/pptx files appear as archive/zip

   This is caused by uploading these files from a Windows computer which hasn't got the Microsoft Office suite installed.  The easiest way to fix is to  install
   the Word viewer and the Microsoft Office Compatibility Pack for Word, Excel, and PowerPoint 2007 and later versions' file formats

tcp lookup some.domain.com no such host

   This happens when rclone cannot resolve a domain.  Please check that your DNS setup is generally working, e.g.

          # both should print a long list of possible IP addresses
          dig www.googleapis.com          # resolve using your default DNS
          dig www.googleapis.com @8.8.8.8 # resolve with Google's DNS server

   If  you  are using systemd-resolved (default on Arch Linux), ensure it is at version 233 or higher.  Previous releases contain a bug which causes not all do
   mains to be resolved properly.

   Additionally with the GODEBUG=netdns= environment variable the Go resolver decision can be influenced.  This also allows to resolve certain issues  with  DNS
   resolution.  See the name resolution section in the go docs (https://golang.org/pkg/net/#hdr-Name_Resolution).

The total size reported in the stats for a sync is wrong and keeps changing

   It  is likely you have more than 10,000 files that need to be synced.  By default, rclone only gets 10,000 files ahead in a sync so as not to use up too much
   memory.  You can change this default with the --max-backlog (https://rclone.org/docs/#max-backlog-n) flag.

Rclone is using too much memory or appears to have a memory leak

   Rclone is written in Go which uses a garbage collector.  The default settings for the garbage collector mean that it runs when the heap size has doubled.

   However it is possible to tune the garbage collector to use less memory by setting GOGC (https://dave.cheney.net/tag/gogc)  to  a  lower  value,  say  export
   GOGC=20.  This will make the garbage collector work harder, reducing memory size at the expense of CPU usage.

   The  most  common  cause  of rclone using lots of memory is a single directory with thousands or millions of files in.  Rclone has to load this entirely into
   memory as rclone objects.  Each rclone object takes 0.5k-1k of memory.

Rclone changes fullwidth Unicode punctuation marks in file names

   For example: On a Windows system, you have a file with name Test1.jpg, where  is the Unicode fullwidth colon symbol.  When using rclone to copy  this  to
   your Google Drive, you will notice that the file gets renamed to Test:1.jpg, where : is the regular (halfwidth) colon.

   The  reason  for such renames is the way rclone handles different restricted filenames (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-filenames) on different cloud
   storage systems.  It tries to avoid ambiguous file names as much and allow moving files between many cloud storage systems transparently,  by  replacing  in
   valid  characters  with similar looking Unicode characters when transferring to one storage system, and replacing back again when transferring to a different
   storage system where the original characters are supported.  When the same Unicode characters are intentionally used in file names, this replacement strategy
   leads to unwanted renames.  Read more here (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-filenames-caveats).

License

   This is free software under the terms of the MIT license (check the COPYING file included with the source code).

          Copyright (C) 2019 by Nick Craig-Wood https://www.craig-wood.com/nick/

          Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
          of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
          in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
          to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
          copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
          furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:

          The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
          all copies or substantial portions of the Software.

          THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
          IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
          FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
          AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
          LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
          OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
          THE SOFTWARE.

Authors and contributors Authors

    Nick Craig-Wood <nick@craig-wood.com>

Contributors

   {{<  rem email addresses removed from here need to be addeed to bin/.ignore-emails to make sure update-authors.py doesn't immediately put them back in again.
   >}}

    Alex Couper <amcouper@gmail.com>

    Leonid Shalupov <leonid@shalupov.com> <shalupov@diverse.org.ru>

    Shimon Doodkin <helpmepro1@gmail.com>

    Colin Nicholson <colin@colinn.com>

    Klaus Post <klauspost@gmail.com>

    Sergey Tolmachev <tolsi.ru@gmail.com>

    Adriano Aurélio Meirelles <adriano@atinge.com>

    C.  Bess <cbess@users.noreply.github.com>

    Dmitry Burdeev <dibu28@gmail.com>

    Joseph Spurrier <github@josephspurrier.com>

    Björn Harrtell <bjorn@wololo.org>

    Xavier Lucas <xavier.lucas@corp.ovh.com>

    Werner Beroux <werner@beroux.com>

    Brian Stengaard <brian@stengaard.eu>

    Jakub Gedeon <jgedeon@sofi.com>

    Jim Tittsler <jwt@onjapan.net>

    Michal Witkowski <michal@improbable.io>

    Fabian Ruff <fabian.ruff@sap.com>

    Leigh Klotz <klotz@quixey.com>

    Romain Lapray <lapray.romain@gmail.com>

    Justin R.  Wilson <jrw972@gmail.com>

    Antonio Messina <antonio.s.messina@gmail.com>

    Stefan G.  Weichinger <office@oops.co.at>

    Per Cederberg <cederberg@gmail.com>

    Radek Šenfeld <rush@logic.cz>

    Fredrik Fornwall <fredrik@fornwall.net>

    Asko Tamm <asko@deekit.net>

    xor-zz <xor@gstocco.com>

    Tomasz Mazur <tmazur90@gmail.com>

    Marco Paganini <paganini@paganini.net>

    Felix Bünemann <buenemann@louis.info>

    Durval Menezes <jmrclone@durval.com>

    Luiz Carlos Rumbelsperger Viana <maxd13_luiz_carlos@hotmail.com>

    Stefan Breunig <stefan-github@yrden.de>

    Alishan Ladhani <ali-l@users.noreply.github.com>

    0xJAKE <0xJAKE@users.noreply.github.com>

    Thibault Molleman <thibaultmol@users.noreply.github.com>

    Scott McGillivray <scott.mcgillivray@gmail.com>

    Bjørn Erik Pedersen <bjorn.erik.pedersen@gmail.com>

    Lukas Loesche <lukas@mesosphere.io>

    emyarod <allllaboutyou@gmail.com>

    T.C.  Ferguson <tcf909@gmail.com>

    Brandur <brandur@mutelight.org>

    Dario Giovannetti <dev@dariogiovannetti.net>

    Károly Oláh <okaresz@aol.com>

    Jon Yergatian <jon@macfanatic.ca>

    Jack Schmidt <github@mowsey.org>

    Dedsec1 <Dedsec1@users.noreply.github.com>

    Hisham Zarka <hzarka@gmail.com>

    Jérôme Vizcaino <jerome.vizcaino@gmail.com>

    Mike Tesch <mjt6129@rit.edu>

    Marvin Watson <marvwatson@users.noreply.github.com>

    Danny Tsai <danny8376@gmail.com>

    Yoni Jah <yonjah+git@gmail.com> <yonjah+github@gmail.com>

    Stephen Harris <github@spuddy.org> <sweharris@users.noreply.github.com>

    Ihor Dvoretskyi <ihor.dvoretskyi@gmail.com>

    Jon Craton <jncraton@gmail.com>

    Hraban Luyat <hraban@0brg.net>

    Michael Ledin <mledin89@gmail.com>

    Martin Kristensen <me@azgul.com>

    Too Much IO <toomuchio@users.noreply.github.com>

    Anisse Astier <anisse@astier.eu>

    Zahiar Ahmed <zahiar@live.com>

    Igor Kharin <igorkharin@gmail.com>

    Bill Zissimopoulos <billziss@navimatics.com>

    Bob Potter <bobby.potter@gmail.com>

    Steven Lu <tacticalazn@gmail.com>

    Sjur Fredriksen <sjurtf@ifi.uio.no>

    Ruwbin <hubus12345@gmail.com>

    Fabian Möller <fabianm88@gmail.com> <f.moeller@nynex.de>

    Edward Q.  Bridges <github@eqbridges.com>

    Vasiliy Tolstov <v.tolstov@selfip.ru>

    Harshavardhana <harsha@minio.io>

    sainaen <sainaen@gmail.com>

    gdm85 <gdm85@users.noreply.github.com>

    Yaroslav Halchenko <debian@onerussian.com>

    John Papandriopoulos <jpap@users.noreply.github.com>

    Zhiming Wang <zmwangx@gmail.com>

    Andy Pilate <cubox@cubox.me>

    Oliver Heyme <olihey@googlemail.com> <olihey@users.noreply.github.com> <de8olihe@lego.com>

    wuyu <wuyu@yunify.com>

    Andrei Dragomir <adragomi@adobe.com>

    Christian Brüggemann <mail@cbruegg.com>

    Alex McGrath Kraak <amkdude@gmail.com>

    bpicode <bjoern.pirnay@googlemail.com>

    Daniel Jagszent <daniel@jagszent.de>

    Josiah White <thegenius2009@gmail.com>

    Ishuah Kariuki <kariuki@ishuah.com> <ishuah91@gmail.com>

    Jan Varho <jan@varho.org>

    Girish Ramakrishnan <girish@cloudron.io>

    LingMan <LingMan@users.noreply.github.com>

    Jacob McNamee <jacobmcnamee@gmail.com>

    jersou <jertux@gmail.com>

    thierry <thierry@substantiel.fr>

    Simon Leinen <simon.leinen@gmail.com> <ubuntu@s3-test.novalocal>

    Dan Dascalescu <ddascalescu+github@gmail.com>

    Jason Rose <jason@jro.io>

    Andrew Starr-Bochicchio <a.starr.b@gmail.com>

    John Leach <john@johnleach.co.uk>

    Corban Raun <craun@instructure.com>

    Pierre Carlson <mpcarl@us.ibm.com>

    Ernest Borowski <er.borowski@gmail.com>

    Remus Bunduc <remus.bunduc@gmail.com>

    Iakov Davydov <iakov.davydov@unil.ch> <dav05.gith@myths.ru>

    Jakub Tasiemski <tasiemski@gmail.com>

    David Minor <dminor@saymedia.com>

    Tim Cooijmans <cooijmans.tim@gmail.com>

    Laurence <liuxy6@gmail.com>

    Giovanni Pizzi <gio.piz@gmail.com>

    Filip Bartodziej <filipbartodziej@gmail.com>

    Jon Fautley <jon@dead.li>

    lewapm <32110057+lewapm@users.noreply.github.com>

    Yassine Imounachen <yassine256@gmail.com>

    Chris Redekop <chris-redekop@users.noreply.github.com> <chris.redekop@gmail.com>

    Jon Fautley <jon@adenoid.appstal.co.uk>

    Will Gunn <WillGunn@users.noreply.github.com>

    Lucas Bremgartner <lucas@bremis.ch>

    Jody Frankowski <jody.frankowski@gmail.com>

    Andreas Roussos <arouss1980@gmail.com>

    nbuchanan <nbuchanan@utah.gov>

    Durval Menezes <rclone@durval.com>

    Victor <vb-github@viblo.se>

    Mateusz <pabian.mateusz@gmail.com>

    Daniel Loader <spicypixel@gmail.com>

    David0rk <davidork@gmail.com>

    Alexander Neumann <alexander@bumpern.de>

    Giri Badanahatti <gbadanahatti@us.ibm.com@Giris-MacBook-Pro.local>

    Leo R.  Lundgren <leo@finalresort.org>

    wolfv <wolfv6@users.noreply.github.com>

    Dave Pedu <dave@davepedu.com>

    Stefan Lindblom <lindblom@spotify.com>

    seuffert <oliver@seuffert.biz>

    gbadanahatti <37121690+gbadanahatti@users.noreply.github.com>

    Keith Goldfarb <barkofdelight@gmail.com>

    Steve Kriss <steve@heptio.com>

    Chih-Hsuan Yen <yan12125@gmail.com>

    Alexander Neumann <fd0@users.noreply.github.com>

    Matt Holt <mholt@users.noreply.github.com>

    Eri Bastos <bastos.eri@gmail.com>

    Michael P.  Dubner <pywebmail@list.ru>

    Antoine GIRARD <sapk@users.noreply.github.com>

    Mateusz Piotrowski <mpp302@gmail.com>

    Animosity022 <animosity22@users.noreply.github.com> <earl.texter@gmail.com>

    Peter Baumgartner <pete@lincolnloop.com>

    Craig Rachel <craig@craigrachel.com>

    Michael G.  Noll <miguno@users.noreply.github.com>

    hensur <me@hensur.de>

    Oliver Heyme <de8olihe@lego.com>

    Richard Yang <richard@yenforyang.com>

    Piotr Oleszczyk <piotr.oleszczyk@gmail.com>

    Rodrigo <rodarima@gmail.com>

    NoLooseEnds <NoLooseEnds@users.noreply.github.com>

    Jakub Karlicek <jakub@karlicek.me>

    John Clayton <john@codemonkeylabs.com>

    Kasper Byrdal Nielsen <byrdal76@gmail.com>

    Benjamin Joseph Dag <bjdag1234@users.noreply.github.com>

    themylogin <themylogin@gmail.com>

    Onno Zweers <onno.zweers@surfsara.nl>

    Jasper Lievisse Adriaanse <jasper@humppa.nl>

    sandeepkru <sandeep.ummadi@gmail.com> <sandeepkru@users.noreply.github.com>

    HerrH <atomtigerzoo@users.noreply.github.com>

    Andrew <4030760+sparkyman215@users.noreply.github.com>

    dan smith <XX1011@gmail.com>

    Oleg Kovalov <iamolegkovalov@gmail.com>

    Ruben Vandamme <github-com-00ff86@vandamme.email>

    Cnly <minecnly@gmail.com>

    Andres Alvarez <1671935+kir4h@users.noreply.github.com>

    reddi1 <xreddi@gmail.com>

    Matt Tucker <matthewtckr@gmail.com>

    Sebastian Bünger <buengese@gmail.com> <buengese@protonmail.com>

    Martin Polden <mpolden@mpolden.no>

    Alex Chen <Cnly@users.noreply.github.com>

    Denis <deniskovpen@gmail.com>

    bsteiss <35940619+bsteiss@users.noreply.github.com>

    Cédric Connes <cedric.connes@gmail.com>

    Dr.  Tobias Quathamer <toddy15@users.noreply.github.com>

    dcpu <42736967+dcpu@users.noreply.github.com>

    Sheldon Rupp <me@shel.io>

    albertony <12441419+albertony@users.noreply.github.com>

    cron410 <cron410@gmail.com>

    Anagh Kumar Baranwal <6824881+darthShadow@users.noreply.github.com>

    Felix Brucker <felix@felixbrucker.com>

    Santiago Rodríguez <scollazo@users.noreply.github.com>

    Craig Miskell <craig.miskell@fluxfederation.com>

    Antoine GIRARD <sapk@sapk.fr>

    Joanna Marek <joanna.marek@u2i.com>

    frenos <frenos@users.noreply.github.com>

    ssaqua <ssaqua@users.noreply.github.com>

    xnaas <me@xnaas.info>

    Frantisek Fuka <fuka@fuxoft.cz>

    Paul Kohout <pauljkohout@yahoo.com>

    dcpu <43330287+dcpu@users.noreply.github.com>

    jackyzy823 <jackyzy823@gmail.com>

    David Haguenauer <ml@kurokatta.org>

    teresy <hi.teresy@gmail.com>

    buergi <patbuergi@gmx.de>

    Florian Gamboeck <mail@floga.de>

    Ralf Hemberger <10364191+rhemberger@users.noreply.github.com>

    Scott Edlund <sedlund@users.noreply.github.com>

    Erik Swanson <erik@retailnext.net>

    Jake Coggiano <jake@stripe.com>

    brused27 <brused27@noemailaddress>

    Peter Kaminski <kaminski@istori.com>

    Henry Ptasinski <henry@logout.com>

    Alexander <kharkovalexander@gmail.com>

    Garry McNulty <garrmcnu@gmail.com>

    Mathieu Carbou <mathieu.carbou@gmail.com>

    Mark Otway <mark@otway.com>

    William Cocker <37018962+WilliamCocker@users.noreply.github.com>

    François Leurent <131.js@cloudyks.org>

    Arkadius Stefanski <arkste@gmail.com>

    Jay <dev@jaygoel.com>

    andrea rota <a@xelera.eu>

    nicolov <nicolov@users.noreply.github.com>

    Matt Joiner <anacrolix@gmail.com>

    Dario Guzik <dario@guzik.com.ar>

    qip <qip@users.noreply.github.com>

    yair@unicorn <yair@unicorn>

    Matt Robinson <brimstone@the.narro.ws>

    kayrus <kay.diam@gmail.com>

    Rémy Léone <remy.leone@gmail.com>

    Wojciech Smigielski <wojciech.hieronim.smigielski@gmail.com>

    weetmuts <oehrstroem@gmail.com>

    Jonathan <vanillajonathan@users.noreply.github.com>

    James Carpenter <orbsmiv@users.noreply.github.com>

    Vince <vince0villamora@gmail.com>

    Nestar47 <47841759+Nestar47@users.noreply.github.com>

    Six <brbsix@gmail.com>

    Alexandru Bumbacea <alexandru.bumbacea@booking.com>

    calisro <robert.calistri@gmail.com>

    Dr.Rx <david.rey@nventive.com>

    marcintustin <marcintustin@users.noreply.github.com>

    jaKa Močnik <jaka@koofr.net>

    Fionera <fionera@fionera.de>

    Dan Walters <dan@walters.io>

    Danil Semelenov <sgtpep@users.noreply.github.com>

    xopez <28950736+xopez@users.noreply.github.com>

    Ben Boeckel <mathstuf@gmail.com>

    Manu <manu@snapdragon.cc>

    Kyle E.  Mitchell <kyle@kemitchell.com>

    Gary Kim <gary@garykim.dev>

    Jon <jonathn@github.com>

    Jeff Quinn <jeffrey.quinn@bluevoyant.com>

    Peter Berbec <peter@berbec.com>

    didil <1284255+didil@users.noreply.github.com>

    id01 <gaviniboom@gmail.com>

    Robert Marko <robimarko@gmail.com>

    Philip Harvey <32467456+pharveybattelle@users.noreply.github.com>

    JorisE <JorisE@users.noreply.github.com>

    garry415 <garry.415@gmail.com>

    forgems <forgems@gmail.com>

    Florian Apolloner <florian@apolloner.eu>

    Aleksandar Janković <office@ajankovic.com> <ajankovic@users.noreply.github.com>

    Maran <maran@protonmail.com>

    nguyenhuuluan434 <nguyenhuuluan434@gmail.com>

    Laura Hausmann <zotan@zotan.pw> <laura@hausmann.dev>

    yparitcher <y@paritcher.com>

    AbelThar <abela.tharen@gmail.com>

    Matti Niemenmaa <matti.niemenmaa+git@iki.fi>

    Russell Davis <russelldavis@users.noreply.github.com>

    Yi FU <yi.fu@tink.se>

    Paul Millar <paul.millar@desy.de>

    justinalin <justinalin@qnap.com>

    EliEron <subanimehd@gmail.com>

    justina777 <chiahuei.lin@gmail.com>

    Chaitanya Bankanhal <bchaitanya15@gmail.com>

    Michał Matczuk <michal@scylladb.com>

    Macavirus <macavirus@zoho.com>

    Abhinav Sharma <abhi18av@outlook.com>

    ginvine <34869051+ginvine@users.noreply.github.com>

    Patrick Wang <mail6543210@yahoo.com.tw>

    Cenk Alti <cenkalti@gmail.com>

    Andreas Chlupka <andy@chlupka.com>

    Alfonso Montero <amontero@tinet.org>

    Ivan Andreev <ivandeex@gmail.com>

    David Baumgold <david@davidbaumgold.com>

    Lars Lehtonen <lars.lehtonen@gmail.com>

    Matei David <matei.david@gmail.com>

    David <david.bramwell@endemolshine.com>

    Anthony Rusdi <33247310+antrusd@users.noreply.github.com>

    Richard Patel <me@terorie.dev>

    庄天翼 <zty0826@gmail.com>

    SwitchJS <dev@switchjs.com>

    Raphael <PowershellNinja@users.noreply.github.com>

    Sezal Agrawal <sezalagrawal@gmail.com>

    Tyler <TylerNakamura@users.noreply.github.com>

    Brett Dutro <brett.dutro@gmail.com>

    Vighnesh SK <booterror99@gmail.com>

    Arijit Biswas <dibbyo456@gmail.com>

    Michele Caci <michele.caci@gmail.com>

    AlexandrBoltris <ua2fgb@gmail.com>

    Bryce Larson <blarson@saltstack.com>

    Carlos Ferreyra <crypticmind@gmail.com>

    Saksham Khanna <sakshamkhanna@outlook.com>

    dausruddin <5763466+dausruddin@users.noreply.github.com>

    zero-24 <zero-24@users.noreply.github.com>

    Xiaoxing Ye <ye@xiaoxing.us>

    Barry Muldrey <barry@muldrey.net>

    Sebastian Brandt <sebastian.brandt@friday.de>

    Marco Molteni <marco.molteni@mailbox.org>

    Ankur Gupta <7876747+ankur0493@users.noreply.github.com>

    Maciej Zimnoch <maciej@scylladb.com>

    anuar45 <serdaliyev.anuar@gmail.com>

    Fernando <ferferga@users.noreply.github.com>

    David Cole <david.cole@sohonet.com>

    Wei He <git@weispot.com>

    Outvi V <19144373+outloudvi@users.noreply.github.com>

    Thomas Kriechbaumer <thomas@kriechbaumer.name>

    Tennix <tennix@users.noreply.github.com>

    Ole Schütt <ole@schuett.name>

    Kuang-che Wu <kcwu@csie.org>

    Thomas Eales <wingsuit@users.noreply.github.com>

    Paul Tinsley <paul.tinsley@vitalsource.com>

    Felix Hungenberg <git@shiftgeist.com>

    Benjamin Richter <github@dev.telepath.de>

    landall <cst_zf@qq.com>

    thestigma <thestigma@gmail.com>

    jtagcat <38327267+jtagcat@users.noreply.github.com>

    Damon Permezel <permezel@me.com>

    boosh <boosh@users.noreply.github.com>

    unbelauscht <58393353+unbelauscht@users.noreply.github.com>

    Motonori IWAMURO <vmi@nifty.com>

    Benjapol Worakan <benwrk@live.com>

    Dave Koston <dave.koston@stackpath.com>

    Durval Menezes <DurvalMenezes@users.noreply.github.com>

    Tim Gallant <me@timgallant.us>

    Frederick Zhang <frederick888@tsundere.moe>

    valery1707 <valery1707@gmail.com>

    Yves G <theYinYeti@yalis.fr>

    Shing Kit Chan <chanshingkit@gmail.com>

    Franklyn Tackitt <franklyn@tackitt.net>

    Robert-André Mauchin <zebob.m@gmail.com>

    evileye <48332831+ibiruai@users.noreply.github.com>

    Joachim Brandon LeBlanc <brandon@leblanc.codes>

    Patryk Jakuszew <patryk.jakuszew@gmail.com>

    fishbullet <shindu666@gmail.com>

    greatroar <@>

    Bernd Schoolmann <mail@quexten.com>

    Elan Ruusamäe <glen@pld-linux.org>

    Max Sum <max@lolyculture.com>

    Mark Spieth <mspieth@users.noreply.github.com>

    harry <me@harry.plus>

    Samantha McVey <samantham@posteo.net>

    Jack Anderson <jack.anderson@metaswitch.com>

    Michael G <draget@speciesm.net>

    Brandon Philips <brandon@ifup.org>

    Daven <dooven@users.noreply.github.com>

    Martin Stone <martin@d7415.co.uk>

    David Bramwell <13053834+dbramwell@users.noreply.github.com>

    Sunil Patra <snl_su@live.com>

    Adam Stroud <adam.stroud@gmail.com>

    Kush <kushsharma@users.noreply.github.com>

    Matan Rosenberg <matan129@gmail.com>

    gitch1 <63495046+gitch1@users.noreply.github.com>

    ElonH <elonhhuang@gmail.com>

    Fred <fred@creativeprojects.tech>

    Sébastien Gross <renard@users.noreply.github.com>

    Maxime Suret <11944422+msuret@users.noreply.github.com>

    Caleb Case <caleb@storj.io> <calebcase@gmail.com>

    Ben Zenker <imbenzenker@gmail.com>

    Martin Michlmayr <tbm@cyrius.com>

    Brandon McNama <bmcnama@pagerduty.com>

    Daniel Slyman <github@skylayer.eu>

    Alex Guerrero <guerrero@users.noreply.github.com>

    Matteo Pietro Dazzi <matteopietro.dazzi@gft.com>

    edwardxml <56691903+edwardxml@users.noreply.github.com>

    Roman Kredentser <shareed2k@gmail.com>

    Kamil Trzciński <ayufan@ayufan.eu>

    Zac Rubin <z-0@users.noreply.github.com>

    Vincent Feltz <psycho@feltzv.fr>

    Heiko Bornholdt <bornholdt@informatik.uni-hamburg.de>

    Matteo Pietro Dazzi <matteopietro.dazzi@gmail.com>

    jtagcat <gitlab@c7.ee>

    Petri Salminen <petri@salminen.dev>

    Tim Burke <tim.burke@gmail.com>

    Kai Lüke <kai@kinvolk.io>

    Garrett Squire <github@garrettsquire.com>

    Evan Harris <eharris@puremagic.com>

    Kevin <keyam@microsoft.com>

    Morten Linderud <morten@linderud.pw>

    Dmitry Ustalov <dmitry.ustalov@gmail.com>

    Jack <196648+jdeng@users.noreply.github.com>

    kcris <cristian.tarsoaga@gmail.com>

    tyhuber1 <68970760+tyhuber1@users.noreply.github.com>

    David Ibarra <david.ibarra@realty.com>

    Tim Gallant <tim@lilt.com>

    Kaloyan Raev <kaloyan@storj.io>

    Jay McEntire <jay.mcentire@gmail.com>

    Leo Luan <leoluan@us.ibm.com>

    aus <549081+aus@users.noreply.github.com>

    Aaron Gokaslan <agokaslan@fb.com>

    Egor Margineanu <egmar@users.noreply.github.com>

    Lucas Kanashiro <lucas.kanashiro@canonical.com>

    WarpedPixel <WarpedPixel@users.noreply.github.com>

    Sam Edwards <sam@samedwards.ca>

    wjielai <gouki0123@gmail.com>

    Muffin King <jinxz_k@live.com>

    Christopher Stewart <6573710+1f47a@users.noreply.github.com>

    Russell Cattelan <cattelan@digitalelves.com>

    gyutw <30371241+gyutw@users.noreply.github.com>

    Hekmon <edouardhur@gmail.com>

    LaSombra <lasombra@users.noreply.github.com>

    Dov Murik <dov.murik@gmail.com>

    Ameer Dawood <ameer1234567890@gmail.com>

    Dan Hipschman <dan.hipschman@opendoor.com>

    Josh Soref <jsoref@users.noreply.github.com>

    David <david@staron.nl>

    Ingo <ingo@hoffmann.cx>

    Adam Plánský <adamplansky@users.noreply.github.com> <adamplansky@gmail.com>

    Manish Gupta <manishgupta.ait@gmail.com>

    Deepak Sah <sah.sslpu@gmail.com>

    Marcin Zelent <marcin@zelent.net>

    zhucan <zhucan.k8s@gmail.com>

    James Lim <james.lim@samsara.com>

    Laurens Janssen <BD69BM@insim.biz>

    Bob Bagwill <bobbagwill@gmail.com>

    Nathan Collins <colli372@msu.edu>

    lostheli

    kelv <kelvin@acks.org>

    Milly <milly.ca@gmail.com>

    gtorelly <gtorelly@gmail.com>

    Brad Ackerman <brad@facefault.org>

    Mitsuo Heijo <mitsuo.heijo@gmail.com>

    Claudio Bantaloukas <rockdreamer@gmail.com>

    Benjamin Gustin <gustin.ben@gmail.com>

    Ingo Weiss <ingo@redhat.com>

    Kerry Su <me@sshockwave.net>

    Ilyess Bachiri <ilyess.bachiri@sonder.com>

    Yury Stankevich <urykhy@gmail.com>

    kice <wslikerqs@gmail.com>

    Denis Neuling <denisneuling@gmail.com>

    Janne Johansson <icepic.dz@gmail.com>

    Patrik Nordlén <patriki@gmail.com>

    CokeMine <aptx4561@gmail.com>

    Sơn Trần-Nguyễn <github@sntran.com>

    lluuaapp <266615+lluuaapp@users.noreply.github.com>

    Zach Kipp <kipp.zach@gmail.com>

    Riccardo Iaconelli <riccardo@kde.org>

    Sakuragawa Misty <gyc990326@gmail.com>

    Nicolas Rueff <nicolas@rueff.fr>

    Pau Rodriguez-Estivill <prodrigestivill@gmail.com>

    Bob Pusateri <BobPusateri@users.noreply.github.com>

    Alex JOST <25005220+dimejo@users.noreply.github.com>

    Alexey Tabakman <samosad.ru@gmail.com>

    David Sze <sze.david@gmail.com>

    cynthia kwok <cynthia.m.kwok@gmail.com>

    Miron Veryanskiy <MironVeryanskiy@gmail.com>

    K265 <k.265@qq.com>

    Vesnyx <Vesnyx@users.noreply.github.com>

    Dmitry Chepurovskiy <me@dm3ch.net>

    Rauno Ots <rauno.ots@cgi.com>

    Georg Neugschwandtner <georg.neugschwandtner@gmx.net>

    pvalls <polvallsrue@gmail.com>

    Robert Thomas <31854736+wolveix@users.noreply.github.com>

    Romeo Kienzler <romeo.kienzler@gmail.com>

    tYYGH <tYYGH@users.noreply.github.com>

    georne <77802995+georne@users.noreply.github.com>

    Maxwell Calman <mcalman@MacBook-Pro.local>

    Naveen Honest Raj <naveendurai19@gmail.com>

    Lucas Messenger <lmesseng@cisco.com>

    Manish Kumar <krmanish260@gmail.com>

    x0b <x0bdev@gmail.com>

    CERN through the CS3MESH4EOSC Project

    Nick Gaya <nicholasgaya+github@gmail.com>

    Ashok Gelal <401055+ashokgelal@users.noreply.github.com>

    Dominik Mydlil <dominik.mydlil@outlook.com>

    Nazar Mishturak <nazarmx@gmail.com>

    Ansh Mittal <iamAnshMittal@gmail.com>

    noabody <noabody@yahoo.com>

    OleFrost <82263101+olefrost@users.noreply.github.com>

    Kenny Parsons <kennyparsons93@gmail.com>

    Jeffrey Tolar <tolar.jeffrey@gmail.com>

    jtagcat <git-514635f7@jtag.cat>

    Tatsuya Noyori <63089076+public-tatsuya-noyori@users.noreply.github.com>

    lewisxy <lewisxy@users.noreply.github.com>

    Nolan Woods <nolan_w@sfu.ca>

    Gautam Kumar <25435568+gautamajay52@users.noreply.github.com>

    Chris Macklin <chris.macklin@10xgenomics.com>

    Antoon Prins <antoon.prins@surfsara.nl>

    Alexey Ivanov <rbtz@dropbox.com>

    Serge Pouliquen <sp31415@free.fr>

    acsfer <carlos@reendex.com>

    Tom <tom@tom-fitzhenry.me.uk>

    Tyson Moore <tyson@tyson.me>

    database64128 <free122448@hotmail.com>

    Chris Lu <chrislusf@users.noreply.github.com>

    Reid Buzby <reid@rethink.software>

    darrenrhs <darrenrhs@gmail.com>

    Florian Penzkofer <fp@nullptr.de>

    Xuanchen Wu <117010292@link.cuhk.edu.cn>

    partev <petrosyan@gmail.com>

    Dmitry Sitnikov <fo2@inbox.ru>

    Haochen Tong <i@hexchain.org>

    Michael Hanselmann <public@hansmi.ch>

    Chuan Zh <zhchuan7@gmail.com>

    Antoine GIRARD <antoine.girard@sapk.fr>

    Justin Winokur (Jwink3101) <Jwink3101@users.noreply.github.com>

    Mariano Absatz (git) <scm@baby.com.ar>

    Greg Sadetsky <lepetitg@gmail.com>

    yedamo <logindaveye@gmail.com>

    hota <lindwurm.q@gmail.com>

    vinibali <vinibali1@gmail.com>

    Ken Enrique Morel <ken.morel.santana@gmail.com>

    Justin Hellings <justin.hellings@gmail.com>

    Parth Shukla <pparth@pparth.net>

    wzl <wangzl31@outlook.com>

    HNGamingUK <connor@earnshawhome.co.uk>

    Jonta <359397+Jonta@users.noreply.github.com>

    YenForYang <YenForYang@users.noreply.github.com>

    Joda Stößer <stoesser@yay-digital.de> <services+github@simjo.st>

    Logeshwaran <waranlogesh@gmail.com>

    Rajat Goel <rajat@dropbox.com>

    r0kk3rz <r0kk3rz@gmail.com>

    Matthew Sevey <mjsevey@gmail.com>

    Filip Rysavy <fil@siasky.net>

    Ian Levesque <ian@ianlevesque.org>

    Thomas Stachl <thomas@stachl.me>

    Dmitry Bogatov <git#v1@kaction.cc>

    thomae <4493560+thomae@users.noreply.github.com>

    trevyn <trevyn-git@protonmail.com>

    David Liu <david.yx.liu@oracle.com>

    Chris Nelson <stuff@cjnaz.com>

    Felix Bunemann <felix.buenemann@gmail.com>

    Atílio Antônio <atiliodadalto@hotmail.com>

    Roberto Ricci <ricci@disroot.org>

    Carlo Mion <mion00@gmail.com>

    Chris Lu <chris.lu@gmail.com>

    Vitor Arruda <vitor.pimenta.arruda@gmail.com>

    bbabich <bbabich@datamossa.com>

    David <dp.davide.palma@gmail.com>

    Borna Butkovic <borna@favicode.net>

    Fredric Arklid <fredric.arklid@consid.se>

    Andy Jackson <Andrew.Jackson@bl.uk>

    Sinan Tan <i@tinytangent.com>

    deinferno <14363193+deinferno@users.noreply.github.com>

    rsapkf <rsapkfff@pm.me>

    Will Holtz <wholtz@gmail.com>

    GGG KILLER <gggkiller2@gmail.com>

    Logeshwaran Murugesan <logeshwaran@testpress.in>

    Lu Wang <coolwanglu@gmail.com>

    Bumsu Hyeon <ksitht@gmail.com>

    Shmz Ozggrn <98463324+ShmzOzggrn@users.noreply.github.com>

    Kim <kim@jotta.no>

    Niels van de Weem <n.van.de.weem@smile.nl>

    Koopa <codingkoopa@gmail.com>

    Yunhai Luo <yunhai-luo@hotmail.com>

    Charlie Jiang <w@chariri.moe>

    Alain Nussbaumer <alain.nussbaumer@alleluia.ch>

    Vanessasaurus <814322+vsoch@users.noreply.github.com>

    Isaac Levy <isaac.r.levy@gmail.com>

    Gourav T <workflowautomation@protonmail.com>

    Paulo Martins <paulo.pontes.m@gmail.com>

    viveknathani <viveknathani2402@gmail.com>

    Eng Zer Jun <engzerjun@gmail.com>

    Abhiraj <abhiraj.official15@gmail.com>

    Márton Elek <elek@apache.org> <elek@users.noreply.github.com>

    Vincent Murphy <vdm@vdm.ie>

    ctrl-q <34975747+ctrl-q@users.noreply.github.com>

    Nil Alexandrov <nalexand@akamai.com>

    GuoXingbin <101376330+guoxingbin@users.noreply.github.com>

    Berkan Teber <berkan@berkanteber.com>

    Tobias Klauser <tklauser@distanz.ch>

    KARBOWSKI Piotr <piotr.karbowski@gmail.com>

    GH <geeklihui@foxmail.com>

    rafma0 <int.main@gmail.com>

    Adrien Rey-Jarthon <jobs@adrienjarthon.com>

    Nick Gooding <73336146+nickgooding@users.noreply.github.com>

    Leroy van Logchem <lr.vanlogchem@gmail.com>

    Zsolt Ero <zsolt.ero@gmail.com>

    Lesmiscore <nao20010128@gmail.com>

    ehsantdy <ehsan.tadayon@arvancloud.com>

    SwazRGB <65694696+swazrgb@users.noreply.github.com>

    Mateusz Puczynski <mati6095@gmail.com>

    Michael C Tiernan - MIT-Research Computing Project <mtiernan@mit.edu>

    Kaspian <34658474+KaspianDev@users.noreply.github.com>

    Werner <EvilOlaf@users.noreply.github.com>

    Hugal31 <hugo.laloge@gmail.com>

    Christian Galo <36752715+cgalo5758@users.noreply.github.com>

    Erik van Velzen <erik@evanv.nl>

    Derek Battams <derek@battams.ca>

    SimonLiu <simonliu009@users.noreply.github.com>

    Hugo Laloge <hla@lescompanions.com>

    Mr-Kanister <68117355+Mr-Kanister@users.noreply.github.com>

    Rob Pickerill <r.pickerill@gmail.com>

    Andrey <to.merge@gmail.com>

    Eric Wolf <19wolf@gmail.com>

    Nick <nick.naumann@mailbox.tu-dresden.de>

    Jason Zheng <jszheng17@gmail.com>

    Matthew Vernon <mvernon@wikimedia.org>

    Noah Hsu <i@nn.ci>

    m00594701 <mengpengbo@huawei.com>

    Art M.  Gallagher <artmg50@gmail.com>

    Sven Gerber <49589423+svengerber@users.noreply.github.com>

    CrossR <r.cross@lancaster.ac.uk>

    Maciej Radzikowski <maciej@radzikowski.com.pl>

    Scott Grimes <scott.grimes@spaciq.com>

    Phil Shackleton <71221528+philshacks@users.noreply.github.com>

    eNV25 <env252525@gmail.com>

    Caleb <inventor96@users.noreply.github.com>

    J-P Treen <jp@wraptious.com>

    Martin Czygan <53705+miku@users.noreply.github.com>

    buda <sandrojijavadze@protonmail.com>

    mirekphd <36706320+mirekphd@users.noreply.github.com>

    vyloy <vyloy@qq.com>

    Anthrazz <25553648+Anthrazz@users.noreply.github.com>

    zzr93 <34027824+zzr93@users.noreply.github.com>

    Paul Norman <penorman@mac.com>

    Lorenzo Maiorfi <maiorfi@gmail.com>

    Claudio Maradonna <penguyman@stronzi.org>

    Ovidiu Victor Tatar <ovi.tatar@googlemail.com>

    Evan Spensley <epspensley@gmail.com>

    Yen Hu <61753151+0x59656e@users.noreply.github.com>

    Steve Kowalik <steven@wedontsleep.org>

    Jordi Gonzalez Muñoz <jordigonzm@gmail.com>

    Joram Schrijver <i@joram.io>

    Mark Trolley <marktrolley@gmail.com>

    João Henrique Franco <joaohenrique.franco@gmail.com>

    anonion <aman207@users.noreply.github.com>

    Ryan Morey <4590343+rmorey@users.noreply.github.com>

    Simon Bos <simonbos9@gmail.com>

    YFdyh000 <yfdyh000@gmail.com> * Josh Soref <2119212+jsoref@users.noreply.github.com>

    Øyvind Heddeland Instefjord <instefjord@outlook.com>

    Dmitry Deniskin <110819396+ddeniskin@users.noreply.github.com>

    Alexander Knorr <106825+opexxx@users.noreply.github.com>

    Richard Bateman <richard@batemansr.us>

    Dimitri Papadopoulos Orfanos <3234522+DimitriPapadopoulos@users.noreply.github.com>

    Lorenzo Milesi <lorenzo.milesi@yetopen.com>

    Isaac Aymerich <isaac.aymerich@gmail.com>

    YanceyChiew <35898533+YanceyChiew@users.noreply.github.com>

    Manoj Ghosh <msays2000@gmail.com>

    Bachue Zhou <bachue.shu@gmail.com>

    Manoj Ghosh <manoj.ghosh@oracle.com>

    Tom Mombourquette <tom@devnode.com>

    Robert Newson <rnewson@apache.org>

    Samuel Johnson <esamueljohnson@gmail.com>

    coultonluke <luke@luke.org.uk>

    Anthony Pessy <anthony@cogniteev.com>

    Philip Harvey <pharvey@battelleecology.org>

    dgouju <dgouju@users.noreply.github.com>

    Clément Notin <clement.notin@gmail.com>

    x3-apptech <66947598+x3-apptech@users.noreply.github.com>

    Arnie97 <arnie97@gmail.com>

    Roel Arents <2691308+roelarents@users.noreply.github.com>

    Aaron Gokaslan <aaronGokaslan@gmail.com>

    techknowlogick <matti@mdranta.net>

    rkettelerij <richard@mindloops.nl>

    Kamui <fin-kamui@pm.me>

    asdffdsazqqq <90116442+asdffdsazqqq@users.noreply.github.com>

    Nathaniel Wesley Filardo <nfilardo@microsoft.com>

    ycdtosa <ycdtosa@users.noreply.github.com>

    Erik Agterdenbos <agterdenbos@users.noreply.github.com>

    Kevin Verstaen <48050031+kverstae@users.noreply.github.com>

    MohammadReza <mrvashian@gmail.com>

    vanplus <60313789+vanplus@users.noreply.github.com>

    Jack <16779171+jkpe@users.noreply.github.com>

    Abdullah Saglam <abdullah.saglam@stonebranch.com>

    Marks Polakovs <github@markspolakovs.me>

    piyushgarg <piyushgarg80@gmail.com>

    Kaloyan Raev <kaloyan-raev@users.noreply.github.com>

    IMTheNachoMan <imthenachoman@gmail.com>

    alankrit <alankrit@google.com>

    Bryan Kaplan <#@bryankaplan.com>

    LXY <767763591@qq.com>

    Simmon Li (he/him) <li.simmon@gmail.com>

    happyxhw <44490504+happyxhw@users.noreply.github.com>

    Simmon Li (he/him) <hello@crespire.dev>

    Matthias Baur <baurmatt@users.noreply.github.com>

    Hunter Wittenborn <hunter@hunterwittenborn.com>

    logopk <peter@kreuser.name>

    Gerard Bosch <30733556+gerardbosch@users.noreply.github.com>

    ToBeFree <github@tfrei.de>

    NodudeWasTaken <75137537+NodudeWasTaken@users.noreply.github.com>

    Peter Brunner <peter@lugoues.net>

    Ninh Pham <dongian.rapclubkhtn@gmail.com>

    Ryan Caezar Itang <sitiom@proton.me>

    Peter Brunner <peter@psykhe.com>

    Leandro Sacchet <leandro.sacchet@animati.com.br>

    dependabot[bot] <49699333+dependabot[bot]@users.noreply.github.com>

Contact the rclone project Forum

   Forum for questions and general discussion:

    https://forum.rclone.org

GitHub repository

   The project's repository is located at:

    https://github.com/rclone/rclone

   There you can file bug reports or contribute with pull requests.

Twitter

   You can also follow me on twitter for rclone announcements:

    @njcw (https://twitter.com/njcw)

Email

   Or if all else fails or you want to ask something private or confidential email Nick Craig-Wood (mailto:nick@craig-wood.com).  Please don't email me requests
   for help - those are better directed to the forum.  Thanks!

AUTHORS

   Nick Craig-Wood.

User Manual Mar 19, 2023 rclone(1)